This is a modern-English version of Copyright Law of the United States of America and Related Laws Contained in Title 17 of the United States Code, Circular 92, originally written by United States, Library of Congress. Copyright Office. It has been thoroughly updated, including changes to sentence structure, words, spelling, and grammar—to ensure clarity for contemporary readers, while preserving the original spirit and nuance. If you click on a paragraph, you will see the original text that we modified, and you can toggle between the two versions.

Scroll to the bottom of this page and you will find a free ePUB download link for this book.

Produced by George Davis

Created by George Davis

Copyright Law of the United States of America

Copyright Law of the United States of America

and

and

Related Laws Contained in Title 17 of the *United States Code*

Related Laws Contained in Title 17 of the *United States Code*

Circular 92

Circular 92

———————————————————————————————————— Contents

Table of Contents

  + The Constitutional Provision Respecting Copyright
  + Preface
  + Chapter 1 - Subject Matter and Scope of Copyright
  + Chapter 2 - Copyright Ownership and Transfer
  + Chapter 3 - Duration of Copyright
  + Chapter 4 - Copyright Notice, Deposit, and Registration
  + Chapter 5 - Copyright Infringement and Remedies
  + Chapter 6 - Manufacturing Requirements and Importation
  + Chapter 7 - Copyright Office
  + Chapter 8 - Copyright Arbitration Royalty Panels
  + Chapter 9 - Protection of Semiconductor Chip Products
  + Chapter 10 - Digital Audio Recording Devices and Media
  + Chapter 11 - Sound Recordings and Music Videos
  + Chapter 12 - Copyright Protection and Management Systems
  + Chapter 13 - Protection of Original Designs
  + Appendix I. Transitional and Supplementary Provisions of the
                Copyright Act of 1976
  + Appendix II. Berne Convention Implementation Act of 1988
  + Appendix III. Uruguay Round Agreements Act
  + Appendix IV. GATT/Trade-Related Aspects of Intellectual Property
                 Rights (TRIPs) Agreement, Part II, Section 6:
                 Layout-Designs (Topographies) of Integrated Circuits
  + Appendix V. Additional Provisions of the Digital Millennium
                Copyright Act
  + Appendix VI. Definition of "Berne Convention Work"
  + Appendix VII. Selected Provisions of the U.S. Code Relating to
                  Copyright

+ The Constitutional Provision Respecting Copyright
  + Preface
  + Chapter 1 - Subject Matter and Scope of Copyright
  + Chapter 2 - Copyright Ownership and Transfer
  + Chapter 3 - Duration of Copyright
  + Chapter 4 - Copyright Notice, Deposit, and Registration
  + Chapter 5 - Copyright Infringement and Remedies
  + Chapter 6 - Manufacturing Requirements and Importation
  + Chapter 7 - Copyright Office
  + Chapter 8 - Copyright Arbitration Royalty Panels
  + Chapter 9 - Protection of Semiconductor Chip Products
  + Chapter 10 - Digital Audio Recording Devices and Media
  + Chapter 11 - Sound Recordings and Music Videos
  + Chapter 12 - Copyright Protection and Management Systems
  + Chapter 13 - Protection of Original Designs
  + Appendix I. Transitional and Supplementary Provisions of the
                Copyright Act of 1976
  + Appendix II. Berne Convention Implementation Act of 1988
  + Appendix III. Uruguay Round Agreements Act
  + Appendix IV. GATT/Trade-Related Aspects of Intellectual Property
                 Rights (TRIPs) Agreement, Part II, Section 6:
                 Layout-Designs (Topographies) of Integrated Circuits
  + Appendix V. Additional Provisions of the Digital Millennium
                Copyright Act
  + Appendix VI. Definition of "Berne Convention Work"
  + Appendix VII. Selected Provisions of the U.S. Code Relating to
                  Copyright

————————————————————————————————————

Understood! Please provide the text you would like me to modernize.

The Constitutional Provision Respecting Copyright

The Copyright Constitutional Provision

The Congress shall have Power … To promote the Progress of Science and useful Arts, by securing for limited Times to Authors and Inventors the exclusive Right to their respective Writings and Discoveries

The Congress shall have the power … to promote the progress of science and useful arts by granting authors and inventors exclusive rights to their writings and discoveries for a limited time.

(United States Constitution, Article I, Section 8)

(United States Constitution, Article I, Section 8)

————————————————————————————————————

Understood. Please provide the text for modernization.

Preface

Introduction

This volume contains the text of title 17 of the *United States Code*, including all amendments enacted through the end of the second session of the 106th Congress in 2000. It includes the Copyright Act of 1976 and all subsequent amendments to copyright law; the Semiconductor Chip Protection Act of 1984, as amended; and the Vessel Hull Design Protection Act, as amended. The Copyright Office is responsible for registering claims under all three.

This volume includes the text of Title 17 of the *United States Code*, incorporating all amendments made up to the end of the second session of the 106th Congress in 2000. It covers the Copyright Act of 1976 and all the amendments to copyright law that followed, the Semiconductor Chip Protection Act of 1984, as amended, and the Vessel Hull Design Protection Act, as amended. The Copyright Office is in charge of registering claims under all three.

The United States copyright law is contained in chapters 1 through 8 and 10 through 12 of title 17 of the *United States Code.* The Copyright Act of 1976, which provides the basic framework for the current copyright law, was enacted on October 19, 1976 as Pub. L. No. 94-553, 90 Stat. 2541. Listed below in chronological order of their enactment are subsequent amendments to copyright law.

The United States copyright law is found in chapters 1 through 8 and 10 through 12 of title 17 of the *United States Code.* The Copyright Act of 1976, which lays out the basic framework for current copyright law, was passed on October 19, 1976, as Pub. L. No. 94-553, 90 Stat. 2541. Below is a chronological list of the amendments made to copyright law.

Chapters 9 and 13 of title 17 contain statutory design protection that is independent of copyright protection. Chapter 9 of title 17 is the Semiconductor Chip Protection Act of 1984 (SCPA), as amended. On November 8, 1984, the SCPA was enacted as title III of Pub. L. No. 98-620, 98 Stat. 3335, 3347. Chapter 13 of title 17 is the Vessel Hull Design Protection Act (VHDPA). It was enacted on October 28, 1998 as title V of the Digital Millennium Copyright Act (DMCA), Pub. L. No. 105-304, 112 Stat. 2860, 2905. Subsequent amendments to the SCPA and the VHDPA are also included in the list below, in chronological order of their enactment.

Chapters 9 and 13 of title 17 include design protection laws that are separate from copyright protection. Chapter 9 of title 17 is the Semiconductor Chip Protection Act of 1984 (SCPA), as updated. The SCPA was established on November 8, 1984, as title III of Pub. L. No. 98-620, 98 Stat. 3335, 3347. Chapter 13 of title 17 is the Vessel Hull Design Protection Act (VHDPA). It was established on October 28, 1998, as title V of the Digital Millennium Copyright Act (DMCA), Pub. L. No. 105-304, 112 Stat. 2860, 2905. Further updates to the SCPA and the VHDPA are also listed below, in the order they were passed.

For transitional and supplementary copyright provisions that were enacted as part of the Copyright Act of 1976 and the DMCA, but which do not amend title 17, see the Appendix.

For transitional and additional copyright rules that were established as part of the Copyright Act of 1976 and the DMCA, but that do not change title 17, see the Appendix.

Statutory Enactments Contained in Title 17 of the *United States Code*

Statutory Laws in Title 17 of the *United States Code*

+ [Copyright Act of 1976], Pub. L. No. 94-553, 90 Stat. 2541 (for the general revision of copyright law, title 17 of the *United States Code*, and for other purposes), October 19, 1976.

+ [Copyright Act of 1976], Pub. L. No. 94-553, 90 Stat. 2541 (for the general revision of copyright law, title 17 of the *United States Code*, and for other purposes), October 19, 1976.

  + Legislative Branch Appropriation Act, 1978, Pub. L. No. 95-94, 91
Stat. 653, 682 (amending Sec. 203 and 708, title 17, *United States Code*,
regarding the deposit of moneys by the Register of Copyrights in the
Treasury of the United States), enacted August 5, 1977.

+ Legislative Branch Appropriation Act, 1978, Pub. L. No. 95-94, 91
Stat. 653, 682 (amending Sec. 203 and 708, title 17, *United States Code*,
related to the deposit of funds by the Register of Copyrights in the
U.S. Treasury), enacted August 5, 1977.

+ [Copyright Amendments], Pub. L. No. 95-598, 92 Stat. 2549, 2676 (amending Sec. 201(e), title 17, *United States Code*, to permit involuntary transfer under the Bankruptcy Law), enacted November 6, 1978.

+ [Copyright Amendments], Pub. L. No. 95-598, 92 Stat. 2549, 2676 (amending Sec. 201(e), title 17, *United States Code*, to allow involuntary transfer under Bankruptcy Law), enacted November 6, 1978.

+ [Copyright Amendments], Pub. L. No. 96-517, 94 Stat. 3015, 3028 (amending Sec. 101 and 117, title 17, *United States Code*, regarding computer programs), enacted December 12, 1980.

+ [Copyright Amendments], Pub. L. No. 96-517, 94 Stat. 3015, 3028 (amending Sec. 101 and 117, title 17, *United States Code*, regarding computer programs), enacted December 12, 1980.

+ Piracy and Counterfeiting Amendments Act of 1982, Pub. L. No. 97-180, 96 Stat. 91, 93 (amending Sec. 506(a), title 17, *United States Code* and title 18 of the *United States Code*), enacted May 24, 1982.

+ Piracy and Counterfeiting Amendments Act of 1982, Pub. L. No. 97-180, 96 Stat. 91, 93 (amending Sec. 506(a), title 17, *United States Code* and title 18 of the *United States Code*), enacted May 24, 1982.

+ [Copyright Amendments], Pub. L. No. 97-215, 96 Stat. 178 (amending the manufacturing clause in chapter 6, title 17, *United States Code*), enacted July 13, 1982.

+ [Copyright Amendments], Pub. L. No. 97-215, 96 Stat. 178 (amending the manufacturing clause in chapter 6, title 17, *United States Code*), enacted July 13, 1982.

+ [Copyright Amendments], Pub. L. No. 97-366, 96 Stat. 1759 (amending Sec. 110 and Sec. 708, title 17, *United States Code*, regarding the redesignation of registration fees as filing fees, and the exemption from copyright liability of certain performances of nondramatic literary or musical works), enacted October 25, 1982.

+ [Copyright Amendments], Pub. L. No. 97-366, 96 Stat. 1759 (amending Sec. 110 and Sec. 708, title 17, *United States Code*, regarding the renaming of registration fees to filing fees, and the exemption from copyright liability for certain performances of non-dramatic literary or musical works), enacted October 25, 1982.

+ Record Rental Amendment of 1984, Pub. L. No. 98-450, 98 Stat. 1727 (amending Sec. 109 and Sec. 115, title 17, *United States Code*, with respect to rental, lease or lending of sound recordings), enacted October 4, 1984.

+ Record Rental Amendment of 1984, Pub. L. No. 98-450, 98 Stat. 1727 (amending Sec. 109 and Sec. 115, title 17, *United States Code*, regarding the rental, lease, or lending of sound recordings), enacted October 4, 1984.

+ Semiconductor Chip Protection Act of 1984, title III of Pub. L. No. 98-620, 98 Stat. 3335, 3347 (adding chapter 9, title 17, *United States Code*, to provide design protection for semiconductor chips), November 8, 1984.

+ Semiconductor Chip Protection Act of 1984, title III of Pub. L. No. 98-620, 98 Stat. 3335, 3347 (adding chapter 9, title 17, *United States Code*, to provide design protection for semiconductor chips), November 8, 1984.

+ [Copyright Amendments], Pub. L. No. 99-397, 100 Stat. 848 (amending Sec. 111 and Sec. 801, title 17, *United States Code*, to clarify the definition of the local service area of a primary transmitter in the case of a low power television station), enacted on August 27, 1986.

+ [Copyright Amendments], Pub. L. No. 99-397, 100 Stat. 848 (amending Sec. 111 and Sec. 801, title 17, *United States Code*, to clarify the definition of the local service area of a primary transmitter for low power television stations), enacted on August 27, 1986.

  + [Amendments to the Semiconductor Chip Protection Act of 1984], Pub.
L. No. 100-159, 101 Stat. 899 (amending chapter 9, title 17, *United
States Code*, regarding protection extended to semiconductor chip
products of foreign entities), enacted November 9, 1987.

+ [Amendments to the Semiconductor Chip Protection Act of 1984], Pub.
L. No. 100-159, 101 Stat. 899 (updating chapter 9, title 17, *United
States Code*, about the protection given to semiconductor chip
products from foreign entities), enacted November 9, 1987.

+ Berne Convention Implementation Act of 1988, Pub. L. No. 100-568, 102 Stat. 2853, enacted October 31, 1988. (See the Appendix for certain provisions of this Act that do not amend title 17 of the *United States Code.*)

+ Berne Convention Implementation Act of 1988, Pub. L. No. 100-568, 102 Stat. 2853, enacted October 31, 1988. (See the Appendix for specific provisions of this Act that do not change title 17 of the *United States Code.*)

+ [Copyright Amendments], Pub. L. No. 100-617, 102 Stat. 3194 (extending for an additional eight-year period certain provisions of title 17, *United States Code*, relating to the rental of sound recordings and for other purposes), enacted November 5, 1988.

+ [Copyright Amendments], Pub. L. No. 100-617, 102 Stat. 3194 (extending for an additional eight-year period certain provisions of title 17, *United States Code*, relating to the rental of sound recordings and for other purposes), enacted November 5, 1988.

+ Satellite Home Viewer Act of 1988, title II of Pub. L. No. 100-667, 102 Stat. 3935, 3949, enacted November 16, 1988.

+ Satellite Home Viewer Act of 1988, title II of Pub. L. No. 100-667, 102 Stat. 3935, 3949, enacted November 16, 1988.

+ Judicial Improvements and Access to Justice Act, Pub. L. No. 100-702, 102 Stat. 4642, 4672 (amending Sec. 912, title 17, *United States Code*), enacted November 19, 1988.

+ Judicial Improvements and Access to Justice Act, Pub. L. No. 100-702, 102 Stat. 4642, 4672 (amending Sec. 912, title 17, *United States Code*), enacted November 19, 1988.

  + Copyright Fees and Technical Amendments Act of 1989, Pub. L. No.
101-318, 104 Stat. 287, enacted on July 3, 1990.

+ Copyright Fees and Technical Amendments Act of 1989, Pub. L. No.
101-318, 104 Stat. 287, enacted on July 3, 1990.

  + Copyright Royalty Tribunal Reform and Miscellaneous Pay Act of 1989,
Pub. L. No. 101-319, 104 Stat. 290, enacted July 3, 1990.

+ Copyright Royalty Tribunal Reform and Miscellaneous Pay Act of 1989,
Pub. L. No. 101-319, 104 Stat. 290, enacted July 3, 1990.

  + Copyright Remedy Clarification Act, Pub. L. No. 101-553, 104 Stat.
2749, enacted November 15, 1990.

+ Copyright Remedy Clarification Act, Pub. L. No. 101-553, 104 Stat.
2749, enacted November 15, 1990.

+ Visual Artists Rights Act of 1990, title VI of the Judicial Improvements Act of 1990, Pub. L. No. 101-650, 104 Stat. 5089, 5128, enacted December 1, 1990.

+ Visual Artists Rights Act of 1990, title VI of the Judicial Improvements Act of 1990, Pub. L. No. 101-650, 104 Stat. 5089, 5128, enacted December 1, 1990.

+ Architectural Works Copyright Protection Act, title VII of the Judicial Improvements Act of 1990, Pub. L. No. 101-650, 104 Stat. 5089, 5133, enacted December 1, 1990.

+ Architectural Works Copyright Protection Act, title VII of the Judicial Improvements Act of 1990, Pub. L. No. 101-650, 104 Stat. 5089, 5133, enacted December 1, 1990.

+ Computer Software Rental Amendments Act of 1990, title VIII of the Judicial Improvements Act of 1990, Pub. L. No. 101-650, 104 Stat 5089, 5134, enacted December 1, 1990.

+ Computer Software Rental Amendments Act of 1990, title VIII of the Judicial Improvements Act of 1990, Pub. L. No. 101-650, 104 Stat 5089, 5134, enacted December 1, 1990.

  + Semiconductor International Protection Extension Act of 1991, Pub.
L. No. 102-64, 105 Stat. 320 (amending chapter 9, title 17, *United
States Code*, regarding protection extended to semiconductor chip
products of foreign entities), enacted June 28, 1991.

+ Semiconductor International Protection Extension Act of 1991, Pub.
L. No. 102-64, 105 Stat. 320 (amending chapter 9, title 17, *United
States Code*, regarding protection extended to semiconductor chip
products of foreign entities), enacted June 28, 1991.

+ Copyright Amendments Act of 1992, Pub. L. No. 102-307, 106 Stat. 264, 272 (amending title 17 of the *United States Code*, by deleting subsection 108(i) in its entirety), enacted June 26, 1992.

+ Copyright Amendments Act of 1992, Pub. L. No. 102-307, 106 Stat. 264, 272 (amending title 17 of the *United States Code*, by deleting subsection 108(i) in its entirety), enacted June 26, 1992.

  + Copyright Renewal Act of 1992, title I of the Copyright Amendments
Act of 1992, Pub. L. No. 102-307, 106 Stat. 264, enacted June 26, 1992.

+ Copyright Renewal Act of 1992, title I of the Copyright Amendments
Act of 1992, Pub. L. No. 102-307, 106 Stat. 264, enacted June 26, 1992.

+ [Copyright Amendments], Pub. L. No. 102-492, 106 Stat. 3145 (amending Sec. 107, title 17, *United States Code*, regarding unpublished works), enacted October 24, 1992.

+ [Copyright Amendments], Pub. L. No. 102-492, 106 Stat. 3145 (amending Sec. 107, title 17, *United States Code*, regarding unpublished works), enacted October 24, 1992.

+ [Copyright Amendments], Pub. L. No. 102-561, 106 Stat. 4233 (amending Sec. 2319, title 18, *United States Code*, regarding criminal penalties for copyright infringement), enacted October 28, 1992.

+ [Copyright Amendments], Pub. L. No. 102-561, 106 Stat. 4233 (amending Sec. 2319, title 18, *United States Code*, regarding criminal penalties for copyright infringement), enacted October 28, 1992.

+ Audio Home Recording Act of 1992, Pub. L. No. 102-563, 106 Stat. 4237 (amending title 17 of the *United States Code* by adding a new chapter 10), enacted October 28, 1992.

+ Audio Home Recording Act of 1992, Pub. L. No. 102-563, 106 Stat. 4237 (amending title 17 of the *United States Code* by adding a new chapter 10), enacted October 28, 1992.

+ North American Free Trade Agreement Implementation Act, Pub. L. No. 103-182, 107 Stat. 2057, 2114 and 2115 (amending Sec. 109, title 17, *United States Code*, and adding a new Sec. 104A), enacted December 8, 1993.

+ North American Free Trade Agreement Implementation Act, Pub. L. No. 103-182, 107 Stat. 2057, 2114 and 2115 (amending Sec. 109, title 17, *United States Code*, and adding a new Sec. 104A), enacted December 8, 1993.

+ Copyright Royalty Tribunal Reform Act of 1993, Pub. L. No. 103-198, 107 Stat. 2304 (amending, *inter alia*, chapter 8, title 17, *United States Code*), enacted December 17, 1993.

+ Copyright Royalty Tribunal Reform Act of 1993, Pub. L. No. 103-198, 107 Stat. 2304 (amending, *inter alia*, chapter 8, title 17, *United States Code*), enacted December 17, 1993.

+ Satellite Home Viewer Act of 1994, Pub. L. No. 103-369, 108 Stat. 3477 (amending, *inter alia*, Sec. 111 and Sec. 119, title 17, *United States Code*, relating to the definition of a local service area of a primary transmitter), enacted October 18, 1994.

+ Satellite Home Viewer Act of 1994, Pub. L. No. 103-369, 108 Stat. 3477 (amending, *inter alia*, Sec. 111 and Sec. 119, title 17, *United States Code*, regarding the definition of a local service area of a primary transmitter), enacted October 18, 1994.

+ Uruguay Round Agreements Act, Pub. L. No. 103-465, 108 Stat. 4809, 4973 (amending, *inter alia*, Sec. 104A, title 17, *United States Code*, and adding a new chapter 11), enacted December 8, 1994. (See the Appendix for the text of certain provisions of this Act that do not amend title 17 of the *United States Code.*)

+ Uruguay Round Agreements Act, Pub. L. No. 103-465, 108 Stat. 4809, 4973 (amending, among other things, Sec. 104A, title 17, United States Code, and adding a new chapter 11), enacted December 8, 1994. (See the Appendix for the text of certain provisions of this Act that do not amend title 17 of the United States Code.)

+ Digital Performance Right in Sound Recordings Act of 1995, Pub. L. No. 104-39, 109 Stat. 336 (amending, *inter alia*, Sec. 114 and Sec. 115, title 17, *United States Code*), enacted November 1, 1995.

+ Digital Performance Right in Sound Recordings Act of 1995, Pub. L. No. 104-39, 109 Stat. 336 (amending, *among other things*, Sec. 114 and Sec. 115, title 17, *United States Code*), enacted November 1, 1995.

  + Anticounterfeiting Consumer Protection Act of 1996, Pub. L. No.
104-153, 110 Stat. 1386, 1388 (amending Sec. 603(c), title 17, *United
States Code* and Sec. 2318, title 18, *United States Code*), enacted
July 2, 1996.

+ Anticounterfeiting Consumer Protection Act of 1996, Pub. L. No.
104-153, 110 Stat. 1386, 1388 (amending Sec. 603(c), title 17, *United
States Code* and Sec. 2318, title 18, *United States Code*), enacted
July 2, 1996.

+ Legislative Branch Appropriations Act, 1997, Pub. L. No. 104-197, 110 Stat. 2394, 2416 (amending*, inter alia*, title 17 of the *United States Code*, by adding a new Sec. 121 concerning the limitation on exclusive copyrights for literary works in specialized format for the blind and disabled), enacted September 16, 1996.

+ Legislative Branch Appropriations Act, 1997, Pub. L. No. 104-197, 110 Stat. 2394, 2416 (amending, among other things, title 17 of the United States Code, by adding a new Sec. 121 about the limitation on exclusive copyrights for literary works in specialized formats for the blind and disabled), enacted September 16, 1996.

  + [Copyright Amendments and Amendments to the Semiconductor Chip
Protection Act of 1984], Pub. L. No. 105-80, 111 Stat. 1529 (making
technical amendments to certain provisions of title 17, *United States
Code*), enacted November 13, 1997.

+ [Copyright Amendments and Changes to the Semiconductor Chip
Protection Act of 1984], Pub. L. No. 105-80, 111 Stat. 1529 (making
technical changes to certain parts of title 17, *United States
Code*), enacted November 13, 1997.

  + No Electronic Theft (NET) Act, Pub. L. No. 105-147, 111 Stat. 2678,
enacted December 16, 1997.

+ No Electronic Theft (NET) Act, Pub. L. No. 105-147, 111 Stat. 2678,
enacted December 16, 1997.

+ Sonny Bono Copyright Term Extension Act, title I of Pub. L. No. 105-298, 112 Stat. 2827 (amending chapter 3, title 17, *United States Code*, to extend the term of copyright protection for most works to life plus 70 years), enacted October 27, 1998.

+ Sonny Bono Copyright Term Extension Act, title I of Pub. L. No. 105-298, 112 Stat. 2827 (amending chapter 3, title 17, *United States Code*, to extend copyright protection for most works to the life of the author plus 70 years), enacted October 27, 1998.

+ Fairness in Music Licensing Act of 1998, title II of Pub. L. No. 105-298, 112 Stat. 2827, 2830 (amending, *inter alia*, Sec. 110, title 17, *United States Code*, and adding Sec. 513 to provide a music licensing exemption for food service and drinking establishments), enacted October 27, 1998.

+ Fairness in Music Licensing Act of 1998, title II of Pub. L. No. 105-298, 112 Stat. 2827, 2830 (amending, *among other things*, Sec. 110, title 17, *United States Code*, and adding Sec. 513 to provide a music licensing exemption for food service and drinking establishments), enacted October 27, 1998.

+ Digital Millennium Copyright Act, Pub. L. No. 105-304, 112 Stat. 2860, 2887 (title IV amending Sec. 108, 112, 114, chapter 7 and chapter 8, title 17, *United States Code*), enacted October 28, 1998. (This Act also contains four separate acts within titles I, II, III and V that amended title 17 of the *United States Code.* These four acts are each separately listed below. See the Appendix for additional provisions of this Act that do not amend title 17 of the *United States Code.*)

+ Digital Millennium Copyright Act, Pub. L. No. 105-304, 112 Stat. 2860, 2887 (title IV amending Sec. 108, 112, 114, chapter 7 and chapter 8, title 17, *United States Code*), enacted October 28, 1998. (This Act also includes four separate acts within titles I, II, III, and V that amended title 17 of the *United States Code.* These four acts are each listed separately below. See the Appendix for additional provisions of this Act that do not amend title 17 of the *United States Code.*)

+ WIPO Copyright and Performances and Phonograms Treaties Implementation Act of 1998, title I of the Digital Millennium Copyright Act, Pub. L. No. 105-304, 112 Stat. 2860, 2861 (amending title 17 of the *United States Code*, *inter alia*, to add a new chapter 12 which prohibits circumvention of copyright protection systems and provides protection for copyright management information), enacted October 28, 1998.

+ WIPO Copyright and Performances and Phonograms Treaties Implementation Act of 1998, title I of the Digital Millennium Copyright Act, Pub. L. No. 105-304, 112 Stat. 2860, 2861 (amending title 17 of the *United States Code*, *inter alia*, to add a new chapter 12 which prohibits bypassing copyright protection systems and offers protection for copyright management information), enacted October 28, 1998.

+ Online Copyright Infringement Liability Limitation Act, title II of the Digital Millennium Copyright Act, Pub. L. No. 105-304, 112 Stat. 2860, 2877 (amending title 17 of the *United States Code*, to add a new Sec. 512), enacted October 28, 1998.

+ Online Copyright Infringement Liability Limitation Act, title II of the Digital Millennium Copyright Act, Pub. L. No. 105-304, 112 Stat. 2860, 2877 (amending title 17 of the *United States Code*, to add a new Sec. 512), enacted October 28, 1998.

+ Computer Maintenance Competition Assurance Act, title III of the Digital Millennium Copyright Act, Pub. L. No. 105-304, 112 Stat. 2860, 2886 (amending Sec. 117, title 17, *United States Code*), enacted October 28, 1998.

+ Computer Maintenance Competition Assurance Act, Title III of the Digital Millennium Copyright Act, Pub. L. No. 105-304, 112 Stat. 2860, 2886 (amending Sec. 117, Title 17, *United States Code*), enacted October 28, 1998.

+ Vessel Hull Design Protection Act, title V of the Digital Millennium Copyright Act, Pub. L. No. 105-304, 112 Stat. 2860, 2905 (adding chapter 13, title 17, *United States Code*, to provide design protection for vessel hulls), enacted October 28, 1998.

+ Vessel Hull Design Protection Act, title V of the Digital Millennium Copyright Act, Pub. L. No. 105-304, 112 Stat. 2860, 2905 (adding chapter 13, title 17, *United States Code*, to provide design protection for vessel hulls), enacted October 28, 1998.

+ [Copyright Amendments and Amendments to the Vessel Hull Design Protection Act], Pub. L. No. 106-44, 113 Stat. 221 (making technical corrections to title 17 of the *United States Code*), enacted August 5, 1999.

+ [Copyright Amendments and Amendments to the Vessel Hull Design Protection Act], Pub. L. No. 106-44, 113 Stat. 221 (making technical corrections to title 17 of the *United States Code*), enacted August 5, 1999.

  + Satellite Home Viewer Improvement Act of 1999, title I of the
Intellectual Property and Communications Omnibus Reform Act of 1999,
Pub. L. No. 106-113, 113 Stat. 1501, app. I (amending chapters 1 and 5
of title 17 of the *United States Code* to replace the Satellite Home
Viewer Act of 1994 and amending chapters 12 and 13 of title 17), enacted
November 29, 1999.

+ Satellite Home Viewer Improvement Act of 1999, title I of the
Intellectual Property and Communications Omnibus Reform Act of 1999,
Pub. L. No. 106-113, 113 Stat. 1501, app. I (updating chapters 1 and 5
of title 17 of the *United States Code* to replace the Satellite Home
Viewer Act of 1994 and updating chapters 12 and 13 of title 17), enacted
November 29, 1999.

+ Digital Theft Deterrence and Copyright Damages Improvement Act of 1999, Pub. L. No. 106-160, 113 Stat 1774, (amending chapter 5 of title 17 of the *United States Code* to increase statutory damages for copyright infringement), enacted December 9, 1999.

+ Digital Theft Deterrence and Copyright Damages Improvement Act of 1999, Pub. L. No. 106-160, 113 Stat 1774, (amending chapter 5 of title 17 of the *United States Code* to raise statutory damages for copyright infringement), enacted December 9, 1999.

+ Work Made for Hire and Copyright Corrections Act of 2000, Pub. L. No. 106-379, 114 Stat. 1444 (amending the definition of work made for hire in title 17 of the *United States Code*, amending chapter 7 of title 17, including changing the language regarding Copyright Office fees, and making other technical and conforming amendments to title 17), enacted October 27, 2000.

+ Work Made for Hire and Copyright Corrections Act of 2000, Pub. L. No. 106-379, 114 Stat. 1444 (updating the definition of work made for hire in title 17 of the *United States Code*, revising chapter 7 of title 17, including changes to the language about Copyright Office fees, and making additional technical and conforming changes to title 17), enacted October 27, 2000.

————————————————————————————————————

Understood! Please provide the text you want modernized.

Chapter 1

Subject Matter and Scope of Copyright

Subject Matter and Scope of Copyright

  + 101. Definitions
  + 102. Subject matter of copyright: In general
  + 103. Subject matter of copyright: Compilations and derivative works
  + 104. Subject matter of copyright: National origin
  + 104A. Copyright in restored works
  + 105. Subject matter of copyright: United States Government works
  + 106. Exclusive rights in copyrighted works
  + 106A. Rights of certain authors to attribution and integrity
  + 107. Limitations on exclusive rights: Fair use
  + 108. Limitations on exclusive rights: Reproduction by libraries and
         archives
  + 109. Limitations on exclusive rights: Effect of transfer of
         particular copy or phonorecord
  + 110. Limitations on exclusive rights: Exemption of certain
         performances and displays
  + 111. Limitations on exclusive rights: Secondary transmissions
  + 112. Limitations on exclusive rights: Ephemeral recordings
  + 113. Scope of exclusive rights in pictorial, graphic, and sculptural
         works
  + 114. Scope of exclusive rights in sound recordings
  + 115. Scope of exclusive rights in nondramatic musical works:
         Compulsory license for making and distributing phonorecords
  + 116. Negotiated licenses for public performances by means of coin-
         operated phonorecord players
  + 117. Limitations on exclusive rights: Computer programs [1]
  + 118. Scope of exclusive rights: Use of certain works in connection
         with noncommercial broadcasting
  + 119. Limitations on exclusive rights: Secondary transmissions of
         superstations and network stations for private home viewing
  + 120. Scope of exclusive rights in architectural works
  + 121. Limitations on exclusive rights: reproduction for blind or
         other people with disabilities
  + 122. Limitations on exclusive rights; secondary transmissions by
         satellite carriers within local market

+ 101. Definitions
  + 102. Subject matter of copyright: In general
  + 103. Subject matter of copyright: Compilations and derivative works
  + 104. Subject matter of copyright: National origin
  + 104A. Copyright in restored works
  + 105. Subject matter of copyright: United States Government works
  + 106. Exclusive rights in copyrighted works
  + 106A. Rights of certain authors to attribution and integrity
  + 107. Limitations on exclusive rights: Fair use
  + 108. Limitations on exclusive rights: Reproduction by libraries and
         archives
  + 109. Limitations on exclusive rights: Effect of transfer of
         particular copy or phonorecord
  + 110. Limitations on exclusive rights: Exemption of certain
         performances and displays
  + 111. Limitations on exclusive rights: Secondary transmissions
  + 112. Limitations on exclusive rights: Ephemeral recordings
  + 113. Scope of exclusive rights in pictorial, graphic, and sculptural
         works
  + 114. Scope of exclusive rights in sound recordings
  + 115. Scope of exclusive rights in nondramatic musical works:
         Compulsory license for making and distributing phonorecords
  + 116. Negotiated licenses for public performances using coin-
         operated phonorecord players
  + 117. Limitations on exclusive rights: Computer programs [1]
  + 118. Scope of exclusive rights: Use of certain works in connection
         with noncommercial broadcasting
  + 119. Limitations on exclusive rights: Secondary transmissions of
         superstations and network stations for private home viewing
  + 120. Scope of exclusive rights in architectural works
  + 121. Limitations on exclusive rights: reproduction for blind or
         other people with disabilities
  + 122. Limitations on exclusive rights: secondary transmissions by
         satellite providers within local market

Section 101. Definitions [2]

Except as otherwise provided in this title, as used in this title, the following terms and their variant forms mean the following:

Except as otherwise stated in this title, the following terms and their variations mean the following:

An "anonymous work" is a work on the copies or phonorecords of which no natural person is identified as author.

An "anonymous work" is a piece where no individual is credited as the author on the copies or recordings.

An "architectural work" is the design of a building as embodied in any tangible medium of expression, including a building, architectural plans, or drawings. The work includes the overall form as well as the arrangement and composition of spaces and elements in the design, but does not include individual standard features. [3]

An "architectural work" is the design of a building captured in any physical form, like a structure, architectural plans, or drawings. The work encompasses the overall shape and the layout and composition of spaces and elements in the design, but it doesn't cover individual standard features. [3]

"Audiovisual works" are works that consist of a series of related images which are intrinsically intended to be shown by the use of machines or devices such as projectors, viewers, or electronic equipment, together with accompanying sounds, if any, regardless of the nature of the material objects, such as films or tapes, in which the works are embodied.

"Audiovisual works" are creations made up of a sequence of related images that are meant to be displayed using machines or devices like projectors, viewers, or electronic equipment, along with any accompanying sounds, regardless of the type of material objects, such as films or tapes, in which these works are captured.

The "Berne Convention" is the Convention for the Protection of Literary and Artistic Works, signed at Berne, Switzerland, on September 9, 1886, and all acts, protocols, and revisions thereto. [4]

The "Berne Convention" is the agreement for protecting literary and artistic works, signed in Berne, Switzerland, on September 9, 1886, along with all related acts, protocols, and updates. [4]

The "best edition" of a work is the edition, published in the United
States at any time before the date of deposit, that the Library of
Congress determines to be most suitable for its purposes.

The "best edition" of a work is the edition, published in the United
States at any time before the deposit date, that the Library of
Congress decides is most appropriate for its needs.

A person's "children" are that person's immediate offspring, whether legitimate or not, and any children legally adopted by that person.

A person's "children" are their direct offspring, regardless of whether they were born legally or not, as well as any children they have legally adopted.

A "collective work" is a work, such as a periodical issue, anthology, or encyclopedia, in which a number of contributions, constituting separate and independent works in themselves, are assembled into a collective whole.

A "collective work" is something like a magazine issue, anthology, or encyclopedia, where various contributions, each being separate and independent works on their own, are brought together into a single, collective whole.

A "compilation" is a work formed by the collection and assembling of preexisting materials or of data that are selected, coordinated, or arranged in such a way that the resulting work as a whole constitutes an original work of authorship. The term "compilation" includes collective works.

A "compilation" is a work created by gathering and organizing existing materials or data that are chosen, coordinated, or arranged in such a way that the final work as a whole represents an original piece of authorship. The term "compilation" also includes collective works.

"Copies" are material objects, other than phonorecords, in which a work is fixed by any method now known or later developed, and from which the work can be perceived, reproduced, or otherwise communicated, either directly or with the aid of a machine or device. The term "copies" includes the material object, other than a phonorecord, in which the work is first fixed.

"Copies" are physical objects, excluding phonorecords, in which a work is stored using any method currently known or developed in the future, and from which the work can be seen, reproduced, or otherwise shared, either directly or with the help of a machine or device. The term "copies" also refers to the physical object, other than a phonorecord, where the work is first stored.

"Copyright owner", with respect to any one of the exclusive rights comprised in a copyright, refers to the owner of that particular right.

"Copyright owner," in relation to any of the exclusive rights included in a copyright, refers to the individual or entity that holds that specific right.

A work is "created" when it is fixed in a copy or phonorecord for the first time; where a work is prepared over a period of time, the portion of it that has been fixed at any particular time constitutes the work as of that time, and where the work has been prepared in different versions, each version constitutes a separate work.

A work is "created" when it is recorded in a copy or sound recording for the first time; if a work is developed over time, the part that has been recorded at any given moment makes up the work as of that moment, and if the work has different versions, each version counts as a separate work.

A "derivative work" is a work based upon one or more preexisting works, such as a translation, musical arrangement, dramatization, fictionalization, motion picture version, sound recording, art reproduction, abridgment, condensation, or any other form in which a work may be recast, transformed, or adapted. A work consisting of editorial revisions, annotations, elaborations, or other modifications, which, as a whole, represent an original work of authorship, is a "derivative work".

A "derivative work" is a creation that is based on one or more existing works, such as a translation, musical arrangement, dramatization, fictionalization, movie adaptation, sound recording, art reproduction, abridgment, condensation, or any other format in which a work can be reimagined, changed, or adapted. A work that includes editorial revisions, annotations, elaborations, or other modifications, which together make up a unique work of authorship, is considered a "derivative work."

A "device", "machine", or "process" is one now known or later developed.

A "device," "machine," or "process" refers to something that is currently known or will be developed in the future.

A "digital transmission" is a transmission in whole or in part in a digital or other non-analog format. [5]

A "digital transmission" is a transmission that is fully or partially in a digital or non-analog format. [5]

To "display" a work means to show a copy of it, either directly or by means of a film, slide, television image, or any other device or process or, in the case of a motion picture or other audiovisual work, to show individual images nonsequentially.

To "display" a work means to show a copy of it, either directly or through a film, slide, TV image, or any other device or method, or, in the case of a movie or other audiovisual work, to show individual images out of order.

An "establishment" is a store, shop, or any similar place of business open to the general public for the primary purpose of selling goods or services in which the majority of the gross square feet of space that is nonresidential is used for that purpose, and in which nondramatic musical works are performed publicly. [6]

An "establishment" is a store, shop, or any similar business that is open to the public mainly for selling goods or services, where most of the nonresidential space is used for that purpose, and where nondramatic musical works are performed publicly. [6]

A "food service or drinking establishment" is a restaurant, inn, bar, tavern, or any other similar place of business in which the public or patrons assemble for the primary purpose of being served food or drink, in which the majority of the gross square feet of space that is nonresidential is used for that purpose, and in which nondramatic musical works are performed publicly. [7]

A "food service or drinking establishment" is a restaurant, inn, bar, tavern, or any similar business where the public or customers gather mainly to be served food or drinks, where most of the nonresidential space is used for that purpose, and where non-dramatic musical performances take place. [7]

The term "financial gain" includes receipt, or expectation of receipt, of anything of value, including the receipt of other copyrighted works. [8]

The term "financial gain" includes receiving, or expecting to receive, anything of value, including receiving other copyrighted works. [8]

A work is "fixed" in a tangible medium of expression when its embodiment in a copy or phonorecord, by or under the authority of the author, is sufficiently permanent or stable to permit it to be perceived, reproduced, or otherwise communicated for a period of more than transitory duration. A work consisting of sounds, images, or both, that are being transmitted, is "fixed" for purposes of this title if a fixation of the work is being made simultaneously with its transmission.

A work is "fixed" in a tangible medium of expression when it is captured in a copy or recording, by or with the permission of the author, in a way that is permanent or stable enough to be perceived, reproduced, or communicated for a time that is longer than just a moment. A work made up of sounds, images, or both, that is being broadcast, is considered "fixed" for this title if it is being recorded at the same time as it is being transmitted.

The "Geneva Phonograms Convention" is the Convention for the Protection of Producers of Phonograms Against Unauthorized Duplication of Their Phonograms, concluded at Geneva, Switzerland, on October 29, 1971. [9]

The "Geneva Phonograms Convention" is the agreement designed to protect producers of phonograms from unauthorized duplication of their recordings, finalized in Geneva, Switzerland, on October 29, 1971. [9]

The "gross square feet of space" of an establishment means the entire interior space of that establishment, and any adjoining outdoor space used to serve patrons, whether on a seasonal basis or otherwise. [10]

The "gross square feet of space" of a business refers to all the indoor space of that business and any outdoor areas used to serve customers, whether it's seasonal or not. [10]

The terms "including" and "such as" are illustrative and not limitative.

The terms "including" and "such as" are examples and not exhaustive.

An "international agreement" is-

An "international agreement" is-

(1) the Universal Copyright Convention; (2) the Geneva Phonograms Convention; (3) the Berne Convention; (4) the WTO Agreement; (5) the WIPO Copyright Treaty; [11] (6) the WIPO Performances and Phonograms Treaty; [12] and (7) any other copyright treaty to which the United States is a party. [13]

(1) the Universal Copyright Convention; (2) the Geneva Phonograms Convention; (3) the Berne Convention; (4) the WTO Agreement; (5) the WIPO Copyright Treaty; [11] (6) the WIPO Performances and Phonograms Treaty; [12] and (7) any other copyright treaty the United States is a part of. [13]

A "joint work" is a work prepared by two or more authors with the intention that their contributions be merged into inseparable or interdependent parts of a unitary whole.

A "joint work" is a piece created by two or more authors who intend for their contributions to be combined into inseparable or interdependent parts of a single whole.

"Literary works" are works, other than audiovisual works, expressed in words, numbers, or other verbal or numerical symbols or indicia, regardless of the nature of the material objects, such as books, periodicals, manuscripts, phonorecords, film, tapes, disks, or cards, in which they are embodied.

"Literary works" are creations, other than audiovisual projects, expressed in words, numbers, or other written or numerical symbols or indicators, regardless of the type of physical forms, such as books, magazines, manuscripts, recordings, films, tapes, disks, or cards, in which they exist.

"Motion pictures" are audiovisual works consisting of a series of related images which, when shown in succession, impart an impression of motion, together with accompanying sounds, if any.

"Motion pictures" are audiovisual works made up of a series of related images that, when displayed one after another, create the illusion of motion, along with any accompanying sounds.

To "perform" a work means to recite, render, play, dance, or act it, either directly or by means of any device or process or, in the case of a motion picture or other audiovisual work, to show its images in any sequence or to make the sounds accompanying it audible.

To "perform" a work means to recite, render, play, dance, or act it, either directly or through any device or process. In the case of a motion picture or other audiovisual work, it means to show its images in any order or to make the accompanying sounds audible.

A "performing rights society" is an association, corporation, or other entity that licenses the public performance of nondramatic musical works on behalf of copyright owners of such works, such as the American Society of Composers, Authors and Publishers (ASCAP), Broadcast Music, Inc. (BMI), and SESAC, Inc. [14]

A "performing rights society" is an organization, company, or other entity that licenses the public performance of non-dramatic musical works on behalf of the copyright owners of those works, like the American Society of Composers, Authors and Publishers (ASCAP), Broadcast Music, Inc. (BMI), and SESAC, Inc. [14]

"Phonorecords" are material objects in which sounds, other than those accompanying a motion picture or other audiovisual work, are fixed by any method now known or later developed, and from which the sounds can be perceived, reproduced, or otherwise communicated, either directly or with the aid of a machine or device. The term "phonorecords" includes the material object in which the sounds are first fixed.

"Phonorecords" are physical objects that capture sounds, excluding those that go along with a movie or other audiovisual content, using any methods known now or invented in the future. These sounds can be heard, reproduced, or otherwise transmitted, whether directly or with the help of a machine or device. The term "phonorecords" also refers to the physical object where the sounds are initially recorded.

"Pictorial, graphic, and sculptural works" include two-dimensional and three-dimensional works of fine, graphic, and applied art, photographs, prints and art reproductions, maps, globes, charts, diagrams, models, and technical drawings, including architectural plans. Such works shall include works of artistic craftsmanship insofar as their form but not their mechanical or utilitarian aspects are concerned; the design of a useful article, as defined in this section, shall be considered a pictorial, graphic, or sculptural work only if, and only to the extent that, such design incorporates pictorial, graphic, or sculptural features that can be identified separately from, and are capable of existing independently of, the utilitarian aspects of the article. [15]

"Pictorial, graphic, and sculptural works" include both 2D and 3D pieces of fine art, graphic art, and applied art, such as photographs, prints, art reproductions, maps, globes, charts, diagrams, models, and technical drawings, including architectural plans. These works also encompass artistic craftsmanship in terms of their form, but not their mechanical or practical features. The design of a useful article, as defined in this section, will be considered a pictorial, graphic, or sculptural work only if, and to the extent that, the design includes pictorial, graphic, or sculptural elements that can be recognized separately from and can exist independently of the practical aspects of the article. [15]

For purposes of section 513, a "proprietor" is an individual, corporation, partnership, or other entity, as the case may be, that owns an establishment or a food service or drinking establishment, except that no owner or operator of a radio or television station licensed by the Federal Communications Commission, cable system or satellite carrier, cable or satellite carrier service or programmer, provider of online services or network access or the operator of facilities therefor, telecommunications company, or any other such audio or audiovisual service or programmer now known or as may be developed in the future, commercial subscription music service, or owner or operator of any other transmission service, shall under any circumstances be deemed to be a proprietor. [16]

For section 513, a "proprietor" refers to an individual, corporation, partnership, or other entity that owns a business or food and drink establishment. However, this definition excludes owners or operators of radio or television stations licensed by the Federal Communications Commission, cable systems or satellite carriers, cable or satellite carrier services or programmers, providers of online services or network access, or operators of related facilities, telecommunications companies, or any other audio or audiovisual services or programmers, whether currently known or developed in the future, commercial subscription music services, or owners or operators of any other transmission services. [16]

A "pseudonymous work" is a work on the copies or phonorecords of which the author is identified under a fictitious name.

A "pseudonymous work" is a work where the author is identified by a made-up name on the copies or phonorecords.

"Publication" is the distribution of copies or phonorecords of a work to the public by sale or other transfer of ownership, or by rental, lease, or lending. The offering to distribute copies or phonorecords to a group of persons for purposes of further distribution, public performance, or public display, constitutes publication. A public performance or display of a work does not of itself constitute publication.

"Publication" is when copies or recordings of a work are shared with the public through sale, transfer of ownership, rental, lease, or lending. Offering to distribute copies or recordings to a group of people for further distribution, public performance, or public display counts as publication. However, just performing or showing a work publicly doesn’t automatically count as publication.

To perform or display a work "publicly" means-

To perform or show a work "publicly" means-

(1) to perform or display it at a place open to the public or at any place where a substantial number of persons outside of a normal circle of a family and its social acquaintances is gathered; or

(1) to perform or show it at a public location or at any spot where a significant number of people outside of a typical family and their social friends are gathered; or

(2) to transmit or otherwise communicate a performance or display of the work to a place specified by clause (1) or to the public, by means of any device or process, whether the members of the public capable of receiving the performance or display receive it in the same place or in separate places and at the same time or at different times.

(2) to send or otherwise show a performance or display of the work to a location mentioned in clause (1) or to the public, using any device or method, regardless of whether the members of the public who can receive the performance or display do so in the same location or in different locations and at the same time or at various times.

"Registration", for purposes of sections 205(c)(2), 405, 406, 410(d), 411, 412, and 506(e), means a registration of a claim in the original or the renewed and extended term of copyright. [17]

"Registration," for the purposes of sections 205(c)(2), 405, 406, 410(d), 411, 412, and 506(e), refers to the registration of a claim in the original or renewed and extended term of copyright. [17]

"Sound recordings" are works that result from the fixation of a series of musical, spoken, or other sounds, but not including the sounds accompanying a motion picture or other audiovisual work, regardless of the nature of the material objects, such as disks, tapes, or other phonorecords, in which they are embodied.

"Sound recordings" are creations that come from capturing a series of musical, spoken, or other sounds, but they don't include the sounds that go along with a movie or other audiovisual work, no matter the kind of physical objects, like discs, tapes, or other phonorecords, in which they're stored.

"State" includes the District of Columbia and the Commonwealth of Puerto
Rico, and any territories to which this title is made applicable by an
Act of Congress.

"State" includes the District of Columbia and the Commonwealth of Puerto
Rico, along with any territories to which this title applies as determined by an
Act of Congress.

A "transfer of copyright ownership" is an assignment, mortgage, exclusive license, or any other conveyance, alienation, or hypothecation of a copyright or of any of the exclusive rights comprised in a copyright, whether or not it is limited in time or place of effect, but not including a nonexclusive license.

A "transfer of copyright ownership" is an assignment, mortgage, exclusive license, or any other transfer, sale, or pledge of a copyright or any of the exclusive rights included in a copyright, regardless of whether it's limited in time or location, but it does not include a nonexclusive license.

A "transmission program" is a body of material that, as an aggregate, has been produced for the sole purpose of transmission to the public in sequence and as a unit.

A "transmission program" is a collection of content that, as a whole, has been created specifically for broadcasting to the public in order and as a single unit.

To "transmit" a performance or display is to communicate it by any device or process whereby images or sounds are received beyond the place from which they are sent.

To "transmit" a performance or display means to send it out using any device or process that allows images or sounds to be received at a location different from where they originated.

A "treaty party" is a country or intergovernmental organization other than the United States that is a party to an international agreement. [18]

A "treaty party" is a country or intergovernmental organization, other than the United States, that is involved in an international agreement. [18]

The "United States", when used in a geographical sense, comprises the
several States, the District of Columbia and the Commonwealth of Puerto
Rico, and the organized territories under the jurisdiction of the United
States Government.

The "United States," in a geographical sense, includes the
various States, the District of Columbia, the Commonwealth of Puerto
Rico, and the organized territories under the authority of the United
States Government.

For purposes of section 411, a work is a "United States work" only if:

For the purposes of section 411, a work is considered a "United States work" only if:

(1) in the case of a published work, the work is first published-

(1) for a published work, the work is first released-

(A) in the United States;

(A) in the USA;

(B) simultaneously in the United States and another treaty party or parties, whose law grants a term of copyright protection that is the same as or longer than the term provided in the United States;

(B) at the same time in the United States and another treaty party or parties, whose law offers a term of copyright protection that is equal to or longer than the term provided in the United States;

(C) simultaneously in the United States and a foreign nation that is not a treaty party; or

(C) at the same time in the United States and in a foreign country that isn't part of the treaty; or

(D) in a foreign nation that is not a treaty party, and all of the authors of the work are nationals, domiciliaries, or habitual residents of, or in the case of an audiovisual work legal entities with headquarters in, the United States;

(D) in a foreign country that isn't a party to the treaty, and all of the authors of the work are citizens, residents, or habitual inhabitants of, or in the case of an audiovisual work, legal entities with their main offices in, the United States;

(2) in the case of an unpublished work, all the authors of the work are nationals, domiciliaries, or habitual residents of the United States, or, in the case of an unpublished audiovisual work, all the authors are legal entities with headquarters in the United States; or

(2) for an unpublished work, all the authors must be citizens, residents, or habitual inhabitants of the United States, or, for an unpublished audiovisual work, all authors must be legal entities based in the United States; or

(3) in the case of a pictorial, graphic, or sculptural work incorporated in a building or structure, the building or structure is located in the United States. [19]

(3) in the case of a picture, graphic, or sculpture included in a building or structure, the building or structure is located in the United States. [19]

A "useful article" is an article having an intrinsic utilitarian function that is not merely to portray the appearance of the article or to convey information. An article that is normally a part of a useful article is considered a "useful article".

A "useful article" is an item that has a fundamental practical function, not just to show off its appearance or provide information. An item that is typically part of a useful article is also considered a "useful article."

The author's "widow" or "widower" is the author's surviving spouse under the law of the author's domicile at the time of his or her death, whether or not the spouse has later remarried.

The author's "widow" or "widower" refers to the author's surviving spouse according to the laws of the author's home state at the time of their death, regardless of whether the spouse has since remarried.

The "WIPO Copyright Treaty" is the WIPO Copyright Treaty concluded at
Geneva, Switzerland, on December 20, 1996. [20]

The "WIPO Copyright Treaty" is the WIPO Copyright Treaty finalized in
Geneva, Switzerland, on December 20, 1996. [20]

The "WIPO Performances and Phonograms Treaty" is the WIPO Performances and Phonograms Treaty concluded at Geneva, Switzerland, on December 20, 1996. [21]

The "WIPO Performances and Phonograms Treaty" is the WIPO Performances and Phonograms Treaty signed in Geneva, Switzerland, on December 20, 1996. [21]

A "work of visual art" is-

A "work of visual art" is-

(1) a painting, drawing, print or sculpture, existing in a single copy, in a limited edition of 200 copies or fewer that are signed and consecutively numbered by the author, or, in the case of a sculpture, in multiple cast, carved, or fabricated sculptures of 200 or fewer that are consecutively numbered by the author and bear the signature or other identifying mark of the author; or

(1) a painting, drawing, print, or sculpture, existing as a one-of-a-kind piece, in a limited edition of 200 copies or fewer that are signed and numbered sequentially by the creator, or, in the case of a sculpture, in multiple cast, carved, or fabricated sculptures of 200 or fewer that are numbered in sequence by the creator and carry the signature or another identifying mark of the creator; or

(2) a still photographic image produced for exhibition purposes only, existing in a single copy that is signed by the author, or in a limited edition of 200 copies or fewer that are signed and consecutively numbered by the author.

(2) a still photograph created solely for exhibition purposes, existing in a single copy signed by the creator, or in a limited edition of 200 copies or fewer that are signed and consecutively numbered by the creator.

A work of visual art does not include-

A work of visual art does not include-

(A)(i) any poster, map, globe, chart, technical drawing, diagram, model, applied art, motion picture or other audiovisual work, book, magazine, newspaper, periodical, data base, electronic information service, electronic publication, or similar publication;

(A)(i) any poster, map, globe, chart, technical drawing, diagram, model, applied art, movie or other audiovisual work, book, magazine, newspaper, periodical, database, electronic information service, electronic publication, or similar publication;

(ii) any merchandising item or advertising, promotional, descriptive, covering, or packaging material or container;

(ii) any merchandise item or advertising, promotional, descriptive, covering, or packaging material or container;

(iii) any portion or part of any item described in clause (i) or (ii);

(iii) any part of any item mentioned in clause (i) or (ii);

(B) any work made for hire; or

(B) any work created for hire; or

(C) any work not subject to copyright protection under this title. [22]

(C) any work that is not protected by copyright under this title. [22]

A "work of the United States Government" is a work prepared by an officer or employee of the United States Government as part of that person's official duties.

A "work of the United States Government" is something created by an officer or employee of the United States Government as part of their official responsibilities.

A "work made for hire" is-

A "work made for hire" is-

(1) a work prepared by an employee within the scope of his or her employment; or

(1) a work created by an employee as part of their job; or

(2) a work specially ordered or commissioned for use as a contribution to a collective work, as a part of a motion picture or other audiovisual work, as a translation, as a supplementary work, as a compilation, as an instructional text, as a test, as answer material for a test, or as an atlas, if the parties expressly agree in a written instrument signed by them that the work shall be considered a work made for hire. For the purpose of the foregoing sentence, a "supplementary work" is a work prepared for publication as a secondary adjunct to a work by another author for the purpose of introducing, concluding, illustrating, explaining, revising, commenting upon, or assisting in the use of the other work, such as forewords, afterwords, pictorial illustrations, maps, charts, tables, editorial notes, musical arrangements, answer material for tests, bibliographies, appendixes, and indexes, and an "instructional text" is a literary, pictorial, or graphic work prepared for publication and with the purpose of use in systematic instructional activities.

(2) a work that is specifically ordered or commissioned to be a part of a collective project, like a movie or any other audiovisual creation, a translation, a supplementary piece, a compilation, an instructional text, a test, answer sheets for a test, or an atlas, if the parties involved agree in a written document signed by them that the work will be recognized as a work made for hire. For the purposes of this sentence, a "supplementary work" is defined as a piece created for publication as a secondary addition to a work by another author, aimed at introducing, concluding, illustrating, explaining, revising, commenting on, or supporting the use of the other work. This includes forewords, afterwords, pictorial illustrations, maps, charts, tables, editorial notes, musical arrangements, answer materials for tests, bibliographies, appendices, and indexes. An "instructional text" refers to a literary, pictorial, or graphic work prepared for publication intended for use in structured teaching activities.

In determining whether any work is eligible to be considered a work made for hire under paragraph (2), neither the amendment contained in section 1011(d) of the Intellectual Property and Communications Omnibus Reform Act of 1999, as enacted by section 1000(a)(9) of Public Law 106-113, nor the deletion of the words added by that amendment—

In figuring out if a work can be classified as a work made for hire under paragraph (2), neither the change in section 1011(d) of the Intellectual Property and Communications Omnibus Reform Act of 1999, as established by section 1000(a)(9) of Public Law 106-113, nor the removal of the words added by that change—

(A) shall be considered or otherwise given any legal significance, or

(A) will be considered or given any legal significance, or

(B) shall be interpreted to indicate congressional approval or disapproval of, or acquiescence in, any judicial determination,

(B) should be understood as showing whether Congress approves or disapproves of, or agrees with, any court ruling,

by the courts or the Copyright Office. Paragraph (2) shall be interpreted as if both section 2(a)(1) of the Work Made For Hire and Copyright Corrections Act of 2000 and section 1011(d) of the Intellectual Property and Communications Omnibus Reform Act of 1999, as enacted by section 1000(a)(9) of Public Law 106-113, were never enacted, and without regard to any inaction or awareness by the Congress at any time of any judicial determinations. [23]

by the courts or the Copyright Office. Paragraph (2) should be interpreted as if both section 2(a)(1) of the Work Made For Hire and the Copyright Corrections Act of 2000 and section 1011(d) of the Intellectual Property and Communications Omnibus Reform Act of 1999, as enacted by section 1000(a)(9) of Public Law 106-113, never happened, and without considering any lack of action or knowledge by Congress at any time regarding any court decisions. [23]

The terms "WTO Agreement" and "WTO member country" have the meanings given those terms in paragraphs (9) and (10), respectively, of section 2 of the Uruguay Round Agreements Act. {24}

The terms "WTO Agreement" and "WTO member country" have the meanings assigned to them in paragraphs (9) and (10), respectively, of section 2 of the Uruguay Round Agreements Act. {24}

A "computer program" is a set of statements or instructions to be used directly or indirectly in a computer in order to bring about a certain result. [25]

A "computer program" is a series of statements or instructions used directly or indirectly on a computer to achieve a specific outcome. [25]

Section 102. Subject matter of copyright: In general [26]

(a) Copyright protection subsists, in accordance with this title, in original works of authorship fixed in any tangible medium of expression, now known or later developed, from which they can be perceived, reproduced, or otherwise communicated, either directly or with the aid of a machine or device. Works of authorship include the following categories:

(a) Copyright protection exists, according to this title, for original works created by authors that are fixed in any physical form of expression, whether known now or developed later, from which they can be seen, copied, or otherwise shared, either directly or with the help of a machine or device. Works of authorship include the following categories:

(1) literary works; (2) musical works, including any accompanying words; (3) dramatic works, including any accompanying music; (4) pantomimes and choreographic works; (5) pictorial, graphic, and sculptural works; (6) motion pictures and other audiovisual works; (7) sound recordings; and (8) architectural works. (b) In no case does copyright protection for an original work of authorship extend to any idea, procedure, process, system, method of operation, concept, principle, or discovery, regardless of the form in which it is described, explained, illustrated, or embodied in such work.

(1) literary works; (2) musical works, including any lyrics; (3) dramatic works, including any music; (4) pantomimes and dance works; (5) visual art, graphic designs, and sculpture; (6) films and other audiovisual content; (7) audio recordings; and (8) architectural designs. (b) Copyright protection for an original work of authorship does not cover any idea, method, process, system, concept, principle, or discovery, no matter how it is described, explained, illustrated, or represented in that work.

Section 103. Subject matter of copyright: Compilations and derivative works

(a) The subject matter of copyright as specified by section 102 includes compilations and derivative works, but protection for a work employing preexisting material in which copyright subsists does not extend to any part of the work in which such material has been used unlawfully.

(a) The topics covered by copyright as outlined in section 102 include compilations and derivative works, but protection for a work that uses existing material under copyright does not extend to any part of that work where such material has been used illegally.

(b) The copyright in a compilation or derivative work extends only to the material contributed by the author of such work, as distinguished from the preexisting material employed in the work, and does not imply any exclusive right in the preexisting material. The copyright in such work is independent of, and does not affect or enlarge the scope, duration, ownership, or subsistence of, any copyright protection in the preexisting material.

(b) The copyright for a compilation or derivative work only covers the material added by the author of that work, as opposed to the existing material used in it, and does not grant any exclusive rights to the existing material. The copyright for such work is separate from, and does not impact or extend the scope, duration, ownership, or existence of any copyright protection for the existing material.

Section 104. Subject matter of copyright: National origin [27]

(a) Unpublished Works. The works specified by sections 102 and 103, while unpublished, are subject to protection under this title without regard to the nationality or domicile of the author.

(a) Unpublished Works. The works mentioned in sections 102 and 103, while not published, are protected under this title regardless of the author's nationality or residence.

(b) Published Works. The works specified by sections 102 and 103, when published, are subject to protection under this title if-

(b) Published Works. The works mentioned in sections 102 and 103, once published, are protected under this title if-

(1) on the date of first publication, one or more of the authors is a national or domiciliary of the United States, or is a national, domiciliary, or sovereign authority of a treaty party, or is a stateless person, wherever that person may be domiciled; or

(1) On the date of first publication, one or more of the authors is a national or resident of the United States, or is a national, resident, or governing authority of a treaty party, or is a stateless person, regardless of where that person may reside; or

(2) the work is first published in the United States or in a foreign nation that, on the date of first publication, is a treaty party; or

(2) the work is first published in the United States or in a foreign country that, at the time of first publication, is a treaty party; or

(3) the work is a sound recording that was first fixed in a treaty party; or

(3) the work is a sound recording that was first established in a treaty party; or

(4) the work is a pictorial, graphic, or sculptural work that is incorporated in a building or other structure, or an architectural work that is embodied in a building and the building or structure is located in the United States or a treaty party; or

(4) the work is a visual, graphic, or sculptural piece that’s part of a building or other structure, or an architectural work that’s embedded in a building, and the building or structure is located in the United States or a country that is part of a treaty; or

(5) the work is first published by the United Nations or any of its specialized agencies, or by the Organization of American States; or

(5) the work is first published by the United Nations or any of its specialized agencies, or by the Organization of American States; or

(6) the work comes within the scope of a Presidential proclamation. Whenever the President finds that a particular foreign nation extends, to works by authors who are nationals or domiciliaries of the United States or to works that are first published in the United States, copyright protection on substantially the same basis as that on which the foreign nation extends protection to works of its own nationals and domiciliaries and works first published in that nation, the President may by proclamation extend protection under this title to works of which one or more of the authors is, on the date of first publication, a national, domiciliary, or sovereign authority of that nation, or which was first published in that nation. The President may revise, suspend, or revoke any such proclamation or impose any conditions or limitations on protection under a proclamation.

(6) the work is covered by a Presidential proclamation. Whenever the President determines that a specific foreign country offers copyright protection to works by authors who are citizens or residents of the United States, or to works that are first published in the United States, on a similar basis to how that country protects the works of its own citizens and residents, the President may issue a proclamation to extend protection under this title to works where one or more authors is, at the time of first publication, a citizen, resident, or official of that country, or that were first published in that country. The President can review, suspend, or revoke any such proclamation or set any conditions or limitations on the protection provided by a proclamation.

For purposes of paragraph (2), a work that is published in the United States or a treaty party within 30 days after publication in a foreign nation that is not a treaty party shall be considered to be first published in the United States or such treaty party, as the case may be.

For paragraph (2), a work that is published in the United States or a treaty partner within 30 days after being published in a foreign country that is not a treaty partner will be regarded as first published in the United States or that treaty partner, as applicable.

(c) Effect of Berne Convention. No right or interest in a work eligible for protection under this title may be claimed by virtue of, or in reliance upon, the provisions of the Berne Convention, or the adherence of the United States thereto. Any rights in a work eligible for protection under this title that derive from this title, other Federal or State statutes, or the common law, shall not be expanded or reduced by virtue of, or in reliance upon, the provisions of the Berne Convention, or the adherence of the United States thereto.

(c) Effect of Berne Convention. No rights or interests in a work that is eligible for protection under this title can be claimed based on the provisions of the Berne Convention or the United States' agreement to it. Any rights in a work that is eligible for protection under this title, stemming from this title, other federal or state laws, or common law, will not be increased or decreased based on the provisions of the Berne Convention or the United States' agreement to it.

(d) Effect of Phonograms Treaties. Notwithstanding the provisions of subsection (b), no works other than sound recordings shall be eligible for protection under this title solely by virtue of the adherence of the United States to the Geneva Phonograms Convention or the WIPO Performances and Phonograms Treaty. [28]

(d) Effect of Phonograms Treaties. Despite what’s stated in subsection (b), only sound recordings will be eligible for protection under this title just because the United States is a member of the Geneva Phonograms Convention or the WIPO Performances and Phonograms Treaty. [28]

Section 104A. Copyright in restored works [29]

(a) Automatic Protection and Term.-

(a) Automatic Protection and Term.

(1) Term.-

Term.

(A) Copyright subsists, in accordance with this section, in restored works, and vests automatically on the date of restoration.

(A) Copyright exists, as per this section, in restored works and automatically takes effect on the date of restoration.

(B) Any work in which copyright is restored under this section shall subsist for the remainder of the term of copyright that the work would have otherwise been granted in the United States if the work never entered the public domain in the United States.

(B) Any work whose copyright is restored under this section will continue to be protected for the rest of the copyright term that the work would have received in the United States if it had never entered the public domain.

(2) Exception. Any work in which the copyright was ever owned or administered by the Alien Property Custodian and in which the restored copyright would be owned by a government or instrumentality thereof, is not a restored work.

(2) Exception. Any work that was ever owned or managed by the Alien Property Custodian, and for which the restored copyright would be held by a government or any of its entities, is not considered a restored work.

(b) Ownership of Restored Copyright. A restored work vests initially in the author or initial rightholder of the work as determined by the law of the source country of the work.

(b) Ownership of Restored Copyright. A restored work initially belongs to the author or original rights holder of the work, as defined by the laws of the source country of the work.

(c) Filing of Notice of Intent to Enforce Restored Copyright Against Reliance Parties. On or after the date of restoration, any person who owns a copyright in a restored work or an exclusive right therein may file with the Copyright Office a notice of intent to enforce that person's copyright or exclusive right or may serve such a notice directly on a reliance party. Acceptance of a notice by the Copyright Office is effective as to any reliance parties but shall not create a presumption of the validity of any of the facts stated therein. Service on a reliance party is effective as to that reliance party and any other reliance parties with actual knowledge of such service and of the contents of that notice.

(c) Filing of Notice of Intent to Enforce Restored Copyright Against Reliance Parties. On or after the date of restoration, anyone who owns a copyright in a restored work or an exclusive right to it can file a notice of intent to enforce their copyright or exclusive right with the Copyright Office, or they can serve that notice directly to a reliance party. Acceptance of a notice by the Copyright Office is effective for any reliance parties but does not create a presumption of the validity of any of the facts stated in it. Serving a reliance party is effective for that party and any other reliance parties who have actual knowledge of the service and the contents of that notice.

(d) Remedies for Infringement of Restored Copyrights.-

(d) Remedies for Infringement of Restored Copyrights.-

(1) Enforcement of Copyright in Restored Works in the Absence of a Reliance Party. As against any party who is not a reliance party, the remedies provided in chapter 5 of this title shall be available on or after the date of restoration of a restored copyright with respect to an act of infringement of the restored copyright that is commenced on or after the date of restoration.

(1) Enforcement of Copyright in Restored Works Without a Reliance Party. Against any party that is not a reliance party, the remedies outlined in chapter 5 of this title will be available starting from the date the copyright is restored for any act of infringement of that restored copyright that occurs on or after the restoration date.

(2) Enforcement of Copyright in Restored Works as Against Reliance Parties. As against a reliance party, except to the extent provided in paragraphs (3) and (4), the remedies provided in chapter 5 of this title shall be available, with respect to an act of infringement of a restored copyright, on or after the date of restoration of the restored copyright if the requirements of either of the following subparagraphs are met:

(2) Enforcement of Copyright in Restored Works Against Reliance Parties. Against a reliance party, except as stated in paragraphs (3) and (4), the remedies outlined in chapter 5 of this title will be available for acts of infringement of a restored copyright that occur on or after the date of restoration of that copyright, provided that the conditions in either of the following subparagraphs are met:

(A)(i) The owner of the restored copyright (or such owner's agent) or the owner of an exclusive right therein (or such owner's agent) files with the Copyright Office, during the 24-month period beginning on the date of restoration, a notice of intent to enforce the restored copyright; and

(A)(i) The owner of the restored copyright (or their agent) or the owner of an exclusive right in it (or their agent) submits a notice of intent to enforce the restored copyright to the Copyright Office within the 24-month period starting from the date of restoration; and

(ii)(I) the act of infringement commenced after the end of the 12-month period beginning on the date of publication of the notice in the Federal Register;

(ii)(I) the act of infringement started after the 12-month period that began on the publication date of the notice in the Federal Register;

(II) the act of infringement commenced before the end of the 12-month period described in subclause (I) and continued after the end of that 12-month period, in which case remedies shall be available only for infringement occurring after the end of that 12-month period; or

(II) the act of infringement started before the end of the 12-month period mentioned in subclause (I) and continued after that 12-month period, in which case remedies will only be available for infringement that took place after the end of that 12-month period; or

(III) copies or phonorecords of a work in which copyright has been restored under this section are made after publication of the notice of intent in the Federal Register.

(III) copies or phonorecords of a work in which copyright has been restored under this section are made after the notice of intent is published in the Federal Register.

(B)(i) The owner of the restored copyright (or such owner's agent) or the owner of an exclusive right therein (or such owner's agent) serves upon a reliance party a notice of intent to enforce a restored copyright; and

(B)(i) The owner of the restored copyright (or their agent) or the owner of an exclusive right in it (or their agent) provides a notice of intent to enforce a restored copyright to a reliance party; and

(ii)(I) the act of infringement commenced after the end of the 12-month period beginning on the date the notice of intent is received;

(ii)(I) the act of infringement started after the 12-month period that begins on the date the notice of intent is received;

(II) the act of infringement commenced before the end of the 12-month period described in subclause (I) and continued after the end of that 12-month period, in which case remedies shall be available only for the infringement occurring after the end of that 12-month period; or

(II) the act of infringement started before the end of the 12-month period mentioned in subclause (I) and continued after that 12-month period, in which case remedies will only be available for the infringement that occurred after the end of that 12-month period; or

(III) copies or phonorecords of a work in which copyright has been restored under this section are made after receipt of the notice of intent.

(III) copies or phonorecords of a work where copyright has been restored under this section are made after the notice of intent has been received.

In the event that notice is provided under both subparagraphs (A) and (B), the 12-month period referred to in such subparagraphs shall run from the earlier of publication or service of notice.

In cases where notice is given under both subparagraphs (A) and (B), the 12-month period mentioned in those subparagraphs will start from the earlier date of publication or service of notice.

(3) Existing Derivative Works.-

(3) Current Derivative Works.-

(A) In the case of a derivative work that is based upon a restored work and is created-

(A) In the case of a derivative work that is based on a restored work and is created-

(i) before the date of the enactment of the Uruguay Round Agreements Act, if the source country of the restored work is an eligible country on such date, or

(i) before the date the Uruguay Round Agreements Act was enacted, if the source country of the restored work is a qualified country on that date, or

(ii) before the date on which the source country of the restored work becomes an eligible country, if that country is not an eligible country on such date of enactment, a reliance party may continue to exploit that derivative work for the duration of the restored copyright if the reliance party pays to the owner of the restored copyright reasonable compensation for conduct which would be subject to a remedy for infringement but for the provisions of this paragraph.

(ii) Before the date when the source country of the restored work becomes an eligible country, if that country is not an eligible country on that date of enactment, a reliance party may continue to use that derivative work for the length of the restored copyright, provided that the reliance party pays the owner of the restored copyright reasonable compensation for actions that would normally lead to a remedy for infringement, except for what is outlined in this paragraph.

(B) In the absence of an agreement between the parties, the amount of such compensation shall be determined by an action in United States district court, and shall reflect any harm to the actual or potential market for or value of the restored work from the reliance party's continued exploitation of the work, as well as compensation for the relative contributions of expression of the author of the restored work and the reliance party to the derivative work.

(B) If the parties can't reach an agreement, the amount of compensation will be decided by a case in a United States district court. It will take into account any damage to the actual or potential market for the restored work due to the reliance party's ongoing use of it, along with compensation for the contributions made by the author of the restored work and the reliance party to the derivative work.

(4) Commencement of Infringement for Reliance Parties. For purposes of section 412, in the case of reliance parties, infringement shall be deemed to have commenced before registration when acts which would have constituted infringement had the restored work been subject to copyright were commenced before the date of restoration.

(4) Start of Infringement for Reliance Parties. For section 412, in the case of reliance parties, infringement will be considered to have started before registration when actions that would count as infringement, if the restored work was under copyright, began before the restoration date.

(e) Notices of Intent to Enforce a Restored Copyright.-

(e) Notices of Intent to Enforce a Restored Copyright.-

(1) Notices of Intent Filed With the Copyright Office.-

(1) Notices of Intent Filed with the Copyright Office.-

(A)(i) A notice of intent filed with the Copyright Office to enforce a restored copyright shall be signed by the owner of the restored copyright or the owner of an exclusive right therein, who files the notice under subsection (d)(2)(A)(i) (hereafter in this paragraph referred to as the "owner"), or by the owner's agent, shall identify the title of the restored work, and shall include an English translation of the title and any other alternative titles known to the owner by which the restored work may be identified, and an address and telephone number at which the owner may be contacted. If the notice is signed by an agent, the agency relationship must have been constituted in a writing signed by the owner before the filing of the notice. The Copyright Office may specifically require in regulations other information to be included in the notice, but failure to provide such other information shall not invalidate the notice or be a basis for refusal to list the restored work in the Federal Register.

(A)(i) A notice of intent submitted to the Copyright Office to enforce a restored copyright must be signed by the owner of the restored copyright or the owner of an exclusive right in it, who files the notice under subsection (d)(2)(A)(i) (hereafter referred to as the "owner"), or by the owner's agent. The notice should specify the title of the restored work and include an English translation of the title along with any other alternative titles known to the owner that the restored work may go by, as well as an address and phone number where the owner can be reached. If the notice is signed by an agent, the agency relationship must be established in a written document signed by the owner before the notice is filed. The Copyright Office may require additional information in the notice through regulations, but failing to provide such additional information will not invalidate the notice or be a reason to refuse listing the restored work in the Federal Register.

(ii) If a work in which copyright is restored has no formal title, it shall be described in the notice of intent in detail sufficient to identify it.

(ii) If a work with restored copyright doesn’t have a formal title, it should be described in the notice of intent in enough detail to identify it.

(iii) Minor errors or omissions may be corrected by further notice at any time after the notice of intent is filed. Notices of corrections for such minor errors or omissions shall be accepted after the period established in subsection (d)(2)(A)(i). Notices shall be published in the Federal Register pursuant to subparagraph (B).

(iii) Small mistakes or missing information can be fixed by additional notice any time after the intent notice is filed. Notices for correcting these minor mistakes or omissions will be accepted after the timeframe set in subsection (d)(2)(A)(i). Notices will be published in the Federal Register according to subparagraph (B).

(B)(i) The Register of Copyrights shall publish in the Federal Register, commencing not later than 4 months after the date of restoration for a particular nation and every 4 months thereafter for a period of 2 years, lists identifying restored works and the ownership thereof if a notice of intent to enforce a restored copyright has been filed.

(B)(i) The Register of Copyrights will publish in the Federal Register, starting no later than 4 months after the date of restoration for a specific country and every 4 months after that for a period of 2 years, lists that identify restored works and their ownership if a notice of intent to enforce a restored copyright has been submitted.

(ii) Not less than 1 list containing all notices of intent to enforce shall be maintained in the Public Information Office of the Copyright Office and shall be available for public inspection and copying during regular business hours pursuant to sections 705 and 708.

(ii) At least one list of all notices of intent to enforce must be kept in the Public Information Office of the Copyright Office and will be available for public inspection and copying during regular business hours according to sections 705 and 708.

(C) The Register of Copyrights is authorized to fix reasonable fees based on the costs of receipt, processing, recording, and publication of notices of intent to enforce a restored copyright and corrections thereto.

(C) The Register of Copyrights has the authority to set reasonable fees based on the costs of receiving, processing, recording, and publishing notices of intent to enforce a restored copyright and any corrections related to that.

(D)(i) Not later than 90 days before the date the Agreement on Trade-Related Aspects of Intellectual Property referred to in section 101(d) (15) of the Uruguay Round Agreements Act enters into force with respect to the United States, the Copyright Office shall issue and publish in the Federal Register regulations governing the filing under this subsection of notices of intent to enforce a restored copyright.

(D)(i) No later than 90 days before the date the Agreement on Trade-Related Aspects of Intellectual Property mentioned in section 101(d)(15) of the Uruguay Round Agreements Act goes into effect for the United States, the Copyright Office must issue and publish regulations in the Federal Register that govern the filing of notices of intent to enforce a restored copyright under this subsection.

(ii) Such regulations shall permit owners of restored copyrights to file simultaneously for registration of the restored copyright.

(ii) These regulations will allow owners of restored copyrights to apply for registration of the restored copyright at the same time.

(2) Notices of Intent Served on a Reliance Party.-

(2) Notices of Intent Delivered to a Reliance Party.-

(A) Notices of intent to enforce a restored copyright may be served on a reliance party at any time after the date of restoration of the restored copyright.

(A) Notices of intent to enforce a restored copyright can be given to a reliance party anytime after the restoration date of the copyright.

(B) Notices of intent to enforce a restored copyright served on a reliance party shall be signed by the owner or the owner's agent, shall identify the restored work and the work in which the restored work is used, if any, in detail sufficient to identify them, and shall include an English translation of the title, any other alternative titles known to the owner by which the work may be identified, the use or uses to which the owner objects, and an address and telephone number at which the reliance party may contact the owner. If the notice is signed by an agent, the agency relationship must have been constituted in writing and signed by the owner before service of the notice.

(B) Notices of intent to enforce a restored copyright served on a reliance party must be signed by the owner or their agent, clearly identify the restored work and the work in which the restored work is used, if applicable, providing enough detail to identify them. The notice should also include an English translation of the title, any other alternative titles known to the owner, the specific uses the owner objects to, and a contact address and phone number for the owner. If an agent signs the notice, the agency relationship must be established in writing and signed by the owner before the notice is served.

(3) Effect of Material False Statements. Any material false statement knowingly made with respect to any restored copyright identified in any notice of intent shall make void all claims and assertions made with respect to such restored copyright.

(3) Effect of Material False Statements. Any significant false statement made knowingly regarding any restored copyright mentioned in any notice of intent will invalidate all claims and assertions related to that restored copyright.

(f) Immunity From Warranty and Related Liability.-

(f) Immunity From Warranty and Related Liability.-

(1) In General. Any person who warrants, promises, or guarantees that a work does not violate an exclusive right granted in section 106 shall not be liable for legal, equitable, arbitral, or administrative relief if the warranty, promise, or guarantee is breached by virtue of the restoration of copyright under this section, if such warranty, promise, or guarantee is made before January 1, 1995.

(1) In General. Anyone who claims, promises, or guarantees that a work doesn’t infringe on an exclusive right granted in section 106 won’t be held responsible for legal, equitable, arbitral, or administrative consequences if the claim, promise, or guarantee is violated due to the restoration of copyright under this section, as long as the claim, promise, or guarantee was made before January 1, 1995.

(2) Performances. No person shall be required to perform any act if such performance is made infringing by virtue of the restoration of copyright under the provisions of this section, if the obligation to perform was undertaken before January 1, 1995.

(2) Performances. No one is required to perform any action if that performance becomes infringing due to the restoration of copyright under this section, as long as the obligation to perform was agreed to before January 1, 1995.

(g) Proclamation of Copyright Restoration. Whenever the President finds that a particular foreign nation extends, to works by authors who are nationals or domiciliaries of the United States, restored copyright protection on substantially the same basis as provided under this section, the President may by proclamation extend restored protection provided under this section to any work

(g) Proclamation of Copyright Restoration. Whenever the President determines that a specific foreign country offers restored copyright protection to works by authors who are U.S. nationals or residents on a similar basis as outlined in this section, the President can issue a proclamation to extend the restored protection given in this section to any work.

(1) of which one or more of the authors is, on the date of first publication, a national, domiciliary, or sovereign authority of that nation; or

(1) of which one or more of the authors is, on the date of first publication, a national, resident, or governing authority of that nation; or

(2) which was first published in that nation.

(2) which was first published in that country.

The President may revise, suspend, or revoke any such proclamation or impose any conditions or limitations on protection under such a proclamation.

The President can change, pause, or cancel any such proclamation or set any conditions or restrictions on the protection provided under that proclamation.

(h) Definitions. For purposes of this section and section 109(a):

(h) Definitions. For the sake of this section and section 109(a):

(1) The term "date of adherence or proclamation" means the earlier of the date on which a foreign nation which, as of the date the WTO Agreement enters into force with respect to the United States, is not a nation adhering to the Berne Convention or a WTO member country, becomes-

(1) The term "date of adherence or proclamation" refers to the earlier date when a foreign country, which is not a member of the Berne Convention or a WTO member as of the date the WTO Agreement goes into effect for the United States, becomes-

(A) a nation adhering to the Berne Convention;

(A) a country that follows the Berne Convention;

(B) a WTO member country;

a member country of the WTO;

(C) a nation adhering to the WIPO Copyright Treaty; [30]

(C) a country following the WIPO Copyright Treaty; [30]

(D) a nation adhering to the WIPO Performances and Phonograms Treaty; [31] or

(D) a country that follows the WIPO Performances and Phonograms Treaty; [31]

(E) subject to a Presidential proclamation under subsection (g).

(E) subject to a Presidential proclamation under subsection (g).

(2) The "date of restoration" of a restored copyright is-

(2) The "date of restoration" for a restored copyright is-

(A) January 1, 1996, if the source country of the restored work is a nation adhering to the Berne Convention or a WTO member country on such date, or

(A) January 1, 1996, if the source country of the restored work is a nation that is part of the Berne Convention or a WTO member country on that date, or

(B) the date of adherence or proclamation, in the case of any other source country of the restored work.

(B) the date of joining or announcement, in the case of any other source country of the restored work.

(3) The term "eligible country" means a nation, other than the United States, that

(3) The term "eligible country" refers to any nation, excluding the United States, that

(A) becomes a WTO member country after the date of the enactment of the
Uruguay Round Agreements Act;

(A) becomes a WTO member country after the date the
Uruguay Round Agreements Act is enacted;

(B) on such date of enactment is, or after such date of enactment becomes, a nation adhering to the Berne Convention;

(B) on the date this law is enacted, or after that date if it becomes a country that follows the Berne Convention;

(C) adheres to the WIPO Copyright Treaty; [32]

(C) follows the WIPO Copyright Treaty; [32]

(D) adheres to the WIPO Performances and Phonograms Treaty; [33] or

(D) complies with the WIPO Performances and Phonograms Treaty; [33] or

(E) after such date of enactment becomes subject to a proclamation under subsection (g).

(E) after that date of enactment becomes subject to a proclamation under subsection (g).

(4) The term "reliance party" means any person who-

(4) The term "reliance party" refers to any individual who—

(A) with respect to a particular work, engages in acts, before the source country of that work becomes an eligible country, which would have violated section 106 if the restored work had been subject to copyright protection, and who, after the source country becomes an eligible country, continues to engage in such acts;

(A) regarding a specific piece of work, participates in actions, before the country where that work originates is recognized as an eligible country, that would have broken section 106 if the restored work had been under copyright protection, and who, after the source country becomes an eligible country, keeps engaging in those actions;

(B) before the source country of a particular work becomes an eligible country, makes or acquires 1 or more copies or phonorecords of that work; or

(B) before the source country of a particular work becomes an eligible country, makes or acquires 1 or more copies or phonorecords of that work; or

(C) as the result of the sale or other disposition of a derivative work covered under subsection (d)(3), or significant assets of a person described in subparagraph (A) or (B), is a successor, assignee, or licensee of that person.

(C) as a result of the sale or other transfer of a derivative work covered under subsection (d)(3), or major assets of a person described in subparagraph (A) or (B), is a successor, assignee, or licensee of that person.

(5) The term "restored copyright" means copyright in a restored work under this section.

(5) The term "restored copyright" refers to the copyright in a restored work under this section.

(6) The term "restored work" means an original work of authorship that-

(6) The term "restored work" refers to an original piece of authorship that-

(A) is protected under subsection (a);

(A) is protected under subsection (a);

(B) is not in the public domain in its source country through expiration of term of protection;

(B) is not in the public domain in its source country due to the expiration of the protection term;

(C) is in the public domain in the United States due to-

(C) is in the public domain in the United States because-

(i) noncompliance with formalities imposed at any time by United States copyright law, including failure of renewal, lack of proper notice, or failure to comply with any manufacturing requirements;

(i) not following the formalities set by U.S. copyright law at any time, such as not renewing, not providing proper notice, or not meeting any manufacturing requirements;

(ii) lack of subject matter protection in the case of sound recordings fixed before February 15, 1972; or

(ii) lack of subject matter protection for sound recordings made before February 15, 1972; or

(iii) lack of national eligibility;

(iii) no national eligibility;

(D) has at least one author or rightholder who was, at the time the work was created, a national or domiciliary of an eligible country, and if published, was first published in an eligible country and not published in the United States during the 30-day period following publication in such eligible country; and

(D) has at least one author or rights holder who, at the time the work was created, was a citizen or resident of an eligible country, and if published, was first published in an eligible country and not published in the United States within the 30-day period after publication in that eligible country; and

(E) if the source country for the work is an eligible country solely by virtue of its adherence to the WIPO Performances and Phonograms Treaty, is a sound recording. [34]

(E) if the source country for the work is an eligible country solely because it follows the WIPO Performances and Phonograms Treaty, it is a sound recording. [34]

(7) The term "rightholder" means the person-

(7) The term "rightholder" refers to the person-

(A) who, with respect to a sound recording, first fixes a sound recording with authorization, or

(A) who, in relation to a sound recording, is the first to authorize and create a fixed sound recording, or

(B) who has acquired rights from the person described in subparagraph
(A) by means of any conveyance or by operation of law.

(B) who has obtained rights from the person mentioned in subparagraph
(A) through any transfer or by legal means.

(8) The "source country" of a restored work is-

(8) The "source country" of a restored work is-

(A) a nation other than the United States;

(A) a country other than the United States;

(B) in the case of an unpublished work-

(B) in the case of an unpublished work-

(i) the eligible country in which the author or rightholder is a national or domiciliary, or, if a restored work has more than 1 author or rightholder, of which the majority of foreign authors or rightholders are nationals or domiciliaries; or

(i) the eligible country where the author or rights holder is a citizen or resident, or, if a restored work has more than one author or rights holder, where the majority of foreign authors or rights holders are citizens or residents; or

(ii) if the majority of authors or rightholders are not foreign, the nation other than the United States which has the most significant contacts with the work; and

(ii) if most of the authors or rights holders are not from outside the country, then the nation other than the United States that has the closest ties to the work; and

(C) in the case of a published work-

(C) in the case of a published work-

(i) the eligible country in which the work is first published, or

(i) the eligible country where the work is first published, or

(ii) if the restored work is published on the same day in 2 or more eligible countries, the eligible country which has the most significant contacts with the work.

(ii) if the restored work is published on the same day in two or more eligible countries, the eligible country with the closest connection to the work.

Section 105. Subject matter of copyright: United States Government works [35]

Copyright protection under this title is not available for any work of the United States Government, but the United States Government is not precluded from receiving and holding copyrights transferred to it by assignment, bequest, or otherwise.

Copyright protection under this title is not available for any work of the United States Government, but the United States Government can receive and hold copyrights transferred to it by assignment, bequest, or other means.

Section 106. Exclusive rights in copyrighted works [36]

Subject to sections 107 through 121, the owner of copyright under this title has the exclusive rights to do and to authorize any of the following:

Subject to sections 107 through 121, the copyright owner under this title has the exclusive rights to do and authorize any of the following:

(1) to reproduce the copyrighted work in copies or phonorecords;

(1) to reproduce the copyrighted work in copies or recordings;

(2) to prepare derivative works based upon the copyrighted work;

(2) to create derivative works based on the copyrighted work;

(3) to distribute copies or phonorecords of the copyrighted work to the public by sale or other transfer of ownership, or by rental, lease, or lending;

(3) to distribute copies or phonorecords of the copyrighted work to the public by selling or transferring ownership, or by renting, leasing, or lending;

(4) in the case of literary, musical, dramatic, and choreographic works, pantomimes, and motion pictures and other audiovisual works, to perform the copyrighted work publicly;

(4) for literary, musical, dramatic, and choreographic works, pantomimes, and motion pictures and other audiovisual works, to publicly perform the copyrighted work;

(5) in the case of literary, musical, dramatic, and choreographic works, pantomimes, and pictorial, graphic, or sculptural works, including the individual images of a motion picture or other audiovisual work, to display the copyrighted work publicly; and

(5) in the case of literary, musical, dramatic, and choreographic works, pantomimes, and pictorial, graphic, or sculptural works, including the individual images of a movie or other audiovisual work, to show the copyrighted work in public; and

(6) in the case of sound recordings, to perform the copyrighted work publicly by means of a digital audio transmission.

(6) in the case of sound recordings, to publicly perform the copyrighted work through a digital audio transmission.

Section 106A. Rights of certain authors to attribution and integrity [37]

(a) Rights of Attribution and Integrity. Subject to section 107 and independent of the exclusive rights provided in section 106, the author of a work of visual art

(a) Rights of Attribution and Integrity. Subject to section 107 and separate from the exclusive rights outlined in section 106, the creator of a visual art piece

(1) shall have the right-

has the right

(A) to claim authorship of that work, and

(A) to assert that they created that work, and

(B) to prevent the use of his or her name as the author of any work of visual art which he or she did not create;

(B) to stop anyone from using his or her name as the author of any visual artwork that he or she didn't create;

(2) shall have the right to prevent the use of his or her name as the author of the work of visual art in the event of a distortion, mutilation, or other modification of the work which would be prejudicial to his or her honor or reputation; and

(2) shall have the right to stop the use of their name as the author of the visual art if there’s a distortion, mutilation, or other modification of the work that would harm their honor or reputation; and

(3) subject to the limitations set forth in section 113(d), shall have the right-

(3) subject to the limitations outlined in section 113(d), shall have the right-

(A) to prevent any intentional distortion, mutilation, or other modification of that work which would be prejudicial to his or her honor or reputation, and any intentional distortion, mutilation, or modification of that work is a violation of that right, and

(A) to prevent any intentional distortion, alteration, or other changes to that work that could harm his or her honor or reputation, and any intentional distortion, alteration, or modification of that work is a violation of that right, and

(B) to prevent any destruction of a work of recognized stature, and any intentional or grossly negligent destruction of that work is a violation of that right.

(B) to prevent any destruction of a work of acknowledged importance, and any intentional or extremely careless destruction of that work is a violation of that right.

(b) Scope and Exercise of Rights. Only the author of a work of visual art has the rights conferred by subsection (a) in that work, whether or not the author is the copyright owner. The authors of a joint work of visual art are coowners of the rights conferred by subsection (a) in that work.

(b) Scope and Exercise of Rights. Only the creator of a visual art piece has the rights granted by subsection (a) for that piece, regardless of whether the creator owns the copyright. The creators of a collaborative visual art piece are co-owners of the rights granted by subsection (a) for that piece.

(c) Exceptions.- (1) The modification of a work of visual art which is the result of the passage of time or the inherent nature of the materials is not a distortion, mutilation, or other modification described in subsection (a)(3)(A).

(c) Exceptions.- (1) Changes to a piece of visual art that happen due to the effects of time or the natural properties of the materials are not considered a distortion, mutilation, or any other modification mentioned in subsection (a)(3)(A).

(2) The modification of a work of visual art which is the result of conservation, or of the public presentation, including lighting and placement, of the work is not a destruction, distortion, mutilation, or other modification described in subsection (a)(3) unless the modification is caused by gross negligence.

(2) Changing a piece of visual art due to conservation efforts or how it’s publicly displayed, including lighting and placement, is not considered destruction, distortion, mutilation, or any other modification mentioned in subsection (a)(3), unless the change is due to gross negligence.

(3) The rights described in paragraphs (1) and (2) of subsection (a) shall not apply to any reproduction, depiction, portrayal, or other use of a work in, upon, or in any connection with any item described in subparagraph (A) or (B) of the definition of "work of visual art" in section 101, and any such reproduction, depiction, portrayal, or other use of a work is not a destruction, distortion, mutilation, or other modification described in paragraph (3) of subsection (a).

(3) The rights outlined in paragraphs (1) and (2) of subsection (a) do not apply to any reproduction, depiction, portrayal, or other use of a work that is related to any item mentioned in subparagraph (A) or (B) of the definition of "work of visual art" in section 101. Furthermore, any such reproduction, depiction, portrayal, or other use of a work does not qualify as destruction, distortion, mutilation, or any other modification described in paragraph (3) of subsection (a).

(d) Duration of Rights.- (1) With respect to works of visual art created on or after the effective date set forth in section 610(a) of the Visual Artists Rights Act of 1990, the rights conferred by subsection (a) shall endure for a term consisting of the life of the author.

(d) Duration of Rights.- (1) For visual art created on or after the effective date specified in section 610(a) of the Visual Artists Rights Act of 1990, the rights granted by subsection (a) will last for the lifetime of the author.

(2) With respect to works of visual art created before the effective date set forth in section 610(a) of the Visual Artists Rights Act of 1990, but title to which has not, as of such effective date, been transferred from the author, the rights conferred by subsection (a) shall be coextensive with, and shall expire at the same time as, the rights conferred by section 106.

(2) For visual art created before the effective date mentioned in section 610(a) of the Visual Artists Rights Act of 1990, but whose title has not been transferred from the author by that effective date, the rights given by subsection (a) will match and will expire at the same time as the rights granted by section 106.

(3) In the case of a joint work prepared by two or more authors, the rights conferred by subsection (a) shall endure for a term consisting of the life of the last surviving author.

(3) In the case of a joint work created by two or more authors, the rights granted by subsection (a) will last for the lifetime of the last surviving author.

(4) All terms of the rights conferred by subsection (a) run to the end of the calendar year in which they would otherwise expire.

(4) All terms of the rights granted by subsection (a) extend to the end of the calendar year in which they would normally expire.

(e) Transfer and Waiver.- (1) The rights conferred by subsection (a) may not be transferred, but those rights may be waived if the author expressly agrees to such waiver in a written instrument signed by the author. Such instrument shall specifically identify the work, and uses of that work, to which the waiver applies, and the waiver shall apply only to the work and uses so identified. In the case of a joint work prepared by two or more authors, a waiver of rights under this paragraph made by one such author waives such rights for all such authors.

(e) Transfer and Waiver.- (1) The rights granted by subsection (a) cannot be transferred, but they can be waived if the author clearly agrees to this waiver in a written document signed by them. This document must specifically identify the work and the uses of that work that the waiver covers, and the waiver will only apply to the identified work and its uses. For a joint work created by two or more authors, if one author waives their rights under this paragraph, it waives those rights for all the authors involved.

(2) Ownership of the rights conferred by subsection (a) with respect to a work of visual art is distinct from ownership of any copy of that work, or of a copyright or any exclusive right under a copyright in that work. Transfer of ownership of any copy of a work of visual art, or of a copyright or any exclusive right under a copyright, shall not constitute a waiver of the rights conferred by subsection (a). Except as may otherwise be agreed by the author in a written instrument signed by the author, a waiver of the rights conferred by subsection (a) with respect to a work of visual art shall not constitute a transfer of ownership of any copy of that work, or of ownership of a copyright or of any exclusive right under a copyright in that work.

(2) The rights given by subsection (a) regarding a visual artwork are separate from owning any copy of that artwork, or from owning a copyright or any exclusive rights tied to that artwork. Selling any copy of a visual artwork, or a copyright, or any exclusive rights under that copyright, does not mean you give up the rights given by subsection (a). Unless the author specifically agrees otherwise in a signed written agreement, giving up the rights mentioned in subsection (a) related to a visual artwork does not mean a transfer of ownership of any copy of that artwork, or of the copyright, or of any exclusive rights associated with that copyright.

Section 107. Limitations on exclusive rights: Fair use [38]

Notwithstanding the provisions of sections 106 and 106A, the fair use of a copyrighted work, including such use by reproduction in copies or phonorecords or by any other means specified by that section, for purposes such as criticism, comment, news reporting, teaching (including multiple copies for classroom use), scholarship, or research, is not an infringement of copyright. In determining whether the use made of a work in any particular case is a fair use the factors to be considered shall include-

Notwithstanding the provisions of sections 106 and 106A, the fair use of a copyrighted work—like making copies or recordings, or using it in any other way outlined in that section—for purposes such as criticism, commentary, news reporting, teaching (including making multiple copies for classroom use), scholarship, or research, does not count as copyright infringement. When deciding if a specific use of a work is fair use, the factors to consider shall include-

(1) the purpose and character of the use, including whether such use is of a commercial nature or is for nonprofit educational purposes;

(1) the purpose and nature of the use, including whether it is for commercial purposes or for nonprofit educational reasons;

(2) the nature of the copyrighted work;

(2) the type of copyrighted work;

(3) the amount and substantiality of the portion used in relation to the copyrighted work as a whole; and

(3) the amount and significance of the part used compared to the entire copyrighted work; and

(4) the effect of the use upon the potential market for or value of the copyrighted work.

(4) the impact of the use on the potential market for or value of the copyrighted work.

The fact that a work is unpublished shall not itself bar a finding of fair use if such finding is made upon consideration of all the above factors.

The fact that a work isn’t published won’t automatically prevent a determination of fair use if that determination is made by considering all the factors mentioned above.

Section 108. Limitations on exclusive rights: Reproduction by libraries and archives [39]

(a) Except as otherwise provided in this title and notwithstanding the provisions of section 106, it is not an infringement of copyright for a library or archives, or any of its employees acting within the scope of their employment, to reproduce no more than one copy or phonorecord of a work, except as provided in subsections (b) and (c), or to distribute such copy or phonorecord, under the conditions specified by this section, if-

(a) Unless stated otherwise in this title and regardless of what section 106 says, it is not considered copyright infringement for a library or archives, or any of its employees working within their job responsibilities, to reproduce one copy or phonorecord of a work, except as described in subsections (b) and (c), or to distribute that copy or phonorecord, according to the conditions outlined in this section, if-

(1) the reproduction or distribution is made without any purpose of direct or indirect commercial advantage;

(1) the reproduction or distribution is done without any intent for direct or indirect profit;

(2) the collections of the library or archives are (i) open to the public, or (ii) available not only to researchers affiliated with the library or archives or with the institution of which it is a part, but also to other persons doing research in a specialized field; and

(2) the collections of the library or archives are (i) open to the public, or (ii) available not only to researchers affiliated with the library or archives or with the institution it belongs to, but also to others conducting research in a specialized field; and

(3) the reproduction or distribution of the work includes a notice of copyright that appears on the copy or phonorecord that is reproduced under the provisions of this section, or includes a legend stating that the work may be protected by copy-right if no such notice can be found on the copy or phonorecord that is reproduced under the provisions of this section.

(3) the reproduction or distribution of the work must include a copyright notice on the copy or phonorecord that is reproduced as per this section, or a statement indicating that the work may be protected by copyright if no such notice is found on the copy or phonorecord that is reproduced under this section.

(b) The rights of reproduction and distribution under this section apply to three copies or phonorecords of an unpublished work duplicated solely for purposes of preservation and security or for deposit for research use in another library or archives of the type described by clause (2) of subsection (a), if-

(b) The rights to reproduce and distribute under this section apply to three copies or phonorecords of an unpublished work that are duplicated only for preservation and security purposes or for deposit for research use in another library or archive of the type described by clause (2) of subsection (a), if-

(1) the copy or phonorecord reproduced is currently in the collections of the library or archives; and

(1) the copy or audio recording produced is currently in the collections of the library or archives; and

(2) any such copy or phonorecord that is reproduced in digital format is not otherwise distributed in that format and is not made available to the public in that format outside the premises of the library or archives.

(2) any copy or phonorecord that is reproduced in digital format is not distributed in that format and is not made available to the public in that format outside of the library or archives.

(c) The right of reproduction under this section applies to three copies or phonorecords of a published work duplicated solely for the purpose of replacement of a copy or phonorecord that is damaged, deteriorating, lost, or stolen, or if the existing format in which the work is stored has become obsolete, if-

(c) The right to reproduce under this section applies to three copies or phonorecords of a published work made solely to replace a copy or phonorecord that is damaged, deteriorating, lost, or stolen, or if the current format in which the work is stored has become outdated, if-

(1) the library or archives has, after a reasonable effort, determined that an unused replacement cannot be obtained at a fair price; and

(1) the library or archives has, after making a reasonable effort, decided that a suitable replacement cannot be found at a reasonable price; and

(2) any such copy or phonorecord that is reproduced in digital format is not made available to the public in that format outside the premises of the library or archives in lawful possession of such copy.

(2) any copy or phonorecord that is reproduced in digital format is not made accessible to the public in that format outside the library or archives that have legal ownership of that copy.

For purposes of this subsection, a format shall be considered obsolete if the machine or device necessary to render perceptible a work stored in that format is no longer manufactured or is no longer reasonably available in the commercial marketplace.

For this subsection, a format is considered obsolete if the machine or device needed to access a work stored in that format is no longer produced or is not reasonably available in the commercial market.

(d) The rights of reproduction and distribution under this section apply to a copy, made from the collection of a library or archives where the user makes his or her request or from that of another library or archives, of no more than one article or other contribution to a copyrighted collection or periodical issue, or to a copy or phonorecord of a small part of any other copyrighted work, if-

(d) The rights to reproduce and distribute under this section apply to a copy made from the collection of a library or archive where the user makes their request, or from another library or archive, of no more than one article or other contribution to a copyrighted collection or issue of a periodical, or to a copy or phonorecord of a small portion of any other copyrighted work, if—

(1) the copy or phonorecord becomes the property of the user, and the library or archives has had no notice that the copy or phonorecord would be used for any purpose other than private study, scholarship, or research; and

(1) the copy or phonorecord belongs to the user, and the library or archives has not been informed that the copy or phonorecord would be used for anything other than personal study, scholarship, or research; and

(2) the library or archives displays prominently, at the place where orders are accepted, and includes on its order form, a warning of copyright in accordance with requirements that the Register of Copyrights shall prescribe by regulation.

(2) the library or archives clearly displays, at the location where orders are accepted, and includes on its order form, a copyright warning as required by regulations set by the Register of Copyrights.

(e) The rights of reproduction and distribution under this section apply to the entire work, or to a substantial part of it, made from the collection of a library or archives where the user makes his or her request or from that of another library or archives, if the library or archives has first determined, on the basis of a reasonable investigation, that a copy or phonorecord of the copyrighted work cannot be obtained at a fair price, if-

(e) The rights to reproduce and distribute under this section apply to the entire work or to a significant portion of it, created from the collection of a library or archive where the user makes their request or from another library or archive, if the library or archive has first determined, based on a reasonable investigation, that a copy or phonorecord of the copyrighted work cannot be obtained at a fair price, if-

(1) the copy or phonorecord becomes the property of the user, and the library or archives has had no notice that the copy or phonorecord would be used for any purpose other than private study, scholarship, or research; and

(1) the copy or phonorecord belongs to the user, and the library or archives has not been informed that the copy or phonorecord would be used for anything other than personal study, scholarship, or research; and

(2) the library or archives displays prominently, at the place where orders are accepted, and includes on its order form, a warning of copyright in accordance with requirements that the Register of Copyrights shall prescribe by regulation.

(2) the library or archives clearly shows, at the location where orders are taken, and includes on its order form, a notice about copyright as required by the regulations set by the Register of Copyrights.

(f) Nothing in this section-

(f) Nothing in this section

(1) shall be construed to impose liability for copyright infringement upon a library or archives or its employees for the unsupervised use of reproducing equipment located on its premises: *Provided*, That such equipment displays a notice that the making of a copy may be subject to the copyright law;

(1) will be understood to place liability for copyright infringement on a library or archive or its employees for the unsupervised use of copying equipment found on its premises: *Provided*, That such equipment shows a notice that making a copy may fall under copyright law;

(2) excuses a person who uses such reproducing equipment or who requests a copy or phonorecord under subsection (d) from liability for copyright infringement for any such act, or for any later use of such copy or phonorecord, if it exceeds fair use as provided by section 107;

(2) protects a person who uses this reproducing equipment or who asks for a copy or phonorecord under subsection (d) from being held liable for copyright infringement for any of these actions, or for any later use of that copy or phonorecord, if it goes beyond fair use as defined in section 107;

(3) shall be construed to limit the reproduction and distribution by lending of a limited number of copies and excerpts by a library or archives of an audiovisual news program, subject to clauses (1), (2), and (3) of subsection (a); or

(3) will be understood to allow the reproduction and distribution through lending of a limited number of copies and excerpts by a library or archives of an audiovisual news program, as long as it follows clauses (1), (2), and (3) of subsection (a); or

(4) in any way affects the right of fair use as provided by section 107, or any contractual obligations assumed at any time by the library or archives when it obtained a copy or phonorecord of a work in its collections.

(4) in any way impacts the right of fair use as outlined in section 107, or any contractual obligations accepted at any time by the library or archives when it obtained a copy or phonorecord of a work in its collections.

(g) The rights of reproduction and distribution under this section extend to the isolated and unrelated reproduction or distribution of a single copy or phonorecord of the same material on separate occasions, but do not extend to cases where the library or archives, or its employee-

(g) The rights to reproduce and distribute under this section apply to the separate and unrelated reproduction or distribution of a single copy or phonorecord of the same material on different occasions, but do not apply to situations where the library or archives, or its employee-

(1) is aware or has substantial reason to believe that it is engaging in the related or concerted reproduction or distribution of multiple copies or phonorecords of the same material, whether made on one occasion or over a period of time, and whether intended for aggregate use by one or more individuals or for separate use by the individual members of a group; or

(1) knows or has strong reasons to believe that it is involved in the related or coordinated reproduction or distribution of multiple copies or recordings of the same material, whether done at one time or over a span of time, and whether meant for combined use by one or more individuals or for separate use by the individual members of a group; or

(2) engages in the systematic reproduction or distribution of single or multiple copies or phonorecords of material described in subsection (d): *Provided*, That nothing in this clause prevents a library or archives from participating in interlibrary arrangements that do not have, as their purpose or effect, that the library or archives receiving such copies or phonorecords for distribution does so in such aggregate quantities as to substitute for a subscription to or purchase of such work.

(2) is involved in the organized reproduction or distribution of one or more copies or recordings of the material mentioned in subsection (d): *However*, nothing in this clause stops a library or archive from taking part in interlibrary agreements, as long as those agreements aren't intended for the library or archive receiving such copies or recordings to use them in such large amounts that it replaces a subscription or purchase of that work.

(h)(1) For purposes of this section, during the last 20 years of any term of copyright of a published work, a library or archives, including a nonprofit educational institution that functions as such, may reproduce, distribute, display, or perform in facsimile or digital form a copy or phonorecord of such work, or portions thereof, for purposes of preservation, scholarship, or research, if such library or archives has first determined, on the basis of a reasonable investigation, that none of the conditions set forth in subparagraphs (A), (B), and (C) of paragraph (2) apply.

(h)(1) For this section, during the last 20 years of any copyright term for a published work, a library or archive, including a nonprofit educational institution that operates as such, may reproduce, distribute, display, or perform a copy or audio recording of that work, or parts of it, in physical or digital form for preservation, scholarship, or research purposes, as long as the library or archive has first determined, through a reasonable investigation, that none of the conditions outlined in subparagraphs (A), (B), and (C) of paragraph (2) apply.

(2) No reproduction, distribution, display, or performance is authorized under this subsection if=

(2) No reproduction, distribution, display, or performance is allowed under this subsection if=

(A) the work is subject to normal commercial exploitation;

(A) the work can be used for standard business purposes;

(B) a copy or phonorecord of the work can be obtained at a reasonable price; or

(B) a copy or recording of the work can be purchased at a fair price; or

(C) the copyright owner or its agent provides notice pursuant to regulations promulgated by the Register of Copyrights that either of the conditions set forth in subparagraphs (A) and (B) applies.

(C) the copyright owner or their agent gives notice according to regulations issued by the Register of Copyrights that either of the conditions mentioned in subparagraphs (A) and (B) applies.

(3) The exemption provided in this subsection does not apply to any subsequent uses by users other than such library or archives.

(3) The exemption mentioned in this section doesn't apply to any further uses by users other than that library or archives.

(i) The rights of reproduction and distribution under this section do not apply to a musical work, a pictorial, graphic or sculptural work, or a motion picture or other audiovisual work other than an audiovisual work dealing with news, except that no such limitation shall apply with respect to rights granted by subsections (b) and (c), or with respect to pictorial or graphic works published as illustrations, diagrams, or similar adjuncts to works of which copies are reproduced or distributed in accordance with subsections (d) and (e).

(i) The rights to reproduce and distribute under this section do not apply to musical works, pictorial, graphic, or sculptural works, or to motion pictures or other audiovisual works, except for audiovisual works related to news. However, this limitation does not apply to rights granted by subsections (b) and (c), or to pictorial or graphic works that are published as illustrations, diagrams, or similar supplements to works for which copies are reproduced or distributed under subsections (d) and (e).

Section 109. Limitations on exclusive rights: Effect of transfer of particular copy or phonorecord [40]

(a) Notwithstanding the provisions of section 106(3), the owner of a particular copy or phonorecord lawfully made under this title, or any person authorized by such owner, is entitled, without the authority of the copyright owner, to sell or otherwise dispose of the possession of that copy or phonorecord. Notwithstanding the preceding sentence, copies or phonorecords of works subject to restored copyright under section 104A that are manufactured before the date of restoration of copyright or, with respect to reliance parties, before publication or service of notice under section 104A(e), may be sold or otherwise disposed of without the authorization of the owner of the restored copyright for purposes of direct or indirect commercial advantage only during the 12-month period beginning on-

(a) Even with the rules in section 106(3), the owner of a specific copy or phonorecord that was legally made under this title, or anyone authorized by that owner, has the right to sell or otherwise get rid of that copy or phonorecord without needing permission from the copyright owner. However, copies or phonorecords of works that have had their copyright restored under section 104A and were made before the copyright was restored, or for reliance parties, before publication or delivery of notice under section 104A(e), can be sold or disposed of for commercial gain without the restored copyright owner's permission only during the 12-month period starting on-

(1) the date of the publication in the Federal Register of the notice of intent filed with the Copyright Office under section 104A(d)(2)(A), or

(1) the date when the notice of intent was published in the Federal Register that was filed with the Copyright Office under section 104A(d)(2)(A), or

(2) the date of the receipt of actual notice served under section 104A(d)(2)(B), whichever occurs first.

(2) the date you receive actual notice served under section 104A(d)(2)(B), whichever happens first.

(b)(1)(A) Notwithstanding the provisions of subsection (a), unless authorized by the owners of copyright in the sound recording or the owner of copyright in a computer program (including any tape, disk, or other medium embodying such program), and in the case of a sound recording in the musical works embodied therein, neither the owner of a particular phonorecord nor any person in possession of a particular copy of a computer program (including any tape, disk, or other medium embodying such program), may, for the purposes of direct or indirect commercial advantage, dispose of, or authorize the disposal of, the possession of that phonorecord or computer program (including any tape, disk, or other medium embodying such program) by rental, lease, or lending, or by any other act or practice in the nature of rental, lease, or lending. Nothing in the preceding sentence shall apply to the rental, lease, or lending of a phonorecord for nonprofit purposes by a nonprofit library or nonprofit educational institution. The transfer of possession of a lawfully made copy of a computer program by a nonprofit educational institution to another nonprofit educational institution or to faculty, staff, and students does not constitute rental, lease, or lending for direct or indirect commercial purposes under this subsection.

(b)(1)(A) Despite what’s stated in subsection (a), unless permitted by the copyright owners of the sound recording or the copyright owner of a computer program (including any tape, disk, or other medium containing that program), and in the case of a sound recording within the musical works included in it, neither the owner of a specific phonorecord nor any person with a specific copy of a computer program (including any tape, disk, or other medium that contains such program) may, for the purpose of making a direct or indirect profit, dispose of, or allow the disposal of, that phonorecord or computer program (including any tape, disk, or other medium containing such program) through rental, lease, lending, or any similar actions. The previous sentence doesn’t apply to the rental, lease, or lending of a phonorecord for nonprofit purposes by a nonprofit library or nonprofit educational institution. Transferring possession of a legally made copy of a computer program by a nonprofit educational institution to another nonprofit educational institution, or to faculty, staff, and students, does not count as rental, lease, or lending for direct or indirect commercial purposes under this subsection.

(B) This subsection does not apply to-

(B) This section does not apply to-

(i) a computer program which is embodied in a machine or product and which cannot be copied during the ordinary operation or use of the machine or product; or

(i) a computer program that is part of a machine or product and cannot be copied during normal operation or use of the machine or product; or

(ii) a computer program embodied in or used in conjunction with a limited purpose computer that is designed for playing video games and may be designed for other purposes.

(ii) a computer program that is included with or used alongside a specific computer designed for playing video games, which may also be intended for other uses.

(C) Nothing in this subsection affects any provision of chapter 9 of this title.

(C) Nothing in this subsection changes any part of chapter 9 of this title.

(2)(A) Nothing in this subsection shall apply to the lending of a computer program for nonprofit purposes by a nonprofit library, if each copy of a computer program which is lent by such library has affixed to the packaging containing the program a warning of copyright in accordance with requirements that the Register of Copyrights shall prescribe by regulation.

(2)(A) Nothing in this subsection applies to a nonprofit library lending a computer program for nonprofit purposes, as long as each copy of the program that is lent has a copyright warning attached to the packaging in accordance with the requirements set by the Register of Copyrights through regulation.

(B) Not later than three years after the date of the enactment of the Computer Software Rental Amendments Act of 1990, and at such times thereafter as the Register of Copyrights considers appropriate, the Register of Copyrights, after consultation with representatives of copyright owners and librarians, shall submit to the Congress a report stating whether this paragraph has achieved its intended purpose of maintaining the integrity of the copyright system while providing nonprofit libraries the capability to fulfill their function. Such report shall advise the Congress as to any information or recommendations that the Register of Copyrights considers necessary to carry out the purposes of this subsection.

(B) No later than three years after the Computer Software Rental Amendments Act of 1990 is enacted, and at times after that as the Register of Copyrights deems appropriate, the Register of Copyrights, after consulting with representatives of copyright owners and librarians, will submit a report to Congress stating whether this paragraph has succeeded in maintaining the integrity of the copyright system while allowing nonprofit libraries to fulfill their role. This report will inform Congress of any information or recommendations that the Register of Copyrights believes are necessary to achieve the goals of this subsection.

(3) Nothing in this subsection shall affect any provision of the antitrust laws. For purposes of the preceding sentence, "antitrust laws" has the meaning given that term in the first section of the Clayton Act and includes section 5 of the Federal Trade Commission Act to the extent that section relates to unfair methods of competition.

(3) Nothing in this subsection will change any part of the antitrust laws. In the previous sentence, "antitrust laws" means what it does in the first section of the Clayton Act and includes section 5 of the Federal Trade Commission Act as it pertains to unfair competition methods.

(4) Any person who distributes a phonorecord or a copy of a computer program (including any tape, disk, or other medium embodying such program) in violation of paragraph (1) is an infringer of copyright under section 501 of this title and is subject to the remedies set forth in sections 502, 503, 504, 505, and 509. Such violation shall not be a criminal offense under section 506 or cause such person to be subject to the criminal penalties set forth in section 2319 of title 18.

(4) Anyone who distributes a phonorecord or a copy of a computer program (including any tape, disk, or other medium containing such a program) in violation of paragraph (1) is infringing on copyright under section 501 of this title and is subject to the remedies outlined in sections 502, 503, 504, 505, and 509. This violation will not be considered a criminal offense under section 506 and will not subject the person to the criminal penalties outlined in section 2319 of title 18.

(c) Notwithstanding the provisions of section 106(5), the owner of a particular copy lawfully made under this title, or any person authorized by such owner, is entitled, without the authority of the copyright owner, to display that copy publicly, either directly or by the projection of no more than one image at a time, to viewers present at the place where the copy is located.

(c) Regardless of what is stated in section 106(5), the owner of a particular copy legally made under this title, or anyone authorized by that owner, has the right to display that copy publicly, either directly or by projecting no more than one image at a time, to viewers present at the location of the copy.

(d) The privileges prescribed by subsections (a) and (c) do not, unless authorized by the copyright owner, extend to any person who has acquired possession of the copy or phonorecord from the copyright owner, by rental, lease, loan, or otherwise, without acquiring ownership of it.

(d) The privileges mentioned in subsections (a) and (c) do not apply to anyone who got possession of the copy or phonorecord from the copyright owner through rental, lease, loan, or any other means, unless the copyright owner has given permission, and this does not include gaining ownership of it.

(e) Notwithstanding the provisions of sections 106(4) and 106(5), in the case of an electronic audiovisual game intended for use in coin-operated equipment, the owner of a particular copy of such a game lawfully made under this title, is entitled, without the authority of the copyright owner of the game, to publicly perform or display that game in coin- operated equipment, except that this subsection shall not apply to any work of authorship embodied in the audiovisual game if the copyright owner of the electronic audiovisual game is not also the copyright owner of the work of authorship.

(e) Despite what’s stated in sections 106(4) and 106(5), if we’re talking about an electronic audiovisual game meant for coin-operated machines, the owner of a specific copy of that game legally made under this title can publicly perform or display that game in coin-operated machines without needing permission from the copyright owner of the game. However, this subsection doesn't apply to any work of authorship included in the audiovisual game if the copyright owner of the electronic audiovisual game isn't also the copyright owner of that work.

Section 110. Limitations on exclusive rights: Exemption of certain performances and displays [41]

Notwithstanding the provisions of section 106, the following are not infringements of copyright:

Notwithstanding the provisions of section 106, the following actions do not infringe on copyright:

(1) performance or display of a work by instructors or pupils in the course of face-to-face teaching activities of a nonprofit educational institution, in a classroom or similar place devoted to instruction, unless, in the case of a motion picture or other audiovisual work, the performance, or the display of individual images, is given by means of a copy that was not lawfully made under this title, and that the person responsible for the performance knew or had reason to believe was not lawfully made;

(1) showing or performing a work by teachers or students during in-person teaching activities at a nonprofit educational institution, in a classroom or similar setting used for instruction, unless, for a movie or other visual work, the performance or display of individual images is done using a copy that was not legally made under this title, and the person responsible for the performance knew or had reason to believe it was not legally made;

(2) performance of a nondramatic literary or musical work or display of a work, by or in the course of a transmission, if-

(2) performance of a non-dramatic literary or musical work or display of a work, by or during a transmission, if-

(A) the performance or display is a regular part of the systematic instructional activities of a governmental body or a nonprofit educational institution; and

(A) the performance or display is a regular part of the organized teaching activities of a government agency or a nonprofit educational organization; and

(B) the performance or display is directly related and of material assistance to the teaching content of the transmission; and

(B) the performance or display is directly connected and significantly aids the teaching content being conveyed; and

(C) the transmission is made primarily for-

(C) the transmission is mainly for-

(i) reception in classrooms or similar places normally devoted to instruction, or

(i) reception in classrooms or similar places typically used for teaching, or

(ii) reception by persons to whom the transmission is directed because their disabilities or other special circumstances prevent their attendance in classrooms or similar places normally devoted to instruction, or

(ii) reception by people who the transmission is meant for because their disabilities or other special situations keep them from attending classrooms or similar places usually dedicated to teaching, or

(iii) reception by officers or employees of governmental bodies as a part of their official duties or employment;

(iii) receiving by officers or employees of government agencies as part of their official responsibilities or jobs;

(3) performance of a nondramatic literary or musical work or of a dramatico-musical work of a religious nature, or display of a work, in the course of services at a place of worship or other religious assembly;

(3) performance of a non-dramatic literary or musical work, or of a dramatic musical work of a religious nature, or presentation of a work during services at a place of worship or other religious gathering;

(4) performance of a nondramatic literary or musical work otherwise than in a transmission to the public, without any purpose of direct or indirect commercial advantage and without payment of any fee or other compensation for the performance to any of its performers, promoters, or organizers, if-

(4) performing a non-dramatic literary or musical work other than through a public transmission, without any intention of gaining direct or indirect commercial benefit and without paying any fees or other compensation to any of the performers, promoters, or organizers, if-

(A) there is no direct or indirect admission charge; or

(A) there is no admission fee, either directly or indirectly; or

(B) the proceeds, after deducting the reasonable costs of producing the performance, are used exclusively for educational, religious, or charitable purposes and not for private financial gain, except where the copyright owner has served notice of objection to the performance under the following conditions;

(B) the profits, after deducting the reasonable expenses of putting on the performance, are used solely for educational, religious, or charitable purposes and not for personal financial gain, unless the copyright owner has submitted a notice of objection to the performance under the following conditions;

(i) the notice shall be in writing and signed by the copyright owner or such owner's duly authorized agent; and

(i) the notice must be in writing and signed by the copyright owner or their authorized agent; and

(ii) the notice shall be served on the person responsible for the performance at least seven days before the date of the performance, and shall state the reasons for the objection; and

(ii) the notice must be given to the person in charge of the performance at least seven days before the performance date, and it should explain the reasons for the objection; and

(iii) the notice shall comply, in form, content, and manner of service, with requirements that the Register of Copyrights shall prescribe by regulation;

(iii) the notice must follow the form, content, and method of delivery requirements set by the Register of Copyrights through regulation;

(5)(A) except as provided in subparagraph (B), communication of a transmission embodying a performance or display of a work by the public reception of the transmission on a single receiving apparatus of a kind commonly used in private homes, unless-

(5)(A) except as provided in subparagraph (B), sharing a transmission that features a performance or display of a work through the reception of the transmission on a single device typically found in private homes, unless-

(i) a direct charge is made to see or hear the transmission; or

(i) a fee is charged to watch or listen to the broadcast; or

(ii) the transmission thus received is further transmitted to the public;

(ii) the transmission received is then shared with the public;

(B) communication by an establishment of a transmission or retransmission embodying a performance or display of a nondramatic musical work intended to be received by the general public, originated by a radio or television broadcast station licensed as such by the Federal Communications Commission, or, if an audiovisual transmission, by a cable system or satellite carrier, if-

(B) communication by a setup for transmitting or retransmitting a performance or display of a nondramatic musical work meant for the general public, originating from a radio or television broadcast station licensed by the Federal Communications Commission, or, if it's an audiovisual transmission, by a cable system or satellite carrier, if-

(i) in the case of an establishment other than a food service or drinking establishment, either the establishment in which the communication occurs has less than 2,000 gross square feet of space (excluding space used for customer parking and for no other purpose), or the establishment in which the communication occurs has 2,000 or more gross square feet of space (excluding space used for customer parking and for no other purpose) and-

(i) if it’s a business that isn’t a restaurant or bar, either the business where the communication happens has less than 2,000 gross square feet of space (not counting space used for customer parking), or the business where the communication happens has 2,000 or more gross square feet of space (not counting space used for customer parking) and-

(I) if the performance is by audio means only, the performance is communicated by means of a total of not more than 6 loudspeakers, of which not more than 4 loudspeakers are located in any 1 room or adjoining outdoor space; or

(I) if the performance is only audio, it can be played through a maximum of 6 speakers, with no more than 4 speakers in any single room or connected outdoor area; or

(II) if the performance or display is by audiovisual means, any visual portion of the performance or display is communicated by means of a total of not more than 4 audiovisual devices, of which not more than 1 audiovisual device is located in any 1 room, and no such audiovisual device has a diagonal screen size greater than 55 inches, and any audio portion of the performance or display is communicated by means of a total of not more than 6 loudspeakers, of which not more than 4 loudspeakers are located in any 1 room or adjoining outdoor space;

(II) If the performance or display uses audiovisual methods, any visual part of it is shown through no more than 4 audiovisual devices, with no more than 1 device in any single room, and none of the devices can have a diagonal screen larger than 55 inches. The audio part of the performance or display is transmitted using a total of no more than 6 speakers, with no more than 4 speakers in any single room or adjoining outdoor space;

(ii) in the case of a food service or drinking establishment, either the establishment in which the communication occurs has less than 3,750 gross square feet of space (excluding space used for customer parking and for no other purpose), or the establishment in which the communication occurs has 3,750 gross square feet of space or more (excluding space used for customer parking and for no other purpose) and

(ii) for a restaurant or bar, either the place where the conversation happens has less than 3,750 square feet of space (not counting the area used for customer parking and for no other reason), or the place where the conversation happens has 3,750 square feet or more (not counting the area used for customer parking and for no other reason) and

(I) if the performance is by audio means only, the performance is communicated by means of a total of not more than 6 loudspeakers, of which not more than 4 loudspeakers are located in any 1 room or adjoining outdoor space; or

(I) if the performance is through audio only, it is communicated through a total of no more than 6 speakers, of which no more than 4 speakers are placed in any one room or adjoining outdoor area; or

(II) if the performance or display is by audiovisual means, any visual portion of the performance or display is communicated by means of a total of not more than 4 audiovisual devices, of which not more than 1 audiovisual device is located in any 1 room, and no such audiovisual device has a diagonal screen size greater than 55 inches, and any audio portion of the performance or display is communicated by means of a total of not more than 6 loudspeakers, of which not more than 4 loudspeakers are located in any 1 room or adjoining outdoor space;

(II) If the performance or display is through audiovisual means, any visual part of the performance or display is shared using no more than 4 audiovisual devices, with a maximum of 1 audiovisual device in any single room, and no device has a diagonal screen size larger than 55 inches. Any audio part of the performance or display is shared using no more than 6 loudspeakers, with a maximum of 4 loudspeakers in any single room or connected outdoor area;

(iii) no direct charge is made to see or hear the transmission or retransmission;

(iii) no fee is charged to watch or listen to the transmission or retransmission;

(iv) the transmission or retransmission is not further transmitted beyond the establishment where it is received; and

(iv) the transmission or retransmission is not sent beyond the location where it is received; and

(v) the transmission or retransmission is licensed by the copyright owner of the work so publicly performed or displayed;

(v) the transmission or retransmission is authorized by the copyright owner of the work that’s being publicly performed or displayed;

(6) performance of a nondramatic musical work by a governmental body or a nonprofit agricultural or horticultural organization, in the course of an annual agricultural or horticultural fair or exhibition conducted by such body or organization; the exemption provided by this clause shall extend to any liability for copyright infringement that would otherwise be imposed on such body or organization, under doctrines of vicarious liability or related infringement, for a performance by a concessionnaire, business establishment, or other person at such fair or exhibition, but shall not excuse any such person from liability for the performance;

(6) Performance of a non-dramatic musical work by a government body or a nonprofit agricultural or horticultural organization during their annual agricultural or horticultural fair or exhibition will be exempt from any potential copyright infringement liability that might otherwise fall on that body or organization under vicarious liability or related infringement rules due to a performance by a concessionaire, business establishment, or another individual at the fair or exhibition. However, this exemption does not relieve that individual from their own liability for the performance;

(7) performance of a nondramatic musical work by a vending establishment open to the public at large without any direct or indirect admission charge, where the sole purpose of the performance is to promote the retail sale of copies or phonorecords of the work, or of the audiovisual or other devices utilized in such performance, and the performance is not transmitted beyond the place where the establishment is located and is within the immediate area where the sale is occurring;

(7) performance of a non-dramatic musical work by a public vending establishment that doesn't charge any admission, where the main goal of the performance is to promote the retail sale of copies or recordings of the work, or of the audiovisual or other devices used in that performance, and the performance is not transmitted outside the location of the establishment and is within the direct area where the sale is taking place;

(8) performance of a nondramatic literary work, by or in the course of a transmission specifically designed for and primarily directed to blind or other handicapped persons who are unable to read normal printed material as a result of their handicap, or deaf or other handicapped persons who are unable to hear the aural signals accompanying a transmission of visual signals, if the performance is made without any purpose of direct or indirect commercial advantage and its transmission is made through the facilities of: (i) a governmental body; or (ii) a noncommercial educational broadcast station (as defined in section 397 of title 47); or (iii) a radio subcarrier authorization (as defined in 47 CFR 73.293-73.295 and 73.593-73.595); or (iv) a cable system (as defined in section 111 (f));

(8) The performance of a non-dramatic literary work, done through a transmission specifically created for and mainly aimed at blind or other disabled individuals who can’t read regular printed material due to their disability, or deaf or other disabled individuals who can’t hear the audio signals that come with a transmission of visual signals, if the performance is made without any intent for direct or indirect commercial gain and its transmission occurs through the facilities of: (i) a governmental entity; or (ii) a non-commercial educational broadcast station (as described in section 397 of title 47); or (iii) a radio subcarrier authorization (as defined in 47 CFR 73.293-73.295 and 73.593-73.595); or (iv) a cable system (as defined in section 111 (f));

(9) performance on a single occasion of a dramatic literary work published at least ten years before the date of the performance, by or in the course of a transmission specifically designed for and primarily directed to blind or other handicapped persons who are unable to read normal printed material as a result of their handicap, if the performance is made without any purpose of direct or indirect commercial advantage and its transmission is made through the facilities of a radio subcarrier authorization referred to in clause (8) (iii), *Provided*, That the provisions of this clause shall not be applicable to more than one performance of the same work by the same performers or under the auspices of the same organization; and

(9) a performance of a dramatic literary work that was published at least ten years before the performance date, specifically designed for and mainly directed at blind or other disabled individuals who can't read standard printed material because of their condition, as long as the performance isn't aimed at making a direct or indirect profit and is transmitted through the facilities of a radio subcarrier authorization mentioned in clause (8) (iii), *Provided*, that the rules in this clause don’t apply to more than one performance of the same work by the same performers or under the same organization; and

(10) notwithstanding paragraph (4), the following is not an infringement of copyright: performance of a nondramatic literary or musical work in the course of a social function which is organized and promoted by a nonprofit veterans' organization or a nonprofit fraternal organization to which the general public is not invited, but not including the invitees of the organizations, if the proceeds from the performance, after deducting the reasonable costs of producing the performance, are used exclusively for charitable purposes and not for financial gain. For purposes of this section the social functions of any college or university fraternity or sorority shall not be included unless the social function is held solely to raise funds for a specific charitable purpose.

(10) Despite paragraph (4), the following does not count as copyright infringement: performing a nondramatic literary or musical work during a social event organized and promoted by a nonprofit veterans' organization or a nonprofit fraternal organization that is not open to the general public, excluding the organization’s invitees, as long as the proceeds from the performance, after covering reasonable production costs, are used solely for charitable purposes and not for profit. For this section, social events for any college or university fraternity or sorority do not count unless the event is held specifically to raise funds for a designated charitable purpose.

The exemptions provided under paragraph (5) shall not be taken into account in any administrative, judicial, or other governmental proceeding to set or adjust the royalties payable to copyright owners for the public performance or display of their works. Royalties payable to copyright owners for any public performance or display of their works other than such performances or displays as are exempted under paragraph (5) shall not be diminished in any respect as a result of such exemption.

The exemptions in paragraph (5) won’t be considered in any administrative, judicial, or governmental proceedings to establish or change the royalties owed to copyright owners for the public performance or display of their works. Royalties owed to copyright owners for any public performance or display of their works, except those that are exempt under paragraph (5), won't be reduced in any way because of that exemption.

Section 111. Limitations on exclusive rights: Secondary transmissions [42]

(a) Certain Secondary Transmissions Exempted. The secondary transmission of a performance or display of a work embodied in a primary transmission is not an infringement of copyright if-

(a) Certain Secondary Transmissions Exempted. The secondary transmission of a performance or display of a work included in a primary transmission doesn't count as copyright infringement if-

(1) the secondary transmission is not made by a cable system, and consists entirely of the relaying, by the management of a hotel, apartment house, or similar establishment, of signals transmitted by a broadcast station licensed by the Federal Communications Commission, within the local service area of such station, to the private lodgings of guests or residents of such establishment, and no direct charge is made to see or hear the secondary transmission; or

(1) the secondary transmission isn't done through a cable system and involves only the management of a hotel, apartment building, or similar place relaying signals from a broadcast station licensed by the Federal Communications Commission, within that station's local service area, to the private accommodations of guests or residents of that establishment, and there is no direct fee to access the secondary transmission; or

(2) the secondary transmission is made solely for the purpose and under the conditions specified by clause (2) of section 110; or

(2) the secondary transmission is done only for the purpose and under the conditions outlined in clause (2) of section 110; or

(3) the secondary transmission is made by any carrier who has no direct or indirect control over the content or selection of the primary transmission or over the particular recipients of the secondary transmission, and whose activities with respect to the secondary transmission consist solely of providing wires, cables, or other communications channels for the use of others: *Provided*, That the provisions of this clause extend only to the activities of said carrier with respect to secondary transmissions and do not exempt from liability the activities of others with respect to their own primary or secondary transmissions;

(3) A secondary transmission is carried out by any carrier that has no direct or indirect control over the content or choice of the primary transmission or the specific recipients of the secondary transmission, and whose role in the secondary transmission is limited to providing wires, cables, or other communication channels for others to use: *Provided*, That the rules in this clause apply only to the actions of the carrier regarding secondary transmissions and do not protect others from liability for their own primary or secondary transmissions;

(4) the secondary transmission is made by a satellite carrier for private home viewing pursuant to a statutory license under section 119; or

(4) the secondary transmission is made by a satellite provider for private home viewing under a statutory license according to section 119; or

(5) the secondary transmission is not made by a cable system but is made by a governmental body, or other nonprofit organization, without any purpose of direct or indirect commercial advantage, and without charge to the recipients of the secondary transmission other than assessments necessary to defray the actual and reasonable costs of maintaining and operating the secondary transmission service.

(5) the secondary transmission isn't done by a cable system but instead is done by a government entity or another nonprofit organization, without any intent for direct or indirect profit, and at no cost to the recipients of the secondary transmission aside from fees needed to cover the actual and reasonable expenses of running the secondary transmission service.

(b) Secondary Transmission of Primary Transmission to Controlled Group. Notwithstanding the provisions of subsections (a) and (c), the secondary transmission to the public of a performance or display of a work embodied in a primary transmission is actionable as an act of infringement under section 501, and is fully subject to the remedies provided by sections 502 through 506 and 509, if the primary transmission is not made for reception by the public at large but is controlled and limited to reception by particular members of the public: *Provided*, however, That such secondary transmission is not actionable as an act of infringement if-

(b) Secondary Transmission of Primary Transmission to Controlled Group. Even with the rules in subsections (a) and (c), if a performance or display of a work from a primary transmission is shared with the public, it can be considered infringement under section 501. This is fully subject to the remedies outlined in sections 502 through 506 and 509, especially if the primary transmission wasn't intended for the general public but was controlled and limited to specific individuals: *Provided*, however, that this secondary transmission is not considered infringement if-

(1) the primary transmission is made by a broadcast station licensed by the Federal Communications Commission; and

(1) the main transmission is done by a broadcast station licensed by the Federal Communications Commission; and

(2) the carriage of the signals comprising the secondary transmission is required under the rules, regulations, or authorizations of the Federal Communications Commission; and

(2) transporting the signals that make up the secondary transmission is required by the rules, regulations, or authorizations of the Federal Communications Commission; and

(3) the signal of the primary transmitter is not altered or changed in any way by the secondary transmitter.

(3) the signal from the primary transmitter is not modified or changed in any way by the secondary transmitter.

(c) Secondary Transmissions by Cable Systems.-

(c) Secondary Transmissions by Cable Systems.-

(1) Subject to the provisions of clauses (2), (3), and (4) of this subsection and section 114(d), secondary transmissions to the public by a cable system of a performance or display of a work embodied in a primary transmission made by a broadcast station licensed by the Federal Communications Commission or by an appropriate governmental authority of Canada or Mexico shall be subject to statutory licensing upon compliance with the requirements of subsection (d) where the carriage of the signals comprising the secondary transmission is permissible under the rules, regulations, or authorizations of the Federal Communications Commission.

(1) Following the rules in clauses (2), (3), and (4) of this subsection and section 114(d), secondary broadcasts to the public by a cable system of a performance or display of a work included in a primary broadcast made by a station licensed by the Federal Communications Commission or by the relevant government authority in Canada or Mexico will be subject to statutory licensing as long as the requirements in subsection (d) are met, provided that the transmission of the signals in the secondary broadcast is allowed under the rules, regulations, or permissions of the Federal Communications Commission.

(2) Notwithstanding the provisions of clause (1) of this subsection, the willful or repeated secondary transmission to the public by a cable system of a primary transmission made by a broadcast station licensed by the Federal Communications Commission or by an appropriate governmental authority of Canada or Mexico and embodying a performance or display of a work is actionable as an act of infringement under section 501, and is fully subject to the remedies provided by sections 502 through 506 and 509, in the following cases:

(2) Even with the rules in clause (1) of this subsection, if a cable system intentionally or repeatedly sends out a primary transmission from a broadcast station licensed by the Federal Communications Commission or by the relevant governmental authority of Canada or Mexico, which includes a performance or display of a work, it counts as infringement under section 501, and the remedies in sections 502 through 506 and 509 apply in these cases:

(A) where the carriage of the signals comprising the secondary transmission is not permissible under the rules, regulations, or authorizations of the Federal Communications Commission; or

(A) where carrying the signals involved in the secondary transmission is not allowed under the rules, regulations, or authorizations of the Federal Communications Commission; or

(B) where the cable system has not deposited the statement of account and royalty fee required by subsection (d).

(B) where the cable system has not submitted the account statement and royalty fee required by subsection (d).

(3) Notwithstanding the provisions of clause (1) of this subsection and subject to the provisions of subsection (e) of this section, the secondary transmission to the public by a cable system of a performance or display of a work embodied in a primary transmission made by a broadcast station licensed by the Federal Communications Commission or by an appropriate governmental authority of Canada or Mexico is actionable as an act of infringement under section 501, and is fully subject to the remedies provided by sections 502 through 506 and sections 509 and 510, if the content of the particular program in which the performance or display is embodied, or any commercial advertising or station announcements transmitted by the primary transmitter during, or immediately before or after, the transmission of such program, is in any way willfully altered by the cable system through changes, deletions, or additions, except for the alteration, deletion, or substitution of commercial advertisements performed by those engaged in television commercial advertising market research: *Provided*, That the research company has obtained the prior consent of the advertiser who has purchased the original commercial advertisement, the television station broadcasting that commercial advertisement, and the cable system performing the secondary transmission: *And provided further*, That such commercial alteration, deletion, or substitution is not performed for the purpose of deriving income from the sale of that commercial time.

(3) Despite the rules in clause (1) of this subsection and following the rules in subsection (e) of this section, a cable system's secondary transmission to the public of a performance or display of a work that is part of a primary transmission made by a broadcast station licensed by the Federal Communications Commission or by an appropriate government authority in Canada or Mexico can be treated as infringement under section 501. It's fully subject to the remedies provided by sections 502 through 506 and sections 509 and 510 if the content of the specific program that includes the performance or display, or any commercials or station announcements aired by the primary transmitter during, just before, or just after that program, is willfully changed by the cable system through edits, removals, or additions, except for changes, removals, or substitutions of commercials made by those involved in television commercial market research: *Provided*, That the research company has obtained prior consent from the advertiser who purchased the original commercial, the television station airing that commercial, and the cable system doing the secondary transmission: *And provided further*, That such commercial changes, removals, or substitutions are not done for profit from selling that commercial time.

(4) Notwithstanding the provisions of clause (1) of this subsection, the secondary transmission to the public by a cable system of a performance or display of a work embodied in a primary transmission made by a broadcast station licensed by an appropriate governmental authority of Canada or Mexico is actionable as an act of infringement under section 501, and is fully subject to the remedies provided by sections 502 through 506 and section 509, if (A) with respect to Canadian signals, the community of the cable system is located more than 150 miles from the United States-Canadian border and is also located south of the forty-second parallel of latitude, or (B) with respect to Mexican signals, the secondary transmission is made by a cable system which received the primary transmission by means other than direct interception of a free space radio wave emitted by such broadcast television station, unless prior to April 15, 1976, such cable system was actually carrying, or was specifically authorized to carry, the signal of such foreign station on the system pursuant to the rules, regulations, or authorizations of the Federal Communications Commission.

(4) Even with the rules in clause (1) of this subsection, if a cable system broadcasts a performance or display of a work that was originally transmitted by a broadcast station licensed by the appropriate government authority in Canada or Mexico, it can be considered copyright infringement under section 501. This action is completely subject to the remedies outlined in sections 502 through 506 and section 509, if (A) for Canadian signals, the cable system's community is located more than 150 miles from the U.S.-Canada border and south of the forty-second parallel of latitude, or (B) for Mexican signals, the cable system retransmitting the signal received it through channels other than directly intercepting a free radio wave from the television station, unless the cable system was already carrying or had special permission to carry that foreign station's signal before April 15, 1976, according to the rules and regulations set by the Federal Communications Commission.

(d) Statutory License for Secondary Transmissions by Cable Systems. [43]

(d) Statutory License for Secondary Transmissions by Cable Systems. [43]

(1) A cable system whose secondary transmissions have been subject to statutory licensing under subsection (c) shall, on a semiannual basis, deposit with the Register of Copyrights, in accordance with requirements that the Register shall prescribe by regulation-

(1) A cable system whose secondary broadcasts have been licensed under subsection (c) must, every six months, submit to the Register of Copyrights, following the guidelines that the Register will set by regulation-

(A) a statement of account, covering the six months next preceding, specifying the number of channels on which the cable system made secondary transmissions to its subscribers, the names and locations of all primary transmitters whose transmissions were further transmitted by the cable system, the total number of subscribers, the gross amounts paid to the cable system for the basic service of providing secondary transmissions of primary broadcast transmitters, and such other data as the Register of Copyrights may from time to time prescribe by regulation. In determining the total number of subscribers and the gross amounts paid to the cable system for the basic service of providing secondary transmissions of primary broadcast transmitters, the cable system shall not include subscribers and amounts collected from subscribers receiving secondary transmissions for private home viewing pursuant to section 119. Such statement shall also include a special statement of account covering any nonnetwork television programming that was carried by the cable system in whole or in part beyond the local service area of the primary transmitter, under rules, regulations, or authorizations of the Federal Communications Commission permitting the substitution or addition of signals under certain circumstances, together with logs showing the times, dates, stations, and programs involved in such substituted or added carriage; and

(A) a statement of account covering the six months prior, detailing the number of channels on which the cable system provided secondary transmissions to its subscribers, the names and locations of all primary transmitters whose broadcasts were further transmitted by the cable system, the total number of subscribers, the total amounts paid to the cable system for the basic service of offering secondary transmissions of primary broadcast transmitters, and any other data the Register of Copyrights may specify through regulations. When calculating the total number of subscribers and the total amounts received by the cable system for the basic service of providing secondary transmissions of primary broadcast transmitters, the cable system should not include subscribers and amounts collected from subscribers receiving secondary transmissions for private home viewing according to section 119. This statement should also include a special account statement covering any non-network television programming that was carried by the cable system in whole or in part beyond the local service area of the primary transmitter, under rules, regulations, or authorizations from the Federal Communications Commission allowing for the substitution or addition of signals under specific circumstances, along with logs showing the times, dates, stations, and programs involved in such substituted or added carriage; and

(B) except in the case of a cable system whose royalty is specified in subclause (C) or (D), a total royalty fee for the period covered by the statement, computed on the basis of specified percentages of the gross receipts from subscribers to the cable service during said period for the basic service of providing secondary transmissions of primary broadcast transmitters, as follows:

(B) except for a cable system whose royalty is outlined in subclause (C) or (D), a total royalty fee for the time covered by the statement, calculated based on specific percentages of the gross income from subscribers to the cable service during that period for the basic service of providing secondary transmissions of primary broadcast transmitters, as follows:

(i) 0.675 of 1 per centum of such gross receipts for the privilege of further transmitting any nonnetwork programming of a primary transmitter in whole or in part beyond the local service area of such primary transmitter, such amount to be applied against the fee, if any, payable pursuant to paragraphs (ii) through (iv);

(i) 0.675% of such gross receipts for the privilege of further transmitting any non-network programming of a primary transmitter, either fully or partially, beyond the local service area of that primary transmitter. This amount will be deducted from the fee, if any, required under paragraphs (ii) through (iv);

(ii) 0.675 of 1 per centum of such gross receipts for the first distant signal equivalent;

(ii) 0.675% of those gross receipts for the first distant signal equivalent;

(iii) 0.425 of 1 per centum of such gross receipts for each of the second, third, and fourth distant signal equivalents;

(iii) 0.425% of such gross receipts for each of the second, third, and fourth distant signal equivalents;

(iv) 0.2 of 1 per centum of such gross receipts for the fifth distant signal equivalent and each additional distant signal equivalent thereafter; and

(iv) 0.2% of those gross receipts for the fifth distant signal equivalent and each additional distant signal equivalent after that; and

in computing the amounts payable under paragraph (ii) through (iv), above, any fraction of a distant signal equivalent shall be computed at its fractional value and, in the case of any cable system located partly within and partly without the local service area of a primary transmitter, gross receipts shall be limited to those gross receipts derived from subscribers located without the local service area of such primary transmitter; and

in calculating the amounts payable under paragraphs (ii) through (iv) above, any fraction of a distant signal equivalent will be calculated at its fractional value. Also, for any cable system that is partly inside and partly outside the local service area of a primary transmitter, gross receipts will only include those from subscribers located outside the local service area of that primary transmitter; and

(C) if the actual gross receipts paid by subscribers to a cable system for the period covered by the statement for the basic service of providing secondary transmissions of primary broadcast transmitters total $80,000 or less, gross receipts of the cable system for the purpose of this subclause shall be computed by subtracting from such actual gross receipts the amount by which $80,000 exceeds such actual gross receipts, except that in no case shall a cable system's gross receipts be reduced to less than $3,000. The royalty fee payable under this subclause shall be 0.5 of 1 per centum, regardless of the number of distant signal equivalents, if any; and

(C) if the total gross receipts paid by subscribers to a cable system for the period covered by the statement for the basic service of providing secondary broadcasts of primary broadcast transmitters are $80,000 or less, the gross receipts of the cable system for this subclause will be calculated by subtracting from those actual gross receipts the difference between $80,000 and those actual gross receipts, but in no case will a cable system's gross receipts be lowered to less than $3,000. The royalty fee due under this subclause will be 0.5 percent, regardless of the number of distant signal equivalents, if any; and

(D) if the actual gross receipts paid by subscribers to a cable system for the period covered by the statement, for the basic service of providing secondary transmissions of primary broadcast transmitters, are more than $80,000 but less than $160,000, the royalty fee payable under this subclause shall be

(D) if the actual gross receipts paid by subscribers to a cable system for the period covered by the statement, for the basic service of providing secondary transmissions of primary broadcast transmitters, are more than $80,000 but less than $160,000, the royalty fee payable under this subclause shall be

(i) 0.5 of 1 per centum of any gross receipts up to $80,000; and

(i) 0.5% of any gross receipts up to $80,000; and

(ii) 1 per centum of any gross receipts in excess of $80,000 but less than $160,000, regardless of the number of distant signal equivalents, if any.

(ii) 1 percent of any gross receipts over $80,000 but less than $160,000, no matter how many distant signal equivalents there are, if any.

(2) The Register of Copyrights shall receive all fees deposited under this section and, after deducting the reasonable costs incurred by the Copyright Office under this section, shall deposit the balance in the Treasury of the United States, in such manner as the Secretary of the Treasury directs. All funds held by the Secretary of the Treasury shall be invested in interest-bearing United States securities for later distribution with interest by the Librarian of Congress in the event no controversy over distribution exists, or by a copyright arbitration royalty panel in the event a controversy over such distribution exists.

(2) The Register of Copyrights will collect all fees deposited under this section and, after deducting reasonable costs incurred by the Copyright Office, will deposit the remaining balance in the U.S. Treasury, as instructed by the Secretary of the Treasury. All funds held by the Secretary of the Treasury will be invested in interest-bearing U.S. securities for future distribution with interest by the Librarian of Congress if there’s no dispute over distribution, or by a copyright arbitration royalty panel if a dispute does exist.

(3) The royalty fees thus deposited shall, in accordance with the procedures provided by clause (4), be distributed to those among the following copyright owners who claim that their works were the subject of secondary transmissions by cable systems during the relevant semiannual period:

(3) The royalty fees deposited will be distributed to the copyright owners who claim their works were part of secondary transmissions by cable systems during the relevant six-month period, following the procedures outlined in clause (4):

(A) any such owner whose work was included in a secondary transmission made by a cable system of a nonnetwork television program in whole or in part beyond the local service area of the primary transmitter; and

(A) any owner whose work was included in a secondary transmission made by a cable system of a non-network television program, in whole or in part, beyond the local service area of the primary transmitter; and

(B) any such owner whose work was included in a secondary transmission identified in a special statement of account deposited under clause (1) (A); and

(B) any owner whose work was included in a secondary transmission mentioned in a special statement of account submitted under clause (1)(A); and

(C) any such owner whose work was included in nonnetwork programming consisting exclusively of aural signals carried by a cable system in whole or in part beyond the local service area of the primary transmitter of such programs.

(C) any owner whose work was included in nonnetwork programming that consists only of audio signals transmitted by a cable system, either entirely or partially, outside the local service area of the main transmitter for those programs.

(4) The royalty fees thus deposited shall be distributed in accordance with the following procedures:

(4) The royalty fees that have been deposited will be distributed according to the following procedures:

(A) During the month of July in each year, every person claiming to be entitled to statutory license fees for secondary transmissions shall file a claim with the Librarian of Congress, in accordance with requirements that the Librarian of Congress shall prescribe by regulation. Notwithstanding any provisions of the antitrust laws, for purposes of this clause any claimants may agree among themselves as to the proportionate division of statutory licensing fees among them, may lump their claims together and file them jointly or as a single claim, or may designate a common agent to receive payment on their behalf.

(A) Every July, anyone who believes they are entitled to statutory license fees for secondary transmissions must submit a claim to the Librarian of Congress, following the rules set by the Librarian. Despite any antitrust laws, claimants can agree on how to split the statutory licensing fees, combine their claims to file them together or as one claim, or appoint a common agent to receive payments for them.

(B) After the first day of August of each year, the Librarian of Congress shall, upon the recommendation of the Register of Copyrights, determine whether there exists a controversy concerning the distribution of royalty fees. If the Librarian determines that no such controversy exists, the Librarian shall, after deducting reasonable administrative costs under this section, distribute such fees to the copyright owners entitled to such fees, or to their designated agents. If the Librarian finds the existence of a controversy, the Librarian shall, pursuant to chapter 8 of this title, convene a copyright arbitration royalty panel to determine the distribution of royalty fees.

(B) After the first day of August each year, the Librarian of Congress will, based on the recommendation of the Register of Copyrights, decide if there’s a dispute regarding the distribution of royalty fees. If the Librarian concludes there’s no dispute, they will distribute the fees to the copyright owners entitled to them, or to their designated representatives, after deducting reasonable administrative costs under this section. If the Librarian finds a dispute exists, they will, according to chapter 8 of this title, set up a copyright arbitration royalty panel to resolve the distribution of the royalty fees.

(C) During the pendency of any proceeding under this subsection, the Librarian of Congress shall withhold from distribution an amount sufficient to satisfy all claims with respect to which a controversy exists, but shall have discretion to proceed to distribute any amounts that are not in controversy.

(C) While any proceeding under this subsection is ongoing, the Librarian of Congress will hold back an amount sufficient to cover all claims that have a dispute, but will have the discretion to go ahead and distribute any amounts that are not disputed.

(e) Nonsimultaneous Secondary Transmissions by Cable Systems.-

(e) Delayed Secondary Transmissions by Cable Systems.-

(1) Notwithstanding those provisions of the second paragraph of subsection (f) relating to nonsimultaneous secondary transmissions by a cable system, any such transmissions are actionable as an act of infringement under section 501, and are fully subject to the remedies provided by sections 502 through 506 and sections 509 and 510, unless

(1) Despite the rules in the second paragraph of subsection (f) about nonsimultaneous secondary transmissions by a cable system, any of these transmissions can be considered an infringement under section 501, and are completely subject to the remedies outlined in sections 502 through 506 and sections 509 and 510, unless

(A) the program on the videotape is transmitted no more than one time to the cable system's subscribers; and

(A) the program on the videotape is sent to the cable system's subscribers only once; and

(B) the copyrighted program, episode, or motion picture videotape, including the commercials contained within such program, episode, or picture, is transmitted without deletion or editing; and

(B) the copyrighted program, episode, or movie videotape, including the commercials within that program, episode, or movie, is transmitted without any cuts or edits; and

(C) an owner or officer of the cable system

(C) an owner or executive of the cable system

(i) prevents the duplication of the videotape while in the possession of the system,

(i) stops the videotape from being copied while it’s in the system's possession,

(ii) prevents unauthorized duplication while in the possession of the facility making the videotape for the system if the system owns or controls the facility, or takes reasonable precautions to prevent such duplication if it does not own or control the facility,

(ii) prevents unauthorized copying while the facility that produces the videotape for the system has it, if the system owns or controls the facility or takes reasonable measures to stop such copying if it does not own or control the facility,

(iii) takes adequate precautions to prevent duplication while the tape is being transported, and

(iii) takes the necessary steps to prevent duplication during the transportation of the tape, and

(iv) subject to clause (2), erases or destroys, or causes the erasure or destruction of, the videotape; and

(iv) subject to clause (2), erases or destroys, or gets the videotape erased or destroyed; and

(D) within forty-five days after the end of each calendar quarter, an owner or officer of the cable system executes an affidavit attesting

(D) within forty-five days after the end of each calendar quarter, an owner or officer of the cable system signs a sworn statement confirming

(i) to the steps and precautions taken to prevent duplication of the videotape, and

(i) to the measures and precautions implemented to stop the duplication of the videotape, and

(ii) subject to clause (2), to the erasure or destruction of all videotapes made or used during such quarter; and

(ii) following clause (2), all videotapes recorded or used during that quarter must be erased or destroyed; and

(E) such owner or officer places or causes each such affidavit, and affidavits received pursuant to clause (2) (C), to be placed in a file, open to public inspection, at such system's main office in the community where the transmission is made or in the nearest community where such system maintains an office; and

(E) that owner or officer ensures that each affidavit, along with affidavits obtained under clause (2)(C), is filed and available for public inspection at the main office of the system in the community where the transmission occurs or in the nearest community where the system has an office; and

(F) the nonsimultaneous transmission is one that the cable system would be authorized to transmit under the rules, regulations, and authorizations of the Federal Communications Commission in effect at the time of the nonsimultaneous transmission if the transmission had been made simultaneously, except that this subclause shall not apply to inadvertent or accidental transmissions.

(F) nonsimultaneous transmission refers to one that the cable system is allowed to transmit according to the rules, regulations, and authorizations of the Federal Communications Commission that are in effect at the time of the nonsimultaneous transmission, as if the transmission had been made simultaneously, except this subclause does not apply to unintentional or accidental transmissions.

(2) If a cable system transfers to any person a videotape of a program nonsimultaneously transmitted by it, such transfer is actionable as an act of infringement under section 501, and is fully subject to the remedies provided by sections 502 through 506 and 509, except that, pursuant to a written, nonprofit contract providing for the equitable sharing of the costs of such videotape and its transfer, a videotape nonsimultaneously transmitted by it, in accordance with clause (1), may be transferred by one cable system in Alaska to another system in Alaska, by one cable system in Hawaii permitted to make such nonsimultaneous transmissions to another such cable system in Hawaii, or by one cable system in Guam, the Northern Mariana Islands, or the Trust Territory of the Pacific Islands, to another cable system in any of those three territories, if-

(2) If a cable system gives a videotape of a program that was not transmitted at the same time, that transfer can be considered an infringement under section 501 and is fully subject to the remedies outlined in sections 502 through 506 and 509. However, according to a written, nonprofit agreement that covers the fair sharing of the costs for that videotape and its transfer, a videotape not transmitted simultaneously can be transferred from one cable system in Alaska to another system in Alaska, from one cable system in Hawaii that is allowed to make such nonsimultaneous transmissions to another cable system in Hawaii, or from one cable system in Guam, the Northern Mariana Islands, or the Trust Territory of the Pacific Islands to another cable system within any of those territories, if—

(A) each such contract is available for public inspection in the offices of the cable systems involved, and a copy of such contract is filed, within thirty days after such contract is entered into, with the Copyright Office (which Office shall make each such contract available for public inspection); and

(A) each contract is available for public inspection in the offices of the involved cable systems, and a copy of each contract is filed with the Copyright Office within thirty days after the contract is signed (the Copyright Office will make each contract available for public inspection); and

(B) the cable system to which the videotape is transferred complies with clause (1) (A), (B), (C) (i), (iii), and (iv), and (D) through (F); and

(B) the cable system where the videotape is transferred meets the requirements of clause (1) (A), (B), (C) (i), (iii), and (iv), and (D) through (F); and

(C) such system provides a copy of the affidavit required to be made in accordance with clause (1) (D) to each cable system making a previous nonsimultaneous transmission of the same videotape.

(C) such system provides a copy of the affidavit that needs to be created in accordance with clause (1) (D) to each cable system that made a previous nonsimultaneous transmission of the same videotape.

(3) This subsection shall not be construed to supersede the exclusivity protection provisions of any existing agreement, or any such agreement hereafter entered into, between a cable system and a television broadcast station in the area in which the cable system is located, or a network with which such station is affiliated.

(3) This subsection shouldn't be taken to override the exclusivity protection rules in any existing agreements, or in any agreements made in the future, between a cable system and a local television broadcast station, or a network that the station is connected to.

(4) As used in this subsection, the term "videotape", and each of its variant forms, means the reproduction of the images and sounds of a program or programs broadcast by a television broadcast station licensed by the Federal Communications Commission, regardless of the nature of the material objects, such as tapes or films, in which the reproduction is embodied.

(4) In this section, the term "videotape" and its variations refer to the recording of the images and sounds of a program or programs aired by a television station licensed by the Federal Communications Commission, no matter what type of material objects, like tapes or films, the recording is stored on.

(f) Definitions. As used in this section, the following terms and their variant forms mean the following:

(f) Definitions. As used in this section, the following terms and their variations mean the following:

A "primary transmission" is a transmission made to the public by the transmitting facility whose signals are being received and further transmitted by the secondary transmission service, regardless of where or when the performance or display was first transmitted.

A "primary transmission" is a transmission made to the public by the transmitting facility whose signals are being received and then retransmitted by the secondary transmission service, no matter where or when the performance or display was first transmitted.

A "secondary transmission" is the further transmitting of a primary transmission simultaneously with the primary transmission, or nonsimultaneously with the primary transmission if by a "cable system" not located in whole or in part within the boundary of the forty-eight contiguous States, Hawaii, or Puerto Rico: *Provided, however*, That a nonsimultaneous further transmission by a cable system located in Hawaii of a primary transmission shall be deemed to be a secondary transmission if the carriage of the television broadcast signal comprising such further transmission is permissible under the rules, regulations, or authorizations of the Federal Communications Commission.

A "secondary transmission" is the additional sending of a primary transmission at the same time as the primary transmission, or not at the same time with respect to the primary transmission if it’s through a "cable system" that is not fully or partially within the borders of the forty-eight contiguous States, Hawaii, or Puerto Rico: *Provided, however*, that a nonsimultaneous additional transmission by a cable system in Hawaii of a primary transmission will be considered a secondary transmission if carrying the television broadcast signal for that additional transmission is allowed under the rules, regulations, or authorizations of the Federal Communications Commission.

A "cable system" is a facility, located in any State, Territory, Trust Territory, or Possession, that in whole or in part receives signals transmitted or programs broadcast by one or more television broadcast stations licensed by the Federal Communications Commission, and makes secondary transmissions of such signals or programs by wires, cables, microwave, or other communications channels to subscribing members of the public who pay for such service. For purposes of determining the royalty fee under subsection (d)(1), two or more cable systems in contiguous communities under common ownership or control or operating from one headend shall be considered as one system.

A "cable system" is a facility located in any state, territory, trust territory, or possession that fully or partially receives signals or programs broadcast by one or more television stations licensed by the Federal Communications Commission and makes secondary transmissions of those signals or programs using wires, cables, microwave, or other communication methods to paying subscribers. To determine the royalty fee under subsection (d)(1), two or more cable systems in neighboring communities under the same ownership or control, or operating from a single headend, will be treated as one system.

The "local service area of a primary transmitter", in the case of a television broadcast station, comprises the area in which such station is entitled to insist upon its signal being retransmitted by a cable system pursuant to the rules, regulations, and authorizations of the Federal Communications Commission in effect on April 15, 1976, or such station's television market as defined in section 76.55(e) of title 47, Code of Federal Regulations (as in effect on September 18, 1993), or any modifications to such television market made, on or after September 18, 1993, pursuant to section 76.55(e) or 76.59 of title 47 of the Code of Federal Regulations, or in the case of a television broadcast station licensed by an appropriate governmental authority of Canada or Mexico, the area in which it would be entitled to insist upon its signal being retransmitted if it were a television broadcast station subject to such rules, regulations, and authorizations. In the case of a low power television station, as defined by the rules and regulations of the Federal Communications Commission, the "local service area of a primary transmitter" comprises the area within 35 miles of the transmitter site, except that in the case of such a station located in a standard metropolitan statistical area which has one of the 50 largest populations of all standard metropolitan statistical areas (based on the 1980 decennial census of population taken by the Secretary of Commerce), the number of miles shall be 20 miles. The "local service area of a primary transmitter", in the case of a radio broadcast station, comprises the primary service area of such station, pursuant to the rules and regulations of the Federal Communications Commission.

The "local service area of a primary transmitter" for a television broadcast station includes the area where that station can require its signal to be retransmitted by a cable system according to the rules, regulations, and authorizations set by the Federal Communications Commission as of April 15, 1976, or the station's television market as defined in section 76.55(e) of title 47, Code of Federal Regulations (effective September 18, 1993), or any updates to that television market made on or after September 18, 1993, under section 76.55(e) or 76.59 of title 47 of the Code of Federal Regulations. For a television broadcast station licensed by the relevant government authority in Canada or Mexico, the area comprises where it could require its signal to be retransmitted if it were subject to those rules, regulations, and authorizations. For a low power television station, as defined by the Federal Communications Commission’s rules and regulations, the "local service area of a primary transmitter" refers to the area within 35 miles of the transmitter site, except if the station is in a standard metropolitan statistical area with one of the 50 largest populations based on the 1980 decennial census taken by the Secretary of Commerce, in which case the distance is 20 miles. The "local service area of a primary transmitter" for a radio broadcast station includes the primary service area of that station, according to the rules and regulations of the Federal Communications Commission.

A "distant signal equivalent" is the value assigned to the secondary transmission of any nonnetwork television programming carried by a cable system in whole or in part beyond the local service area of the primary transmitter of such programming. It is computed by assigning a value of one to each independent station and a value of one-quarter to each network station and noncommercial educational station for the nonnetwork programming so carried pursuant to the rules, regulations, and authorizations of the Federal Communications Commission. The foregoing values for independent, network, and noncommercial educational stations are subject, however, to the following exceptions and limitations. Where the rules and regulations of the Federal Communications Commission require a cable system to omit the further transmission of a particular program and such rules and regulations also permit the substitution of another program embodying a performance or display of a work in place of the omitted transmission, or where such rules and regulations in effect on the date of enactment of this Act permit a cable system, at its election, to effect such deletion and substitution of a nonlive program or to carry additional programs not transmitted by primary transmitters within whose local service area the cable system is located, no value shall be assigned for the substituted or additional program; where the rules, regulations, or authorizations of the Federal Communications Commission in effect on the date of enactment of this Act permit a cable system, at its election, to omit the further transmission of a particular program and such rules, regulations, or authorizations also permit the substitution of another program embodying a performance or display of a work in place of the omitted transmission, the value assigned for the substituted or additional program shall be, in the case of a live program, the value of one full distant signal equivalent multiplied by a fraction that has as its numerator the number of days in the year in which such substitution occurs and as its denominator the number of days in the year. In the case of a station carried pursuant to the late-night or specialty programming rules of the Federal Communications Commission, or a station carried on a part-time basis where full-time carriage is not possible because the cable system lacks the activated channel capacity to retransmit on a full-time basis all signals which it is authorized to carry, the values for independent, network, and noncommercial educational stations set forth above, as the case may be, shall be multiplied by a fraction which is equal to the ratio of the broadcast hours of such station carried by the cable system to the total broadcast hours of the station.

A "distant signal equivalent" is the value assigned to the secondary transmission of any non-network television programming carried by a cable system, either in full or in part, outside the local service area of the main transmitter of that programming. This value is calculated by giving a value of one to each independent station and a value of one-quarter to each network station and noncommercial educational station for the non-network programming carried according to the rules, regulations, and authorizations of the Federal Communications Commission. However, these values for independent, network, and noncommercial educational stations are subject to certain exceptions and limitations. If the Federal Communications Commission's rules and regulations require a cable system to stop transmitting a particular program and also allow the substitution of another program featuring a performance or display of a work instead of the omitted transmission, or if those rules and regulations in effect at the time this Act was enacted allow a cable system to choose to delete and substitute a non-live program or to air additional programs not transmitted by primary transmitters within the local service area of the cable system, then no value will be assigned for the substituted or additional program. Furthermore, if the rules, regulations, or authorizations of the Federal Communications Commission that were in effect at the time this Act was enacted allow a cable system the option to stop transmitting a specific program and also permit the substitution of another program featuring a performance or display of a work instead of the omitted transmission, the value assigned for the substituted or additional program will be, in the case of a live program, the value of one full distant signal equivalent multiplied by a fraction where the numerator is the number of days in the year that the substitution occurs and the denominator is the total number of days in the year. For a station carried under the late-night or specialty programming rules of the Federal Communications Commission, or a station carried on a part-time basis when full-time carriage isn’t possible due to the cable system lacking sufficient activated channel capacity to retransmit all authorized signals on a full-time basis, the values for independent, network, and noncommercial educational stations mentioned above will be multiplied by a fraction that represents the ratio of the broadcast hours for that station carried by the cable system to the total broadcast hours of the station.

A "network station" is a television broadcast station that is owned or operated by, or affiliated with, one or more of the television networks in the United States providing nationwide transmissions, and that transmits a substantial part of the programming supplied by such networks for a substantial part of that station's typical broadcast day.

A "network station" is a TV broadcast station that is owned, operated by, or partnered with one or more of the TV networks in the United States that provide nationwide broadcasts. It airs a significant portion of the programming offered by those networks for a considerable part of that station's regular broadcast day.

An "independent station" is a commercial television broadcast station other than a network station.

An "independent station" is a commercial TV broadcast station that isn't part of a network.

A "noncommercial educational station" is a television station that is a noncommercial educational broadcast station as defined in section 397 of title 47.

A "noncommercial educational station" is a TV station that is a noncommercial educational broadcast station as defined in section 397 of title 47.

Section 112. Limitations on exclusive rights: Ephemeral recordings [44]

(a)(1) Notwithstanding the provisions of section 106, and except in the case of a motion picture or other audiovisual work, it is not an infringement of copyright for a transmitting organization entitled to transmit to the public a performance or display of a work, under a license, including a statutory license under section 114(f), or transfer of the copyright or under the limitations on exclusive rights in sound recordings specified by section 114 (a) or for a transmitting organization that is a broadcast radio or television station licensed as such by the Federal Communications Commission and that makes a broadcast transmission of a performance of a sound recording in a digital format on a nonsubscription basis, to make no more than one copy or phonorecord of a particular transmission program embodying the performance or display, if-

(a)(1) Despite what section 106 says, and except for movies or other audiovisual works, it's not considered copyright infringement for a broadcasting organization that has the right to publicly transmit a performance or display of a work, under a license, including a statutory license under section 114(f), or transfer of the copyright, or under the limits on exclusive rights for sound recordings set out in section 114(a), or for a broadcasting organization that is a radio or television station licensed by the Federal Communications Commission that transmits a performance of a sound recording in a digital format without requiring a subscription, to make no more than one copy or phonorecord of a specific transmission program featuring the performance or display, if-

(A) the copy or phonorecord is retained and used solely by the transmitting organization that made it, and no further copies or phonorecords are reproduced from it; and

(A) the copy or phonorecord is kept and used only by the transmitting organization that created it, and no additional copies or phonorecords are made from it; and

(B) the copy or phonorecord is used solely for the transmitting organization's own transmissions within its local service area, or for purposes of archival preservation or security; and

(B) the copy or phonorecord is used only for the transmitting organization’s own broadcasts within its local service area, or for archival preservation or security purposes; and

(C) unless preserved exclusively for archival purposes, the copy or phonorecord is destroyed within six months from the date the transmission program was first transmitted to the public.

(C) unless kept only for archival purposes, the copy or phonorecord is destroyed within six months from the date the transmission program was first broadcast to the public.

(2) In a case in which a transmitting organization entitled to make a copy or phonorecord under paragraph (1) in connection with the transmission to the public of a performance or display of a work is prevented from making such copy or phonorecord by reason of the application by the copyright owner of technical measures that prevent the reproduction of the work, the copyright owner shall make available to the transmitting organization the necessary means for permitting the making of such copy or phonorecord as permitted under that paragraph, if it is technologically feasible and economically reasonable for the copyright owner to do so. If the copyright owner fails to do so in a timely manner in light of the transmitting organization's reasonable business requirements, the transmitting organization shall not be liable for a violation of section 1201(a)(1) of this title for engaging in such activities as are necessary to make such copies or phonorecords as permitted under paragraph (1) of this subsection.

(2) If a transmitting organization that can make a copy or phonorecord under paragraph (1) for publicly sharing a performance or display of a work is blocked from doing so because the copyright owner has applied technical measures to prevent the work's reproduction, the copyright owner must provide the transmitting organization with the necessary tools to allow for making that copy or phonorecord as allowed under that paragraph, as long as it’s technically feasible and economically reasonable for the copyright owner. If the copyright owner fails to do this in a timely manner considering the transmitting organization's reasonable business needs, the transmitting organization will not be held liable for a violation of section 1201(a)(1) of this title for taking the necessary actions to make such copies or phonorecords as allowed under paragraph (1) of this subsection.

(b) Notwithstanding the provisions of section 106, it is not an infringement of copyright for a governmental body or other nonprofit organization entitled to transmit a performance or display of a work, under section 110(2) or under the limitations on exclusive rights in sound recordings specified by section 114(a), to make no more than thirty copies or phonorecords of a particular transmission program embodying the performance or display, if

(b) Regardless of what section 106 says, it isn’t considered copyright infringement for a government agency or other nonprofit organization that has the right to broadcast a performance or show a work, under section 110(2) or under the restrictions on exclusive rights for sound recordings specified in section 114(a), to create no more than thirty copies or phonorecords of a specific broadcast program that contains the performance or display, if

(1) no further copies or phonorecords are reproduced from the copies or phonorecords made under this clause; and

(1) no additional copies or audio recordings are made from the copies or audio recordings created under this clause; and

(2) except for one copy or phonorecord that may be preserved exclusively for archival purposes, the copies or phonorecords are destroyed within seven years from the date the transmission program was first transmitted to the public.

(2) except for one copy or recording that may be kept only for archival purposes, the copies or recordings are destroyed within seven years from the date the transmission program was first aired to the public.

(c) Notwithstanding the provisions of section 106, it is not an infringement of copyright for a governmental body or other nonprofit organization to make for distribution no more than one copy or phonorecord, for each transmitting organization specified in clause (2) of this subsection, of a particular transmission program embodying a performance of a nondramatic musical work of a religious nature, or of a sound recording of such a musical work, if-

(c) Even with the rules in section 106, it's not considered copyright infringement for a government agency or other nonprofit organization to make one copy or recording for distribution for each transmitting organization mentioned in clause (2) of this subsection of a specific broadcast program featuring a performance of a religious-themed nondramatic musical work or a sound recording of that musical work, if-

(1) there is no direct or indirect charge for making or distributing any such copies or phonorecords; and

(1) there is no direct or indirect fee for creating or distributing any such copies or phonorecords; and

(2) none of such copies or phonorecords is used for any performance other than a single transmission to the public by a transmitting organization entitled to transmit to the public a performance of the work under a license or transfer of the copyright; and

(2) none of these copies or phonorecords is used for any performance other than a single broadcast to the public by an organization that has the right to transmit a performance of the work under a license or transfer of the copyright; and

(3) except for one copy or phonorecord that may be preserved exclusively for archival purposes, the copies or phonorecords are all destroyed within one year from the date the transmission program was first transmitted to the public.

(3) except for one copy or phonorecord that can be kept solely for archival reasons, all copies or phonorecords must be destroyed within one year from the date the transmission program was first aired to the public.

(d) Notwithstanding the provisions of section 106, it is not an infringement of copyright for a governmental body or other nonprofit organization entitled to transmit a performance of a work under section 110(8) to make no more than ten copies or phonorecords embodying the performance, or to permit the use of any such copy or phonorecord by any governmental body or nonprofit organization entitled to transmit a performance of a work under section 110(8), if-

(d) Despite what’s stated in section 106, it’s not a copyright violation for a government agency or other nonprofit organization allowed to broadcast a performance of a work under section 110(8) to make up to ten copies or phonorecords of that performance, or to allow any such copy or phonorecord to be used by any government agency or nonprofit organization permitted to broadcast a performance of a work under section 110(8), if-

(1) any such copy or phonorecord is retained and used solely by the organization that made it, or by a governmental body or nonprofit organization entitled to transmit a performance of a work under section 110(8), and no further copies or phonorecords are reproduced from it; and

(1) any such copy or phonorecord is kept and used only by the organization that created it, or by a government body or nonprofit organization allowed to transmit a performance of a work under section 110(8), and no additional copies or phonorecords are made from it; and

(2) any such copy or phonorecord is used solely for transmissions authorized under section 110(8), or for purposes of archival preservation or security; and

(2) any such copy or phonorecord is used only for transmissions authorized under section 110(8), or for archival preservation or security purposes; and

(3) the governmental body or nonprofit organization permitting any use of any such copy or phonorecord by any governmental body or nonprofit organization under this subsection does not make any charge for such use.

(3) the government body or nonprofit organization allowing any use of any such copy or phonorecord by any government body or nonprofit organization under this subsection does not charge for that use.

(e) Statutory License. (1) A transmitting organization entitled to transmit to the public a performance of a sound recording under the limitation on exclusive rights specified by section 114(d)(1)(C)(iv) or under a statutory license in accordance with section 114(f) is entitled to a statutory license, under the conditions specified by this subsection, to make no more than 1 phonorecord of the sound recording (unless the terms and conditions of the statutory license allow for more), if the following conditions are satisfied:

(e) Statutory License. (1) A transmitting organization that has the right to broadcast a performance of a sound recording under the exclusive rights limitation outlined in section 114(d)(1)(C)(iv) or under a statutory license per section 114(f) can obtain a statutory license, under the conditions specified in this subsection, to create no more than 1 phonorecord of the sound recording (unless the terms of the statutory license permit more), provided that the following conditions are met:

(A) The phonorecord is retained and used solely by the transmitting organization that made it, and no further phonorecords are reproduced from it.

(A) The phonorecord is kept and used only by the organization that created it, and no additional phonorecords are produced from it.

(B) The phonorecord is used solely for the transmitting organization's own transmissions originating in the United States under a statutory license in accordance with section 114(f) or the limitation on exclusive rights specified by section 114(d)(1)(C)(iv).

(B) The phonorecord is used only for the transmitting organization's own broadcasts originating in the United States under a statutory license as outlined in section 114(f) or the limitations on exclusive rights specified by section 114(d)(1)(C)(iv).

(C) Unless preserved exclusively for purposes of archival preservation, the phonorecord is destroyed within 6 months from the date the sound recording was first transmitted to the public using the phonorecord.

(C) Unless kept solely for archival purposes, the phonorecord is destroyed within 6 months from the date the sound recording was first transmitted to the public using the phonorecord.

(D) Phonorecords of the sound recording have been distributed to the public under the authority of the copyright owner or the copyright owner authorizes the transmitting entity to transmit the sound recording, and the transmitting entity makes the phonorecord under this subsection from a phonorecord lawfully made and acquired under the authority of the copyright owner.

(D) Phonorecords of the sound recording have been shared with the public by the copyright owner or the copyright owner has allowed the transmitting entity to share the sound recording, and the transmitting entity creates the phonorecord under this subsection from a phonorecord that was legally made and obtained with the copyright owner's permission.

(2) Notwithstanding any provision of the antitrust laws, any copyright owners of sound recordings and any transmitting organizations entitled to a statutory license under this subsection may negotiate and agree upon royalty rates and license terms and conditions for making phonorecords of such sound recordings under this section and the proportionate division of fees paid among copyright owners, and may designate common agents to negotiate, agree to, pay, or receive such royalty payments.

(2) Regardless of any part of the antitrust laws, copyright owners of sound recordings and any broadcasting organizations eligible for a statutory license under this subsection can negotiate and agree on royalty rates and licensing terms for producing phonorecords of those sound recordings under this section. They can also determine how to divide the fees paid among copyright owners and appoint common agents to negotiate, agree on, pay, or receive those royalty payments.

(3) No later than 30 days after the date of the enactment of the Digital Millennium Copyright Act, the Librarian of Congress shall cause notice to be published in the Federal Register of the initiation of voluntary negotiation proceedings for the purpose of determining reasonable terms and rates of royalty payments for the activities specified by paragraph (1) of this subsection during the period beginning on the date of the enactment of such Act and ending on December 31, 2000, or such other date as the parties may agree. Such rates shall include a minimum fee for each type of service offered by transmitting organizations. Any copyright owners of sound recordings or any transmitting organizations entitled to a statutory license under this subsection may submit to the Librarian of Congress licenses covering such activities with respect to such sound recordings. The parties to each negotiation proceeding shall bear their own costs.

(3) No later than 30 days after the Digital Millennium Copyright Act is enacted, the Librarian of Congress will publish a notice in the Federal Register to start voluntary negotiation proceedings aimed at establishing reasonable royalty payment terms and rates for the activities mentioned in paragraph (1) of this subsection. This will cover the period starting from the enactment date of this Act until December 31, 2000, or another date agreed upon by the parties. These rates must include a minimum fee for each type of service provided by transmitting organizations. Any copyright owners of sound recordings or any transmitting organizations eligible for a statutory license under this subsection can submit licenses for these activities related to those sound recordings to the Librarian of Congress. Each party involved in the negotiation process will be responsible for their own costs.

(4) In the absence of license agreements negotiated under paragraph (2), during the 60-day period commencing 6 months after publication of the notice specified in paragraph (3), and upon the filing of a petition in accordance with section 803(a)(1), the Librarian of Congress shall, pursuant to chapter 8, convene a copyright arbitration royalty panel to determine and publish in the Federal Register a schedule of reasonable rates and terms which, subject to paragraph (5), shall be binding on all copyright owners of sound recordings and transmitting organizations entitled to a statutory license under this subsection during the period beginning on the date of the enactment of the Digital Millennium Copyright Act and ending on December 31, 2000, or such other date as the parties may agree. Such rates shall include a minimum fee for each type of service offered by transmitting organizations. The copyright arbitration royalty panel shall establish rates that most clearly represent the fees that would have been negotiated in the marketplace between a willing buyer and a willing seller. In determining such rates and terms, the copyright arbitration royalty panel shall base its decision on economic, competitive, and programming information presented by the parties, including-

(4) If there are no license agreements made under paragraph (2), during the 60 days starting 6 months after the notice mentioned in paragraph (3) is published, and after filing a petition according to section 803(a)(1), the Librarian of Congress will, in line with chapter 8, gather a copyright arbitration royalty panel to determine and publish in the Federal Register a schedule of reasonable rates and terms which, subject to paragraph (5), will be binding on all copyright owners of sound recordings and transmitting organizations that qualify for a statutory license under this subsection from the date the Digital Millennium Copyright Act is enacted until December 31, 2000, or another date agreed upon by the parties. These rates will include a minimum fee for each type of service provided by transmitting organizations. The copyright arbitration royalty panel will set rates that best reflect the fees that would have been negotiated in the marketplace between a willing buyer and a willing seller. When determining these rates and terms, the copyright arbitration royalty panel will base its decision on economic, competitive, and programming information provided by the parties, including-

(A) whether use of the service may substitute for or may promote the sales of phonorecords or otherwise interferes with or enhances the copyright owner's traditional streams of revenue; and

(A) whether using the service could replace or boost the sales of music records or otherwise impacts or increases the copyright owner's usual sources of income; and

(B) the relative roles of the copyright owner and the transmitting organization in the copyrighted work and the service made available to the public with respect to relative creative contribution, technological contribution, capital investment, cost, and risk.

(B) the relative roles of the copyright owner and the transmitting organization in the copyrighted work and the service offered to the public concerning their creative contributions, technological contributions, capital investment, costs, and risks.

In establishing such rates and terms, the copyright arbitration royalty panel may consider the rates and terms under voluntary license agreements negotiated as provided in paragraphs (2) and (3). The Librarian of Congress shall also establish requirements by which copyright owners may receive reasonable notice of the use of their sound recordings under this section, and under which records of such use shall be kept and made available by transmitting organizations entitled to obtain a statutory license under this subsection.

In setting these rates and terms, the copyright arbitration royalty panel can look at the rates and terms from voluntary license agreements negotiated as described in paragraphs (2) and (3). The Librarian of Congress will also set up requirements for how copyright owners can receive reasonable notice about the use of their sound recordings under this section, and how records of such use will be kept and shared by organizations that have the right to obtain a statutory license under this subsection.

(5) License agreements voluntarily negotiated at any time between 1 or more copyright owners of sound recordings and 1 or more transmitting organizations entitled to obtain a statutory license under this subsection shall be given effect in lieu of any determination by a copyright arbitration royalty panel or decision by the Librarian of Congress.

(5) License agreements that are voluntarily negotiated at any time between one or more copyright owners of sound recordings and one or more broadcasting organizations entitled to obtain a statutory license under this subsection will be recognized instead of any ruling by a copyright arbitration royalty panel or decision by the Librarian of Congress.

(6) Publication of a notice of the initiation of voluntary negotiation proceedings as specified in paragraph (3) shall be repeated, in accordance with regulations that the Librarian of Congress shall prescribe, in the first week of January 2000, and at 2-year intervals thereafter, except to the extent that different years for the repeating of such proceedings may be determined in accordance with paragraph (3). The procedures specified in paragraph (4) shall be repeated, in accordance with regulations that the Librarian of Congress shall prescribe, upon filing of a petition in accordance with section 803(a) (1), during a 60-day period commencing on July 1, 2000, and at 2-year intervals thereafter, except to the extent that different years for the repeating of such proceedings may be determined in accordance with paragraph (3). The procedures specified in paragraph (4) shall be concluded in accordance with section 802.

(6) A notice announcing the start of voluntary negotiation proceedings mentioned in paragraph (3) will be published again, following regulations set by the Librarian of Congress, during the first week of January 2000, and then every two years after that, unless different years for repeating such proceedings are specified in paragraph (3). The procedures outlined in paragraph (4) will be repeated, according to regulations established by the Librarian of Congress, upon filing a petition as outlined in section 803(a)(1), during a 60-day period starting on July 1, 2000, and every two years thereafter, unless different years for repeating such proceedings are designated in paragraph (3). The procedures described in paragraph (4) will be completed according to section 802.

(7)(A) Any person who wishes to make a phonorecord of a sound recording under a statutory license in accordance with this subsection may do so without infringing the exclusive right of the copyright owner of the sound recording under section 106(1)

(7)(A) Anyone who wants to create a phonorecord of a sound recording under a statutory license according to this subsection can do so without violating the exclusive rights of the copyright owner of the sound recording as stated in section 106(1)

(i) by complying with such notice requirements as the Librarian of Congress shall prescribe by regulation and by paying royalty fees in accordance with this subsection; or

(i) by following the notice requirements set by the Librarian of Congress through regulation and by paying royalty fees according to this subsection; or

(ii) if such royalty fees have not been set, by agreeing to pay such royalty fees as shall be determined in accordance with this subsection.

(ii) if those royalty fees haven't been established, by agreeing to pay the royalty fees that will be determined according to this subsection.

(B) Any royalty payments in arrears shall be made on or before the 20th day of the month next succeeding the month in which the royalty fees are set.

(B) Any overdue royalty payments must be made on or before the 20th day of the month following the month in which the royalty fees are established.

(8) If a transmitting organization entitled to make a phonorecord under this subsection is prevented from making such phonorecord by reason of the application by the copyright owner of technical measures that prevent the reproduction of the sound recording, the copyright owner shall make available to the transmitting organization the necessary means for permitting the making of such phonorecord as permitted under this subsection, if it is technologically feasible and economically reasonable for the copyright owner to do so. If the copyright owner fails to do so in a timely manner in light of the transmitting organization's reasonable business requirements, the transmitting organization shall not be liable for a violation of section 1201(a)(1) of this title for engaging in such activities as are necessary to make such phonorecords as permitted under this subsection.

(8) If a broadcasting organization that has the right to make a phonorecord under this subsection is blocked from doing so because the copyright owner has implemented technical measures that stop the reproduction of the sound recording, the copyright owner must provide the broadcasting organization with the necessary means to create such phonorecords as allowed under this subsection, as long as it is technologically feasible and financially reasonable for the copyright owner. If the copyright owner does not do this in a timely manner considering the broadcasting organization's reasonable business needs, then the broadcasting organization will not be held liable for violating section 1201(a)(1) of this title for taking the actions needed to create those phonorecords as allowed under this subsection.

(9) Nothing in this subsection annuls, limits, impairs, or otherwise affects in any way the existence or value of any of the exclusive rights of the copyright owners in a sound recording, except as otherwise provided in this subsection, or in a musical work, including the exclusive rights to reproduce and distribute a sound recording or musical work, including by means of a digital phonorecord delivery, under section 106(1), 106(3), and 115, and the right to perform publicly a sound recording or musical work, including by means of a digital audio transmission, under sections 106(4) and 106(6).

(9) Nothing in this subsection cancels, limits, diminishes, or otherwise affects the existence or value of any of the exclusive rights held by copyright owners in a sound recording, except as stated in this subsection or in a musical work, including the exclusive rights to reproduce and distribute a sound recording or musical work, including through digital phonorecord delivery, under sections 106(1), 106(3), and 115, and the right to publicly perform a sound recording or musical work, including through digital audio transmission, under sections 106(4) and 106(6).

(f) The transmission program embodied in a copy or phonorecord made under this section is not subject to protection as a derivative work under this title except with the express consent of the owners of copyright in the preexisting works employed in the program.

(f) The transmission program included in a copy or phonorecord made under this section is not protected as a derivative work under this title unless the owners of copyright in the preexisting works used in the program give their explicit consent.

Section 113. Scope of exclusive rights in pictorial, graphic, and sculptural works [45]

(a) Subject to the provisions of subsections (b) and (c) of this section, the exclusive right to reproduce a copyrighted pictorial, graphic, or sculptural work in copies under section 106 includes the right to reproduce the work in or on any kind of article, whether useful or otherwise.

(a) According to the rules in subsections (b) and (c) of this section, the sole right to reproduce a copyrighted pictorial, graphic, or sculptural work in copies under section 106 includes the right to reproduce the work on any type of item, regardless of whether it's practical or not.

(b) This title does not afford, to the owner of copyright in a work that portrays a useful article as such, any greater or lesser rights with respect to the making, distribution, or display of the useful article so portrayed than those afforded to such works under the law, whether title 17 or the common law or statutes of a State, in effect on December 31, 1977, as held applicable and construed by a court in an action brought under this title.

(b) This title does not give the copyright owner of a work that shows a useful article any more or fewer rights regarding the creation, distribution, or display of that useful article than those granted to similar works by the law, whether it's title 17 or state laws in effect on December 31, 1977, as interpreted and enforced by a court in a case brought under this title.

(c) In the case of a work lawfully reproduced in useful articles that have been offered for sale or other distribution to the public, copyright does not include any right to prevent the making, distribution, or display of pictures or photographs of such articles in connection with advertisements or commentaries related to the distribution or display of such articles, or in connection with news reports.

(c) If a work is lawfully reproduced in useful items that are sold or distributed to the public, copyright doesn’t grant the right to stop the creation, distribution, or showing of pictures or photos of these items in relation to ads or commentary about their distribution or display, or in connection with news reports.

(d)(1) In a case in which-

(d)(1) In a scenario where-

(A) a work of visual art has been incorporated in or made part of a building in such a way that removing the work from the building will cause the destruction, distortion, mutilation, or other modification of the work as described in section 106A(a)(3), and

(A) a piece of visual art has been integrated into or attached to a building in such a way that taking the artwork out of the building will result in the destruction, distortion, mutilation, or other alteration of the work as outlined in section 106A(a)(3), and

(B) the author consented to the installation of the work in the building either before the effective date set forth in section 610(a) of the Visual Artists Rights Act of 1990, or in a written instrument executed on or after such effective date that is signed by the owner of the building and the author and that specifies that installation of the work may subject the work to destruction, distortion, mutilation, or other modification, by reason of its removal,

(B) the author agreed to have the work installed in the building either before the date specified in section 610(a) of the Visual Artists Rights Act of 1990, or in a written document signed on or after that date by both the owner of the building and the author, which states that installing the work could lead to its destruction, distortion, mutilation, or other changes due to its removal,

then the rights conferred by paragraphs (2) and (3) of section 106A(a) shall not apply.

then the rights granted by paragraphs (2) and (3) of section 106A(a) shall not apply.

(2) If the owner of a building wishes to remove a work of visual art which is a part of such building and which can be removed from the building without the destruction, distortion, mutilation, or other modification of the work as described in section 106A(a)(3), the author's rights under paragraphs (2) and (3) of section 106A(a) shall apply unless-

(2) If the owner of a building wants to take down a piece of visual art that is part of the building and can be removed without damaging, altering, or changing the work as mentioned in section 106A(a)(3), the author's rights under paragraphs (2) and (3) of section 106A(a) will apply unless-

(A) the owner has made a diligent, good faith attempt without success to notify the author of the owner's intended action affecting the work of visual art, or

(A) the owner has made a serious, honest effort to notify the author of the owner's planned action affecting the visual artwork, but was unsuccessful, or

(B) the owner did provide such notice in writing and the person so notified failed, within 90 days after receiving such notice, either to remove the work or to pay for its removal.

(B) the owner did provide that notice in writing and the person who was notified failed, within 90 days after receiving the notice, to either remove the work or to pay for its removal.

For purposes of subparagraph (A), an owner shall be presumed to have made a diligent, good faith attempt to send notice if the owner sent such notice by registered mail to the author at the most recent address of the author that was recorded with the Register of Copyrights pursuant to paragraph (3). If the work is removed at the expense of the author, title to that copy of the work shall be deemed to be in the author.

For the purposes of subsection (A), an owner is assumed to have made a reasonable, good faith effort to send notice if they sent that notice by registered mail to the author at the author's last address on file with the Register of Copyrights as outlined in paragraph (3). If the work is removed at the author's expense, ownership of that copy of the work will be considered to be with the author.

(3) The Register of Copyrights shall establish a system of records whereby any author of a work of visual art that has been incorporated in or made part of a building, may record his or her identity and address with the Copyright Office. The Register shall also establish procedures under which any such author may update the information so recorded, and procedures under which owners of buildings may record with the Copyright Office evidence of their efforts to comply with this subsection.

(3) The Register of Copyrights will set up a record system so that any visual artist whose work has been included in or become part of a building can register their identity and address with the Copyright Office. The Register will also create procedures that allow these artists to update their recorded information and procedures for building owners to submit proof of their efforts to comply with this section to the Copyright Office.

Section 114. Scope of exclusive rights in sound recordings [46]

(a) The exclusive rights of the owner of copyright in a sound recording are limited to the rights specified by clauses (1), (2), (3) and (6) of section 106, and do not include any right of performance under section 106(4).

(a) The special rights of the copyright owner in a sound recording are limited to the rights outlined in clauses (1), (2), (3), and (6) of section 106, and do not include any performance rights under section 106(4).

(b) The exclusive right of the owner of copyright in a sound recording under clause (1) of section 106 is limited to the right to duplicate the sound recording in the form of phonorecords or copies that directly or indirectly recapture the actual sounds fixed in the recording. The exclusive right of the owner of copyright in a sound recording under clause (2) of section 106 is limited to the right to prepare a derivative work in which the actual sounds fixed in the sound recording are rearranged, remixed, or otherwise altered in sequence or quality. The exclusive rights of the owner of copyright in a sound recording under clauses (1) and (2) of section 106 do not extend to the making or duplication of another sound recording that consists entirely of an independent fixation of other sounds, even though such sounds imitate or simulate those in the copyrighted sound recording. The exclusive rights of the owner of copyright in a sound recording under clauses (1), (2), and (3) of section 106 do not apply to sound recordings included in educational television and radio programs (as defined in section 397 of title 47) distributed or transmitted by or through public broadcasting entities (as defined by section 118(g)): *Provided*, That copies or phonorecords of said programs are not commercially distributed by or through public broadcasting entities to the general public.

(b) The exclusive right of the copyright owner for a sound recording under clause (1) of section 106 is limited to the right to duplicate the sound recording in the form of phonorecords or copies that directly or indirectly capture the actual sounds recorded. The exclusive right of the copyright owner for a sound recording under clause (2) of section 106 is limited to the right to create a derivative work where the actual sounds from the sound recording are rearranged, remixed, or otherwise modified in sequence or quality. The exclusive rights of the copyright owner for a sound recording under clauses (1) and (2) of section 106 do not include the creation or duplication of another sound recording that consists entirely of an independent recording of other sounds, even if those sounds resemble or imitate those in the copyrighted sound recording. The exclusive rights of the copyright owner for a sound recording under clauses (1), (2), and (3) of section 106 do not apply to sound recordings included in educational television and radio programs (as defined in section 397 of title 47) that are distributed or transmitted by public broadcasting entities (as defined by section 118(g)): *Provided*, That copies or phonorecords of these programs are not commercially distributed by or through public broadcasting entities to the general public.

(c) This section does not limit or impair the exclusive right to perform publicly, by means of a phonorecord, any of the works specified by section 106(4).

(c) This section does not limit or affect the exclusive right to publicly perform, through a phonorecord, any of the works mentioned in section 106(4).

(d) Limitations on Exclusive Right. Notwithstanding the provisions of section 106(6)-

(d) Limitations on Exclusive Right. Despite what is outlined in section 106(6)-

(1) Exempt transmissions and retransmissions. The performance of a sound recording publicly by means of a digital audio transmission, other than as a part of an interactive service, is not an infringement of section 106(6) if the performance is part of-

(1) Exempt transmissions and retransmissions. Playing a sound recording publicly through a digital audio transmission, as long as it’s not part of an interactive service, does not violate section 106(6) if the performance is part of-

(A) a nonsubscription broadcast transmission;

an ad-supported broadcast channel;

(B) a retransmission of a nonsubscription broadcast transmission: *Provided*, That, in the case of a retransmission of a radio station's broadcast transmission-

(B) a retransmission of a nonsubscription broadcast transmission: *Provided*, That, in the case of a retransmission of a radio station's broadcast transmission-

(i) the radio station's broadcast transmission is not willfully or repeatedly retransmitted more than a radius of 150 miles from the site of the radio broadcast transmitter, however-

(i) the radio station's broadcast transmission is not intentionally or repeatedly retransmitted more than 150 miles from the location of the radio broadcast transmitter, however-

(I) the 150 mile limitation under this clause shall not apply when a nonsubscription broadcast transmission by a radio station licensed by the Federal Communications Commission is retransmitted on a non- subscription basis by a terrestrial broadcast station, terrestrial translator, or terrestrial repeater licensed by the Federal Communications Commission; and

(I) the 150-mile limit in this clause will not apply when a non-subscription broadcast from a radio station licensed by the Federal Communications Commission is retransmitted on a non-subscription basis by a terrestrial broadcast station, terrestrial translator, or terrestrial repeater licensed by the Federal Communications Commission; and

(II) in the case of a subscription retransmission of a non-subscription broadcast retransmission covered by subclause (I), the 150 mile radius shall be measured from the transmitter site of such broadcast retransmitter;

(II) in the case of a subscription retransmission of a non-subscription broadcast retransmission covered by subclause (I), the 150-mile radius shall be measured from the transmitter site of that broadcast retransmitter;

(ii) the retransmission is of radio station broadcast transmissions that are

(ii) the retransmission is of radio station broadcast transmissions that

(I) obtained by the retransmitter over the air;

(I) obtained by the retransmitter through the air;

(II) not electronically processed by the retransmitter to deliver separate and discrete signals; and

(II) not processed electronically by the retransmitter to deliver separate and distinct signals; and

(III) retransmitted only within the local communities served by the retransmitter;

(III) retransmitted only within the local communities served by the retransmitter;

(iii) the radio station's broadcast transmission was being retransmitted to cable systems (as defined in section 111(f)) by a satellite carrier on January 1, 1995, and that retransmission was being retransmitted by cable systems as a separate and discrete signal, and the satellite carrier obtains the radio station's broadcast transmission in an analog format: *Provided*, That the broadcast transmission being retransmitted may embody the programming of no more than one radio station; or

(iii) the radio station's broadcast was being rebroadcast to cable systems (as defined in section 111(f)) by a satellite carrier on January 1, 1995, and that rebroadcast was being sent by cable systems as a separate and distinct signal, and the satellite carrier receives the radio station's broadcast in an analog format: *Provided*, That the broadcast being rebroadcast may include the programming of no more than one radio station; or

(iv) the radio station's broadcast transmission is made by a noncommercial educational broadcast station funded on or after January 1, 1995, under section 396(k) of the Communications Act of 1934 (47 U.S.C. 396(k)), consists solely of noncommercial educational and cultural radio programs, and the retransmission, whether or not simultaneous, is a nonsubscription terrestrial broadcast retransmission; or

(iv) the radio station's broadcast transmission is made by a noncommercial educational broadcast station funded on or after January 1, 1995, under section 396(k) of the Communications Act of 1934 (47 U.S.C. 396(k)), consists only of noncommercial educational and cultural radio programs, and the retransmission, whether simultaneous or not, is a nonsubscription terrestrial broadcast retransmission; or

(C) a transmission that comes within any of the following categories-

(C) a transmission that falls into any of the following categories-

(i) a prior or simultaneous transmission incidental to an exempt transmission, such as a feed received by and then retransmitted by an exempt transmitter: *Provided*, That such incidental transmissions do not include any subscription transmission directly for reception by members of the public;

(i) a previous or simultaneous transmission that is related to an exempt transmission, like a feed received and then retransmitted by an exempt transmitter: *Provided*, That these incidental transmissions do not include any subscription transmission directly for reception by the public;

(ii) a transmission within a business establishment, confined to its premises or the immediately surrounding vicinity;

(ii) a transmission that happens within a business, limited to its location or the nearby area;

(iii) a retransmission by any retransmitter, including a multichannel video programming distributor as defined in section 602(12) of the Communications Act of 1934 (47 U.S.C. 522 (12)), of a transmission by a transmitter licensed to publicly perform the sound recording as a part of that transmission, if the retransmission is simultaneous with the licensed transmission and authorized by the transmitter; or

(iii) a retransmission by any retransmitter, including a multichannel video programming distributor as defined in section 602(12) of the Communications Act of 1934 (47 U.S.C. 522 (12)), of a transmission by a transmitter licensed to publicly perform the sound recording as part of that transmission, as long as the retransmission occurs simultaneously with the licensed transmission and is authorized by the transmitter; or

(iv) a transmission to a business establishment for use in the ordinary course of its business: *Provided*, That the business recipient does not retransmit the transmission outside of its premises or the immediately surrounding vicinity, and that the transmission does not exceed the sound recording performance complement. Nothing in this clause shall limit the scope of the exemption in clause (ii).

(iv) a transmission to a business for use in its regular operations: *Provided*, That the business receiving it does not send the transmission outside its location or the nearby area, and that the transmission does not go beyond the sound recording performance complement. Nothing in this clause shall restrict the scope of the exemption in clause (ii).

(2) Statutory licensing of certain transmissions.-

(2) Legal licensing of specific broadcasts.-

The performance of a sound recording publicly by means of a subscription digital audio transmission not exempt under paragraph (1), an eligible nonsubscription transmission, or a transmission not exempt under paragraph (1) that is made by a preexisting satellite digital audio radio service shall be subject to statutory licensing, in accordance with subsection (f) if-

The performance of a sound recording publicly through a subscription digital audio transmission that isn't exempt under paragraph (1), an eligible nonsubscription transmission, or a transmission not exempt under paragraph (1) made by an existing satellite digital audio radio service will be subject to statutory licensing as stated in subsection (f) if-

(A)(i) the transmission is not part of an interactive service;

(A)(i) the transmission isn’t part of an interactive service;

(ii) except in the case of a transmission to a business establishment, the transmitting entity does not automatically and intentionally cause any device receiving the transmission to switch from one program channel to another; and

(ii) except when sending to a business, the transmitting entity does not automatically and intentionally make any device receiving the transmission switch from one program channel to another; and

(iii) except as provided in section 1002(e), the transmission of the sound recording is accompanied, if technically feasible, by the information encoded in that sound recording, if any, by or under the authority of the copyright owner of that sound recording, that identifies the title of the sound recording, the featured recording artist who performs on the sound recording, and related information, including information concerning the underlying musical work and its writer;

(iii) except as stated in section 1002(e), the transmission of the sound recording should include, if technically possible, any information encoded in that sound recording, provided by or authorized by the copyright owner, that identifies the title of the sound recording, the main artist performing on the recording, and related details, including information about the underlying musical work and its writer;

(B) in the case of a subscription transmission not exempt under paragraph (1) that is made by a preexisting subscription service in the same transmission medium used by such service on July 31, 1998, or in the case of a transmission not exempt under paragraph (1) that is made by a preexisting satellite digital audio radio service-

(B) if a subscription transmission doesn't qualify for an exemption under paragraph (1) and is made by an existing subscription service using the same transmission method they were using on July 31, 1998, or if it's a transmission not exempt under paragraph (1) made by a preexisting satellite digital audio radio service-

(i) the transmission does not exceed the sound recording performance complement; and

(i) the transmission doesn't go beyond the sound recording performance complement; and

(ii) the transmitting entity does not cause to be published by means of an advance program schedule or prior announcement the titles of the specific sound recordings or phonorecords embodying such sound recordings to be transmitted; and

(ii) the transmitting entity does not publish in advance a program schedule or prior announcement of the titles of the specific sound recordings or phonorecords containing those sound recordings to be transmitted; and

(C) in the case of an eligible nonsubscription transmission or a subscription transmission not exempt under paragraph (1) that is made by a new subscription service or by a preexisting subscription service other than in the same transmission medium used by such service on July 31, 1998-

(C) in the case of an eligible nonsubscription transmission or a subscription transmission that isn't exempt under paragraph (1) made by a new subscription service or by an existing subscription service, except in the same transmission medium used by that service on July 31, 1998—

(i) the transmission does not exceed the sound recording performance complement, except that this requirement shall not apply in the case of a retransmission of a broadcast transmission if the retransmission is made by a transmitting entity that does not have the right or ability to control the programming of the broadcast station making the broadcast transmission, unless-

(i) the transmission does not go beyond the sound recording performance complement, but this rule doesn’t apply when retransmitting a broadcast if the retransmitting entity doesn’t have the right or ability to control the programming of the broadcast station that is making the broadcast transmission, unless-

(I) the broadcast station makes broadcast transmissions-

(I) the broadcast station makes broadcast transmissions-

(aa) in digital format that regularly exceed the sound recording performance complement; or

(aa) in digital format that regularly surpasses the sound recording performance complement; or

(bb) in analog format, a substantial portion of which, on a weekly basis, exceed the sound recording performance complement; and

(bb) in analog format, a significant portion of which, on a weekly basis, exceeds the sound recording performance limit; and

(II) the sound recording copyright owner or its representative has notified the transmitting entity in writing that broadcast transmissions of the copyright owner's sound recordings exceed the sound recording performance complement as provided in this clause;

(II) the sound recording copyright owner or their representative has informed the transmitting entity in writing that broadcast transmissions of the copyright owner's sound recordings go beyond the sound recording performance limit as stated in this clause;

(ii) the transmitting entity does not cause to be published, or induce or facilitate the publication, by means of an advance program schedule or prior announcement, the titles of the specific sound recordings to be transmitted, the phonorecords embodying such sound recordings, or, other than for illustrative purposes, the names of the featured recording artists, except that this clause does not disqualify a transmitting entity that makes a prior announcement that a particular artist will be featured within an unspecified future time period, and in the case of a retransmission of a broadcast transmission by a transmitting entity that does not have the right or ability to control the programming of the broadcast transmission, the requirement of this clause shall not apply to a prior oral announcement by the broadcast station, or to an advance program schedule published, induced, or facilitated by the broadcast station, if the transmitting entity does not have actual knowledge and has not received written notice from the copyright owner or its representative that the broadcast station publishes or induces or facilitates the publication of such advance program schedule, or if such advance program schedule is a schedule of classical music programming published by the broadcast station in the same manner as published by that broadcast station on or before September 30, 1998;

(ii) the transmitting entity does not publish, encourage, or help publish, through an advance program schedule or prior announcement, the titles of specific sound recordings to be transmitted, the phonorecords containing those sound recordings, or, except for illustrative reasons, the names of the featured recording artists, provided that this clause does not disqualify a transmitting entity that announces in advance that a particular artist will be featured at an unspecified future time. In the case of rebroadcasting a transmission by a transmitting entity that cannot control the programming of the broadcast, this clause does not apply to a prior oral announcement by the broadcast station, or to an advance program schedule published, encouraged, or facilitated by the broadcast station, if the transmitting entity is not aware and has not received written notice from the copyright owner or its representative that the broadcast station publishes, encourages, or helps publish such an advance program schedule, or if such advance program schedule is a schedule of classical music programming published by the broadcast station in the same way it was published on or before September 30, 1998;

(iii) the transmission-

(iii) the broadcast-

(I) is not part of an archived program of less than 5 hours duration;

(I) is not part of a program that's archived and lasts less than 5 hours;

(II) is not part of an archived program of 5 hours or greater in duration that is made available for a period exceeding 2 weeks;

(II) is not part of an archived program that lasts 5 hours or more and is available for more than 2 weeks;

(III) is not part of a continuous program which is of less than 3 hours duration; or

(III) is not part of a continuous program that is less than 3 hours long; or

(IV) is not part of an identifiable program in which performances of sound recordings are rendered in a predetermined order, other than an archived or continuous program, that is transmitted at-

(IV) is not part of a specific program where sound recordings are played in a set order, except for an archived or ongoing program, that is transmitted at-

(aa) more than 3 times in any 2-week period that have been publicly announced in advance, in the case of a program of less than 1 hour in duration, or

(aa) more than 3 times in any 2-week period that have been publicly announced in advance, for programs that are less than 1 hour long, or

(bb) more than 4 times in any 2-week period that have been publicly announced in advance, in the case of a program of 1 hour or more in duration, except that the requirement of this subclause shall not apply in the case of a retransmission of a broadcast transmission by a transmitting entity that does not have the right or ability to control the programming of the broadcast transmission, unless the transmitting entity is given notice in writing by the copyright owner of the sound recording that the broadcast station makes broadcast transmissions that regularly violate such requirement;

(bb) more than 4 times in any 2-week period that have been publicly announced ahead of time, for programs that last 1 hour or longer, except that this rule doesn't apply to re-transmissions of a broadcast by a transmitting entity that can’t control the programming of the broadcast, unless the transmitting entity receives written notice from the copyright owner of the sound recording informing them that the broadcast station regularly violates this requirement;

(iv) the transmitting entity does not knowingly perform the sound recording, as part of a service that offers transmissions of visual images contemporaneously with transmissions of sound recordings, in a manner that is likely to cause confusion, to cause mistake, or to deceive, as to the affiliation, connection, or association of the copyright owner or featured recording artist with the transmitting entity or a particular product or service advertised by the transmitting entity, or as to the origin, sponsorship, or approval by the copyright owner or featured recording artist of the activities of the transmitting entity other than the performance of the sound recording itself;

(iv) the transmitting entity does not intentionally play the sound recording as part of a service that provides visual images at the same time as sound recordings in a way that is likely to confuse, mislead, or deceive anyone about the relationship, connection, or association of the copyright owner or featured recording artist with the transmitting entity or any specific product or service promoted by the transmitting entity, or about the source, sponsorship, or approval by the copyright owner or featured recording artist of the activities of the transmitting entity apart from the playing of the sound recording itself;

(v) the transmitting entity cooperates to prevent, to the extent feasible without imposing substantial costs or burdens, a transmission recipient or any other person or entity from automatically scanning the transmitting entity's transmissions alone or together with transmissions by other transmitting entities in order to select a particular sound recording to be transmitted to the transmission recipient, except that the requirement of this clause shall not apply to a satellite digital audio service that is in operation, or that is licensed by the Federal Communications Commission, on or before July 31, 1998;

(v) the transmitting entity works together to prevent, as much as possible without creating significant costs or difficulties, a transmission recipient or any other person or entity from automatically scanning the transmitting entity's transmissions alone or combined with other transmissions to choose a specific sound recording to send to the transmission recipient, except that this requirement does not apply to a satellite digital audio service that is operational or licensed by the Federal Communications Commission on or before July 31, 1998;

(vi) the transmitting entity takes no affirmative steps to cause or induce the making of a phonorecord by the transmission recipient, and if the technology used by the transmitting entity enables the transmitting entity to limit the making by the transmission recipient of phonorecords of the transmission directly in a digital format, the transmitting entity sets such technology to limit such making of phonorecords to the extent permitted by such technology;

(vi) the transmitting entity doesn’t actively try to cause or encourage the transmission recipient to make a phonorecord, and if the technology used by the transmitting entity allows it to prevent the transmission recipient from making phonorecords of the transmission directly in a digital format, the transmitting entity configures that technology to restrict such making of phonorecords as much as the technology allows;

(vii) phonorecords of the sound recording have been distributed to the public under the authority of the copyright owner or the copyright owner authorizes the transmitting entity to transmit the sound recording, and the transmitting entity makes the transmission from a phonorecord lawfully made under the authority of the copyright owner, except that the requirement of this clause shall not apply to a retransmission of a broadcast transmission by a transmitting entity that does not have the right or ability to control the programming of the broadcast transmission, unless the transmitting entity is given notice in writing by the copyright owner of the sound recording that the broadcast station makes broadcast transmissions that regularly violate such requirement;

(vii) phonorecords of the sound recording have been shared with the public under the permission of the copyright owner, or the copyright owner allows the transmitting entity to send out the sound recording, and the transmitting entity makes the transmission from a phonorecord that was lawfully created under the authority of the copyright owner. However, the requirements of this section do not apply to a retransmission of a broadcast by a transmitting entity that does not have the right or ability to control the broadcast's programming unless the transmitting entity receives a written notice from the copyright owner of the sound recording that the broadcast station regularly makes transmissions that violate this requirement;

(viii) the transmitting entity accommodates and does not interfere with the transmission of technical measures that are widely used by sound recording copyright owners to identify or protect copyrighted works, and that are technically feasible of being transmitted by the transmitting entity without imposing substantial costs on the transmitting entity or resulting in perceptible aural or visual degradation of the digital signal, except that the requirement of this clause shall not apply to a satellite digital audio service that is in operation, or that is licensed under the authority of the Federal Communications Commission, on or before July 31, 1998, to the extent that such service has designed, developed, or made commitments to procure equipment or technology that is not compatible with such technical measures before such technical measures are widely adopted by sound recording copyright owners; and

(viii) The transmitting entity supports and doesn’t disrupt the transmission of technical measures that are commonly used by music copyright owners to identify or protect their copyrighted works, and that can be transmitted by the transmitting entity without causing significant costs or noticeable decline in the quality of the digital signal. However, this requirement doesn’t apply to a satellite digital audio service that was operating or licensed by the Federal Communications Commission on or before July 31, 1998, as long as that service had designed, developed, or committed to buying equipment or technology that isn’t compatible with those technical measures before they were widely adopted by music copyright owners; and

(ix) the transmitting entity identifies in textual data the sound recording during, but not before, the time it is performed, including the title of the sound recording, the title of the phonorecord embodying such sound recording, if any, and the featured recording artist, in a manner to permit it to be displayed to the transmission recipient by the device or technology intended for receiving the service provided by the transmitting entity, except that the obligation in this clause shall not take effect until 1 year after the date of the enactment of the Digital Millennium Copyright Act and shall not apply in the case of a retransmission of a broadcast transmission by a transmitting entity that does not have the right or ability to control the programming of the broadcast transmission, or in the case in which devices or technology intended for receiving the service provided by the transmitting entity that have the capability to display such textual data are not common in the marketplace.

(ix) the transmitting entity identifies the sound recording in the text while it is being performed, but not before, including the sound recording's title, the title of the phonorecord that contains that sound recording, if applicable, and the featured recording artist, in a way that allows it to be displayed to the transmission recipient by the device or technology used to receive the service provided by the transmitting entity. However, this obligation will not take effect until one year after the Digital Millennium Copyright Act is enacted and does not apply in cases where a transmitting entity retransmits a broadcast transmission without the right or ability to control the programming of that broadcast, or when the devices or technology used to receive the service provided by the transmitting entity that can display this textual data are not common in the market.

(3) Licenses for transmissions by interactive services.-

(3) Licenses for transmissions by interactive services.-

(A) No interactive service shall be granted an exclusive license under section 106(6) for the performance of a sound recording publicly by means of digital audio transmission for a period in excess of 12 months, except that with respect to an exclusive license granted to an interactive service by a licensor that holds the copyright to 1,000 or fewer sound recordings, the period of such license shall not exceed 24 months: *Provided, however*, That the grantee of such exclusive license shall be ineligible to receive another exclusive license for the performance of that sound recording for a period of 13 months from the expiration of the prior exclusive license.

(A) No interactive service will be given an exclusive license under section 106(6) for publicly performing a sound recording through digital audio transmission for more than 12 months. However, if an exclusive license is granted to an interactive service by a licensor who owns the copyright to 1,000 or fewer sound recordings, the license can last up to 24 months. *Provided, however*, that the recipient of this exclusive license will not be able to get another exclusive license for that sound recording for 13 months after the previous exclusive license expires.

(B) The limitation set forth in subparagraph (A) of this paragraph shall not apply if-

(B) The restriction mentioned in subparagraph (A) of this paragraph will not apply if-

(i) the licensor has granted and there remain in effect licenses under section 106(6) for the public performance of sound recordings by means of digital audio transmission by at least 5 different interactive services; *Provided, however*, That each such license must be for a minimum of 10 percent of the copyrighted sound recordings owned by the licensor that have been licensed to interactive services, but in no event less than 50 sound recordings; or

(i) the licensor has granted and there are still active licenses under section 106(6) for the public performance of sound recordings through digital audio transmission by at least 5 different interactive services; *Provided, however*, That each license must cover at least 10 percent of the copyrighted sound recordings owned by the licensor that have been licensed to interactive services, but in no case less than 50 sound recordings; or

(ii) the exclusive license is granted to perform publicly up to 45 seconds of a sound recording and the sole purpose of the performance is to promote the distribution or performance of that sound recording.

(ii) the exclusive license allows for the public performance of up to 45 seconds of a sound recording, and the only purpose of the performance is to promote the distribution or performance of that sound recording.

(C) Notwithstanding the grant of an exclusive or nonexclusive license of the right of public performance under section 106(6), an interactive service may not publicly perform a sound recording unless a license has been granted for the public performance of any copyrighted musical work contained in the sound recording: *Provided*, That such license to publicly perform the copyrighted musical work may be granted either by a performing rights society representing the copyright owner or by the copyright owner.

(C) Regardless of whether an exclusive or nonexclusive license for the right of public performance is granted under section 106(6), an interactive service cannot publicly perform a sound recording unless it has received a license for the public performance of any copyrighted musical work included in the sound recording. *Provided*, that this license to publicly perform the copyrighted musical work can be granted either by a performing rights organization representing the copyright owner or directly by the copyright owner.

(D) The performance of a sound recording by means of a retransmission of a digital audio transmission is not an infringement of section 106(6) if-

(D) The performance of a sound recording through a retransmission of a digital audio transmission isn't a violation of section 106(6) if-

(i) the retransmission is of a transmission by an interactive service licensed to publicly perform the sound recording to a particular member of the public as part of that transmission; and

(i) the retransmission is of a broadcast by an interactive service licensed to publicly play the sound recording for a specific member of the public as part of that broadcast; and

(ii) the retransmission is simultaneous with the licensed transmission, authorized by the transmitter, and limited to that particular member of the public intended by the interactive service to be the recipient of the transmission.

(ii) the retransmission happens at the same time as the licensed transmission, is approved by the transmitter, and is restricted to that specific group of people that the interactive service aims to reach with the transmission.

(E) For the purposes of this paragraph-

(E) For the purposes of this paragraph—

(i) a "licensor" shall include the licensing entity and any other entity under any material degree of common ownership, management, or control that owns copyrights in sound recordings; and

(i) a "licensor" means the licensing organization and any other organization that has a significant degree of shared ownership, management, or control and owns copyrights in sound recordings; and

(ii) a "performing rights society" is an association or corporation that licenses the public performance of nondramatic musical works on behalf of the copyright owner, such as the American Society of Composers, Authors and Publishers, Broadcast Music, Inc., and SESAC, Inc.

(ii) a "performing rights society" is a group or company that grants permission for the public performance of non-dramatic musical works on behalf of the copyright owner, such as the American Society of Composers, Authors and Publishers, Broadcast Music, Inc., and SESAC, Inc.

(4) Rights not otherwise limited.-

Rights not otherwise restricted.

(A) Except as expressly provided in this section, this section does not limit or impair the exclusive right to perform a sound recording publicly by means of a digital audio transmission under section 106(6).

(A) Unless specifically stated otherwise in this section, this section does not restrict or diminish the exclusive right to publicly perform a sound recording through a digital audio transmission under section 106(6).

(B) Nothing in this section annuls or limits in any way-

(B) Nothing in this section cancels or restricts in any way-

(i) the exclusive right to publicly perform a musical work, including by means of a digital audio transmission, under section 106(4);

(i) the exclusive right to publicly perform a musical work, including through a digital audio transmission, under section 106(4);

(ii) the exclusive rights in a sound recording or the musical work embodied therein under sections 106(1), 106(2) and 106(3); or

(ii) the exclusive rights in a sound recording or the musical work contained within it under sections 106(1), 106(2), and 106(3); or

(iii) any other rights under any other clause of section 106, or remedies available under this title as such rights or remedies exist either before or after the date of enactment of the Digital Performance Right in Sound Recordings Act of 1995.

(iii) any other rights under any other clause of section 106, or remedies available under this title as those rights or remedies exist either before or after the enactment date of the Digital Performance Right in Sound Recordings Act of 1995.

(C) Any limitations in this section on the exclusive right under section 106(6) apply only to the exclusive right under section 106(6) and not to any other exclusive rights under section 106. Nothing in this section shall be construed to annul, limit, impair or otherwise affect in any way the ability of the owner of a copyright in a sound recording to exercise the rights under sections 106(1), 106(2) and 106(3), or to obtain the remedies available under this title pursuant to such rights, as such rights and remedies exist either before or after the date of enactment of the Digital Performance Right in Sound Recordings Act of 1995.

(C) Any limits in this section on the exclusive right under section 106(6) apply only to that specific right and not to any other exclusive rights under section 106. Nothing in this section should be interpreted as canceling, restricting, diminishing, or otherwise affecting the copyright owner’s ability to exercise the rights under sections 106(1), 106(2), and 106(3), or to access the remedies that are available under this title for those rights, as those rights and remedies exist whether before or after the law was enacted for the Digital Performance Right in Sound Recordings Act of 1995.

(e) Authority for Negotiations.-

Authority for Negotiations.

(1) Notwithstanding any provision of the antitrust laws, in negotiating statutory licenses in accordance with subsection (f), any copyright owners of sound recordings and any entities performing sound recordings affected by this section may negotiate and agree upon the royalty rates and license terms and conditions for the performance of such sound recordings and the proportionate division of fees paid among copyright owners, and may designate common agents on a nonexclusive basis to negotiate, agree to, pay, or receive payments.

(1) Regardless of any part of the antitrust laws, when negotiating statutory licenses under subsection (f), copyright owners of sound recordings and any entities performing those sound recordings affected by this section can negotiate and agree on the royalty rates and license terms and conditions for performing such sound recordings, as well as how to fairly divide the fees among copyright owners. They can also appoint common agents on a nonexclusive basis to negotiate, agree to, pay, or receive payments.

(2) For licenses granted under section 106(6), other than statutory licenses, such as for performances by interactive services or performances that exceed the sound recording performance complement

(2) For licenses given under section 106(6), apart from statutory licenses, like those for performances by interactive services or performances that go beyond the sound recording performance complement

(A) copyright owners of sound recordings affected by this section may designate common agents to act on their behalf to grant licenses and receive and remit royalty payments: *Provided*, That each copyright owner shall establish the royalty rates and material license terms and conditions unilaterally, that is, not in agreement, combination, or concert with other copyright owners of sound recordings; and

(A) Copyright owners of sound recordings impacted by this section can appoint common agents to represent them in granting licenses and managing royalty payments: *Provided*, That each copyright owner will set the royalty rates and important license terms and conditions independently, meaning, not in agreement, combination, or cooperation with other copyright owners of sound recordings; and

(B) entities performing sound recordings affected by this section may designate common agents to act on their behalf to obtain licenses and collect and pay royalty fees: *Provided*, That each entity performing sound recordings shall determine the royalty rates and material license terms and conditions unilaterally, that is, not in agreement, combination, or concert with other entities performing sound recordings.

(B) entities making sound recordings impacted by this section can choose common agents to represent them in getting licenses and handling royalty fees: *Provided*, That each entity making sound recordings will set the royalty rates and the terms and conditions of the license on their own, meaning not in agreement, collaboration, or partnership with other entities making sound recordings.

(f) Licenses for Certain Nonexempt Transmissions. [47]

(f) Licenses for Certain Nonexempt Transmissions. [47]

(1)(A) [48] No later than 30 days after the enactment of the Digital Performance Right in Sound Recordings Act of 1995, the Librarian of Congress shall cause notice to be published in the Federal Register of the initiation of voluntary negotiation proceedings for the purpose of determining reasonable terms and rates of royalty payments for subscription transmissions by preexisting subscription services and transmissions by preexisting satellite digital audio radio services specified by subsection (d)(2) of this section during the period beginning on the effective date of such Act and ending on December 31, 2001, or, if a copyright arbitration royalty panel is convened, ending 30 days after the Librarian issues and publishes in the Federal Register an order adopting the determination of the copyright arbitration royalty panel or an order setting the terms and rates (if the Librarian rejects the panel's determination). Such terms and rates shall distinguish among the different types of digital audio transmission services then in operation. Any copyright owners of sound recordings, preexisting subscription services, or preexisting satellite digital audio radio services may submit to the Librarian of Congress licenses covering such subscription transmissions with respect to such sound recordings. The parties to each negotiation proceeding shall bear their own costs.

(1)(A) [48] No later than 30 days after the Digital Performance Right in Sound Recordings Act of 1995 is enacted, the Librarian of Congress will publish a notice in the Federal Register about the start of voluntary negotiations to determine fair terms and rates for royalty payments for subscription transmissions by existing subscription services and transmissions by existing satellite digital audio radio services specified in subsection (d)(2) of this section. This will cover the period starting from the effective date of the Act until December 31, 2001, or, if a copyright arbitration royalty panel is convened, until 30 days after the Librarian issues and publishes in the Federal Register an order adopting the panel's determination or an order setting the terms and rates (if the Librarian rejects the panel's decision). These terms and rates will differentiate among the various types of digital audio transmission services in operation at that time. Any copyright owners of sound recordings, existing subscription services, or existing satellite digital audio radio services can submit licenses for these subscription transmissions regarding those sound recordings to the Librarian of Congress. Each party involved in the negotiation proceedings will cover their own costs.

(B) In the absence of license agreements negotiated under subparagraph (A), during the 60-day period commencing 6 months after publication of the notice specified in subparagraph (A), and upon the filing of a petition in accordance with section 803(a)(1), the Librarian of Congress shall, pursuant to chapter 8, convene a copyright arbitration royalty panel to determine and publish in the Federal Register a schedule of rates and terms which, subject to paragraph (3), shall be binding on all copyright owners of sound recordings and entities performing sound recordings affected by this paragraph. In establishing rates and terms for preexisting subscription services and preexisting satellite digital audio radio services, in addition to the objectives set forth in section 801(b)(1), the copyright arbitration royalty panel may consider the rates and terms for comparable types of subscription digital audio transmission services and comparable circumstances under voluntary license agreements negotiated as provided in subparagraph (A).

(B) If there are no license agreements made under subparagraph (A), during the 60-day period that starts 6 months after the publication of the notice mentioned in subparagraph (A), and after filing a petition according to section 803(a)(1), the Librarian of Congress will, as per chapter 8, bring together a copyright arbitration royalty panel to decide and publish in the Federal Register a schedule of rates and terms that, subject to paragraph (3), will be binding on all copyright owners of sound recordings and entities performing sound recordings impacted by this paragraph. When setting rates and terms for existing subscription services and existing satellite digital audio radio services, in addition to the goals outlined in section 801(b)(1), the copyright arbitration royalty panel can take into account the rates and terms for similar types of subscription digital audio transmission services and similar situations under voluntary license agreements negotiated as stated in subparagraph (A).

(C)(i) Publication of a notice of the initiation of voluntary negotiation proceedings as specified in subparagraph (A) shall be repeated, in accordance with regulations that the Librarian of Congress shall prescribe-

(C)(i) A notice about starting voluntary negotiation proceedings, as mentioned in subparagraph (A), will be published again, following the regulations set by the Librarian of Congress.

(I) no later than 30 days after a petition is filed by any copyright owners of sound recordings, any preexisting subscription services, or any preexisting satellite digital audio radio services indicating that a new type of subscription digital audio transmission service on which sound recordings are performed is or is about to become operational; and

(I) no later than 30 days after a petition is filed by any copyright owners of sound recordings, any existing subscription services, or any existing satellite digital audio radio services stating that a new kind of subscription digital audio transmission service featuring sound recordings is or is about to be operational; and

(II) in the first week of January 2001, and at 5-year intervals thereafter.

(II) in the first week of January 2001, and every 5 years after that.

(ii) The procedures specified in subparagraph (B) shall be repeated, in accordance with regulations that the Librarian of Congress shall prescribe, upon filing of a petition in accordance with section 803(a) (1) during a 60-day period commencing-

(ii) The procedures outlined in subparagraph (B) will be repeated, following the regulations set by the Librarian of Congress, when a petition is filed according to section 803(a)(1) during a 60-day period starting-

(I) 6 months after publication of a notice of the initiation of voluntary negotiation proceedings under subparagraph (A) pursuant to a petition under clause (i)(I) of this subparagraph; or

(I) 6 months after the publication of a notice that voluntary negotiation proceedings are starting under subparagraph (A) according to a petition under clause (i)(I) of this subparagraph; or

(II) on July 1, 2001, and at 5-year intervals thereafter.

(II) on July 1, 2001, and every 5 years after that.

(iii) The procedures specified in subparagraph (B) shall be concluded in accordance with section 802.

(iii) The procedures outlined in subparagraph (B) will be completed according to section 802.

(2)(A) No later than 30 days after the date of the enactment of the Digital Millennium Copyright Act, the Librarian of Congress shall cause notice to be published in the Federal Register of the initiation of voluntary negotiation proceedings for the purpose of determining reasonable terms and rates of royalty payments for public performances of sound recordings by means of eligible nonsubscription transmissions and transmissions by new subscription services specified by subsection (d)(2) during the period beginning on the date of the enactment of such Act and ending on December 31, 2000, or such other date as the parties may agree. Such rates and terms shall distinguish among the different types of eligible nonsubscription transmission services and new subscription services then in operation and shall include a minimum fee for each such type of service. Any copyright owners of sound recordings or any entities performing sound recordings affected by this paragraph may submit to the Librarian of Congress licenses covering such eligible nonsubscription transmissions and new subscription services with respect to such sound recordings. The parties to each negotiation proceeding shall bear their own costs.

(2)(A) No later than 30 days after the Digital Millennium Copyright Act is enacted, the Librarian of Congress will publish a notice in the Federal Register announcing the start of voluntary negotiations. The goal is to determine fair terms and rates for royalty payments for public performances of sound recordings through eligible nonsubscription transmissions and the new subscription services mentioned in subsection (d)(2). This will cover the period from the enactment date until December 31, 2000, or another date agreed upon by the parties. The rates and terms will differentiate between the various types of eligible nonsubscription transmission services and new subscription services that are operational at that time and will establish a minimum fee for each type of service. Any copyright owners of sound recordings or entities performing sound recordings impacted by this paragraph can submit licenses to the Librarian of Congress for these eligible nonsubscription transmissions and new subscription services. Each party involved in the negotiation will be responsible for their own costs.

(B) In the absence of license agreements negotiated under subparagraph (A), during the 60-day period commencing 6 months after publication of the notice specified in subparagraph (A), and upon the filing of a petition in accordance with section 803(a)(1), the Librarian of Congress shall, pursuant to chapter 8, convene a copyright arbitration royalty panel to determine and publish in the Federal Register a schedule of rates and terms which, subject to paragraph (3), shall be binding on all copyright owners of sound recordings and entities performing sound recordings affected by this paragraph during the period beginning on the date of the enactment of the Digital Millennium Copyright Act and ending on December 31, 2000, or such other date as the parties may agree. Such rates and terms shall distinguish among the different types of eligible nonsubscription transmission services then in operation and shall include a minimum fee for each such type of service, such differences to be based on criteria including, but not limited to, the quantity and nature of the use of sound recordings and the degree to which use of the service may substitute for or may promote the purchase of phonorecords by consumers. In establishing rates and terms for transmissions by eligible nonsubscription services and new subscription services, the copyright arbitration royalty panel shall establish rates and terms that most clearly represent the rates and terms that would have been negotiated in the marketplace between a willing buyer and a willing seller. In determining such rates and terms, the copyright arbitration royalty panel shall base its decision on economic, competitive and programming information presented by the parties, including-

(B) If there are no license agreements negotiated under subparagraph (A), during the 60-day period starting 6 months after the notice mentioned in subparagraph (A) is published, and after submitting a petition according to section 803(a)(1), the Librarian of Congress will, in line with chapter 8, set up a copyright arbitration royalty panel to determine and publish in the Federal Register a schedule of rates and terms. These rates and terms, subject to paragraph (3), will be binding on all copyright owners of sound recordings and entities performing sound recordings impacted by this paragraph from the date the Digital Millennium Copyright Act was enacted until December 31, 2000, or another date agreed upon by the parties. These rates and terms will differentiate among the various types of eligible nonsubscription transmission services available at that time and will include a minimum fee for each type of service. These differences will be based on criteria including, but not limited to, the amount and nature of use of sound recordings and how much the service may replace or encourage consumers to buy phonorecords. When establishing rates and terms for transmissions by eligible nonsubscription services and new subscription services, the copyright arbitration royalty panel will set rates and terms that best reflect what would have been negotiated in the market between a willing buyer and a willing seller. In making these determinations, the copyright arbitration royalty panel will consider economic, competitive, and programming information provided by the parties, including—

(i) whether use of the service may substitute for or may promote the sales of phonorecords or otherwise may interfere with or may enhance the sound recording copyright owner's other streams of revenue from its sound recordings; and

(i) whether using the service could replace or boost the sales of phonorecords or might disrupt or improve the sound recording copyright owner's other revenue sources from its sound recordings; and

(ii) the relative roles of the copyright owner and the transmitting entity in the copyrighted work and the service made available to the public with respect to relative creative contribution, technological contribution, capital in-vestment, cost, and risk.

(ii) the relative roles of the copyright owner and the transmitting entity in the copyrighted work and the service provided to the public regarding their creative contributions, technological contributions, investments, costs, and risks.

In establishing such rates and terms, the copyright arbitration royalty panel may consider the rates and terms for comparable types of digital audio transmission services and comparable circumstances under voluntary license agreements negotiated under subparagraph (A).

In setting these rates and terms, the copyright arbitration royalty panel can take into account the rates and terms for similar types of digital audio transmission services and similar situations under voluntary license agreements negotiated under subparagraph (A).

(C)(i) Publication of a notice of the initiation of voluntary negotiation proceedings as specified in subparagraph (A) shall be repeated in accordance with regulations that the Librarian of Congress shall prescribe-

(C)(i) A notice about starting voluntary negotiation proceedings as detailed in subparagraph (A) must be published again according to the regulations set by the Librarian of Congress.

(I) no later than 30 days after a petition is filed by any copyright owners of sound recordings or any eligible nonsubscription service or new subscription service indicating that a new type of eligible nonsubscription service or new subscription service on which sound recordings are performed is or is about to become operational; and

(I) no later than 30 days after a petition is filed by any copyright owners of sound recordings or any eligible nonsubscription service or new subscription service stating that a new type of eligible nonsubscription service or new subscription service, which will perform sound recordings, is or is about to start operating; and

(II) in the first week of January 2000, and at 2-year intervals thereafter, except to the extent that different years for the repeating of such proceedings may be determined in accordance with subparagraph (A).

(II) in the first week of January 2000, and every 2 years after that, unless different years for repeating such proceedings are decided in line with subparagraph (A).

(ii) The procedures specified in subparagraph (B) shall be repeated, in accordance with regulations that the Librarian of Congress shall prescribe, upon filing of a petition in accordance with section 803(a) (1) during a 60-day period commencing-

(ii) The procedures outlined in subparagraph (B) will be repeated, following the regulations set by the Librarian of Congress, when a petition is filed according to section 803(a)(1) during a 60-day period starting-

(I) 6 months after publication of a notice of the initiation of voluntary negotiation proceedings under subparagraph (A) pursuant to a petition under clause (i)(I); or

(I) 6 months after publishing a notice to start voluntary negotiation proceedings under subparagraph (A) following a petition under clause (i)(I); or

(II) on July 1, 2000, and at 2-year intervals thereafter, except to the extent that different years for the repeating of such proceedings may be determined in accordance with subparagraph (A).

(II) on July 1, 2000, and every 2 years after that, unless different years for repeating such proceedings are determined according to subparagraph (A).

(iii) The procedures specified in subparagraph (B) shall be concluded in accordance with section 802.

(iii) The procedures outlined in subparagraph (B) must be completed according to section 802.

(3) License agreements voluntarily negotiated at any time between 1 or more copyright owners of sound recordings and 1 or more entities performing sound recordings shall be given effect in lieu of any determination by a copyright arbitration royalty panel or decision by the Librarian of Congress.

(3) License agreements that are voluntarily negotiated at any time between one or more copyright owners of sound recordings and one or more entities performing those sound recordings will take precedence over any decision made by a copyright arbitration royalty panel or the Librarian of Congress.

(4)(A) The Librarian of Congress shall also establish requirements by which copyright owners may receive reasonable notice of the use of their sound recordings under this section, and under which records of such use shall be kept and made available by entities performing sound recordings.

(4)(A) The Librarian of Congress will also set up requirements so that copyright owners can get proper notice about the use of their sound recordings under this section, and will ensure that records of this use are maintained and accessible by the entities performing the sound recordings.

(B) Any person who wishes to perform a sound recording publicly by means of a transmission eligible for statutory licensing under this subsection may do so without infringing the exclusive right of the copyright owner of the sound recording-

(B) Anyone who wants to publicly perform a sound recording through a transmission that qualifies for statutory licensing under this section can do so without violating the copyright owner's exclusive rights to the sound recording.

(i) by complying with such notice requirements as the Librarian of Congress shall prescribe by regulation and by paying royalty fees in accordance with this subsection; or

(i) by following the notice requirements set by the Librarian of Congress through regulations and by paying royalty fees as specified in this subsection; or

(ii) if such royalty fees have not been set, by agreeing to pay such royalty fees as shall be determined in accordance with this subsection.

(ii) if those royalty fees haven't been established, by agreeing to pay the royalty fees that will be determined according to this subsection.

(C) Any royalty payments in arrears shall be made on or before the twentieth day of the month next succeeding the month in which the royalty fees are set.

(C) Any overdue royalty payments must be made on or before the twentieth day of the month following the month in which the royalty fees are established.

(g) Proceeds From Licensing of Transmissions.-

(g) Earnings from Licensing of Broadcasts.-

(1) Except in the case of a transmission licensed under a statutory license in accordance with subsection (f) of this section-

(1) Except for a transmission licensed under a statutory license according to subsection (f) of this section-

(A) a featured recording artist who performs on a sound recording that has been licensed for a transmission shall be entitled to receive payments from the copyright owner of the sound recording in accordance with the terms of the artist's contract; and

(A) a featured recording artist who performs on a sound recording that has been licensed for transmission shall be entitled to receive payments from the copyright owner of the sound recording according to the terms of the artist's contract; and

(B) a nonfeatured recording artist who performs on a sound recording that has been licensed for a transmission shall be entitled to receive payments from the copyright owner of the sound recording in accordance with the terms of the nonfeatured recording artist's applicable contract or other applicable agreement.

(B) a nonfeatured recording artist who performs on a sound recording that has been licensed for a transmission will be entitled to receive payments from the copyright owner of the sound recording based on the terms of the nonfeatured recording artist's relevant contract or other applicable agreement.

(2) The copyright owner of the exclusive right under section 106(6) of this title to publicly perform a sound recording by means of a digital audio transmission shall allocate to recording artists in the following manner its receipts from the statutory licensing of transmission performances of the sound recording in accordance with subsection (f) of this section:

(2) The copyright holder of the exclusive right under section 106(6) of this title to publicly perform a sound recording through digital audio transmission must allocate its revenue from the statutory licensing of transmission performances of the sound recording to recording artists in the following way, according to subsection (f) of this section:

(A) 21/2 percent of the receipts shall be deposited in an escrow account managed by an independent administrator jointly appointed by copyright owners of sound recordings and the American Federation of Musicians (or any successor entity) to be distributed to nonfeatured musicians (whether or not members of the American Federation of Musicians) who have performed on sound recordings.

(A) 2.5 percent of the earnings will be put into an escrow account managed by an independent administrator jointly chosen by the copyright owners of sound recordings and the American Federation of Musicians (or any successor organization) to be distributed to nonfeatured musicians (regardless of whether they are members of the American Federation of Musicians) who have performed on sound recordings.

(B) 21/2 percent of the receipts shall be deposited in an escrow account managed by an independent administrator jointly appointed by copyright owners of sound recordings and the American Federation of Television and Radio Artists (or any successor entity) to be distributed to nonfeatured vocalists (whether or not members of the American Federation of Television and Radio Artists) who have performed on sound recordings.

(B) 2.5 percent of the receipts will be put into an escrow account run by an independent administrator who is jointly chosen by the copyright owners of sound recordings and the American Federation of Television and Radio Artists (or any successor group) to be allocated to non-featured vocalists (regardless of whether they are members of the American Federation of Television and Radio Artists) who have performed on sound recordings.

(C) 45 percent of the receipts shall be allocated, on a per sound recording basis, to the recording artist or artists featured on such sound recording (or the persons conveying rights in the artists' performance in the sound recordings).

(C) 45 percent of the earnings shall be distributed, on a per sound recording basis, to the recording artist or artists featured on that sound recording (or to the individuals transferring rights in the artists' performance in the sound recordings).

(h) Licensing to Affiliates.-

Licensing for Affiliates.

(1) If the copyright owner of a sound recording licenses an affiliated entity the right to publicly perform a sound recording by means of a digital audio transmission under section 106(6), the copyright owner shall make the licensed sound recording available under section 106(6) on no less favorable terms and conditions to all bona fide entities that offer similar services, except that, if there are material differences in the scope of the requested license with respect to the type of service, the particular sound recordings licensed, the frequency of use, the number of subscribers served, or the duration, then the copyright owner may establish different terms and conditions for such other services.

(1) If the copyright owner of a sound recording allows a related entity to publicly perform a sound recording through digital audio transmission according to section 106(6), the copyright owner must make that licensed sound recording available under section 106(6) on terms and conditions that are no less favorable than those offered to all genuine entities that provide similar services. However, if there are significant differences in the requested license regarding the type of service, the specific sound recordings licensed, the frequency of use, the number of subscribers served, or the duration, then the copyright owner can set different terms and conditions for those other services.

(2) The limitation set forth in paragraph (1) of this subsection shall not apply in the case where the copyright owner of a sound recording licenses-

(2) The limitation mentioned in paragraph (1) of this subsection won't apply when the copyright owner of a sound recording grants a license-

(A) an interactive service; or

an interactive service, or

(B) an entity to perform publicly up to 45 seconds of the sound recording and the sole purpose of the performance is to promote the distribution or performance of that sound recording.

(B) an entity to perform publicly for up to 45 seconds of the sound recording, and the only purpose of the performance is to promote the distribution or performance of that sound recording.

(i) No Effect on Royalties for Underlying Works. License fees payable for the public performance of sound recordings under section 106(6) shall not be taken into account in any administrative, judicial, or other governmental proceeding to set or adjust the royalties payable to copyright owners of musical works for the public performance of their works. It is the intent of Congress that royalties payable to copyright owners of musical works for the public performance of their works shall not be diminished in any respect as a result of the rights granted by section 106(6).

(i) No Effect on Royalties for Underlying Works. License fees owed for the public performance of sound recordings under section 106(6) will not be considered in any administrative, judicial, or other governmental processes when determining or adjusting the royalties that copyright owners of musical works receive for the public performance of their works. Congress intends that the royalties received by copyright owners of musical works for the public performance of their works will not be reduced in any way due to the rights provided by section 106(6).

(j) Definitions. As used in this section, the following terms have the following meanings:

(j) Definitions. As used in this section, the following terms mean the following:

(l) An "affiliated entity" is an entity engaging in digital audio transmissions covered by section 106(6), other than an interactive service, in which the licensor has any direct or indirect partnership or any ownership interest amounting to 5 percent or more of the outstanding voting or non-voting stock.

(l) An "affiliated entity" is an entity involved in digital audio transmissions as described in section 106(6), excluding interactive services, where the licensor holds any direct or indirect partnership or any ownership stake of 5 percent or more of the total voting or non-voting stock.

(2) An "archived program" is a predetermined program that is available repeatedly on the demand of the transmission recipient and that is performed in the same order from the beginning, except that an archived program shall not include a re-corded event or broadcast transmission that makes no more than an incidental use of sound recordings, as long as such recorded event or broadcast transmission does not contain an entire sound recording or feature a particular sound recording.

(2) An "archived program" is a scheduled program that can be accessed repeatedly by the viewer whenever they want, and it runs in the same sequence from the start. However, an archived program isn’t allowed to include a recorded event or broadcast that only uses sound recordings incidentally, as long as that recorded event or broadcast doesn’t feature a whole sound recording or highlight a specific sound recording.

(3) A "broadcast" transmission is a transmission made by a terrestrial broadcast station licensed as such by the Federal Communications Commission.

(3) A "broadcast" transmission is a transmission made by a land-based broadcast station that has been licensed as such by the Federal Communications Commission.

(4) A "continuous program" is a predetermined program that is continuously performed in the same order and that is accessed at a point in the program that is beyond the control of the transmission recipient.

(4) A "continuous program" is a set program that is constantly executed in the same sequence and can be accessed at a point in the program that is beyond the control of the person receiving the transmission.

(5) A "digital audio transmission" is a digital transmission as defined in section 101, that embodies the transmission of a sound recording. This term does not include the transmission of any audiovisual work.

(5) A "digital audio transmission" is a digital transmission as defined in section 101 that involves the transfer of a sound recording. This term does not include the transfer of any audiovisual work.

(6) An "eligible nonsubscription transmission" is a noninteractive nonsubscription digital audio transmission not exempt under subsection (d)(1) that is made as part of a service that provides audio programming consisting, in whole or in part, of performances of sound recordings, including retransmissions of broadcast transmissions, if the primary purpose of the service is to provide to the public such audio or other entertainment programming, and the primary purpose of the service is not to sell, advertise, or promote particular products or services other than sound recordings, live concerts, or other music-related events.

(6) An "eligible nonsubscription transmission" is a noninteractive, nonsubscription digital audio transmission that isn't exempt under subsection (d)(1). It's part of a service that offers audio programming which includes, fully or partly, performances of sound recordings, including retransmissions of broadcast shows, as long as the main goal of the service is to provide the public with that audio or other entertainment content, and it's not primarily aimed at selling, advertising, or promoting specific products or services aside from sound recordings, live concerts, or other music-related events.

(7) An "interactive service" is one that enables a member of the public to receive a transmission of a program specially created for the recipient, or on request, a transmission of a particular sound recording, whether or not as part of a program, which is selected by or on behalf of the recipient. The ability of individuals to request that particular sound recordings be performed for reception by the public at large, or in the case of a subscription service, by all subscribers of the service, does not make a service interactive, if the programming on each channel of the service does not substantially consist of sound recordings that are performed within 1 hour of the request or at a time designated by either the transmitting entity or the individual making such request. If an entity offers both interactive and noninteractive services (either concurrently or at different times), the noninteractive component shall not be treated as part of an interactive service.

(7) An "interactive service" is one that allows a member of the public to receive a broadcast of a program created specifically for them, or upon request, a broadcast of a specific sound recording, whether or not it's part of a program, chosen by or for the individual. The ability for individuals to ask for particular sound recordings to be played for the public, or in the case of a subscription service, for all subscribers, doesn't make a service interactive if the programming on each channel doesn’t mainly consist of sound recordings played within an hour of the request or at a time set by either the broadcasting entity or the requester. If an entity provides both interactive and noninteractive services (either at the same time or at different times), the noninteractive part will not be considered part of an interactive service.

(8) A "new subscription service" is a service that performs sound recordings by means of noninteractive subscription digital audio transmissions and that is not a preexisting subscription service or a preexisting satellite digital audio radio service.

(8) A "new subscription service" is a service that delivers sound recordings through noninteractive subscription digital audio streams and is not a previously established subscription service or a previously established satellite digital audio radio service.

(9) A "nonsubscription" transmission is any transmission that is not a subscription transmission.

(9) A "nonsubscription" transmission is any transmission that isn't a subscription transmission.

(10) A "preexisting satellite digital audio radio service" is a subscription satellite digital audio radio service provided pursuant to a satellite digital audio radio service license issued by the Federal Communications Commission on or before July 31, 1998, and any renewal of such license to the extent of the scope of the original license, and may include a limited number of sample channels representative of the subscription service that are made available on a nonsubscription basis in order to promote the subscription service.

(10) A "preexisting satellite digital audio radio service" is a subscription-based satellite digital audio radio service offered under a satellite digital audio radio service license granted by the Federal Communications Commission before or on July 31, 1998, including any renewals of that license as long as they stay within the limits of the original license. It may also feature a small number of sample channels that represent the subscription service and are available for free to promote the subscription service.

(11) A "preexisting subscription service" is a service that performs sound recordings by means of noninteractive audio-only subscription digital audio transmissions, which was in existence and was making such transmissions to the public for a fee on or before July 31, 1998, and may include a limited number of sample channels representative of the subscription service that are made available on a nonsubscription basis in order to promote the subscription service.

(11) A "preexisting subscription service" is a service that provides sound recordings through noninteractive audio-only subscription digital audio transmissions, which was available and delivering such transmissions to the public for a fee on or before July 31, 1998. It may also offer a few sample channels that represent the subscription service, available on a nonsubscription basis to promote the service.

(12) A "retransmission" is a further transmission of an initial transmission, and includes any further retransmission of the same transmission. Except as provided in this section, a transmission qualifies as a "retransmission" only if it is simultaneous with the initial transmission. Nothing in this definition shall be construed to exempt a transmission that fails to satisfy a separate element required to qualify for an exemption under section 114(d)(1).

(12) A "retransmission" is an additional transmission of an original transmission and includes any subsequent retransmission of the same transmission. Except as stated in this section, a transmission counts as a "retransmission" only if it occurs simultaneously with the original transmission. Nothing in this definition should be interpreted as exempting a transmission that doesn't meet a separate requirement needed to qualify for an exemption under section 114(d)(1).

(13) The "sound recording performance complement" is the transmission during any 3-hour period, on a particular channel used by a transmitting entity, of no more than-

(13) The "sound recording performance complement" is the transmission during any 3-hour period, on a specific channel used by a transmitting entity, of no more than-

(A) 3 different selections of sound recordings from any one phonorecord lawfully distributed for public performance or sale in the United States, if no more than 2 such selections are transmitted consecutively; or

(A) 3 different sound recordings from any one phonorecord that are legally distributed for public performance or sale in the United States, as long as no more than 2 of these recordings are played one after the other; or

(B) 4 different selections of sound recordings-

(B) 4 different choices of sound recordings-

(i) by the same featured recording artist; or

(i) by the same highlighted recording artist; or

(ii) from any set or compilation of phonorecords lawfully distributed together as a unit for public performance or sale in the United States, if no more than three such selections are transmitted consecutively:

(ii) from any collection or compilation of phonorecords legally distributed together as a unit for public performance or sale in the United States, if no more than three of those selections are transmitted one after the other:

*Provided*, That the transmission of selections in excess of the numerical limits provided for in clauses (A) and (B) from multiple phonorecords shall nonetheless qualify as a sound recording performance complement if the programming of the multiple phonorecords was not willfully intended to avoid the numerical limitations prescribed in such clauses.

*Provided*, That the transmission of selections beyond the numerical limits set in clauses (A) and (B) from multiple phonorecords will still qualify as a sound recording performance complement if the programming of the multiple phonorecords was not intentionally designed to evade the numerical limitations outlined in those clauses.

(14) A "subscription" transmission is a transmission that is controlled and limited to particular recipients, and for which consideration is required to be paid or otherwise given by or on behalf of the recipient to receive the transmission or a package of transmissions including the transmission.

(14) A "subscription" transmission is a transmission that is regulated and restricted to specific recipients, and for which payment or some form of compensation is required from or on behalf of the recipient to access the transmission or a collection of transmissions that includes the transmission.

(15) A "transmission" is either an initial transmission or a retransmission.

(15) A "transmission" is either the first transmission or a retransmission.

Section 115. Scope of exclusive rights in nondramatic musical works: Compulsory license for making and distributing phonorecords [49]

In the case of nondramatic musical works, the exclusive rights provided by clauses (1) and (3) of section 106, to make and to distribute phonorecords of such works, are subject to compulsory licensing under the conditions specified by this section.

In the case of non-dramatic musical works, the exclusive rights granted by clauses (1) and (3) of section 106, to create and distribute phonorecords of these works, are subject to compulsory licensing under the conditions outlined in this section.

(a) Availability and Scope of Compulsory License.-

(a) Availability and Scope of Compulsory License.-

(1) When phonorecords of a nondramatic musical work have been distributed to the public in the United States under the authority of the copyright owner, any other person, including those who make phonorecords or digital phonorecord deliveries, may, by complying with the provisions of this section, obtain a compulsory license to make and distribute phonorecords of the work. A person may obtain a compulsory license only if his or her primary purpose in making phonorecords is to distribute them to the public for private use, including by means of a digital phonorecord delivery. A person may not obtain a compulsory license for use of the work in the making of phonorecords duplicating a sound recording fixed by another, unless:

(1) When recordings of a non-dramatic musical work have been made available to the public in the United States with the permission of the copyright owner, anyone else, including those who create recordings or digital recordings, can, by following the rules in this section, get a compulsory license to make and distribute recordings of the work. A person can obtain a compulsory license only if their main goal in making recordings is to distribute them to the public for personal use, including through digital delivery. A person cannot get a compulsory license to use the work for making recordings that duplicate a sound recording created by someone else, unless:

(i) such sound recording was fixed lawfully; and

(i) that sound recording was lawfully made; and

(ii) the making of the phonorecords was authorized by the owner of copyright in the sound recording or, if the sound recording was fixed before February 15, 1972, by any person who fixed the sound recording pursuant to an express license from the owner of the copyright in the musical work or pursuant to a valid compulsory license for use of such work in a sound recording.

(ii) the creation of the phonorecords was approved by the copyright owner of the sound recording or, if the sound recording was created before February 15, 1972, by anyone who created the sound recording under an explicit license from the copyright owner of the musical work or under a valid compulsory license for using that work in a sound recording.

(2) A compulsory license includes the privilege of making a musical arrangement of the work to the extent necessary to conform it to the style or manner of interpretation of the performance involved, but the arrangement shall not change the basic melody or fundamental character of the work, and shall not be subject to protection as a derivative work under this title, except with the express consent of the copyright owner.

(2) A compulsory license allows the creation of a musical arrangement of the work as needed to fit the style or interpretation of the performance, but the arrangement must not alter the basic melody or essential character of the work and cannot be considered a derivative work under this title, unless the copyright owner explicitly agrees.

(b) Notice of Intention to Obtain Compulsory License.-

(b) Notice of Intention to Get a Compulsory License.-

(1) Any person who wishes to obtain a compulsory license under this section shall, before or within thirty days after making, and before distributing any phonorecords of the work, serve notice of intention to do so on the copyright owner. If the registration or other public records of the Copyright Office do not identify the copyright owner and include an address at which notice can be served, it shall be sufficient to file the notice of intention in the Copyright Office. The notice shall comply, in form, content, and manner of service, with requirements that the Register of Copyrights shall prescribe by regulation.

(1) Anyone who wants to get a compulsory license under this section must serve a notice of intention to the copyright owner before or within thirty days of making, and before distributing any phonorecords of the work. If the registration or other public records of the Copyright Office don’t identify the copyright owner and provide an address for serving notice, it’s enough to file the notice of intention with the Copyright Office. The notice must meet the form, content, and service requirements outlined by the Register of Copyrights in regulations.

(2) Failure to serve or file the notice required by clause (1) forecloses the possibility of a compulsory license and, in the absence of a negotiated license, renders the making and distribution of phonorecords actionable as acts of infringement under section 501 and fully subject to the remedies provided by sections 502 through 506 and 509.

(2) Not serving or filing the notice required by clause (1) eliminates the option for a compulsory license and, if there’s no negotiated license, makes the creation and distribution of phonorecords liable as acts of infringement under section 501 and completely subject to the remedies outlined in sections 502 through 506 and 509.

(c) Royalty Payable Under Compulsory License. [50]-

(c) Royalty Payable Under Compulsory License. [50]-

(1) To be entitled to receive royalties under a compulsory license, the copyright owner must be identified in the registration or other public records of the Copyright Office. The owner is entitled to royalties for phonorecords made and distributed after being so identified, but is not entitled to recover for any phonorecords previously made and distributed.

(1) To qualify for receiving royalties under a mandatory license, the copyright owner must be listed in the registration or other public records of the Copyright Office. The owner is entitled to royalties for phonorecords produced and distributed after being identified, but cannot recover for any phonorecords that were made and distributed before that identification.

(2) Except as provided by clause (1), the royalty under a compulsory license shall be payable for every phonorecord made and distributed in accordance with the license. For this purpose, and other than as provided in paragraph (3), a phonorecord is considered "distributed" if the person exercising the compulsory license has voluntarily and permanently parted with its possession. With respect to each work embodied in the phonorecord, the royalty shall be either two and three- fourths cents, or one-half of one cent per minute of playing time or fraction thereof, whichever amount is larger. [51]

(2) Unless stated otherwise in clause (1), the royalty for a compulsory license must be paid for every phonorecord produced and distributed under the license. In this context, and aside from what's mentioned in paragraph (3), a phonorecord is considered "distributed" when the person using the compulsory license has willingly and permanently given up possession of it. For each work included in the phonorecord, the royalty will be either two and three-fourths cents or one-half of one cent per minute of playing time or any part of a minute, whichever amount is greater. [51]

(3)(A) A compulsory license under this section includes the right of the compulsory licensee to distribute or authorize the distribution of a phonorecord of a nondramatic musical work by means of a digital transmission which constitutes a digital phonorecord delivery, regardless of whether the digital transmission is also a public performance of the sound recording under section 106(6) of this title or of any nondramatic musical work embodied therein under section 106(4) of this title. For every digital phonorecord delivery by or under the authority of the compulsory licensee-

(3)(A) A compulsory license under this section grants the compulsory licensee the right to distribute or allow the distribution of a phonorecord of a non-dramatic musical work through a digital transmission that counts as a digital phonorecord delivery, regardless of whether the digital transmission is also considered a public performance of the sound recording under section 106(6) of this title or of any non-dramatic musical work included in it under section 106(4) of this title. For each digital phonorecord delivery made by or authorized by the compulsory licensee-

(i) on or before December 31, 1997, the royalty payable by the compulsory licensee shall be the royalty prescribed under paragraph (2) and chapter 8 of this title; and

(i) on or before December 31, 1997, the royalty owed by the compulsory licensee shall be the royalty specified in paragraph (2) and chapter 8 of this title; and

(ii) on or after January 1, 1998, the royalty payable by the compulsory licensee shall be the royalty prescribed under subparagraphs (B) through (F) and chapter 8 of this title.

(ii) on or after January 1, 1998, the royalty to be paid by the mandatory licensee will be the royalty outlined in subparagraphs (B) through (F) and chapter 8 of this title.

(B) Notwithstanding any provision of the antitrust laws, any copyright owners of nondramatic musical works and any persons entitled to obtain a compulsory license under subsection (a)(1) may negotiate and agree upon the terms and rates of royalty payments under this paragraph and the proportionate division of fees paid among copyright owners, and may designate common agents to negotiate, agree to, pay or receive such royalty payments. Such authority to negotiate the terms and rates of royalty payments includes, but is not limited to, the authority to negotiate the year during which the royalty rates prescribed under subparagraphs (B) through (F) and chapter 8 of this title shall next be determined.

(B) Regardless of any part of the antitrust laws, any copyright owners of non-dramatic musical works and anyone eligible to get a compulsory license under subsection (a)(1) can negotiate and agree on the terms and rates of royalty payments mentioned in this paragraph, as well as how to divide the fees among copyright owners. They can also appoint common agents to negotiate, agree to, pay, or receive those royalty payments. This authority to negotiate terms and rates of royalty payments includes, but is not limited to, the ability to negotiate the year when the royalty rates outlined in subparagraphs (B) through (F) and chapter 8 of this title will be next determined.

(C) During the period of June 30, 1996, through December 31, 1996, the Librarian of Congress shall cause notice to be published in the Federal Register of the initiation of voluntary negotiation proceedings for the purpose of determining reasonable terms and rates of royalty payments for the activities specified by subparagraph (A) during the period beginning January 1, 1998, and ending on the effective date of any new terms and rates established pursuant to subparagraph (C), (D) or (F), or such other date (regarding digital phonorecord deliveries) as the parties may agree. Such terms and rates shall distinguish between (i) digital phonorecord deliveries where the reproduction or distribution of a phonorecord is incidental to the transmission which constitutes the digital phonorecord delivery, and (ii) digital phonorecord deliveries in general. Any copyright owners of nondramatic musical works and any persons entitled to obtain a compulsory license under subsection (a)(1) may submit to the Librarian of Congress licenses covering such activities. The parties to each negotiation proceeding shall bear their own costs.

(C) From June 30, 1996, to December 31, 1996, the Librarian of Congress will publish a notice in the Federal Register announcing the start of voluntary negotiations to determine fair terms and rates for royalty payments related to the activities mentioned in subparagraph (A) for the period beginning January 1, 1998, until any new terms and rates are put in place under subparagraphs (C), (D), or (F), or another agreed-upon date regarding digital phonorecord deliveries. These terms and rates will differentiate between (i) digital phonorecord deliveries where copying or distributing a phonorecord is secondary to the transmission that makes up the digital phonorecord delivery, and (ii) digital phonorecord deliveries in general. Any copyright holders of nondramatic musical works and anyone eligible for a compulsory license under subsection (a)(1) can submit licenses covering these activities to the Librarian of Congress. Each party involved in the negotiation will be responsible for their own costs.

(D) In the absence of license agreements negotiated under subparagraphs (B) and (C), upon the filing of a petition in accordance with section 803(a)(1), the Librarian of Congress shall, pursuant to chapter 8, convene a copyright arbitration royalty panel to determine a schedule of rates and terms which, subject to subparagraph (E), shall be binding on all copyright owners of nondramatic musical works and persons entitled to obtain a compulsory license under subsection (a)(1) during the period beginning January 1, 1998, and ending on the effective date of any new terms and rates established pursuant to subparagraph (C), (D) or (F), or such other date (regarding digital phonorecord deliveries) as may be determined pursuant to subparagraphs (B) and (C). Such terms and rates shall distinguish between (i) digital phonorecord deliveries where the reproduction or distribution of a phonorecord is incidental to the transmission which constitutes the digital phonorecord delivery, and (ii) digital phonorecord deliveries in general. In addition to the objectives set forth in section 801(b)(1), in establishing such rates and terms, the copyright arbitration royalty panel may consider rates and terms under voluntary license agreements negotiated as provided in subparagraphs (B) and (C). The royalty rates payable for a compulsory license for a digital phonorecord delivery under this section shall be established de novo and no precedential effect shall be given to the amount of the royalty payable by a compulsory licensee for digital phonorecord deliveries on or before December 31, 1997. The Librarian of Congress shall also establish requirements by which copyright owners may receive reasonable notice of the use of their works under this section, and under which records of such use shall be kept and made available by persons making digital phonorecord deliveries.

(D) If there are no license agreements negotiated under subparagraphs (B) and (C), when a petition is filed according to section 803(a)(1), the Librarian of Congress will, according to chapter 8, set up a copyright arbitration royalty panel to decide on a schedule of rates and terms that, subject to subparagraph (E), will be binding for all copyright owners of nondramatic musical works and individuals who are entitled to obtain a compulsory license under subsection (a)(1) from January 1, 1998, until the effective date of any new terms and rates set under subparagraphs (C), (D), or (F), or any other date (related to digital phonorecord deliveries) as determined by subparagraphs (B) and (C). These terms and rates will differentiate between (i) digital phonorecord deliveries where the reproduction or distribution of a phonorecord is incidental to the transmission that makes up the digital phonorecord delivery, and (ii) digital phonorecord deliveries in general. Alongside the goals stated in section 801(b)(1), when setting these rates and terms, the copyright arbitration royalty panel can consider rates and terms from voluntary license agreements negotiated as described in subparagraphs (B) and (C). The royalty rates payable for a compulsory license for a digital phonorecord delivery under this section will be set from scratch, and previous royalty amounts paid by a compulsory licensee for digital phonorecord deliveries on or before December 31, 1997, will have no precedent. The Librarian of Congress will also establish requirements for copyright owners to receive reasonable notice of the use of their works under this section, and how records of such use should be maintained and made accessible by individuals making digital phonorecord deliveries.

(E)(i) License agreements voluntarily negotiated at any time between one or more copyright owners of nondramatic musical works and one or more persons entitled to obtain a compulsory license under subsection (a)(1) shall be given effect in lieu of any determination by the Librarian of Congress. Subject to clause (ii), the royalty rates determined pursuant to subparagraph (C), (D) or (F) shall be given effect in lieu of any contrary royalty rates specified in a contract pursuant to which a recording artist who is the author of a nondramatic musical work grants a license under that person's exclusive rights in the musical work under paragraphs (1) and (3) of section 106 or commits another person to grant a license in that musical work under paragraphs (1) and (3) of section 106, to a person desiring to fix in a tangible medium of expression a sound recording embodying the musical work.

(E)(i) License agreements that are freely negotiated at any time between one or more copyright owners of nondramatic musical works and one or more individuals entitled to get a compulsory license under subsection (a)(1) will take precedence over any decision made by the Librarian of Congress. Subject to clause (ii), the royalty rates set according to subparagraph (C), (D), or (F) will take precedence over any conflicting royalty rates specified in a contract where a recording artist, who is the author of a nondramatic musical work, grants a license for that person's exclusive rights in the musical work under paragraphs (1) and (3) of section 106 or involves another person in granting a license for that musical work under paragraphs (1) and (3) of section 106, to someone wanting to fix a sound recording that includes the musical work in a tangible medium of expression.

(ii) The second sentence of clause (i) shall not apply to-

(ii) The second sentence of clause (i) doesn't apply to-

(I) a contract entered into on or before June 22, 1995 and not modified thereafter for the purpose of reducing the royalty rates determined pursuant to subparagraph (C), (D) or (F) or of increasing the number of musical works within the scope of the contract covered by the reduced rates, except if a contract entered into on or before June 22, 1995, is modified thereafter for the purpose of increasing the number of musical works within the scope of the contract, any contrary royalty rates specified in the contract shall be given effect in lieu of royalty rates determined pursuant to subparagraph (C), (D) or (F) for the number of musical works within the scope of the contract as of June 22, 1995; and

(I) a contract made on or before June 22, 1995, and not changed afterward to lower the royalty rates set according to subparagraph (C), (D), or (F), or to increase the number of musical works included in the contract that are covered by the lower rates, unless a contract made on or before June 22, 1995, is modified later to increase the number of musical works included in the contract, in which case any conflicting royalty rates stated in the contract will take precedence over the royalty rates set according to subparagraph (C), (D), or (F) for the number of musical works included in the contract as of June 22, 1995; and

(II) a contract entered into after the date that the sound recording is fixed in a tangible medium of expression substantially in a form intended for commercial release, if at the time the contract is entered into, the recording artist retains the right to grant licenses as to the musical work under paragraphs (1) and (3) of section 106.

(II) a contract made after the date when the sound recording is captured in a physical format that is mainly meant for commercial release, if at the time the contract is made, the recording artist still holds the right to grant licenses for the musical work under paragraphs (1) and (3) of section 106.

(F) The procedures specified in subparagraphs (C) and (D) shall be repeated and concluded, in accordance with regulations that the Librarian of Congress shall prescribe, in each fifth calendar year after 1997, except to the extent that different years for the repeating and concluding of such proceedings may be determined in accordance with subparagraphs (B) and (C).

(F) The procedures outlined in subparagraphs (C) and (D) will be repeated and completed, following regulations set by the Librarian of Congress, every fifth calendar year after 1997, unless different years for repeating and completing these processes are established in accordance with subparagraphs (B) and (C).

(G) Except as provided in section 1002(e) of this title, a digital phonorecord delivery licensed under this paragraph shall be accompanied by the information encoded in the sound recording, if any, by or under the authority of the copyright owner of that sound recording, that identifies the title of the sound recording, the featured recording artist who performs on the sound recording, and related information, including information concerning the underlying musical work and its writer.

(G) Except as stated in section 1002(e) of this title, a digital phonorecord delivery licensed under this paragraph must include the information encoded in the sound recording, if there is any, by or with the permission of the copyright owner of that sound recording, which identifies the title of the sound recording, the main artist performing on the sound recording, and related details, including information about the original musical work and its songwriter.

(H)(i) A digital phonorecord delivery of a sound recording is actionable as an act of infringement under section 501, and is fully subject to the remedies provided by sections 502 through 506 and section 509, unless-

(H)(i) A digital phonorecord delivery of a sound recording can be considered an act of infringement under section 501, and is completely subject to the remedies outlined in sections 502 through 506 and section 509, unless-

(I) the digital phonorecord delivery has been authorized by the copyright owner of the sound recording; and

(I) the digital phonorecord delivery has been approved by the copyright owner of the sound recording; and

(II) the owner of the copyright in the sound recording or the entity making the digital phonorecord delivery has obtained a compulsory license under this section or has otherwise been authorized by the copyright owner of the musical work to distribute or authorize the distribution, by means of a digital phonorecord delivery, of each musical work embodied in the sound recording.

(II) the copyright holder of the sound recording or the organization making the digital phonorecord delivery has obtained a mandatory license under this section or has received permission from the copyright owner of the musical work to distribute or allow the distribution, through a digital phonorecord delivery, of each musical work included in the sound recording.

(ii) Any cause of action under this subparagraph shall be in addition to those available to the owner of the copyright in the nondramatic musical work under subsection (c)(6) and section 106(4) and the owner of the copyright in the sound recording under section 106(6).

(ii) Any legal claim under this subparagraph will be in addition to those available to the copyright owner of the non-dramatic musical work under subsection (c)(6) and section 106(4), as well as to the copyright owner of the sound recording under section 106(6).

(I) The liability of the copyright owner of a sound recording for infringement of the copyright in a nondramatic musical work embodied in the sound recording shall be determined in accordance with applicable law, except that the owner of a copyright in a sound recording shall not be liable for a digital phonorecord delivery by a third party if the owner of the copyright in the sound recording does not license the distribution of a phonorecord of the nondramatic musical work.

(I) The copyright owner of a sound recording is responsible for any violations of the copyright in a nondramatic musical work included in that sound recording, according to relevant laws. However, the copyright owner of a sound recording will not be held liable for a digital phonorecord delivery made by a third party if they did not give permission for the distribution of a phonorecord of the nondramatic musical work.

(J) Nothing in section 1008 shall be construed to prevent the exercise of the rights and remedies allowed by this paragraph, paragraph (6), and chapter 5 in the event of a digital phonorecord delivery, except that no action alleging infringement of copyright may be brought under this title against a manufacturer, importer or distributor of a digital audio recording device, a digital audio recording medium, an analog recording device, or an analog recording medium, or against a consumer, based on the actions described in such section.

(J) Nothing in section 1008 should be interpreted as stopping the use of the rights and remedies provided in this paragraph, paragraph (6), and chapter 5 in the case of a digital phonorecord delivery, except that no lawsuit claiming copyright infringement can be filed under this title against a manufacturer, importer, or distributor of a digital audio recording device, a digital audio recording medium, an analog recording device, or an analog recording medium, or against a consumer, based on the actions described in that section.

(K) Nothing in this section annuls or limits

(K) Nothing in this section cancels or restricts

(i) the exclusive right to publicly perform a sound recording or the musical work embodied therein, including by means of a digital transmission, under sections 106(4) and 106(6),

(i) the sole right to publicly play a sound recording or the musical work contained in it, including through digital transmission, according to sections 106(4) and 106(6),

(ii) except for compulsory licensing under the conditions specified by this section, the exclusive rights to reproduce and distribute the sound recording and the musical work embodied therein under sections 106(1) and 106(3), including by means of a digital phonorecord delivery, or (iii) any other rights under any other provision of section 106, or remedies available under this title, as such rights or remedies exist either before or after the date of enactment of the Digital Performance Right in Sound Recordings Act of 1995.

(ii) except for mandatory licensing under the conditions outlined in this section, the exclusive rights to reproduce and distribute the sound recording and the musical work included in it under sections 106(1) and 106(3), including through digital phonorecord delivery, or (iii) any other rights under any other part of section 106, or remedies available under this title, as these rights or remedies exist either before or after the enactment date of the Digital Performance Right in Sound Recordings Act of 1995.

(L) The provisions of this section concerning digital phonorecord deliveries shall not apply to any exempt transmissions or retransmissions under section 114(d)(1). The exemptions created in section 114(d)(1) do not expand or reduce the rights of copyright owners under section 106(1) through (5) with respect to such transmissions and retransmissions.

(L) The rules in this section about digital phonorecord deliveries do not apply to any exempt transmissions or retransmissions under section 114(d)(1). The exemptions outlined in section 114(d)(1) do not affect the rights of copyright owners as defined in section 106(1) through (5) regarding those transmissions and retransmissions.

(4) A compulsory license under this section includes the right of the maker of a phonorecord of a nondramatic musical work under subsection (a)(1) to distribute or authorize distribution of such phonorecord by rental, lease, or lending (or by acts or practices in the nature of rental, lease, or lending). In addition to any royalty payable under clause (2) and chapter 8 of this title, a royalty shall be payable by the compulsory licensee for every act of distribution of a phonorecord by or in the nature of rental, lease, or lending, by or under the authority of the compulsory licensee. With respect to each nondramatic musical work embodied in the phonorecord, the royalty shall be a proportion of the revenue received by the compulsory licensee from every such act of distribution of the phonorecord under this clause equal to the proportion of the revenue received by the compulsory licensee from distribution of the phonorecord under clause (2) that is payable by a compulsory licensee under that clause and under chapter 8. The Register of Copyrights shall issue regulations to carry out the purpose of this clause.

(4) A mandatory license under this section gives the creator of a phonorecord of a non-dramatic musical work in subsection (a)(1) the right to distribute or allow distribution of that phonorecord through rental, lease, or lending (or any similar actions). In addition to any royalty payable under clause (2) and chapter 8 of this title, a royalty will be paid by the compulsory licensee for each instance of distributing a phonorecord through rental, lease, or lending, by or under the authority of the compulsory licensee. For each non-dramatic musical work contained in the phonorecord, the royalty will be a share of the revenue received by the compulsory licensee from each distribution of the phonorecord under this clause, proportional to the revenue received from distribution of the phonorecord under clause (2) that the compulsory licensee must pay under that clause and chapter 8. The Register of Copyrights will create regulations to implement this clause.

(5) Royalty payments shall be made on or before the twentieth day of each month and shall include all royalties for the month next preceding. Each monthly payment shall be made under oath and shall comply with requirements that the Register of Copyrights shall prescribe by regulation. The Register shall also prescribe regulations under which detailed cumulative annual statements of account, certified by a certified public accountant, shall be filed for every compulsory license under this section. The regulations covering both the monthly and the annual statements of account shall prescribe the form, content, and manner of certification with respect to the number of records made and the number of records distributed.

(5) Royalty payments must be made on or before the 20th day of each month and will cover all royalties for the previous month. Each monthly payment has to be made under oath and must meet the requirements set by the Register of Copyrights through regulation. The Register will also establish rules for filing detailed annual cumulative account statements, certified by a certified public accountant, for every compulsory license covered by this section. The regulations for both the monthly and annual account statements will outline the format, content, and certification process regarding the number of records produced and the number of records distributed.

(6) If the copyright owner does not receive the monthly payment and the monthly and annual statements of account when due, the owner may give written notice to the licensee that, unless the default is remedied within thirty days from the date of the notice, the compulsory license will be automatically terminated. Such termination renders either the making or the distribution, or both, of all phonorecords for which the royalty has not been paid, actionable as acts of infringement under section 501 and fully subject to the remedies provided by sections 502 through 506 and 509.

(6) If the copyright owner doesn't receive the monthly payment and the monthly and annual account statements when they're due, the owner can send written notice to the licensee stating that, unless the issue is fixed within thirty days from the date of the notice, the compulsory license will be automatically terminated. This termination makes any production or distribution, or both, of all phonorecords for which the royalty hasn't been paid, subject to action for infringement under section 501 and fully liable to the remedies outlined in sections 502 through 506 and 509.

(d) Definition. As used in this section, the following term has the following meaning: A "digital phonorecord delivery" is each individual delivery of a phonorecord by digital transmission of a sound recording which results in a specifically identifiable reproduction by or for any transmission recipient of a phonorecord of that sound recording, regardless of whether the digital transmission is also a public performance of the sound recording or any nondramatic musical work embodied therein. A digital phonorecord delivery does not result from a real-time, non-interactive subscription transmission of a sound recording where no reproduction of the sound recording or the musical work embodied therein is made from the inception of the transmission through to its receipt by the transmission recipient in order to make the sound recording audible.

(d) Definition. As used in this section, the following term means: A "digital phonorecord delivery" is each individual delivery of a phonorecord through digital transmission of a sound recording that results in a specific, identifiable reproduction by or for any recipient of that phonorecord, regardless of whether the digital transmission is also a public performance of the sound recording or any non-dramatic musical work included in it. A digital phonorecord delivery does not occur from a real-time, non-interactive subscription transmission of a sound recording where no reproduction of the sound recording or the musical work included is made from the beginning of the transmission to its receipt by the recipient for the purpose of making the sound recording audible.

Section 116. Negotiated licenses for public performances by means of coin- operated phonorecord players [52]

(a) Applicability of Section. This section applies to any nondramatic musical work embodied in a phonorecord.

(a) Applicability of Section. This section applies to any non-dramatic musical work that is recorded on a phonorecord.

(b) Negotiated Licenses.-

(b) Negotiated Licenses.

(1) Authority for negotiations. Any owners of copyright in works to which this section applies and any operators of coin-operated phonorecord players may negotiate and agree upon the terms and rates of royalty payments for the performance of such works and the proportionate division of fees paid among copyright owners, and may designate common agents to negotiate, agree to, pay, or receive such royalty payments.

(1) Authority for negotiations. Any copyright owners of works covered by this section and any operators of coin-operated music players can negotiate and agree on the terms and rates of royalty payments for performing these works, as well as how to divide the fees among copyright owners. They can also appoint common agents to negotiate, agree to, pay, or receive these royalty payments.

(2) Arbitration. Parties not subject to such a negotiation, may determine, by arbitration in accordance with the provisions of chapter 8, the terms and rates and the division of fees described in paragraph (1).

(2) Arbitration. Parties not involved in such a negotiation may decide, through arbitration in line with the rules in chapter 8, the terms and rates and the division of fees mentioned in paragraph (1).

(c) License Agreements Superior to Copyright Arbitration Royalty Panel Determinations. License agreements between one or more copyright owners and one or more operators of coin-operated phonorecord players, which are negotiated in accordance with subsection (b), shall be given effect in lieu of any otherwise applicable determination by a copyright arbitration royalty panel.

(c) License Agreements Take Precedence Over Copyright Arbitration Royalty Panel Decisions. License agreements made between one or more copyright owners and one or more operators of coin-operated record players, which are negotiated according to subsection (b), will take priority over any relevant decision by a copyright arbitration royalty panel.

(d) Definitions. As used in this section, the following terms mean the following:

(d) Definitions. As used in this section, the following terms mean the following:

(1) A "coin-operated phonorecord player" is a machine or device that-

(1) A "coin-operated record player" is a machine or device that-

(A) is employed solely for the performance of nondramatic musical works by means of phonorecords upon being activated by the insertion of coins, currency, tokens, or other monetary units or their equivalent;

(A) is used only for playing nondramatic musical works through phonorecords when activated by inserting coins, cash, tokens, or other forms of payment or their equivalent;

(B) is located in an establishment making no direct or indirect charge for admission;

(B) is situated in a place that doesn't charge any fees for entry, either directly or indirectly;

(C) is accompanied by a list which is comprised of the titles of all the musical works available for performance on it, and is affixed to the phonorecord player or posted in the establishment in a prominent position where it can be readily examined by the public; and

(C) comes with a list that includes the titles of all the musical works available for performance on it, and it is attached to the phonorecord player or displayed in the establishment in a visible spot where the public can easily check it out; and

(D) affords a choice of works available for performance and permits the choice to be made by the patrons of the establishment in which it is located.

(D) offers a selection of works that can be performed and allows the choice to be made by the patrons of the venue where it is situated.

(2) An "operator" is any person who, alone or jointly with others-

(2) An "operator" is anyone who, individually or together with others-

(A) owns a coin-operated phonorecord player;

(A) has a coin-operated record player;

(B) has the power to make a coin-operated phonorecord player available for placement in an establishment for purposes of public performance; or

(B) has the authority to provide a coin-operated record player for installation in a venue for public performances; or

(C) has the power to exercise primary control over the selection of the musical works made available for public performance on a coin-operated phonorecord player.

(C) has the authority to take primary control over choosing the musical works that can be publicly performed on a coin-operated phonorecord player.

Section 117. Limitations on exclusive rights: Computer programs [53]

(a) Making of Additional Copy or Adaptation by Owner of Copy. Notwithstanding the provisions of section 106, it is not an infringement for the owner of a copy of a computer program to make or authorize the making of another copy or adaptation of that computer program provided:

(a) Making an Additional Copy or Adaptation by the Owner of the Copy. Even with section 106, it’s not considered an infringement for the owner of a copy of a computer program to create or allow another copy or adaptation of that computer program if:

(1) that such a new copy or adaptation is created as an essential step in the utilization of the computer program in conjunction with a machine and that it is used in no other manner, or

(1) that a new copy or adaptation is created as a necessary step in using the computer program together with a machine and that it is not used in any other way, or

(2) that such new copy or adaptation is for archival purposes only and that all archival copies are destroyed in the event that continued possession of the computer program should cease to be rightful.

(2) that any new copy or adaptation is for archival purposes only and that all archival copies are destroyed if the rightful possession of the computer program is no longer valid.

(b) Lease, Sale, or Other Transfer of Additional Copy or Adaptation. Any exact copies prepared in accordance with the provisions of this section may be leased, sold, or otherwise transferred, along with the copy from which such copies were prepared, only as part of the lease, sale, or other transfer of all rights in the program. Adaptations so prepared may be transferred only with the authorization of the copyright owner.

(b) Lease, Sale, or Other Transfer of Additional Copy or Adaptation. Any exact copies made according to the rules in this section can be leased, sold, or otherwise transferred, along with the original copy from which those copies were made, only as part of the lease, sale, or other transfer of all rights in the program. Adaptations created this way can only be transferred with permission from the copyright owner.

(c) Machine Maintenance or Repair. Notwithstanding the provisions of section 106, it is not an infringement for the owner or lessee of a machine to make or authorize the making of a copy of a computer program if such copy is made solely by virtue of the activation of a machine that lawfully contains an authorized copy of the computer program, for purposes only of maintenance or repair of that machine, if-

(c) Machine Maintenance or Repair. Notwithstanding the provisions of section 106, it's not considered infringement for the owner or lessee of a machine to create or allow the creation of a copy of a computer program if that copy is made solely due to the activation of a machine that legally contains an authorized copy of the computer program, for the purpose of maintaining or repairing that machine, if-

(1) such new copy is used in no other manner and is destroyed immediately after the maintenance or repair is completed; and

(1) this new copy is used only in this way and is destroyed right after the maintenance or repair is done; and

(2) with respect to any computer program or part thereof that is not necessary for that machine to be activated, such program or part thereof is not accessed or used other than to make such new copy by virtue of the activation of the machine.

(2) regarding any computer program or part of it that isn’t essential for that machine to start up, that program or part is not accessed or used except to create such a new copy due to the machine's activation.

(d) Definitions. For purposes of this section-

(d) Definitions. For this section—

(1) the "maintenance" of a machine is the servicing of the machine in order to make it work in accordance with its original specifications and any changes to those specifications authorized for that machine; and

(1) The "maintenance" of a machine is the service performed on the machine to ensure it operates according to its original specifications and any authorized changes to those specifications for that machine; and

(2) the "repair" of a machine is the restoring of the machine to the state of working in accordance with its original specifications and any changes to those specifications authorized for that machine.

(2) The "repair" of a machine means bringing the machine back to its working condition based on its original specifications and any authorized changes to those specifications for that machine.

Section 118. Scope of exclusive rights: Use of certain works in connection with noncommercial broadcasting [54]

(a) The exclusive rights provided by section 106 shall, with respect to the works specified by subsection (b) and the activities specified by subsection (d), be subject to the conditions and limitations prescribed by this section.

(a) The exclusive rights granted by section 106 regarding the works mentioned in subsection (b) and the activities outlined in subsection (d) will be subject to the conditions and limitations specified in this section.

(b) Notwithstanding any provision of the antitrust laws, any owners of copyright in published nondramatic musical works and published pictorial, graphic, and sculptural works and any public broadcasting entities, respectively, may negotiate and agree upon the terms and rates of royalty payments and the proportionate division of fees paid among various copyright owners, and may designate common agents to negotiate, agree to, pay, or receive payments.

(b) Despite any part of the antitrust laws, copyright owners of published non-dramatic musical works and published visual arts like graphics, pictures, and sculptures, as well as public broadcasting entities, can negotiate and agree on the terms and rates of royalty payments, decide how to split fees among different copyright owners, and appoint common agents to negotiate, agree to, pay, or receive payments.

(1) Any owner of copyright in a work specified in this subsection or any public broadcasting entity may submit to the Librarian of Congress proposed licenses covering such activities with respect to such works. The Librarian of Congress shall proceed on the basis of the proposals submitted to it as well as any other relevant information. The Librarian of Congress shall permit any interested party to submit information relevant to such proceedings.

(1) Any copyright owner of a work mentioned in this section or any public broadcasting organization can send proposed licenses to the Librarian of Congress covering these activities related to those works. The Librarian of Congress will act based on the proposals received and any other relevant information. The Librarian of Congress will allow any interested party to submit relevant information for these proceedings.

(2) License agreements voluntarily negotiated at any time between one or more copyright owners and one or more public broadcasting entities shall be given effect in lieu of any determination by the Librarian of Congress: *Provided*, That copies of such agreements are filed in the Copyright Office within thirty days of execution in accordance with regulations that the Register of Copyrights shall prescribe.

(2) License agreements voluntarily negotiated at any time between one or more copyright owners and one or more public broadcasting entities will take precedence over any decision made by the Librarian of Congress: *Provided*, That copies of these agreements are submitted to the Copyright Office within thirty days of being made, following the rules set by the Register of Copyrights.

(3) In the absence of license agreements negotiated under paragraph (2), the Librarian of Congress shall, pursuant to chapter 8, convene a copyright arbitration royalty panel to determine and publish in the Federal Register a schedule of rates and terms which, subject to paragraph (2), shall be binding on all owners of copyright in works specified by this subsection and public broadcasting entities, regardless of whether such copyright owners have submitted proposals to the Librarian of Congress. In establishing such rates and terms the copyright arbitration royalty panel may consider the rates for comparable circumstances under voluntary license agreements negotiated as provided in paragraph (2). The Librarian of Congress shall also establish requirements by which copyright owners may receive reasonable notice of the use of their works under this section, and under which records of such use shall be kept by public broadcasting entities.

(3) If there are no license agreements negotiated under paragraph (2), the Librarian of Congress will, according to chapter 8, set up a copyright arbitration royalty panel to determine and publish a schedule of rates and terms in the Federal Register that, subject to paragraph (2), will be mandatory for all copyright owners of works mentioned in this subsection and public broadcasting organizations, even if those copyright owners haven’t submitted proposals to the Librarian of Congress. In setting these rates and terms, the copyright arbitration royalty panel can take into account the rates for similar situations under voluntary license agreements negotiated as outlined in paragraph (2). The Librarian of Congress will also establish requirements so that copyright owners receive appropriate notice of the use of their works under this section, and so that records of such use are maintained by public broadcasting organizations.

(c) The initial procedure specified in subsection (b) shall be repeated and concluded between June 30 and December 31, 1997, and at five-year intervals thereafter, in accordance with regulations that the Librarian of Congress shall prescribe.

(c) The initial procedure outlined in subsection (b) will be repeated and completed between June 30 and December 31, 1997, and every five years after that, following the regulations set by the Librarian of Congress.

(d) Subject to the terms of any voluntary license agreements that have been negotiated as provided by subsection (b) (2), a public broadcasting entity may, upon compliance with the provisions of this section, including the rates and terms established by a copyright arbitration royalty panel under subsection (b) (3), engage in the following activities with respect to published nondramatic musical works and published pictorial, graphic, and sculptural works:

(d) Following the terms of any voluntary licensing agreements that have been negotiated as mentioned in subsection (b)(2), a public broadcasting organization may, as long as it complies with the provisions of this section, including the rates and terms set by a copyright arbitration royalty panel under subsection (b)(3), participate in the following activities regarding published nondramatic musical works and published pictorial, graphic, and sculptural works:

(1) performance or display of a work by or in the course of a transmission made by a noncommercial educational broadcast station referred to in subsection (g); and

(1) showing or presenting a work during a broadcast made by a noncommercial educational station mentioned in subsection (g); and

(2) production of a transmission program, reproduction of copies or phonorecords of such a transmission program, and distribution of such copies or phonorecords, where such production, reproduction, or distribution is made by a nonprofit institution or organization solely for the purpose of transmissions specified in paragraph (1); and

(2) creating a transmission program, making copies or phonorecords of that transmission program, and distributing those copies or phonorecords, when this production, reproduction, or distribution is done by a nonprofit institution or organization solely for the transmission purposes outlined in paragraph (1); and

(3) the making of reproductions by a governmental body or a nonprofit institution of a transmission program simultaneously with its transmission as specified in paragraph (1), and the performance or display of the contents of such program under the conditions specified by paragraph (1) of section 110, but only if the reproductions are used for performances or displays for a period of no more than seven days from the date of the transmission specified in paragraph (1), and are destroyed before or at the end of such period. No person supplying, in accordance with paragraph (2), a reproduction of a transmission program to governmental bodies or nonprofit institutions under this paragraph shall have any liability as a result of failure of such body or institution to destroy such reproduction: *Provided*, That it shall have notified such body or institution of the requirement for such destruction pursuant to this paragraph: *And provided further*, That if such body or institution itself fails to destroy such reproduction it shall be deemed to have infringed.

(3) The creation of copies by a government agency or a nonprofit organization of a broadcast program at the same time as it’s actually being broadcast, as outlined in paragraph (1), and the performance or display of that program's content under the conditions specified by paragraph (1) of section 110, is allowed only if the copies are used for performances or displays for no longer than seven days from the broadcast date mentioned in paragraph (1), and are destroyed before or at the end of that period. No one who provides a copy of a broadcast program to government agencies or nonprofit organizations in accordance with paragraph (2) will be held liable for that agency or organization’s failure to destroy the copy, *Provided*, that they have informed that agency or organization of the destruction requirement according to this paragraph; *And provided further*, that if the agency or organization fails to destroy the copy itself, it will be considered to have infringed.

(e) Except as expressly provided in this subsection, this section shall have no applicability to works other than those specified in subsection (b). Owners of copyright in nondramatic literary works and public broadcasting entities may, during the course of voluntary negotiations, agree among themselves, respectively, as to the terms and rates of royalty payments without liability under the antitrust laws. Any such terms and rates of royalty payments shall be effective upon filing in the Copyright Office, in accordance with regulations that the Register of Copyrights shall prescribe.

(e) Unless stated otherwise in this subsection, this section does not apply to works other than those mentioned in subsection (b). Copyright owners of nondramatic literary works and public broadcasting entities can negotiate the terms and rates of royalty payments among themselves during voluntary discussions, without facing antitrust liability. Any agreements on these terms and rates will take effect once filed with the Copyright Office, following the regulations set by the Register of Copyrights.

(f) Nothing in this section shall be construed to permit, beyond the limits of fair use as provided by section 107, the unauthorized dramatization of a nondramatic musical work, the production of a transmission program drawn to any substantial extent from a published compilation of pictorial, graphic, or sculptural works, or the unauthorized use of any portion of an audiovisual work.

(f) Nothing in this section should be interpreted as allowing, beyond the boundaries of fair use as outlined in section 107, the unauthorized dramatization of a non-dramatic musical work, the creation of a broadcast program that takes a significant amount from a published collection of images, graphics, or sculptures, or the unauthorized use of any part of an audiovisual work.

(g) As used in this section, the term "public broadcasting entity" means a noncommercial educational broadcast station as defined in section 397 of title 47 and any nonprofit institution or organization engaged in the activities described in paragraph (2) of subsection (d).

(g) In this section, the term "public broadcasting entity" refers to a noncommercial educational broadcast station as defined in section 397 of title 47, along with any nonprofit institution or organization involved in the activities described in paragraph (2) of subsection (d).

Section 119. Limitations on exclusive rights: Secondary transmissions of superstations and network stations for private home viewing [55]

(a) Secondary Transmissions by Satellite Carriers.-

(a) Secondary Transmissions by Satellite Providers.-

(1) Superstations and PBS Satellite Feed. Subject to the provisions of paragraphs (3), (4), and (6) of this subsection and section 114(d), secondary transmissions of a performance or display of a work embodied in a primary transmission made by a superstation or by the Public Broadcasting Service satellite feed shall be subject to statutory licensing under this section if the secondary transmission is made by a satellite carrier to the public for private home viewing, with regard to secondary transmissions the satellite carrier is in compliance with the rules, regulations, or authorizations of the Federal Communications Commission governing the carriage of television broadcast station signals, and the carrier makes a direct or indirect charge for each retransmission service to each household receiving the secondary transmission or to a distributor that has contracted with the carrier for direct or indirect delivery of the secondary transmission to the public for private home viewing. In the case of the Public Broadcasting Service satellite feed, the statutory license shall be effective until January 1, 2002. [56]

(1) Superstations and PBS Satellite Feed. Subject to the provisions of paragraphs (3), (4), and (6) of this subsection and section 114(d), secondary transmissions of a performance or display of a work included in a primary transmission made by a superstation or the Public Broadcasting Service satellite feed will fall under statutory licensing according to this section if the secondary transmission is made by a satellite carrier to the public for private home viewing. The satellite carrier must comply with the Federal Communications Commission's rules, regulations, or authorizations for carrying television broadcast station signals, and the carrier must charge directly or indirectly for each retransmission service to each household receiving the secondary transmission, or to a distributor that has contracted with the carrier to deliver the secondary transmission to the public for private home viewing. For the Public Broadcasting Service satellite feed, the statutory license will be effective until January 1, 2002. [56]

(2) Network stations.-

(2) Network channels.-

(A) In general. Subject to the provisions of subparagraphs (B) and (C) of this paragraph and paragraphs (3), (4), (5), and (6) of this subsection and section 114(d), secondary transmissions of a performance or display of a work embodied in a primary transmission made by a network station shall be subject to statutory licensing under this section if the secondary transmission is made by a satellite carrier to the public for private home viewing, with regard to secondary transmissions the satellite carrier is in compliance with the rules, regulations, or authorizations of the Federal Communications Commission governing the carriage of television broadcast station signals, and the carrier makes a direct or indirect charge for such retransmission service to each subscriber receiving the secondary transmission.

(A) In general. Subject to the provisions of subparagraphs (B) and (C) of this paragraph and paragraphs (3), (4), (5), and (6) of this subsection and section 114(d), secondary transmissions of a performance or display of a work included in a primary transmission made by a network station will be subject to statutory licensing under this section if the secondary transmission is made by a satellite carrier to the public for private home viewing, provided that the satellite carrier complies with the rules, regulations, or authorizations of the Federal Communications Commission regarding the transmission of television broadcast station signals, and the carrier charges a direct or indirect fee for such retransmission service to each subscriber receiving the secondary transmission.

(B) Secondary transmissions to unserved households.-

(B) Secondary transmissions to underserved households.

(i) In general. The statutory license provided for in subparagraph (A) shall be limited to secondary transmissions of the signals of no more than two network stations in a single day for each television network to persons who reside in unserved households.

(i) In general. The statutory license outlined in subparagraph (A) will be limited to secondary transmissions of the signals from no more than two network stations in a single day for each television network to people living in unserved households.

(ii) Accurate determinations of eligibility.-

(ii) Accurate eligibility determinations.

(I) Accurate predictive model. In determining presumptively whether a person resides in an unserved household under subsection (d)(10)(A), a court shall rely on the Individual Location Longley-Rice model set forth by the Federal Communications Commission in Docket No. 98-201, as that model may be amended by the Commission over time under section 339(c)(3) of the Communications Act of 1934 to increase the accuracy of that model.

(I) Accurate predictive model. In determining whether a person is likely living in an unserved household under subsection (d)(10)(A), a court shall use the Individual Location Longley-Rice model established by the Federal Communications Commission in Docket No. 98-201, as that model may be updated by the Commission over time under section 339(c)(3) of the Communications Act of 1934 to enhance its accuracy.

(II) Accurate measurements. For purposes of site measurements to determine whether a person resides in an unserved household under subsection (d)(10)(A), a court shall rely on section 339(c)(4) of the Communications Act of 1934.

(II) Accurate measurements. For site measurements to check if someone lives in an unserved household under subsection (d)(10)(A), a court will rely on section 339(c)(4) of the Communications Act of 1934.

(iii) C-band exemption to unserved households.-

(iii) C-band exemption for unserved households.-

(I) In general. The limitations of clause (i) shall not apply to any secondary transmissions by C-band services of network stations that a subscriber to C-band service received before any termination of such secondary transmissions before October 31, 1999.

(I) In general. The restrictions of clause (i) do not apply to any secondary transmissions by C-band services of network stations that a C-band service subscriber received before any end of those secondary transmissions before October 31, 1999.

(II) Definition. In this clause the term "C-band service" means a service that is licensed by the Federal Communications Commission and operates in the Fixed Satellite Service under part 25 of title 47 of the Code of Federal Regulations.

(II) Definition. In this section, the term "C-band service" refers to a service that is licensed by the Federal Communications Commission and operates in the Fixed Satellite Service under part 25 of title 47 of the Code of Federal Regulations.

(C) Submission of subscriber lists to networks. A satellite carrier that makes secondary transmissions of a primary transmission made by a network station pursuant to subparagraph (A) shall, 90 days after commencing such secondary transmissions, submit to the network that owns or is affiliated with the network station a list identifying (by name and street address, including county and zip code) all subscribers to which the satellite carrier makes secondary transmissions of that primary transmission. Thereafter, on the 15th of each month, the satellite carrier shall submit to the network a list identifying (by name and street address, including county and zip code) any persons who have been added or dropped as such subscribers since the last submission under this subparagraph. Such subscriber information submitted by a satellite carrier may be used only for purposes of monitoring compliance by the satellite carrier with this subsection. The submission requirements of this subparagraph shall apply to a satellite carrier only if the network to whom the submissions are to be made places on file with the Register of Copyrights a document identifying the name and address of the person to whom such submissions are to be made. The Register shall maintain for public inspection a file of all such documents.

(C) Submission of subscriber lists to networks. A satellite carrier that broadcasts secondary transmissions of a primary transmission from a network station as described in subparagraph (A) must submit a list to the network that owns or is affiliated with the network station within 90 days after starting those secondary transmissions. This list must include the names and street addresses (including county and zip code) of all subscribers who receive those secondary transmissions of the primary transmission. After that, on the 15th of each month, the satellite carrier must provide the network with a list showing any new or removed subscribers (by name and street address, including county and zip code) since the last submission under this subparagraph. The subscriber information submitted by the satellite carrier can only be used to monitor compliance with this subsection. These submission requirements apply to a satellite carrier only if the network to which the submissions are sent has filed a document with the Register of Copyrights that identifies the person who will receive these submissions, including their name and address. The Register will keep a file of all such documents available for public inspection.

(3) Noncompliance with reporting and payment requirements.- Notwithstanding the provisions of paragraphs (1) and (2), the willful or repeated secondary transmission to the public by a satellite carrier of a primary transmission made by a superstation or a network station and embodying a performance or display of a work is actionable as an act of infringement under section 501, and is fully subject to the remedies provided by sections 502 through 506 and 509, where the satellite carrier has not deposited the statement of account and royalty fee required by subsection (b), or has failed to make the submissions to networks required by paragraph (2)(C).

(3) Not following reporting and payment requirements. - Even with the rules in paragraphs (1) and (2), if a satellite carrier willfully or repeatedly transmits a primary transmission from a superstation or a network station to the public, which includes a performance or display of a work, it can be considered an infringement under section 501. The satellite carrier will also face the penalties outlined in sections 502 to 506 and 509 if they haven’t submitted the statement of account and royalty fee as required in subsection (b), or if they haven’t provided the required submissions to networks mentioned in paragraph (2)(C).

(4) Willful alterations. Notwithstanding the provisions of paragraphs (1) and (2), the secondary transmission to the public by a satellite carrier of a performance or display of a work embodied in a primary transmission made by a superstation or a network station is actionable as an act of infringement under section 501, and is fully subject to the remedies provided by sections 502 through 506 and sections 509 and 510, if the content of the particular program in which the performance or display is embodied, or any commercial advertising or station announcement transmitted by the primary transmitter during, or immediately before or after, the transmission of such program, is in any way willfully altered by the satellite carrier through changes, deletions, or additions, or is combined with programming from any other broadcast signal.

(4) Willful alterations. Despite the rules in paragraphs (1) and (2), if a satellite carrier sends a secondary broadcast to the public that includes a performance or display of a work from a primary broadcast by a superstation or network station, it can be considered an infringement under section 501. This holds true and is fully subject to the remedies outlined in sections 502 through 506 and sections 509 and 510, if the specific program containing the performance or display, or any commercials or station announcements broadcasted by the original transmitter during, just before, or just after the program, is intentionally altered by the satellite carrier through any changes, deletions, or additions, or is mixed with content from any other broadcast signal.

(5) Violation of territorial restrictions on statutory license for network stations.-

(5) Breaking territorial restrictions on statutory licenses for network stations.-

(A) Individual violations. The willful or repeated secondary transmission by a satellite carrier of a primary transmission made by a network station and embodying a performance or display of a work to a subscriber who does not reside in an unserved household is actionable as an act of infringement under section 501 and is fully subject to the remedies provided by sections 502 through 506 and 509, except that-

(A) Individual violations. The intentional or repeated secondary transmission by a satellite carrier of a primary transmission made by a network station that includes a performance or display of a work to a subscriber who does not live in an unserved household can be treated as an infringement under section 501 and is fully subject to the remedies provided by sections 502 through 506 and 509, except that-

(i) no damages shall be awarded for such act of infringement if the satellite carrier took corrective action by promptly withdrawing service from the ineligible subscriber, and

(i) no damages will be awarded for this act of infringement if the satellite carrier quickly took action by stopping service to the ineligible subscriber, and

(ii) any statutory damages shall not exceed $5 for such subscriber for each month during which the violation occurred.

(ii) any statutory damages shall not be more than $5 for that subscriber for each month the violation happened.

(B) Pattern of violations. If a satellite carrier engages in a willful or repeated pattern or practice of delivering a primary transmission made by a network station and embodying a performance or display of a work to subscribers who do not reside in unserved households, then in addition to the remedies set forth in subparagraph (A)-

(B) Pattern of violations. If a satellite carrier intentionally or repeatedly delivers a primary transmission from a network station that includes a performance or display of a work to subscribers who do not live in unserved households, then in addition to the remedies outlined in subparagraph (A)-

(i) if the pattern or practice has been carried out on a substantially nationwide basis, the court shall order a permanent injunction barring the secondary transmission by the satellite carrier, for private home viewing, of the primary transmissions of any primary network station affiliated with the same network, and the court may order statutory damages of not to exceed $250,000 for each 6-month period during which the pattern or practice was carried out; and

(i) If the pattern or practice has been conducted on a largely nationwide level, the court will issue a permanent injunction prohibiting the satellite carrier from transmitting the primary broadcasts of any network station affiliated with the same network for private home viewing. The court may also award statutory damages of up to $250,000 for each 6-month period during which the pattern or practice took place; and

(ii) if the pattern or practice has been carried out on a local or regional basis, the court shall order a permanent injunction barring the secondary transmission, for private home viewing in that locality or region, by the satellite carrier of the primary transmissions of any primary network station affiliated with the same network, and the court may order statutory damages of not to exceed $250,000 for each 6-month period during which the pattern or practice was carried out.

(ii) If the pattern or practice has been done on a local or regional level, the court will issue a permanent injunction stopping the satellite carrier from transmitting primary broadcasts of any primary network station connected to the same network for private home viewing in that local area or region. The court may also impose statutory damages up to $250,000 for each 6-month period during which the pattern or practice occurred.

(C) Previous subscribers excluded. Subparagraphs (A) and (B) do not apply to secondary transmissions by a satellite carrier to persons who subscribed to receive such secondary transmissions from the satellite carrier or a distributor before November 16, 1988.

(C) Previous subscribers excluded. Subparagraphs (A) and (B) do not apply to secondary transmissions by a satellite carrier to people who subscribed to receive those secondary transmissions from the satellite carrier or a distributor before November 16, 1988.

(D) Burden of proof. [57] In any action brought under this paragraph, the satellite carrier shall have the burden of proving that its secondary transmission of a primary transmission by a network station is for private home viewing to an unserved household.

(D) Burden of proof. [57] In any action brought under this paragraph, the satellite carrier must prove that its secondary transmission of a primary transmission by a network station is intended for private home viewing to a household that doesn’t receive the service.

(E) Exception. The secondary transmission by a satellite carrier of a performance or display of a work embodied in a primary transmission made by a network station to subscribers who do not reside in unserved households shall not be an act of infringement if-

(E) Exception. The secondary transmission by a satellite carrier of a performance or display of a work featured in a primary transmission from a network station to subscribers who do not live in unserved households shall not be considered an act of infringement if-

(i) the station on May 1, 1991, was retransmitted by a satellite carrier and was not on that date owned or operated by or affiliated with a television network that offered interconnected program service on a regular basis for 15 or more hours per week to at least 25 affiliated television licensees in 10 or more States;

(i) the station on May 1, 1991, was broadcast by a satellite carrier and was not, on that date, owned or operated by or linked to a television network that provided interconnected programming for at least 15 hours a week to at least 25 associated television licensees in 10 or more States;

(ii) as of July 1, 1998, such station was retransmitted by a satellite carrier under the statutory license of this section; and

(ii) as of July 1, 1998, that station was being retransmitted by a satellite provider under the legal license of this section; and

(iii) the station is not owned or operated by or affiliated with a television network that, as of January 1, 1995, offered interconnected program service on a regular basis for 15 or more hours per week to at least 25 affiliated television licensees in 10 or more States.

(iii) the station is not owned or run by, or connected to, a television network that, as of January 1, 1995, provided interconnected program service on a regular basis for 15 or more hours a week to at least 25 affiliated television licensees in 10 or more states.

(6) Discrimination by a satellite carrier. Notwithstanding the provisions of paragraph (1), the willful or repeated secondary transmission to the public by a satellite carrier of [a] performance or display of a work embodied in a primary transmission made by a superstation or a network station is actionable as an act of infringement under section 501, and is fully subject to the remedies provided by sections 502 through 506 and 509, if the satellite carrier unlawfully discriminates against a distributor. [58]

(6) Discrimination by a satellite carrier. Regardless of the rules in paragraph (1), if a satellite carrier intentionally or repeatedly broadcasts to the public a performance or display of a work that was originally transmitted by a superstation or network station, it can be treated as infringement under section 501. This is entirely subject to the remedies outlined in sections 502 through 506 and 509, if the satellite carrier illegally discriminates against a distributor. [58]

(7) Geographic limitation on secondary transmissions. The statutory license created by this section shall apply only to secondary transmissions to households located in the United States.

(7) Geographic limitation on secondary transmissions. The statutory license created by this section will only apply to secondary transmissions to households located in the United States.

(8) Transitional signal intensity measurement procedures. [59]

(8) Procedures for measuring transitional signal intensity. [59]

(A) In general. Subject to subparagraph (C), upon a challenge by a network station regarding whether a subscriber is an unserved household within the predicted Grade B Contour of the station, the satellite carrier shall, within 60 days after the receipt of the challenge-

(A) In general. Subject to subparagraph (C), when a network station questions whether a subscriber is an unserved household within the predicted Grade B Contour of the station, the satellite carrier must respond within 60 days after receiving the challenge-

(i) terminate service to that household of the signal that is the subject of the challenge, and within 30 days thereafter notify the network station that made the challenge that service to that household has been terminated; or

(i) stop service to the household related to the signal being challenged, and within 30 days after that, inform the network station that issued the challenge that service to that household has been stopped; or

(ii) conduct a measurement of the signal intensity of the subscriber's household to determine whether the household is an unserved household after giving reasonable notice to the network station of the satellite carrier's intent to conduct the measurement.

(ii) measure the signal strength of the subscriber's home to see if the home is unserved, after providing reasonable notice to the network station about the satellite carrier's plan to conduct the measurement.

(B) Effect of measurement. If the satellite carrier conducts a signal intensity measurement under subparagraph (A) and the measurement indicates that-

(B) Effect of measurement. If the satellite carrier measures signal strength as mentioned in subparagraph (A) and the measurement shows that-

(i) the household is not an unserved household, the satellite carrier shall, within 60 days after the measurement is conducted, terminate the service to that household of the signal that is the subject of the challenge, and within 30 days thereafter notify the network station that made the challenge that service to that household has been terminated; or

(i) if the household is not considered unserved, the satellite carrier must, within 60 days after the measurement is done, end the service to that household for the signal that is being challenged, and within 30 days after that, inform the network station that made the challenge that service to that household has been terminated; or

(ii) the household is an unserved household, the station challenging the service shall reimburse the satellite carrier for the costs of the signal measurement within 60 days after receipt of the measurement results and a statement of the costs of the measurement.

(ii) If the household is unserved, the station disputing the service must reimburse the satellite carrier for the signal measurement costs within 60 days after receiving the measurement results and a statement of those costs.

(C) Limitation on measurements.-

(C) Measurement limits.

(i) Notwithstanding subparagraph (A), a satellite carrier may not be required to conduct signal intensity measurements during any calendar year in excess of 5 percent of the number of subscribers within the network station's local market that have subscribed to the service as of the effective date of the Satellite Home Viewer Act of 1994.

(i) However, a satellite carrier isn't required to measure signal intensity more than 5 percent of the number of subscribers in the local market of the network station who have subscribed to the service as of the effective date of the Satellite Home Viewer Act of 1994.

(ii) If a network station challenges whether a subscriber is an unserved household in excess of 5 percent of the subscribers within the network station's local market within a calendar year, subparagraph (A) shall not apply to challenges in excess of such 5 percent, but the station may conduct its own signal intensity measurement of the subscriber's household after giving reasonable notice to the satellite carrier of the network station's intent to conduct the measurement. If such measurement indicates that the household is not an unserved household, the carrier shall, within 60 days after receipt of the measurement, terminate service to the household of the signal that is the subject of the challenge and within 30 days thereafter notify the network station that made the challenge that service has been terminated. The carrier shall also, within 60 days after receipt of the measurement and a statement of the costs of the measurement, reimburse the network station for the cost it incurred in conducting the measurement.

(ii) If a network station questions whether a subscriber is part of an unserved household that exceeds 5 percent of the subscribers in the network station's local market within a calendar year, subparagraph (A) won't apply to challenges beyond that 5 percent. However, the station can carry out its own signal strength measurement at the subscriber's household after giving reasonable notice to the satellite carrier about the intent to do so. If that measurement shows the household is not an unserved household, the carrier must, within 60 days of receiving the measurement, stop service to that household for the signal in question and notify the network station that raised the challenge within 30 days that service has been terminated. The carrier must also reimburse the network station for the costs of the measurement within 60 days after receiving the measurement and an invoice for the expenses.

(D) Outside the predicted grade b contour.-

(D) Outside the predicted grade B area.

(i) If a network station challenges whether a subscriber is an unserved household outside the predicted Grade B Contour of the station, the station may conduct a measurement of the signal intensity of the subscriber's household to determine whether the household is an unserved household after giving reasonable notice to the satellite carrier of the network station's intent to conduct the measurement.

(i) If a network station questions whether a subscriber is an unserved household beyond the predicted Grade B Contour of the station, the station can measure the signal strength at the subscriber's household to find out if it's an unserved household, after giving the satellite carrier reasonable notice of the network station's plan to conduct the measurement.

(ii) If the network station conducts a signal intensity measurement under clause (i) and the measurement indicates that-

(ii) If the network station measures signal intensity as stated in clause (i) and the measurement shows that-

(I) the household is not an unserved household, the station shall forward the results to the satellite carrier who shall, within 60 days after receipt of the measurement, terminate the service to the household of the signal that is the subject of the challenge, and shall reimburse the station for the costs of the measurement within 60 days after receipt of the measurement results and a statement of such costs; or

(I) the household is not an unserved household, the station shall forward the results to the satellite carrier who shall, within 60 days after receiving the measurement, end the service to the household for the signal that is being challenged, and shall reimburse the station for the costs of the measurement within 60 days after receiving the measurement results and an invoice for those costs; or

(II) the household is an unserved household, the station shall pay the costs of the measurement.

(II) If the household is unserved, the station will cover the measurement costs.

(9) Loser pays for signal intensity measurement; recovery of measurement costs in a civil action. In any civil action filed relating to the eligibility of subscribing households as unserved households-

(9) The loser pays for measuring signal intensity; recovering measurement costs in a civil action. In any civil action filed regarding the eligibility of subscribing households as unserved households—

(A) a network station challenging such eligibility shall, within 60 days after receipt of the measurement results and a statement of such costs, reimburse the satellite carrier for any signal intensity measurement that is conducted by that carrier in response to a challenge by the network station and that establishes the household is an unserved household; and

(A) a network station that disputes this eligibility must, within 60 days of receiving the measurement results and a breakdown of the costs, pay the satellite carrier for any signal intensity measurement conducted by that carrier due to the challenge by the network station, which proves that the household is an unserved household; and

(B) a satellite carrier shall, within 60 days after receipt of the measurement results and a statement of such costs, reimburse the network station challenging such eligibility for any signal intensity measurement that is conducted by that station and that establishes the household is not an unserved household.

(B) a satellite carrier must, within 60 days after receiving the measurement results and a statement of those costs, reimburse the network station that is questioning the eligibility for any signal intensity measurement conducted by that station, which shows that the household is not an unserved household.

(10) inability to conduct measurement. If a network station makes a reasonable attempt to conduct a site measurement of its signal at a subscriber's household and is denied access for the purpose of conducting the measurement, and is otherwise unable to conduct a measurement, the satellite carrier shall within 60 days notice thereof, terminate service of the station's network to that household.

(10) inability to conduct measurement. If a network station tries to measure its signal at a subscriber's home but is denied access to do so, and cannot measure it in any other way, the satellite carrier must terminate the network service for that household within 60 days of the notice.

(11) Service to recreational vehicles and commercial trucks.-

(11) Service for RVs and commercial trucks.-

(A) Exemption.-

Exemption.

(i) In general. For purposes of this subsection, and subject to clauses (ii) and (iii), the term "unserved household" shall include-

(i) In general. For this subsection, and with respect to clauses (ii) and (iii), the term "unserved household" will include-

(I) recreational vehicles as defined in regulations of the Secretary of
Housing and Urban Development under section 3282.8 of title 24 of the
Code of Federal Regulations; and

(I) recreational vehicles as defined in the regulations of the Secretary of
Housing and Urban Development under section 3282.8 of title 24 of the
Code of Federal Regulations; and

(II) commercial trucks that qualify as commercial motor vehicles under regulations of the Secretary of Transportation under section 383.5 of title 49 of the Code of Federal Regulations.

(II) commercial trucks that meet the definition of commercial motor vehicles according to the regulations set by the Secretary of Transportation under section 383.5 of title 49 of the Code of Federal Regulations.

(ii) Limitation. Clause (i) shall apply only to a recreational vehicle or commercial truck if any satellite carrier that proposes to make a secondary transmission of a network station to the operator of such a recreational vehicle or commercial truck complies with the documentation requirements under subparagraphs (B) and (C).

(ii) Limitation. Clause (i) only applies to a recreational vehicle or commercial truck if any satellite carrier that wants to transmit a network station to the operator of that recreational vehicle or commercial truck meets the documentation requirements outlined in subparagraphs (B) and (C).

(iii) Exclusion. For purposes of this subparagraph, the terms "recreational vehicle" and "commercial truck" shall not include any fixed dwelling, whether a mobile home or otherwise.

(iii) Exclusion. For this subparagraph, the terms "recreational vehicle" and "commercial truck" do not include any fixed dwelling, whether it's a mobile home or something else.

(B) Documentation requirements. A recreational vehicle or commercial truck shall be deemed to be an unserved household beginning 10 days after the relevant satellite carrier provides to the network that owns or is affiliated with the network station that will be secondarily transmitted to the recreational vehicle or commercial truck the following documents:

(B) Documentation requirements. A recreational vehicle or commercial truck will be considered an unserved household starting 10 days after the relevant satellite carrier provides the network that owns or is connected to the network station that will be secondarily transmitted to the recreational vehicle or commercial truck with the following documents:

(i) Declaration. A signed declaration by the operator of the recreational vehicle or commercial truck that the satellite dish is permanently attached to the recreational vehicle or commercial truck, and will not be used to receive satellite programming at any fixed dwelling.

(i) Declaration. A signed statement from the operator of the recreational vehicle or commercial truck confirming that the satellite dish is permanently attached to the recreational vehicle or commercial truck, and will not be used to receive satellite programming at any permanent residence.

(ii) Registration. In the case of a recreational vehicle, a copy of the current State vehicle registration for the recreational vehicle.

(ii) Registration. In the case of a recreational vehicle, a copy of the current state vehicle registration for the recreational vehicle.

(iii) Registration and license. In the case of a commercial truck, a copy of-

(iii) Registration and license. In the case of a commercial truck, a copy of-

(I) the current State vehicle registration for the truck; and

(I) the current state vehicle registration for the truck; and

(II) a copy of a valid, current commercial driver's license, as defined in regulations of the Secretary of Transportation under section 383 of title 49 of the Code of Federal Regulations, issued to the operator.

(II) a copy of a valid, current commercial driver's license, as defined in regulations set by the Secretary of Transportation under section 383 of title 49 of the Code of Federal Regulations, issued to the operator.

(C) Updated documentation requirements. If a satellite carrier wishes to continue to make secondary transmissions to a recreational vehicle or commercial truck for more than a 2-year period, that carrier shall provide each network, upon request, with updated documentation in the form described under subparagraph (B) during the 90 days before expiration of that 2-year period.

(C) Updated documentation requirements. If a satellite carrier wants to keep making secondary transmissions to a recreational vehicle or commercial truck for more than 2 years, that carrier must provide each network, upon request, with updated documentation as described in subparagraph (B) during the 90 days before the end of that 2-year period.

(12) Statutory license contingent on compliance with fcc rules and remedial steps. Notwithstanding any other provision of this section, the willful or repeated secondary transmission to the public by a satellite carrier of a primary transmission embodying a performance or display of a work made by a broadcast station licensed by the Federal Communications Commission is actionable as an act of infringement under section 501, and is fully subject to the remedies provided by sections 502 through 506 and 509, if, at the time of such transmission, the satellite carrier is not in compliance with the rules, regulations, and authorizations of the Federal Communications Commission concerning the carriage of television broadcast station signals. [60]

(12) Statutory license dependent on following FCC rules and corrective actions. Regardless of any other part of this section, knowingly or repeatedly retransmitting to the public by a satellite carrier a primary transmission that features a performance or display of a work created by a broadcast station licensed by the Federal Communications Commission is considered an infringement under section 501. It is also fully subject to the remedies outlined in sections 502 through 506 and 509 if, at the time of that transmission, the satellite carrier is not following the rules, regulations, and authorizations of the Federal Communications Commission regarding the transmission of television broadcast station signals. [60]

(b) Statutory License for Secondary Transmissions for Private Home Viewing.-

(b) Statutory License for Secondary Transmissions for Private Home Viewing.-

(1) Deposits with the register of copyrights. A satellite carrier whose secondary transmissions are subject to statutory licensing under subsection (a) shall, on a semiannual basis, deposit with the Register of Copyrights, in accordance with requirements that the Register shall prescribe by regulation-

(1) Deposits with the Register of Copyrights. A satellite carrier whose secondary transmissions are subject to statutory licensing under subsection (a) must, every six months, deposit with the Register of Copyrights, following the requirements that the Register will specify by regulation-

(A) a statement of account, covering the preceding 6-month period, specifying the names and locations of all superstations and network stations whose signals were transmitted, at any time during that period, to subscribers for private home viewing as described in subsections (a) (1) and (a)(2), the total number of subscribers that received such transmissions, and such other data as the Register of Copyrights may from time to time prescribe by regulation; and

(A) a statement of account for the previous 6-month period, listing the names and locations of all superstations and network stations that transmitted signals to subscribers for private home viewing at any time during that period as described in subsections (a) (1) and (a)(2), the total number of subscribers who received those transmissions, and any other information that the Register of Copyrights may require from time to time through regulations; and

(B) a royalty fee for that 6-month period, computed by-

(B) a royalty fee for that 6-month period, calculated by-

(i) multiplying the total number of subscribers receiving each secondary transmission of a superstation during each calendar month by 17.5 cents per subscriber in the case of superstations that as retransmitted by the satellite carrier include any program which, if delivered by any cable system in the United States, would be subject to the syndicated exclusivity rules of the Federal Communications Commission, and 14 cents per subscriber in the case of superstations that are syndex-proof as defined in section 258.2 of title 37, Code of Federal Regulations;

(i) multiplying the total number of subscribers receiving each secondary transmission of a superstation during each calendar month by 17.5 cents per subscriber for superstations that, as retransmitted by the satellite carrier, include any program that, if delivered by any cable system in the United States, would be subject to the syndicated exclusivity rules of the Federal Communications Commission, and 14 cents per subscriber for superstations that are syndex-proof as defined in section 258.2 of title 37, Code of Federal Regulations;

(ii) multiplying the number of subscribers receiving each secondary transmission of a network station or the Public Broadcasting Service satellite feed during each calendar month by 6 cents; [61] and

(ii) multiplying the number of subscribers getting each secondary transmission from a network station or the Public Broadcasting Service satellite feed during each month by 6 cents; [61] and

(iii) adding together the totals computed under clauses (i) and (ii).

(iii) adding up the totals calculated in clauses (i) and (ii).

(2) Investment of fees. The Register of Copyrights shall receive all fees deposited under this section and, after deducting the reasonable costs incurred by the Copyright Office under this section (other than the costs deducted under paragraph (4)), shall deposit the balance in the Treasury of the United States, in such manner as the Secretary of the Treasury directs. All funds held by the Secretary of the Treasury shall be invested in interest-bearing securities of the United States for later distribution with interest by the Librarian of Congress as provided by this title.

(2) Investment of fees. The Register of Copyrights will collect all fees paid under this section and, after subtracting the reasonable expenses incurred by the Copyright Office under this section (excluding the costs mentioned in paragraph (4)), will deposit the remaining amount into the Treasury of the United States, as directed by the Secretary of the Treasury. All funds held by the Secretary of the Treasury will be invested in interest-bearing U.S. securities for future distribution with interest by the Librarian of Congress as outlined in this title.

(3) Persons to whom fees are distributed. The royalty fees deposited under paragraph (2) shall, in accordance with the procedures provided by paragraph (4), be distributed to those copyright owners whose works were included in a secondary transmission for private home viewing made by a satellite carrier during the applicable 6-month accounting period and who file a claim with the Librarian of Congress under paragraph (4).

(3) Individuals who receive fees. The royalty fees deposited under paragraph (2) will be distributed to the copyright owners of works included in a secondary transmission for private home viewing made by a satellite carrier during the relevant 6-month accounting period, as per the procedures outlined in paragraph (4), provided they file a claim with the Librarian of Congress under paragraph (4).

(4) Procedures for distribution. The royalty fees deposited under paragraph (2) shall be distributed in accordance with the following procedures:

(4) Procedures for distribution. The royalty fees deposited under paragraph (2) will be distributed according to the following procedures:

(A) Filing of claims for fees. During the month of July in each year, each person claiming to be entitled to statutory license fees for secondary transmissions for private home viewing shall file a claim with the Librarian of Congress, in accordance with requirements that the Librarian of Congress shall prescribe by regulation. For purposes of this paragraph, any claimants may agree among themselves as to the proportionate division of statutory license fees among them, may lump their claims together and file them jointly or as a single claim, or may designate a common agent to receive payment on their behalf.

(A) Filing of claims for fees. During July of each year, anyone who believes they are entitled to statutory license fees for secondary transmissions for private home viewing must submit a claim to the Librarian of Congress, following the guidelines specified by the Librarian of Congress through regulations. For this paragraph, claimants can agree on how to divide the statutory license fees among themselves, can combine their claims and file them together or as one single claim, or can appoint a common agent to receive payment on their behalf.

(B) Determination of controversy; distributions. After the first day of August of each year, the Librarian of Congress shall determine whether there exists a controversy concerning the distribution of royalty fees. If the Librarian of Congress determines that no such controversy exists, the Librarian of Congress shall, after deducting reasonable administrative costs under this paragraph, distribute such fees to the copyright owners entitled to receive them, or to their designated agents. If the Librarian of Congress finds the existence of a controversy, the Librarian of Congress shall, pursuant to chapter 8 of this title, convene a copyright arbitration royalty panel to determine the distribution of royalty fees.

(B) Determining disputes; distributions. After the first day of August each year, the Librarian of Congress will figure out whether there is a dispute regarding the distribution of royalty fees. If the Librarian determines that there is no dispute, they will, after subtracting reasonable administrative costs, distribute the fees to the copyright owners entitled to them, or to their designated agents. If the Librarian finds that a dispute exists, they will, according to chapter 8 of this title, assemble a copyright arbitration royalty panel to decide how the royalty fees should be distributed.

(C) Withholding of fees during controversy. During the pendency of any proceeding under this subsection, the Librarian of Congress shall withhold from distribution an amount sufficient to satisfy all claims with respect to which a controversy exists, but shall have discretion to proceed to distribute any amounts that are not in controversy.

(C) Withholding of fees during a dispute. During the ongoing proceedings under this subsection, the Librarian of Congress will withhold an amount from distribution that is enough to cover all claims involved in the dispute, but has the discretion to distribute any amounts that are not in dispute.

(c) Adjustment of Royalty Fees.-

(c) Adjustment of Royalty Rates.-

(1) Applicability and determination of royalty fees. The rate of the royalty fee payable under subsection (b)(1)(B) shall be effective unless a royalty fee is established under paragraph (2) or (3) of this subsection.

(1) Applicability and determination of royalty fees. The royalty fee rate due under subsection (b)(1)(B) will apply unless a royalty fee is set under paragraph (2) or (3) of this subsection.

(2) Fee set by voluntary negotiation.-

(2) Fee determined through voluntary negotiation.-

(A) Notice of initiation of proceedings. On or before July 1, 1996, the Librarian of Congress shall cause notice to be published in the Federal Register of the initiation of voluntary negotiation proceedings for the purpose of determining the royalty fee to be paid by satellite carriers under subsection (b)(1)(B).

(A) Notice of the start of proceedings. On or before July 1, 1996, the Librarian of Congress will publish a notice in the Federal Register announcing the start of voluntary negotiation proceedings to determine the royalty fee that satellite carriers must pay under subsection (b)(1)(B).

(B) Negotiations. Satellite carriers, distributors, and copyright owners entitled to royalty fees under this section shall negotiate in good faith in an effort to reach a voluntary agreement or voluntary agreements for the payment of royalty fees. Any such satellite carriers, distributors, and copyright owners may at any time negotiate and agree to the royalty fee, and may designate common agents to negotiate, agree to, or pay such fees. If the parties fail to identify common agents, the Librarian of Congress shall do so, after requesting recommendations from the parties to the negotiation proceeding. The parties to each negotiation proceeding shall bear the entire cost thereof.

(B) Negotiations. Satellite carriers, distributors, and copyright owners entitled to royalty fees under this section must negotiate in good faith to try to reach a voluntary agreement or agreements for the payment of royalty fees. Any of these satellite carriers, distributors, and copyright owners can negotiate and agree on the royalty fee at any time and can appoint common agents to negotiate, agree to, or pay those fees. If the parties can’t identify common agents, the Librarian of Congress will do so after asking the parties for recommendations for the negotiation process. The parties involved in each negotiation will cover the full cost of it.

(C) Agreements binding on parties; filing of agreements. Voluntary agreements negotiated at any time in accordance with this paragraph shall be binding upon all satellite carriers, distributors, and copyright owners that are parties thereto. Copies of such agreements shall be filed with the Copyright Office within 30 days after execution in accordance with regulations that the Register of Copyrights shall prescribe.

(C) Agreements binding on parties; filing of agreements. Voluntary agreements made at any time according to this paragraph will be binding on all satellite carriers, distributors, and copyright owners who are involved. Copies of these agreements must be filed with the Copyright Office within 30 days after they are signed, following the regulations set by the Register of Copyrights.

(D) Period agreement is in effect. The obligation to pay the royalty fees established under a voluntary agreement which has been filed with the Copyright Office in accordance with this paragraph shall become effective on the date specified in the agreement, and shall remain in effect until December 31, 1999, or in accordance with the terms of the agreement, whichever is later.

(D) A period agreement is in effect. The requirement to pay the royalty fees set forth in a voluntary agreement filed with the Copyright Office following this paragraph will start on the date specified in the agreement and will remain in effect until December 31, 1999, or according to the terms of the agreement, whichever is later.

(3) Fee set by compulsory arbitration.-

(3) Fee established by mandatory arbitration.-

(A) Notice of initiation of proceedings. On or before January 1, 1997, the Librarian of Congress shall cause notice to be published in the Federal Register of the initiation of arbitration proceedings for the purpose of determining a reasonable royalty fee to be paid under subsection (b)(1)(B) by satellite carriers who are not parties to a voluntary agreement filed with the Copyright Office in accordance with paragraph (2). Such arbitration proceeding shall be conducted under chapter 8.

(A) Notice of the start of proceedings. On or before January 1, 1997, the Librarian of Congress will publish a notice in the Federal Register about the beginning of arbitration proceedings to set a reasonable royalty fee to be paid under subsection (b)(1)(B) by satellite carriers that are not part of a voluntary agreement submitted to the Copyright Office according to paragraph (2). This arbitration process will be carried out under chapter 8.

(B) Establishment of royalty fees. In determining royalty fees under this paragraph, the copyright arbitration royalty panel appointed under chapter 8 shall establish fees for the retransmission of network stations and superstations that most clearly represent the fair market value of secondary transmissions. In determining the fair market value, the panel shall base its decision on economic, competitive, and programming information presented by the parties, including-

(B) Setting up royalty fees. When figuring out royalty fees under this paragraph, the copyright arbitration royalty panel appointed under chapter 8 will set fees for the retransmission of network stations and superstations that best reflect the fair market value of secondary transmissions. To determine the fair market value, the panel will consider economic, competitive, and programming information provided by the parties, including-

(i) the competitive environment in which such programming is distributed, the cost of similar signals in similar private and compulsory license marketplaces, and any special features and conditions of the retransmission marketplace;

(i) the competitive environment where this programming is distributed, the cost of similar signals in similar private and mandatory licensing markets, and any unique features and conditions of the retransmission market;

(ii) the economic impact of such fees on copyright owners and satellite carriers; and

(ii) the financial effect of these fees on copyright owners and satellite carriers; and

(iii) the impact on the continued availability of secondary transmissions to the public.

(iii) the effect on the ongoing availability of secondary broadcasts to the public.

(C) Period during which decision of arbitration panel or order of librarian effective. The obligation to pay the royalty fee established under a determination which-

(C) Period during which the arbitration panel's decision or the librarian's order is in effect. The responsibility to pay the royalty fee set by a determination which-

(i) is made by a copyright arbitration royalty panel in an arbitration proceeding under this paragraph and is adopted by the Librarian of Congress under section 802(f), or

(i) is made by a copyright arbitration royalty panel in an arbitration proceeding under this paragraph and is adopted by the Librarian of Congress under section 802(f), or

(ii) is established by the Librarian of Congress under section 802(f), shall become effective as provided in section 802(g ), or July 1, 1997, whichever is later.

(ii) is established by the Librarian of Congress under section 802(f), will take effect as stated in section 802(g), or on July 1, 1997, whichever is later.

(D) Persons subject to royalty fee. The royalty fee referred to in subparagraph (C) shall be binding on all satellite carriers, distributors, and copyright owners, who are not party to a voluntary agreement filed with the Copyright Office under paragraph (2).

(D) People responsible for the royalty fee. The royalty fee mentioned in subparagraph (C) will apply to all satellite carriers, distributors, and copyright owners who are not part of a voluntary agreement submitted to the Copyright Office under paragraph (2).

(4) Reduction. [62]-

Reduction. [62]-

(A) Superstation. The rate of the royalty fee in effect on January 1, 1998, payable in each case under subsection (b)(1)(B)(i) shall be reduced by 30 percent.

(A) Superstation. The royalty fee rate in effect on January 1, 1998, payable in each case under subsection (b)(1)(B)(i) will be reduced by 30 percent.

(B) Network and public broadcasting satellite feed. The rate of the royalty fee in effect on January 1, 1998, payable under subsection (b) (1)(B)(ii) shall be reduced by 45 percent.

(B) Network and public broadcasting satellite feed. The royalty fee rate in effect on January 1, 1998, that is payable under subsection (b)(1)(B)(ii) will be reduced by 45 percent.

(5) Public broadcasting service as agent. For purposes of section 802, with respect to royalty fees paid by satellite carriers for retransmitting the Public Broadcasting Service satellite feed, the Public Broadcasting Service shall be the agent for all public television copyright claimants and all Public Broadcasting Service member stations. [63]

(5) Public broadcasting service as agent. For the purposes of section 802, regarding royalty fees paid by satellite carriers for retransmitting the Public Broadcasting Service satellite feed, the Public Broadcasting Service will act as the agent for all public television copyright claimants and all Public Broadcasting Service member stations. [63]

(d) Definitions. As used in this section-

(d) Definitions. As used in this section-

(1) Distributor. The term "distributor" means an entity which contracts to distribute secondary transmissions from a satellite carrier and, either as a single channel or in a package with other programming, provides the secondary transmission either directly to individual subscribers for private home viewing or indirectly through other program distribution entities.

(1) Distributor. The term "distributor" refers to an entity that contracts to distribute secondary transmissions from a satellite carrier and, either as a single channel or as part of a package with other programming, delivers the secondary transmission either directly to individual subscribers for private home viewing or indirectly through other program distribution entities.

(2) Network station. The term "network station" means-

(2) Network station. The term "network station" refers to-

(A) a television broadcast station, including any translator station or terrestrial satellite station that rebroadcasts all or substantially all of the programming broadcast by a network station, that is owned or operated by, or affiliated with, one or more of the television networks in the United States which offer an interconnected program service on a regular basis for 15 or more hours per week to at least 25 of its affiliated television licensees in 10 or more States; or

(A) a TV broadcast station, including any translator station or terrestrial satellite station that rebroadcasts all or most of the programming aired by a network station, that is owned, operated by, or affiliated with one or more television networks in the United States which provide an interconnected program service regularly for 15 or more hours a week to at least 25 of its affiliated television licensees in 10 or more states; or

(B) a noncommercial educational broadcast station (as defined in section 397 of the Communications Act of 1934).

(B) a noncommercial educational broadcast station (as defined in section 397 of the Communications Act of 1934).

(3) Primary network station. The term "primary network station" means a network station that broadcasts or rebroadcasts the basic programming service of a particular national network.

(3) Primary network station. The term "primary network station" refers to a network station that broadcasts or rebroadcasts the core programming service of a specific national network.

(4) Primary transmission. The term "primary transmission" has the meaning given that term in section 111(f) of this title.

(4) Primary transmission. The term "primary transmission" means what is defined in section 111(f) of this title.

(5) Private home viewing. The term "private home viewing" means the viewing, for private use in a household by means of satellite reception equipment which is operated by an individual in that household and which serves only such household, of a secondary transmission delivered by a satellite carrier of a primary transmission of a television station licensed by the Federal Communications Commission.

(5) Private home viewing. The term "private home viewing" refers to the viewing, for personal use within a household, using satellite reception equipment that is operated by a person in that household and serves only that specific household. This involves a secondary transmission provided by a satellite carrier of a primary transmission from a television station licensed by the Federal Communications Commission.

(6) Satellite carrier. The term "satellite carrier" means an entity that uses the facilities of a satellite or satellite service licensed by the Federal Communications Commission and operates in the Fixed-Satellite Service under part 25 of title 47 of the Code of Federal Regulations or the Direct Broadcast Satellite Service under part 100 of title 47 of the Code of Federal Regulations to establish and operate a channel of communications for point-to-multipoint distribution of television station signals, and that owns or leases a capacity or service on a satellite in order to provide such point-to-multipoint distribution, except to the extent that such entity provides such distribution pursuant to tariff under the Communications Act of 1934, other than for private home viewing.

(6) Satellite carrier. The term "satellite carrier" refers to a company that uses the infrastructure of a satellite or satellite service licensed by the Federal Communications Commission and operates in the Fixed-Satellite Service under part 25 of title 47 of the Code of Federal Regulations or the Direct Broadcast Satellite Service under part 100 of title 47 of the Code of Federal Regulations to set up and run a communication channel for point-to-multipoint distribution of television station signals, and that owns or leases capacity or service on a satellite to provide that point-to-multipoint distribution, except when the entity provides such distribution according to a tariff under the Communications Act of 1934, other than for private home viewing.

(7) Secondary transmission. The term "secondary transmission" has the meaning given that term in section 111(f) of this title.

(7) Secondary transmission. The term "secondary transmission" means what is defined in section 111(f) of this title.

(8) Subscriber. The term "subscriber" means an individual who receives a secondary transmission service for private home viewing by means of a secondary transmission from a satellite carrier and pays a fee for the service, directly or indirectly, to the satellite carrier or to a distributor.

(8) Subscriber. The term "subscriber" refers to a person who receives a secondary transmission service for private home viewing through a secondary transmission from a satellite provider and pays a fee for that service, either directly or indirectly, to the satellite provider or to a distributor.

(9) Superstation. The term "superstation"-

Superstation. The term "superstation" -

(A) means a television broadcast station, other than a network station, licensed by the Federal Communications Commission that is secondarily transmitted by a satellite carrier; and

(A) means a television broadcast station, other than a network station, licensed by the Federal Communications Commission that is also transmitted by a satellite carrier; and

(B) except for purposes of computing the royalty fee, includes the
Public Broadcasting Service satellite feed. [64]

(B) except for calculating the royalty fee, includes the
Public Broadcasting Service satellite feed. [64]

(10) Unserved household. The term "unserved household", with respect to a particular television network, means a household that-

(10) Unserved household. The term "unserved household," in relation to a specific television network, refers to a household that-

(A) cannot receive, through the use of a conventional, stationary, outdoor rooftop receiving antenna, an over-the-air signal of a primary network station affiliated with that network of Grade B intensity as defined by the Federal Communications Commission under section 73.683(a) of title 47 of the Code of Federal Regulations, as in effect on January 1, 1999;

(A) cannot receive, using a standard, fixed outdoor rooftop antenna, an over-the-air signal from a primary network station associated with that network at Grade B intensity as defined by the Federal Communications Commission under section 73.683(a) of title 47 of the Code of Federal Regulations, as it was on January 1, 1999;

(B) is subject to a waiver granted under regulations established under section 339(c)(2) of the Communications Act of 1934;

(B) is subject to a waiver granted under the rules set forth in section 339(c)(2) of the Communications Act of 1934;

(C) is a subscriber to whom subsection (e) applies;

(C) is a subscriber to whom subsection (e) applies;

(D) is a subscriber to whom subsection (a)(11) applies; or

(D) is a subscriber that subsection (a)(11) applies to; or

(E) is a subscriber to whom the exemption under subsection (a)(2)(B) (iii) applies.

(E) is a subscriber who qualifies for the exemption under subsection (a)(2)(B)(iii).

(11) Local market. The term "local market" has the meaning given such term under section 122(j).

(11) Local market. The term "local market" means what is defined in section 122(j).

(12) Public broadcasting service satellite feed. The term "Public Broadcasting Service satellite feed" means the national satellite feed distributed and designated for purposes of this section by the Public Broadcasting Service consisting of educational and informational programming intended for private home viewing, to which the Public Broadcasting Service holds national terrestrial broadcast rights. [65]

(12) Public broadcasting service satellite feed. The term "Public Broadcasting Service satellite feed" refers to the national satellite feed that is distributed and designated for this section by the Public Broadcasting Service. It includes educational and informational programming meant for viewing at home, for which the Public Broadcasting Service has national terrestrial broadcast rights. [65]

(e) Moratorium on Copyright Liability. Until December 31, 2004, a subscriber who does not receive a signal of Grade A intensity (as defined in the regulations of the Federal Communications Commission under section 73.683(a) of title 47 of the Code of Federal Regulations, as in effect on January 1, 1999, or predicted by the Federal Communications Commission using the Individual Location Longley-Rice methodology described by the Federal Communications Commission in Docket No. 98-201) of a local network television broadcast station shall remain eligible to receive signals of network stations affiliated with the same network, if that subscriber had satellite service of such network signal terminated after July 11, 1998, and before October 31, 1999, as required by this section, or received such service on October 31, 1999.

(e) Moratorium on Copyright Liability. Until December 31, 2004, a subscriber who does not receive a signal of Grade A intensity (as defined in the regulations of the Federal Communications Commission under section 73.683(a) of title 47 of the Code of Federal Regulations, as it was on January 1, 1999, or predicted by the Federal Communications Commission using the Individual Location Longley-Rice methodology described by the Federal Communications Commission in Docket No. 98-201) from a local network television broadcast station will still be eligible to receive signals from network stations affiliated with the same network, if that subscriber had their satellite service for that network signal terminated after July 11, 1998, and before October 31, 1999, as required by this section, or received that service on October 31, 1999.

Section 120. Scope of exclusive rights in architectural works [66]

(a) Pictorial Representations Permitted. The copyright in an architectural work that has been constructed does not include the right to prevent the making, distributing, or public display of pictures, paintings, photographs, or other pictorial representations of the work, if the building in which the work is embodied is located in or ordinarily visible from a public place.

(a) Pictorial Representations Permitted. The copyright for an architectural work that has been built does not include the right to stop the creation, distribution, or public display of pictures, paintings, photographs, or other visual representations of the work, as long as the building containing the work is situated in or usually visible from a public space.

(b) Alterations to and Destruction of Buildings. Notwithstanding the provisions of section 106(2), the owners of a building embodying an architectural work may, without the consent of the author or copyright owner of the architectural work, make or authorize the making of alterations to such building, and destroy or authorize the destruction of such building.

(b) Changes to and Demolition of Buildings. Despite what is stated in section 106(2), the owners of a building featuring an architectural design can, without needing permission from the creator or copyright holder of that design, make or allow changes to the building, and demolish or permit the demolition of the building.

Section 121. Limitations on exclusive rights: reproduction for blind or other people with disabilities [67]

(a) Notwithstanding the provisions of section 106, it is not an infringement of copyright for an authorized entity to reproduce or to distribute copies or phonorecords of a previously published, nondramatic literary work if such copies or phonorecords are reproduced or distributed in specialized formats exclusively for use by blind or other persons with disabilities.

(a) Despite what is stated in section 106, it is not considered a copyright infringement for an authorized entity to make or distribute copies or recordings of a previously published, non-dramatic literary work if those copies or recordings are made or shared in specialized formats solely for the use of blind or other individuals with disabilities.

(b)(1) Copies or phonorecords to which this section applies shall

(b)(1) Copies or recordings to which this section applies shall

(A) not be reproduced or distributed in a format other than a specialized format exclusively for use by blind or other persons with disabilities;

(A) cannot be reproduced or shared in any format other than a specialized format solely for use by blind individuals or people with other disabilities;

(B) bear a notice that any further reproduction or distribution in a format other than a specialized format is an infringement; and

(B) include a notice that any additional reproduction or distribution in a format other than a specialized format is considered infringement; and

(C) include a copyright notice identifying the copyright owner and the date of the original publication.

(C) include a copyright notice that identifies the copyright owner and the date of the original publication.

(2) The provisions of this subsection shall not apply to standardized, secure, or norm-referenced tests and related testing material, or to computer programs, except the portions thereof that are in conventional human language (including descriptions of pictorial works) and displayed to users in the ordinary course of using the computer programs.

(2) The rules in this subsection don’t apply to standardized, secure, or norm-referenced tests and related testing materials, or to computer programs, except for the parts that are written in regular human language (including descriptions of images) and shown to users during normal use of the computer programs.

(c) For purposes of this section, the term-

(c) For the purposes of this section, the term-

(1) "authorized entity" means a nonprofit organization or a governmental agency that has a primary mission to provide specialized services relating to training, education, or adaptive reading or information access needs of blind or other persons with disabilities;

(1) "authorized entity" refers to a nonprofit organization or a government agency that primarily focuses on providing specialized services for training, education, or adaptive reading and information access for blind individuals or others with disabilities;

(2) "blind or other persons with disabilities" means individuals who are eligible or who may qualify in accordance with the Act entitled "An Act to provide books for the adult blind", approved March 3, 1931 (2 U.S.C. 135a; 46 Stat. 1487) to receive books and other publications produced in specialized formats; and

(2) "blind or other persons with disabilities" refers to individuals who are eligible or may qualify under the Act titled "An Act to provide books for the adult blind," approved on March 3, 1931 (2 U.S.C. 135a; 46 Stat. 1487), to receive books and other publications produced in specialized formats; and

(3) "specialized formats" means braille, audio, or digital text which is exclusively for use by blind or other persons with disabilities.

(3) "specialized formats" refers to braille, audio, or digital text that is exclusively intended for use by blind individuals or others with disabilities.

Section 122. Limitations on exclusive rights; secondary transmissions by satellite carriers within local markets [68]

(a) Secondary Transmissions of television Broadcast Stations by Satellite Carriers. A secondary transmission of a performance or display of a work embodied in a primary transmission of a television broadcast station into the station's local market shall be subject to statutory licensing under this section if-

(a) Secondary Transmissions of television Broadcast Stations by Satellite Carriers. A secondary transmission of a performance or display of a work included in a primary transmission of a television broadcast station into the station's local market will be subject to statutory licensing under this section if-

(1) the secondary transmission is made by a satellite carrier to the public;

(1) the secondary transmission is done by a satellite carrier to the public;

(2) with regard to secondary transmissions, the satellite carrier is in compliance with the rules, regulations, or authorizations of the Federal Communications Commission governing the carriage of television broadcast station signals; and

(2) regarding secondary transmissions, the satellite provider follows the rules, regulations, or approvals of the Federal Communications Commission that regulate the transmission of television broadcast station signals; and

(3) the satellite carrier makes a direct or indirect charge for the secondary transmission to-

(3) the satellite carrier charges directly or indirectly for the secondary transmission to-

(A) each subscriber receiving the secondary transmission; or

(A) each subscriber getting the secondary transmission; or

(B) a distributor that has contracted with the satellite carrier for direct or indirect delivery of the secondary transmission to the public.

(B) a distributor that has made a contract with the satellite carrier for direct or indirect delivery of the secondary transmission to the public.

(b) Reporting Requirements.-

(b) Reporting Requirements.-

(1) Initial lists. A satellite carrier that makes secondary transmissions of a primary transmission made by a network station under subsection (a) shall, within 90 days after commencing such secondary transmissions, submit to the network that owns or is affiliated with the network station a list identifying (by name in alphabetical order and street address, including county and zip code) all subscribers to which the satellite carrier makes secondary transmissions of that primary transmission under subsection (a).

(1) Initial lists. A satellite carrier that relays a primary transmission from a network station under subsection (a) must, within 90 days of starting those secondary transmissions, send the network that owns or is associated with the network station a list that includes (in alphabetical order by name and street address, including county and zip code) all subscribers receiving those secondary transmissions of the primary transmission under subsection (a).

(2) Subsequent lists. After the list is submitted under paragraph (1), the satellite carrier shall, on the 15th of each month, submit to the network a list identifying (by name in alphabetical order and street address, including county and zip code) any subscribers who have been added or dropped as subscribers since the last submission under this subsection.

(2) Subsequent lists. After the list is submitted under paragraph (1), the satellite carrier must, on the 15th of each month, provide the network with a list identifying (by name in alphabetical order and street address, including county and zip code) any subscribers who have been added or dropped since the last submission under this subsection.

(3) Use of subscriber information. Subscriber information submitted by a satellite carrier under this subsection may be used only for the purposes of monitoring compliance by the satellite carrier with this section.

(3) Use of subscriber information. Subscriber information provided by a satellite carrier under this subsection may only be used to monitor the satellite carrier's compliance with this section.

(4) Requirements of networks. The submission requirements of this subsection shall apply to a satellite carrier only if the network to which the submissions are to be made places on file with the Register of Copyrights a document identifying the name and address of the person to whom such submissions are to be made. The Register of Copyrights shall maintain for public inspection a file of all such documents.

(4) Requirements of networks. The submission requirements in this subsection apply to a satellite carrier only if the network receiving the submissions files a document with the Register of Copyrights that identifies the name and address of the person to whom the submissions should be sent. The Register of Copyrights will keep a file of all such documents available for public inspection.

(c) No Royalty Fee Required. A satellite carrier whose secondary transmissions are subject to statutory licensing under subsection (a) shall have no royalty obligation for such secondary transmissions.

(c) No Royalty Fee Required. A satellite carrier that has secondary transmissions covered by statutory licensing under subsection (a) will not have any royalty obligation for those secondary transmissions.

(d) Noncompliance with Reporting and Regulatory Requirements. Notwithstanding subsection (a), the willful or repeated secondary transmission to the public by a satellite carrier into the local market of a television broadcast station of a primary transmission embodying a performance or display of a work made by that television broadcast station is actionable as an act of infringement under section 501, and is fully subject to the remedies provided under sections 502 through 506 and 509, if the satellite carrier has not complied with the reporting requirements of subsection (b) or with the rules, regulations, and authorizations of the Federal Communications Commission concerning the carriage of television broadcast signals.

(d) Noncompliance with Reporting and Regulatory Requirements. Regardless of subsection (a), if a satellite carrier intentionally or repeatedly retransmits to the public a television broadcast station's primary transmission that shows a performance or display of a work created by that television broadcast station, this can be considered an infringement under section 501. Additionally, it is fully subject to the remedies outlined in sections 502 through 506 and 509, if the satellite carrier fails to meet the reporting requirements in subsection (b) or does not follow the rules, regulations, and authorizations set by the Federal Communications Commission regarding the transmission of television broadcast signals.

(e) Willful Alterations. Notwithstanding subsection (a), the secondary transmission to the public by a satellite carrier into the local market of a television broadcast station of a performance or display of a work embodied in a primary transmission made by that television broadcast station is actionable as an act of infringement under section 501, and is fully subject to the remedies provided by sections 502 through 506 and sections 509 and 510, if the content of the particular program in which the performance or display is embodied, or any commercial advertising or station announcement transmitted by the primary transmitter during, or immediately before or after, the transmission of such program, is in any way willfully altered by the satellite carrier through changes, deletions, or additions, or is combined with programming from any other broadcast signal.

(e) Willful Alterations. Regardless of subsection (a), if a satellite carrier sends a secondary transmission to the public in the local market of a television broadcast station that includes a performance or display of a work from a primary transmission by that station, it can be considered an act of infringement under section 501. This action is fully subject to the remedies outlined in sections 502 to 506, and sections 509 and 510, if the content of the specific program featuring the performance or display, or any commercial advertisements or station announcements aired by the primary transmitter during, or right before or after, the transmission of that program, is willfully altered by the satellite carrier through changes, deletions, or additions, or if it’s mixed with programming from any other broadcast signal.

(f) Violation of territorial Restrictions on Statutory License for television Broadcast Stations.-

(f) Violation of territorial restrictions on statutory licenses for television broadcast stations.

(1) Individual violations. The willful or repeated secondary transmission to the public by a satellite carrier of a primary transmission embodying a performance or display of a work made by a television broadcast station to a subscriber who does not reside in that station's local market, and is not subject to statutory licensing under section 119 or a private licensing agreement, is actionable as an act of infringement under section 501 and is fully subject to the remedies provided by sections 502 through 506 and 509, except that-

(1) Individual violations. The intentional or repeated secondary transmission to the public by a satellite provider of a primary transmission featuring a performance or display of a work made by a TV station to a subscriber who doesn't live in that station's local market, and is not covered by statutory licensing under section 119 or a private licensing agreement, can be treated as an infringement under section 501 and is fully subject to the remedies outlined in sections 502 through 506 and 509, except that-

(A) no damages shall be awarded for such act of infringement if the satellite carrier took corrective action by promptly withdrawing service from the ineligible subscriber; and

(A) no damages will be awarded for such an act of infringement if the satellite carrier quickly took corrective action by withdrawing service from the ineligible subscriber; and

(B) any statutory damages shall not exceed $5 for such subscriber for each month during which the violation occurred.

(B) any statutory damages shall not be more than $5 for that subscriber for each month the violation happened.

(2) Pattern of violations. If a satellite carrier engages in a willful or repeated pattern or practice of secondarily transmitting to the public a primary transmission embodying a performance or display of a work made by a television broadcast station to subscribers who do not reside in that station's local market, and are not subject to statutory licensing under section 119 or a private licensing agreement, then in addition to the remedies under paragraph (1)-

(2) Pattern of violations. If a satellite carrier intentionally or repeatedly broadcasts a primary transmission that includes a performance or display of a work created by a television broadcast station to subscribers outside that station's local market, and those subscribers are not covered by statutory licensing under section 119 or a private licensing agreement, then in addition to the remedies under paragraph (1)-

(A) if the pattern or practice has been carried out on a substantially nationwide basis, the court-

(A) if the pattern or practice has been carried out on a significantly nationwide scale, the court-

(i) shall order a permanent injunction barring the secondary transmission by the satellite carrier of the primary transmissions of that television broadcast station (and if such television broadcast station is a network station, all other television broadcast stations affiliated with such network); and

(i) will issue a permanent injunction preventing the satellite carrier from retransmitting the primary broadcasts of that television station (and if the station is part of a network, all other stations affiliated with that network); and

(ii) may order statutory damages not exceeding $250,000 for each 6-month period during which the pattern or practice was carried out; and

(ii) can order statutory damages up to $250,000 for every 6-month period during which the pattern or practice occurred; and

(B) if the pattern or practice has been carried out on a local or regional basis with respect to more than one television broadcast station, the court-

(B) if the pattern or practice has been carried out locally or regionally affecting more than one television broadcast station, the court-

(i) shall order a permanent injunction barring the secondary transmission in that locality or region by the satellite carrier of the primary transmissions of any television broadcast station; and

(i) will issue a permanent injunction preventing the satellite carrier from retransmitting the primary signals of any television broadcast station in that area or region; and

(ii) may order statutory damages not exceeding $250,000 for each 6-month period during which the pattern or practice was carried out.

(ii) may order statutory damages of up to $250,000 for each 6-month period that the pattern or practice occurred.

(g) Burden of Proof. In any action brought under subsection (f), the satellite carrier shall have the burden of proving that its secondary transmission of a primary transmission by a television broadcast station is made only to subscribers located within that station's local market or subscribers being served in compliance with section 119 or a private licensing agreement.

(g) Burden of Proof. In any action brought under subsection (f), the satellite carrier must prove that its secondary transmission of a primary transmission by a television broadcast station is made only to subscribers located within that station's local market or to subscribers being served in compliance with section 119 or a private licensing agreement.

(h) Geographic Limitations on secondary Transmissions. The statutory license created by this section shall apply to secondary transmissions to locations in the United States.

(h) Geographic Limitations on Secondary Transmissions. The statutory license established by this section will apply to secondary transmissions to locations within the United States.

(i) Exclusivity with Respect to Secondary Transmissions of Broadcast Stations by Satellite to Members of the Public. No provision of section 111 or any other law (other than this section and section 119) shall be construed to contain any authorization, exemption, or license through which secondary transmissions by satellite carriers of programming contained in a primary transmission made by a television broadcast station may be made without obtaining the consent of the copyright owner.

(i) Exclusivity Regarding Secondary Broadcasts by Satellite to the Public. No part of section 111 or any other law (except for this section and section 119) will be interpreted as granting any authorization, exemption, or license allowing satellite carriers to make secondary broadcasts of programming from a primary transmission by a television broadcast station without securing the copyright owner's consent.

(j) Definitions. In this section-

Definitions. In this section-

(1) Distributor. The term "distributor" means an entity which contracts to distribute secondary transmissions from a satellite carrier and, either as a single channel or in a package with other programming, provides the secondary transmission either directly to individual subscribers or indirectly through other program distribution entities.

(1) Distributor. The term "distributor" refers to an entity that has a contract to distribute secondary transmissions from a satellite carrier and, whether as a single channel or bundled with other programming, delivers the secondary transmission either directly to individual subscribers or indirectly through other program distribution entities.

(2) Local market.-

Local market.

(A) In general. The term "local market", in the case of both commercial and noncommercial television broadcast stations, means the designated market area in which a station is located, and-

(A) In general. The term "local market," for both commercial and noncommercial television broadcast stations, refers to the designated market area where a station is situated, and-

(i) in the case of a commercial television broadcast station, all commercial television broadcast stations licensed to a community within the same designated market area are within the same local market; and

(i) for a commercial television broadcast station, all commercial television broadcast stations licensed to a community within the same designated market area are considered to be in the same local market; and

(ii) in the case of a noncommercial educational television broadcast station, the market includes any station that is licensed to a community within the same designated market area as the noncommercial educational television broadcast station.

(ii) for a noncommercial educational television broadcast station, the market includes any station that is licensed to a community within the same designated market area as that noncommercial educational television broadcast station.

(B) County of license. In addition to the area described in subparagraph (A), a station's local market includes the county in which the station's community of license is located.

(B) County of license. In addition to the area described in subparagraph (A), a station's local market also includes the county where the station's community of license is located.

(C) Designated market area. For purposes of subparagraph (A), the term "designated market area" means a designated market area, as determined by Nielsen Media Research and published in the 1999-2000 Nielsen Station Index Directory and Nielsen Station Index United States Television Household Estimates or any successor publication.

(C) Designated market area. For the purposes of subparagraph (A), the term "designated market area" refers to a specific market area identified by Nielsen Media Research and published in the 1999-2000 Nielsen Station Index Directory and Nielsen Station Index United States Television Household Estimates or any updated publication.

(3) Network station; satellite carrier; secondary transmission. The terms "network station", "satellite carrier", and "secondary transmission" have the meanings given such terms under section 119(d).

(3) Network station; satellite carrier; secondary transmission. The terms "network station," "satellite carrier," and "secondary transmission" have the meanings provided for those terms under section 119(d).

(4) Subscriber. The term "subscriber" means a person who receives a secondary transmission service from a satellite carrier and pays a fee for the service, directly or indirectly, to the satellite carrier or to a distributor.

(4) Subscriber. The term "subscriber" refers to a person who gets a secondary transmission service from a satellite carrier and pays a fee for the service, either directly or indirectly, to the satellite carrier or to a distributor.

(5) Television broadcast station. The term "television broadcast station"-

(5) Television broadcast station. The term "television broadcast station" -

(A) means an over-the-air, commercial or noncommercial television broadcast station licensed by the Federal Communications Commission under subpart E of part 73 of title 47, Code of Federal Regulations, except that such term does not include a low-power or translator television station; and

(A) means a television broadcast station, either commercial or noncommercial, that is licensed by the Federal Communications Commission under subpart E of part 73 of title 47, Code of Federal Regulations, but this term does not include a low-power or translator television station; and

(B) includes a television broadcast station licensed by an appropriate governmental authority of Canada or Mexico if the station broadcasts primarily in the English language and is a network station as defined in section 119(d)(2)(A).

(B) includes a TV broadcast station licensed by the relevant governmental authority of Canada or Mexico if the station primarily broadcasts in English and is a network station as defined in section 119(d)(2)(A).

————————— Chapter 1 Endnotes

Chapter 1 References

1 In 1980, section 117 was amended in its entirety with an amendment in the nature of a substitute that included a new title. However, the table of sections was not changed to reflect the new title. Pub. L. No. 96-517, 94 Stat. 3015, 3028. In 1997, a technical amendment made that change. Pub. L. No. 105-80, 111 Stat. 1529, 1534.

1 In 1980, section 117 was completely revised with a substitution amendment that introduced a new title. However, the table of sections didn't get updated to show the new title. Pub. L. No. 96-517, 94 Stat. 3015, 3028. In 1997, a technical amendment made that change. Pub. L. No. 105-80, 111 Stat. 1529, 1534.

2 The Audio Home Recording Act of 1992 amended section 101 by inserting "Except as otherwise provided in this title," at the beginning of the first sentence. Pub. L. No. 102-563, 106 Stat. 4237, 4248.

2 The Audio Home Recording Act of 1992 changed section 101 by adding "Except as otherwise provided in this title," at the beginning of the first sentence. Pub. L. No. 102-563, 106 Stat. 4237, 4248.

The Berne Convention Implementation Act of 1988 amended section 101 by adding a definition for "Berne Convention work." Pub. L. No. 100-568, 102 Stat. 2853, 2854. In 1990, the Architectural Works Copyright Protection Act amended the definition of "Berne Convention work" by adding paragraph (5). Pub. L. No. 101-650, 104 Stat. 5089, 5133. The WIPO Copyright and Performances and Phonograms Treaties Implementation Act of 1998 deleted the definition of "Berne Convention work" from section 101. Pub. L. No. 105-304, 112 Stat. 2860, 2861. The definition of "Berne Convention work," as deleted, is contained in part VI of the Appendix.

The Berne Convention Implementation Act of 1988 updated section 101 by adding a definition for "Berne Convention work." Pub. L. No. 100-568, 102 Stat. 2853, 2854. In 1990, the Architectural Works Copyright Protection Act revised the definition of "Berne Convention work" by adding paragraph (5). Pub. L. No. 101-650, 104 Stat. 5089, 5133. The WIPO Copyright and Performances and Phonograms Treaties Implementation Act of 1998 removed the definition of "Berne Convention work" from section 101. Pub. L. No. 105-304, 112 Stat. 2860, 2861. The definition of "Berne Convention work," as removed, is included in part VI of the Appendix.

3 In 1990, the Architectural Works Copyright Protection Act amended section 101 by adding the definition for "architectural work." Pub. L. No. 101-650, 104 Stat. 5089, 5133. That Act states that the definition is applicable to "any architectural work that, on the date of the enactment of this Act, is unconstructed and embodied in unpublished plans or drawings, except that protection for such architectural work under title 17, United States Code, by virtue of the amendments made by this title, shall terminate on December 31, 2002, unless the work is constructed by that date."

3 In 1990, the Architectural Works Copyright Protection Act updated section 101 by adding the definition for "architectural work." Pub. L. No. 101-650, 104 Stat. 5089, 5133. That Act specifies that the definition applies to "any architectural work that, on the date of the enactment of this Act, is unconstructed and represented in unpublished plans or drawings, except that protection for such architectural work under title 17, United States Code, as a result of the amendments made by this title, will end on December 31, 2002, unless the work is built by that date."

4 The Berne Convention Implementation Act of 1988 amended section 101 by adding the definition of "Berne Convention." Pub. L. No. 100-568, 102 Stat. 2853, 2854.

4 The Berne Convention Implementation Act of 1988 changed section 101 by including the definition of "Berne Convention." Pub. L. No. 100-568, 102 Stat. 2853, 2854.

5 The Digital Performance Right in Sound Recordings Act of 1995 amended section 101 by adding the definition of "digital transmission." Pub. L. No.104-39, 109 Stat. 336, 348.

5 The Digital Performance Right in Sound Recordings Act of 1995 changed section 101 by adding the definition of "digital transmission." Pub. L. No.104-39, 109 Stat. 336, 348.

6 The Fairness in Music Licensing Act of 1998 amended section 101 by adding the definition of "establishment." Pub. L. No. 105-298, 112 Stat. 2827, 2833.

6 The Fairness in Music Licensing Act of 1998 changed section 101 by adding the definition of "establishment." Pub. L. No. 105-298, 112 Stat. 2827, 2833.

7 The Fairness in Music Licensing Act of 1998 amended section 101 by adding the definition of "food service or drinking establishment." Pub. L. No. 105-298, 112 Stat. 2827, 2833.

7 The Fairness in Music Licensing Act of 1998 changed section 101 by adding the definition of "food service or drinking establishment." Pub. L. No. 105-298, 112 Stat. 2827, 2833.

8 In 1997, the No Electronic Theft (NET) Act amended section 101 by adding the definition for "financial gain." Pub. L. No. 105-147, 111 Stat. 2678.

8 In 1997, the No Electronic Theft (NET) Act updated section 101 by introducing the definition for "financial gain." Pub. L. No. 105-147, 111 Stat. 2678.

9 The WIPO Copyright and Performances and Phonograms Treaties Implementation Act of 1998 amended section 101 by adding the definition of "Geneva Phonograms Convention." Pub. L. No. 105-304, 112 Stat. 2860, 2861.

9 The WIPO Copyright and Performances and Phonograms Treaties Implementation Act of 1998 changed section 101 by including the definition of "Geneva Phonograms Convention." Pub. L. No. 105-304, 112 Stat. 2860, 2861.

10 The Fairness in Music Licensing Act of 1998 amended section 101 by adding the definition of "gross square feet of space." Pub. L. No. 105-298, 112 Stat. 2827, 2833.

10 The Fairness in Music Licensing Act of 1998 changed section 101 by adding the definition of "gross square feet of space." Pub. L. No. 105-298, 112 Stat. 2827, 2833.

11 The WIPO Copyright and Performances and Phonograms Treaties Implementation Act of 1998 requires that paragraph (5) of the definition of "international agreement" take effect upon entry into force of the WIPO Copyright Treaty with respect to the United States. Pub. L. No. 105-304, 112 Stat. 2860, 2877.

11 The WIPO Copyright and Performances and Phonograms Treaties Implementation Act of 1998 states that paragraph (5) of the definition of "international agreement" will come into effect when the WIPO Copyright Treaty goes into effect for the United States. Pub. L. No. 105-304, 112 Stat. 2860, 2877.

12 The WIPO Copyright and Performances and Phonograms Treaties Implementation Act of 1998 requires that paragraph (6) of the definition of "international agreement" take effect upon entry into force of the WIPO Performances and Phonograms Treaty with respect to the United States. Pub. L. No. 105-304, 112 Stat. 2860, 2877.

12 The WIPO Copyright and Performances and Phonograms Treaties Implementation Act of 1998 states that paragraph (6) of the definition of "international agreement" will become effective when the WIPO Performances and Phonograms Treaty takes effect for the United States. Pub. L. No. 105-304, 112 Stat. 2860, 2877.

13 The WIPO Copyright and Performances and Phonograms Treaties Implementation Act of 1998 amended section 101 by adding the definition of "international agreement." Pub. L. No. 105-304, 112 Stat. 2860, 2861.

13 The WIPO Copyright and Performances and Phonograms Treaties Implementation Act of 1998 changed section 101 by adding the definition of "international agreement." Pub. L. No. 105-304, 112 Stat. 2860, 2861.

14 The Fairness in Music Licensing Act of 1998 amended section 101 by adding the definition of "performing rights society." Pub. L. No. 105-298, 112 Stat. 2827, 2833.

14 The Fairness in Music Licensing Act of 1998 updated section 101 by including the definition of "performing rights society." Pub. L. No. 105-298, 112 Stat. 2827, 2833.

15 The Berne Convention Implementation Act of 1988 amended the definition of "Pictorial, graphic, and sculptural works" by inserting "diagrams, models, and technical drawings, including architectural plans" in the first sentence, in lieu of "technical drawings, diagrams, and models." Pub. L. No. 100-568, 102 Stat. 2853, 2854.

15 The Berne Convention Implementation Act of 1988 changed the definition of "Pictorial, graphic, and sculptural works" by adding "diagrams, models, and technical drawings, including architectural plans" in the first sentence, instead of "technical drawings, diagrams, and models." Pub. L. No. 100-568, 102 Stat. 2853, 2854.

16 The Fairness in Music Licensing Act of 1998 amended section 101 by adding the definition of "proprietor." Pub. L. No. 105-298, 112 Stat. 2827, 2833. In 1999, a technical amendment added the phrase "For purposes of section 513,", to the beginning of the definition of "proprietor." Pub. L. No. 106-44, 113 Stat. 221, 222.

16 The Fairness in Music Licensing Act of 1998 changed section 101 by adding the definition of "proprietor." Pub. L. No. 105-298, 112 Stat. 2827, 2833. In 1999, a technical amendment added the phrase "For purposes of section 513," to the start of the definition of "proprietor." Pub. L. No. 106-44, 113 Stat. 221, 222.

17 The Copyright Renewal Act of 1992 amended section 101 by adding the definition of "registration." Pub. L. No. 102-307, 106 Stat. 264, 266.

17 The Copyright Renewal Act of 1992 changed section 101 by including the definition of "registration." Pub. L. No. 102-307, 106 Stat. 264, 266.

18 The WIPO Copyright and Performances and Phonograms Treaties Implementation Act of 1998 amended section 101 by adding the definition of "treaty party." Pub. L. No. 105-304, 112 Stat. 2860, 2861.

18 The WIPO Copyright and Performances and Phonograms Treaties Implementation Act of 1998 changed section 101 by adding the definition of "treaty party." Pub. L. No. 105-304, 112 Stat. 2860, 2861.

19 The Berne Convention Implementation Act of 1988 amended section 101 by adding the definition of "country of origin" of a Berne Convention work, for purposes of section 411. Pub. L. No. 100-568, 102 Stat. 2853, 2854. The WIPO Copyright and Performances and Phonograms Treaties Implementation Act of 1998 amended that definition by changing it to a definition for "United States work," for purposes of section 411. Pub. L. No. 105-304, 112 Stat. 2860, 2861. In 1999, a technical amendment moved the definition of "United States work" to place it in alphabetical order, after the definition for "United States." Pub. L. No. 106-44, 113 Stat. 221, 222.

19 The Berne Convention Implementation Act of 1988 updated section 101 by adding the definition of "country of origin" for a Berne Convention work, specifically for section 411. Pub. L. No. 100-568, 102 Stat. 2853, 2854. The WIPO Copyright and Performances and Phonograms Treaties Implementation Act of 1998 changed that definition to refer to "United States work," also for section 411. Pub. L. No. 105-304, 112 Stat. 2860, 2861. In 1999, a technical amendment rearranged the definition of "United States work" to put it in alphabetical order, following the definition for "United States." Pub. L. No. 106-44, 113 Stat. 221, 222.

20 The WIPO Copyright and Performances and Phonograms Treaties Implementation Act of 1998 amended section 101 by adding the definition of "WIPO Copyright Treaty." Pub. L. No. 105-304, 112 Stat. 2860, 2861. That definition is required to take effect upon entry into force of the WIPO Copyright Treaty with respect to the United States. Pub. L. No. 105-304, 112 Stat. 2860, 2877.

20 The WIPO Copyright and Performances and Phonograms Treaties Implementation Act of 1998 updated section 101 by adding a definition for "WIPO Copyright Treaty." Pub. L. No. 105-304, 112 Stat. 2860, 2861. That definition will take effect when the WIPO Copyright Treaty comes into force for the United States. Pub. L. No. 105-304, 112 Stat. 2860, 2877.

21 The WIPO Copyright and Performances and Phonograms Treaties Implementation Act of 1998 amended section 101 by adding the definition of "WIPO Performances and Phonograms Treaty." Pub. L. No. 105-304, 112 Stat. 2860, 2862. That definition is required to take effect upon entry into force of the WIPO Performances and Phonograms Treaty with respect to the United States. Pub. L. No. 105-304, 112 Stat. 2860, 2877.

21 The WIPO Copyright and Performances and Phonograms Treaties Implementation Act of 1998 updated section 101 by adding the definition of "WIPO Performances and Phonograms Treaty." Pub. L. No. 105-304, 112 Stat. 2860, 2862. This definition is set to take effect when the WIPO Performances and Phonograms Treaty is enacted for the United States. Pub. L. No. 105-304, 112 Stat. 2860, 2877.

22 The Visual Artists Rights Act of 1990 amended section 101 by adding the definition of "work of visual art." Pub. L. No. 101-650, 104 Stat. 5089, 5128.

22 The Visual Artists Rights Act of 1990 changed section 101 by including the definition of "work of visual art." Pub. L. No. 101-650, 104 Stat. 5089, 5128.

23 The Satellite Home Viewer Improvement Act of 1999 amended the definition of "a work made for hire" by inserting "as a sound recording" after "audiovisual work." Pub. L. No. 106-113, 113 Stat. 1501, app. I at 1501A-544. The Work Made for Hire and Copyright Corrections Act of 2000 amended the definition of "work made for hire" by deleting "as a sound recording" after "audiovisual work." Pub. L. No. 106-379, 114 Stat. 1444. The Act also added a second paragraph to part (2) of that definition. *Id.* These changes are effective retroactively, as of November 29, 1999.

23 The Satellite Home Viewer Improvement Act of 1999 updated the definition of "a work made for hire" by adding "as a sound recording" after "audiovisual work." Pub. L. No. 106-113, 113 Stat. 1501, app. I at 1501A-544. The Work Made for Hire and Copyright Corrections Act of 2000 changed the definition of "work made for hire" by removing "as a sound recording" after "audiovisual work." Pub. L. No. 106-379, 114 Stat. 1444. The Act also included a second paragraph in part (2) of that definition. *Id.* These changes are effective retroactively, starting from November 29, 1999.

24 The WIPO Copyright and Performances and Phonograms Treaties Implementation Act of 1998 amended section 101 by adding the definitions of "WTO Agreement" and "WTO member country," thereby transferring those definitions to section 101 from section 104A. Pub. L. No. 105-304, 112 Stat. 2860, 2862. See also endnote 29, *infra.*

24 The WIPO Copyright and Performances and Phonograms Treaties Implementation Act of 1998 changed section 101 by including the definitions of "WTO Agreement" and "WTO member country," moving those definitions from section 104A to section 101. Pub. L. No. 105-304, 112 Stat. 2860, 2862. See also endnote 29, *infra.*

25 In 1980, the definition of "computer program" was added to section 101. Pub. L. No. 96-517, 94 Stat. 3015, 3028.

25 In 1980, the definition of "computer program" was added to section 101. Pub. L. No. 96-517, 94 Stat. 3015, 3028.

26 In 1990, the Architectural Works Copyright Protection Act amended subsection 102(a) by adding at the end thereof paragraph (8). Pub. L. No. 101-650, 104 Stat. 5089, 5133.

26 In 1990, the Architectural Works Copyright Protection Act changed subsection 102(a) by adding paragraph (8) at the end. Pub. L. No. 101-650, 104 Stat. 5089, 5133.

27 The Berne Convention Implementation Act of 1988 amended section 104(b) by redesignating paragraph (4) as paragraph (5), by inserting after paragraph (3) a new paragraph (4) and by adding subsection (c) at the end. Pub. L. No. 100-568, 102 Stat. 2853, 2855. The WIPO Copyright and Performances and Phonograms Treaties Implementation Act of 1998 amended section 104 as follows: 1) by amending subsection (b) to redesignate paragraphs (3) and (5) as (5) and (6), respectively, and by adding a new paragraph (3); 2) by amending section 104(b), throughout; and 3) by adding section 104(d). Pub. L. No. 105-304, 112 Stat. 2860, 2862.

27 The Berne Convention Implementation Act of 1988 changed section 104(b) by renumbering paragraph (4) to paragraph (5), inserting a new paragraph (4) after paragraph (3), and adding subsection (c) at the end. Pub. L. No. 100-568, 102 Stat. 2853, 2855. The WIPO Copyright and Performances and Phonograms Treaties Implementation Act of 1998 updated section 104 as follows: 1) it changed subsection (b) to renumber paragraphs (3) and (5) to (5) and (6), respectively, and added a new paragraph (3); 2) it revised section 104(b) throughout; and 3) it added section 104(d). Pub. L. No. 105-304, 112 Stat. 2860, 2862.

28 The WIPO Copyright and Performances and Phonograms Treaties Implementation Act of 1998 requires that subsection (d), regarding the effect of phonograms treaties, take effect upon entry into force of the WIPO Performances and Phonograms Treaty with respect to the United States. Pub. L. No. 105-304, 112 Stat. 2860, 2877.

28 The WIPO Copyright and Performances and Phonograms Treaties Implementation Act of 1998 states that subsection (d), which relates to the impact of phonograms treaties, will take effect when the WIPO Performances and Phonograms Treaty comes into force for the United States. Pub. L. No. 105-304, 112 Stat. 2860, 2877.

29 In 1993, the North American Free Trade Agreement Implementation Act added section 104A. Pub. L. No. 103-182, 107 Stat. 2057, 2115. In 1994, the Uruguay Round Agreements Act amended section 104A in its entirety with an amendment in the nature of a substitute. Pub. L. No. 103-465, 108 Stat. 4809, 4976. On November 13, 1997, Section 104A was amended by replacing subsection (d)(3)(A), by striking the last sentence of subsection (e)(1)(B)(ii) and by rewriting paragraphs (2) and (3) of subsection (h). Pub. L. No. 105-80, 111 Stat. 1529, 1530. The WIPO Copyright and Performances and Phonograms Treaties Implementation Act of 1998 amended section 104A by rewriting paragraphs (1) and (3) of subsection (h); by adding subparagraph (E) to subsection (h)(6); and by amending subsection (h)(8)(B)(i). Pub. L. No. 105-304, 112 Stat. 2860, 2862. That act also deleted paragraph (9), thereby transferring the definitions for "WTO Agreement" and "WTO member country" from section 104A to section 101. Pub. L. No. 105-304, 112 Stat. 2860, 2863. See also endnote 24, *supra.*

29 In 1993, the North American Free Trade Agreement Implementation Act added section 104A. Pub. L. No. 103-182, 107 Stat. 2057, 2115. In 1994, the Uruguay Round Agreements Act completely amended section 104A with a substitute amendment. Pub. L. No. 103-465, 108 Stat. 4809, 4976. On November 13, 1997, Section 104A was updated by replacing subsection (d)(3)(A), removing the last sentence of subsection (e)(1)(B)(ii), and rewriting paragraphs (2) and (3) of subsection (h). Pub. L. No. 105-80, 111 Stat. 1529, 1530. The WIPO Copyright and Performances and Phonograms Treaties Implementation Act of 1998 revised section 104A by rewriting paragraphs (1) and (3) of subsection (h); adding subparagraph (E) to subsection (h)(6); and modifying subsection (h)(8)(B)(i). Pub. L. No. 105-304, 112 Stat. 2860, 2862. That act also removed paragraph (9), transferring the definitions for "WTO Agreement" and "WTO member country" from section 104A to section 101. Pub. L. No. 105-304, 112 Stat. 2860, 2863. See also endnote 24, *supra.*

30 The WIPO Copyright and Performances and Phonograms Treaties Implementation Act of 1998 requires that subparagraph (C) of the definition of "date of adherence or proclamation" take effect upon entry into force of the WIPO Copyright Treaty with respect to the United States. Pub. L. No. 105-304, 112 Stat. 2860, 2877.

30 The WIPO Copyright and Performances and Phonograms Treaties Implementation Act of 1998 states that subparagraph (C) of the definition of "date of adherence or proclamation" will be effective once the WIPO Copyright Treaty comes into effect for the United States. Pub. L. No. 105-304, 112 Stat. 2860, 2877.

31 The WIPO Copyright and Performances and Phonograms Treaties Implementation Act of 1998 requires that subparagraph (D) of the definition of "date of adherence or proclamation" take effect upon entry into force of the WIPO Performances and Phonograms Treaty with respect to the United States. Pub. L. No. 105-304, 112 Stat. 2860, 2877.

31 The WIPO Copyright and Performances and Phonograms Treaties Implementation Act of 1998 states that subparagraph (D) of the definition of "date of adherence or proclamation" takes effect when the WIPO Performances and Phonograms Treaty goes into effect for the United States. Pub. L. No. 105-304, 112 Stat. 2860, 2877.

32 The WIPO Copyright and Performances and Phonograms Treaties Implementation Act of 1998 requires that subparagraph (C) of the definition of "eligible country" take effect upon entry into force of the WIPO Copyright Treaty with respect to the United States. Pub. L. No. 105-304, 112 Stat. 2860, 2877.

32 The WIPO Copyright and Performances and Phonograms Treaties Implementation Act of 1998 requires that subparagraph (C) of the definition of "eligible country" take effect upon entry into force of the WIPO Copyright Treaty with respect to the United States. Pub. L. No. 105-304, 112 Stat. 2860, 2877.

33 The WIPO Copyright and Performances and Phonograms Treaties Implementation Act of 1998 requires that subparagraph (D) of the definition of "eligible country" take effect upon entry into force of the WIPO Performance and Phonograms Treaty with respect to the United States. Pub. L. No. 105-304, 112 Stat. 2860, 2877.

33 The WIPO Copyright and Performances and Phonograms Treaties Implementation Act of 1998 states that subparagraph (D) of the definition of "eligible country" will go into effect when the WIPO Performance and Phonograms Treaty is enforced for the United States. Pub. L. No. 105-304, 112 Stat. 2860, 2877.

34 The WIPO Copyright and Performances and Phonograms Treaties Implementation Act of 1998 requires that subparagraph (E) of the definition of "restored work" take effect upon entry into force of the WIPO Performances and Phonograms Treaty with respect to the United States. Pub. L. No. 105-304, 112 Stat. 2860, 2877.

34 The WIPO Copyright and Performances and Phonograms Treaties Implementation Act of 1998 states that subparagraph (E) of the definition of "restored work" will take effect once the WIPO Performances and Phonograms Treaty comes into force for the United States. Pub. L. No. 105-304, 112 Stat. 2860, 2877.

35 In 1968, the Standard Reference Data Act provided an exception to Section 105, Pub. L. No. 90-396, 82 Stat. 339. Section 6 of that act amended title 15 of the *United States Code* by authorizing the Secretary of Commerce, at 15 U.S.C. 290e, to secure copyright and renewal thereof on behalf of the United States as author or proprietor "in all or any part of any standard reference data which he prepares or makes available under this chapter," and to "authorize the reproduction and publication thereof by others." See also section 105(f) of the Transitional and Supplementary Provisions of the Copyright Act of 1976, in Part I of the Appendix. Pub. L. No. 94-553, 90 Stat. 2541.

35 In 1968, the Standard Reference Data Act created an exception to Section 105, Pub. L. No. 90-396, 82 Stat. 339. Section 6 of that act updated title 15 of the *United States Code* by allowing the Secretary of Commerce, at 15 U.S.C. 290e, to obtain copyright and its renewal on behalf of the United States as author or owner "in all or any part of any standard reference data that he prepares or makes available under this chapter," and to "allow others to reproduce and publish it." See also section 105(f) of the Transitional and Supplementary Provisions of the Copyright Act of 1976, in Part I of the Appendix. Pub. L. No. 94-553, 90 Stat. 2541.

36 The Digital Performance Right in Sound Recordings Act of 1995 amended section 106 by adding paragraph (6). Pub. L. No. 104-39, 109 Stat. 336. In 1999, a technical amendment substituted "121" for "120." Pub. L. No. 106-44, 113 Stat. 221, 222.

36 The Digital Performance Right in Sound Recordings Act of 1995 amended section 106 by adding paragraph (6). Pub. L. No. 104-39, 109 Stat. 336. In 1999, a technical amendment substituted "121" for "120." Pub. L. No. 106-44, 113 Stat. 221, 222.

37 The Visual Artists Rights Act of 1990 added section 106A. Pub. L. No. 101-650, 104 Stat. 5089, 5128. The Act states that, generally, section 106A is to take effect six months after the date of its enactment, that is, six months after December 1, 1990, and that the rights created by section 106A shall apply to (1) works created before such effective date but title to which has not, as of such effective date, been transferred from the author and (2) works created on or after such effective date, but shall not apply to any destruction, distortion, mutilation or other modification (as described in section 106A(a)(3)) of any work which occurred before such effective date. See also, endnote 3, chapter 3.

37 The Visual Artists Rights Act of 1990 added section 106A. Pub. L. No. 101-650, 104 Stat. 5089, 5128. The Act states that, generally, section 106A will take effect six months after the date it was enacted, which means six months after December 1, 1990. The rights established by section 106A will apply to (1) works created before this effective date for which the title has not been transferred from the author as of that date and (2) works created on or after this effective date. However, it will not apply to any destruction, distortion, mutilation, or other modifications (as described in section 106A(a)(3)) of any work that occurred before this effective date. See also, endnote 3, chapter 3.

38 The Visual Artists Rights Act of 1990 amended section 107 by adding the reference to section 106A. Pub. L. No. 101-650, 104 Stat. 5089, 5132. In 1992, section 107 was also amended to add the last sentence. Pub. L. No. 102-492, 106 Stat. 3145.

38 The Visual Artists Rights Act of 1990 changed section 107 by adding a reference to section 106A. Pub. L. No. 101-650, 104 Stat. 5089, 5132. In 1992, section 107 was also revised to include the last sentence. Pub. L. No. 102-492, 106 Stat. 3145.

39 The Copyright Amendments Act of 1992 amended section 108 by repealing subsection (i) in its entirety. Pub. L. No. 102-307, 106 Stat. 264, 272. In 1998, the Digital Millennium Copyright Act amended section 108 by making changes to subsections (a), (b) and (c); by redesignating subsection (h) as (i); and by adding a new subsection (h). Pub. L. No. 105-304, 112 Stat. 2860, 2889.

39 The Copyright Amendments Act of 1992 changed section 108 by completely removing subsection (i). Pub. L. No. 102-307, 106 Stat. 264, 272. In 1998, the Digital Millennium Copyright Act modified section 108 by updating subsections (a), (b), and (c); renumbering subsection (h) to (i); and adding a new subsection (h). Pub. L. No. 105-304, 112 Stat. 2860, 2889.

40 The Record Rental Amendment of 1984 amended section 109 by redesignating subsections (b) and (c) as subsections (c) and (d), respectively, and by inserting a new subsection (b) after subsection (a). Pub. L. No. 98-450, 98 Stat. 1727. Section 4(b) of the Act states that the provisions of section 109(b), as added by section 2 of the Act, "shall not affect the right of an owner of a particular phonorecord of a sound recording, who acquired such ownership before [October 4, 1984], to dispose of the possession of that particular phonorecord on or after such date of enactment in any manner permitted by section 109 of title 17, United States Code, as in effect on the day before the date of the enactment of this Act." Pub. L. No. 98-450, 98 Stat. 1727, 1728. Section 4(c) of the Act also states that the amendments "shall not apply to rentals, leasings, lendings (or acts or practices in the nature of rentals, leasings, or lendings) occurring after the date which is 13 years after [October 4, 1984]" In 1988, the Record Rental Amendment Act of 1984 was amended to extend the time period in section 4(c) from 5 years to 13 years. Pub. L. No. 100-617, 102 Stat. 3194. In 1993, the North American Free Trade Agreement Implementation Act repealed section 4(c) of the Record Rental Amendment of 1984. Pub. L. No. 103-182, 107 Stat. 2057, 2114. Also in 1988, technical amendments to section 109(d) inserted "(c)" in lieu of "(b)" and substituted "copyright" in lieu of "coyright" Pub. L. No. 100-617, 102 Stat. 3194.

40 The Record Rental Amendment of 1984 changed section 109 by renumbering subsections (b) and (c) to subsections (c) and (d), respectively, and adding a new subsection (b) after subsection (a). Pub. L. No. 98-450, 98 Stat. 1727. Section 4(b) of the Act specifies that the provisions of section 109(b), added by section 2 of the Act, "shall not affect the right of an owner of a particular phonorecord of a sound recording, who acquired such ownership before [October 4, 1984], to dispose of the possession of that particular phonorecord on or after such date of enactment in any manner permitted by section 109 of title 17, United States Code, as in effect on the day before the date of the enactment of this Act." Pub. L. No. 98-450, 98 Stat. 1727, 1728. Section 4(c) of the Act also clarifies that the amendments "shall not apply to rentals, leasings, lendings (or acts or practices in the nature of rentals, leasings, or lendings) occurring after the date which is 13 years after [October 4, 1984]." In 1988, the Record Rental Amendment Act of 1984 was updated to extend the time period in section 4(c) from 5 years to 13 years. Pub. L. No. 100-617, 102 Stat. 3194. In 1993, the North American Free Trade Agreement Implementation Act eliminated section 4(c) of the Record Rental Amendment of 1984. Pub. L. No. 103-182, 107 Stat. 2057, 2114. Also in 1988, technical updates to section 109(d) replaced "(b)" with "(c)" and corrected "coyright" to "copyright." Pub. L. No. 100-617, 102 Stat. 3194.

The Computer Software Rental Amendments Act of 1990 amended section 109(b) as follows: 1) paragraphs (2) and (3) were redesignated as paragraphs (3) and (4), respectively; 2) paragraph (1) was struck out and new paragraphs (1) and (2) were inserted in lieu thereof; and 3) paragraph (4), as redesignated, was amended in its entirety with a new paragraph (4) inserted in lieu thereof. Pub. L. No. 101-650, 104 Stat. 5089, 5134. The Act states that section 109(b), as amended, "shall not affect the right of a person in possession of a particular copy of a computer program, who acquired such copy before the date of the enactment of this Act, to dispose of the possession of that copy on or after such date of enactment in any manner permitted by section 109 of title 17, United States Code, as in effect on the day before such date of enactment." The Act also states that the amendments made to section 109(b) "shall not apply to rentals, leasings, or lendings (or acts or practices in the nature of rentals, leasings, or lendings) occurring on or after October 1, 1997." However, this limitation, which is set forth in the first sentence of section 804 (c) of the Computer Software Rental Amendments Act of 1990, at 104 Stat. 5136, was subsequently deleted in 1994 by the Uruguay Round Agreements Act. Pub. L. No. 103-465, 108 Stat. 4809, 4974.

The Computer Software Rental Amendments Act of 1990 updated section 109(b) as follows: 1) paragraphs (2) and (3) were renumbered as paragraphs (3) and (4); 2) paragraph (1) was removed and replaced with new paragraphs (1) and (2); and 3) paragraph (4), now renumbered, was completely rewritten with a new paragraph (4) added. Pub. L. No. 101-650, 104 Stat. 5089, 5134. The Act states that section 109(b), as updated, "shall not affect the right of a person in possession of a particular copy of a computer program, who acquired such copy before the date of the enactment of this Act, to dispose of the possession of that copy on or after such date of enactment in any manner permitted by section 109 of title 17, United States Code, as in effect on the day before such date of enactment." The Act also notes that the changes made to section 109(b) "shall not apply to rentals, leasing, or lending (or actions similar to rentals, leasing, or lending) occurring on or after October 1, 1997." However, this limitation, mentioned in the first sentence of section 804 (c) of the Computer Software Rental Amendments Act of 1990, at 104 Stat. 5136, was later removed in 1994 by the Uruguay Round Agreements Act. Pub. L. No. 103-465, 108 Stat. 4809, 4974.

The Computer Software Rental Amendments Act of 1990 also amended section 109 by adding at the end thereof subsection (e). Pub. L. No. 101-650, 104 Stat. 5089, 5135. That Act states that the provisions contained in the new subsection (e) shall take effect 1 year after the date of enactment of such Act, that is, one year after December 1, 1990. The Act also states that such amendments so made "shall not apply to public performances or displays that occur on or after October 1, 1995."

The Computer Software Rental Amendments Act of 1990 also changed section 109 by adding subsection (e) at the end. Pub. L. No. 101-650, 104 Stat. 5089, 5135. This Act says that the provisions in the new subsection (e) will take effect one year after the date the Act was enacted, which is one year after December 1, 1990. The Act also states that these amendments "will not apply to public performances or displays that happen on or after October 1, 1995."

In 1994, the Uruguay Round Agreements Act amended section 109(a) by adding the second sentence, which begins with "Notwithstanding the preceding sentence." Pub. L. No. 103-465, 108 Stat. 4809, 4981.

In 1994, the Uruguay Round Agreements Act changed section 109(a) by adding a second sentence that starts with "Notwithstanding the preceding sentence." Pub. L. No. 103-465, 108 Stat. 4809, 4981.

41 In 1988, the Extension of Record Rental Amendment amended section 110 by adding paragraph (10). Pub. L. No. 97-366, 96 Stat. 1759. In 1997, the Technical Corrections to the Satellite Home Viewer Act amended section 110 by inserting a semicolon in lieu of the period at the end of paragraph (8); by inserting "; and" in lieu of the period at the end of paragraph (9); and by inserting "(4)" in lieu of "4 above" in paragraph (10). Pub. L. No. 105-80, 111 Stat. 1529, 1534. The Fairness in Music Licensing Act of 1998 amended section 110, in paragraph 5, by adding subparagraph (B) and by making conforming amendments to subparagraph (A); by adding the phrase "or of the audiovisual or other devices utilized in such performance" to paragraph 7; and by adding the last paragraph to section 110 that begins "The exemptions provided under paragraph (5)." Pub. L. No. 105-298, 112 Stat. 2827, 2830. In 1999, a technical amendment made corrections to conform paragraph designations that were affected by amendments previously made by the Fairness in Music Licensing Act of 1998. Pub. L. No. 106-44, 113 Stat. 221.

41 In 1988, the Extension of Record Rental Amendment revised section 110 by adding paragraph (10). Pub. L. No. 97-366, 96 Stat. 1759. In 1997, the Technical Corrections to the Satellite Home Viewer Act modified section 110 by replacing the period at the end of paragraph (8) with a semicolon; inserting "; and" instead of the period at the end of paragraph (9); and changing "4 above" to "(4)" in paragraph (10). Pub. L. No. 105-80, 111 Stat. 1529, 1534. The Fairness in Music Licensing Act of 1998 updated section 110 by adding subparagraph (B) in paragraph 5 and making related adjustments to subparagraph (A); adding the phrase "or of the audiovisual or other devices utilized in such performance" to paragraph 7; and adding the last paragraph to section 110 that starts with "The exemptions provided under paragraph (5)." Pub. L. No. 105-298, 112 Stat. 2827, 2830. In 1999, a technical amendment made corrections to align paragraph designations that were impacted by earlier amendments from the Fairness in Music Licensing Act of 1998. Pub. L. No. 106-44, 113 Stat. 221.

42 In 1986, section 111(d) was amended by striking out paragraph (1) and by redesignating paragraphs (2), (3), (4) and (5) as paragraphs (1), (2), (3) and (4), respectively. Pub. L. 99-397, 100 Stat. 848. Also, in 1986, section 111(f) was amended by substituting "subsection (d)(1)" for "subsection (d)(2)" in the last sentence of the definition of "secondary transmission" and by adding a new sentence after the first sentence in the definition of "local service area of a primary transmitter." Pub. L. No. 99-397, 100 Stat. 848.

42 In 1986, section 111(d) was changed by removing paragraph (1) and renumbering paragraphs (2), (3), (4), and (5) as paragraphs (1), (2), (3), and (4), respectively. Pub. L. 99-397, 100 Stat. 848. Also, in 1986, section 111(f) was updated by replacing "subsection (d)(2)" with "subsection (d)(1)" in the last sentence of the definition of "secondary transmission" and by adding a new sentence after the first sentence in the definition of "local service area of a primary transmitter." Pub. L. No. 99-397, 100 Stat. 848.

The Satellite Home Viewer Act of 1988 amended subsection 111(a) by striking "or" at the end of paragraph (3), by redesignating paragraph (4) as paragraph (5) and by inserting a new paragraph (4). Pub. L. No. 100-667, 102 Stat. 3935, 3949. That Act also amended section (d)(1)(A) by adding the second sentence which begins with "In determining the total number."* Id.*

The Satellite Home Viewer Act of 1988 changed subsection 111(a) by removing "or" at the end of paragraph (3), renumbering paragraph (4) as paragraph (5), and adding a new paragraph (4). Pub. L. No. 100-667, 102 Stat. 3935, 3949. That Act also modified section (d)(1)(A) by including the second sentence that starts with "In determining the total number."* Id.*

The Copyright Royalty Tribunal Reform Act of 1993 amended section 111(d) by substituting "Librarian of Congress" for "Copyright Royalty Tribunal" where appropriate, by inserting a new sentence in lieu of the second and third sentences of paragraph (2) and, in paragraph (4), by amending subparagraph (B) in its entirety with substitute language. Pub. L. No. 103-198, 107 Stat. 2304, 2311.

The Copyright Royalty Tribunal Reform Act of 1993 changed section 111(d) by replacing "Copyright Royalty Tribunal" with "Librarian of Congress" where needed, adding a new sentence instead of the second and third sentences of paragraph (2), and completely revising subparagraph (B) in paragraph (4) with new wording. Pub. L. No. 103-198, 107 Stat. 2304, 2311.

The Satellite Home Viewer Act of 1994 amended section 111(f) by inserting "microwave" after "wires, cables," in the paragraph relating to the definition of "cable system" and by inserting new matter after "April 15, 1976," in the paragraph relating to the definition of "local service area of a primary transmitter." Pub. L. No. 103-369, 108 Stat. 3477, 3480. That Act provides that the amendment "relating to the definition of the local service area of a primary transmitter, shall take effect on July 1, 1994." *Id.*

The Satellite Home Viewer Act of 1994 updated section 111(f) by adding "microwave" after "wires, cables," in the part that defines "cable system" and by including new information after "April 15, 1976," in the section that defines "local service area of a primary transmitter." Pub. L. No. 103-369, 108 Stat. 3477, 3480. This Act states that the change "related to the definition of the local service area of a primary transmitter, shall take effect on July 1, 1994." *Id.*

In 1995, the Digital Performance in Sound Recordings Act amended section 111(c)(1) by inserting "and section 114(d)" in the first sentence, after "of this subsection." Pub. L. No. 104-39, 109 Stat. 336, 348.

In 1995, the Digital Performance in Sound Recordings Act changed section 111(c)(1) by adding "and section 114(d)" in the first sentence, after "of this subsection." Pub. L. No. 104-39, 109 Stat. 336, 348.

The Satellite Home Viewer Improvement Act of 1999 amended section 111 by substituting "statutory" for "compulsory" and "programming" for "programing," wherever they appeared. Pub. L. No. 106-113, 113 Stat. 1501, app. I at 1501A-543. The Act also amended sections 111(a) and (b) by inserting "performance or display of a work embodied in a primary transmission" in lieu of "primary transmission embodying a performance or display of a work." It amended paragraph (1) of section 111(c) by inserting "a performance or display of a work embodied in" after "by a cable system of" and by striking "and embodying a performance or display of a work." It amended subparagraphs (3) and (4) of section 111(a) by inserting "a performance or display of a work embodied in a primary transmission" in lieu of "a primary transmission" and by striking "and embodying a performance or display of a work." *Id.*

The Satellite Home Viewer Improvement Act of 1999 changed section 111 by replacing "compulsory" with "statutory" and "programing" with "programming" wherever those terms appeared. Pub. L. No. 106-113, 113 Stat. 1501, app. I at 1501A-543. The Act also modified sections 111(a) and (b) by adding "performance or display of a work embodied in a primary transmission" instead of "primary transmission embodying a performance or display of a work." It updated paragraph (1) of section 111(c) by inserting "a performance or display of a work embodied in" after "by a cable system of" and removing "and embodying a performance or display of a work." It amended subparagraphs (3) and (4) of section 111(a) by replacing "a primary transmission" with "a performance or display of a work embodied in a primary transmission" and removing "and embodying a performance or display of a work." *Id.*

43 Royalty rates specified by the compulsory licensing provisions of this section are subject to adjustment by copyright arbitration royalty panels appointed and convened by the Librarian of Congress in accordance with the provisions of Chapter 8 of title 17 of the *United States Code, *as amended by the Copyright Royalty Tribunal Reform Act of 1993, Pub. L. No. 103-198, 107 Stat. 2304, 2311.

43 Royalty rates set by the compulsory licensing rules in this section can be changed by copyright arbitration royalty panels that are appointed and convened by the Librarian of Congress according to the rules of Chapter 8 of title 17 of the *United States Code,* as amended by the Copyright Royalty Tribunal Reform Act of 1993, Pub. L. No. 103-198, 107 Stat. 2304, 2311.

44 In 1998, the Digital Millennium Copyright Act amended section 112 by redesignating subsection (a) as subsection (a)(1); by redesignating former sections (a)(1), (a)(2) and (a)(3) as subsections (a)(1)(A), (a) (1)(B) and (a)(1)(C), respectively; by adding subsection (a)(2); and by amending the language in new subsection (a)(1). Pub. L. No. 105-304, 112 Stat. 2860, 2888. The Digital Millennium Copyright Act also amended section 112 by redesignating subsection (e) as subsection (f) and adding a new subsection (e). Pub. L. No. 105-304, 112 Stat. 2860, 2899. In 1999, a technical amendment to section 112(e) redesignated paragraphs (3) through (10) as (2) through (9) and corrected the paragraph references throughout that section to conform to those redesignations. Pub. L. No. 106-44, 113 Stat. 221.

44 In 1998, the Digital Millennium Copyright Act changed section 112 by renaming subsection (a) as subsection (a)(1); by renaming the previous sections (a)(1), (a)(2), and (a)(3) as subsections (a)(1)(A), (a)(1)(B), and (a)(1)(C), respectively; by adding subsection (a)(2); and by updating the language in the new subsection (a)(1). Pub. L. No. 105-304, 112 Stat. 2860, 2888. The Digital Millennium Copyright Act also updated section 112 by renaming subsection (e) as subsection (f) and adding a new subsection (e). Pub. L. No. 105-304, 112 Stat. 2860, 2899. In 1999, a technical amendment to section 112(e) renamed paragraphs (3) through (10) as (2) through (9) and corrected the paragraph references throughout that section to match those new names. Pub. L. No. 106-44, 113 Stat. 221.

45 The Visual Artists Rights Act of 1990 amended section 113 by adding subsection (d) at the end thereof. Pub. L. No. 101-650, 104 Stat. 5089, 5130.

45 The Visual Artists Rights Act of 1990 changed section 113 by adding subsection (d) at the end. Pub. L. No. 101-650, 104 Stat. 5089, 5130.

46 The Digital Performance Right in Sound Recordings Act of 1995 amended section 114 as follows: 1) in subsection (a), by striking "and (3)" and inserting in lieu thereof "(3) and (6)"; 2) in subsection (b) in the first sentence, by striking "phonorecords, or of copies of motion pictures and other audiovisual works," and inserting "phonorecords or copies"; and 3) by striking subsection (d) and inserting in lieu thereof new subsections (d), (e), (f), (g), (h), (i), and (j). Pub. L. No. 104-39, 109 Stat. 336. In 1997, subsection 114(f) was amended by inserting all the text that appears after "December 31, 2000" (which is now December 31, 2001, in paragraph (1)(A)) and by striking "and publish in the Federal Register." Pub. L. No. 105-80, 111 Stat. 1529, 1531.

46 The Digital Performance Right in Sound Recordings Act of 1995 amended section 114 as follows: 1) in subsection (a), by removing "and (3)" and replacing it with "(3) and (6)"; 2) in subsection (b), in the first sentence, by removing "phonorecords, or of copies of motion pictures and other audiovisual works," and replacing it with "phonorecords or copies"; and 3) by removing subsection (d) and replacing it with new subsections (d), (e), (f), (g), (h), (i), and (j). Pub. L. No. 104-39, 109 Stat. 336. In 1997, subsection 114(f) was amended by adding all the text that appears after "December 31, 2000" (which is now December 31, 2001, in paragraph (1)(A)) and by removing "and publish in the Federal Register." Pub. L. No. 105-80, 111 Stat. 1529, 1531.

In 1998, the Digital Millennium Copyright Act amended section 114(d) by replacing paragraphs (1)(A) and (2) with amendments in the nature of substitutes. Pub. L. No. 105-304, 112 Stat. 2860, 2890. That Act also amended section 114(f) by revising the title; by redesignating paragraph (1) as paragraph (1)(A); by adding paragraph (1)(B) in lieu of paragraphs (2), (3), (4) and (5); and by amending the language in newly designated paragraph (1)(A), including revising the effective date from December 31, 2000, to December 31, 2001. Pub. L. No. 105-304, 112 Stat. 2860, 2894. The Digital Millennium Copyright Act also amended subsection 114(g) by substituting "transmission" in lieu of "subscription transmission," wherever it appears and, in the first sentence in paragraph (g)(1), by substituting "transmission licensed under a statutory license" in lieu of "subscription transmission licensed." Pub. L. No. 105-304, 112 Stat. 2860, 2897. That Act also amended subsection 114(j) by redesignating paragraphs (2), (3), (5), (6), (7) and (8) as (3), (5), (9), (12), (13) and (14), respectively; by amending paragraphs (4) and (9) in their entirety and resdesignating them as paragraphs (7) and (15), respectively; and by adding new definitions, including, paragraph (2) defining "archived program," paragraph (4) defining "continuous program," paragraph (6) defining "eligible nonsubscription transmission," paragraph (8) defining "new subscription service," paragraph (10) defining "preexisting satellite digital audio radio service" and paragraph (11) defining "preexisting subscription service." Pub. L. No. 105-304, 112 Stat. 2860, 2897.

In 1998, the Digital Millennium Copyright Act updated section 114(d) by replacing paragraphs (1)(A) and (2) with substitute amendments. Pub. L. No. 105-304, 112 Stat. 2860, 2890. It also revised section 114(f) by changing the title; redesignating paragraph (1) as paragraph (1)(A); adding paragraph (1)(B) instead of paragraphs (2), (3), (4), and (5); and changing the wording in the newly designated paragraph (1)(A), which included moving the effective date from December 31, 2000, to December 31, 2001. Pub. L. No. 105-304, 112 Stat. 2860, 2894. The Digital Millennium Copyright Act further amended subsection 114(g) by replacing "subscription transmission" with "transmission" wherever it appeared and in the first sentence of paragraph (g)(1) by changing "subscription transmission licensed" to "transmission licensed under a statutory license." Pub. L. No. 105-304, 112 Stat. 2860, 2897. It also updated subsection 114(j) by redesignating paragraphs (2), (3), (5), (6), (7), and (8) as (3), (5), (9), (12), (13), and (14), respectively; fully amending paragraphs (4) and (9) and renaming them as paragraphs (7) and (15); and by adding new definitions, including paragraph (2) for "archived program," paragraph (4) for "continuous program," paragraph (6) for "eligible nonsubscription transmission," paragraph (8) for "new subscription service," paragraph (10) for "preexisting satellite digital audio radio service," and paragraph (11) for "preexisting subscription service." Pub. L. No. 105-304, 112 Stat. 2860, 2897.

47 The Digital Millennium Copyright Act states that "the publication of notice of proceedings under section 114(f)(1) . . . as in effect upon the effective date of [the Digital Performance Right in Sound Recordings Act of 1995, Pub. L. No. 104-39, 109 Stat. 336], for the determination of royalty payments shall be deemed to have been made for the period beginning on the effective date of that Act and ending on December 1, 2001." Pub. L. No. 105-304, 112 Stat. 2860, 2899.

47 The Digital Millennium Copyright Act states that "the publication of notice of proceedings under section 114(f)(1) . . . as it was in effect on the effective date of [the Digital Performance Right in Sound Recordings Act of 1995, Pub. L. No. 104-39, 109 Stat. 336], for determining royalty payments will be considered to have occurred for the period starting on the effective date of that Act and ending on December 1, 2001." Pub. L. No. 105-304, 112 Stat. 2860, 2899.

48 The Digital Millennium Copyright Act contains an additional effective date provision for the amendment that changed the date in subsection 114(f)(1)(A) to December 31, 2001. This provision is paragraph 405(a)(5) of the Digital Millennium Copyright Act which is in Appendix V of this publication.

48 The Digital Millennium Copyright Act includes an extra effective date rule for the amendment that updated the date in subsection 114(f)(1)(A) to December 31, 2001. This rule is paragraph 405(a)(5) of the Digital Millennium Copyright Act, which can be found in Appendix V of this publication.

49 The Record Rental Amendment of 1984 amended section 115 by redesignating paragraphs (3) and (4) of subsection (c) as paragraphs (4) and (5), respectively, and by adding a new paragraph (3). Pub. L. No. 98-450, 98 Stat. 1727.

49 The Record Rental Amendment of 1984 changed section 115 by renumbering paragraphs (3) and (4) of subsection (c) to paragraphs (4) and (5), respectively, and by adding a new paragraph (3). Pub. L. No. 98-450, 98 Stat. 1727.

In 1997, section 115 was amended by striking "and publish in the Federal Register" in subparagraph 115(c)(3)(D). Pub. L. No. 105-80, 111 Stat. 1529, 1531. The same legislation also amended section 115(c)(3)(E) by replacing the phrases "sections 106(1) and (3)" and "sections 106(1) and 106(3)" with "paragraphs (1) and (3) of section 106." Pub. L. No. 105-80, 111 Stat. 1529, 1534.

In 1997, section 115 was updated by removing "and publish in the Federal Register" from subparagraph 115(c)(3)(D). Pub. L. No. 105-80, 111 Stat. 1529, 1531. The same law also revised section 115(c)(3)(E) by changing "sections 106(1) and (3)" and "sections 106(1) and 106(3)" to "paragraphs (1) and (3) of section 106." Pub. L. No. 105-80, 111 Stat. 1529, 1534.

The Digital Performance Right in Sound Recordings Act of 1995 amended section 115 as follows: 1) in the first sentence of subsection (a)(1), by striking "any other person" and inserting in lieu thereof "any other person, including those who make phonorecords or digital phonorecord deliveries,"; 2) in the second sentence of the same subsection, by inserting before the period "including by means of a digital phonorecord delivery"; 3) in the second sentence of subsection (c)(2), by inserting "and other than as provided in paragraph (3)," after "For this purpose,"; 4) by redesignating paragraphs (3), (4) and (5) of subsection (c) as paragraphs (4), (5) and (6), respectively, and by inserting after paragraph (2) a new paragraph (3); and (5) by adding after subsection (c) a new subsection (d). Pub. L. No. 104-39, 109 Stat. 336, 344.

The Digital Performance Right in Sound Recordings Act of 1995 changed section 115 as follows: 1) in the first sentence of subsection (a)(1), it removed "any other person" and replaced it with "any other person, including those who make phonorecords or digital phonorecord deliveries,"; 2) in the second sentence of the same subsection, it added before the period "including by means of a digital phonorecord delivery"; 3) in the second sentence of subsection (c)(2), it added "and other than as provided in paragraph (3)," after "For this purpose,"; 4) it renumbered paragraphs (3), (4) and (5) of subsection (c) as paragraphs (4), (5) and (6), respectively, and added a new paragraph (3) after paragraph (2); and (5) it introduced a new subsection (d) after subsection (c). Pub. L. No. 104-39, 109 Stat. 336, 344.

50 Royalty rates specified by the compulsory licensing provisions of this section are subject to adjustment by copyright arbitration royalty panels appointed and convened by the Librarian of Congress in accordance with the provisions of Chapter 8 of title 17 of the *United States Code*, as amended by the Copyright Royalty Tribunal Reform Act of 1993. Pub. L. No. 103-198, 107 Stat. 2304.

50 The royalty rates set by the mandatory licensing rules in this section can be adjusted by copyright arbitration royalty panels that are appointed and brought together by the Librarian of Congress, following the guidelines of Chapter 8 of Title 17 of the *United States Code*, as updated by the Copyright Royalty Tribunal Reform Act of 1993. Pub. L. No. 103-198, 107 Stat. 2304.

51 Pursuant to this subsection and section 803(a)(3) of title 17, the current rates have been established by regulation and may be found at 37 C.F.R. 255.

51 According to this subsection and section 803(a)(3) of title 17, the current rates have been set by regulation and can be found at 37 C.F.R. 255.

52 The Berne Convention Implementation Act of 1988 added section 116A. Pub. L. No. 100-568, 102 Stat. 2853, 2855. The Copyright Royalty Tribunal Reform Act of 1993 redesignated section 116A as section 116; repealed the preexisting section 116; in the redesignated section 116, struck subsections (b), (e), (f) and (g), and redesignated subsections (c) and (d) as subsections (b) and (c), respectively; and substituted, where appropriate, "Librarian of Congress" or "copyright arbitration royalty panel" for "Copyright Royalty Tribunal." Pub. L. No. 103-198, 107 Stat. 2304, 2309. In 1997, section 116 was amended by rewriting subsection (b)(2) and by adding a new subsection (d). Pub. L. No. 105-80, 111 Stat. 1529, 1531.

52 The Berne Convention Implementation Act of 1988 added section 116A. Pub. L. No. 100-568, 102 Stat. 2853, 2855. The Copyright Royalty Tribunal Reform Act of 1993 changed section 116A to section 116; eliminated the previous section 116; in the new section 116, removed subsections (b), (e), (f), and (g), and renumbered subsections (c) and (d) as subsections (b) and (c), respectively; and replaced, when applicable, "Librarian of Congress" or "copyright arbitration royalty panel" for "Copyright Royalty Tribunal." Pub. L. No. 103-198, 107 Stat. 2304, 2309. In 1997, section 116 was updated by revising subsection (b)(2) and adding a new subsection (d). Pub. L. No. 105-80, 111 Stat. 1529, 1531.

53 In 1980, section 117 was amended in its entirety. Pub. L. No. 96-517, 94 Stat. 3015, 3028. In 1998, the Computer Maintenance Competition Assurance Act amended section 117 by inserting headings for subsections (a) and (b) and by adding subsections (c) and (d). Pub. L. No. 105-304, 112 Stat. 2860, 2887.

53 In 1980, section 117 was completely updated. Pub. L. No. 96-517, 94 Stat. 3015, 3028. In 1998, the Computer Maintenance Competition Assurance Act revised section 117 by adding headings for subsections (a) and (b) and by including new subsections (c) and (d). Pub. L. No. 105-304, 112 Stat. 2860, 2887.

54 The Copyright Royalty Tribunal Reform Act of 1993 amended section 118 by striking the first two sentences of subsection (b), by substituting a new first sentence in paragraph (3) and by making general conforming amendments throughout. Pub. L. 103-198, 107 Stat. 2304, 2309. In 1999, a technical amendment deleted paragraph (2) from section 118(e). Pub. L. No. 106-44, 113 Stat. 221, 222.

54 The Copyright Royalty Tribunal Reform Act of 1993 changed section 118 by removing the first two sentences of subsection (b), replacing the first sentence in paragraph (3) with a new one, and making various general updates throughout. Pub. L. 103-198, 107 Stat. 2304, 2309. In 1999, a technical amendment removed paragraph (2) from section 118(e). Pub. L. No. 106-44, 113 Stat. 221, 222.

55 The Satellite Home Viewer Act of 1988 added section 119. Pub. L. No. 100-667, 102 Stat. 3935, 3949. The Copyright Royalty Tribunal Reform Act of 1993 amended subsections (b) and (c) of section 119 by substituting "Librarian of Congress" in lieu of "Copyright Royalty Tribunal" wherever it appeared and by making related conforming amendments. Pub. L. No. 103-198, 107 Stat. 2304, 2310. The Copyright Royalty Tribunal Reform Act of 1993 also amended paragraph (c)(3) by deleting subparagraphs (B), (C), (E) and (F) and by redesignating subparagraph (D) as (B), (G) as (C) and (H) as (D). The redesignated subparagraph (C) was amended in its entirety and paragraph (c)(4) was deleted. *Id.*

55 The Satellite Home Viewer Act of 1988 added section 119. Pub. L. No. 100-667, 102 Stat. 3935, 3949. The Copyright Royalty Tribunal Reform Act of 1993 changed subsections (b) and (c) of section 119 by replacing "Copyright Royalty Tribunal" with "Librarian of Congress" wherever it appeared and by making related adjustments. Pub. L. No. 103-198, 107 Stat. 2304, 2310. The Copyright Royalty Tribunal Reform Act of 1993 also modified paragraph (c)(3) by removing subparagraphs (B), (C), (E), and (F), and renaming subparagraph (D) as (B), (G) as (C), and (H) as (D). The newly named subparagraph (C) was entirely revised and paragraph (c)(4) was removed. *Id.*

The Satellite Home Viewer Act of 1994 further amended section 119. Pub. L. No. 103-369, 108 Stat. 3477. In 1997, technical corrections and clarifications were made to the Satellite Home Viewer Act of 1994. Pub. L. No. 105-80, 111 Stat. 1529. Those two acts amended section 119 as follows: 1) by deleting or replacing obsolete effective dates; 2) in subsection (a)(5), by adding subparagraph (D); 3) in subsection (a), by adding paragraphs (8), (9) and (10); 4) in subsection (b)(1)(B), by adjusting the royalty rate for retransmitted superstations; 5) in subsection (c)(3), by replacing subparagraph (B) with an amendment in the nature of a substitute; 6) in subsections (d)(2) and (d)(6), by modifying the definition of "network station" and "satellite carrier"; and 7) in subsection (d), by adding paragraph 11 to define "local market."

The Satellite Home Viewer Act of 1994 further updated section 119. Pub. L. No. 103-369, 108 Stat. 3477. In 1997, technical corrections and clarifications were made to the Satellite Home Viewer Act of 1994. Pub. L. No. 105-80, 111 Stat. 1529. These two acts changed section 119 in the following ways: 1) by removing or replacing outdated effective dates; 2) in subsection (a)(5), by adding subparagraph (D); 3) in subsection (a), by adding paragraphs (8), (9), and (10); 4) in subsection (b)(1)(B), by adjusting the royalty rate for retransmitted superstations; 5) in subsection (c)(3), by replacing subparagraph (B) with an amendment that serves as a substitute; 6) in subsections (d)(2) and (d)(6), by updating the definition of "network station" and "satellite carrier"; and 7) in subsection (d), by adding paragraph 11 to define "local market."

Pursuant to section 4 of the Satellite Home Viewer Act of 1994, the changes made by that Act to section 119 of the *United States Code* ceased to be effective on December 31, 1999. Pub. L. No. 103-369, 108 Stat. 3477, 3481. However, section 1003 of the Satellite Home Viewer Improvement Act of 1999 extended that date to December 31, 2004. Pub. L. No. 106-113, 113 Stat. 1501, app. I at 1501A-527.

Pursuant to section 4 of the Satellite Home Viewer Act of 1994, the changes made by that Act to section 119 of the *United States Code* stopped being effective on December 31, 1999. Pub. L. No. 103-369, 108 Stat. 3477, 3481. However, section 1003 of the Satellite Home Viewer Improvement Act of 1999 pushed that date to December 31, 2004. Pub. L. No. 106-113, 113 Stat. 1501, app. I at 1501A-527.

The Digital Performance Right in Sound Recordings Act of 1995 amended section 119 in the first sentence of subsections (a)(1) and (a)(2)(A), respectively, by inserting the words "and section 114(d)" after "of this subsection." Pub. L. No. 104-39, 109 Stat. 336, 348. In 1999, a technical amendment substituted "network station's" for "network's stations" in section 119(a)(8)(C)(ii). Pub. L. No. 106-44, 113 Stat. 221, 222.

The Digital Performance Right in Sound Recordings Act of 1995 changed section 119 by adding the words "and section 114(d)" after "of this subsection" in the first sentence of subsections (a)(1) and (a)(2)(A). Pub. L. No. 104-39, 109 Stat. 336, 348. In 1999, a technical amendment replaced "network's stations" with "network station's" in section 119(a)(8)(C)(ii). Pub. L. No. 106-44, 113 Stat. 221, 222.

The Satellite Home Viewer Improvement Act of 1999 amended section 119(a) (1) as follows: 1) by inserting "AND PBS SATELLITE FEED" after "SUPERSTATIONS" in the paragraph heading; 2) by inserting "performance or display of a work embodied in a primary transmission made by a superstation or by the Public Broadcasting Service satellite feed" in lieu of "primary transmission made by a superstation and embodying a performance or display of a work," (see endnote 55, *infra*) and 3) by adding the last sentence, which begins "In the case of the Public Broadcasting Service." Pub. L. No. 106-113, 113 Stat. 1501, app. I at 1501A-530 and 543. The Act states that these amendments shall be effective as of July 1, 1999, except for a portion of the second item, starting with "performance or display" through "superstation." Pub. L. No. 106-113, 113 Stat. 1501, app. I at 1501A-544. The Act also amended section 119(a) by inserting the phrase "with regard to secondary transmissions the satellite carrier is in compliance with the rules, regulations, or authorization of the Federal Communications Commission governing the carriage of television broadcast stations signals" in paragraphs (1) and (2) and by inserting into paragraph (2), "a performance or display of a work embodied in a primary transmission made by a network station" in lieu of "programming contained in a primary transmission made by a network station and embodying a performance or display of a work." *Id.* at 1501A-531 and 544. The Act amended section 119(a)(2) by substituting new language for paragraph (B) and, in paragraph (C), by deleting "currently" after "the satellite carrier" near the end of the first sentence. *Id.* at 1501A-528 and 544. It also amended section 119(a)(4) by inserting "a performance or display of a work embodied in" after "by a satellite carrier of" and by deleting "and embodying a performance or display of a work." *Id.* at 1501A-544. The Satellite Home Viewer Improvement Act of 1999 further amended section 119(a) by adding subparagraph (E) to paragraph (5). *Id.* at 1501A-528. It amended section 119(a)(6) by inserting "performance or display of a work embodied in" after "by a satellite carrier of" and by deleting "and embodying a performance or display of a work."* Id.* The Act also amended section 119(a) by adding paragraphs (11) and (12). *Id.* at 1501A-529 and 531.

The Satellite Home Viewer Improvement Act of 1999 changed section 119(a)(1) in the following ways: 1) by adding "AND PBS SATELLITE FEED" after "SUPERSTATIONS" in the heading; 2) by replacing "primary transmission made by a superstation and embodying a performance or display of a work" with "performance or display of a work embodied in a primary transmission made by a superstation or by the Public Broadcasting Service satellite feed" (see endnote 55, *infra*); and 3) by including the last sentence that starts with "In the case of the Public Broadcasting Service." Pub. L. No. 106-113, 113 Stat. 1501, app. I at 1501A-530 and 543. The Act specifies that these changes will take effect on July 1, 1999, except for part of the second item, which runs from "performance or display" to "superstation." Pub. L. No. 106-113, 113 Stat. 1501, app. I at 1501A-544. The Act also modified section 119(a) by adding "with regard to secondary transmissions the satellite carrier is in compliance with the rules, regulations, or authorization of the Federal Communications Commission governing the carriage of television broadcast stations signals" in paragraphs (1) and (2) and by replacing "programming contained in a primary transmission made by a network station and embodying a performance or display of a work" with "a performance or display of a work embodied in a primary transmission made by a network station" in paragraph (2). *Id.* at 1501A-531 and 544. The Act updated section 119(a)(2) by changing the language in paragraph (B) and by removing "currently" from near the end of the first sentence in paragraph (C) after "the satellite carrier." *Id.* at 1501A-528 and 544. It also revised section 119(a)(4) by adding "a performance or display of a work embodied in" after "by a satellite carrier of" and by removing "and embodying a performance or display of a work." *Id.* at 1501A-544. The Satellite Home Viewer Improvement Act of 1999 further updated section 119(a) by adding subparagraph (E) to paragraph (5). *Id.* at 1501A-528. It changed section 119(a)(6) by inserting "performance or display of a work embodied in" after "by a satellite carrier of" and removing "and embodying a performance or display of a work." *Id.* The Act also revised section 119(a) by adding paragraphs (11) and (12). *Id.* at 1501A-529 and 531.

The Satellite Home Viewer Improvement Act of 1999 amended section 119(b) (1) by inserting "or the Public Broadcasting Service satellite feed" into subparagraph (B). (See endnote 60, *infra.*) *Id.* at 1501A-530. The Act amended section 119(c) by adding a new paragraph (4). *Id.* at 1501A-527. The Act amended section 119(d) by substituting new language for paragraphs (9) through (11) and by adding paragraph (12).* Id.* at 1501A-527, 530 and 531. The Act substituted new language for section 119(e). *Id.* at 1501A-529.

The Satellite Home Viewer Improvement Act of 1999 changed section 119(b)(1) by adding "or the Public Broadcasting Service satellite feed" to subparagraph (B). (See endnote 60, *infra.*) *Id.* at 1501A-530. The Act also updated section 119(c) by adding a new paragraph (4). *Id.* at 1501A-527. Additionally, the Act revised section 119(d) by replacing paragraphs (9) through (11) with new language and by adding paragraph (12).* Id.* at 1501A-527, 530 and 531. The Act provided new language for section 119(e). *Id.* at 1501A-529.

56 The Satellite Home Viewer Improvement Act of 1999 amended section 119(a)(1) by deleting "primary transmission made by a superstation and embodying a performance or display of a work" and inserting in its place "performance or display of a work embodied in a primary transmission made by a superstation." Pub. L. No. 106-113, 113 Stat. 1501, app. I at 1501A-543. This amendatory language did not take into account a prior amendment which had inserted "or by the Public Broadcasting Service satellite feed" after "superstation" into the phrase quoted above that was deleted. Pub. L. No. 106-113, 113 Stat. 1501, app. I at 1501A-530. There was no mention of the phrase "or by the Public Broadcasting Service satellite feed" in that second amendment. To accommodate both amendments, the phrase "or by the Public Broadcasting Service satellite feed" has been placed at the end of the new language, after "superstation."

56 The Satellite Home Viewer Improvement Act of 1999 changed section 119(a)(1) by removing "primary transmission made by a superstation and embodying a performance or display of a work" and replacing it with "performance or display of a work embodied in a primary transmission made by a superstation." Pub. L. No. 106-113, 113 Stat. 1501, app. I at 1501A-543. This updated language didn’t consider a previous amendment that had added "or by the Public Broadcasting Service satellite feed" after "superstation" in the part that was deleted. Pub. L. No. 106-113, 113 Stat. 1501, app. I at 1501A-530. The second amendment didn’t mention the phrase "or by the Public Broadcasting Service satellite feed." To include both amendments, the phrase "or by the Public Broadcasting Service satellite feed" has been added at the end of the new wording, after "superstation."

57 The Satellite Home Viewer Act of 1994 states that "The provisions of section 119(a)(5)(D) . . . relating to the burden of proof of satellite carriers, shall take effect on January 1, 1997, with respect to civil actions relating to the eligibility of subscribers who subscribed to service as an unserved household before the date of the enactment of this Act." Pub. L. No. 103-369, 108 Stat. 3477, 3481.

57 The Satellite Home Viewer Act of 1994 states that "The provisions of section 119(a)(5)(D) . . . regarding the burden of proof for satellite carriers will take effect on January 1, 1997, in relation to civil actions concerning the eligibility of subscribers who signed up for service as unserved households before the date this Act was enacted." Pub. L. No. 103-369, 108 Stat. 3477, 3481.

58 It appears that section 1011(b)(2)(D)(i) of the Satellite Home Viewer Improvement Act of 1999 inadvertently omitted the word "a" when it amended this paragraph. Pub. L. No. 106-113, 113 Stat. 1501, app. I at 1501A-528.

58 It looks like section 1011(b)(2)(D)(i) of the Satellite Home Viewer Improvement Act of 1999 accidentally left out the word "a" when it changed this paragraph. Pub. L. No. 106-113, 113 Stat. 1501, app. I at 1501A-528.

59 The Satellite Home Viewer Act of 1994 states that "The provisions of section 119(a)(8)[,] . . . relating to transitional signal intensity measurements, shall cease to be effective on December 31, 1996." Pub. L. No. 103-369, 108 Stat. 3477, 3481.

59 The Satellite Home Viewer Act of 1994 states that "The provisions of section 119(a)(8)[,] . . . relating to transitional signal intensity measurements, shall cease to be effective on December 31, 1996." Pub. L. No. 103-369, 108 Stat. 3477, 3481.

60 It appears that Congress intended for the Satellite Home Viewer Improvement Act of 1999 to amend section 119(a) of title 17, as amended by section 1005(d) of the Satellite Home Viewer Improvement Act of 1999, by adding a new paragraph (12) at the end thereof. Pub. L. No. 106-113, 113 Stat. 1501, app. I at 1501A-531. However, due to a drafting error, the reference in the amendment is to section 119(a) as amended by section 1005(e), instead.

60 It seems that Congress intended for the Satellite Home Viewer Improvement Act of 1999 to modify section 119(a) of title 17, which was revised by section 1005(d) of the Satellite Home Viewer Improvement Act of 1999, by adding a new paragraph (12) at the end. Pub. L. No. 106-113, 113 Stat. 1501, app. I at 1501A-531. However, because of a drafting mistake, the reference in the amendment points to section 119(a) as amended by section 1005(e) instead.

61 It appears that Congress intended for the Satellite Home Viewer Improvement Act of 1999 to amend section 119(b)(1)(B)(ii) to insert "or the Public Broadcasting Service satellite feed" after "network station." Pub. L. No. 106-113, 113 Stat. 1501, app. I at 1501A-530. However, due to a drafting error, the reference in the amendment is to section 119(b) (1)(B)(iii), instead. The Act states that this amendment shall be effective as of July 1, 1999. Pub. L. No. 106-113, 113 Stat. 1501, app. I at 1501A-544.

61 It seems that Congress meant for the Satellite Home Viewer Improvement Act of 1999 to change section 119(b)(1)(B)(ii) by adding "or the Public Broadcasting Service satellite feed" after "network station." Pub. L. No. 106-113, 113 Stat. 1501, app. I at 1501A-530. However, because of a drafting mistake, the amendment refers to section 119(b)(1)(B)(iii) instead. The Act states that this amendment will be effective as of July 1, 1999. Pub. L. No. 106-113, 113 Stat. 1501, app. I at 1501A-544.

62 The Satellite Home Viewer Improvement Act of 1999 states that section 119(c)(4) shall be effective as of July 1, 1999. Pub. L. No. 106-113, 113 Stat. 1501, app. I at 1501A-527.

62 The Satellite Home Viewer Improvement Act of 1999 states that section 119(c)(4) will be effective starting July 1, 1999. Pub. L. No. 106-113, 113 Stat. 1501, app. I at 1501A-527.

63 The Satellite Home Viewer Improvement Act of 1999 states that section 119(c)(5) shall be effective as of July 1, 1999. Pub. L. No. 106-113, 113 Stat. 1501, app. I at 1501A-544.

63 The Satellite Home Viewer Improvement Act of 1999 says that section 119(c)(5) will take effect on July 1, 1999. Pub. L. No. 106-113, 113 Stat. 1501, app. I at 1501A-544.

64 The Satellite Home Viewer Improvement Act of 1999 states that section 119(d)(9) shall be effective as of July 1, 1999. Pub. L. No. 106-113, 113 Stat. 1501, app. I at 1501A-544.

64 The Satellite Home Viewer Improvement Act of 1999 states that section 119(d)(9) shall be effective as of July 1, 1999. Pub. L. No. 106-113, 113 Stat. 1501, app. I at 1501A-544.

65 The Satellite Home Viewer Improvement Act of 1999 states that section 119(d)(12) shall be effective as of July 1, 1999. Pub. L. No. 106-113, 113 Stat. 1501, app. I at 1501A-544.

65 The Satellite Home Viewer Improvement Act of 1999 says that section 119(d)(12) will take effect on July 1, 1999. Pub. L. No. 106-113, 113 Stat. 1501, app. I at 1501A-544.

66 In 1990, the Architectural Works Copyright Protection Act added section 120. Pub. L. No. 101-650, 104 Stat. 5089, 5133.

66 In 1990, the Architectural Works Copyright Protection Act added section 120. Pub. L. No. 101-650, 104 Stat. 5089, 5133.

67 The Legislative Branch Appropriations Act, 1997, added section 121. Pub. L. No. 104-197, 110 Stat. 2394, 2416. The Work Made for Hire and Copyright Corrections Act of 2000 amended section 121 by substituting "section 106" for "sections 106 and 710." Pub. L. No. 106-379, 114 Stat. 1444, 1445.

67 The Legislative Branch Appropriations Act, 1997, added section 121. Pub. L. No. 104-197, 110 Stat. 2394, 2416. The Work Made for Hire and Copyright Corrections Act of 2000 changed section 121 by replacing "sections 106 and 710" with "section 106." Pub. L. No. 106-379, 114 Stat. 1444, 1445.

68 The Satellite Home Viewer Improvement Act of 1999 added section 122. Pub. L. No. 106-113, 113 Stat. 1501, app. I at 1501A-523. The Act states that section 122 shall be effective as of November 29, 1999. Pub. L. No. 106-113, 113 Stat. 1501, app. I at 1501A-544.

68 The Satellite Home Viewer Improvement Act of 1999 added section 122. Pub. L. No. 106-113, 113 Stat. 1501, app. I at 1501A-523. The Act states that section 122 shall be effective as of November 29, 1999. Pub. L. No. 106-113, 113 Stat. 1501, app. I at 1501A-544.

————————————————————————————————————

Understood. Please provide the text you would like me to modernize.

Chapter 2

Copyright Ownership and Transfer

Copyright Ownership and Transfer

  + 201. Ownership of copyright
  + 202. Ownership of copyright as distinct from ownership of material
         object
  + 203. Termination of transfers and licenses granted by the author
  + 204. Execution of transfers of copyright ownership
  + 205. Recordation of transfers and other documents

+ 201. Copyright Ownership
  + 202. Copyright Ownership vs. Material Ownership
         object
  + 203. Ending of Transfers and Licenses Granted by the Author
  + 204. Completing Transfers of Copyright Ownership
  + 205. Recording Transfers and Other Documents

Section 201. Ownership of copyright {1}

(a) Initial Ownership. Copyright in a work protected under this title vests initially in the author or authors of the work. The authors of a joint work are coowner of copyright in the work.

(a) Initial Ownership. Copyright in a work protected under this title belongs initially to the author or authors of the work. The authors of a joint work are co-owners of the copyright in that work.

(b) Works Made for Hire. In the case of a work made for hire, the employer or other person for whom the work was prepared is considered the author for purposes of this title, and, unless the parties have expressly agreed otherwise in a written instrument signed by them, owns all of the rights comprised in the copyright.

(b) Works Made for Hire. In the case of a work created for hire, the employer or the person for whom the work was done is recognized as the author for the purposes of this title, and, unless both parties have clearly agreed otherwise in a written document signed by them, owns all the rights included in the copyright.

(c) Contributions to Collective Works. Copyright in each separate contribution to a collective work is distinct from copyright in the collective work as a whole, and vests initially in the author of the contribution. In the absence of an express transfer of the copyright or of any rights under it, the owner of copyright in the collective work is presumed to have acquired only the privilege of reproducing and distributing the contribution as part of that particular collective work, any revision of that collective work, and any later collective work in the same series.

(c) Contributions to Collective Works. Copyright for each individual contribution to a collective work is separate from the copyright for the entire collective work and initially belongs to the author of the contribution. Unless there is a clear transfer of copyright or rights under it, the copyright holder of the collective work is assumed to have only the right to reproduce and distribute that contribution as part of that specific collective work, any revisions of that collective work, and any future collective work in the same series.

(d) Transfer of Ownership.-

(d) Transfer of Ownership.

(1) The ownership of a copyright may be transferred in whole or in part by any means of conveyance or by operation of law, and may be bequeathed by will or pass as personal property by the applicable laws of intestate succession.

(1) Copyright ownership can be transferred fully or partially through any method of transfer or by law, and it can be inherited through a will or passed on as personal property according to the relevant intestate succession laws.

(2) Any of the exclusive rights comprised in a copyright, including any subdivision of any of the rights specified by section 106, may be transferred as provided by clause (1) and owned separately. The owner of any particular exclusive right is entitled, to the extent of that right, to all of the protection and remedies accorded to the copyright owner by this title.

(2) Any of the exclusive rights included in a copyright, including any subdivision of the rights specified in section 106, can be transferred as outlined in clause (1) and owned separately. The owner of any specific exclusive right is entitled, to the extent of that right, to all the protection and remedies granted to the copyright owner by this title.

(e) Involuntary Transfer. When an individual author's ownership of a copyright, or of any of the exclusive rights under a copyright, has not previously been transferred voluntarily by that individual author, no action by any governmental body or other official or organization purporting to seize, expropriate, transfer, or exercise rights of ownership with respect to the copyright, or any of the exclusive rights under a copyright, shall be given effect under this title, except as provided under title 11. [2]

(e) Involuntary Transfer. When an individual author’s ownership of a copyright, or any of the exclusive rights under that copyright, hasn’t been voluntarily transferred by that author beforehand, no action taken by any government body or other official or organization that claims to seize, take over, transfer, or exercise ownership rights regarding the copyright, or any of the exclusive rights under that copyright, will be recognized under this title, except as specified under title 11. [2]

Section 202. Ownership of copyright as distinct from ownership of material object.

Ownership of a copyright, or of any of the exclusive rights under a copyright, is distinct from ownership of any material object in which the work is embodied. Transfer of ownership of any material object, including the copy or phonorecord in which the work is first fixed, does not of itself convey any rights in the copyrighted work embodied in the object; nor, in the absence of an agreement, does transfer of ownership of a copyright or of any exclusive rights under a copyright convey property rights in any material object.

Ownership of a copyright, or any of the exclusive rights that come with it, is separate from owning the physical item that contains the work. Transferring ownership of any physical item, including the copy or record in which the work was initially fixed, doesn’t automatically give you any rights to the copyrighted work in that item; also, without an agreement, transferring ownership of a copyright or any exclusive rights doesn’t grant you property rights in any physical object.

Section 203. Termination of transfers and licenses granted by the author [3]

(a) Conditions for Termination. In the case of any work other than a work made for hire, the exclusive or nonexclusive grant of a transfer or license of copyright or of any right under a copyright, executed by the author on or after January 1, 1978, otherwise than by will, is subject to termination under the following conditions:

(a) Conditions for Termination. In the case of any work that isn't a work made for hire, the exclusive or nonexclusive grant of a transfer or license of copyright or any rights under a copyright, executed by the author on or after January 1, 1978, other than by will, is subject to termination under the following conditions:

(1) In the case of a grant executed by one author, termination of the grant may be effected by that author or, if the author is dead, by the person or persons who, under clause (2) of this subsection, own and are entitled to exercise a total of more than one-half of that author's termination interest. In the case of a grant executed by two or more authors of a joint work, termination of the grant may be effected by a majority of the authors who executed it; if any of such authors is dead, the termination interest of any such author may be exercised as a unit by the person or persons who, under clause (2) of this subsection, own and are entitled to exercise a total of more than one-half of that author's interest.

(1) If a grant is made by one author, that author can terminate the grant, or if the author has passed away, the termination can be carried out by the person or people who, according to clause (2) of this subsection, collectively own and are entitled to exercise more than half of that author's termination rights. In the case of a grant made by two or more authors of a joint work, a majority of the authors who signed it can terminate the grant; if any of those authors have passed away, their termination rights can be exercised as a whole by the person or people who, under clause (2) of this subsection, collectively own and are entitled to exercise more than half of that author's rights.

(2) Where an author is dead, his or her termination interest is owned, and may be exercised, as follows:

(2) When an author has passed away, their termination interest is owned and can be exercised as follows:

(A) the widow or widower owns the author's entire termination interest unless there are any surviving children or grandchildren of the author, in which case the widow or widower owns one-half of the author's interest;

(A) the widow or widower owns the author's entire termination interest unless there are any surviving children or grandchildren of the author, in which case the widow or widower owns half of the author's interest;

(B) the author's surviving children, and the surviving children of any dead child of the author, own the author's entire termination interest unless there is a widow or widower, in which case the ownership of one- half of the author's interest is divided among them;

(B) the author's living children, and the living children of any deceased child of the author, own the author's entire termination interest unless there is a widow or widower, in which case the ownership of half of the author's interest is divided among them;

(C) the rights of the author's children and grandchildren are in all cases divided among them and exercised on a per stirpes basis according to the number of such author's children represented; the share of the children of a dead child in a termination interest can be exercised only by the action of a majority of them.

(C) the rights of the author's children and grandchildren are always shared among them and are exercised on a per stirpes basis based on how many of the author's children are represented; the share of the children of a deceased child in a termination interest can only be acted upon by a majority of them.

(D) In the event that the author's widow or widower, children, and grandchildren are not living, the author's executor, administrator, personal representative, or trustee shall own the author's entire termination interest.

(D) If the author's spouse, children, or grandchildren are not alive, the author's executor, administrator, personal representative, or trustee will own the author's full termination interest.

(3) Termination of the grant may be effected at any time during a period of five years beginning at the end of thirty-five years from the date of execution of the grant; or, if the grant covers the right of publication of the work, the period begins at the end of thirty-five years from the date of publication of the work under the grant or at the end of forty years from the date of execution of the grant, whichever term ends earlier.

(3) The grant can be terminated anytime within a five-year period that starts either thirty-five years after the grant was executed, or, if the grant includes the publishing rights of the work, it starts thirty-five years after the work was published under the grant or forty years after the grant was executed, whichever comes first.

(4) The termination shall be effected by serving an advance notice in writing, signed by the number and proportion of owners of termination interests required under clauses (1) and (2) of this subsection, or by their duly authorized agents, upon the grantee or the grantee's successor in title.

(4) The termination will be carried out by giving advance notice in writing, signed by the amount and percentage of owners of termination interests needed under clauses (1) and (2) of this subsection, or by their authorized agents, to the grantee or the grantee's successor in title.

(A) The notice shall state the effective date of the termination, which shall fall within the five-year period specified by clause (3) of this subsection, and the notice shall be served not less than two or more than ten years before that date. A copy of the notice shall be recorded in the Copyright Office before the effective date of termination, as a condition to its taking effect.

(A) The notice must indicate the date when the termination becomes effective, which should be within the five-year period outlined in clause (3) of this subsection. The notice must be given at least two years and no more than ten years before that date. A copy of the notice must be filed in the Copyright Office before the termination date for it to take effect.

(B) The notice shall comply, in form, content, and manner of service, with requirements that the Register of Copyrights shall prescribe by regulation.

(B) The notice must meet the standards for format, content, and delivery that the Register of Copyrights will specify through regulations.

(5) Termination of the grant may be effected notwithstanding any agreement to the contrary, including an agreement to make a will or to make any future grant.

(5) The grant can be terminated regardless of any agreements to the contrary, including agreements to create a will or to provide any future grant.

(b) Effect of Termination. Upon the effective date of termination, all rights under this title that were covered by the terminated grants revert to the author, authors, and other persons owning termination interests under clauses (1) and (2) of subsection (a), including those owners who did not join in signing the notice of termination under clause (4) of subsection (a), but with the following limitations:

(b) Effect of Termination. Upon the effective date of termination, all rights under this title that were covered by the terminated grants go back to the author, authors, and other individuals who own termination interests under clauses (1) and (2) of subsection (a), including those owners who didn't sign the notice of termination under clause (4) of subsection (a), but with the following limitations:

(1) A derivative work prepared under authority of the grant before its termination may continue to be utilized under the terms of the grant after its termination, but this privilege does not extend to the preparation after the termination of other derivative works based upon the copyrighted work covered by the terminated grant.

(1) A derivative work created under the permission of the grant before it ends can still be used under the terms of the grant even after it has ended, but this right does not apply to creating additional derivative works based on the copyrighted work after the grant has terminated.

(2) The future rights that will revert upon termination of the grant become vested on the date the notice of termination has been served as provided by clause (4) of subsection (a). The rights vest in the author, authors, and other persons named in, and in the proportionate shares provided by, clauses (1) and (2) of subsection (a).

(2) The future rights that will go back to the original owners when the grant ends become official on the date the termination notice is delivered as outlined in clause (4) of subsection (a). The rights belong to the author, authors, and other specified individuals, and in the shares specified in clauses (1) and (2) of subsection (a).

(3) Subject to the provisions of clause (4) of this subsection, a further grant, or agreement to make a further grant, of any right covered by a terminated grant is valid only if it is signed by the same number and proportion of the owners, in whom the right has vested under clause (2) of this subsection, as are required to terminate the grant under clauses (1) and (2) of subsection (a). Such further grant or agreement is effective with respect to all of the persons in whom the right it covers has vested under clause (2) of this subsection, including those who did not join in signing it. If any person dies after rights under a terminated grant have vested in him or her, that person's legal representatives, legatees, or heirs at law represent him or her for purposes of this clause.

(3) According to the rules in clause (4) of this subsection, any additional grant, or agreement to provide an additional grant, of any right from a terminated grant is only valid if it's signed by the same number and proportion of owners who have the right under clause (2) of this subsection, which is required to cancel the grant under clauses (1) and (2) of subsection (a). This additional grant or agreement is effective for everyone who has the right it refers to under clause (2) of this subsection, including those who didn't sign it. If someone passes away after rights under a terminated grant have been given to them, that person's legal representatives, beneficiaries, or heirs will represent them for this clause.

(4) A further grant, or agreement to make a further grant, of any right covered by a terminated grant is valid only if it is made after the effective date of the termination. As an exception, however, an agreement for such a further grant may be made between the persons provided by clause (3) of this subsection and the original grantee or such grantee's successor in title, after the notice of termination has been served as provided by clause (4) of subsection (a).

(4) Any additional grant, or agreement to make an additional grant, of any right covered by a terminated grant is valid only if it occurs after the termination date. However, as an exception, an agreement for such an additional grant can be made between the parties described in clause (3) of this subsection and the original grantee or that grantee's successor in title, after the notice of termination has been given as stated in clause (4) of subsection (a).

(5) Termination of a grant under this section affects only those rights covered by the grants that arise under this title, and in no way affects rights arising under any other Federal, State, or foreign laws.

(5) Terminating a grant under this section only impacts the rights covered by the grants that come under this title and does not affect rights that arise under any other Federal, State, or foreign laws.

(6) Unless and until termination is effected under this section, the grant, if it does not provide otherwise, continues in effect for the term of copyright provided by this title.

(6) Unless termination is carried out under this section, the grant, unless stated otherwise, remains in effect for the duration of the copyright period outlined in this title.

Section 204. Execution of transfers of copyright ownership-

(a) A transfer of copyright ownership, other than by operation of law, is not valid unless an instrument of conveyance, or a note or memorandum of the transfer, is in writing and signed by the owner of the rights conveyed or such owner's duly authorized agent.

(a) A transfer of copyright ownership, other than by operation of law, is not valid unless there’s a written document or note that details the transfer and is signed by the owner of the rights being transferred or their authorized agent.

(b) A certificate of acknowledgment is not required for the validity of a transfer, but is prima facie evidence of the execution of the transfer if-

(b) A certificate of acknowledgment isn't necessary for a transfer to be valid, but it serves as initial proof of the transfer's execution if-

(1) in the case of a transfer executed in the United States, the certificate is issued by a person authorized to administer oaths within the United States; or

(1) If the transfer is done in the United States, the certificate is provided by someone who is authorized to administer oaths in the United States; or

(2) in the case of a transfer executed in a foreign country, the certificate is issued by a diplomatic or consular officer of the United States, or by a person authorized to administer oaths whose authority is proved by a certificate of such an officer.

(2) If a transfer is carried out in another country, the certificate is issued by a U.S. diplomatic or consular officer, or by someone authorized to administer oaths, and this authority is verified by a certificate from such an officer.

Section 205. Recordation of transfers and other documents [4]

(a) Conditions for Recordation. Any transfer of copyright ownership or other document pertaining to a copyright may be recorded in the Copyright Office if the document filed for recordation bears the actual signature of the person who executed it, or if it is accompanied by a sworn or official certification that it is a true copy of the original, signed document.

(a) Conditions for Recordation. Any transfer of copyright ownership or other document related to a copyright can be recorded in the Copyright Office if the document submitted for recordation has the actual signature of the person who signed it, or if it comes with a sworn or official certification confirming that it is a true copy of the original signed document.

(b) Certificate of Recordation. The Register of Copyrights shall, upon receipt of a document as provided by subsection (a) and of the fee provided by section 708, record the document and return it with a certificate of recordation.

(b) Certificate of Recordation. The Register of Copyrights will, upon receiving a document as outlined in subsection (a) and the fee mentioned in section 708, record the document and return it with a certificate of recordation.

(c) Recordation as Constructive Notice. Recordation of a document in the Copyright Office gives all persons constructive notice of the facts stated in the recorded document, but only if-

(c) Recording as Constructive Notice. Recording a document in the Copyright Office provides everyone with constructive notice of the facts mentioned in the recorded document, but only if-

(1) the document, or material attached to it, specifically identifies the work to which it pertains so that, after the document is indexed by the Register of Copyrights, it would be revealed by a reasonable search under the title or registration number of the work; and

(1) the document, or any material attached to it, clearly identifies the work it relates to so that, once the document is recorded by the Register of Copyrights, it can be found through a reasonable search using the title or registration number of the work; and

(2) registration has been made for the work.

(2) registration has been completed for the work.

(d) Priority Between Conflicting Transfers. As between two conflicting transfers, the one executed first prevails if it is recorded, in the manner required to give constructive notice under subsection (c), within one month after its execution in the United States or within two months after its execution outside the United States, or at any time before recordation in such manner of the later transfer. Otherwise the later transfer prevails if recorded first in such manner, and if taken in good faith, for valuable consideration or on the basis of a binding promise to pay royalties, and without notice of the earlier transfer.

(d) Priority Between Conflicting Transfers. When there are two conflicting transfers, the one that was executed first wins if it is recorded in the way required to provide constructive notice under subsection (c) within one month of its execution in the United States or within two months if it was executed outside the United States, or at any time before the later transfer is recorded in that manner. If those conditions aren't met, the later transfer takes priority if it is recorded first in that way, and if it was done in good faith, for valuable consideration or based on a binding promise to pay royalties, and without knowledge of the earlier transfer.

(e) Priority Between Conflicting Transfer of Ownership and Nonexclusive License. A nonexclusive license, whether recorded or not, prevails over a conflicting transfer of copyright ownership if the license is evidenced by a written instrument signed by the owner of the rights licensed or such owner's duly authorized agent, and if

(e) Priority Between Conflicting Transfer of Ownership and Nonexclusive License. A nonexclusive license, regardless of whether it is recorded, takes precedence over a conflicting transfer of copyright ownership if the license is documented by a written agreement signed by the owner of the licensed rights or their authorized agent, and if

(1) the license was taken before execution of the transfer; or

(1) the license was obtained before the transfer was carried out; or

(2) the license was taken in good faith before recordation of the transfer and without notice of it.

(2) the license was obtained in good faith before the transfer was recorded and without knowledge of it.

————————— Chapter 2 Endnotes

Chapter 2 References

1 In 1978, section 201(e) was amended by deleting the period at the end and adding ", except as provided under title 11."

1 In 1978, section 201(e) was updated by removing the period at the end and adding ", except as provided under title 11."

2 Title 11 of the *United States Code* is entitled "Bankruptcy."

2 Title 11 of the *United States Code* is called "Bankruptcy."

3 In 1998, the Sonny Bono Copyright Term Extension Act amended section 203 by deleting "by his widow or her widower and his or her grandchildren" from the first sentence in paragraph (2) of subsection (a) and by adding subparagraph (D) to paragraph (2). Pub. L. No. 105-298, 112 Stat. 2827, 2829.

3 In 1998, the Sonny Bono Copyright Term Extension Act changed section 203 by removing "by his widow or her widower and his or her grandchildren" from the first sentence in paragraph (2) of subsection (a) and by adding subparagraph (D) to paragraph (2). Pub. L. No. 105-298, 112 Stat. 2827, 2829.

4 The Berne Convention Implementation Act of 1988 amended section 205 by deleting subsection (d) and redesignating subsections (e) and (f) as subsections (d) and (e), respectively. Pub. L. No. 100-568, 102 Stat. 2853, 2857.

4 The Berne Convention Implementation Act of 1988 changed section 205 by removing subsection (d) and renumbering subsections (e) and (f) to subsections (d) and (e), respectively. Pub. L. No. 100-568, 102 Stat. 2853, 2857.

————————————————————————————————————

Got it! Please provide the text you want me to modernize.

Chapter 3 [1]

Duration of Copyright

Copyright Duration

  + 301. Preemption with respect to other laws
  + 302. Duration of copyright: Works created on or after January 1,
         1978
  + 303. Duration of copyright: Works created but not published or
         copyrighted before January 1, 1978
  + 304. Duration of copyright: Subsisting copyrights
  + 305. Duration of copyright: Terminal date

+ 301. Preemption regarding other laws
  + 302. Length of copyright: Works created on or after January 1,
         1978
  + 303. Length of copyright: Works created but not published or
         copyrighted before January 1, 1978
  + 304. Length of copyright: Existing copyrights
  + 305. Length of copyright: End date

Section 301. Preemption with respect to other laws [2]

(a) On and after January 1, 1978, all legal or equitable rights that are equivalent to any of the exclusive rights within the general scope of copyright as specified by section 106 in works of authorship that are fixed in a tangible medium of expression and come within the subject matter of copyright as specified by sections 102 and 103, whether created before or after that date and whether published or unpublished, are governed exclusively by this title. Thereafter, no person is entitled to any such right or equivalent right in any such work under the common law or statutes of any State.

(a) Starting January 1, 1978, all legal or equitable rights that are equivalent to any of the exclusive rights outlined in section 106 for works of authorship that are fixed in a tangible form and fall under the subject matter of copyright as described in sections 102 and 103, whether created before or after that date and whether published or unpublished, are governed solely by this title. From that point on, no person has any such right or equivalent right in any of these works under common law or the statutes of any State.

(b) Nothing in this title annuls or limits any rights or remedies under the common law or statutes of any State with respect to-

(b) Nothing in this title cancels or restricts any rights or remedies under common law or state statutes regarding-

(1) subject matter that does not come within the subject matter of copyright as specified by sections 102 and 103, including works of authorship not fixed in any tangible medium of expression; or

(1) subject matter that isn't covered by copyright as outlined in sections 102 and 103, including works of authorship that are not fixed in any physical form of expression; or

(2) any cause of action arising from undertakings commenced before January 1, 1978;

(2) any legal claim that comes from activities started before January 1, 1978;

(3) activities violating legal or equitable rights that are not equivalent to any of the exclusive rights within the general scope of copyright as specified by section 106; or

(3) activities that violate legal or fair rights and do not match any of the exclusive rights outlined in section 106 of copyright law; or

(4) State and local landmarks, historic preservation, zoning, or building codes, relating to architectural works protected under section 102(a)(8).

(4) State and local landmarks, historic preservation, zoning, or building codes related to architectural works protected under section 102(a)(8).

(c) With respect to sound recordings fixed before February 15, 1972, any rights or remedies under the common law or statutes of any State shall not be annulled or limited by this title until February 15, 2067. The preemptive provisions of subsection (a) shall apply to any such rights and remedies pertaining to any cause of action arising from undertakings commenced on and after February 15, 2067. Notwithstanding the provisions of section 303, no sound recording fixed before February 15, 1972, shall be subject to copyright under this title before, on, or after February 15, 2067.

(c) Regarding sound recordings made before February 15, 1972, any rights or remedies available under common law or state statutes will not be canceled or limited by this title until February 15, 2067. The preemptive provisions in subsection (a) will apply to any such rights and remedies related to any legal actions that start on or after February 15, 2067. Despite the rules in section 303, no sound recordings made before February 15, 1972, will be subject to copyright under this title on, before, or after February 15, 2067.

(d) Nothing in this title annuls or limits any rights or remedies under any other Federal statute.

(d) Nothing in this title cancels or limits any rights or remedies under any other Federal law.

(e) The scope of Federal preemption under this section is not affected by the adherence of the United States to the Berne Convention or the satisfaction of obligations of the United States thereunder.

(e) The extent of Federal preemption under this section isn't influenced by the United States' commitment to the Berne Convention or its fulfillment of obligations under it.

(f)(1) On or after the effective date set forth in section 610(a) of the Visual Artists Rights Act of 1990, all legal or equitable rights that are equivalent to any of the rights conferred by section 106A with respect to works of visual art to which the rights conferred by section 106A apply are governed exclusively by section 106A and section 113(d) and the provisions of this title relating to such sections. Thereafter, no person is entitled to any such right or equivalent right in any work of visual art under the common law or statutes of any State. [3]

(f)(1) On or after the effective date mentioned in section 610(a) of the Visual Artists Rights Act of 1990, all legal or equitable rights that are similar to the rights granted by section 106A for visual art works that section 106A covers are solely governed by section 106A and section 113(d) and the related provisions of this title. After that, no one has any such rights or equivalent rights in any visual artwork under state common law or statutes. [3]

(2) Nothing in paragraph (1) annuls or limits any rights or remedies under the common law or statutes of any State with respect to-

(2) Nothing in paragraph (1) cancels or restricts any rights or remedies under the common law or statutes of any State regarding-

(A) any cause of action from undertakings commenced before the effective date set forth in section 610(a) of the Visual Artists Rights Act of 1990;

(A) any legal claims from actions that started before the effective date specified in section 610(a) of the Visual Artists Rights Act of 1990;

(B) activities violating legal or equitable rights that are not equivalent to any of the rights conferred by section 106A with respect to works of visual art; or

(B) activities that violate legal or equitable rights that don’t match any of the rights granted by section 106A concerning visual art works; or

(C) activities violating legal or equitable rights which extend beyond the life of the author.

(C) activities that violate legal or fair rights that last beyond the author's lifetime.

Section 302. Duration of copyright: Works created on or after January 1, 1978 [4]

(a) In General. Copyright in a work created on or after January 1, 1978, subsists from its creation and, except as provided by the following subsections, endures for a term consisting of the life of the author and 70 years after the author's death.

(a) In General. Copyright for a work created on or after January 1, 1978, begins as soon as it's created and, unless stated otherwise in the following subsections, lasts for the life of the author plus 70 years after the author's death.

(b) Joint Works. In the case of a joint work prepared by two or more authors who did not work for hire, the copyright endures for a term consisting of the life of the last surviving author and 70 years after such last surviving author's death.

(b) Joint Works. In the case of a joint work created by two or more authors who were not employed for hire, the copyright lasts for the duration of the life of the last surviving author and for 70 years after that author's death.

(c) Anonymous Works, Pseudonymous Works, and Works Made for Hire. In the case of an anonymous work, a pseudonymous work, or a work made for hire, the copyright endures for a term of 95 years from the year of its first publication, or a term of 120 years from the year of its creation, whichever expires first. If, before the end of such term, the identity of one or more of the authors of an anonymous or pseudonymous work is revealed in the records of a registration made for that work under subsections (a) or (d) of section 408, or in the records provided by this subsection, the copyright in the work endures for the term specified by subsection (a) or (b), based on the life of the author or authors whose identity has been revealed. Any person having an interest in the copyright in an anonymous or pseudonymous work may at any time record, in records to be maintained by the Copyright Office for that purpose, a statement identifying one or more authors of the work; the statement shall also identify the person filing it, the nature of that person's interest, the source of the information recorded, and the particular work affected, and shall comply in form and content with requirements that the Register of Copyrights shall prescribe by regulation.

(c) Anonymous Works, Pseudonymous Works, and Works Made for Hire. For an anonymous work, a pseudonymous work, or a work made for hire, the copyright lasts for 95 years from the year it was first published, or for 120 years from the year it was created, whichever comes first. If, before the end of this period, the identity of one or more authors of an anonymous or pseudonymous work is disclosed in the registration records made for that work under subsections (a) or (d) of section 408, or in the records provided by this subsection, the copyright in the work lasts for the term specified by subsection (a) or (b), based on the life of the author or authors whose identity has been revealed. Anyone with an interest in the copyright of an anonymous or pseudonymous work can at any time record a statement identifying one or more authors of the work in records maintained by the Copyright Office for that purpose; the statement must also identify the person filing it, their interest, the source of the information recorded, and the specific work affected, and must comply with the form and content requirements set by the Register of Copyrights through regulation.

(d) Records Relating to Death of Authors. Any person having an interest in a copyright may at any time record in the Copyright Office a statement of the date of death of the author of the copyrighted work, or a statement that the author is still living on a particular date. The statement shall identify the person filing it, the nature of that person's interest, and the source of the information recorded, and shall comply in form and content with requirements that the Register of Copyrights shall prescribe by regulation. The Register shall maintain current records of information relating to the death of authors of copyrighted works, based on such recorded statements and, to the extent the Register considers practicable, on data contained in any of the records of the Copyright Office or in other reference sources.

(d) Records Regarding the Death of Authors. Any person with an interest in a copyright can record a statement in the Copyright Office at any time indicating the date of the author's death or stating that the author is still alive as of a specific date. The statement must identify the person submitting it, detail that person's interest, and provide the source of the information recorded. It must also meet the form and content requirements set by the Register of Copyrights through regulation. The Register will keep updated records about the deaths of authors of copyrighted works based on these recorded statements and, as far as practical, on information from other records in the Copyright Office or other reference sources.

(e) Presumption as to Author's Death. After a period of 95 years from the year of first publication of a work, or a period of 120 years from the year of its creation, whichever expires first, any person who obtains from the Copyright Office a certified report that the records provided by subsection (d) disclose nothing to indicate that the author of the work is living, or died less than 70 years before, is entitled to the benefit of a presumption that the author has been dead for at least 70 years. Reliance in good faith upon this presumption shall be a complete defense to any action for infringement under this title.

(e) Presumption About Author's Death. After 95 years from the year a work was first published, or 120 years from the year it was created, whichever comes first, anyone who gets a certified report from the Copyright Office showing that the records mentioned in subsection (d) indicate that the author is not alive, or died less than 70 years ago, is entitled to assume that the author has been dead for at least 70 years. Acting in good faith based on this assumption will be a full defense against any infringement claim under this title.

Section 303. Duration of copyright: Works created but not published or copyrighted before January 1, 1978 [5]

(a) Copyright in a work created before January 1, 1978, but not theretofore in the public domain or copyrighted, subsists from January 1, 1978, and endures for the term provided by section 302. In no case, however, shall the term of copyright in such a work expire before December 31, 2002; and, if the work is published on or before December 31, 2002, the term of copyright shall not expire before December 31, 2047.

(a) Copyright for a work created before January 1, 1978, that was not already in the public domain or copyrighted, starts on January 1, 1978, and lasts for the duration specified in section 302. However, the copyright term for such a work will not end before December 31, 2002; and if the work is published on or before December 31, 2002, the copyright will not expire before December 31, 2047.

(b) The distribution before January 1, 1978, of a phonorecord shall not for any purpose constitute a publication of the musical work embodied therein.

(b) The distribution of a phonorecord before January 1, 1978, shall not be considered a publication of the musical work contained in it for any purpose.

Section 304. Duration of copyright: Subsisting copyrights [6]

(a) Copyrights in Their First Term on January 1, 1978.

(a) Copyrights in Their First Term on January 1, 1978.

(1)(A) Any copyright, in the first term of which is subsisting on January 1, 1978, shall endure for 28 years from the date it was originally secured.

(1)(A) Any copyright that is still in effect on January 1, 1978, will last for 28 years from the date it was originally obtained.

(B) In the case of-

In this case of-

(i) any posthumous work or of any periodical, cyclopedic, or other composite work upon which the copyright was originally secured by the proprietor thereof, or

(i) any posthumous work or any periodical, encyclopedic, or other combined work for which the copyright was originally obtained by its owner, or

(ii) any work copyrighted by a corporate body (otherwise than as assignee or licensee of the individual author) or by an employer for whom such work is made for hire,

(ii) any work copyrighted by a corporate entity (other than as an assignee or licensee of the individual author) or by an employer for whom that work is created as a work for hire,

the proprietor of such copyright shall be entitled to a renewal and extension of the copyright in such work for the further term of 67 years.

the owner of such copyright will be entitled to a renewal and extension of the copyright in such work for an additional period of 67 years.

(C) In the case of any other copyrighted work, including a contribution by an individual author to a periodical or to a cyclopedic or other composite work-

(C) In the case of any other copyrighted work, including a contribution by an individual author to a magazine or to an encyclopedic or other combined work-

(i) the author of such work, if the author is still living,

(i) the writer of that work, if the writer is still alive,

(ii) the widow, widower, or children of the author, if the author is not living,

(ii) the widow, widower, or children of the author, if the author is deceased,

(iii) the author's executors, if such author, widow, widower, or children are not living, or

(iii) the author's executors, if the author, spouse, or children are not alive, or

(iv) the author's next of kin, in the absence of a will of the author, shall be entitled to a renewal and extension of the copyright in such work for a further term of 67 years.

(iv) the author's closest relatives, if there is no will from the author, will have the right to renew and extend the copyright for that work for an additional term of 67 years.

(2)(A) At the expiration of the original term of copyright in a work specified in paragraph (1)(B) of this subsection, the copyright shall endure for a renewed and extended further term of 67 years, which-

(2)(A) At the end of the original copyright term for a work mentioned in paragraph (1)(B) of this subsection, the copyright will last for a renewed and extended period of 67 years, which-

(i) if an application to register a claim to such further term has been made to the Copyright Office within 1 year before the expiration of the original term of copyright, and the claim is registered, shall vest, upon the beginning of such further term, in the proprietor of the copyright who is entitled to claim the renewal of copyright at the time the application is made; or

(i) if an application to register a claim for an extension has been made to the Copyright Office within 1 year before the original copyright term ends, and the claim is registered, it will transfer, at the start of this new term, to the copyright owner who is eligible to request the renewal of copyright when the application is submitted; or

(ii) if no such application is made or the claim pursuant to such application is not registered, shall vest, upon the beginning of such further term, in the person or entity that was the proprietor of the copyright as of the last day of the original term of copyright.

(ii) if no such application is made or if the claim based on that application is not registered, it will belong, when the new term begins, to the person or entity that owned the copyright on the last day of the original copyright term.

(B) At the expiration of the original term of copyright in a work specified in paragraph (1)(C) of this subsection, the copyright shall endure for a renewed and extended further term of 67 years, which-

(B) When the original term of copyright for a work mentioned in paragraph (1)(C) of this subsection expires, the copyright will continue for an additional extended term of 67 years, which-

(i) if an application to register a claim to such further term has been made to the Copyright Office within 1 year before the expiration of the original term of copyright, and the claim is registered, shall vest, upon the beginning of such further term, in any person who is entitled under paragraph (1)(C) to the renewal and extension of the copyright at the time the application is made; or

(i) if an application to register a claim for a further term has been submitted to the Copyright Office within 1 year before the original copyright term expires, and the claim is registered, it will be granted, upon the start of that further term, to anyone who is entitled under paragraph (1)(C) to the renewal and extension of the copyright at the time the application is submitted; or

(ii) if no such application is made or the claim pursuant to such application is not registered, shall vest, upon the beginning of such further term, in any person entitled under paragraph (1)(C), as of the last day of the original term of copyright, to the renewal and extension of the copyright.

(ii) if no application is submitted or the claim from that application is not registered, it will be granted, at the start of the new term, to anyone entitled under paragraph (1)(C), as of the last day of the original copyright term, to renew and extend the copyright.

(3)(A) An application to register a claim to the renewed and extended term of copyright in a work may be made to the Copyright Office-

(3)(A) You can apply to register a claim for the renewed and extended term of copyright in a work at the Copyright Office-

(i) within 1 year before the expiration of the original term of copyright by any person entitled under paragraph (1)(B) or (C) to such further term of 67 years; and

(i) within 1 year before the original copyright term expires for any person entitled under paragraph (1)(B) or (C) to an additional term of 67 years; and

(ii) at any time during the renewed and extended term by any person in whom such further term vested, under paragraph (2)(A) or (B), or by any successor or assign of such person, if the application is made in the name of such person.

(ii) at any time during the renewed and extended term by any person to whom that further term is granted, under paragraph (2)(A) or (B), or by any successor or assignee of that person, as long as the application is made in that person's name.

(B) Such an application is not a condition of the renewal and extension of the copyright in a work for a further term of 67 years.

(B) Such an application is not a requirement for renewing and extending the copyright of a work for another term of 67 years.

(4)(A) If an application to register a claim to the renewed and extended term of copyright in a work is not made within 1 year before the expiration of the original term of copyright in a work, or if the claim pursuant to such application is not registered, then a derivative work prepared under authority of a grant of a transfer or license of the copyright that is made before the expiration of the original term of copyright may continue to be used under the terms of the grant during the renewed and extended term of copyright without infringing the copyright, except that such use does not extend to the preparation during such renewed and extended term of other derivative works based upon the copyrighted work covered by such grant.

(4)(A) If you don't apply to register a claim for the renewed and extended copyright term of a work within 1 year before the original copyright term ends, or if the claim from that application isn’t registered, then a derivative work created under a transfer or license granted before the original copyright term ends can still be used according to the terms of that grant during the renewed and extended copyright term without violating the copyright. However, this use doesn't allow for the creation of other derivative works during the renewed and extended term based on the copyrighted work covered by that grant.

(B) If an application to register a claim to the renewed and extended term of copyright in a work is made within 1 year before its expiration, and the claim is registered, the certificate of such registration shall constitute prima facie evidence as to the validity of the copyright during its renewed and extended term and of the facts stated in the certificate. The evidentiary weight to be accorded the certificates of a registration of a renewed and extended term of copyright made after the end of that 1-year period shall be within the discretion of the court.

(B) If a claim to register a work's renewed and extended copyright term is submitted within one year before it expires, and the claim gets registered, the certificate of that registration will serve as initial proof of the copyright's validity during the renewed and extended term, as well as the facts listed in the certificate. The weight of evidence for certificates of registration for a renewed and extended copyright term submitted after that one-year period will be determined by the court's discretion.

(b) Copyrights in Their Renewal Term at the Time of the Effective Date of the Sonny Bono Copyright Term Extension Act. [7] Any copyright still in its renewal term at the time that the Sonny Bono Copyright Term Extension Act becomes effective shall have a copyright term of 95 years from the date copyright was originally secured. [8]

(b) Copyrights in Their Renewal Term at the Time of the Effective Date of the Sonny Bono Copyright Term Extension Act. [7] Any copyright still in its renewal term when the Sonny Bono Copyright Term Extension Act takes effect will have a copyright term of 95 years from the date the copyright was originally secured. [8]

(c) Termination of Transfers and Licenses Covering Extended Renewal Term. In the case of any copyright subsisting in either its first or renewal term on January 1, 1978, other than a copyright in a work made for hire, the exclusive or nonexclusive grant of a transfer or license of the renewal copyright or any right under it, executed before January 1, 1978, by any of the persons designated by subsection (a)(1)(C) of this section, otherwise than by will, is subject to termination under the following conditions:

(c) Ending of Transfers and Licenses for Extended Renewal Term. If there’s a copyright that is still valid in its first or renewal term as of January 1, 1978, and it's not a copyright for a work made for hire, any exclusive or nonexclusive transfer or license of the renewal copyright or any rights connected to it, signed before January 1, 1978, by anyone mentioned in subsection (a)(1)(C) of this section, other than by will, can be terminated under the following conditions:

(1) In the case of a grant executed by a person or persons other than the author, termination of the grant may be effected by the surviving person or persons who executed it. In the case of a grant executed by one or more of the authors of the work, termination of the grant may be effected, to the extent of a particular author's share in the ownership of the renewal copyright, by the author who executed it or, if such author is dead, by the person or persons who, under clause (2) of this subsection, own and are entitled to exercise a total of more than one- half of that author's termination interest.

(1) If a grant is made by someone other than the author, the surviving person or people who signed it can terminate the grant. If a grant is made by one or more of the authors of the work, the termination can be initiated by the author who signed it, or if that author has passed away, by the person or people who, according to clause (2) of this subsection, own and have the right to exercise more than half of that author's termination interest.

(2) Where an author is dead, his or her termination interest is owned, and may be exercised, as follows:

(2) If an author is deceased, their termination interest is owned and can be exercised in the following ways:

(A) the widow or widower owns the author's entire termination interest unless there are any surviving children or grandchildren of the author, in which case the widow or widower owns one-half of the author's interest;

(A) the widow or widower owns the author's complete termination interest unless there are any surviving children or grandchildren of the author, in which case the widow or widower owns half of the author's interest;

(B) the author's surviving children, and the surviving children of any dead child of the author, own the author's entire termination interest unless there is a widow or widower, in which case the ownership of one- half of the author's interest is divided among them;

(B) the author's living children, along with the living children of any deceased child of the author, own the author's full termination interest unless there is a widow or widower, in which case ownership of half of the author's interest is divided among them;

(C) the rights of the author's children and grandchildren are in all cases divided among them and exercised on a per stirpes basis according to the number of such author's children represented; the share of the children of a dead child in a termination interest can be exercised only by the action of a majority of them.

(C) the rights of the author's children and grandchildren are always divided among them and exercised on a per stirpes basis according to how many of the author's children are represented; the share of the children of a deceased child in a termination interest can only be exercised by the decision of a majority of them.

(D) In the event that the author's widow or widower, children, and grandchildren are not living, the author's executor, administrator, personal representative, or trustee shall own the author's entire termination interest.

(D) If the author's spouse, children, and grandchildren are not alive, the author's executor, administrator, personal representative, or trustee will own the author's entire termination interest.

(3) Termination of the grant may be effected at any time during a period of five years beginning at the end of fifty-six years from the date copyright was originally secured, or beginning on January 1, 1978, whichever is later.

(3) The grant can be terminated at any time during a five-year period starting either after fifty-six years from when the copyright was first secured or on January 1, 1978, whichever is later.

(4) The termination shall be effected by serving an advance notice in writing upon the grantee or the grantee's successor in title. In the case of a grant executed by a person or persons other than the author, the notice shall be signed by all of those entitled to terminate the grant under clause (1) of this subsection, or by their duly authorized agents. In the case of a grant executed by one or more of the authors of the work, the notice as to any one author's share shall be signed by that author or his or her duly authorized agent or, if that author is dead, by the number and proportion of the owners of his or her termination interest required under clauses (1) and (2) of this subsection, or by their duly authorized agents.

(4) Termination will be carried out by giving prior written notice to the grantee or their legal successor. If the grant was made by someone other than the author, the notice must be signed by everyone entitled to terminate the grant under clause (1) of this subsection, or by their authorized representatives. If the grant was made by one or more of the authors of the work, the notice regarding any individual author's share must be signed by that author or their authorized representative, or if that author has passed away, by the required number and proportion of the owners of their termination interest as specified in clauses (1) and (2) of this subsection, or by their authorized representatives.

(A) The notice shall state the effective date of the termination, which shall fall within the five-year period specified by clause (3) of this subsection, or, in the case of a termination under subsection (d), within the five-year period specified by subsection (d)(2), and the notice shall be served not less than two or more than ten years before that date. A copy of the notice shall be recorded in the Copyright Office before the effective date of termination, as a condition to its taking effect.

(A) The notice must state the effective date of termination, which should be within the five-year period mentioned in clause (3) of this subsection, or, if it’s a termination under subsection (d), within the five-year period specified by subsection (d)(2). The notice has to be served at least two years and no more than ten years before that date. A copy of the notice must be recorded in the Copyright Office before the effective date of termination for it to take effect.

(B) The notice shall comply, in form, content, and manner of service, with requirements that the Register of Copyrights shall prescribe by regulation.

(B) The notice must meet the requirements for its format, content, and delivery method that the Register of Copyrights establishes through regulation.

(5) Termination of the grant may be effected notwithstanding any agreement to the contrary, including an agreement to make a will or to make any future grant.

(5) The grant can be terminated regardless of any agreements to the contrary, including agreements to create a will or to make any future grant.

(6) In the case of a grant executed by a person or persons other than the author, all rights under this title that were covered by the terminated grant revert, upon the effective date of termination, to all of those entitled to terminate the grant under clause (1) of this subsection. In the case of a grant executed by one or more of the authors of the work, all of a particular author's rights under this title that were covered by the terminated grant revert, upon the effective date of termination, to that author or, if that author is dead, to the persons owning his or her termination interest under clause (2) of this subsection, including those owners who did not join in signing the notice of termination under clause (4) of this subsection. In all cases the reversion of rights is subject to the following limitations:

(6) If a grant is made by someone other than the author, all rights covered by the terminated grant go back, on the date the termination takes effect, to anyone who has the right to terminate the grant under clause (1) of this subsection. If a grant is made by one or more of the authors of the work, all rights of a specific author covered by the terminated grant revert, on the date of termination, to that author. If that author has passed away, those rights go to the people who own their termination interest under clause (2) of this subsection, including those who didn’t sign the notice of termination under clause (4) of this subsection. In all cases, the return of rights is subject to the following limitations:

(A) A derivative work prepared under authority of the grant before its termination may continue to be utilized under the terms of the grant after its termination, but this privilege does not extend to the preparation after the termination of other derivative works based upon the copyrighted work covered by the terminated grant.

(A) A derivative work created under the authority of the grant before it ends may still be used under the terms of the grant after it ends, but this privilege doesn't apply to the creation of other derivative works based on the copyrighted work covered by the terminated grant after it has ended.

(B) The future rights that will revert upon termination of the grant become vested on the date the notice of termination has been served as provided by clause (4) of this subsection.

(B) The future rights that will return after the termination of the grant become established on the date the notice of termination has been given as outlined in clause (4) of this subsection.

(C) Where the author's rights revert to two or more persons under clause (2) of this subsection, they shall vest in those persons in the proportionate shares provided by that clause. In such a case, and subject to the provisions of subclause (D) of this clause, a further grant, or agreement to make a further grant, of a particular author's share with respect to any right covered by a terminated grant is valid only if it is signed by the same number and proportion of the owners, in whom the right has vested under this clause, as are required to terminate the grant under clause (2) of this subsection. Such further grant or agreement is effective with respect to all of the persons in whom the right it covers has vested under this subclause, including those who did not join in signing it. If any person dies after rights under a terminated grant have vested in him or her, that person's legal representatives, legatees, or heirs at law represent him or her for purposes of this subclause.

(C) When the author's rights go back to two or more people as stated in clause (2) of this subsection, those rights will be divided among them according to the shares outlined in that clause. In this situation, and as long as it follows the rules in subclause (D) of this clause, any new grant or agreement to create a new grant for a specific author's share related to any right covered by a terminated grant is valid only if it is signed by the same number and proportion of the owners to whom the right has gone back under this clause, as those needed to terminate the grant under clause (2) of this subsection. This new grant or agreement applies to all the people who have that right under this subclause, including those who did not sign it. If someone passes away after their rights under a terminated grant have been assigned to them, that person's legal representatives, beneficiaries, or heirs will act on their behalf for this subclause.

(D) A further grant, or agreement to make a further grant, of any right covered by a terminated grant is valid only if it is made after the effective date of the termination. As an exception, however, an agreement for such a further grant may be made between the author or any of the persons provided by the first sentence of clause (6) of this subsection, or between the persons provided by subclause (C) of this clause, and the original grantee or such grantee's successor in title, after the notice of termination has been served as provided by clause (4) of this subsection.

(D) A new grant, or an agreement to provide a new grant, of any right that was part of a terminated grant is only valid if it's made after the termination's effective date. However, as an exception, an agreement for such a new grant can be made between the author or any individuals mentioned in the first sentence of clause (6) of this subsection, or between the individuals mentioned in subclause (C) of this clause, and the original grantee or that grantee's successor in title, after the notice of termination has been served as outlined in clause (4) of this subsection.

(E) Termination of a grant under this subsection affects only those rights covered by the grant that arise under this title, and in no way affects rights arising under any other Federal, State, or foreign laws.

(E) Ending a grant under this section only impacts the rights associated with the grant that come from this title, and does not affect rights that arise under any other federal, state, or foreign laws.

(F) Unless and until termination is effected under this subsection, the grant, if it does not provide otherwise, continues in effect for the remainder of the extended renewal term.

(F) Unless termination happens under this subsection, the grant, unless stated otherwise, remains in effect for the rest of the extended renewal term.

(d) Termination Rights Provided in Subsection (c) Which Have Expired on or Before the Effective Date of the Sonny Bono Copyright Term Extension Act. In the case of any copyright other than a work made for hire, subsisting in its renewal term on the effective date of the Sonny Bono Copyright Term Extension Act [9] for which the termination right provided in subsection (c) has expired by such date, where the author or owner of the termination right has not previously exercised such termination right, the exclusive or nonexclusive grant of a transfer or license of the renewal copyright or any right under it, executed before January 1, 1978, by any of the persons designated in subsection (a)(1)(C) of this section, other than by will, is subject to termination under the following conditions:

(d) Termination Rights Provided in Subsection (c) Which Have Expired on or Before the Effective Date of the Sonny Bono Copyright Term Extension Act. If there’s a copyright that isn’t a work made for hire, and it’s still in its renewal term on the effective date of the Sonny Bono Copyright Term Extension Act [9], and the termination right mentioned in subsection (c) has expired by that date, if the author or owner of the termination right has not previously used it, then any exclusive or nonexclusive transfer or license of the renewal copyright or any rights under it, signed before January 1, 1978, by anyone named in subsection (a)(1)(C) of this section, other than through a will, can be terminated under the following conditions:

(1) The conditions specified in subsections (c) (1), (2), (4), (5), and (6) of this section apply to terminations of the last 20 years of copyright term as provided by the amendments made by the Sonny Bono Copyright Term Extension Act.

(1) The conditions outlined in subsections (c) (1), (2), (4), (5), and (6) of this section apply to terminations during the last 20 years of the copyright term as stated in the changes made by the Sonny Bono Copyright Term Extension Act.

(2) Termination of the grant may be effected at any time during a period of 5 years beginning at the end of 75 years from the date copyright was originally secured.

(2) The grant can be terminated at any time during a 5-year period starting 75 years after the copyright was originally obtained.

Section 305. Duration of copyright: Terminal date

All terms of copyright provided by sections 302 through 304 run to the end of the calendar year in which they would otherwise expire.

All copyright terms outlined in sections 302 through 304 extend to the end of the calendar year in which they would normally expire.

————————— Chapter 3 Endnotes

Chapter 3 References

1 Private Law 92-60, 85 Stat. 857, effective December 15, 1971, states that:

1 Private Law 92-60, 85 Stat. 857, effective December 15, 1971, states

[A]ny provision of law to the contrary notwithstanding, copyright is hereby granted to the trustees under the will of Mary Baker Eddy, their successors, and assigns, in the work "Science and Health with Key to the Scriptures" (entitled also in some editions "Science and Health" or "Science and Health; with a Key to the Scriptures"), by Mary Baker Eddy, including all editions thereof in English and translation heretofore published, or hereafter published by or on behalf of said trustees, their successors or assigns, for a term of seventy-five years from the effective date of this Act or from the date of first publication, whichever is later.

Any law to the contrary aside, copyright is granted to the trustees under the will of Mary Baker Eddy, along with their successors and assigns, for the work "Science and Health with Key to the Scriptures" (also titled in some editions "Science and Health" or "Science and Health; with a Key to the Scriptures"), by Mary Baker Eddy. This includes all editions published in English and any translations published before or after by or for these trustees, their successors, or assigns, for a period of seventy-five years starting from the effective date of this Act or from the date of first publication, whichever is later.

But *cf. United Christian Scientists v. Christian Science Board of Directors, First Church of Christ, Scientist*, 829 F.2d 1152, 4 USPQ2d 1177 (D.C. Cir. 1987) (holding Priv. L. 92-60, 85 Stat. 857, to be unconstitutional because it violates the Establishment Clause).

But *cf. United Christian Scientists v. Christian Science Board of Directors, First Church of Christ, Scientist*, 829 F.2d 1152, 4 USPQ2d 1177 (D.C. Cir. 1987) (holding Priv. L. 92-60, 85 Stat. 857, to be unconstitutional because it violates the Establishment Clause).

2 The Berne Convention Implementation Act of 1988 amended section 301 by adding at the end thereof subsection (e). Pub. L. No. 100-568, 102 Stat. 2853, 2857. In 1990, the Architectural Works Copyright Protection Act amended section 301(b) by adding at the end thereof paragraph (4). Pub. L. No. 101-650, 104 Stat. 5133, 5134. The Visual Artists Rights Act of 1990 amended section 301 by adding at the end thereof subsection (f). Pub. L. No. 101-650, 104 Stat. 5089, 5131. In 1998, the Sonny Bono Copyright Term Extension Act amended section 301 by changing "February 15, 2047" to "February 15, 2067" each place it appeared in subsection (c). Pub. L. No. 105-298, 112 Stat. 2827.

2 The Berne Convention Implementation Act of 1988 updated section 301 by adding subsection (e) at the end. Pub. L. No. 100-568, 102 Stat. 2853, 2857. In 1990, the Architectural Works Copyright Protection Act changed section 301(b) by adding paragraph (4) at the end. Pub. L. No. 101-650, 104 Stat. 5133, 5134. The Visual Artists Rights Act of 1990 modified section 301 by adding subsection (f) at the end. Pub. L. No. 101-650, 104 Stat. 5089, 5131. In 1998, the Sonny Bono Copyright Term Extension Act revised section 301 by changing "February 15, 2047" to "February 15, 2067" wherever it appeared in subsection (c). Pub. L. No. 105-298, 112 Stat. 2827.

3 The Visual Artists Rights Act of 1990, which added subsection (f), states, "Subject to subsection (b) and except as provided in subsection (c), this title and the amendments made by this title take effect 6 months after the date of the enactment of this Act," that is, six months after December 1, 1990. Pub. L. No. 101-650, 104 Stat. 5089, 5132. See also endnote 37, chapter 1.

3 The Visual Artists Rights Act of 1990, which added subsection (f), states, "Except as outlined in subsection (b) and with the exceptions in subsection (c), this title and the amendments made by this title become effective six months after the date this Act is enacted," which means six months after December 1, 1990. Pub. L. No. 101-650, 104 Stat. 5089, 5132. See also endnote 37, chapter 1.

4 In 1998, the Sonny Bono Copyright Term Extension Act amended section 302 by substituting "70" for "fifty," "95" for "seventy-five" and "120" for "one hundred" each place they appeared. Pub. L. No. 105-298, 112 Stat. 2827.

4 In 1998, the Sonny Bono Copyright Term Extension Act changed section 302 by replacing "50" with "70," "75" with "95," and "100" with "120" wherever they appeared. Pub. L. No. 105-298, 112 Stat. 2827.

5 In 1997, section 303 was amended by adding subsection (b). Pub. L. No. 105-80, 111 Stat. 1529, 1534. In 1998, the Sonny Bono Copyright Term Extension Act amended section 303 by substituting "December 31, 2047" for "December 31, 2027." Pub. L. No. 105-298, 112 Stat. 2827.

5 In 1997, section 303 was changed by adding subsection (b). Pub. L. No. 105-80, 111 Stat. 1529, 1534. In 1998, the Sonny Bono Copyright Term Extension Act modified section 303 by replacing "December 31, 2027" with "December 31, 2047." Pub. L. No. 105-298, 112 Stat. 2827.

6 The Copyright Renewal Act of 1992 amended section 304 by substituting a new subsection (a) and by making a conforming amendment in the matter preceding paragraph (1) of subsection (c). Pub. L. No. 102-307, 106 Stat. 264. The Act, as amended by the Sonny Bono Copyright Term Extension Act, states that the renewal and extension of a copyright for a further term of 67 years "shall have the same effect with respect to any grant, before the effective date of the Sonny Bono Copyright Term Extension Act [October 27, 1998], of a transfer or license of the further term as did the renewal of a copyright before the effective date of the Sonny Bono Copyright Term Extension Act [October 27, 1998] under the law in effect at the time of such grant." The Act also states that the 1992 amendments "shall apply only to those copyrights secured between January 1, 1964, and December 31, 1977. Copyrights secured before January 1, 1964, shall be governed by the provisions of section 304(a) of title 17, United States Code, as in effect on the day before . . .[enactment on June 26, 1992], except each reference to forty-seven years in such provisions shall be deemed to be 67 years." Pub. L. No. 102-307, 106 Stat. 264, 266, as amended by the Sonny Bono Copyright Term Extension Act, Pub. L. No. 105-298, 112 Stat. 2827, 2828.

6 The Copyright Renewal Act of 1992 changed section 304 by adding a new subsection (a) and making a corresponding amendment to the text before paragraph (1) of subsection (c). Pub. L. No. 102-307, 106 Stat. 264. The Act, amended by the Sonny Bono Copyright Term Extension Act, states that renewing and extending a copyright for an additional term of 67 years "will have the same effect regarding any grant, made before the effective date of the Sonny Bono Copyright Term Extension Act [October 27, 1998], of a transfer or license for the additional term as did the renewal of a copyright before the effective date of the Sonny Bono Copyright Term Extension Act [October 27, 1998] under the law in effect at that time." The Act also specifies that the 1992 amendments "will apply only to those copyrights obtained between January 1, 1964, and December 31, 1977. Copyrights obtained before January 1, 1964, will be governed by the provisions of section 304(a) of title 17, United States Code, as it stood on the day before . . .[enactment on June 26, 1992], except that each reference to forty-seven years in those provisions will be considered as 67 years." Pub. L. No. 102-307, 106 Stat. 264, 266, as amended by the Sonny Bono Copyright Term Extension Act, Pub. L. No. 105-298, 112 Stat. 2827, 2828.

In 1998, the Sonny Bono Copyright Term Extension Act amended section 304 by substituting "67" for "47" wherever it appeared in subsection (a), by substituting a new subsection (b) and by adding subsection (d) at the end thereof. Pub. L. No. 105-298, 112 Stat. 2827. That Act also amended subsection 304(c) by deleting "by his widow or her widower and his or her children or grandchildren" from the first sentence of paragraph (2), by adding subparagraph (D) at the end of paragraph (2) and by inserting "or, in the case of a termination under subsection (d), within the five- year period specified by subsection (d)(2)," into the first sentence of subparagraph (4)(A). *Id.*

In 1998, the Sonny Bono Copyright Term Extension Act changed section 304 by replacing "67" with "47" wherever it appeared in subsection (a), introducing a new subsection (b), and adding subsection (d) at the end. Pub. L. No. 105-298, 112 Stat. 2827. This Act also updated subsection 304(c) by removing "by his widow or her widower and his or her children or grandchildren" from the first sentence of paragraph (2), adding subparagraph (D) at the end of paragraph (2), and inserting "or, in the case of a termination under subsection (d), within the five-year period specified by subsection (d)(2)," into the first sentence of subparagraph (4)(A). *Id.*

7 A series of nine Acts of Congress extended until December 31, 1976, previously renewed copyrights in which the renewal term would otherwise have expired between September 19, 1962 and December 31, 1976. The last of these enactments is Pub. L. No. 93-573, 88 Stat. 1873, enacted December 31, 1974, which cites the eight earlier acts. See also section 102 of the Transitional and Supplementary Provisions of the Copyright Act of 1976, in Part I of the Appendix. Pub. L. No. 94-553, 90 Stat. 2541.

7 A series of nine Acts of Congress extended until December 31, 1976, previously renewed copyrights that would have expired between September 19, 1962, and December 31, 1976. The last of these laws is Pub. L. No. 93-573, 88 Stat. 1873, enacted on December 31, 1974, which references the eight earlier acts. See also section 102 of the Transitional and Supplementary Provisions of the Copyright Act of 1976, in Part I of the Appendix. Pub. L. No. 94-553, 90 Stat. 2541.

8 The effective date of the Sonny Bono Copyright Term Extension Act is October 27, 1998.

8 The Sonny Bono Copyright Term Extension Act went into effect on October 27, 1998.

9 See endnote 8, *supra*.

9 See endnote 8, *above*.

————————————————————————————————————

Sure! Please provide the text you would like me to modernize.

Chapter 4

Copyright Notice, Deposit, and Registration

Copyright Notice, Deposit, and Registration

  + 401. Notice of copyright: Visually perceptible copies
  + 402. Notice of copyright: Phonorecords of sound recordings
  + 403. Notice of copyright: Publications incorporating United States
         Government works
  + 404. Notice of copyright: Contributions to collective works
  + 405. Notice of copyright: Omission of notice on certain copies and
         phonorecords
  + 406. Notice of copyright: Error in name or date on certain copies
         and phonorecords
  + 407. Deposit of copies or phonorecords for Library of Congress
  + 408. Copyright registration in general
  + 409. Application for copyright registration
  + 410. Registration of claim and issuance of certificate
  + 411. Registration and infringement actions
  + 412. Registration as prerequisite to certain remedies for
         infringement

+ 401. Copyright Notice: Copies that can be seen
  + 402. Copyright Notice: Sound recordings
  + 403. Copyright Notice: Publications that include United States
         Government works
  + 404. Copyright Notice: Contributions to collective works
  + 405. Copyright Notice: Missing notice on some copies and
         sound recordings
  + 406. Copyright Notice: Mistake in name or date on some copies
         and sound recordings
  + 407. Submitting copies or sound recordings to the Library of Congress
  + 408. General copyright registration
  + 409. Application for copyright registration
  + 410. Claim registration and issuing of certificate
  + 411. Registration and infringement lawsuits
  + 412. Registration as a requirement for certain remedies for
         infringement

Section 401. Notice of copyright: Visually perceptible copies [1]

(a) General Provisions. Whenever a work protected under this title is published in the United States or elsewhere by authority of the copyright owner, a notice of copyright as provided by this section may be placed on publicly distributed copies from which the work can be visually perceived, either directly or with the aid of a machine or device.

(a) General Provisions. Whenever a work protected under this title is published in the United States or anywhere else with the permission of the copyright owner, a copyright notice as outlined in this section may be placed on publicly distributed copies that allow the work to be seen, either directly or with the help of a machine or device.

(b) Form of Notice. If a notice appears on the copies, it shall consist of the following three elements:

(b) Form of Notice. If a notice is shown on the copies, it must include the following three elements:

(1) the symbol (the letter C in a circle), or the word "Copyright", or the abbreviation "Copr."; and

(1) the symbol (the letter C in a circle), or the word "Copyright", or the abbreviation "Copr."; and

(2) the year of first publication of the work; in the case of compilations or derivative works incorporating previously published material, the year date of first publication of the compilation or derivative work is sufficient. The year date may be omitted where a pictorial, graphic, or sculptural work, with accompanying text matter, if any, is reproduced in or on greeting cards, postcards, stationery, jewelry, dolls, toys, or any useful articles; and

(2) the year the work was first published; for compilations or derivative works that include previously published material, the year of first publication of the compilation or derivative work is enough. The year can be skipped if a pictorial, graphic, or sculptural work, along with any text, is reproduced on greeting cards, postcards, stationery, jewelry, dolls, toys, or any useful items; and

(3) the name of the owner of copyright in the work, or an abbreviation by which the name can be recognized, or a generally known alternative designation of the owner.

(3) the name of the copyright owner of the work, or an abbreviation that can be recognized, or a commonly known alternative name for the owner.

(c) Position of Notice. The notice shall be affixed to the copies in such manner and location as to give reasonable notice of the claim of copyright. The Register of Copyrights shall prescribe by regulation, as examples, specific methods of affixation and positions of the notice on various types of works that will satisfy this requirement, but these specifications shall not be considered exhaustive.

(c) Position of Notice. The notice must be attached to the copies in a way and place that provides reasonable notice of the copyright claim. The Register of Copyrights will establish regulations that include specific methods and locations for the notice on different types of works that will meet this requirement, but these guidelines should not be seen as comprehensive.

(d) Evidentiary Weight of Notice. If a notice of copyright in the form and position specified by this section appears on the published copy or copies to which a defendant in a copyright infringement suit had access, then no weight shall be given to such a defendant's interposition of a defense based on innocent infringement in mitigation of actual or statutory damages, except as provided in the last sentence of section 504(c)(2).

(d) Evidentiary Weight of Notice. If a copyright notice is displayed in the format and position specified by this section on the published copy or copies that a defendant in a copyright infringement lawsuit had access to, then the defendant's claim of innocent infringement as a defense to reduce actual or statutory damages will not be considered, except as outlined in the last sentence of section 504(c)(2).

Section 402. Notice of copyright: Phonorecords of sound recordings [2]

(a) General Provisions. Whenever a sound recording protected under this title is published in the United States or elsewhere by authority of the copyright owner, a notice of copyright as provided by this section may be placed on publicly distributed phonorecords of the sound recording.

(a) General Provisions. Whenever a sound recording protected under this title is published in the United States or anywhere else by the copyright owner's permission, a copyright notice as specified in this section may be placed on phonorecords of the sound recording that are distributed to the public.

(b) Form of Notice. If a notice appears on the phonorecords, it shall consist of the following three elements:

(b) Form of Notice. If a notice appears on the phonorecords, it must include these three elements:

(1) the symbol [P in a circle] (the letter P in a circle); and

(1) the symbol [P in a circle] (the letter P enclosed in a circle); and

(2) the year of first publication of the sound recording; and

(2) the year the sound recording was first published; and

(3) the name of the owner of copyright in the sound recording, or an abbreviation by which the name can be recognized, or a generally known alternative designation of the owner; if the producer of the sound recording is named on the phonorecord labels or containers, and if no other name appears in conjunction with the notice, the producer's name shall be considered a part of the notice.

(3) the name of the copyright owner for the sound recording, or a recognizable abbreviation of that name, or a commonly known alternative name for the owner; if the producer of the sound recording is listed on the phonorecord labels or containers, and no other name appears with the notice, the producer's name will be treated as part of the notice.

(c) Position of Notice. The notice shall be placed on the surface of the phonorecord, or on the phonorecord label or container, in such manner and location as to give reasonable notice of the claim of copyright.

(c) Position of Notice. The notice must be placed on the surface of the phonorecord, or on the phonorecord label or container, in a way and location that provides reasonable notice of the copyright claim.

(d) Evidentiary Weight of Notice. If a notice of copyright in the form and position specified by this section appears on the published phonorecord or phonorecords to which a defendant in a copyright infringement suit had access, then no weight shall be given to such a defendant's interposition of a defense based on innocent infringement in mitigation of actual or statutory damages, except as provided in the last sentence of section 504(c)(2).

(d) Weight of Copyright Notice. If a copyright notice, formatted and placed as specified in this section, is visible on the published phonorecord or phonorecords that a defendant in a copyright infringement lawsuit had access to, then that defendant cannot use a defense based on innocent infringement to reduce actual or statutory damages, except as stated in the last sentence of section 504(c)(2).

Section 403. Notice of copyright: Publications incorporating United States Government works [3]

Sections 401(d) and 402(d) shall not apply to a work published in copies or phonorecords consisting predominantly of one or more works of the United States Government unless the notice of copyright appearing on the published copies or phonorecords to which a defendant in the copyright infringement suit had access includes a statement identifying, either affirmatively or negatively, those portions of the copies or phonorecords embodying any work or works protected under this title.

Sections 401(d) and 402(d) don't apply to a work published in copies or phonorecords mainly featuring one or more works of the United States Government unless the copyright notice on the published copies or phonorecords that a defendant in the copyright infringement lawsuit accessed includes a statement that clearly identifies, either positively or negatively, those parts of the copies or phonorecords that include any work or works protected under this title.

Section 404. Notice of copyright: Contributions to collective works [4]

(a) A separate contribution to a collective work may bear its own notice of copyright, as provided by sections 401 through 403. However, a single notice applicable to the collective work as a whole is sufficient to invoke the provisions of section 401(d) or 402(d), as applicable with respect to the separate contributions it contains (not including advertisements inserted on behalf of persons other than the owner of copyright in the collective work), regardless of the ownership of copyright in the contributions and whether or not they have been previously published.

(a) A separate contribution to a collective work can have its own copyright notice, as outlined in sections 401 through 403. However, a single notice that applies to the entire collective work is enough to activate the provisions of section 401(d) or 402(d), depending on the separate contributions it includes (not counting ads placed for people other than the copyright owner of the collective work), regardless of who owns the copyright on the contributions or whether they have been published before.

(b) With respect to copies and phonorecords publicly distributed by authority of the copyright owner before the effective date of the Berne Convention Implementation Act of 1988, where the person named in a single notice applicable to a collective work as a whole is not the owner of copyright in a separate contribution that does not bear its own notice, the case is governed by the provisions of section 406(a).

(b) Regarding copies and phonorecords that were publicly distributed with permission from the copyright owner before the effective date of the Berne Convention Implementation Act of 1988, if the individual mentioned in a single notice that applies to a collective work as a whole is not the copyright owner of a separate contribution that doesn’t have its own notice, the situation is regulated by section 406(a).

Section 405. Notice of copyright: Omission of notice on certain copies and phonorecords [5]

(a) Effect of Omission on Copyright. With respect to copies and phonorecords publicly distributed by authority of the copyright owner before the effective date of the Berne Convention Implementation Act of 1988, the omission of the copyright notice described in sections 401 through 403 from copies or phonorecords publicly distributed by authority of the copyright owner does not invalidate the copyright in a work if-

(a) Effect of Omission on Copyright. Regarding copies and phonorecords that are publicly distributed with the copyright owner’s permission before the effective date of the Berne Convention Implementation Act of 1988, leaving out the copyright notice mentioned in sections 401 through 403 from copies or phonorecords publicly distributed by the copyright owner does not nullify the copyright in a work if-

(1) the notice has been omitted from no more than a relatively small number of copies or phonorecords distributed to the public; or

(1) the notice has been left out of only a small number of copies or phonorecords given to the public; or

(2) registration for the work has been made before or is made within five years after the publication without notice, and a reasonable effort is made to add notice to all copies or phonorecords that are distributed to the public in the United States after the omission has been discovered; or

(2) registration for the work has happened before or is done within five years after the publication without notice, and a reasonable effort is made to add notice to all copies or phonorecords that are distributed to the public in the United States after the omission has been found; or

(3) the notice has been omitted in violation of an express requirement in writing that, as a condition of the copyright owner's authorization of the public distribution of copies or phonorecords, they bear the prescribed notice.

(3) the notice has been left out, which goes against a clear written requirement that, as a condition for the copyright owner's permission to distribute copies or recordings to the public, they must include the required notice.

(b) Effect of Omission on Innocent Infringers. Any person who innocently infringes a copyright, in reliance upon an authorized copy or phonorecord from which the copyright notice has been omitted and which was publicly distributed by authority of the copyright owner before the effective date of the Berne Convention Implementation Act of 1988, incurs no liability for actual or statutory damages under section 504 for any infringing acts committed before receiving actual notice that registration for the work has been made under section 408, if such person proves that he or she was misled by the omission of notice. In a suit for infringement in such a case the court may allow or disallow recovery of any of the infringer's profits attributable to the infringement, and may enjoin the continuation of the infringing undertaking or may require, as a condition for permitting the continuation of the infringing undertaking, that the infringer pay the copyright owner a reasonable license fee in an amount and on terms fixed by the court.

(b) Effect of Omission on Innocent Infringers. Any person who unknowingly infringes a copyright while relying on an authorized copy or phonorecord that is missing the copyright notice and was publicly distributed with the copyright owner's permission before the effective date of the Berne Convention Implementation Act of 1988, is not liable for actual or statutory damages under section 504 for any infringing acts committed before they receive actual notice that the work has been registered under section 408, if they can prove they were misled by the missing notice. In a lawsuit for infringement in such cases, the court may decide to allow or deny recovery of any profits the infringer made from the infringement, and may prohibit the continuation of the infringing activity or may require, as a condition for allowing the infringer to continue, that they pay the copyright owner a reasonable license fee in an amount and on terms set by the court.

(c) Removal of Notice. Protection under this title is not affected by the removal, destruction, or obliteration of the notice, without the authorization of the copyright owner, from any publicly distributed copies or phonorecords.

(c) Removal of Notice. Protection under this title is not affected by the removal, destruction, or obliteration of the notice, without the authorization of the copyright owner, from any publicly distributed copies or phonorecords.

Section 406. Notice of copyright: Error in name or date on certain copies and phonorecords [6]

(a) Error in Name. With respect to copies and phonorecords publicly distributed by authority of the copyright owner before the effective date of the Berne Convention Implementation Act of 1988, where the person named in the copyright notice on copies or phonorecords publicly distributed by authority of the copyright owner is not the owner of copyright, the validity and ownership of the copyright are not affected. In such a case, however, any person who innocently begins an undertaking that infringes the copyright has a complete defense to any action for such infringement if such person proves that he or she was misled by the notice and began the undertaking in good faith under a purported transfer or license from the person named therein, unless before the undertaking was begun-

(a) Error in Name. Regarding copies and phonorecords that were publicly distributed with the permission of the copyright owner before the Berne Convention Implementation Act of 1988 took effect, if the person listed in the copyright notice on those copies or phonorecords is not the actual copyright owner, the validity and ownership of the copyright remain unaffected. However, in this situation, any individual who unknowingly starts a project that infringes on the copyright has a full defense against any claims of infringement if they can show that they were misled by the notice and commenced the project in good faith based on a supposed transfer or license from the person named in the notice, unless prior to starting the project-

(1) registration for the work had been made in the name of the owner of copyright; or

(1) registration for the work had been done in the name of the copyright owner; or

(2) a document executed by the person named in the notice and showing the ownership of the copyright had been recorded.

(2) a document signed by the person mentioned in the notice that proves ownership of the copyright had been recorded.

The person named in the notice is liable to account to the copyright owner for all receipts from transfers or licenses purportedly made under the copyright by the person named in the notice.

The individual mentioned in the notice is responsible for reporting to the copyright owner all earnings from any transfers or licenses that they claim to have made under the copyright.

(b) Error in Date. When the year date in the notice on copies or phonorecords distributed before the effective date of the Berne Convention Implementation Act of 1988 by authority of the copyright owner is earlier than the year in which publication first occurred, any period computed from the year of first publication under section 302 is to be computed from the year in the notice. Where the year date is more than one year later than the year in which publication first occurred, the work is considered to have been published without any notice and is governed by the provisions of section 405.

(b) Error in Date. When the year listed in the notice on copies or phonorecords distributed before the effective date of the Berne Convention Implementation Act of 1988 by the copyright owner is earlier than the year in which the publication first took place, any period calculated from the year of first publication under section 302 will be based on the year in the notice. If the year listed is more than one year later than the year of first publication, the work is treated as if it was published without any notice and is subject to the rules in section 405.

(c) Omission of Name or Date. Where copies or phonorecords publicly distributed before the effective date of the Berne Convention Implementation Act of 1988 by authority of the copyright owner contain no name or no date that could reasonably be considered a part of the notice, the work is considered to have been published without any notice and is governed by the provisions of section 405 as in effect on the day before the effective date of the Berne Convention Implementation Act of 1988.

(c) Omission of Name or Date. Where copies or phonorecords that were publicly distributed before the effective date of the Berne Convention Implementation Act of 1988, authorized by the copyright owner, do not include a name or date that could reasonably be considered part of the notice, the work is deemed to have been published without any notice and is subject to the rules of section 405 as they were in effect the day before the effective date of the Berne Convention Implementation Act of 1988.

Section 407. Deposit of copies or phonorecords for Library of Congress [7]

(a) Except as provided by subsection (c), and subject to the provisions of subsection (e), the owner of copyright or of the exclusive right of publication in a work published in the United States shall deposit, within three months after the date of such publication-

(a) Except as stated in subsection (c), and following the rules in subsection (e), the copyright owner or the exclusive publisher of a work released in the United States must submit it within three months after the publication date—

(1) two complete copies of the best edition; or

(1) two full copies of the best edition; or

(2) if the work is a sound recording, two complete phonorecords of the best edition, together with any printed or other visually perceptible material published with such phonorecords.

(2) If the work is a sound recording, two complete copies of the best edition, along with any printed or other visual materials published with those records.

Neither the deposit requirements of this subsection nor the acquisition provisions of subsection (e) are conditions of copyright protection.

Neither the deposit requirements in this subsection nor the acquisition rules in subsection (e) are conditions for copyright protection.

(b) The required copies or phonorecords shall be deposited in the Copyright Office for the use or disposition of the Library of Congress. The Register of Copyrights shall, when requested by the depositor and upon payment of the fee prescribed by section 708, issue a receipt for the deposit.

(b) The required copies or phonorecords must be submitted to the Copyright Office for use or distribution by the Library of Congress. The Register of Copyrights will issue a receipt for the deposit when requested by the depositor and after the fee outlined in section 708 is paid.

(c) The Register of Copyrights may by regulation exempt any categories of material from the deposit requirements of this section, or require deposit of only one copy or phonorecord with respect to any categories. Such regulations shall provide either for complete exemption from the deposit requirements of this section, or for alternative forms of deposit aimed at providing a satisfactory archival record of a work without imposing practical or financial hardships on the depositor, where the individual author is the owner of copyright in a pictorial, graphic, or sculptural work and (i) less than five copies of the work have been published, or (ii) the work has been published in a limited edition consisting of numbered copies, the monetary value of which would make the mandatory deposit of two copies of the best edition of the work burdensome, unfair, or unreasonable.

(c) The Register of Copyrights can, through regulations, exempt certain types of materials from the deposit requirements of this section or allow the deposit of just one copy or recording for specific categories. These regulations will either completely waive the deposit requirements of this section or offer alternative deposit methods to ensure a proper archival record of a work without causing practical or financial difficulties for the depositor. This applies especially when the individual author owns the copyright for a pictorial, graphic, or sculptural work and (i) fewer than five copies of the work have been published, or (ii) the work has been released in a limited edition of numbered copies, where the monetary value would make the mandatory deposit of two copies of the best edition of the work burdensome, unfair, or unreasonable.

(d) At any time after publication of a work as provided by subsection(a), the Register of Copyrights may make written demand for the required deposit on any of the persons obligated to make the deposit under subsection (a). Unless deposit is made within three months after the demand is received, the person or persons on whom the demand was made are liable-

(d) At any time after a work is published as stated in subsection (a), the Register of Copyrights can request in writing the required deposit from anyone who is supposed to make the deposit under subsection (a). If the deposit isn't made within three months after the demand is received, the person or people who received the demand are liable-

(1) to a fine of not more than $250 for each work; and

(1) to a fine of up to $250 for each work; and

(2) to pay into a specially designated fund in the Library of Congress the total retail price of the copies or phonorecords demanded, or, if no retail price has been fixed, the reasonable cost to the Library of Congress of acquiring them; and

(2) to pay into a specifically designated fund in the Library of Congress the total retail price of the copies or phonorecords requested, or, if no retail price has been set, the reasonable cost for the Library of Congress to obtain them; and

(3) to pay a fine of $2,500, in addition to any fine or liability imposed under clauses (1) and (2), if such person willfully or repeatedly fails or refuses to comply with such a demand.

(3) to pay a fine of $2,500, in addition to any fine or liability imposed under clauses (1) and (2), if that person willfully or repeatedly fails or refuses to comply with that demand.

(e) With respect to transmission programs that have been fixed and transmitted to the public in the United States but have not been published, the Register of Copyrights shall, after consulting with the Librarian of Congress and other interested organizations and officials, establish regulations governing the acquisition, through deposit or otherwise, of copies or phonorecords of such programs for the collections of the Library of Congress.

(e) Regarding transmission programs that have been fixed and sent out to the public in the United States but haven't been published, the Register of Copyrights will, after talking with the Librarian of Congress and other interested groups and officials, set regulations for acquiring copies or phonorecords of such programs for the collections of the Library of Congress.

(1) The Librarian of Congress shall be permitted, under the standards and conditions set forth in such regulations, to make a fixation of a transmission program directly from a transmission to the public, and to reproduce one copy or phonorecord from such fixation for archival purposes.

(1) The Librarian of Congress is allowed, following the standards and conditions outlined in the regulations, to capture a broadcast program directly from a public transmission and to create one copy or recording from that capture for archival purposes.

(2) Such regulations shall also provide standards and procedures by which the Register of Copyrights may make written demand, upon the owner of the right of transmission in the United States, for the deposit of a copy or phonorecord of a specific transmission program. Such deposit may, at the option of the owner of the right of transmission in the United States, be accomplished by gift, by loan for purposes of reproduction, or by sale at a price not to exceed the cost of reproducing and supplying the copy or phonorecord. The regulations established under this clause shall provide reasonable periods of not less than three months for compliance with a demand, and shall allow for extensions of such periods and adjustments in the scope of the demand or the methods for fulfilling it, as reasonably warranted by the circumstances. Willful failure or refusal to comply with the conditions prescribed by such regulations shall subject the owner of the right of transmission in the United States to liability for an amount, not to exceed the cost of reproducing and supplying the copy or phonorecord in question, to be paid into a specially designated fund in the Library of Congress.

(2) These regulations will also set standards and procedures for the Register of Copyrights to make a written request to the owner of the transmission rights in the United States for a copy or phonorecord of a specific transmission program. The owner can fulfill this request by donating, lending for reproduction purposes, or selling it for no more than the cost of reproducing and supplying the copy or phonorecord. The regulations developed under this clause will allow a minimum of three months for compliance with the request, and will permit extensions or adjustments to the request and the methods to meet it, depending on the circumstances. Deliberate failure or refusal to comply with these regulations will lead to the owner of the transmission rights in the United States being liable for an amount not exceeding the cost of reproducing and supplying the requested copy or phonorecord, to be paid into a designated fund at the Library of Congress.

(3) Nothing in this subsection shall be construed to require the making or retention, for purposes of deposit, of any copy or phonorecord of an unpublished transmission program, the transmission of which occurs before the receipt of a specific written demand as provided by clause (2).

(3) Nothing in this subsection should be interpreted as requiring the creation or keeping, for deposit purposes, of any copy or phonorecord of an unpublished transmission program, the transmission of which takes place before receiving a specific written request as stated in clause (2).

(4) No activity undertaken in compliance with regulations prescribed under clauses (1) and (2) of this subsection shall result in liability if intended solely to assist in the acquisition of copies or phonorecords under this subsection.

(4) No actions taken in accordance with the rules outlined in clauses (1) and (2) of this subsection will lead to any liability if they are aimed solely at helping to obtain copies or phonorecords under this subsection.

Section 408. Copyright registration in general [8]

(a) Registration Permissive. At any time during the subsistence of the first term of copyright in any published or unpublished work in which the copyright was secured before January 1, 1978, and during the subsistence of any copyright secured on or after that date, the owner of copyright or of any exclusive right in the work may obtain registration of the copyright claim by delivering to the Copyright Office the deposit specified by this section, together with the application and fee specified by sections 409 and 708. Such registration is not a condition of copyright protection.

(a) Registration Permissive. Anytime during the duration of the first term of copyright in any published or unpublished work, where the copyright was secured before January 1, 1978, and during the duration of any copyright secured on or after that date, the copyright owner or anyone with an exclusive right to the work can register their copyright claim by sending the required deposit to the Copyright Office, along with the application and fee outlined in sections 409 and 708. This registration is not a requirement for copyright protection.

(b) Deposit for Copyright Registration. Except as provided by subsection (c), the material deposited for registration shall include-

(b) Deposit for Copyright Registration. Except as stated in subsection (c), the material submitted for registration must include-

(1) in the case of an unpublished work, one complete copy or phonorecord;

(1) for an unpublished work, one complete copy or recording;

(2) in the case of a published work, two complete copies or phonorecords of the best edition;

(2) for a published work, two complete copies or recordings of the best edition;

(3) in the case of a work first published outside the United States, one complete copy or phonorecord as so published;

(3) for a work that was first published outside the United States, one complete copy or phonorecord as published;

(4) in the case of a contribution to a collective work, one complete copy or phonorecord of the best edition of the collective work.

(4) in the case of a contribution to a collective work, one complete copy or recording of the best edition of the collective work.

Copies or phonorecords deposited for the Library of Congress under section 407 may be used to satisfy the deposit provisions of this section, if they are accompanied by the prescribed application and fee, and by any additional identifying material that the Register may, by regulation, require. The Register shall also prescribe regulations establishing requirements under which copies or phonorecords acquired for the Library of Congress under subsection (e) of section 407, otherwise than by deposit, may be used to satisfy the deposit provisions of this section. (c) Administrative Classification and Optional Deposit. (1) The Register of Copyrights is authorized to specify by regulation the administrative classes into which works are to be placed for purposes of deposit and registration, and the nature of the copies or phonorecords to be deposited in the various classes specified. The regulations may require or permit, for particular classes, the deposit of identifying material instead of copies or phonorecords, the deposit of only one copy or phonorecord where two would normally be required, or a single registration for a group of related works. This administrative classification of works has no significance with respect to the subject matter of copyright or the exclusive rights provided by this title.

Copies or phonorecords submitted to the Library of Congress under section 407 can be used to meet the deposit requirements of this section, as long as they come with the required application and fee, along with any other identifying material that the Register might require by regulation. The Register will also set rules for how copies or phonorecords obtained for the Library of Congress under subsection (e) of section 407, through means other than deposit, can be used to meet the deposit requirements of this section. (c) Administrative Classification and Optional Deposit. (1) The Register of Copyrights has the authority to define by regulation the administrative classes into which works will be categorized for deposit and registration, and to specify the types of copies or phonorecords to be deposited in each class. The regulations may require or allow, for certain classes, the deposit of identifying material instead of copies or phonorecords, the deposit of just one copy or phonorecord when normally two would be needed, or a single registration for a group of related works. This administrative classification of works does not affect the subject matter of copyright or the exclusive rights provided by this title.

(2) Without prejudice to the general authority provided under clause (1), the Register of Copyrights shall establish regulations specifically permitting a single registration for a group of works by the same individual author, all first published as contributions to periodicals, including newspapers, within a twelve-month period, on the basis of a single deposit, application, and registration fee, under the following conditions-

(2) In addition to the general authority given in clause (1), the Register of Copyrights will set up regulations that allow for a single registration for a collection of works by the same author, as long as they were all first published as contributions to periodicals, including newspapers, within a twelve-month period. This will be based on just one deposit, application, and registration fee, under the following conditions-

(A) if the deposit consists of one copy of the entire issue of the periodical, or of the entire section in the case of a newspaper, in which each contribution was first published; and

(A) if the deposit includes one copy of the whole issue of the periodical, or of the complete section in the case of a newspaper, where each contribution was initially published; and

(B) if the application identifies each work separately, including the periodical containing it and its date of first publication.

(B) if the application lists each work individually, including the periodical that published it and its original publication date.

(3) As an alternative to separate renewal registrations under subsection (a) of section 304, a single renewal registration may be made for a group of works by the same individual author, all first published as contributions to periodicals, including newspapers, upon the filing of a single application and fee, under all of the following conditions:

(3) Instead of doing separate renewal registrations under subsection (a) of section 304, you can submit one renewal registration for multiple works by the same author, all originally published as contributions to periodicals, including newspapers, by filing a single application and paying one fee, as long as all of the following conditions are met:

(A) the renewal claimant or claimants, and the basis of claim or claims under section 304(a), is the same for each of the works; and

(A) the renewal claimant or claimants, and the reasons for the claim or claims under section 304(a), are the same for each of the works; and

(B) the works were all copyrighted upon their first publication, either through separate copyright notice and registration or by virtue of a general copyright notice in the periodical issue as a whole; and

(B) the works were all copyrighted when they were first published, either through a separate copyright notice and registration or because of a general copyright notice in the entire periodical issue; and

(C) the renewal application and fee are received not more than twenty- eight or less than twenty-seven years after the thirty-first day of December of the calendar year in which all of the works were first published; and

(C) the renewal application and fee are received no more than twenty-eight years and no less than twenty-seven years after December 31 of the calendar year when all the works were first published; and

(D) the renewal application identifies each work separately, including the periodical containing it and its date of first publication.

(D) the renewal application lists each work individually, along with the periodical it's in and the date it was first published.

(d) Corrections and Amplifications. The Register may also establish, by regulation, formal procedures for the filing of an application for supplementary registration, to correct an error in a copyright registration or to amplify the information given in a registration. Such application shall be accompanied by the fee provided by section 708, and shall clearly identify the registration to be corrected or amplified. The information contained in a supplementary registration augments but does not supersede that contained in the earlier registration.

(d) Corrections and Amplifications. The Register can also set up formal procedures for applying for supplementary registration to fix an error in a copyright registration or to add more information to a registration, as established by regulation. This application must include the fee specified in section 708 and must clearly identify the registration that needs to be corrected or expanded. The information in a supplementary registration adds to but does not replace that in the original registration.

(e) Published Edition of Previously Registered Work. Registration for the first published edition of a work previously registered in unpublished form may be made even though the work as published is substantially the same as the unpublished version.

(e) Published Edition of Previously Registered Work. Registration for the first published edition of a work that was previously registered in unpublished form can be done even if the published version is largely the same as the unpublished one.

Section 409. Application for copyright registration [9]

The application for copyright registration shall be made on a form prescribed by the Register of Copyrights and shall include

The application for copyright registration must be submitted using a form specified by the Register of Copyrights and must include

(1) the name and address of the copyright claimant;

(1) the name and address of the person claiming copyright;

(2) in the case of a work other than an anonymous or pseudonymous work, the name and nationality or domicile of the author or authors, and, if one or more of the authors is dead, the dates of their deaths;

(2) in the case of a work that is not anonymous or pseudonymous, the name and nationality or residence of the author or authors, and if one or more of the authors has passed away, the dates of their deaths;

(3) if the work is anonymous or pseudonymous, the nationality or domicile of the author or authors;

(3) if the work is anonymous or published under a fake name, the nationality or residence of the author or authors;

(4) in the case of a work made for hire, a statement to this effect;

(4) in the case of a work made for hire, a statement to this effect;

(5) if the copyright claimant is not the author, a brief statement of how the claimant obtained ownership of the copyright;

(5) If the copyright owner is not the author, a short statement explaining how the owner acquired the copyright;

(6) the title of the work, together with any previous or alternative titles under which the work can be identified;

(6) the title of the work, along with any previous or alternate titles that can be used to identify the work;

(7) the year in which creation of the work was completed;

(7) the year when the work was finished;

(8) if the work has been published, the date and nation of its first publication;

(8) if the work has been published, the date and country of its first publication;

(9) in the case of a compilation or derivative work, an identification of any preexisting work or works that it is based on or incorporates, and a brief, general statement of the additional material covered by the copyright claim being registered;

(9) for a compilation or derivative work, identify any preexisting work or works it is based on or includes, along with a brief, general statement about the additional material that is covered by the copyright claim being registered;

(10) in the case of a published work containing material of which copies are required by section 601 to be manufactured in the United States, the names of the persons or organizations who performed the processes specified by subsection (c) of section 601 with respect to that material, and the places where those processes were performed; and

(10) if a published work includes material for which copies need to be made in the United States according to section 601, the names of the individuals or organizations that carried out the processes outlined in subsection (c) of section 601 related to that material, along with the locations where those processes took place; and

(11) any other information regarded by the Register of Copyrights as bearing upon the preparation or identification of the work or the existence, ownership, or duration of the copyright.

(11) any other information that the Register of Copyrights considers relevant to the preparation or identification of the work, or to the existence, ownership, or duration of the copyright.

If an application is submitted for the renewed and extended term provided for in section 304(a)(3)(A) and an original term registration has not been made, the Register may request information with respect to the existence, ownership, or duration of the copyright for the original term.

If an application is submitted for the renewed and extended term outlined in section 304(a)(3)(A) and no original term registration has been done, the Register may ask for information regarding the existence, ownership, or length of the copyright for the original term.

Section 410. Registration of claim and issuance of certificate

(a) When, after examination, the Register of Copyrights determines that, in accordance with the provisions of this title, the material deposited constitutes copyrightable subject matter and that the other legal and formal requirements of this title have been met, the Register shall register the claim and issue to the applicant a certificate of registration under the seal of the Copyright Office. The certificate shall contain the information given in the application, together with the number and effective date of the registration.

(a) When the Register of Copyrights examines the material and determines that it meets the criteria for copyright protection as outlined in this title, and that all other legal and formal requirements have been met, the Register will register the claim and issue a certificate of registration to the applicant under the Copyright Office's seal. The certificate will include the information provided in the application, along with the registration number and effective date.

(b) In any case in which the Register of Copyrights determines that, in accordance with the provisions of this title, the material deposited does not constitute copyrightable subject matter or that the claim is invalid for any other reason, the Register shall refuse registration and shall notify the applicant in writing of the reasons for such refusal.

(b) If the Register of Copyrights decides that the material submitted does not qualify for copyright protection or that the claim is invalid for any other reason, the Register will deny the registration and will inform the applicant in writing about the reasons for the denial.

(c) In any judicial proceedings the certificate of a registration made before or within five years after first publication of the work shall constitute *prima facie* evidence of the validity of the copyright and of the facts stated in the certificate. The evidentiary weight to be accorded the certificate of a registration made thereafter shall be within the discretion of the court.

(c) In any legal proceedings, a copyright registration certificate issued before or within five years after the work's first publication will serve as *prima facie* evidence of the copyright's validity and the details stated in the certificate. The weight given to a registration certificate issued after that time will be determined by the court's discretion.

(d) The effective date of a copyright registration is the day on which an application, deposit, and fee, which are later determined by the Register of Copyrights or by a court of competent jurisdiction to be acceptable for registration, have all been received in the Copyright Office.

(d) The effective date of a copyright registration is the day when an application, deposit, and fee, which are later considered acceptable for registration by the Register of Copyrights or a court of competent jurisdiction, have all been received in the Copyright Office.

Section 411. Registration and infringement actions [10]

(a) Except for an action brought for a violation of the rights of the author under section 106A(a), and subject to the provisions of subsection (b), no action for infringement of the copyright in any United States work shall be instituted until registration of the copyright claim has been made in accordance with this title. In any case, however, where the deposit, application, and fee required for registration have been delivered to the Copyright Office in proper form and registration has been refused, the applicant is entitled to institute an action for infringement if notice thereof, with a copy of the complaint, is served on the Register of Copyrights. The Register may, at his or her option, become a party to the action with respect to the issue of registrability of the copyright claim by entering an appearance within sixty days after such service, but the Register's failure to become a party shall not deprive the court of jurisdiction to determine that issue.

(a) Except for a lawsuit filed for a violation of the author's rights under section 106A(a), and as long as it follows the rules in subsection (b), no lawsuit for copyright infringement on any United States work can be started until the copyright claim is registered according to this title. However, if the required deposit, application, and fee for registration have been submitted to the Copyright Office correctly and registration has been denied, the applicant can file a lawsuit for infringement if they serve notice of this along with a copy of the complaint to the Register of Copyrights. The Register can choose to join the lawsuit regarding the copyright claim's registrability by responding within sixty days after being served, but if the Register doesn’t join, it won’t take away the court's ability to rule on that issue.

(b) In the case of a work consisting of sounds, images, or both, the first fixation of which is made simultaneously with its transmission, the copyright owner may, either before or after such fixation takes place, institute an action for infringement under section 501, fully subject to the remedies provided by sections 502 through 506 and sections 509 and 510, if, in accordance with requirements that the Register of Copyrights shall prescribe by regulation, the copyright owner-

(b) If a work includes sounds, images, or both, and the first recording happens at the same time as its broadcast, the copyright owner can take legal action for infringement under section 501, either before or after the recording happens, subject to the remedies outlined in sections 502 through 506 and sections 509 and 510, if the copyright owner meets the requirements set by the Register of Copyrights through regulations.

(1) serves notice upon the infringer, not less than 48 hours before such fixation, identifying the work and the specific time and source of its first transmission, and declaring an intention to secure copyright in the work; and

(1) notifies the infringer at least 48 hours before the fixation, identifying the work and the exact time and source of its first transmission, and stating an intention to secure copyright in the work; and

(2) makes registration for the work, if required by subsection (a), within three months after its first transmission.

(2) registers the work, if required by subsection (a), within three months after its first transmission.

Section 412. Registration as prerequisite to certain remedies for infringement [11]

In any action under this title, other than an action brought for a violation of the rights of the author under section 106A(a) or an action instituted under section 411(b), no award of statutory damages or of attorney's fees, as provided by sections 504 and 505, shall be made for

In any action under this title, except for an action filed for a violation of the author's rights under section 106A(a) or an action started under section 411(b), no award of statutory damages or attorney's fees, as detailed in sections 504 and 505, will be given for

(1) any infringement of copyright in an unpublished work commenced before the effective date of its registration; or

(1) any violation of copyright in an unpublished work that started before the effective date of its registration; or

(2) any infringement of copyright commenced after first publication of the work and before the effective date of its registration, unless such registration is made within three months after the first publication of the work.

(2) any violation of copyright that started after the first publication of the work and before the effective date of its registration, unless that registration occurs within three months after the work's first publication.

————————— Chapter 4 Endnotes

Chapter 4 References

1 The Berne Convention Implementation Act of 1988 amended section 401 as follows: 1) in subsection (a), by changing the heading to "General Provisions" and by inserting "may be placed on" in lieu of "shall be placed on all"; 2) in subsection (b), by inserting "If a notice appears on the copies, it" in lieu of "The notice appearing on the copies"; and 3) by adding subsection (d). Pub. L. No. 100-568, 102 Stat. 2853, 2857.

1 The Berne Convention Implementation Act of 1988 updated section 401 as follows: 1) in subsection (a), the heading was changed to "General Provisions" and "may be placed on" was added instead of "shall be placed on all"; 2) in subsection (b), "If a notice appears on the copies, it" was added instead of "The notice appearing on the copies"; and 3) subsection (d) was added. Pub. L. No. 100-568, 102 Stat. 2853, 2857.

2 The Berne Convention Implementation Act of 1988 amended section 402 as follows: 1) in subsection (a), by changing the heading to "General Provisions" and by inserting "may be placed on" in lieu of "shall be placed on all"; 2) in subsection (b), by inserting "If a notice appears on the phonorecords, it" in lieu of "The notice appearing on the phonorecords"; and 3) by adding subsection (d). Pub. L. No. 100-568, 102 Stat. 2853, 2857.

2 The Berne Convention Implementation Act of 1988 updated section 402 as follows: 1) in subsection (a), the heading was changed to "General Provisions" and "may be placed on" was added instead of "shall be placed on all"; 2) in subsection (b), "If a notice appears on the phonorecords, it" was added instead of "The notice appearing on the phonorecords"; and 3) subsection (d) was added. Pub. L. No. 100-568, 102 Stat. 2853, 2857.

3 The Berne Convention Implementation Act of 1988 amended section 403 in its entirety. Pub. L. No. 100-568, 102 Stat. 2853, 2858.

3 The Berne Convention Implementation Act of 1988 completely revised section 403. Pub. L. No. 100-568, 102 Stat. 2853, 2858.

4 The Berne Convention Implementation Act of 1988 amended section 404 as follows: 1) in the second sentence of subsection (a), by inserting "to invoke the provisions of section 401(d) or 402(d), as applicable" in lieu of "to satisfy the requirements of sections 401 through 403" and 2) in subsection (b), by inserting "With respect to copies and phonorecords publicly distributed by authority of the copyright owner before the effective date of the Berne Convention Implementation Act of 1988," at the beginning of the sentence. Pub. L. No. 100-568, 102 Stat. 2853, 2858.

4 The Berne Convention Implementation Act of 1988 changed section 404 as follows: 1) in the second sentence of subsection (a), by adding "to invoke the provisions of section 401(d) or 402(d), as applicable" instead of "to satisfy the requirements of sections 401 through 403" and 2) in subsection (b), by adding "Regarding copies and phonorecords publicly distributed by the copyright owner before the effective date of the Berne Convention Implementation Act of 1988," at the start of the sentence. Pub. L. No. 100-568, 102 Stat. 2853, 2858.

5 The Berne Convention Implementation Act of 1988 amended section 405 as follows: 1) in subsection (a), by inserting "With respect to copies and phonorecords publicly distributed by authority of the copyright owner before the effective date of the Berne Convention Implementation Act of 1988, the omission of the copyright notice described in" at the beginning of the first sentence, in lieu of "The omission of the copyright notice prescribed by"; 2) in subsection (b), by inserting after "omitted," in the first sentence, "and which was publicly distributed by authority of the copyright owner before the effective date of the Berne Convention Implementation Act of 1988"; and 3) by amending the section heading to add "on certain copies and phonorecords" at the end thereof. Pub. L. No. 100-568, 102 Stat. 2853, 2858.

5 The Berne Convention Implementation Act of 1988 updated section 405 as follows: 1) in subsection (a), by adding "Regarding copies and phonorecords that were publicly distributed with the copyright owner's permission before the effective date of the Berne Convention Implementation Act of 1988, the lack of the copyright notice described in" at the beginning of the first sentence, instead of "The omission of the copyright notice prescribed by"; 2) in subsection (b), by adding after "omitted," in the first sentence, "and which was publicly distributed with the copyright owner's permission before the effective date of the Berne Convention Implementation Act of 1988"; and 3) by changing the section heading to include "on certain copies and phonorecords" at the end. Pub. L. No. 100-568, 102 Stat. 2853, 2858.

6 The Berne Convention Implementation Act of 1988 amended section 406 as follows: 1) in subsection (a), by inserting "With respect to copies and phonorecords publicly distributed by authority of the copyright owner before the effective date of the Berne Convention Implementation Act of 1988," at the beginning of the first sentence; 2) in subsection (b), by inserting "before the effective date of the Berne Convention Implementation Act of 1988" after "distributed"; 3) in subsection (c), by inserting "before the effective date of the Berne Convention Implementation Act of 1988" after "publicly distributed" and by inserting "as in effect on the day before the effective date of the Berne Convention Implementation Act of 1988" after "405"; and 4) by amending the section heading to add "on certain copies and phonorecords" at the end thereof. Pub. L. No. 100-568, 102 Stat. 2853, 2858.

6 The Berne Convention Implementation Act of 1988 changed section 406 like this: 1) in subsection (a), it added "Regarding copies and phonorecords publicly distributed with the copyright owner's permission before the effective date of the Berne Convention Implementation Act of 1988," at the start of the first sentence; 2) in subsection (b), it added "before the effective date of the Berne Convention Implementation Act of 1988" after "distributed"; 3) in subsection (c), it added "before the effective date of the Berne Convention Implementation Act of 1988" after "publicly distributed" and added "as in effect on the day before the effective date of the Berne Convention Implementation Act of 1988" after "405"; and 4) it updated the section heading to include "on certain copies and phonorecords" at the end. Pub. L. No. 100-568, 102 Stat. 2853, 2858.

7 The Berne Convention Implementation Act of 1988 amended section 407 by striking out the words "with notice of copyright" in subsection (a). Pub. L. No. 100-568, 102 Stat. 2853, 2859.

7 The Berne Convention Implementation Act of 1988 changed section 407 by removing the phrase "with notice of copyright" in subsection (a). Pub. L. No. 100-568, 102 Stat. 2853, 2859.

8 The Berne Convention Implementation Act of 1988 amended section 408 by deleting "Subject to the provisions of section 405(a)," at the beginning of the second sentence of subsection (a). Pub. L. No. 100-568, 102 Stat. 2853, 2859. That Act also amended section 408(c)(2) by inserting "the following conditions:" in lieu of "all of the following conditions" and by striking subparagraph (A) and by redesignating subparagraphs (B) and (C) as subparagraphs (A) and (B), respectively. *Id.*

8 The Berne Convention Implementation Act of 1988 changed section 408 by removing "Subject to the provisions of section 405(a)," at the start of the second sentence of subsection (a). Pub. L. No. 100-568, 102 Stat. 2853, 2859. That Act also modified section 408(c)(2) by replacing "all of the following conditions" with "the following conditions:" and by eliminating subparagraph (A) and renumbering subparagraphs (B) and (C) as subparagraphs (A) and (B), respectively. *Id.*

The Copyright Renewal Act of 1992 amended section 408 by revising the first sentence of subsection (a), preceding the words "the owner of copyright or of any exclusive right." Pub. L. No. 102-307, 106 Stat. 264, 266.

The Copyright Renewal Act of 1992 changed section 408 by updating the first sentence of subsection (a) to come before the words "the owner of copyright or of any exclusive right." Pub. L. No. 102-307, 106 Stat. 264, 266.

9 The Copyright Renewal Act of 1992 amended section 409 by adding the last sentence. Pub. L. No. 102-307, 106 Stat. 264, 266.

9 The Copyright Renewal Act of 1992 changed section 409 by adding the last sentence. Pub. L. No. 102-307, 106 Stat. 264, 266.

10 The Berne Convention Implementation Act of 1988 amended section 411 as follows: 1) in subsection (a), by inserting "Except for actions for infringement of copyright in Berne Convention works whose country of origin is not the United States, and" before "subject"; 2) in paragraph (b)(2), by inserting ", if required by subsection (a)," after "work"; and 3) by inserting "and infringement actions" in the heading, in lieu of "as prerequisite to infringement suit." Pub. L. No. 100-568, 102 Stat. 2853, 2859.

10 The Berne Convention Implementation Act of 1988 changed section 411 as follows: 1) in subsection (a), by adding "Except for actions for copyright infringement in Berne Convention works whose country of origin is not the United States, and" before "subject"; 2) in paragraph (b)(2), by adding ", if required by subsection (a)," after "work"; and 3) by replacing "as prerequisite to infringement suit" with "and infringement actions" in the heading. Pub. L. No. 100-568, 102 Stat. 2853, 2859.

The Visual Artists Rights Act of 1990 amended section 411(a) by inserting "and an action brought for a violation of the rights of the author under section 106A(a)" after "United States." Pub. L. No. 101-650, 104 Stat. 5089, 5131. In 1997, section 411(b)(1) was amended in its entirety. Pub. L. No. 105-80, 111 Stat. 1529, 1532.

The Visual Artists Rights Act of 1990 changed section 411(a) by adding "and an action brought for a violation of the rights of the author under section 106A(a)" after "United States." Pub. L. No. 101-650, 104 Stat. 5089, 5131. In 1997, section 411(b)(1) was completely revised. Pub. L. No. 105-80, 111 Stat. 1529, 1532.

The WIPO Copyright and Performances and Phonograms Treaties Implementation Act of 1998 amended the first sentence in section 411(a) by deleting "actions for infringement of copyright in Berne Convention works whose country of origin is not the United and" and by inserting "United States" after "no action for infringement of the copyright in any." Pub. L. No. 105-304, 112 Stat. 2860, 2863.

The WIPO Copyright and Performances and Phonograms Treaties Implementation Act of 1998 changed the first sentence in section 411(a) by removing "actions for infringement of copyright in Berne Convention works whose country of origin is not the United and" and by adding "United States" after "no action for infringement of the copyright in any." Pub. L. No. 105-304, 112 Stat. 2860, 2863.

11 The Visual Artists Rights Act of 1990 amended section 412 by inserting "an action brought for a violation of the rights of the author under section 106A(a) or" after "other than." Pub. L. No. 101-650, 104 Stat. 5089, 5131.

11 The Visual Artists Rights Act of 1990 changed section 412 by adding "an action brought for a violation of the rights of the author under section 106A(a) or" after "other than." Pub. L. No. 101-650, 104 Stat. 5089, 5131.

————————————————————————————————————

Understood! Please provide the text you'd like me to modernize.

Chapter 5 [1]

Copyright Infringement and Remedies

Copyright Violation and Solutions

+ 501. Infringement of copyright + 502. Remedies for infringement: Injunctions + 503. Remedies for infringement: Impounding and disposition of infringing articles + 504. Remedies for infringement: Damages and profits + 505. Remedies for infringement: Costs and attorney's fees + 506. Criminal offenses + 507. Limitations on actions + 508. Notification of filing and determination of actions + 509. Seizure and forfeiture + 510. Remedies for alteration of programming by cable systems + 511. Liability of States, instrumentalities of States, and State officials for infringement of copyright + 512. Limitations on liability relating to material online + 513. [2] Determination of reasonable license fees for individual proprietors

+ 501. Copyright infringement + 502. Solutions for infringement: Injunctions + 503. Solutions for infringement: Seizure and handling of infringing items + 504. Solutions for infringement: Damages and profits + 505. Solutions for infringement: Costs and attorney's fees + 506. Criminal offenses + 507. Time limits on actions + 508. Notification of filing and outcomes of actions + 509. Seizure and forfeiture + 510. Solutions for changes to programming by cable systems + 511. Responsibility of States, state agencies, and state officials for copyright infringement + 512. Limits on liability regarding online material + 513. [2] Determining fair license fees for individual proprietors

Section 501. Infringement of copyright [3]

(a) Anyone who violates any of the exclusive rights of the copyright owner as provided by sections 106 through 121 or of the author as provided in section 106A(a), or who imports copies or phonorecords into the United States in violation of section 602, is an infringer of the copyright or right of the author, as the case may be. For purposes of this chapter (other than section 506), any reference to copyright shall be deemed to include the rights conferred by section 106A(a). As used in this subsection, the term "anyone" includes any State, any instrumentality of a State, and any officer or employee of a State or instrumentality of a State acting in his or her official capacity. Any State, and any such instrumentality, officer, or employee, shall be subject to the provisions of this title in the same manner and to the same extent as any nongovernmental entity.

(a) Anyone who breaks any of the exclusive rights of the copyright owner as outlined in sections 106 through 121, or of the author as mentioned in section 106A(a), or who brings copies or phonorecords into the United States against the rules in section 602, is considered a copyright infringer or an infringer of the author's rights, as applicable. For the purposes of this chapter (excluding section 506), any reference to copyright should include the rights given by section 106A(a). In this subsection, the term "anyone" refers to any state, any entity of a state, and any official or employee of a state or entity acting in their official capacity. Any state and any such entity, official, or employee will be subject to the rules in this title just like any private organization.

(b) The legal or beneficial owner of an exclusive right under a copyright is entitled, subject to the requirements of section 411, to institute an action for any infringement of that particular right committed while he or she is the owner of it. The court may require such owner to serve written notice of the action with a copy of the complaint upon any person shown, by the records of the Copyright Office or otherwise, to have or claim an interest in the copyright, and shall require that such notice be served upon any person whose interest is likely to be affected by a decision in the case. The court may require the joinder, and shall permit the intervention, of any person having or claiming an interest in the copyright.

(b) The legal or beneficial owner of an exclusive copyright has the right, following the rules in section 411, to file a lawsuit for any infringement of that right that occurs while they own it. The court may require the owner to send written notice of the lawsuit along with a copy of the complaint to anyone shown in the records of the Copyright Office or elsewhere to have or claim an interest in the copyright. The court must also require that notice be sent to anyone whose interest might be affected by the court's decision. The court can require that any person with an interest in the copyright join the case, and it must allow anyone claiming an interest to intervene.

(c) For any secondary transmission by a cable system that embodies a performance or a display of a work which is actionable as an act of infringement under subsection (c) of section 111, a television broadcast station holding a copyright or other license to transmit or perform the same version of that work shall, for purposes of subsection (b) of this section, be treated as a legal or beneficial owner if such secondary transmission occurs within the local service area of that television station.

(c) For any secondary transmission by a cable system that includes a performance or display of a work that can be considered infringement under subsection (c) of section 111, a TV broadcast station that holds the copyright or another license to transmit or perform the same version of that work will be treated as a legal or beneficial owner for the purposes of subsection (b) of this section, as long as that secondary transmission happens within the local service area of that TV station.

(d) For any secondary transmission by a cable system that is actionable as an act of infringement pursuant to section 111(c)(3), the following shall also have standing to sue: (i) the primary transmitter whose transmission has been altered by the cable system; and (ii) any broadcast station within whose local service area the secondary transmission occurs.

(d) For any secondary transmission by a cable system that can be considered an infringement under section 111(c)(3), the following parties are also allowed to sue: (i) the primary transmitter whose transmission has been changed by the cable system; and (ii) any broadcast station within the local service area where the secondary transmission takes place.

(e) With respect to any secondary transmission that is made by a satellite carrier of a performance or display of a work embodied in a primary transmission and is actionable as an act of infringement under section 119(a)(5), a network station holding a copyright or other license to transmit or perform the same version of that work shall, for purposes of subsection (b) of this section, be treated as a legal or beneficial owner if such secondary transmission occurs within the local service area of that station.

(e) Regarding any secondary transmission made by a satellite carrier of a performance or display of a work included in a primary transmission, which can be considered an infringement under section 119(a)(5), a network station that holds a copyright or other license to transmit or perform the same version of that work will, for the purposes of subsection (b) of this section, be treated as a legal or beneficial owner if that secondary transmission occurs within the local service area of that station.

(f)(1) With respect to any secondary transmission that is made by a satellite carrier of a performance or display of a work embodied in a primary transmission and is actionable as an act of infringement under section 122, a television broadcast station holding a copyright or other license to transmit or perform the same version of that work shall, for purposes of subsection (b) of this section, be treated as a legal or beneficial owner if such secondary transmission occurs within the local market of that station.

(f)(1) Regarding any secondary transmission made by a satellite carrier of a performance or display of a work that’s included in a primary transmission and could be considered infringement under section 122, a television broadcast station that holds copyright or another license to transmit or perform the same version of that work will be viewed as a legal or beneficial owner for the purposes of subsection (b) of this section, as long as that secondary transmission takes place within the local market of that station.

(2) A television broadcast station may file a civil action against any satellite carrier that has refused to carry television broadcast signals, as required under section 122(a)(2), to enforce that television broadcast station's rights under section 338(a) of the Communications Act of 1934.

(2) A TV station can file a lawsuit against any satellite provider that has declined to carry its broadcast signals, as required by section 122(a)(2), to uphold the TV station's rights under section 338(a) of the Communications Act of 1934.

Section 502. Remedies for infringement: Injunctions

(a) Any court having jurisdiction of a civil action arising under this title may, subject to the provisions of section 1498 of title 28, grant temporary and final injunctions on such terms as it may deem reasonable to prevent or restrain infringement of a copyright.

(a) Any court with jurisdiction over a civil action related to this title may, following the rules in section 1498 of title 28, issue temporary and permanent injunctions on terms it finds reasonable to prevent or stop copyright infringement.

(b) Any such injunction may be served anywhere in the United States on the person enjoined; it shall be operative throughout the United States and shall be enforceable, by proceedings in contempt or otherwise, by any United States court having jurisdiction of that person. The clerk of the court granting the injunction shall, when requested by any other court in which enforcement of the injunction is sought, transmit promptly to the other court a certified copy of all the papers in the case on file in such clerk's office.

(b) Any such injunction can be served anywhere in the United States on the person being restrained; it will be effective throughout the United States and can be enforced, through contempt proceedings or otherwise, by any United States court with jurisdiction over that person. The clerk of the court that issued the injunction must, when requested by any other court seeking to enforce the injunction, quickly send a certified copy of all the case documents on file in that clerk's office to the other court.

Section 503. Remedies for infringement: Impounding and disposition of infringing articles

(a) At any time while an action under this title is pending, the court may order the impounding, on such terms as it may deem reasonable, of all copies or phonorecords claimed to have been made or used in violation of the copyright owner's exclusive rights, and of all plates, molds, matrices, masters, tapes, film negatives, or other articles by means of which such copies or phonorecords may be reproduced.

(a) At any point while a case under this title is ongoing, the court can order the seizure, under terms it considers reasonable, of all copies or phonorecords that are claimed to have been made or used in violation of the copyright owner's exclusive rights, along with all plates, molds, matrices, masters, tapes, film negatives, or other items used to reproduce those copies or phonorecords.

(b) As part of a final judgment or decree, the court may order the destruction or other reasonable disposition of all copies or phonorecords found to have been made or used in violation of the copyright owner's exclusive rights, and of all plates, molds, matrices, masters, tapes, film negatives, or other articles by means of which such copies or phonorecords may be reproduced.

(b) As part of a final judgment or ruling, the court may order the destruction or other reasonable handling of all copies or recordings found to have been made or used in violation of the copyright owner's exclusive rights, and of all plates, molds, matrices, masters, tapes, film negatives, or other items that can be used to reproduce those copies or recordings.

Section 504. Remedies for infringement: Damages and profits [4]

(a) In General. Except as otherwise provided by this title, an infringer of copyright is liable for either-

(a) In General. Except as otherwise stated in this title, someone who infringes on copyright is responsible for either-

(1) the copyright owner's actual damages and any additional profits of the infringer, as provided by subsection (b); or

(1) the copyright owner's real damages and any extra profits made by the infringer, as outlined in subsection (b); or

(2) statutory damages, as provided by subsection (c).

(2) statutory damages, as outlined in subsection (c).

(b) Actual Damages and Profits. The copyright owner is entitled to recover the actual damages suffered by him or her as a result of the infringement, and any profits of the infringer that are attributable to the infringement and are not taken into account in computing the actual damages. In establishing the infringer's profits, the copyright owner is required to present proof only of the infringer's gross revenue, and the infringer is required to prove his or her deductible expenses and the elements of profit attributable to factors other than the copyrighted work.

(b) Actual Damages and Profits. The copyright owner has the right to recover the actual damages they suffered due to the infringement, as well as any profits that the infringer made from the infringement that weren’t included in calculating the actual damages. To determine the infringer's profits, the copyright owner only needs to provide evidence of the infringer's gross revenue, while the infringer must prove their deductible expenses and any profits that come from sources other than the copyrighted work.

(c) Statutory Damages.

(c) Statutory Damages.

(1) Except as provided by clause (2) of this subsection, the copyright owner may elect, at any time before final judgment is rendered, to recover, instead of actual damages and profits, an award of statutory damages for all infringements involved in the action, with respect to any one work, for which any one infringer is liable individually, or for which any two or more infringers are liable jointly and severally, in a sum of not less than $750 or more than $30,000 as the court considers just. For the purposes of this subsection, all the parts of a compilation or derivative work constitute one work.

(1) Unless stated in clause (2) of this subsection, the copyright owner can choose, at any time before a final judgment is made, to receive an award of statutory damages instead of actual damages and profits for all infringements involved in the case. This applies to any one work for which a single infringer is individually liable, or for which two or more infringers are jointly and severally liable, in an amount not less than $750 and not more than $30,000, as the court deems appropriate. For this subsection, all parts of a compilation or derivative work are considered one work.

(2) In a case where the copyright owner sustains the burden of proving, and the court finds, that infringement was committed willfully, the court in its discretion may increase the award of statutory damages to a sum of not more than $150,000. In a case where the infringer sustains the burden of proving, and the court finds, that such infringer was not aware and had no reason to believe that his or her acts constituted an infringement of copyright, the court in its discretion may reduce the award of statutory damages to a sum of not less than $200. The court shall remit statutory damages in any case where an infringer believed and had reasonable grounds for believing that his or her use of the copyrighted work was a fair use under section 107, if the infringer was: (i) an employee or agent of a nonprofit educational institution, library, or archives acting within the scope of his or her employment who, or such institution, library, or archives itself, which infringed by reproducing the work in copies or phonorecords; or (ii) a public broadcasting entity which or a person who, as a regular part of the nonprofit activities of a public broadcasting entity (as defined in subsection (g) of section 118) infringed by performing a published nondramatic literary work or by reproducing a transmission program embodying a performance of such a work.

(2) If the copyright owner proves, and the court determines, that infringement was done willfully, the court may increase the statutory damages to no more than $150,000. If the infringer proves, and the court finds, that they were unaware and had no reason to believe their actions were infringing on copyright, the court may decrease the statutory damages to at least $200. The court must lower statutory damages in any case where an infringer genuinely believed and had reasonable grounds to believe their use of the copyrighted work was fair use under section 107, if the infringer was: (i) an employee or agent of a nonprofit educational institution, library, or archives acting within the scope of their employment that reproduced the work in copies or phonorecords; or (ii) a public broadcasting entity or a person who, as part of the nonprofit activities of a public broadcasting entity (as defined in subsection (g) of section 118), infringed by performing a published nondramatic literary work or by reproducing a transmission program featuring a performance of such a work.

(d) Additional Damages in Certain Cases. In any case in which the court finds that a defendant proprietor of an establishment who claims as a defense that its activities were exempt under section 110(5) did not have reasonable grounds to believe that its use of a copyrighted work was exempt under such section, the plaintiff shall be entitled to, in addition to any award of damages under this section, an additional award of two times the amount of the license fee that the proprietor of the establishment concerned should have paid the plaintiff for such use during the preceding period of up to 3 years.

(d) Additional Damages in Certain Cases. In any situation where the court determines that a defendant owner of a business, who claims the defense that its activities were exempt under section 110(5), did not have reasonable grounds to believe that their use of a copyrighted work was exempt under that section, the plaintiff will be entitled to, in addition to any damages awarded under this section, an extra amount equal to two times the license fee that the business owner should have paid the plaintiff for that use during the previous period of up to 3 years.

Section 505. Remedies for infringement: Costs and attorney's fees

In any civil action under this title, the court in its discretion may allow the recovery of full costs by or against any party other than the United States or an officer thereof. Except as otherwise provided by this title, the court may also award a reasonable attorney's fee to the prevailing party as part of the costs.

In any civil case under this title, the court may, at its discretion, allow any party other than the United States or its officers to recover full costs. Unless stated otherwise in this title, the court can also grant a reasonable attorney's fee to the winning party as part of the costs.

Section 506. Criminal offenses [5]

(a) Criminal Infringement. Any person who infringes a copyright willfully either

(a) Criminal Infringement. Any person who willfully infringes a copyright

(1) for purposes of commercial advantage or private financial gain, or

(1) for the sake of making a profit or personal financial benefit, or

(2) by the reproduction or distribution, including by electronic means, during any 180-day period, of 1 or more copies or phonorecords of 1 or more copyrighted works, which have a total retail value of more than $1,000,

(2) by reproducing or distributing, including electronically, during any 180-day period, 1 or more copies or phonorecords of 1 or more copyrighted works that have a total retail value of over $1,000,

shall be punished as provided under section 2319 of title 18, United States Code. For purposes of this subsection, evidence of reproduction or distribution of a copyrighted work, by itself, shall not be sufficient to establish willful infringement.

shall be punished as outlined in section 2319 of title 18, United States Code. For this subsection, proof of reproducing or distributing a copyrighted work, on its own, is not enough to demonstrate willful infringement.

(b) Forfeiture and Destruction. When any person is convicted of any violation of subsection (a), the court in its judgment of conviction shall, in addition to the penalty therein prescribed, order the forfeiture and destruction or other disposition of all infringing copies or phonorecords and all implements, devices, or equipment used in the manufacture of such infringing copies or phonorecords.

(b) Forfeiture and Destruction. When someone is found guilty of violating subsection (a), the court, in its judgment, must order, in addition to the prescribed penalty, the forfeiture and destruction or other handling of all infringing copies or phonorecords, along with all tools, devices, or equipment used to make those infringing copies or phonorecords.

(c) Fraudulent Copyright Notice. Any person who, with fraudulent intent, places on any article a notice of copyright or words of the same purport that such person knows to be false, or who, with fraudulent intent, publicly distributes or imports for public distribution any article bearing such notice or words that such person knows to be false, shall be fined not more than $2,500.

(c) Fraudulent Copyright Notice. Any person who, with the intent to deceive, places a copyright notice or similar wording on any item that they know is false, or who, with the intent to deceive, publicly distributes or imports for public distribution any item with such a notice or wording that they know is false, shall be fined no more than $2,500.

(d) Fraudulent Removal of Copyright Notice. Any person who, with fraudulent intent, removes or alters any notice of copyright appearing on a copy of a copyrighted work shall be fined not more than $2,500.

(d) Fraudulent Removal of Copyright Notice. Any person who, with fraudulent intent, removes or changes any copyright notice on a copy of a copyrighted work will be fined up to $2,500.

(e) False Representation. Any person who knowingly makes a false representation of a material fact in the application for copyright registration provided for by section 409, or in any written statement filed in connection with the application, shall be fined not more than $2,500.

(e) False Representation. Any person who knowingly makes a false statement about an important fact in the copyright registration application outlined in section 409, or in any written statement submitted with the application, will be fined up to $2,500.

(f) Rights of Attribution and Integrity. Nothing in this section applies to infringement of the rights conferred by section 106A(a).

(f) Rights of Attribution and Integrity. Nothing in this section applies to violations of the rights granted by section 106A(a).

Section 507. Limitations on actions [6]

(a) Criminal Proceedings. Except as expressly provided otherwise in this title, no criminal proceeding shall be maintained under the provisions of this title unless it is commenced within 5 years after the cause of action arose.

(a) Criminal Proceedings. Except as specifically stated otherwise in this title, no criminal proceeding shall be initiated under the provisions of this title unless it starts within 5 years after the cause of action occurred.

(b) Civil Actions. No civil action shall be maintained under the provisions of this title unless it is commenced within three years after the claim accrued.

(b) Civil Actions. No civil action can be maintained under the provisions of this title unless it is started within three years after the claim arose.

Section 508. Notification of filing and determination of actions

(a) Within one month after the filing of any action under this title, the clerks of the courts of the United States shall send written notification to the Register of Copyrights setting forth, as far as is shown by the papers filed in the court, the names and addresses of the parties and the title, author, and registration number of each work involved in the action. If any other copyrighted work is later included in the action by amendment, answer, or other pleading, the clerk shall also send a notification concerning it to the Register within one month after the pleading is filed.

(a) Within one month after filing any action under this title, the clerks of the U.S. courts must send written notice to the Register of Copyrights, detailing, as far as indicated by the papers filed in court, the names and addresses of the parties and the title, author, and registration number of each work involved in the action. If any other copyrighted work is later added to the action through an amendment, answer, or other pleading, the clerk must also send a notification about it to the Register within one month after the pleading is filed.

(b) Within one month after any final order or judgment is issued in the case, the clerk of the court shall notify the Register of it, sending with the notification a copy of the order or judgment together with the written opinion, if any, of the court.

(b) Within one month after any final order or judgment is issued in the case, the court clerk must notify the Register, sending a copy of the order or judgment along with the court's written opinion, if there is one.

(c) Upon receiving the notifications specified in this section, the Register shall make them a part of the public records of the Copyright Office.

(c) After getting the notifications mentioned in this section, the Register will include them in the public records of the Copyright Office.

Section 509. Seizure and forfeiture

(a) All copies or phonorecords manufactured, reproduced, distributed, sold, or otherwise used, intended for use, or possessed with intent to use in violation of section 506 (a), and all plates, molds, matrices, masters, tapes, film negatives, or other articles by means of which such copies or phonorecords may be reproduced, and all electronic, mechanical, or other devices for manufacturing, reproducing, or assembling such copies or phonorecords may be seized and forfeited to the United States.

(a) All copies or phonorecords made, reproduced, distributed, sold, or otherwise used, intended for use, or held with the intent to use in violation of section 506 (a), as well as all plates, molds, matrices, masters, tapes, film negatives, or other items used to reproduce such copies or phonorecords, and all electronic, mechanical, or other devices for making, reproducing, or assembling such copies or phonorecords may be seized and forfeited to the United States.

(b) The applicable procedures relating to

the relevant procedures regarding

(i) the seizure, summary and judicial forfeiture, and condemnation of vessels, vehicles, merchandise, and baggage for violations of the customs laws contained in title 19,

(i) the seizure, summary judgment, and legal forfeiture, and condemnation of ships, vehicles, goods, and luggage for breaking the customs laws found in title 19,

(ii) the disposition of such vessels, vehicles, merchandise, and baggage or the proceeds from the sale thereof,

(ii) the handling of these vessels, vehicles, goods, and luggage or the profits from their sale,

(iii) the remission or mitigation of such forfeiture,

(iii) the forgiveness or reduction of such forfeiture,

(iv) the compromise of claims, and

(iv) the settling of claims, and

(v) the award of compensation to informers in respect of such forfeitures, shall apply to seizures and forfeitures incurred, or alleged to have been incurred, under the provisions of this section, insofar as applicable and not inconsistent with the provisions of this section; except that such duties as are imposed upon any officer or employee of the Treasury Department or any other person with respect to the seizure and forfeiture of vessels, vehicles, merchandise, and baggage under the provisions of the customs laws contained in title 19 shall be performed with respect to seizure and forfeiture of all articles described in subsection (a) by such officers, agents, or other persons as may be authorized or designated for that purpose by the Attorney General.

(v) The payment of rewards to informers related to those forfeitures will apply to seizures and forfeitures that happened, or are claimed to have happened, under this section, as long as it’s applicable and doesn’t conflict with this section's provisions. However, the responsibilities placed on any officer or employee of the Treasury Department or anyone else regarding the seizure and forfeiture of vessels, vehicles, merchandise, and luggage under the customs laws stated in title 19 will still be carried out for all items mentioned in subsection (a) by officers, agents, or others authorized or appointed for that purpose by the Attorney General.

Section 510. Remedies for alteration of programming by cable systems [7]

(a) In any action filed pursuant to section 111(c)(3), the following remedies shall be available:

(a) In any action filed under section 111(c)(3), the following remedies will be available:

(1) Where an action is brought by a party identified in subsections (b) or (c) of section 501, the remedies provided by sections 502 through 505, and the remedy provided by subsection (b) of this section; and

(1) When a party listed in subsections (b) or (c) of section 501 initiates an action, the solutions offered by sections 502 through 505, along with the solution provided by subsection (b) of this section; and

(2) When an action is brought by a party identified in subsection (d) of section 501, the remedies provided by sections 502 and 505, together with any actual damages suffered by such party as a result of the infringement, and the remedy provided by subsection (b) of this section.

(2) When a party mentioned in subsection (d) of section 501 files an action, the remedies outlined in sections 502 and 505, along with any actual damages that party experienced due to the infringement, and the remedy provided by subsection (b) of this section will apply.

(b) In any action filed pursuant to section 111(c)(3), the court may decree that, for a period not to exceed thirty days, the cable system shall be deprived of the benefit of a statutory license for one or more distant signals carried by such cable system.

(b) In any action filed under section 111(c)(3), the court may order that, for a period of up to thirty days, the cable system will lose the benefit of a statutory license for one or more distant signals carried by that cable system.

Section 511. Liability of States, instrumentalities of States, and State officials for infringement of copyright [8]

(a) In General. Any State, any instrumentality of a State, and any officer or employee of a State or instrumentality of a State acting in his or her official capacity, shall not be immune, under the Eleventh Amendment of the Constitution of the United States or under any other doctrine of sovereign immunity, from suit in Federal Court by any person, including any governmental or nongovernmental entity, for a violation of any of the exclusive rights of a copyright owner provided by sections 106 through 121, for importing copies of phonorecords in violation of section 602, or for any other violation under this title.

(a) In General. Any state, any agency of a state, and any officer or employee of a state or agency acting in their official capacity, shall not be protected, under the Eleventh Amendment of the Constitution of the United States or any other principle of sovereign immunity, from being sued in Federal Court by any person, including any government or private entity, for violating any exclusive rights of a copyright owner provided by sections 106 through 121, for importing copies of phonorecords in violation of section 602, or for any other violation under this title.

(b) Remedies. In a suit described in subsection (a) for a violation described in that subsection, remedies (including remedies both at law and in equity) are available for the violation to the same extent as such remedies are available for such a violation in a suit against any public or private entity other than a State, instrumentality of a State, or officer or employee of a State acting in his or her official capacity. Such remedies include impounding and disposition of infringing articles under section 503, actual damages and profits and statutory damages under section 504, costs and attorney's fees under section 505, and the remedies provided in section 510.

(b) Remedies. In a lawsuit mentioned in subsection (a) for a violation described in that subsection, remedies (including both legal and equitable remedies) are available for the violation just as they would be in a case against any public or private entity, except for a State, a State's agency, or a State officer or employee acting in their official role. These remedies include seizing and disposing of infringing items under section 503, actual damages and profits as well as statutory damages under section 504, costs and attorney's fees under section 505, and the remedies specified in section 510.

Section 512. Limitations on liability relating to material online [9]

(a) Transitory Digital Network Communications. A service provider shall not be liable for monetary relief, or, except as provided in subsection (j), for injunctive or other equitable relief, for infringement of copyright by reason of the provider's transmitting, routing, or providing connections for, material through a system or network controlled or operated by or for the service provider, or by reason of the intermediate and transient storage of that material in the course of such transmitting, routing, or providing connections, if-

(a) Temporary Digital Network Communications. A service provider won't be held responsible for monetary compensation, or, except as stated in subsection (j), for injunctive or other types of equitable relief, for copyright infringement due to the provider's transmission, routing, or connection of material through a system or network that they control or operate, or because of the short-term storage of that material during such transmission, routing, or connection, if-

(1) the transmission of the material was initiated by or at the direction of a person other than the service provider;

(1) the transfer of the material was started by or under the guidance of someone other than the service provider;

(2) the transmission, routing, provision of connections, or storage is carried out through an automatic technical process without selection of the material by the service provider;

(2) the transmission, routing, provision of connections, or storage is done through an automatic technical process without the service provider selecting the material;

(3) the service provider does not select the recipients of the material except as an automatic response to the request of another person;

(3) the service provider does not choose the recipients of the material except as an automatic reaction to someone else's request;

(4) no copy of the material made by the service provider in the course of such intermediate or transient storage is maintained on the system or network in a manner ordinarily accessible to anyone other than anticipated recipients, and no such copy is maintained on the system or network in a manner ordinarily accessible to such anticipated recipients for a longer period than is reasonably necessary for the transmission, routing, or provision of connections; and

(4) no copy of the material created by the service provider during any intermediate or temporary storage is kept on the system or network in a way that's normally accessible to anyone other than the intended recipients, and no such copy is stored on the system or network in a way that's normally accessible to those intended recipients for longer than what's reasonably needed for the transmission, routing, or provision of connections; and

(5) the material is transmitted through the system or network without modification of its content.

(5) the material is sent through the system or network without changing its content.

(b) System Caching.

(b) System Caching.

(1) Limitation on Liability. A service provider shall not be liable for monetary relief, or, except as provided in subsection (j), for injunctive or other equitable relief, for infringement of copyright by reason of the intermediate and temporary storage of material on a system or network controlled or operated by or for the service provider in a case in which-

(1) Limitation on Liability. A service provider won't be responsible for monetary damages, or, except as stated in subsection (j), for injunctive or other equitable relief, for copyright infringement due to the short-term and temporary storage of material on a system or network managed or operated by or for the service provider in a case in which-

(A) the material is made available online by a person other than the service provider;

(A) the material is shared online by someone other than the service provider;

(B) the material is transmitted from the person described in subparagraph (A) through the system or network to a person other than the person described in subparagraph (A) at the direction of that other person; and

(B) the material is sent from the person mentioned in subparagraph (A) through the system or network to someone else, at the request of that other person; and

(C) the storage is carried out through an automatic technical process for the purpose of making the material available to users of the system or network who, after the material is transmitted as described in subparagraph (B), request access to the material from the person described in subparagraph (A), if the conditions set forth in paragraph (2) are met.

(C) the storage happens through an automatic technical process to make the material accessible to users of the system or network who, after the material is transmitted as mentioned in subparagraph (B), request access to the material from the person described in subparagraph (A), if the conditions outlined in paragraph (2) are met.

(2) Conditions. The conditions referred to in paragraph (1) are that-

(2) Conditions. The conditions mentioned in paragraph (1) are that-

(A) the material described in paragraph (1) is transmitted to the subsequent users described in paragraph (1)(C) without modification to its content from the manner in which the material was transmitted from the person described in paragraph (1)(A);

(A) the material mentioned in paragraph (1) is sent to the later users identified in paragraph (1)(C) without any changes to its content from how it was provided by the person noted in paragraph (1)(A);

(B) the service provider described in paragraph (1) complies with rules concerning the refreshing, reloading, or other updating of the material when specified by the person making the material available online in accordance with a generally accepted industry standard data communications protocol for the system or network through which that person makes the material available, except that this subparagraph applies only if those rules are not used by the person described in paragraph (1)(A) to prevent or unreasonably impair the intermediate storage to which this subsection applies;

(B) the service provider mentioned in paragraph (1) follows the rules about refreshing, reloading, or updating the material when required by the person sharing the material online, according to a widely accepted industry standard data communication protocol for the system or network that person uses to share the material. However, this part only applies if those rules aren’t used by the person in paragraph (1)(A) to block or unfairly limit the intermediate storage referenced in this subsection;

(C) the service provider does not interfere with the ability of technology associated with the material to return to the person described in paragraph (1)(A) the information that would have been available to that person if the material had been obtained by the subsequent users described in paragraph (1)(C) directly from that person, except that this subparagraph applies only if that technology-

(C) the service provider doesn’t prevent the technology linked to the material from giving back to the person described in paragraph (1)(A) the information that would have been available to that person if the material had been obtained by the later users mentioned in paragraph (1)(C) directly from that person, but this subparagraph only applies if that technology—

(i) does not significantly interfere with the performance of the provider's system or network or with the intermediate storage of the material;

(i) does not seriously disrupt the operation of the provider's system or network or the temporary storage of the material;

(ii) is consistent with generally accepted industry standard communications protocols; and

(ii) aligns with widely accepted industry standard communication protocols; and

(iii) does not extract information from the provider's system or network other than the information that would have been available to the person described in paragraph (1)(A) if the subsequent users had gained access to the material directly from that person;

(iii) does not pull information from the provider's system or network other than the information that would have been accessible to the person mentioned in paragraph (1)(A) if the later users had obtained the material directly from that person;

(D) if the person described in paragraph (1)(A) has in effect a condition that a person must meet prior to having access to the material, such as a condition based on payment of a fee or provision of a password or other information, the service provider permits access to the stored material in significant part only to users of its system or network that have met those conditions and only in accordance with those conditions; and

(D) if the person described in paragraph (1)(A) has a requirement that someone must fulfill before they can access the material, like having to pay a fee or provide a password or other information, the service provider allows access to the stored material mainly to users of its system or network who have met those requirements and only according to those conditions; and

(E) if the person described in paragraph (1)(A) makes that material available online without the authorization of the copyright owner of the material, the service provider responds expeditiously to remove, or disable access to, the material that is claimed to be infringing upon notification of claimed infringement as described in subsection (c)(3), except that this subparagraph applies only if-

(E) if the person mentioned in paragraph (1)(A) posts that material online without the copyright owner's permission, the service provider must quickly remove or block access to the material that is said to be infringing after receiving a notification of claimed infringement as explained in subsection (c)(3), but this part only applies if-

(i) the material has previously been removed from the originating site or access to it has been disabled, or a court has ordered that the material be removed from the originating site or that access to the material on the originating site be disabled; and

(i) the content has been taken down from the original site, or access to it has been restricted, or a court has ordered that the content be removed from the original site or that access to the content on the original site be restricted; and

(ii) the party giving the notification includes in the notification a statement confirming that the material has been removed from the originating site or access to it has been disabled or that a court has ordered that the material be removed from the originating site or that access to the material on the originating site be disabled.

(ii) the party giving the notification includes in the notification a statement confirming that the material has been removed from the originating site or access to it has been disabled or that a court has ordered that the material be removed from the originating site or that access to the material on the originating site be disabled.

(c) Information Residing on Systems or Networks at Direction of Users.

(c) Information Stored on Systems or Networks at the Request of Users.

(1) In General. A service provider shall not be liable for monetary relief, or, except as provided in subsection (j), for injunctive or other equitable relief, for infringement of copyright by reason of the storage at the direction of a user of material that resides on a system or network controlled or operated by or for the service provider, if the service provider-

(1) In General. A service provider isn't responsible for paying damages, or, except as stated in subsection (j), for any kind of injunctive or other equitable relief, for copyright infringement due to the storage of material at a user's request that is kept on a system or network controlled or operated by or for the service provider, if the service provider-

(A)(i) does not have actual knowledge that the material or an activity using the material on the system or network is infringing;

(A)(i) does not actually know that the material or an activity using the material on the system or network is infringing;

(ii) in the absence of such actual knowledge, is not aware of facts or circumstances from which infringing activity is apparent; or

(ii) if there’s no actual knowledge, isn’t aware of facts or situations that clearly indicate infringing activity; or

(iii) upon obtaining such knowledge or awareness, acts expeditiously to remove, or disable access to, the material;

(iii) once becoming aware of such information, quickly takes steps to remove or block access to the material;

(B) does not receive a financial benefit directly attributable to the infringing activity, in a case in which the service provider has the right and ability to control such activity; and

(B) does not receive a financial benefit that directly comes from the infringing activity, in a situation where the service provider has the right and ability to control that activity; and

(C) upon notification of claimed infringement as described in paragraph (3), responds expeditiously to remove, or disable access to, the material that is claimed to be infringing or to be the subject of infringing activity.

(C) upon being notified of alleged infringement as described in paragraph (3), responds promptly to remove or disable access to the material that is claimed to be infringing or related to infringing activity.

(2) Designated Agent. The limitations on liability established in this subsection apply to a service provider only if the service provider has designated an agent to receive notifications of claimed infringement described in paragraph (3), by making available through its service, including on its website in a location accessible to the public, and by providing to the Copyright Office, substantially the following information:

(2) Designated Agent. The limits on liability outlined in this subsection apply to a service provider only if they have designated an agent to receive notifications of claimed infringement mentioned in paragraph (3), by making that information available through their service, including on their website in a publicly accessible location, and by providing the Copyright Office with essentially the following information:

(A) the name, address, phone number, and electronic mail address of the agent.

(A) the name, address, phone number, and email address of the agent.

(B) other contact information which the Register of Copyrights may deem appropriate.

(B) other contact info that the Register of Copyrights may consider suitable.

The Register of Copyrights shall maintain a current directory of agents available to the public for inspection, including through the Internet, in both electronic and hard copy formats, and may require payment of a fee by service providers to cover the costs of maintaining the directory.

The Register of Copyrights will keep an updated directory of agents that the public can check out, available online and in printed form, and may charge a fee to service providers to help cover the costs of maintaining the directory.

(3) Elements of Notification.

(3) Notification Elements.

(A) To be effective under this subsection, a notification of claimed infringement must be a written communication provided to the designated agent of a service provider that includes substantially the following:

(A) To be effective under this subsection, a notification of claimed infringement must be a written communication sent to the designated agent of a service provider that includes basically the following:

(i) A physical or electronic signature of a person authorized to act on behalf of the owner of an exclusive right that is allegedly infringed.

(i) A physical or digital signature from someone authorized to act for the owner of an exclusive right that is supposedly violated.

(ii) Identification of the copyrighted work claimed to have been infringed, or, if multiple copyrighted works at a single online site are covered by a single notification, a representative list of such works at that site.

(ii) Identification of the copyrighted work that is alleged to have been infringed, or, if several copyrighted works at a single online site are included in one notification, a representative list of those works at that site.

(iii) Identification of the material that is claimed to be infringing or to be the subject of infringing activity and that is to be removed or access to which is to be disabled, and information reasonably sufficient to permit the service provider to locate the material.

(iii) Identify the material that is alleged to be infringing or is involved in infringing activity and needs to be removed or had access to it disabled, along with enough information to allow the service provider to find the material.

(iv) Information reasonably sufficient to permit the service provider to contact the complaining party, such as an address, telephone number, and, if available, an electronic mail address at which the complaining party may be contacted.

(iv) Information that's enough to allow the service provider to reach out to the person making the complaint, like an address, phone number, and, if available, an email address where the complaining party can be contacted.

(v) A statement that the complaining party has a good faith belief that use of the material in the manner complained of is not authorized by the copyright owner, its agent, or the law.

(v) A statement that the complaining party genuinely believes that using the material in the way that has been complained about is not permitted by the copyright owner, their agent, or the law.

(vi) A statement that the information in the notification is accurate, and under penalty of perjury, that the complaining party is authorized to act on behalf of the owner of an exclusive right that is allegedly infringed.

(vi) A statement that the information in the notification is true, and under penalty of perjury, that the complaining party is authorized to act on behalf of the owner of an exclusive right that is supposedly infringed.

(B)(i) Subject to clause (ii), a notification from a copyright owner or from a person authorized to act on behalf of the copyright owner that fails to comply substantially with the provisions of subparagraph (A) shall not be considered under paragraph (1)(A) in determining whether a service provider has actual knowledge or is aware of facts or circumstances from which infringing activity is apparent.

(B)(i) As long as clause (ii) is followed, a notification from a copyright owner or someone authorized to act for the copyright owner that doesn’t significantly meet the requirements of subparagraph (A) won’t be taken into account under paragraph (1)(A) when deciding if a service provider has actual knowledge or is aware of facts or situations that show infringing activity.

(ii) In a case in which the notification that is provided to the service provider's designated agent fails to comply substantially with all the provisions of subparagraph (A) but substantially complies with clauses (ii), (iii), and (iv) of subparagraph (A), clause (i) of this subparagraph applies only if the service provider promptly attempts to contact the person making the notification or takes other reasonable steps to assist in the receipt of notification that substantially complies with all the provisions of subparagraph (A).

(ii) If the notification given to the service provider's designated agent doesn't fully meet all the requirements of subparagraph (A) but does meet clauses (ii), (iii), and (iv) of subparagraph (A), then clause (i) of this subparagraph will only apply if the service provider quickly tries to contact the person who made the notification or takes other reasonable actions to help ensure that the notification fully complies with all the requirements of subparagraph (A).

(d) Information Location Tools. A service provider shall not be liable for monetary relief, or, except as provided in subsection (j), for injunctive or other equitable relief, for infringement of copyright by reason of the provider referring or linking users to an online location containing infringing material or infringing activity, by using information location tools, including a directory, index, reference, pointer, or hypertext link, if the service provider-

(d) Information Location Tools. A service provider won't be held responsible for monetary damages, or, except as outlined in subsection (j), for injunctive or other equitable remedies, for copyright infringement just because the provider has referred or linked users to an online site that has infringing content or activities, by using information location tools, such as a directory, index, reference, pointer, or hypertext link, if the service provider-

(1)(A) does not have actual knowledge that the material or activity is infringing;

(1)(A) does not know for sure that the material or activity is infringing;

(B) in the absence of such actual knowledge, is not aware of facts or circumstances from which infringing activity is apparent; or

(B) if there’s no actual knowledge, is not aware of any facts or situations that would make infringing activity obvious; or

(C) upon obtaining such knowledge or awareness, acts expeditiously to remove, or disable access to, the material;

(C) as soon as they become aware of such knowledge or information, they quickly take action to remove or disable access to the material;

(2) does not receive a financial benefit directly attributable to the infringing activity, in a case in which the service provider has the right and ability to control such activity; and

(2) does not receive a financial benefit directly related to the infringing activity, in a situation where the service provider has the right and ability to control that activity; and

(3) upon notification of claimed infringement as described in subsection (c)(3), responds expeditiously to remove, or disable access to, the material that is claimed to be infringing or to be the subject of infringing activity, except that, for purposes of this paragraph, the information described in subsection (c)(3)(A)(iii) shall be identification of the reference or link, to material or activity claimed to be infringing, that is to be removed or access to which is to be disabled, and information reasonably sufficient to permit the service provider to locate that reference or link.

(3) upon being notified of a claimed infringement as outlined in subsection (c)(3), responds quickly to remove or disable access to the material that is said to be infringing or involved in infringing activity. For this paragraph, the information mentioned in subsection (c)(3)(A)(iii) should include the identification of the reference or link to the material or activity claimed to be infringing that needs to be removed or have access disabled, along with enough details to help the service provider find that reference or link.

(e) Limitation on Liability of Nonprofit Educational Institutions. (1) When a public or other nonprofit institution of higher education is a service provider, and when a faculty member or graduate student who is an employee of such institution is performing a teaching or research function, for the purposes of subsections (a) and (b) such faculty member or graduate student shall be considered to be a person other than the institution, and for the purposes of subsections (c) and (d) such faculty member's or graduate student's knowledge or awareness of his or her infringing activities shall not be attributed to the institution, if-

(e) Limitation on Liability of Nonprofit Educational Institutions. (1) When a public or other nonprofit institution of higher education provides services, and when a faculty member or graduate student who works for that institution is involved in teaching or research, for the purposes of subsections (a) and (b) that faculty member or graduate student will be seen as separate from the institution. Additionally, for the purposes of subsections (c) and (d), any knowledge or awareness that the faculty member or graduate student has regarding their infringing activities will not be considered knowledge of the institution, if-

(A) such faculty member's or graduate student's infringing activities do not involve the provision of online access to instructional materials that are or were required or recommended, within the preceding 3-year period, for a course taught at the institution by such faculty member or graduate student;

(A) Activities by a faculty member or graduate student that violate this policy do not include providing online access to instructional materials that were required or recommended for a course taught by that faculty member or graduate student within the last 3 years;

(B) the institution has not, within the preceding 3-year period, received more than 2 notifications described in subsection (c)(3) of claimed infringement by such faculty member or graduate student, and such notifications of claimed infringement were not actionable under subsection (f); and

(B) the institution has not received more than 2 notifications in the last 3 years as described in subsection (c)(3) about claimed infringement by that faculty member or graduate student, and those notifications of claimed infringement were not actionable under subsection (f); and

(C) the institution provides to all users of its system or network informational materials that accurately describe, and promote compliance with, the laws of the United States relating to copyright.

(C) the institution provides all users of its system or network informational materials that accurately describe and promote compliance with the copyright laws of the United States.

(2) For the purposes of this subsection, the limitations on injunctive relief contained in subsections (j)(2) and (j)(3), but not those in (j) (1), shall apply.

(2) For this subsection, the restrictions on injunctive relief found in subsections (j)(2) and (j)(3), but not those in (j)(1), will apply.

(f) Misrepresentations. Any person who knowingly materially misrepresents under this section-

(f) Misrepresentations. Any person who knowingly makes a significant misrepresentation under this section—

(1) that material or activity is infringing, or

(1) that the material or activity is infringing, or

(2) that material or activity was removed or disabled by mistake or misidentification,

(2) that the material or activity was removed or disabled by accident or misidentification,

shall be liable for any damages, including costs and attorneys' fees, incurred by the alleged infringer, by any copyright owner or copyright owner's authorized licensee, or by a service provider, who is injured by such misrepresentation, as the result of the service provider relying upon such misrepresentation in removing or disabling access to the material or activity claimed to be infringing, or in replacing the removed material or ceasing to disable access to it.

shall be responsible for any damages, including costs and attorney’s fees, incurred by the alleged infringer, by any copyright owner or authorized licensee of the copyright owner, or by a service provider, who is harmed by such misrepresentation, as a result of the service provider relying on that misrepresentation in removing or disabling access to the material or activity claimed to be infringing, or in replacing the removed material or stopping the disabling of access to it.

(g) Replacement of Removed or Disabled Material and Limitation on Other Liability.

(g) Replacement of Removed or Disabled Material and Limitation on Other Liability.

(1) No Liability for Taking Down Generally. Subject to paragraph (2), a service provider shall not be liable to any person for any claim based on the service provider's good faith disabling of access to, or removal of, material or activity claimed to be infringing or based on facts or circumstances from which infringing activity is apparent, regardless of whether the material or activity is ultimately determined to be infringing.

(1) No Liability for Taking Down Generally. Subject to paragraph (2), a service provider won’t be held responsible to anyone for any claim related to the service provider’s genuine efforts to disable access to or remove material or activities that are claimed to be infringing, or based on facts or circumstances that clearly indicate infringing activity, even if it’s later determined that the material or activity wasn’t actually infringing.

(2) Exception. Paragraph (1) shall not apply with respect to material residing at the direction of a subscriber of the service provider on a system or network controlled or operated by or for the service provider that is removed, or to which access is disabled by the service provider, pursuant to a notice provided under subsection (c)(1)(C), unless the service provider-

(2) Exception. Paragraph (1) does not apply to material located at the request of a subscriber of the service provider on a system or network controlled or managed by or for the service provider that is taken down, or to which access is blocked by the service provider, following a notice provided under subsection (c)(1)(C), unless the service provider-

(A) takes reasonable steps promptly to notify the subscriber that it has removed or disabled access to the material;

(A) takes appropriate actions quickly to inform the subscriber that it has removed or disabled access to the content;

(B) upon receipt of a counter notification described in paragraph (3), promptly provides the person who provided the notification under subsection (c)(1)(C) with a copy of the counter notification, and informs that person that it will re-place the removed material or cease disabling access to it in 10 business days; and

(B) after receiving a counter notification mentioned in paragraph (3), quickly gives the person who sent the notification under subsection (c)(1)(C) a copy of the counter notification and lets that person know that it will restore the removed material or stop blocking access to it in 10 business days; and

(C) replaces the removed material and ceases disabling access to it not less than 10, nor more than 14, business days following receipt of the counter notice, unless its designated agent first receives notice from the person who submitted the notification under subsection (c)(1)(C) that such person has filed an action seeking a court order to restrain the subscriber from engaging in infringing activity relating to the material on the service provider's system or network.

(C) replaces the removed material and stops blocking access to it no less than 10 and no more than 14 business days after receiving the counter notice, unless its designated agent gets a notice from the person who submitted the notification under subsection (c)(1)(C) that this person has filed a lawsuit seeking a court order to stop the subscriber from engaging in infringing activity related to the material on the service provider's system or network.

(3) Contents of Counter Notification. To be effective under this subsection, a counter notification must be a written communication provided to the service provider's designated agent that includes substantially the following:

(3) Contents of Counter Notification. To be effective under this subsection, a counter notification must be a written communication sent to the service provider's designated agent that includes basically the following:

(A) A physical or electronic signature of the subscriber.

(A) A signature, either physical or electronic, from the subscriber.

(B) Identification of the material that has been removed or to which access has been disabled and the location at which the material appeared before it was removed or access to it was disabled.

(B) Identification of the material that has been removed or access to which has been restricted, along with the location where the material was displayed before it was removed or access was restricted.

(C) A statement under penalty of perjury that the subscriber has a good faith belief that the material was removed or disabled as a result of mistake or misidentification of the material to be removed or disabled.

(C) A statement made under penalty of perjury that the subscriber honestly believes that the material was removed or disabled due to a mistake or misidentification of the material intended to be removed or disabled.

(D) The subscriber's name, address, and telephone number, and a statement that the subscriber consents to the jurisdiction of Federal District Court for the judicial district in which the address is located, or if the subscriber's address is outside of the United States, for any judicial district in which the service provider may be found, and that the subscriber will accept service of process from the person who provided notification under subsection (c)(1)(C) or an agent of such person.

(D) The subscriber's name, address, and phone number, along with a statement confirming that the subscriber agrees to the jurisdiction of the Federal District Court for the judicial district where the address is located, or if the subscriber's address is outside the United States, for any judicial district where the service provider can be found, and that the subscriber will accept legal documents from the person who provided notification under subsection (c)(1)(C) or an agent of that person.

(4) Limitation on Other Liability. A service provider's compliance with paragraph (2) shall not subject the service provider to liability for copyright infringement with respect to the material identified in the notice provided under subsection (c)(1)(C).

(4) Limitation on Other Liability. A service provider's compliance with paragraph (2) will not make the service provider liable for copyright infringement concerning the material mentioned in the notice given under subsection (c)(1)(C).

(h) Subpoena to Identify Infringer.

(h) Subpoena to Identify Offender.

(1) Request. A copyright owner or a person authorized to act on the owner's behalf may request the clerk of any United States district court to issue a subpoena to a service provider for identification of an alleged infringer in accordance with this subsection.

(1) Request. A copyright owner or someone authorized to act on the owner's behalf can ask the clerk of any United States district court to issue a subpoena to a service provider for the identification of an alleged infringer according to this subsection.

(2) Contents of Request. The request may be made by filing with the clerk-

(2) Contents of Request. The request can be submitted by filing with the clerk-

(A) a copy of a notification described in subsection (c)(3)(A);

(A) a copy of a notice mentioned in subsection (c)(3)(A);

(B) a proposed subpoena; and

(B) a proposed subpoena; and

(C) a sworn declaration to the effect that the purpose for which the subpoena is sought is to obtain the identity of an alleged infringer and that such information will only be used for the purpose of protecting rights under this title.

(C) a sworn statement confirming that the reason for the subpoena is to find out the identity of a person accused of infringement and that this information will only be used to protect rights under this title.

(3) Contents of Subpoena. The subpoena shall authorize and order the service provider receiving the notification and the subpoena to expeditiously disclose to the copyright owner or person authorized by the copyright owner information sufficient to identify the alleged infringer of the material described in the notification to the extent such information is available to the service provider.

(3) Contents of Subpoena. The subpoena will permit and require the service provider that receives the notification and the subpoena to promptly disclose to the copyright owner or a person authorized by the copyright owner information that is enough to identify the alleged infringer of the material mentioned in the notification, as long as that information is available to the service provider.

(4) Basis for Granting Subpoena. If the notification filed satisfies the provisions of subsection (c)(3)(A), the proposed subpoena is in proper form, and the accompanying declaration is properly executed, the clerk shall expeditiously issue and sign the proposed subpoena and return it to the requester for delivery to the service provider.

(4) Basis for Granting Subpoena. If the notification filed meets the requirements of subsection (c)(3)(A), the proposed subpoena is properly formatted, and the accompanying declaration is correctly filled out, the clerk will quickly issue and sign the proposed subpoena and return it to the requester for delivery to the service provider.

(5) Actions of Service Provider Receiving Subpoena. Upon receipt of the issued subpoena, either accompanying or subsequent to the receipt of a notification described in subsection (c)(3)(A), the service provider shall expeditiously disclose to the copyright owner or person authorized by the copyright owner the information required by the subpoena, notwithstanding any other provision of law and regardless of whether the service provider responds to the notification.

(5) Actions of Service Provider Receiving Subpoena. When the service provider gets the issued subpoena, either along with or after receiving the notification mentioned in subsection (c)(3)(A), the service provider must quickly share the information requested in the subpoena with the copyright owner or someone authorized by the copyright owner, regardless of any other laws or whether the service provider replies to the notification.

(6) Rules Applicable to Subpoena. Unless otherwise provided by this section or by applicable rules of the court, the procedure for issuance and delivery of the subpoena, and the remedies for noncompliance with the subpoena, shall be governed to the greatest extent practicable by those provisions of the Federal Rules of Civil Procedure governing the issuance, service, and enforcement of a subpoena duces tecum.

(6) Rules Applicable to Subpoena. Unless stated otherwise in this section or by the court's rules, the process for issuing and delivering the subpoena, as well as the remedies for failing to comply with it, will be largely governed by the relevant parts of the Federal Rules of Civil Procedure that deal with issuing, serving, and enforcing a subpoena duces tecum.

(i) Conditions for Eligibility.

Eligibility Criteria.

(1) Accommodation of Technology. The limitations on liability established by this section shall apply to a service provider only if the service provider-

(1) Accommodation of Technology. The limits on liability set by this section apply to a service provider only if the service provider-

(A) has adopted and reasonably implemented, and informs subscribers and account holders of the service provider's system or network of, a policy that provides for the termination in appropriate circumstances of subscribers and account holders of the service provider's system or network who are repeat infringers; and

(A) has adopted and reasonably implemented, and informs subscribers and account holders of the service provider's system or network about, a policy that allows for the termination in appropriate situations of subscribers and account holders of the service provider's system or network who are repeat infringers; and

(B) accommodates and does not interfere with standard technical measures.

(B) accommodates and doesn’t interfere with standard technical measures.

(2) Definition. As used in this subsection, the term "standard technical measures" means technical measures that are used by copyright owners to identify or protect copyrighted works and-

(2) Definition. In this section, the term "standard technical measures" refers to technical methods that copyright owners use to identify or safeguard copyrighted works and-

(A) have been developed pursuant to a broad consensus of copyright owners and service providers in an open, fair, voluntary, multi-industry standards process;

(A) have been developed based on a wide agreement among copyright owners and service providers in an open, fair, voluntary, multi-industry standards process;

(B) are available to any person on reasonable and nondiscriminatory terms; and

(B) are available to anyone on fair and nondiscriminatory terms; and

(C) do not impose substantial costs on service providers or substantial burdens on their systems or networks.

(C) do not impose significant costs on service providers or major burdens on their systems or networks.

(j) Injunctions. The following rules shall apply in the case of any application for an injunction under section 502 against a service provider that is not subject to monetary remedies under this section:

(j) Injunctions. The following rules will apply for any application for an injunction under section 502 against a service provider that is not subject to monetary remedies under this section:

(1) Scope of Relief. (A) With respect to conduct other than that which qualifies for the limitation on remedies set forth in subsection (a), the court may grant injunctive relief with respect to a service provider only in one or more of the following forms:

(1) Scope of Relief. (A) Regarding conduct that doesn't fall under the limitations on remedies described in subsection (a), the court may provide injunctive relief concerning a service provider only in one or more of the following ways:

(i) An order restraining the service provider from providing access to infringing material or activity residing at a particular online site on the provider's system or network.

(i) An order that stops the service provider from allowing access to infringing material or activities located at a specific online site on the provider's system or network.

(ii) An order restraining the service provider from providing access to a subscriber or account holder of the service provider's system or network who is engaging in infringing activity and is identified in the order, by terminating the accounts of the subscriber or account holder that are specified in the order.

(ii) A court order stopping the service provider from giving access to a subscriber or account holder of the service provider's system or network who is involved in infringing activities and is mentioned in the order, by shutting down the accounts of the subscriber or account holder that are listed in the order.

(iii) Such other injunctive relief as the court may consider necessary to prevent or restrain infringement of copyrighted material specified in the order of the court at a particular online location, if such relief is the least burdensome to the service provider among the forms of relief comparably effective for that purpose.

(iii) Any other court-ordered injunctions that the court finds necessary to stop or limit the infringement of copyrighted material mentioned in the court's order at a specific online location, as long as this relief is the least burdensome option for the service provider compared to similarly effective alternatives.

(B) If the service provider qualifies for the limitation on remedies described in subsection (a), the court may only grant injunctive relief in one or both of the following forms:

(B) If the service provider meets the criteria for the limitation on remedies outlined in subsection (a), the court may only issue injunctive relief in one or both of the following ways:

(i) An order restraining the service provider from providing access to a subscriber or account holder of the service provider's system or network who is using the provider's service to engage in infringing activity and is identified in the order, by terminating the accounts of the subscriber or account holder that are specified in the order.

(i) A court order blocking the service provider from giving access to a subscriber or account holder of the provider's system or network who is using the service to engage in infringing activity, as identified in the order, by terminating the accounts of the subscriber or account holder specified in the order.

(ii) An order restraining the service provider from providing access, by taking reasonable steps specified in the order to block access, to a specific, identified, online location outside the United States.

(ii) A court order preventing the service provider from allowing access, by taking the reasonable steps outlined in the order to block access, to a specific, identified online location outside the United States.

(2) Considerations. The court, in considering the relevant criteria for injunctive relief under applicable law, shall consider-

(2) Considerations. The court, while evaluating the relevant criteria for injunctive relief under the applicable law, will take into account-

(A) whether such an injunction, either alone or in combination with other such injunctions issued against the same service provider under this subsection, would significantly burden either the provider or the operation of the provider's system or network;

(A) whether such an injunction, either by itself or together with other similar injunctions issued against the same service provider under this subsection, would significantly burden either the provider or the operation of the provider's system or network;

(B) the magnitude of the harm likely to be suffered by the copyright owner in the digital network environment if steps are not taken to prevent or restrain the infringement;

(B) the extent of the damage that the copyright owner will probably experience in the digital network environment if actions are not taken to stop or limit the infringement;

(C) whether implementation of such an injunction would be technically feasible and effective, and would not interfere with access to noninfringing material at other online locations; and

(C) whether carrying out such an injunction would be technically doable and effective, and would not block access to non-infringing material on other online sites; and

(D) whether other less burdensome and comparably effective means of preventing or restraining access to the infringing material are available.

(D) whether there are other less burdensome and equally effective ways to prevent or limit access to the infringing material.

(3) Notice and Ex Parte Orders. Injunctive relief under this subsection shall be available only after notice to the service provider and an opportunity for the service provider to appear are provided, except for orders ensuring the preservation of evidence or other orders having no material adverse effect on the operation of the service provider's communications network.

(3) Notice and Ex Parte Orders. Injunctive relief under this subsection will only be available after the service provider has been notified and given a chance to respond, except for orders that ensure evidence is preserved or other orders that won't significantly impact the service provider's communications network operations.

(k) Definitions.

(k) Definitions.

(1) Service Provider. (A) As used in subsection (a), the term "service provider" means an entity offering the transmission, routing, or providing of connections for digital online communications, between or among points specified by a user, of material of the user's choosing, without modification to the content of the material as sent or received.

(1) Service Provider. (A) In subsection (a), the term "service provider" refers to a company that offers the transmission, routing, or connection services for digital online communications, between or among locations specified by a user, for material of the user's choice, without altering the content of the material as it is sent or received.

(B) As used in this section, other than subsection (a), the term "service provider" means a provider of online services or network access, or the operator of facilities therefor, and includes an entity described in subparagraph (A).

(B) In this section, excluding subsection (a), the term "service provider" refers to someone who offers online services or network access, or runs the facilities for them, and includes an entity mentioned in subparagraph (A).

(2) Monetary Relief. As used in this section, the term "monetary relief" means damages, costs, attorneys' fees, and any other form of monetary payment.

(2) Monetary Relief. As used in this section, the term "monetary relief" means damages, costs, attorney's fees, and any other type of monetary payment.

(l) Other Defenses Not Affected. The failure of a service provider's conduct to qualify for limitation of liability under this section shall not bear adversely upon the consideration of a defense by the service provider that the service provider's conduct is not infringing under this title or any other defense.

(l) Other Defenses Not Affected. The fact that a service provider's actions don't meet the criteria for limiting liability under this section won't negatively affect the service provider's ability to argue that their actions aren't infringing under this title or any other defense.

(m) Protection of Privacy. Nothing in this section shall be construed to condition the applicability of subsections (a) through (d) on-

(m) Protection of Privacy. Nothing in this section should be interpreted as making the applicability of subsections (a) through (d) dependent on-

(1) a service provider monitoring its service or affirmatively seeking facts indicating infringing activity, except to the extent consistent with a standard technical measure complying with the provisions of subsection (i); or

(1) a service provider keeping an eye on its service or actively looking for signs of infringing activity, unless it's in line with a standard technical measure that meets the requirements of subsection (i); or

(2) a service provider gaining access to, removing, or disabling access to material in cases in which such conduct is prohibited by law.

(2) a service provider getting access to, removing, or shutting off access to material in situations where such actions are against the law.

(n) Construction. Subsections (a), (b), (c), and (d) describe separate and distinct functions for purposes of applying this section. Whether a service provider qualifies for the limitation on liability in any one of those subsections shall be based solely on the criteria in that subsection, and shall not affect a determination of whether that service provider qualifies for the limitations on liability under any other such subsection.

(n) Construction. Subsections (a), (b), (c), and (d) outline different functions for the purpose of applying this section. A service provider's eligibility for the liability limitation in any of those subsections will be determined only by the criteria in that subsection and will not impact whether that service provider meets the eligibility for liability limitations under any other subsection.

Section 513. Determination of reasonable license fees for individual proprietors [10]

In the case of any performing rights society subject to a consent decree which provides for the determination of reasonable license rates or fees to be charged by the performing rights society, notwithstanding the provisions of that consent decree, an individual proprietor who owns or operates fewer than 7 non-publicly traded establishments in which nondramatic musical works are performed publicly and who claims that any license agreement offered by that performing rights society is unreasonable in its license rate or fee as to that individual proprietor, shall be entitled to determination of a reasonable license rate or fee as follows:

In the case of any performing rights organization that falls under a consent decree which sets reasonable license rates or fees to be charged, an individual owner who operates fewer than 7 privately-owned establishments where nondramatic musical works are performed publicly and believes that any license agreement offered by that organization is unreasonable in terms of its license rate or fee, is entitled to have a reasonable license rate or fee determined as follows:

(1) The individual proprietor may commence such proceeding for determination of a reasonable license rate or fee by filing an application in the applicable district court under paragraph (2) that a rate disagreement exists and by serving a copy of the application on the performing rights society. Such proceeding shall commence in the applicable district court within 90 days after the service of such copy, except that such 90-day requirement shall be subject to the administrative requirements of the court.

(1) The individual owner can start the process to determine a reasonable license rate or fee by filing an application in the appropriate district court under paragraph (2) stating that there is a disagreement over the rate, and by providing a copy of the application to the performing rights organization. This process should start in the appropriate district court within 90 days after serving the copy, except that the 90-day requirement will be subject to the court’s administrative rules.

(2) The proceeding under paragraph (1) shall be held, at the individual proprietor's election, in the judicial district of the district court with jurisdiction over the applicable consent decree or in that place of holding court of a district court that is the seat of the Federal circuit (other than the Court of Appeals for the Federal Circuit) in which the proprietor's establishment is located.

(2) The proceeding mentioned in paragraph (1) will take place, at the owner's choice, in the judicial district of the district court that has authority over the relevant consent decree or in the court location of a district court that is the seat of the Federal circuit (other than the Court of Appeals for the Federal Circuit) where the owner's establishment is located.

(3) Such proceeding shall be held before the judge of the court with jurisdiction over the consent decree governing the performing rights society. At the discretion of the court, the proceeding shall be held before a special master or magistrate judge appointed by such judge. Should that consent decree provide for the appointment of an advisor or advisors to the court for any purpose, any such advisor shall be the special master so named by the court.

(3) The proceedings will take place before the judge of the court that has authority over the consent decree related to the performing rights society. The court may decide to hold the proceedings before a special master or magistrate judge appointed by that judge. If the consent decree allows for the appointment of an advisor or advisors to the court for any reason, those advisors will be the special master designated by the court.

(4) In any such proceeding, the industry rate shall be presumed to have been reasonable at the time it was agreed to or determined by the court. Such presumption shall in no way affect a determination of whether the rate is being correctly applied to the individual proprietor.

(4) In any such proceeding, the industry rate will be assumed to have been reasonable when it was agreed upon or decided by the court. This assumption will not influence whether the rate is being accurately applied to the individual owner.

(5) Pending the completion of such proceeding, the individual proprietor shall have the right to perform publicly the copyrighted musical compositions in the repertoire of the performing rights society by paying an interim license rate or fee into an interest bearing escrow account with the clerk of the court, subject to retroactive adjustment when a final rate or fee has been determined, in an amount equal to the industry rate, or, in the absence of an industry rate, the amount of the most recent license rate or fee agreed to by the parties.

(5) While waiting for the completion of this process, the individual owner has the right to publicly perform the copyrighted musical compositions in the repertoire of the performing rights society by paying a temporary license fee into an interest-bearing escrow account with the court clerk. This is subject to retroactive adjustments once a final rate or fee has been decided, equal to the industry rate, or if there isn't an industry rate, the amount of the most recent license rate or fee agreed upon by the parties.

(6) Any decision rendered in such proceeding by a special master or magistrate judge named under paragraph (3) shall be reviewed by the judge of the court with jurisdiction over the consent decree governing the performing rights society. Such proceeding, including such review, shall be concluded within 6 months after its commencement.

(6) Any decision made in that proceeding by a special master or magistrate judge appointed under paragraph (3) will be reviewed by the judge of the court that has authority over the consent decree involving the performing rights society. That proceeding, including the review, must be completed within 6 months of starting.

(7) Any such final determination shall be binding only as to the individual proprietor commencing the proceeding, and shall not be applicable to any other proprietor or any other performing rights society, and the performing rights society shall be relieved of any obligation of nondiscrimination among similarly situated music users that may be imposed by the consent decree governing its operations.

(7) Any final decision made will only be binding on the individual owner who started the process and will not apply to any other owner or any other performing rights organization. Additionally, the performing rights organization will be released from any obligation to treat similar music users equally as may be required by the consent decree regulating its operations.

(8) An individual proprietor may not bring more than one proceeding provided for in this section for the determination of a reasonable license rate or fee under any license agreement with respect to any one performing rights society.

(8) An individual owner may not initiate more than one proceeding outlined in this section to determine a reasonable license rate or fee under any licensing agreement with any one performing rights organization.

(9) For purposes of this section, the term "industry rate" means the license fee a performing rights society has agreed to with, or which has been determined by the court for, a significant segment of the music user industry to which the individual proprietor belongs.

(9) In this section, "industry rate" refers to the license fee that a performing rights organization has agreed upon with, or that a court has determined for, a significant part of the music user industry that the individual owner is part of.

————————— Chapter 5 Endnotes

Chapter 5 References

1 Concerning the liability of the United States Government for copyright infringement, see 28 U.S.C. 1498. Title 28 of the *United States Code* is entitled "Judiciary and Judicial Procedure."

1 Regarding the United States Government's liability for copyright infringement, see 28 U.S.C. 1498. Title 28 of the *United States Code* is titled "Judiciary and Judicial Procedure."

2 In 1998, two sections 512 were enacted into law. On October 17, 1998, the Fairness in Music Licensing Act of 1998 was enacted. This Act amended chapter five to add section 512 entitled "Determination of reasonable license fees for individual proprietors." Pub. L. No. 105-298, 112 Stat. 2827, 2831. On October 28, 1998, the Online Copyright Infringement Liability Limitation Act was enacted. This Act amended chapter five to add section 512 entitled "Limitations on liability relating to material online." Pub. L. No. 105-304, 112 Stat. 2860, 2877. In 1999, a technical correction was enacted to redesignate the section 512 that was entitled "Determination of reasonable license fees for individual proprietors" as section 513. Also, the table of sections was amended to reflect that change. Pub. L. No. 106-44, 113 Stat. 221. See also endnote 10*, infra.*

2 In 1998, two sections 512 were put into law. On October 17, 1998, the Fairness in Music Licensing Act of 1998 was passed. This Act changed chapter five to add section 512 called "Determination of reasonable license fees for individual proprietors." Pub. L. No. 105-298, 112 Stat. 2827, 2831. On October 28, 1998, the Online Copyright Infringement Liability Limitation Act was passed. This Act changed chapter five to add section 512 called "Limitations on liability relating to material online." Pub. L. No. 105-304, 112 Stat. 2860, 2877. In 1999, a technical correction was made to change the title of section 512 called "Determination of reasonable license fees for individual proprietors" to section 513. Also, the table of sections was updated to reflect that change. Pub. L. No. 106-44, 113 Stat. 221. See also endnote 10*, infra.*

3 The Berne Convention Implementation Act of 1988 amended section 501(b) by striking out "sections 205(d) and 411" and inserting in lieu thereof "section 411." Pub. L. No. 100-568, 102 Stat. 2853, 2860. The Satellite Home Viewer Act of 1988 amended section 501 by adding subsection (e). Pub. L. No. 100-667, 102 Stat. 3935, 3957.

3 The Berne Convention Implementation Act of 1988 changed section 501(b) by removing "sections 205(d) and 411" and replacing it with "section 411." Pub. L. No. 100-568, 102 Stat. 2853, 2860. The Satellite Home Viewer Act of 1988 updated section 501 by adding subsection (e). Pub. L. No. 100-667, 102 Stat. 3935, 3957.

In 1990, the Copyright Remedy Clarification Act amended section 501(a) by adding the last two sentences. Pub. L. No. 101-553, 104 Stat. 2749. The Visual Artists Rights Act of 1990 also amended section 501(a) as follows: 1) by inserting "or of the author as provided in section 106A(a)" after "118" and 2) by striking out "copyright." and inserting in lieu thereof "copyright or right of the author, as the case may be. For purposes of this chapter (other than section 506), any reference to copyright shall be deemed to include the rights conferred by section 106A(a)." Pub. L. No. 101-650, 104 Stat. 5089, 5131.

In 1990, the Copyright Remedy Clarification Act changed section 501(a) by adding the last two sentences. Pub. L. No. 101-553, 104 Stat. 2749. The Visual Artists Rights Act of 1990 also modified section 501(a) in two ways: 1) by adding "or of the author as provided in section 106A(a)" after "118" and 2) by removing "copyright." and replacing it with "copyright or right of the author, as the case may be. For the purposes of this chapter (except for section 506), any mention of copyright will include the rights given by section 106A(a)." Pub. L. No. 101-650, 104 Stat. 5089, 5131.

In 1999, a technical correction amended the first sentence in subsection 501(a) by inserting "121" in lieu of "118." Pub. L. No. 106-44, 113 Stat. 221, 222. The Satellite Home Viewer Improvement Act of 1999 amended section 501 by adding a subsection (f) and, in subsection (e), by inserting "performance or display of a work embodied in a primary transmission" in lieu of "primary transmission embodying the performance or display of a work." Pub. L. No. 106-113, 113 Stat. 1501, app. I at 1501A-527 and 544. The Satellite Home Viewer Improvement Act of 1999 states that section 501(f) shall be effective as of July 1, 1999. Pub. L. No. 106-113, 113 Stat. 1501, app. I at 1501A-544.

In 1999, a technical correction changed the first sentence in subsection 501(a) by replacing "118" with "121." Pub. L. No. 106-44, 113 Stat. 221, 222. The Satellite Home Viewer Improvement Act of 1999 updated section 501 by adding a new subsection (f) and, in subsection (e), by changing "primary transmission embodying the performance or display of a work" to "performance or display of a work embodied in a primary transmission." Pub. L. No. 106-113, 113 Stat. 1501, app. I at 1501A-527 and 544. The Satellite Home Viewer Improvement Act of 1999 specifies that section 501(f) will be effective starting July 1, 1999. Pub. L. No. 106-113, 113 Stat. 1501, app. I at 1501A-544.

4 The Berne Convention Implementation Act of 1988 amended section 504(c) as follows: 1) in paragraph (1), by inserting "$500" in lieu of "$250" and by inserting "$20,000" in lieu of "$10,000" and 2) in paragraph (2), by inserting "$100,000" in lieu of "$50,000" and by inserting "$200" in lieu of "$100." Pub. L. No. 100-568, 102 Stat. 2853, 2860. The Digital Theft Deterrence and Copyright Damages Improvement Act of 1999 amended section 504(c), in paragraph (1), by substituting "$750" for "$500" and "$30,000" for "$20,000" and, in paragraph (2), by substituting "$150,000" for "$100,000." Pub. L. No. 106-160, 113 Stat. 1774.

4 The Berne Convention Implementation Act of 1988 changed section 504(c) as follows: 1) in paragraph (1), by replacing "$250" with "$500" and "$10,000" with "$20,000" and 2) in paragraph (2), by replacing "$50,000" with "$100,000" and "$100" with "$200." Pub. L. No. 100-568, 102 Stat. 2853, 2860. The Digital Theft Deterrence and Copyright Damages Improvement Act of 1999 updated section 504(c), in paragraph (1), by changing "$500" to "$750" and "$20,000" to "$30,000," and in paragraph (2), by changing "$100,000" to "$150,000." Pub. L. No. 106-160, 113 Stat. 1774.

5 The Piracy and Counterfeiting Amendments Act of 1982 amended section 506 by substituting a new subsection(a). Pub. L. No. 97-180, 96 Stat. 91, 93. The Visual Artists Rights Act of 1990 amended section 506 by adding subsection (f). Pub. L. No.101-650, 104 Stat. 5089, 5131. In 1997, the No Electronic Theft (NET) Act again amended section 506 by amending subsection (a) in its entirety. Pub. L. No. 105-147, 111 Stat. 2678. That Act also directed the United States Sentencing Commission to "ensure that the applicable guideline range for a defendant convicted of a crime against intellectual property . . . is sufficiently stringent to deter such a crime" and to "ensure that the guidelines provide for consideration of the retail value and quantity of the items with respect to which the crime against intellectual property was committed." Pub. L. No. 105-147, 111 Stat. 2678, 2680. See also endnote 2 in Part VII of the Appendix.

5 The Piracy and Counterfeiting Amendments Act of 1982 updated section 506 by replacing it with a new subsection (a). Pub. L. No. 97-180, 96 Stat. 91, 93. The Visual Artists Rights Act of 1990 amended section 506 by adding subsection (f). Pub. L. No. 101-650, 104 Stat. 5089, 5131. In 1997, the No Electronic Theft (NET) Act further amended section 506 by completely revising subsection (a). Pub. L. No. 105-147, 111 Stat. 2678. That Act also instructed the United States Sentencing Commission to "make sure that the guideline range for someone convicted of a crime against intellectual property... is strict enough to deter such a crime" and to "ensure that the guidelines take into account the retail value and quantity of the items involved in the intellectual property crime." Pub. L. No. 105-147, 111 Stat. 2678, 2680. See also endnote 2 in Part VII of the Appendix.

6 In 1997, the No Electronic Theft (NET) Act amended section 507(a) by inserting "5" in lieu of "three." Pub. L. No. 105-147, 111 Stat. 2678.

6 In 1997, the No Electronic Theft (NET) Act changed section 507(a) by replacing "three" with "5." Pub. L. No. 105-147, 111 Stat. 2678.

7 The Satellite Home Viewer Improvement Act of 1999 amended the heading for section 510 by substituting "programming" for "programing" and, in subsection (b), by substituting "statutory" for "compulsory." Pub. L. No. 106-113, 113 Stat. 1501, app. I at 1501A-543.

7 The Satellite Home Viewer Improvement Act of 1999 changed the heading for section 510 by replacing "programing" with "programming" and, in subsection (b), by changing "compulsory" to "statutory." Pub. L. No. 106-113, 113 Stat. 1501, app. I at 1501A-543.

8 In 1990, the Copyright Remedy Clarification Act added section 511. Pub. L. No. 101-553, 104 Stat. 2749. In 1999, a technical correction amended subsection 511(a) by inserting "121" in lieu of "119." Pub. L. No. 106-44, 113 Stat. 221, 222.

8 In 1990, the Copyright Remedy Clarification Act added section 511. Pub. L. No. 101-553, 104 Stat. 2749. In 1999, a technical correction updated subsection 511(a) by replacing "119" with "121." Pub. L. No. 106-44, 113 Stat. 221, 222.

9 In 1998, the Online Copyright Infringement Liability Limitation Act added section 512. Pub. L. No. 105-304, 112 Stat. 2860, 2877. In 1999, a technical correction deleted the heading for paragraph (2) of section 512(e), which was "Injunctions." Pub. L. No. 106-44, 113 Stat. 221, 222.

9 In 1998, the Online Copyright Infringement Liability Limitation Act added section 512. Pub. L. No. 105-304, 112 Stat. 2860, 2877. In 1999, a technical correction removed the heading for paragraph (2) of section 512(e), which was "Injunctions." Pub. L. No. 106-44, 113 Stat. 221, 222.

10 The Fairness in Music Licensing Act of 1998 added section 513. Pub. L. No. 105-298, 112 Stat. 2827, 2831. This section was originally designated as section 512. However, because two sections 512 had been enacted into law in 1998, a technical amendment redesignated this as section 513. Pub. L. No. 106-44, 113 Stat. 221. See also endnote 2*, supra.*

10 The Fairness in Music Licensing Act of 1998 added section 513. Pub. L. No. 105-298, 112 Stat. 2827, 2831. This section was initially labeled as section 512. However, since two different sections 512 were created in 1998, a technical amendment renumbered this to section 513. Pub. L. No. 106-44, 113 Stat. 221. See also endnote 2*, supra.*

————————————————————————————————————

Understood! Please provide the text you want me to modernize.

Chapter 6

Manufacturing Requirements and Importation

Manufacturing Specs and Imports

  + 601. Manufacture, importation, and public distribution of certain
         copies
  + 602. Infringing importation of copies or phonorecords
  + 603. Importation prohibitions: Enforcement and disposition of
         excluded articles

+ 601. Production, import, and public distribution of certain
         copies
  + 602. Unauthorized import of copies or phonorecords
  + 603. Import restrictions: Enforcement and handling of
         excluded items

Section 601. Manufacture, importation, and public distribution of certain copies [1]

(a) Prior to July 1, 1986, and except as provided by subsection (b), the importation into or public distribution in the United States of copies of a work consisting preponderantly of nondramatic literary material that is in the English language and is protected under this title is prohibited unless the portions consisting of such material have been manufactured in the United States or Canada.

(a) Before July 1, 1986, and unless stated in subsection (b), importing or publicly distributing copies of a work mainly made up of nondramatic literary content in English that is protected under this title is not allowed unless the parts containing such material were made in the United States or Canada.

(b) The provisions of subsection (a) do not apply-

(b) The rules in subsection (a) don't apply-

(1) where, on the date when importation is sought or public distribution in the United States is made, the author of any substantial part of such material is neither a national nor a domiciliary of the United States or, if such author is a national of the United States, he or she has been domiciled outside the United States for a continuous period of at least one year immediately preceding that date; in the case of a work made for hire, the exemption provided by this clause does not apply unless a substantial part of the work was prepared for an employer or other person who is not a national or domiciliary of the United States or a domestic corporation or enterprise;

(1) when, on the date importation is requested or public distribution in the United States occurs, the author of any significant part of the material is neither a citizen nor a resident of the United States, or if that author is a U.S. citizen, they have lived outside the United States for a continuous period of at least one year before that date; in the case of a work made for hire, the exemption provided by this clause does not apply unless a significant part of the work was created for an employer or other entity that is not a citizen or resident of the United States, or a domestic corporation or business;

(2) where the United States Customs Service is presented with an import statement issued under the seal of the Copyright Office, in which case a total of no more than two thousand copies of any one such work shall be allowed entry; the import statement shall be issued upon request to the copyright owner or to a person designated by such owner at the time of registration for the work under section 408 or at any time thereafter;

(2) where the United States Customs Service has an import statement given under the seal of the Copyright Office, in this case, no more than two thousand copies of any one such work will be allowed for entry; the import statement will be issued upon request to the copyright owner or to a person chosen by that owner at the time of registration for the work under section 408 or at any time afterward;

(3) where importation is sought under the authority or for the use, other than in schools, of the Government of the United States or of any State or political subdivision of a State;

(3) where importation is requested under the authority or for the use, outside of schools, of the Government of the United States or any State or local government.

(4) where importation, for use and not for sale, is sought-

(4) where the importation is requested for use and not for resale-

(A) by any person with respect to no more than one copy of any work at any one time;

(A) by any person regarding only one copy of any work at any given time;

(B) by any person arriving from outside the United States, with respect to copies forming part of such person's personal baggage; or

(B) by anyone arriving from outside the United States, concerning copies that are part of that person's personal luggage; or

(C) by an organization operated for scholarly, educational, or religious purposes and not for private gain, with respect to copies intended to form a part of its library;

(C) by an organization run for academic, educational, or religious purposes and not for personal profit, regarding copies meant to be part of its library;

(5) where the copies are reproduced in raised characters for the use of the blind; or

(5) where copies are made with raised letters for the use of the blind; or

(6) where, in addition to copies imported under clauses (3) and (4) of this subsection, no more than two thousand copies of any one such work, which have not been manufactured in the United States or Canada, are publicly distributed in the United States; or

(6) where, in addition to copies imported under clauses (3) and (4) of this subsection, no more than two thousand copies of any one such work, which have not been made in the United States or Canada, are publicly distributed in the United States; or

(7) where, on the date when importation is sought or public distribution in the United States is made-

(7) where, on the date when importation is requested or public distribution in the United States occurs-

(A) the author of any substantial part of such material is an individual and receives compensation for the transfer or license of the right to distribute the work in the United States; and

(A) the author of any significant portion of this material is a person and is paid for the transfer or license of the right to distribute the work in the United States; and

(B) the first publication of the work has previously taken place outside the United States under a transfer or license granted by such author to a transferee or licensee who was not a national or domiciliary of the United States or a domestic corporation or enterprise; and

(B) the first release of the work occurred outside the United States under a transfer or license given by the author to someone who wasn’t a national or resident of the United States or a domestic corporation or business; and

(C) there has been no publication of an authorized edition of the work of which the copies were manufactured in the United States; and

(C) there has been no release of an official edition of the work for which copies were produced in the United States; and

(D) the copies were reproduced under a transfer or license granted by such author or by the transferee or licensee of the right of first publication as mentioned in subclause (B), and the transferee or the licensee of the right of reproduction was not a national or domiciliary of the United States or a domestic corporation or enterprise.

(D) the copies were made under a transfer or license from the author or from the person or organization that holds the right of first publication as mentioned in subclause (B), and the person or organization with the right to reproduce was not a citizen or resident of the United States or a domestic corporation or business.

(c) The requirement of this section that copies be manufactured in the United States or Canada is satisfied if-

(c) The requirement of this section that copies be made in the United States or Canada is met if-

(1) in the case where the copies are printed directly from type that has been set, or directly from plates made from such type, the setting of the type and the making of the plates have been performed in the United States or Canada; or

(1) in situations where the copies are printed directly from type that has been set, or directly from plates made from that type, the type setting and the creation of the plates have been done in the United States or Canada; or

(2) in the case where the making of plates by a lithographic or photoengraving process is a final or intermediate step preceding the printing of the copies, the making of the plates has been performed in the United States or Canada; and

(2) when creating plates through a lithographic or photoengraving process is a final or intermediate step before printing the copies, the plates have been made in the United States or Canada; and

(3) in any case, the printing or other final process of producing multiple copies and any binding of the copies have been performed in the United States or Canada.

(3) In any case, the printing or other final steps of creating multiple copies and any binding of the copies have been done in the United States or Canada.

(d) Importation or public distribution of copies in violation of this section does not invalidate protection for a work under this title. However, in any civil action or criminal proceeding for infringement of the exclusive rights to reproduce and distribute copies of the work, the infringer has a complete defense with respect to all of the nondramatic literary material comprised in the work and any other parts of the work in which the exclusive rights to reproduce and distribute copies are owned by the same person who owns such exclusive rights in the nondramatic literary material, if the infringer proves-

(d) Importing or publicly distributing copies in violation of this section doesn’t cancel the protection for a work under this title. However, in any civil or criminal case for infringing on the exclusive rights to reproduce and distribute copies of the work, the infringer has a full defense concerning all the nondramatic literary content included in the work and any other parts of the work for which the exclusive rights to reproduce and distribute copies are owned by the same person who owns those exclusive rights in the nondramatic literary content, if the infringer can prove—

(1) that copies of the work have been imported into or publicly distributed in the United States in violation of this section by or with the authority of the owner of such exclusive rights; and

(1) that copies of the work have been brought into or publicly shared in the United States in violation of this section by or with the permission of the owner of those exclusive rights; and

(2) that the infringing copies were manufactured in the United States or Canada in accordance with the provisions of subsection (c); and

(2) that the copied versions were made in the United States or Canada following the rules outlined in subsection (c); and

(3) that the infringement was commenced before the effective date of registration for an authorized edition of the work, the copies of which have been manufactured in the United States or Canada in accordance with the provisions of subsection (c).

(3) that the infringement started before the registration date for an authorized edition of the work, the copies of which were made in the United States or Canada in line with the rules in subsection (c).

(e) In any action for infringement of the exclusive rights to reproduce and distribute copies of a work containing material required by this section to be manufactured in the United States or Canada, the copyright owner shall set forth in the complaint the names of the persons or organizations who performed the processes specified by subsection (c) with respect to that material, and the places where those processes were performed.

(e) In any lawsuit for violating the exclusive rights to reproduce and distribute copies of a work that must be made in the United States or Canada, the copyright owner must include in the complaint the names of the individuals or organizations that carried out the processes mentioned in subsection (c) related to that material, as well as the locations where those processes took place.

Section 602. Infringing importation of copies or phonorecords

(a) Importation into the United States, without the authority of the owner of copyright under this title, of copies or phonorecords of a work that have been acquired outside the United States is an infringement of the exclusive right to distribute copies or phonorecords under section 106, actionable under section 501. This subsection does not apply to-

(a) Importing copies or phonorecords of a work into the United States without the permission of the copyright owner is a violation of the exclusive right to distribute copies or phonorecords under section 106, and can be prosecuted under section 501. This subsection does not apply to-

(1) importation of copies or phonorecords under the authority or for the use of the Government of the United States or of any State or political subdivision of a State, but not including copies or phonorecords for use in schools, or copies of any audiovisual work imported for purposes other than archival use;

(1) importing copies or phonorecords under the authority or for the use of the Government of the United States or any State or political subdivision of a State, but not including copies or phonorecords for use in schools, or copies of any audiovisual work imported for purposes other than archival use;

(2) importation, for the private use of the importer and not for distribution, by any person with respect to no more than one copy or phonorecord of any one work at any one time, or by any person arriving from outside the United States with respect to copies or phonorecords forming part of such person's personal baggage; or

(2) importing, for the personal use of the importer and not for sharing, by any individual regarding no more than one copy or phonorecord of any single work at any given time, or by any individual arriving from outside the United States concerning copies or phonorecords that are part of that person's personal luggage; or

(3) importation by or for an organization operated for scholarly, educational, or religious purposes and not for private gain, with respect to no more than one copy of an audiovisual work solely for its archival purposes, and no more than five copies or phonorecords of any other work for its library lending or archival purposes, unless the importation of such copies or phonorecords is part of an activity consisting of systematic reproduction or distribution, engaged in by such organization in violation of the provisions of section 108(g)(2).

(3) Importing by or for an organization that operates for scholarly, educational, or religious reasons and not for profit, is allowed for no more than one copy of an audiovisual work strictly for archival purposes, and no more than five copies or phonorecords of any other work for library lending or archival purposes, unless the importation of these copies or phonorecords is part of a systematic reproduction or distribution activity by the organization that goes against the rules in section 108(g)(2).

(b) In a case where the making of the copies or phonorecords would have constituted an infringement of copyright if this title had been applicable, their importation is prohibited. In a case where the copies or phonorecords were lawfully made, the United States Customs Service has no authority to prevent their importation unless the provisions of section 601 are applicable. In either case, the Secretary of the Treasury is authorized to prescribe, by regulation, a procedure under which any person claiming an interest in the copyright in a particular work may, upon payment of a specified fee, be entitled to notification by the Customs Service of the importation of articles that appear to be copies or phonorecords of the work.

(b) If making copies or phonorecords would have violated copyright if this title were applicable, their importation is not allowed. However, if the copies or phonorecords were legally made, the United States Customs Service cannot block their importation unless section 601 applies. In both situations, the Secretary of the Treasury is permitted to set up a procedure by regulation that allows anyone claiming an interest in the copyright of a specific work to receive notification from the Customs Service about the importation of items that seem to be copies or phonorecords of that work, upon payment of a specified fee.

Section 603. Importation prohibitions: Enforcement and disposition of excluded articles [2]

(a) The Secretary of the Treasury and the United States Postal Service shall separately or jointly make regulations for the enforcement of the provisions of this title prohibiting importation.

(a) The Secretary of the Treasury and the United States Postal Service will create regulations separately or together to enforce the rules in this title that prohibit importation.

(b) These regulations may require, as a condition for the exclusion of articles under section 602-

(b) These rules might require, as a condition for excluding items under section 602-

(1) that the person seeking exclusion obtain a court order enjoining importation of the articles; or

(1) that the person requesting exclusion get a court order to stop the importation of the items; or

(2) that the person seeking exclusion furnish proof, of a specified nature and in accordance with prescribed procedures, that the copyright in which such person claims an interest is valid and that the importation would violate the prohibition in section 602; the person seeking exclusion may also be required to post a surety bond for any injury that may result if the detention or exclusion of the articles proves to be unjustified.

(2) that the person asking for exclusion provide evidence, of a specified type and following set procedures, that the copyright they claim to hold is valid and that the import would break the rule in section 602; the person requesting exclusion may also need to post a surety bond for any damages that may occur if the detention or exclusion of the items turns out to be unjustified.

(c) Articles imported in violation of the importation prohibitions of this title are subject to seizure and forfeiture in the same manner as property imported in violation of the customs revenue laws. Forfeited articles shall be destroyed as directed by the Secretary of the Treasury or the court, as the case may be.

(c) Items brought in that go against the import restrictions of this title can be seized and forfeited just like items imported in violation of customs revenue laws. Forfeited items will be destroyed as instructed by the Secretary of the Treasury or the court, depending on the situation.

————————— Chapter 6 Endnotes

Chapter 6 References

1 In 1982, section 601(a) was amended in the first sentence by substituting "1986" for "1982." Pub. L. No. 97-215, 96 Stat. 178.

1 In 1982, section 601(a) was changed in the first sentence by replacing "1982" with "1986." Pub. L. No. 97-215, 96 Stat. 178.

2 The Anticounterfeiting Consumer Protection Act of 1996 amended the last sentence of section 603(c) by deleting the semicolon and all text immediately following the words "as the case may be." Pub. L. No. 104-153, 110 Stat. 1386, 1388.

2 The Anticounterfeiting Consumer Protection Act of 1996 changed the last sentence of section 603(c) by removing the semicolon and all the text right after the words "as the case may be." Pub. L. No. 104-153, 110 Stat. 1386, 1388.

————————————————————————————————————

Sure, I'm ready to assist with that! Please provide the text you'd like me to modernize.

Chapter 7 [1]

Copyright Office

Copyright Office

  + 701. The Copyright Office: General responsibilities and organization
  + 702. Copyright Office regulations
  + 703. Effective date of actions in Copyright Office
  + 704. Retention and disposition of articles deposited in Copyright
         Office
  + 705. Copyright Office records: Preparation, maintenance, public
         inspection, and searching
  + 706. Copies of Copyright Office records
  + 707. Copyright Office forms and publications
  + 708. Copyright Office fees
  + 709. Delay in delivery caused by disruption of postal or other
         services

+ 701. The Copyright Office: General responsibilities and organization
  + 702. Copyright Office regulations
  + 703. Effective date of actions in Copyright Office
  + 704. Retention and disposal of articles submitted to Copyright
         Office
  + 705. Copyright Office records: Preparation, maintenance, public
         inspection, and searching
  + 706. Copies of Copyright Office records
  + 707. Copyright Office forms and publications
  + 708. Copyright Office fees
  + 709. Delays in delivery caused by disruptions in postal or other
         services

Section 701. The Copyright Office: General responsibilities and organization [2]

(a) All administrative functions and duties under this title, except as otherwise specified, are the responsibility of the Register of Copyrights as director of the Copyright Office of the Library of Congress. The Register of Copyrights, together with the subordinate officers and employees of the Copyright Office, shall be appointed by the Librarian of Congress, and shall act under the Librarian's general direction and supervision.

(a) All administrative functions and duties under this title, except as otherwise specified, are the responsibility of the Register of Copyrights as the director of the Copyright Office of the Library of Congress. The Register of Copyrights, along with the subordinate officers and employees of the Copyright Office, will be appointed by the Librarian of Congress and will operate under the Librarian's general direction and supervision.

(b) In addition to the functions and duties set out elsewhere in this chapter, the Register of Copyrights shall perform the following functions:

(b) Besides the functions and duties described in other parts of this chapter, the Register of Copyrights will carry out the following functions:

(1) Advise Congress on national and international issues relating to copyright, other matters arising under this title, and related matters.

(1) Advise Congress on national and international issues related to copyright, other matters covered in this title, and associated topics.

(2) Provide information and assistance to Federal departments and agencies and the Judiciary on national and international issues relating to copyright, other matters arising under this title, and related matters.

(2) Provide information and support to federal departments and agencies, as well as the judiciary, on national and international issues concerning copyright, other matters related to this title, and associated topics.

(3) Participate in meetings of international intergovernmental organizations and meetings with foreign government officials relating to copyright, other matters arising under this title, and related matters, including as a member of United States delegations as authorized by the appropriate Executive branch authority.

(3) Take part in meetings of international intergovernmental organizations and meetings with foreign government officials regarding copyright, other issues related to this title, and related matters, including as a member of United States delegations as allowed by the appropriate Executive branch authority.

(4) Conduct studies and programs regarding copyright, other matters arising under this title, and related matters, the administration of the Copyright Office, or any function vested in the Copyright Office by law, including educational programs conducted cooperatively with foreign intellectual property offices and international intergovernmental organizations.

(4) Conduct research and programs related to copyright, other issues related to this title, and connected matters, the management of the Copyright Office, or any function assigned to the Copyright Office by law, including educational programs done in collaboration with foreign intellectual property offices and international intergovernmental organizations.

(5) Perform such other functions as Congress may direct, or as may be appropriate in furtherance of the functions and duties specifically set forth in this title.

(5) Carry out any other tasks that Congress may direct, or that are appropriate in support of the functions and duties specifically outlined in this title.

(c) The Register of Copyrights shall adopt a seal to be used on and after January 1, 1978, to authenticate all certified documents issued by the Copyright Office.

(c) The Register of Copyrights will adopt a seal to be used starting January 1, 1978, to authenticate all certified documents issued by the Copyright Office.

(d) The Register of Copyrights shall make an annual report to the Librarian of Congress of the work and accomplishments of the Copyright Office during the previous fiscal year. The annual report of the Register of Copyrights shall be published separately and as a part of the annual report of the Librarian of Congress.

(d) The Register of Copyrights will submit a yearly report to the Librarian of Congress detailing the activities and achievements of the Copyright Office from the previous fiscal year. The Register of Copyrights' annual report will be published separately and will also be included in the annual report of the Librarian of Congress.

(e) Except as provided by section 706(b) and the regulations issued thereunder, all actions taken by the Register of Copyrights under this title are subject to the provisions of the Administrative Procedure Act of June 11, 1946, as amended (c. 324, 60 Stat. 237, title 5, United States Code, Chapter 5, Subchapter II and Chapter 7).

(e) Except as stated in section 706(b) and the related regulations, all actions taken by the Register of Copyrights under this title must follow the rules set out in the Administrative Procedure Act of June 11, 1946, as amended (c. 324, 60 Stat. 237, title 5, United States Code, Chapter 5, Subchapter II and Chapter 7).

(f) The Register of Copyrights shall be compensated at the rate of pay in effect for level III of the Executive Schedule under section 5314 of title 5.3 The Librarian of Congress shall establish not more than four positions for Associate Registers of Copyrights, in accordance with the recommendations of the Register of Copyrights. The Librarian shall make appointments to such positions after consultation with the Register of Copyrights. Each Associate Register of Copyrights shall be paid at a rate not to exceed the maximum annual rate of basic pay payable for GS-18 of the General Schedule under section 5332 of title 5.

(f) The Register of Copyrights will be paid at the salary level for level III of the Executive Schedule as outlined in section 5314 of title 5. The Librarian of Congress will create no more than four positions for Associate Registers of Copyrights, based on the recommendations from the Register of Copyrights. The Librarian will appoint individuals to these positions after consulting with the Register of Copyrights. Each Associate Register of Copyrights will receive a salary that does not exceed the highest annual salary for GS-18 of the General Schedule as specified in section 5332 of title 5.

Section 702. Copyright Office regulations [4]

The Register of Copyrights is authorized to establish regulations not inconsistent with law for the administration of the functions and duties made the responsibility of the Register under this title. All regulations established by the Register under this title are subject to the approval of the Librarian of Congress.

The Register of Copyrights is authorized to create regulations that align with the law for managing the functions and duties assigned to the Register under this title. All regulations made by the Register under this title require approval from the Librarian of Congress.

Section 703. Effective date of actions in Copyright Office

In any case in which time limits are prescribed under this title for the performance of an action in the Copyright Office, and in which the last day of the prescribed period falls on a Saturday, Sunday, holiday, or other nonbusiness day within the District of Columbia or the Federal Government, the action may be taken on the next succeeding business day, and is effective as of the date when the period expired.

In any situation where there are time limits set under this title for taking action in the Copyright Office, and the last day of that time period falls on a Saturday, Sunday, holiday, or another non-business day in the District of Columbia or the Federal Government, the action can be taken on the next business day, and it will be considered effective as of the date the period ended.

Section 704. Retention and disposition of articles deposited in Copyright Office

(a) Upon their deposit in the Copyright Office under sections 407 and 408, all copies, phonorecords, and identifying material, including those deposited in connection with claims that have been refused registration, are the property of the United States Government.

(a) Once they are submitted to the Copyright Office under sections 407 and 408, all copies, phonorecords, and identifying materials, including those submitted in connection with claims that were denied registration, belong to the United States Government.

(b) In the case of published works, all copies, phonorecords, and identifying material deposited are available to the Library of Congress for its collections, or for exchange or transfer to any other library. In the case of unpublished works, the Library is entitled, under regulations that the Register of Copyrights shall prescribe, to select any deposits for its collections or for transfer to the National Archives of the United States or to a Federal records center, as defined in section 2901 of title 44.

(b) For published works, all copies, audio recordings, and identification materials that are submitted are available to the Library of Congress for inclusion in its collections, or for exchange or transfer to any other library. For unpublished works, the Library has the right, following regulations set by the Register of Copyrights, to choose any deposits for its collections or for transfer to the National Archives of the United States or to a Federal records center, as defined in section 2901 of title 44.

(c) The Register of Copyrights is authorized, for specific or general categories of works, to make a facsimile reproduction of all or any part of the material deposited under section 408, and to make such reproduction a part of the Copyright Office records of the registration, before transferring such material to the Library of Congress as provided by subsection (b), or before destroying or otherwise disposing of such material as provided by subsection (d).

(c) The Register of Copyrights is allowed, for certain types of works, to create a facsimile copy of all or any part of the material submitted under section 408, and to include that copy in the Copyright Office's registration records before sending the material to the Library of Congress as stated in subsection (b), or before destroying or otherwise getting rid of the material as described in subsection (d).

(d) Deposits not selected by the Library under subsection (b), or identifying portions or reproductions of them, shall be retained under the control of the Copyright Office, including retention in Government storage facilities, for the longest period considered practicable and desirable by the Register of Copyrights and the Librarian of Congress. After that period it is within the joint discretion of the Register and the Librarian to order their destruction or other disposition; but, in the case of unpublished works, no deposit shall be knowingly or intentionally destroyed or otherwise disposed of during its term of copyright unless a facsimile reproduction of the entire deposit has been made a part of the Copyright Office records as provided by subsection (c).

(d) Deposits not picked by the Library under subsection (b), or identifying parts or copies of them, will be kept under the authority of the Copyright Office, including storage in Government facilities, for the longest time considered practical and necessary by the Register of Copyrights and the Librarian of Congress. After that time, it is up to the joint decision of the Register and the Librarian to decide whether to destroy them or dispose of them in another way; however, in the case of unpublished works, no deposit will be intentionally destroyed or disposed of during its copyright term unless a complete facsimile reproduction of the deposit has been included in the Copyright Office records as specified in subsection (c).

(e) The depositor of copies, phonorecords, or identifying material under section 408, or the copyright owner of record, may request retention, under the control of the Copyright Office, of one or more of such articles for the full term of copyright in the work. The Register of Copyrights shall prescribe, by regulation, the conditions under which such requests are to be made and granted, and shall fix the fee to be charged under section 708(a)(10) if the request is granted.

(e) The person who deposits copies, phonorecords, or identifying material under section 408, or the copyright owner of record, can request that one or more of these items be kept under the management of the Copyright Office for the entire duration of the copyright in the work. The Register of Copyrights will set regulations detailing how these requests should be made and approved, and will establish the fee to be charged under section 708(a)(10) if the request is approved.

Section 705. Copyright Office records: Preparation, maintenance, public inspection, and searching [5]

(a) The Register of Copyrights shall ensure that records of deposits, registrations, recordations, and other actions taken under this title are maintained, and that indexes of such records are prepared.

(a) The Register of Copyrights will make sure that records of deposits, registrations, recordations, and other actions taken under this title are kept up to date, and that indexes of these records are created.

(b) Such records and indexes, as well as the articles deposited in connection with completed copyright registrations and retained under the control of the Copyright Office, shall be open to public inspection.

(b) These records and indexes, along with the materials submitted for completed copyright registrations and kept under the authority of the Copyright Office, will be available for public inspection.

(c) Upon request and payment of the fee specified by section 708, the Copyright Office shall make a search of its public records, indexes, and deposits, and shall furnish a report of the information they disclose with respect to any particular deposits, registrations, or recorded documents.

(c) If you request it and pay the fee set by section 708, the Copyright Office will search its public records, indexes, and deposits, and will provide a report on the information they reveal regarding any specific deposits, registrations, or recorded documents.

Section 706. Copies of Copyright Office records

(a) Copies may be made of any public records or indexes of the Copyright Office; additional certificates of copyright registration and copies of any public records or indexes may be furnished upon request and payment of the fees specified by section 708.

(a) You can make copies of any public records or indexes of the Copyright Office; additional certificates of copyright registration and copies of any public records or indexes can be provided upon request and payment of the fees listed in section 708.

(b) Copies or reproductions of deposited articles retained under the control of the Copyright Office shall be authorized or furnished only under the conditions specified by the Copyright Office regulations.

(b) Copies or reproductions of deposited articles kept under the control of the Copyright Office will only be authorized or provided according to the conditions set by the Copyright Office regulations.

Section 707. Copyright Office forms and publications

(a) Catalog of Copyright Entries. The Register of Copyrights shall compile and publish at periodic intervals catalogs of all copyright registrations. These catalogs shall be divided into parts in accordance with the various classes of works, and the Register has discretion to determine, on the basis of practicability and usefulness, the form and frequency of publication of each particular part.

(a) Catalog of Copyright Entries. The Register of Copyrights will compile and publish catalogs of all copyright registrations at regular intervals. These catalogs will be organized into sections based on different types of works, and the Register has the authority to decide, based on practicality and usefulness, how and how often to publish each section.

(b) Other Publications. The Register shall furnish, free of charge upon request, application forms for copyright registration and general informational material in connection with the functions of the Copyright Office. The Register also has the authority to publish compilations of information, bibliographies, and other material he or she considers to be of value to the public.

(b) Other Publications. The Register will provide, at no cost upon request, application forms for copyright registration and general informational materials related to the functions of the Copyright Office. The Register also has the authority to publish collections of information, bibliographies, and other materials that he or she believes will be valuable to the public.

(c) Distribution of Publications. All publications of the Copyright Office shall be furnished to depository libraries as specified under section 1905 of title 44, and, aside from those furnished free of charge, shall be offered for sale to the public at prices based on the cost of reproduction and distribution.

(c) Distribution of Publications. All publications of the Copyright Office will be provided to depository libraries as outlined in section 1905 of title 44, and, apart from those provided for free, will be available for sale to the public at prices based on the cost of reproduction and distribution.

Section 708. Copyright Office fees [6]

(a) Fees. Fees shall be paid to the Register of Copyrights-

(a) Fees. Fees will be paid to the Register of Copyrights-

(1) on filing each application under section 408 for registration of a copyright claim or for a supplementary registration, including the issuance of a certificate of registration if registration is made;

(1) when submitting each application under section 408 for registering a copyright claim or for a supplementary registration, including the issuance of a registration certificate if registration is granted;

(2) on filing each application for registration of a claim for renewal of a subsisting copyright under section 304(a), including the issuance of a certificate of registration if registration is made;

(2) when submitting each application to register a claim for renewal of an existing copyright under section 304(a), including the issuance of a registration certificate if registration is granted;

(3) for the issuance of a receipt for a deposit under section 407;

(3) for issuing a receipt for a deposit under section 407;

(4) for the recordation, as provided by section 205, of a transfer of copyright ownership or other document;

(4) for the recording, as stated in section 205, of a transfer of copyright ownership or other document;

(5) for the filing, under section 115(b), of a notice of intention to obtain a compulsory license;

(5) for submitting, under section 115(b), a notice of intent to obtain a compulsory license;

(6) for the recordation, under section 302(c), of a statement revealing the identity of an author of an anonymous or pseudonymous work, or for the recordation, under section 302(d), of a statement relating to the death of an author;

(6) for the registration, under section 302(c), of a statement disclosing the identity of an author of an anonymous or pseudonymous work, or for the registration, under section 302(d), of a statement regarding the death of an author;

(7) for the issuance, under section 706, of an additional certificate of registration;

(7) for issuing an additional registration certificate under section 706;

(8) for the issuance of any other certification; and

(8) for issuing any other certification; and

(9) for the making and reporting of a search as provided by section 705, and for any related services.

(9) for conducting and reporting a search as outlined in section 705, and for any associated services.

The Register of Copyrights is authorized to fix fees for other services, including the cost of preparing copies of Copyright Office records, whether or not such copies are certified, based on the cost of providing the service.

The Register of Copyrights is allowed to set fees for additional services, including the cost of making copies of Copyright Office records, whether or not those copies are certified, according to the cost of delivering the service.

(b) Adjustment of Fees. The Register of Copyrights may, by regulation, adjust the fees for the services specified in paragraphs (1) through (9) of subsection (a) in the following manner: [7]

(b) Fee Adjustment. The Register of Copyrights can, through regulations, change the fees for the services listed in paragraphs (1) to (9) of subsection (a) as follows: [7]

(1) The Register shall conduct a study of the costs incurred by the Copyright Office for the registration of claims, the recordation of documents, and the provision of services. The study shall also consider the timing of any adjustment in fees and the authority to use such fees consistent with the budget.

(1) The Register will carry out a study on the costs faced by the Copyright Office for registering claims, recording documents, and providing services. The study will also look into when any fee adjustments should happen and the authority to use those fees in line with the budget.

(2) The Register may, on the basis of the study under paragraph (1), and subject to paragraph (5), adjust fees to not more than that necessary to cover the reasonable costs incurred by the Copyright Office for the services described in paragraph (1), plus a reasonable inflation adjustment to account for any estimated increase in costs.

(2) The Register may, based on the study in paragraph (1), and following paragraph (5), adjust the fees to cover only the reasonable costs incurred by the Copyright Office for the services mentioned in paragraph (1), plus a reasonable inflation adjustment for any anticipated increase in costs.

(3) Any fee established under paragraph (2) shall be rounded off to the nearest dollar, or for a fee less than $12, rounded off to the nearest 50 cents.

(3) Any fee set under paragraph (2) will be rounded to the nearest dollar, or if the fee is less than $12, it will be rounded to the nearest 50 cents.

(4) Fees established under this subsection shall be fair and equitable and give due consideration to the objectives of the copyright system.

(4) Fees set under this subsection must be fair and reasonable and take into account the goals of the copyright system.

(5) If the Register determines under paragraph (2) that fees should be adjusted, the Register shall prepare a proposed fee schedule and submit the schedule with the accompanying economic analysis to the Congress. The fees proposed by the Register may be instituted after the end of 120 days after the schedule is submitted to the Congress unless, within that 120-day period, a law is enacted stating in substance that the Congress does not approve the schedule.

(5) If the Register decides under paragraph (2) that fees need to be changed, the Register will create a proposed fee schedule and send it along with the economic analysis to Congress. The fees suggested by the Register can be put into effect after 120 days from when the schedule is submitted to Congress, unless a law is passed during that 120-day period stating that Congress does not approve the schedule.

(c) The fees prescribed by or under this section are applicable to the United States Government and any of its agencies, employees, or officers, but the Register of Copyrights has discretion to waive the requirement of this subsection in occasional or isolated cases involving relatively small amounts.

(c) The fees set by or under this section apply to the United States Government and any of its agencies, employees, or officers, but the Register of Copyrights can choose to waive this requirement in occasional or isolated cases involving relatively small amounts.

(d) (1) Except as provided in paragraph (2), all fees received under this section shall be deposited by the Register of Copyrights in the Treasury of the United States and shall be credited to the appropriations for necessary expenses of the Copyright Office. Such fees that are collected shall remain available until expended. The Register may, in accordance with regulations that he or she shall prescribe, refund any sum paid by mistake or in excess of the fee required by this section.

(d) (1) Except as stated in paragraph (2), all fees collected under this section will be deposited by the Register of Copyrights into the U.S. Treasury and credited to the budget for the Copyright Office's necessary expenses. The collected fees will stay available until spent. The Register may, following the regulations they create, refund any amount that was paid by mistake or above the required fee outlined in this section.

(2) In the case of fees deposited against future services, the Register of Copyrights shall request the Secretary of the Treasury to invest in interest-bearing securities in the United States Treasury any portion of the fees that, as determined by the Register, is not required to meet current deposit account demands. Funds from such portion of fees shall be invested in securities that permit funds to be available to the Copyright Office at all times if they are determined to be necessary to meet current deposit account demands. Such investments shall be in public debt securities with maturities suitable to the needs of the Copyright Office, as determined by the Register of Copyrights, and bearing interest at rates determined by the Secretary of the Treasury, taking into consideration current market yields on outstanding marketable obligations of the United States of comparable maturities.

(2) When it comes to fees paid in advance for future services, the Register of Copyrights will ask the Secretary of the Treasury to invest any portion of the fees that the Register decides isn’t needed to cover current deposit account requests in interest-earning securities issued by the U.S. Treasury. These funds will be invested in securities that allow the Copyright Office to access them whenever necessary to meet current deposit account requests. The investments will be in public debt securities with maturities that align with the needs of the Copyright Office, as determined by the Register of Copyrights, and will earn interest at rates set by the Secretary of the Treasury, taking into account the current market yields on other U.S. marketable securities with similar maturities.

(3) The income on such investments shall be deposited in the Treasury of the United States and shall be credited to the appropriations for necessary expenses of the Copyright Office.

(3) The earnings from these investments will be deposited into the U.S. Treasury and will be allocated to the budget for the necessary expenses of the Copyright Office.

Section 709. Delay in delivery caused by disruption of postal or other services

In any case in which the Register of Copyrights determines, on the basis of such evidence as the Register may by regulation require, that a deposit, application, fee, or any other material to be delivered to the Copyright Office by a particular date, would have been received in the Copyright Office in due time except for a general disruption or suspension of postal or other transportation or communications services, the actual receipt of such material in the Copyright Office within one month after the date on which the Register determines that the disruption or suspension of such services has terminated, shall be considered timely.

In any situation where the Register of Copyrights decides, based on evidence as required by regulation, that a deposit, application, fee, or any other material meant to be delivered to the Copyright Office by a certain date would have arrived on time except for a widespread disruption or halt in postal or other transportation or communication services, the actual arrival of that material in the Copyright Office within one month after the date the Register determines that the disruption or suspension has ended will be considered on time.

————————— Chapter 7 Endnotes

Chapter 7 References

1 The Work Made for Hire and Copyright Corrections Act of 2000 amended the table of sections for chapter 7 by deleting section 710, entitled, "Reproduction for use of the blind and physically handicapped: Voluntary licensing forms and procedures." Pub. L. No. 106-379, 114 Stat. 1444, 1445.

1 The Work Made for Hire and Copyright Corrections Act of 2000 changed the section list for chapter 7 by removing section 710, titled, "Reproduction for use of the blind and physically handicapped: Voluntary licensing forms and procedures." Pub. L. No. 106-379, 114 Stat. 1444, 1445.

2 The Copyright Fees and Technical Amendments Act of 1989 amended section 701 by adding subsection (e). Pub. L. No. 101-319, 104 Stat. 290. In 1998, the Digital Millennium Copyright Act amended section 701 by adding a new subsection (b), redesignating former subsections (b) through (e) as (c) through (f) respectively, and, in the new subsection (f), by substituting "III" for "IV" and "5314" for "5315." Pub. L. No. 105-304, 112 Stat. 2860, 2887.

2 The Copyright Fees and Technical Amendments Act of 1989 changed section 701 by adding subsection (e). Pub. L. No. 101-319, 104 Stat. 290. In 1998, the Digital Millennium Copyright Act revised section 701 by adding a new subsection (b), renumbering the previous subsections (b) through (e) to (c) through (f) respectively, and in the new subsection (f), replacing "III" with "IV" and "5314" with "5315." Pub. L. No. 105-304, 112 Stat. 2860, 2887.

3 Title 5 of the *United States Code* is entitled "Government Organization and Employees."

3 Title 5 of the *United States Code* is called "Government Organization and Employees."

4 Copyright Office regulations are published in the *Federal Register [http://www.loc.gov/copyright/fedreg/] *and in title 37, Chapter II, of the *Code of Federal Regulations. [http://www.loc.gov/copyright/title37/] *

4 Copyright Office regulations are published in the *Federal Register [http://www.loc.gov/copyright/fedreg/] *and in Title 37, Chapter II, of the *Code of Federal Regulations. [http://www.loc.gov/copyright/title37/] *

5 The Work Made for Hire and Copyright Corrections Act of 2000 amended section 705 by rewriting paragraph (a). Pub. L. No. 106-379, 114 Stat. 1444, 1445.

5 The Work Made for Hire and Copyright Corrections Act of 2000 changed section 705 by rewriting paragraph (a). Pub. L. No. 106-379, 114 Stat. 1444, 1445.

6 The Copyright Fees and Technical Amendments Act of 1989 amended section 708 by substituting a new subsection (a), by redesignating subsections (b) and (c) as subsections (c) and (d), respectively, and by adding a new subsection (b). Pub. L. No. 101-318, 104 Stat. 287. The Act states that these amendments "shall take effect 6 months after the date of the enactment of this Act" and shall apply to:

6 The Copyright Fees and Technical Amendments Act of 1989 changed section 708 by replacing the old subsection (a) with a new one, renaming subsections (b) and (c) to subsections (c) and (d), and adding a new subsection (b). Pub. L. No. 101-318, 104 Stat. 287. The Act specifies that these changes "will take effect 6 months after the date of the enactment of this Act" and will apply to:

(A) claims to original, supplementary, and renewal copyright received for registration, and to items received for recordation in the Copyright Office, on or after such effective date, and

(A) claims to original, supplementary, and renewal copyright submitted for registration, as well as items submitted for recordation in the Copyright Office, on or after that effective date, and

(B) other requests for services received on or after such effective date, or received before such effective date for services not yet rendered as of such date.

(B) other requests for services received on or after that effective date, or received before that effective date for services that haven't been provided by that date.

With respect to prior claims, the Act states that claims to original, supplementary, and renewal copyright received for registration and items received for recordation in acceptable form in the Copyright Office before the above mentioned effective date, and requests for services which are rendered before such effective date "shall be governed by section 708 of title 17, United States Code, as in effect before such effective date." Pub. L. No. 101-318, 104 Stat. 287, 288.

With regard to previous claims, the Act states that claims for original, supplementary, and renewal copyright submitted for registration and items received for record in acceptable form in the Copyright Office before the mentioned effective date, along with requests for services provided before that effective date, "will be governed by section 708 of title 17, United States Code, as it was in effect before that effective date." Pub. L. No. 101-318, 104 Stat. 287, 288.

The Copyright Renewal Act of 1992 amended paragraph (2) of section 708(a) by striking the words "in its first term" and by substituting "$20" in lieu of "$12." Pub. L. No. 102-307, 106 Stat. 264, 266.

The Copyright Renewal Act of 1992 changed paragraph (2) of section 708(a) by removing the phrase "in its first term" and replacing "$12" with "$20." Pub. L. No. 102-307, 106 Stat. 264, 266.

In 1997, section 708 was amended by rewriting subsections (b) and (d) in their entirety. Pub. L. No. 105-80, 111 Stat. 1529, 1532.

In 1997, section 708 was changed by completely rewriting subsections (b) and (d). Pub. L. No. 105-80, 111 Stat. 1529, 1532.

The Work Made for Hire and Copyright Corrections Act of 2000 amended section 708 by rewriting subsection (a), by substituting new language for the first sentence in subsection (b) and by substituting "adjustment" for "increase" in paragraph (b)(1), the word "adjust" for "increase" in paragraph (b)(2) and the word "adjusted" for "increased" in paragraph (b)(5). Pub. L. No. 106-379, 114 Stat. 1444, 1445. The Act also stated that "The fees under section 708(a) of title 17, United States Code, on the date of the enactment of this Act shall be the fees in effect under section 708(a) of such title on the day before such date of enactment."

The Work Made for Hire and Copyright Corrections Act of 2000 updated section 708 by rewriting subsection (a), replacing the first sentence in subsection (b) with new language, and changing "increase" to "adjustment" in paragraph (b)(1), the word "adjust" for "increase" in paragraph (b)(2), and "adjusted" for "increased" in paragraph (b)(5). Pub. L. No. 106-379, 114 Stat. 1444, 1445. The Act also stated, "The fees under section 708(a) of title 17, United States Code, on the date of the enactment of this Act shall be the fees in effect under section 708(a) of such title on the day before such date of enactment."

7 The current fees may be found in the *Code of Federal Regulations, [http://www.loc.gov/copyright/title37/] * at 37 C.F.R. Sec. 201.3, [http://www.loc.gov/copyright/title37/] as authorized by Pub. L. No. 105-80, 111 Stat. 1529, 1532. In Pub. L. No. 105-80, Congress amended section 708(b) to require that the Register of Copyrights establish fees by regulation.

7 You can find the current fees in the *Code of Federal Regulations, [http://www.loc.gov/copyright/title37/] * at 37 C.F.R. Sec. 201.3, [http://www.loc.gov/copyright/title37/] as authorized by Pub. L. No. 105-80, 111 Stat. 1529, 1532. In Pub. L. No. 105-80, Congress changed section 708(b) to require the Register of Copyrights to set fees through regulations.

————————————————————————————————————

Understood! Please provide the text you would like me to modernize.

Chapter 8 [1]

Copyright Arbitration Royalty Panels

Copyright Arbitration Royalty Boards

  + 801. Copyright arbitration royalty panels: Establishment and purpose
  + 802. Membership and proceedings of copyright arbitration royalty
         panels
  + 803. Institution and conclusion of proceedings

+ 801. Copyright arbitration royalty panels: Establishment and purpose
  + 802. Membership and proceedings of copyright arbitration royalty
         panels
  + 803. Institution and conclusion of proceedings

Section 801. Copyright arbitration royalty panels: Establishment and purpose [2]

(a) Establishment. The Librarian of Congress, upon the recommendation of the Register of Copyrights, is authorized to appoint and convene copyright arbitration royalty panels.

(a) Establishment. The Librarian of Congress, based on the recommendation of the Register of Copyrights, is authorized to appoint and convene copyright arbitration royalty panels.

(b) Purposes. Subject to the provisions of this chapter, the purposes of the copyright arbitration royalty panels shall be as follows:

(b) Purposes. Subject to the provisions of this chapter, the purposes of the copyright arbitration royalty panels shall be as follows:

(1) To make determinations concerning the adjustment of reasonable copyright royalty rates as provided in sections 114, 115, 116, and 119, and to make determinations as to reasonable terms and rates of royalty payments as provided in section 118. The rates applicable under sections 114(f)(1)(B), 115, and 116 shall be calculated to achieve the following objectives:

(1) To decide on the adjustment of fair copyright royalty rates as stated in sections 114, 115, 116, and 119, and to determine fair terms and rates of royalty payments as outlined in section 118. The rates under sections 114(f)(1)(B), 115, and 116 will be calculated to meet the following goals:

(A) To maximize the availability of creative works to the public;

(A) To make creative works more accessible to the public;

(B) To afford the copyright owner a fair return for his creative work and the copyright user a fair income under existing economic conditions;

(B) To give the copyright owner a fair return for their creative work and the copyright user a fair income under current economic conditions;

(C) To reflect the relative roles of the copyright owner and the copyright user in the product made available to the public with respect to relative creative contribution, technological contribution, capital investment, cost, risk, and contribution to the opening of new markets for creative expression and media for their communication;

(C) To show the different roles of the copyright owner and the copyright user in the product offered to the public regarding their creative input, technological input, financial investment, expenses, risks, and contributions to creating new markets for creative expression and ways to share that expression;

(D) To minimize any disruptive impact on the structure of the industries involved and on generally prevailing industry practices.

(D) To reduce any disruptive effect on the structure of the industries involved and on the overall industry practices.

(2) To make determinations concerning the adjustment of the copyright royalty rates in section 111 solely in accordance with the following provisions:

(2) To decide on the adjustment of the copyright royalty rates in section 111 only based on the following provisions:

(A) The rates established by section 111(d)(1)(B) may be adjusted to reflect (i) national monetary inflation or deflation or (ii) changes in the average rates charged cable subscribers for the basic service of providing secondary transmissions to maintain the real constant dollar level of the royalty fee per subscriber which existed as of the date of enactment of this Act: *Provided*, That if the average rates charged cable system subscribers for the basic service of providing secondary transmissions are changed so that the average rates exceed national monetary inflation, no change in the rates established by section 111(d) (1)(B) shall be permitted: *And provided further, *That no increase in the royalty fee shall be permitted based on any reduction in the average number of distant signal equivalents per subscriber. The copyright arbitration royalty panels may consider all factors relating to the maintenance of such level of payments including, as an extenuating factor, whether the industry has been restrained by subscriber rate regulating authorities from increasing the rates for the basic service of providing secondary transmissions.

(A) The rates set by section 111(d)(1)(B) can be adjusted to account for (i) national inflation or deflation or (ii) changes in the average prices that cable subscribers pay for the basic service of providing secondary transmissions, in order to maintain the same real dollar value of the royalty fee per subscriber that was in effect when this Act was enacted: *Provided*, that if the average prices charged to cable system subscribers for the basic service of providing secondary transmissions increase beyond national inflation, there will be no change in the rates set by section 111(d)(1)(B): *And provided further,* that no increase in the royalty fee will be allowed due to any decrease in the average number of distant signal equivalents per subscriber. The copyright arbitration royalty panels can take into account all factors related to maintaining this level of payments, including, as a mitigating factor, whether the industry has been limited by subscriber rate regulating authorities from raising the prices for the basic service of providing secondary transmissions.

(B) In the event that the rules and regulations of the Federal Communications Commission are amended at any time after April 15, 1976, to permit the carriage by cable systems of additional television broadcast signals beyond the local service area of the primary transmitters of such signals, the royalty rates established by section 111(d)(1)(B) may be adjusted to insure that the rates for the additional distant signal equivalents resulting from such carriage are reasonable in the light of the changes effected by the amendment to such rules and regulations. In determining the reasonableness of rates proposed following an amendment of Federal Communications Commission rules and regulations, the copyright arbitration royalty panels shall consider, among other factors, the economic impact on copyright owners and users: *Provided*, That no adjustment in royalty rates shall be made under this subclause with respect to any distant signal equivalent or fraction thereof represented by (i) carriage of any signal permitted under the rules and regulations of the Federal Communications Commission in effect on April 15, 1976, or the carriage of a signal of the same type (that is, independent, network, or noncommercial educational) substituted for such permitted signal, or (ii) a television broadcast signal first carried after April 15, 1976, pursuant to an individual waiver of the rules and regulations of the Federal Communications Commission, as such rules and regulations were in effect on April 15,1976.

(B) If the rules and regulations of the Federal Communications Commission are changed at any time after April 15, 1976, to allow cable systems to carry more television broadcast signals beyond the local areas of the primary transmitters of those signals, the royalty rates set by section 111(d)(1)(B) may be adjusted to ensure that the rates for the additional distant signal equivalents from such carriage are reasonable considering the changes made by the amendment to those rules and regulations. When determining whether the rates proposed after an amendment of the Federal Communications Commission's rules and regulations are reasonable, the copyright arbitration royalty panels will take into account, among other factors, the economic impact on copyright owners and users: *Provided*, that no adjustment in royalty rates will be made under this subclause regarding any distant signal equivalent or fraction of it represented by (i) the carriage of any signal allowed under the Federal Communications Commission's rules and regulations in effect on April 15, 1976, or the carriage of a signal of the same category (that is, independent, network, or noncommercial educational) that replaces such permitted signal, or (ii) a television broadcast signal first carried after April 15, 1976, in accordance with an individual waiver of the Federal Communications Commission's rules and regulations, as those rules and regulations were in effect on April 15, 1976.

(C) In the event of any change in the rules and regulations of the Federal Communications Commission with respect to syndicated and sports program exclusivity after April 15, 1976, the rates established by section 111(d)(1)(B) may be adjusted to assure that such rates are reasonable in light of the changes to such rules and regulations, but any such adjustment shall apply only to the affected television broadcast signals carried on those systems affected by the change.

(C) If there are any changes to the rules and regulations of the Federal Communications Commission regarding syndicated and sports program exclusivity after April 15, 1976, the rates set by section 111(d)(1)(B) may be adjusted to ensure that these rates remain reasonable considering the changes to those rules and regulations. However, any adjustments will only apply to the affected television broadcast signals carried on the systems that are impacted by the changes.

(D) The gross receipts limitations established by section 111(d)(1)(C) and (D) shall be adjusted to reflect national monetary inflation or deflation or changes in the average rates charged cable system subscribers for the basic service of providing secondary transmissions to maintain the real constant dollar value of the exemption provided by such section; and the royalty rate specified therein shall not be subject to adjustment.

(D) The gross receipts limits set by section 111(d)(1)(C) and (D) will be updated to account for national monetary inflation or deflation, as well as changes in the average rates that cable system subscribers pay for basic service providing secondary transmissions. This is to ensure that the real constant dollar value of the exemption given by that section is maintained; however, the royalty rate specified in that section will not be adjusted.

(3) To distribute royalty fees deposited with the Register of Copyrights under sections 111, 116, 119(b), and 1003, and to determine, in cases where controversy exists, the distribution of such fees.

(3) To distribute royalty fees deposited with the Copyright Office under sections 111, 116, 119(b), and 1003, and to decide, in cases of dispute, how to distribute those fees.

(c) Rulings. The Librarian of Congress, upon the recommendation of the Register of Copyrights, may, before a copyright arbitration royalty panel is convened, make any necessary procedural or evidentiary rulings that would apply to the proceedings conducted by such panel, including-

(c) Rulings. The Librarian of Congress, based on the advice of the Register of Copyrights, can, before a copyright arbitration royalty panel is set up, make any necessary procedural or evidence-related rulings that would apply to the proceedings held by such a panel, including-

(1) authorizing the distribution of those royalty fees collected under sections 111, 119, and 1005 that the Librarian has found are not subject to controversy; and

(1) allowing the distribution of those royalty fees collected under sections 111, 119, and 1005 that the Librarian has determined are not disputed; and

(2) accepting or rejecting royalty claims filed under sections 111, 119, and 1007 on the basis of timeliness or the failure to establish the basis for a claim.

(2) accepting or rejecting royalty claims submitted under sections 111, 119, and 1007 based on whether they were filed on time or if the necessary basis for a claim wasn't established.

(d) Support and Reimbursement of Arbitration Panels. The Librarian of Congress, upon the recommendation of the Register of Copyrights, shall provide the copyright arbitration royalty panels with the necessary administrative services related to proceedings under this chapter, and shall reimburse the arbitrators presiding in distribution proceedings at such intervals and in such manner as the Librarian shall provide by regulation. Each such arbitrator is an independent contractor acting on behalf of the United States, and shall be hired pursuant to a signed agreement between the Library of Congress and the arbitrator. Payments to the arbitrators shall be considered reasonable costs incurred by the Library of Congress and the Copyright Office for purposes of section 802(h)(1).

(d) Support and Reimbursement of Arbitration Panels. The Librarian of Congress, based on the recommendation of the Register of Copyrights, will provide the copyright arbitration royalty panels with the necessary administrative services related to proceedings under this chapter, and will reimburse the arbitrators overseeing distribution proceedings at the intervals and in the manner determined by the regulations set forth by the Librarian. Each arbitrator is an independent contractor representing the United States, and will be hired under a signed agreement between the Library of Congress and the arbitrator. Payments to the arbitrators will be recognized as reasonable expenses incurred by the Library of Congress and the Copyright Office for the purposes of section 802(h)(1).

Section 802. Membership and proceedings of copyright arbitration royalty panels [3]

(a) Composition of Copyright Arbitration Royalty Panels. A copyright arbitration royalty panel shall consist of 3 arbitrators selected by the Librarian of Congress pursuant to subsection (b).

(a) Composition of Copyright Arbitration Royalty Panels. A copyright arbitration royalty panel will consist of 3 arbitrators chosen by the Librarian of Congress according to subsection (b).

(b) Selection of Arbitration Panel. Not later than 10 days after publication of a notice in the Federal Register initiating an arbitration proceeding under section 803, and in accordance with procedures specified by the Register of Copyrights, the Librarian of Congress shall, upon the recommendation of the Register of Copyrights, select 2 arbitrators from lists provided by professional arbitration associations. Qualifications of the arbitrators shall include experience in conducting arbitration proceedings and facilitating the resolution and settlement of disputes, and any qualifications which the Librarian of Congress, upon the recommendation of the Register of Copyrights, shall adopt by regulation. The 2 arbitrators so selected shall, within 10 days after their selection, choose a third arbitrator from the same lists, who shall serve as the chairperson of the arbitrators. If such 2 arbitrators fail to agree upon the selection of a third arbitrator, the Librarian of Congress shall promptly select the third arbitrator. The Librarian of Congress, upon the recommendation of the Register of Copyrights, shall adopt regulations regarding standards of conduct which shall govern arbitrators and the proceedings under this chapter. [4]

(b) Selection of Arbitration Panel. No later than 10 days after a notice is published in the Federal Register to start an arbitration proceeding under section 803, and following procedures set by the Register of Copyrights, the Librarian of Congress will, based on the Register of Copyrights' recommendation, choose 2 arbitrators from lists given by professional arbitration associations. The arbitrators must have experience in conducting arbitration proceedings and in helping resolve disputes, along with any qualifications that the Librarian of Congress, based on the Register of Copyrights' recommendation, decides to adopt through regulation. The 2 selected arbitrators will, within 10 days of their selection, choose a third arbitrator from the same lists, who will act as the chairperson. If these 2 arbitrators can’t agree on the third arbitrator, the Librarian of Congress will quickly select one. The Librarian of Congress, on the advice of the Register of Copyrights, will establish regulations regarding the standards of conduct that will apply to the arbitrators and the proceedings under this chapter. [4]

(c) Arbitration Proceedings. Copyright arbitration royalty panels shall conduct arbitration proceedings, subject to subchapter II of chapter 5 of title 5, for the purpose of making their determinations in carrying out the purposes set forth in section 801. The arbitration panels shall act on the basis of a fully documented written record, prior decisions of the Copyright Royalty Tribunal, prior copyright arbitration panel determinations, and rulings by the Librarian of Congress under section 801(c). Any copyright owner who claims to be entitled to royalties under section 111, 112, 114, 116, or 119, any transmitting organization entitled to a statutory license under section 112(f), any person entitled to a statutory license under section 114(d), any person entitled to a compulsory license under section 115, or any interested copyright party who claims to be entitled to royalties under section 1006, may submit relevant information and proposals to the arbitration panels in proceedings applicable to such copyright owner or interested copyright party, and any other person participating in arbitration proceedings may submit such relevant information and proposals to the arbitration panel conducting the proceedings. In ratemaking proceedings, the parties to the proceedings shall bear the entire cost thereof in such manner and proportion as the arbitration panels shall direct. In distribution proceedings, the parties shall bear the cost in direct proportion to their share of the distribution.

(c) Arbitration Proceedings. Copyright arbitration royalty panels will conduct arbitration proceedings according to subchapter II of chapter 5 of title 5, to make their decisions in line with the purposes outlined in section 801. The arbitration panels will base their decisions on a fully documented written record, previous decisions from the Copyright Royalty Tribunal, past copyright arbitration panel decisions, and rulings from the Librarian of Congress under section 801(c). Any copyright owner claiming entitlement to royalties under section 111, 112, 114, 116, or 119, any transmitting organization qualified for a statutory license under section 112(f), any person eligible for a statutory license under section 114(d), any person entitled to a compulsory license under section 115, or any interested copyright party claiming entitlement to royalties under section 1006, may submit relevant information and proposals to the arbitration panels in proceedings related to their case. Additionally, any other person involved in arbitration proceedings may submit relevant information and proposals to the arbitration panel conducting the proceedings. In ratemaking proceedings, the parties involved will cover the total cost as directed by the arbitration panels. In distribution proceedings, the parties will share the cost in direct proportion to their share of the distribution.

(d) Procedures. Effective on the date of the enactment of the Copyright Royalty Tribunal Reform Act of 1993, the Librarian of Congress shall adopt the rules and regulations set forth in chapter 3 of title 37 of the Code of Federal Regulations to govern proceedings under this chapter. Such rules and regulations shall remain in effect unless and until the Librarian, upon the recommendation of the Register of Copyrights, adopts supplemental or superseding regulations under subchapter II of chapter 5 of title 5.

(d) Procedures. Starting from the date the Copyright Royalty Tribunal Reform Act of 1993 is enacted, the Librarian of Congress will implement the rules and regulations outlined in chapter 3 of title 37 of the Code of Federal Regulations to manage proceedings under this chapter. These rules and regulations will stay in effect unless the Librarian, based on the recommendation of the Register of Copyrights, establishes additional or overriding regulations under subchapter II of chapter 5 of title 5.

(e) Report to the Librarian of Congress. Not later than 180 days after publication of the notice in the Federal Register initiating an arbitration proceeding, the copyright arbitration royalty panel conducting the proceeding shall report to the Librarian of Congress its determination concerning the royalty fee or distribution of royalty fees, as the case may be. Such report shall be accompanied by the written record, and shall set forth the facts that the arbitration panel found relevant to its determination.

(e) Report to the Librarian of Congress. No later than 180 days after the notice is published in the Federal Register starting an arbitration proceeding, the copyright arbitration royalty panel overseeing the process must report to the Librarian of Congress its decision about the royalty fee or how the royalty fees will be distributed, as applicable. This report should include the written record and outline the facts that the arbitration panel considered important to its decision.

(f) Action by Librarian of Congress. Within 90 days after receiving the report of a copyright arbitration royalty panel under subsection (e), the Librarian of Congress, upon the recommendation of the Register of Copyrights, shall adopt or reject the determination of the arbitration panel. The Librarian shall adopt the determination of the arbitration panel unless the Librarian finds that the determination is arbitrary or contrary to the applicable provisions of this title. If the Librarian rejects the determination of the arbitration panel, the Librarian shall, before the end of an additional 30-day period, and after full examination of the record created in the arbitration proceeding, issue an order setting the royalty fee or distribution of fees, as the case may be. The Librarian shall cause to be published in the Federal Register the determination of the arbitration panel, and the decision of the Librarian (including an order issued under the preceding sentence). The Librarian shall also publicize such determination and decision in such other manner as the Librarian considers appropriate. The Librarian shall also make the report of the arbitration panel and the accompanying record available for public inspection and copying.

(f) Action by the Librarian of Congress. Within 90 days after receiving the report from a copyright arbitration royalty panel under subsection (e), the Librarian of Congress, based on the recommendation from the Register of Copyrights, will either accept or reject the arbitration panel's decision. The Librarian will accept the panel's decision unless it is deemed arbitrary or not in line with the relevant provisions of this title. If the Librarian rejects the panel's decision, they must, within an additional 30 days and after thoroughly reviewing the records from the arbitration, issue an order establishing the royalty fee or distribution of fees, as applicable. The Librarian will publish the arbitration panel's decision and their own decision (including any orders made as mentioned above) in the Federal Register. The Librarian will also announce this decision and the panel's determination in whatever way they find appropriate. Additionally, the Librarian will make the arbitration panel's report and the related records available for public inspection and copying.

(g) Judicial Review. Any decision of the Librarian of Congress under subsection (f) with respect to a determination of an arbitration panel may be appealed, by any aggrieved party who would be bound by the determination, to the United States Court of Appeals for the District of Columbia Circuit, within 30 days after the publication of the decision in the Federal Register. If no appeal is brought within such 30-day period, the decision of the Librarian is final, and the royalty fee or determination with respect to the distribution of fees, as the case may be, shall take effect as set forth in the decision. When this title provides that the royalty rates or terms that were previously in effect are to expire on a specified date, any adjustment by the Librarian of those rates or terms shall be effective as of the day following the date of expiration of the rates or terms that were previously in effect, even if the Librarian's decision is rendered on a later date. The pendency of an appeal under this paragraph shall not relieve persons obligated to make royalty payments under sections 111, 112, 114, 115, 116, 118, 119, or 1003 who would be affected by the determination on appeal to deposit the statement of account and royalty fees specified in those sections. The court shall have jurisdiction to modify or vacate a decision of the Librarian only if it finds, on the basis of the record before the Librarian, that the Librarian acted in an arbitrary manner. If the court modifies the decision of the Librarian, the court shall have jurisdiction to enter its own determination with respect to the amount or distribution of royalty fees and costs, to order the repayment of any excess fees, and to order the payment of any underpaid fees, and the interest pertaining respectively thereto, in accordance with its final judgment. The court may further vacate the decision of the arbitration panel and remand the case to the Librarian for arbitration proceedings in accordance with subsection (c).

(g) Judicial Review. Any decision made by the Librarian of Congress under subsection (f) regarding an arbitration panel's determination can be appealed by any affected party who would be bound by that determination, to the United States Court of Appeals for the District of Columbia Circuit, within 30 days after the decision is published in the Federal Register. If no appeal is filed within that 30-day period, the Librarian's decision becomes final, and the royalty fee or the determination about fee distribution will take effect as outlined in the decision. When this title states that previous royalty rates or terms will expire on a specific date, any adjustment by the Librarian to those rates or terms will take effect the day after the expiration of the previously effective rates or terms, even if the Librarian's decision is made later. The ongoing appeal under this paragraph doesn't excuse individuals required to make royalty payments under sections 111, 112, 114, 115, 116, 118, 119, or 1003 from submitting their statement of account and royalty fees as specified in those sections. The court can modify or overturn a decision by the Librarian only if it determines, based on the record before the Librarian, that the Librarian acted arbitrarily. If the court changes the Librarian's decision, it can also issue its own ruling on the amount or distribution of royalty fees and costs, order the repayment of any excess fees, and require payment of any underpaid fees plus the respective interest, in line with its final judgment. The court may also overturn the arbitration panel's decision and send the case back to the Librarian for arbitration as per subsection (c).

(h) Administrative Matters.

(h) Admin Matters.

(1) Deduction of costs of library of congress and copyright office from royalty fees. The Librarian of Congress and the Register of Copyrights may, to the extent not otherwise provided under this title, deduct from royalty fees deposited or collected under this title the reasonable costs incurred by the Library of Congress and the Copyright Office under this chapter. Such deduction may be made before the fees are distributed to any copyright claimants. In addition, all funds made available by an appropriations Act as offsetting collections and available for deductions under this subsection shall remain available until expended. In ratemaking proceedings, the reasonable costs of the Librarian of Congress and the Copyright Office shall be borne by the parties to the proceedings as directed by the arbitration panels under subsection (c).

(1) Deduction of costs of the Library of Congress and Copyright Office from royalty fees. The Librarian of Congress and the Register of Copyrights may, unless stated otherwise in this title, deduct reasonable costs incurred by the Library of Congress and the Copyright Office under this chapter from royalty fees deposited or collected under this title. These deductions may occur before the fees are distributed to any copyright claimants. Additionally, all funds made available through an appropriations Act as offsetting collections, and available for deductions under this subsection, will remain available until they are spent. In ratemaking proceedings, the reasonable costs of the Librarian of Congress and the Copyright Office will be covered by the parties involved in the proceedings as directed by the arbitration panels under subsection (c).

(2) Positions required for administration of compulsory licensing. Section 307 of the Legislative Branch Appropriations Act, 1994, shall not apply to employee positions in the Library of Congress that are required to be filled in order to carry out section 111, 112, 114, 115, 116, 118, or 119 or chapter 10.

(2) Positions needed for managing compulsory licensing. Section 307 of the Legislative Branch Appropriations Act, 1994, will not apply to employee positions in the Library of Congress that must be filled to implement sections 111, 112, 114, 115, 116, 118, or 119, or chapter 10.

Section 803. Institution and conclusion of proceedings [5]

(a)(1) With respect to proceedings under section 801(b)(1) concerning the adjustment of royalty rates as provided in sections 112, 114, 115, and 116, and with respect to proceedings under subparagraphs (A) and (D) of section 801(b)(2), during the calendar years specified in the schedule set forth in paragraphs (2), (3), (4), and (5), any owner or user of a copyrighted work whose royalty rates are specified by this title, established by the Copyright Royalty Tribunal before the date of the enactment of the Copyright Royalty Tribunal Reform Act of 1993, or established by a copyright arbitration royalty panel after such date of enactment, may file a petition with the Librarian of Congress declaring that the petitioner requests an adjustment of the rate. The Librarian of Congress shall, upon the recommendation of the Register of Copyrights, make a determination as to whether the petitioner has such a significant interest in the royalty rate in which an adjustment is requested. If the Librarian determines that the petitioner has such a significant interest, the Librarian shall cause notice of this determination, with the reasons therefor, to be published in the Federal Register, together with the notice of commencement of proceedings under this chapter.

(a)(1) Regarding proceedings under section 801(b)(1) about changing royalty rates as outlined in sections 112, 114, 115, and 116, and regarding proceedings under subparagraphs (A) and (D) of section 801(b)(2), during the calendar years listed in the schedule in paragraphs (2), (3), (4), and (5), any owner or user of a copyrighted work whose royalty rates are defined by this title, set by the Copyright Royalty Tribunal before the Copyright Royalty Tribunal Reform Act of 1993 was enacted, or determined by a copyright arbitration royalty panel after that date, can submit a petition to the Librarian of Congress stating that they are requesting a change in the rate. The Librarian of Congress, with the recommendation of the Register of Copyrights, will decide if the petitioner has a significant interest in the royalty rate that is being requested for adjustment. If the Librarian finds that the petitioner has such a significant interest, they will publish the determination and its reasons in the Federal Register, along with the notice that proceedings under this chapter are starting.

(2) In proceedings under section 801(b)(2)(A) and (D), a petition described in paragraph (1) may be filed during 1995 and in each subsequent fifth calendar year.

(2) In proceedings under section 801(b)(2)(A) and (D), a petition described in paragraph (1) may be filed during 1995 and in each following fifth calendar year.

(3) In proceedings under section 801(b)(1) concerning the adjustment of royalty rates as provided in section 115, a petition described in paragraph (1) may be filed in 1997 and in each subsequent tenth calendar year or as prescribed in section 115(c)(3)(D).

(3) In cases under section 801(b)(1) regarding changes to royalty rates as outlined in section 115, a petition mentioned in paragraph (1) can be submitted in 1997 and in each following tenth calendar year or as specified in section 115(c)(3)(D).

(4)(A) In proceedings under section 801(b)(1) concerning the adjustment of royalty rates as provided in section 116, a petition described in paragraph (1) may be filed at any time within 1 year after negotiated licenses authorized by section 116 are terminated or expire and are not replaced by subsequent agreements.

(4)(A) In cases under section 801(b)(1) about changing royalty rates as outlined in section 116, a petition mentioned in paragraph (1) can be submitted anytime within 1 year after the negotiated licenses allowed by section 116 end or expire and are not followed by new agreements.

(B) If a negotiated license authorized by section 116 is terminated or expires and is not replaced by another such license agreement which provides permission to use a quantity of musical works not substantially smaller than the quantity of such works performed on coin-operated phonorecord players during the 1-year period ending March 1, 1989, the Librarian of Congress shall, upon petition filed under paragraph (1) within 1 year after such termination or expiration, convene a copyright arbitration royalty panel. The arbitration panel shall promptly establish an interim royalty rate or rates for the public performance by means of a coin-operated phonorecord player of non-dramatic musical works embodied in phonorecords which had been subject to the terminated or expired negotiated license agreement. Such rate or rates shall be the same as the last such rate or rates and shall remain in force until the conclusion of proceedings by the arbitration panel, in accordance with section 802, to adjust the royalty rates applicable to such works, or until superseded by a new negotiated license agreement, as provided in section 116(b).

(B) If a negotiated license authorized by section 116 is terminated or expires and is not replaced by another license agreement that allows the use of a number of musical works that is not significantly smaller than the number of works performed on coin-operated phonorecord players during the 1-year period ending March 1, 1989, the Librarian of Congress shall, upon a petition filed under paragraph (1) within 1 year after the termination or expiration, set up a copyright arbitration royalty panel. The arbitration panel shall quickly establish an interim royalty rate or rates for the public performance via coin-operated phonorecord players of non-dramatic musical works contained in phonorecords that were covered by the terminated or expired negotiated license agreement. These rates shall be the same as the last rates and shall stay in effect until the arbitration panel completes its proceedings, in line with section 802, to adjust the royalty rates for these works, or until they are replaced by a new negotiated license agreement, as stated in section 116(b).

(5) With respect to proceedings under section 801(b)(1) concerning the determination of reasonable terms and rates of royalty payments as provided in section 112 or 114, the Librarian of Congress shall proceed when and as provided by those sections.

(5) Regarding proceedings under section 801(b)(1) about determining fair terms and rates for royalty payments as outlined in section 112 or 114, the Librarian of Congress will act when and as specified in those sections.

(b) With respect to proceedings under subparagraph (B) or (C) of section 801(b)(2), following an event described in either of those subsections, any owner or user of a copyrighted work whose royalty rates are specified by section 111, or by a rate established by the Copyright Royalty Tribunal or the Librarian of Congress, may, within twelve months, file a petition with the Librarian declaring that the petitioner requests an adjustment of the rate. In this event the Librarian shall proceed as in subsection (a) of this section. Any change in royalty rates made by the Copyright Royalty Tribunal or the Librarian of Congress pursuant to this subsection may be reconsidered in 1980, 1985, and each fifth calendar year thereafter, in accordance with the provisions in section 801(b)(2)(B) or (C), as the case may be.

(b) Regarding proceedings under subparagraph (B) or (C) of section 801(b)(2), after an event described in either of those subsections, any owner or user of a copyrighted work whose royalty rates are set by section 111, or by a rate established by the Copyright Royalty Tribunal or the Librarian of Congress, may file a petition with the Librarian within twelve months, stating that the petitioner is requesting a rate adjustment. In this case, the Librarian will proceed as outlined in subsection (a) of this section. Any changes in royalty rates made by the Copyright Royalty Tribunal or the Librarian of Congress under this subsection may be reconsidered in 1980, 1985, and every fifth calendar year after that, according to the provisions in section 801(b)(2)(B) or (C), as applicable.

(c) With respect to proceedings under section 801(b)(1), concerning the determination of reasonable terms and rates of royalty payments as provided in section 118, the Librarian of Congress shall proceed when and as provided by that section.

(c) Regarding proceedings under section 801(b)(1), about determining fair terms and rates for royalty payments as stated in section 118, the Librarian of Congress will act when and as outlined by that section.

(d) With respect to proceedings under section 801(b)(3) or (4), concerning the distribution of royalty fees in certain circumstances under section 111, 116, 119, or 1007, the Librarian of Congress shall, upon a determination that a controversy exists concerning such distribution, cause to be published in the Federal Register notice of commencement of proceedings under this chapter.

(d) Regarding proceedings under section 801(b)(3) or (4), related to the distribution of royalty fees in specific situations under section 111, 116, 119, or 1007, the Librarian of Congress shall, upon finding that a dispute exists about this distribution, publish a notice in the Federal Register to announce the start of proceedings under this chapter.

————————— Chapter 8 Endnotes

Chapter 8 References

1 The Copyright Royalty Tribunal Reform Act of 1993 amended chapter 8 by substituting a new chapter title heading and by repealing sections 803 and 805 through 810. Pub. L. No. 103-198, 107 Stat. 2304, 2308.

1 The Copyright Royalty Tribunal Reform Act of 1993 updated chapter 8 by changing the chapter title and eliminating sections 803 and 805 through 810. Pub. L. No. 103-198, 107 Stat. 2304, 2308.

2 In 1986, section 801(b) was amended in paragraph (2)(A) by inserting "111(d)(1)(B)" in lieu of "111(d)(2)(B)," wherever it appeared. Pub. L. No. 99-397, 100 Stat. 848. The Satellite Home Viewer Act of 1988 amended section 801(b)(3) by substituting ", 116 and 119(b)" in lieu of "and 116." Pub. L. No. 100-667, 102 Stat. 3935, 3949, 3958. The Copyright Royalty Tribunal Reform Act of 1993 amended section 801 by giving it a new heading, by amending subsection (a) in its entirety, by making conforming amendments throughout subsection (b), by amending the first sentence of subsection (c) and by adding subsection (d). Pub. L. No. 103-198, 107 Stat. 2304. In 1997, section 801 was amended by inserting "119" in the first sentence of subsection (b)(1), by adding paragraphs (1) and (2) of subsection (c) and by amending subsection (d) in its entirety. Pub. L. No. 105-80, 111 Stat. 1529, 1533. In 1998, the Digital Millennium Copyright Act amended the first sentence of section 801(b) by inserting "114(f)(1)(B)" in lieu of "114." Pub. L. No. 105-304, 112 Stat. 2860, 2902.

2 In 1986, section 801(b) was updated in paragraph (2)(A) by replacing "111(d)(2)(B)" with "111(d)(1)(B)" wherever it appeared. Pub. L. No. 99-397, 100 Stat. 848. The Satellite Home Viewer Act of 1988 updated section 801(b)(3) by changing ", 116 and 119(b)" to "and 116." Pub. L. No. 100-667, 102 Stat. 3935, 3949, 3958. The Copyright Royalty Tribunal Reform Act of 1993 revised section 801 by giving it a new title, overhauling subsection (a), making related updates throughout subsection (b), revising the first sentence of subsection (c), and adding subsection (d). Pub. L. No. 103-198, 107 Stat. 2304. In 1997, section 801 was modified by adding "119" to the first sentence of subsection (b)(1), adding paragraphs (1) and (2) to subsection (c), and completely revising subsection (d). Pub. L. No. 105-80, 111 Stat. 1529, 1533. In 1998, the Digital Millennium Copyright Act changed the first sentence of section 801(b) by replacing "114" with "114(f)(1)(B)." Pub. L. No. 105-304, 112 Stat. 2860, 2902.

3 The Copyright Royalty Tribunal Reform Act of 1993 amended section 802 in its entirety. Pub. L. No. 103-198, 107 Stat. 2304, 2305. In 1997, section 802(h)(1) was amended in its entirety. Pub. L. No. 105-80, 111 Stat. 1529.

3 The Copyright Royalty Tribunal Reform Act of 1993 completely revised section 802. Pub. L. No. 103-198, 107 Stat. 2304, 2305. In 1997, section 802(h)(1) was completely revised. Pub. L. No. 105-80, 111 Stat. 1529.

In 1998, the Digital Millennium Copyright Act amended section 802 as follows: 1) in subsection (c), by inserting in the third sentence "any transmitting organization entitled to a statutory license under section 112(f)" after "section 111, 112, 114, 116, and 119"; 2) in subsection (f), by inserting "90" in lieu of "60" in the first sentence and "an additional 30-day period" in lieu of "that additional 60 day period" in the third sentence; 3) in subsection (g), by adding the third sentence, which begins "When this title provides that the royalty rates" and by inserting "112" after "111"; and 4) by inserting "112" after "111" in subsection (h)(2). Pub. L. No. 105-304, 112 Stat. 2860, 2902.

In 1998, the Digital Millennium Copyright Act changed section 802 as follows: 1) in subsection (c), by adding "any transmitting organization entitled to a statutory license under section 112(f)" after "section 111, 112, 114, 116, and 119" in the third sentence; 2) in subsection (f), by replacing "60" with "90" in the first sentence and "that additional 60 day period" with "an additional 30-day period" in the third sentence; 3) in subsection (g), by adding the third sentence that starts with "When this title provides that the royalty rates" and by inserting "112" after "111"; and 4) by adding "112" after "111" in subsection (h)(2). Pub. L. No. 105-304, 112 Stat. 2860, 2902.

4 See title 37, Chapter II, of the *Code of Federal Regulations.*

4 See title 37, Chapter II, of the *Code of Federal Regulations.*

5 The Copyright Royalty Tribunal Reform Act of 1993 redesignated section 804 as section 803 and amended the newly designated section 803 in its entirety. Pub. L. No. 103-198, 107 Stat. 2304, 2307. In 1995, the Digital Performance Right in Sound Recordings Act amended section 803(a) by adding paragraph (5) and by making conforming amendments throughout chapter 8. Pub. L. No. 104-39, 109 Stat. 336, 349. In 1998, the Digital Millennium Copyright Act amended section 803(a) by inserting "112" before "114" in paragraphs (1) and (5) and by substituting "those sections" in lieu of "that section" in paragraph (5). Pub. L. No. 105-304, 112 Stat. 2860, 2902.

5 The Copyright Royalty Tribunal Reform Act of 1993 changed section 804 to section 803 and fully revised the newly designated section 803. Pub. L. No. 103-198, 107 Stat. 2304, 2307. In 1995, the Digital Performance Right in Sound Recordings Act updated section 803(a) by adding paragraph (5) and making related changes throughout chapter 8. Pub. L. No. 104-39, 109 Stat. 336, 349. In 1998, the Digital Millennium Copyright Act modified section 803(a) by inserting "112" before "114" in paragraphs (1) and (5) and by replacing "that section" with "those sections" in paragraph (5). Pub. L. No. 105-304, 112 Stat. 2860, 2902.

————————————————————————————————————

Understood! Please provide the text you'd like me to modernize.

Chapter 9 [1]

Protection of Semiconductor Chip Products

Protection of Semiconductor Chip Products

+ 901. Definitions + 902. Subject matter of protection + 903. Ownership, transfer, licensure, and recordation [2] + 904. Duration of protection + 905. Exclusive rights in mask works + 906. Limitation on exclusive rights: reverse engineering; first sale + 907. Limitation on exclusive rights: innocent infringement + 908. Registration of claims of protection + 909. Mask work notice + 910. Enforcement of exclusive rights + 911. Civil actions + 912. Relation to other laws + 913. Transitional provisions + 914. International transitional provisions

+ 901. Definitions + 902. Subject matter of protection + 903. Ownership, transfer, licensing, and recording [2] + 904. Duration of protection + 905. Exclusive rights in mask works + 906. Limitations on exclusive rights: reverse engineering; first sale + 907. Limitations on exclusive rights: innocent infringement + 908. Claims for protection registration + 909. Mask work notice + 910. Enforcement of exclusive rights + 911. Civil actions + 912. Relation to other laws + 913. Transitional provisions + 914. International transitional provisions

Section 901. Definitions

(a) As used in this chapter

(a) As used in this chapter

(1) a "semiconductor chip product" is the final or intermediate form of any product-

(1) a "semiconductor chip product" is the final or intermediate form of any product-

(A) having two or more layers of metallic, insulating, or semiconductor material, deposited or otherwise placed on, or etched away or otherwise removed from, a piece of semiconductor material in accordance with a predetermined pattern; and

(A) having two or more layers of metal, insulating, or semiconductor material, applied or placed on, or etched away or otherwise removed from, a piece of semiconductor material according to a specific pattern; and

(B) intended to perform electronic circuitry functions;

(B) meant to carry out electronic circuit functions;

(2) a "mask work" is a series of related images, however fixed or encoded-

(2) a "mask work" is a set of connected images, whether they're fixed or encoded-

(A) having or representing the predetermined, three-dimensional pattern of metallic, insulating, or semiconductor material present or removed from the layers of a semiconductor chip product; and

(A) having or representing the set, three-dimensional design of metallic, insulating, or semiconductor material that is either present or removed from the layers of a semiconductor chip product; and

(B) in which series the relation of the images to one another is that each image has the pattern of the surface of one form of the semiconductor chip product;

(B) in which series the relationship of the images to each other is that each image reflects the pattern on the surface of one type of semiconductor chip product;

(3) a mask work is "fixed" in a semiconductor chip product when its embodiment in the product is sufficiently permanent or stable to permit the mask work to be perceived or reproduced from the product for a period of more than transitory duration;

(3) a mask work is "fixed" in a semiconductor chip product when its representation in the product is stable or permanent enough for the mask work to be seen or reproduced from the product for a duration that is longer than temporary;

(4) to "distribute" means to sell, or to lease, bail, or otherwise transfer, or to offer to sell, lease, bail, or otherwise transfer;

(4) to "distribute" means to sell, lease, bail, or transfer in any other way, or to offer to sell, lease, bail, or transfer in any other way;

(5) to "commercially exploit" a mask work is to distribute to the public for commercial purposes a semiconductor chip product embodying the mask work; except that such term includes an offer to sell or transfer a semiconductor chip product only when the offer is in writing and occurs after the mask work is fixed in the semiconductor chip product;

(5) To "commercially exploit" a mask work means to sell or distribute to the public a semiconductor chip product that includes the mask work for commercial reasons; however, this term also covers an offer to sell or transfer a semiconductor chip product, but only if the offer is in writing and takes place after the mask work has been incorporated into the semiconductor chip product;

(6) the "owner" of a mask work is the person who created the mask work, the legal representative of that person if that person is deceased or under a legal incapacity, or a party to whom all the rights under this chapter of such person or representative are transferred in accordance with section 903(b); except that, in the case of a work made within the scope of a person's employment, the owner is the employer for whom the person created the mask work or a party to whom all the rights under this chapter of the employer are transferred in accordance with section 903(b);

(6) The "owner" of a mask work is the person who created it, the legal representative of that person if they have passed away or cannot make decisions, or anyone to whom all the rights under this chapter of that person or their representative have been transferred according to section 903(b); except that, if the work was created as part of someone’s job, the owner is the employer for whom the work was created or anyone to whom all the rights under this chapter of the employer have been transferred according to section 903(b);

(7) an "innocent purchaser" is a person who purchases a semiconductor chip product in good faith and without having notice of protection with respect to the semiconductor chip product;

(7) an "innocent purchaser" is someone who buys a semiconductor chip product honestly and without knowing about any protections related to the semiconductor chip product;

(8) having "notice of protection" means having actual knowledge that, or reasonable grounds to believe that, a mask work is protected under this chapter; and

(8) having "notice of protection" means having actual knowledge that, or reasonable grounds to believe that, a mask work is protected under this chapter; and

(9) an "infringing semiconductor chip product" is a semiconductor chip product which is made, imported, or distributed in violation of the exclusive rights of the owner of a mask work under this chapter.

(9) an "infringing semiconductor chip product" is a semiconductor chip product that is made, imported, or distributed in violation of the exclusive rights of the owner of a mask work under this chapter.

(b) For purposes of this chapter, the distribution or importation of a product incorporating a semiconductor chip product as a part thereof is a distribution or importation of that semiconductor chip product.

(b) For this chapter, distributing or importing a product that includes a semiconductor chip is considered distributing or importing that semiconductor chip.

Section 902. Subject matter of protection [3]

(a)(1) Subject to the provisions of subsection (b), a mask work fixed in a semiconductor chip product, by or under the authority of the owner of the mask work, is eligible for protection under this chapter if-

(a)(1) Following the rules in subsection (b), a mask work that is embedded in a semiconductor chip product, created by or authorized by the owner of the mask work, can be protected under this chapter if-

(A) on the date on which the mask work is registered under section 908, or is first commercially exploited anywhere in the world, whichever occurs first, the owner of the mask work is (i) a national or domiciliary of the United States, (ii) a national, domiciliary, or sovereign authority of a foreign nation that is a party to a treaty affording protection to mask works to which the United States is also a party, or (iii) a stateless person, wherever that person may be domiciled;

(A) on the date the mask work is registered under section 908, or is first commercially used anywhere in the world, whichever comes first, the owner of the mask work is (i) a citizen or resident of the United States, (ii) a citizen, resident, or government authority of a foreign nation that is a party to a treaty, providing protection to mask works that the United States is also a part of, or (iii) a stateless person, no matter where that person lives;

(B) the mask work is first commercially exploited in the United States; or

(B) the mask work is first used commercially in the United States;

(C) the mask work comes within the scope of a Presidential proclamation issued under paragraph (2).

(C) the mask work falls under a Presidential proclamation issued according to paragraph (2).

(2) Whenever the President finds that a foreign nation extends, to mask works of owners who are nationals or domiciliaries of the United States protection (A) on substantially the same basis as that on which the foreign nation extends protection to mask works of its own nationals and domiciliaries and mask works first commercially exploited in that nation, or (B) on substantially the same basis as provided in this chapter, the President may by proclamation extend protection under this chapter to mask works (i) of owners who are, on the date on which the mask works are registered under section 908, or the date on which the mask works are first commercially exploited anywhere in the world, whichever occurs first, nationals, domiciliaries, or sovereign authorities of that nation, or (ii) which are first commercially exploited in that nation. The President may revise, suspend, or revoke any such proclamation or impose any conditions or limitations on protection extended under any such proclamation.

(2) Whenever the President determines that a foreign country provides protection for mask works created by owners who are citizens or residents of the United States, either (A) on a similar basis as it does for its own citizens and residents, as well as for works first commercially used in that country, or (B) on a basis similar to what is outlined in this chapter, the President may, through a proclamation, extend protection under this chapter to mask works (i) of owners who are, on the date the mask works are registered under section 908, or the date they are first commercially exploited anywhere in the world—whichever comes first—citizens, residents, or government entities of that country, or (ii) that are first commercially exploited in that country. The President has the authority to modify, pause, or cancel any such proclamation or impose conditions or limitations on the protection granted under any such proclamation.

(b) Protection under this chapter shall not be available for a mask work that-

(b) Protection under this chapter won’t be available for a mask work that-

(1) is not original; or

is not original; or

(2) consists of designs that are staple, commonplace, or familiar in the semiconductor industry, or variations of such designs, combined in a way that, considered as a whole, is not original.

(2) consists of designs that are standard, common, or familiar in the semiconductor industry, or variations of such designs, combined in a way that, when viewed as a whole, is not original.

(c) In no case does protection under this chapter for a mask work extend to any idea, procedure, process, system, method of operation, concept, principle, or discovery, regardless of the form in which it is described, explained, illustrated, or embodied in such work.

(c) In no situation does protection under this chapter for a mask work cover any idea, procedure, process, system, method of operation, concept, principle, or discovery, no matter how it is described, explained, illustrated, or presented in that work.

Section 903. Ownership, transfer, licensing, and recordation

(a) The exclusive rights in a mask work subject to protection under this chapter belong to the owner of the mask work.

(a) The exclusive rights to a mask work that are protected under this chapter belong to the owner of the mask work.

(b) The owner of the exclusive rights in a mask work may transfer all of those rights, or license all or less than all of those rights, by any written instrument signed by such owner or a duly authorized agent of the owner. Such rights may be transferred or licensed by operation of law, may be bequeathed by will, and may pass as personal property by the applicable laws of intestate succession.

(b) The owner of the exclusive rights to a mask work can transfer all those rights, or license all or part of them, through any written document signed by the owner or an authorized agent. These rights can also be transferred or licensed by law, can be left in a will, and can be passed on as personal property under the relevant laws of intestate succession.

(c)(1) Any document pertaining to a mask work may be recorded in the Copyright Office if the document filed for recordation bears the actual signature of the person who executed it, or if it is accompanied by a sworn or official certification that it is a true copy of the original, signed document. The Register of Copyrights shall, upon receipt of the document and the fee specified pursuant to section 908(d), record the document and return it with a certificate of recordation. The recordation of any transfer or license under this paragraph gives all persons constructive notice of the facts stated in the recorded document concerning the transfer or license.

(c)(1) Any document related to a mask work can be recorded in the Copyright Office if it has the actual signature of the person who signed it, or if it's accompanied by a sworn statement or official certification confirming that it is a true copy of the original signed document. The Register of Copyrights will, upon receiving the document and the specified fee under section 908(d), record the document and send it back with a certificate of record. Recording any transfer or license under this section provides all individuals with constructive notice of the details mentioned in the recorded document regarding the transfer or license.

(2) In any case in which conflicting transfers of the exclusive rights in a mask work are made, the transfer first executed shall be void as against a subsequent transfer which is made for a valuable consideration and without notice of the first transfer, unless the first transfer is recorded in accordance with paragraph (1) within three months after the date on which it is executed, but in no case later than the day before the date of such subsequent transfer.

(2) In any situation where there are conflicting transfers of exclusive rights in a mask work, the first transfer will be invalid if a subsequent transfer is made for valuable consideration and without knowledge of the first transfer, unless the first transfer is recorded as stated in paragraph (1) within three months after it is executed, but not later than the day before the date of the subsequent transfer.

(d) Mask works prepared by an officer or employee of the United States Government as part of that person's official duties are not protected under this chapter, but the United States Government is not precluded from receiving and holding exclusive rights in mask works transferred to the Government under subsection (b).

(d) Mask works created by an officer or employee of the United States Government as part of their official duties are not protected under this chapter, but the United States Government can still receive and hold exclusive rights to mask works transferred to the Government under subsection (b).

Section 904. Duration of protection

(a) The protection provided for a mask work under this chapter shall commence on the date on which the mask work is registered under section 908, or the date on which the mask work is first commercially exploited anywhere in the world, whichever occurs first.

(a) The protection for a mask work under this chapter will start on the date the mask work is registered under section 908, or the date the mask work is first commercially used anywhere in the world, whichever happens first.

(b) Subject to subsection (c) and the provisions of this chapter, the protection provided under this chapter to a mask work shall end ten years after the date on which such protection commences under subsection (a).

(b) Depending on subsection (c) and the rules of this chapter, the protection given to a mask work under this chapter will expire ten years after the start date of that protection according to subsection (a).

(c) All terms of protection provided in this section shall run to the end of the calendar year in which they would otherwise expire.

(c) All protection terms outlined in this section will extend until the end of the calendar year in which they would typically expire.

Section 905. Exclusive rights in mask works

The owner of a mask work provided protection under this chapter has the exclusive rights to do and to authorize any of the following:

The owner of a mask work provided protection under this chapter has the exclusive rights to do and to authorize any of the following:

(1) to reproduce the mask work by optical, electronic, or any other means;

(1) to reproduce the mask work using optical, electronic, or any other methods;

(2) to import or distribute a semiconductor chip product in which the mask work is embodied; and

(2) to import or distribute a semiconductor chip product that includes the mask work; and

(3) to induce or knowingly to cause another person to do any of the acts described in paragraphs (1) and (2).

(3) to persuade or intentionally lead someone else to do any of the actions described in paragraphs (1) and (2).

Section 906. Limitation on exclusive rights: reverse engineering; first sale

(a) Notwithstanding the provisions of section 905, it is not an infringement of the exclusive rights of the owner of a mask work for-

(a) Despite what’s stated in section 905, it’s not a violation of the exclusive rights of the owner of a mask work for-

(1) a person to reproduce the mask work solely for the purpose of teaching, analyzing, or evaluating the concepts or techniques embodied in the mask work or the circuitry, logic flow, or organization of components used in the mask work; or

(1) a person to recreate the mask work only for the purpose of teaching, analyzing, or evaluating the concepts or techniques involved in the mask work or the circuitry, logic flow, or organization of components used in the mask work; or

(2) a person who performs the analysis or evaluation described in paragraph (1) to incorporate the results of such conduct in an original mask work which is made to be distributed.

(2) a person who analyzes or evaluates as described in paragraph (1) to include the results of that work in a new mask work that is intended for distribution.

(b) Notwithstanding the provisions of section 905(2), the owner of a particular semiconductor chip product made by the owner of the mask work, or by any person authorized by the owner of the mask work, may import, distribute, or otherwise dispose of or use, but not reproduce, that particular semiconductor chip product without the authority of the owner of the mask work.

(b) Regardless of what section 905(2) says, the owner of a specific semiconductor chip product made by the owner of the mask work, or by anyone authorized by the owner of the mask work, can import, distribute, or otherwise sell or use that specific semiconductor chip product, but they cannot reproduce it without the owner's permission.

Section 907. Limitation on exclusive rights: innocent infringement

(a) Notwithstanding any other provision of this chapter, an innocent purchaser of an infringing semiconductor chip product-

(a) Regardless of any other rule in this chapter, a buyer who unknowingly purchases an infringing semiconductor chip product-

(1) shall incur no liability under this chapter with respect to the importation or distribution of units of the infringing semiconductor chip product that occurs before the innocent purchaser has notice of protection with respect to the mask work embodied in the semiconductor chip product; and

(1) will not be held responsible under this chapter for the importation or distribution of units of the infringing semiconductor chip product that happens before the unknowing buyer is aware of the protection regarding the mask work included in the semiconductor chip product; and

(2) shall be liable only for a reasonable royalty on each unit of the infringing semiconductor chip product that the innocent purchaser imports or distributes after having notice of protection with respect to the mask work embodied in the semiconductor chip product.

(2) will only be responsible for a fair royalty on each unit of the infringing semiconductor chip product that the unaware buyer imports or distributes after being notified about the protection relating to the mask work included in the semiconductor chip product.

(b) The amount of the royalty referred to in subsection (a)(2) shall be determined by the court in a civil action for infringement unless the parties resolve the issue by voluntary negotiation, mediation, or binding arbitration.

(b) The amount of the royalty mentioned in subsection (a)(2) will be set by the court in a civil lawsuit for infringement unless the parties solve the issue through voluntary negotiation, mediation, or binding arbitration.

(c) The immunity of an innocent purchaser from liability referred to in subsection (a)(1) and the limitation of remedies with respect to an innocent purchaser referred to in subsection (a)(2) shall extend to any person who directly or indirectly purchases an infringing semiconductor chip product from an innocent purchaser.

(c) The protection for an innocent buyer from liability mentioned in subsection (a)(1) and the limitations on remedies for an innocent buyer noted in subsection (a)(2) will also apply to anyone who directly or indirectly buys an infringing semiconductor chip product from an innocent buyer.

(d) The provisions of subsections (a), (b), and (c) apply only with respect to those units of an infringing semiconductor chip product that an innocent purchaser purchased before having notice of protection with respect to the mask work embodied in the semiconductor chip product.

(d) The rules in subsections (a), (b), and (c) only apply to those units of a semiconductor chip product that an innocent buyer bought before they were aware of the protection related to the mask work included in the semiconductor chip product.

Section 908. Registration of claims of protection

(a) The owner of a mask work may apply to the Register of Copyrights for registration of a claim of protection in a mask work. Protection of a mask work under this chapter shall terminate if application for registration of a claim of protection in the mask work is not made as provided in this chapter within two years after the date on which the mask work is first commercially exploited anywhere in the world.

(a) The owner of a mask work can apply to the Register of Copyrights to register a claim for protection of that mask work. Protection for a mask work under this chapter will end if the application for registration of the protection claim is not made as outlined in this chapter within two years after the mask work is first commercially used anywhere in the world.

(b) The Register of Copyrights shall be responsible for all administrative functions and duties under this chapter. Except for section 708, the provisions of chapter 7 of this title relating to the general responsibilities, organization, regulatory authority, actions, records, and publications of the Copyright Office shall apply to this chapter, except that the Register of Copyrights may make such changes as may be necessary in applying those provisions to this chapter.

(b) The Register of Copyrights will manage all administrative tasks and responsibilities under this chapter. With the exception of section 708, the rules in chapter 7 of this title concerning the overall responsibilities, structure, regulatory power, actions, records, and publications of the Copyright Office will apply to this chapter. However, the Register of Copyrights can make any necessary adjustments to apply those rules to this chapter.

(c) The application for registration of a mask work shall be made on a form prescribed by the Register of Copyrights. Such form may require any information regarded by the Register as bearing upon the preparation or identification of the mask work, the existence or duration of protection of the mask work under this chapter, or ownership of the mask work. The application shall be accompanied by the fee set pursuant to subsection (d) and the identifying material specified pursuant to such subsection.

(c) The application to register a mask work must be completed on a form provided by the Register of Copyrights. This form may ask for any information that the Register considers relevant to the creation or identification of the mask work, the existence or length of its protection under this chapter, or its ownership. The application must be submitted with the fee outlined in subsection (d) and the identifying material required by that subsection.

(d) The Register of Copyrights shall by regulation set reasonable fees for the filing of applications to register claims of protection in mask works under this chapter, and for other services relating to the administration of this chapter or the rights under this chapter, taking into consideration the cost of providing those services, the benefits of a public record, and statutory fee schedules under this title. The Register shall also specify the identifying material to be deposited in connection with the claim for registration.

(d) The Register of Copyrights will set reasonable fees through regulations for filing applications to register claims of protection for mask works under this chapter, as well as for other services related to the administration of this chapter or the rights under this chapter. This will take into account the costs of providing those services, the benefits of having a public record, and the statutory fee schedules under this title. The Register will also outline the identifying materials that need to be submitted with the registration claim.

(e) If the Register of Copyrights, after examining an application for registration, determines, in accordance with the provisions of this chapter, that the application relates to a mask work which is entitled to protection under this chapter, then the Register shall register the claim of protection and issue to the applicant a certificate of registration of the claim of protection under the seal of the Copyright Office. The effective date of registration of a claim of protection shall be the date on which an application, deposit of identifying material, and fee, which are determined by the Register of Copyrights or by a court of competent jurisdiction to be acceptable for registration of the claim, have all been received in the Copyright Office.

(e) If the Register of Copyrights, after reviewing a registration application, finds that the application pertains to a mask work that qualifies for protection under this chapter, then the Register will register the protection claim and provide the applicant with a certificate of registration under the seal of the Copyright Office. The effective date of the registration will be the date on which the application, the submission of identifying material, and the fee—deemed acceptable for registration of the claim by the Register of Copyrights or a court with the proper authority—have all been received by the Copyright Office.

(f) In any action for infringement under this chapter, the certificate of registration of a mask work shall constitute prima facie evidence (1) of the facts stated in the certificate, and (2) that the applicant issued the certificate has met the requirements of this chapter, and the regulations issued under this chapter, with respect to the registration of claims.

(f) In any lawsuit for infringement under this chapter, the registration certificate of a mask work will serve as clear evidence (1) of the facts mentioned in the certificate, and (2) that the person who issued the certificate has fulfilled the requirements of this chapter and the regulations made under this chapter regarding the registration of claims.

(g) Any applicant for registration under this section who is dissatisfied with the refusal of the Register of Copyrights to issue a certificate of registration under this section may seek judicial review of that refusal by bringing an action for such review in an appropriate United States district court not later than sixty days after the refusal. The provisions of chapter 7 of title 5 shall apply to such judicial review. The failure of the Register of Copyrights to issue a certificate of registration within four months after an application for registration is filed shall be deemed to be a refusal to issue a certificate of registration for purposes of this subsection and section 910(b)(2), except that, upon a showing of good cause, the district court may shorten such four-month period.

(g) Anyone applying for registration under this section who is unhappy with the Register of Copyrights’ refusal to issue a registration certificate can request a judicial review of that refusal by filing a lawsuit in the appropriate United States district court no later than sixty days after the refusal. The rules in chapter 7 of title 5 apply to this judicial review. If the Register of Copyrights doesn't issue a registration certificate within four months after an application is submitted, it will be considered a refusal to issue a registration certificate for this subsection and section 910(b)(2). However, the district court may shorten this four-month period if good cause is shown.

Section 909. Mask work notice [4]

(a) The owner of a mask work provided protection under this chapter may affix notice to the mask work, and to masks and semiconductor chip products embodying the mask work, in such manner and location as to give reasonable notice of such protection. The Register of Copyrights shall prescribe by regulation, as examples, specific methods of affixation and positions of notice for purposes of this section, but these specifications shall not be considered exhaustive. The affixation of such notice is not a condition of protection under this chapter, but shall constitute prima facie evidence of notice of protection.

(a) The owner of a mask work that is protected under this chapter can attach a notice to the mask work, as well as to the masks and semiconductor chip products that incorporate the mask work, in a way and location that gives reasonable notice of that protection. The Register of Copyrights will set regulations providing specific methods for attaching the notice and suggested positions for it, but these guidelines won't be seen as complete. Adding this notice is not a requirement for protection under this chapter, but it will serve as prima facie evidence of notice of protection.

(b) The notice referred to in subsection (a) shall consist of-

(b) The notice mentioned in subsection (a) must include-

(1) the words "mask work", the symbol *M*, or the symbol [M in a circle] (the letter M in a circle); and

(1) the words "mask work", the symbol *M*, or the symbol [M in a circle] (the letter M in a circle); and

(2) the name of the owner or owners of the mask work or an abbreviation by which the name is recognized or is generally known.

(2) the name of the owner or owners of the mask work or an abbreviation that identifies the name as it is recognized or commonly known.

Section 910. Enforcement of exclusive rights [5]

(a) Except as otherwise provided in this chapter, any person who violates any of the exclusive rights of the owner of a mask work under this chapter, by conduct in or affecting commerce, shall be liable as an infringer of such rights. As used in this subsection, the term "any person" includes any State, any instrumentality of a State, and any officer or employee of a State or instrumentality of a State acting in his or her official capacity. Any State, and any such instrumentality, officer, or employee, shall be subject to the provisions of this chapter in the same manner and to the same extent as any nongovernmental entity.

(a) Unless stated otherwise in this chapter, anyone who violates the exclusive rights of a mask work owner under this chapter, through actions related to commerce, will be considered an infringer of those rights. In this subsection, the term "anyone" also includes any State, any State agency, and any officer or employee of a State or agency acting in their official role. Any State, as well as any such agency, officer, or employee, will be subject to the rules of this chapter just like any private entity.

(b)(1) The owner of a mask work protected under this chapter, or the exclusive licensee of all rights under this chapter with respect to the mask work, shall, after a certificate of registration of a claim of protection in that mask work has been issued under section 908, be entitled to institute a civil action for any infringement with respect to the mask work which is committed after the commencement of protection of the mask work under section 904(a).

(b)(1) The owner of a mask work protected under this chapter, or the exclusive licensee of all rights related to the mask work, can, after receiving a certificate of registration for a claim of protection in that mask work under section 908, file a civil lawsuit for any infringement involving the mask work that happens after the protection for the mask work starts under section 904(a).

(2) In any case in which an application for registration of a claim of protection in a mask work and the required deposit of identifying material and fee have been received in the Copyright Office in proper form and registration of the mask work has been refused, the applicant is entitled to institute a civil action for infringement under this chapter with respect to the mask work if notice of the action, together with a copy of the complaint, is served on the Register of Copyrights, in accordance with the Federal Rules of Civil Procedure. The Register may, at his or her option, become a party to the action with respect to the issue of whether the claim of protection is eligible for registration by entering an appearance within sixty days after such service, but the failure of the Register to become a party to the action shall not deprive the court of jurisdiction to determine that issue.

(2) If an application to register a claim for protection of a mask work and the necessary deposit of identifying material and fee have been properly submitted to the Copyright Office, and registration of the mask work has been denied, the applicant has the right to file a civil lawsuit for infringement under this chapter regarding the mask work. This is contingent upon providing notice of the lawsuit, along with a copy of the complaint, to the Register of Copyrights, in accordance with the Federal Rules of Civil Procedure. The Register can choose to join the lawsuit on the question of whether the protection claim qualifies for registration by entering an appearance within sixty days of receiving that notice. However, if the Register does not join the lawsuit, it does not affect the court's ability to decide on that issue.

(c)(1) The Secretary of the Treasury and the United States Postal Service shall separately or jointly issue regulations for the enforcement of the rights set forth in section 905 with respect to importation. These regulations may require, as a condition for the exclusion of articles from the United States, that the person seeking exclusion take any one or more of the following actions:

(c)(1) The Secretary of the Treasury and the United States Postal Service will issue regulations either separately or together to enforce the rights outlined in section 905 regarding imports. These regulations may require that anyone requesting the exclusion of items from the United States must take one or more of the following actions:

(A) Obtain a court order enjoining, or an order of the International Trade Commission under section 337 of the Tariff Act of 1930 excluding, importation of the articles.

(A) Get a court order to stop, or an order from the International Trade Commission under section 337 of the Tariff Act of 1930 prohibiting, the import of the items.

(B) Furnish proof that the mask work involved is protected under this chapter and that the importation of the articles would infringe the rights in the mask work under this chapter.

(B) Provide evidence that the mask work in question is protected under this chapter and that importing the items would violate the rights related to the mask work under this chapter.

(C) Post a surety bond for any injury that may result if the detention or exclusion of the articles proves to be unjustified.

(C) Post a surety bond for any injury that may occur if the detention or exclusion of the items turns out to be unjustified.

(2) Articles imported in violation of the rights set forth in section 905 are subject to seizure and forfeiture in the same manner as property imported in violation of the customs laws. Any such forfeited articles shall be destroyed as directed by the Secretary of the Treasury or the court, as the case may be, except that the articles may be returned to the country of export whenever it is shown to the satisfaction of the Secretary of the Treasury that the importer had no reasonable grounds for believing that his or her acts constituted a violation of the law.

(2) Items brought in against the rights listed in section 905 can be seized and forfeited just like goods that violate customs laws. Any items that are forfeited will be destroyed as directed by the Secretary of the Treasury or the court, depending on the situation. However, these items can be sent back to the country of export if the Secretary of the Treasury is convinced that the importer had no reasonable basis for thinking that their actions broke the law.

Section 911. Civil actions [6]

(a) Any court having jurisdiction of a civil action arising under this chapter may grant temporary restraining orders, preliminary injunctions, and permanent injunctions on such terms as the court may deem reasonable to prevent or restrain infringement of the exclusive rights in a mask work under this chapter.

(a) Any court with jurisdiction over a civil action under this chapter can issue temporary restraining orders, preliminary injunctions, and permanent injunctions on terms that the court finds reasonable to prevent or stop the infringement of exclusive rights in a mask work under this chapter.

(b) Upon finding an infringer liable, to a person entitled under section 910(b)(1) to institute a civil action, for an infringement of any exclusive right under this chapter, the court shall award such person actual damages suffered by the person as a result of the infringement. The court shall also award such person the infringer's profits that are attributable to the infringement and are not taken into account in computing the award of actual damages. In establishing the infringer's profits, such person is required to present proof only of the infringer's gross revenue, and the infringer is required to prove his or her deductible expenses and the elements of profit attributable to factors other than the mask work.

(b) If the court finds someone guilty of infringement, a person who has the right under section 910(b)(1) to file a civil lawsuit for an infringement of any exclusive right under this chapter will be awarded the actual damages they suffered as a result of the infringement. The court will also give that person the profits made by the infringer that are linked to the infringement and not included in the actual damages awarded. To establish the infringer's profits, the person only needs to show proof of the infringer's total revenue, while the infringer must prove their deductible expenses and any profits from factors other than the mask work.

(c) At any time before final judgment is rendered, a person entitled to institute a civil action for infringement may elect, instead of actual damages and profits as provided by subsection (b), an award of statutory damages for all infringements involved in the action, with respect to any one mask work for which any one infringer is liable individually, or for which any two or more infringers are liable jointly and severally, in an amount not more than $250,000 as the court considers just.

(c) Before a final judgment is made, someone entitled to file a civil lawsuit for infringement can choose to receive statutory damages instead of actual damages and profits, as mentioned in subsection (b). This applies to all infringements related to a single mask work for which one infringer is individually responsible, or for which two or more infringers are jointly and severally liable, with an amount not exceeding $250,000 as deemed fair by the court.

(d) An action for infringement under this chapter shall be barred unless the action is commenced within three years after the claim accrues.

(d) A lawsuit for infringement under this chapter will be blocked unless the lawsuit is started within three years after the claim arises.

(e)(1) At any time while an action for infringement of the exclusive rights in a mask work under this chapter is pending, the court may order the impounding, on such terms as it may deem reasonable, of all semiconductor chip products, and any drawings, tapes, masks, or other products by means of which such products may be reproduced, that are claimed to have been made, imported, or used in violation of those exclusive rights. Insofar as practicable, applications for orders under this paragraph shall be heard and determined in the same manner as an application for a temporary restraining order or preliminary injunction.

(e)(1) At any time while a lawsuit for infringement of exclusive rights in a mask work under this chapter is ongoing, the court may order the impounding, on terms it considers reasonable, of all semiconductor chip products, along with any drawings, tapes, masks, or other items that could be used to reproduce those products, which are claimed to have been made, imported, or used in violation of those exclusive rights. As much as possible, applications for orders under this paragraph should be heard and decided in the same way as an application for a temporary restraining order or preliminary injunction.

(2) As part of a final judgment or decree, the court may order the destruction or other disposition of any infringing semiconductor chip products, and any masks, tapes, or other articles by means of which such products may be reproduced.

(2) As part of a final judgment or decree, the court may order the destruction or other disposal of any infringing semiconductor chip products, as well as any masks, tapes, or other items used to reproduce such products.

(f) In any civil action arising under this chapter, the court in its discretion may allow the recovery of full costs, including reasonable attorneys' fees, to the prevailing party.

(f) In any civil action under this chapter, the court may, at its discretion, allow the winning party to recover full costs, including reasonable attorneys' fees.

(g)(1) Any State, any instrumentality of a State, and any officer or employee of a State or instrumentality of a State acting in his or her official capacity, shall not be immune, under the Eleventh Amendment of the Constitution of the United States or under any other doctrine of sovereign immunity, from suit in Federal court by any person, including any governmental or nongovernmental entity, for a violation of any of the exclusive rights of the owner of a mask work under this chapter, or for any other violation under this chapter.

(g)(1) No state, any part of a state, or any officer or employee of a state or its part acting in their official role is protected under the Eleventh Amendment of the United States Constitution or any other principle of sovereign immunity from being sued in federal court by anyone, including government and non-government entities, for violating any of the exclusive rights of a mask work owner under this chapter, or for any other breach under this chapter.

(2) In a suit described in paragraph (1) for a violation described in that paragraph, remedies (including remedies both at law and in equity) are available for the violation to the same extent as such remedies are available for such a violation in a suit against any public or private entity other than a State, instrumentality of a State, or officer or employee of a State acting in his or her official capacity. Such remedies include actual damages and profits under subsection (b), statutory damages under subsection (c), impounding and disposition of infringing articles under subsection (e), and costs and attorney's fees under subsection (f).

(2) In a case mentioned in paragraph (1) for a violation described there, remedies (including both legal and equitable remedies) are available for the violation just like they would be in a lawsuit against any public or private entity, except for a State, a State instrumentality, or a State officer or employee acting in their official role. These remedies include actual damages and profits under subsection (b), statutory damages under subsection (c), confiscation and disposal of infringing items under subsection (e), and costs and attorney's fees under subsection (f).

Section 912. Relation to other laws [7]

(a) Nothing in this chapter shall affect any right or remedy held by any person under chapters 1 through 8 or 10 of this title, or under title 35.

(a) Nothing in this chapter will impact any rights or remedies that any person has under chapters 1 through 8 or 10 of this title, or under title 35.

(b) Except as provided in section 908(b) of this title, references to "this title" or "title 17" in chapters 1 through 8 or 10 of this title shall be deemed not to apply to this chapter.

(b) Except as stated in section 908(b) of this title, mentions of "this title" or "title 17" in chapters 1 through 8 or 10 of this title will not be considered applicable to this chapter.

(c) The provisions of this chapter shall preempt the laws of any State to the extent those laws provide any rights or remedies with respect to a mask work which are equivalent to those rights or remedies provided by this chapter, except that such preemption shall be effective only with respect to actions filed on or after January 1, 1986.

(c) The rules in this chapter will take priority over any State laws that offer rights or remedies related to a mask work that are similar to those provided by this chapter, but this priority will only apply to actions filed on or after January 1, 1986.

(d) Notwithstanding subsection (c), nothing in this chapter shall detract from any rights of a mask work owner, whether under Federal law (exclusive of this chapter) or under the common law or the statutes of a State, heretofore or hereafter declared or enacted, with respect to any mask work first commercially exploited before July 1, 1983.

(d) Even with subsection (c), nothing in this chapter will take away any rights of a mask work owner, whether under Federal law (not including this chapter) or under state law or common law, that have been established or enacted before or after, regarding any mask work that was first commercially used before July 1, 1983.

Section 913. Transitional provisions

(a) No application for registration under section 908 may be filed, and no civil action under section 910 or other enforcement proceeding under this chapter may be instituted, until sixty days after the date of the enactment of this chapter.

(a) No application for registration under section 908 can be submitted, and no civil action under section 910 or other enforcement action under this chapter can be started, until sixty days after the date this chapter is enacted.

(b) No monetary relief under section 911 may be granted with respect to any conduct that occurred before the date of the enactment of this chapter, except as provided in subsection (d).

(b) No financial relief under section 911 can be granted for any actions that happened before the date this chapter was enacted, except as stated in subsection (d).

(c) Subject to subsection (a), the provisions of this chapter apply to all mask works that are first commercially exploited or are registered under this chapter, or both, on or after the date of the enactment of this chapter.

(c) Following subsection (a), the rules in this chapter apply to all mask works that are either first commercially used or registered under this chapter, or both, on or after the date this chapter was enacted.

(d)(1) Subject to subsection (a), protection is available under this chapter to any mask work that was first commercially exploited on or after July 1, 1983, and before the date of the enactment of this chapter, if a claim of protection in the mask work is registered in the Copyright Office before July 1, 1985, under section 908.

(d)(1) According to subsection (a), protection is available under this chapter for any mask work that was first commercially used on or after July 1, 1983, and before the date this chapter was enacted, as long as a claim for protection of the mask work is registered with the Copyright Office before July 1, 1985, under section 908.

(2) In the case of any mask work described in paragraph (1) that is provided protection under this chapter, infringing semiconductor chip product units manufactured before the date of the enactment of this chapter may, without liability under sections 910 and 911, be imported into or distributed in the United States, or both, until two years after the date of registration of the mask work under section 908, but only if the importer or distributor, as the case may be, first pays or offers to pay the reasonable royalty referred to in section 907(a)(2) to the mask work owner, on all such units imported or distributed, or both, after the date of the enactment of this chapter.

(2) In the case of any mask work mentioned in paragraph (1) that receives protection under this chapter, semiconductor chip products made before this chapter was enacted can be imported or distributed in the United States, or both, without liability under sections 910 and 911, until two years after the mask work is registered under section 908. However, this is only allowed if the importer or distributor pays or offers to pay the reasonable royalty referred to in section 907(a)(2) to the mask work owner for all units imported or distributed after this chapter was enacted.

(3) In the event that a person imports or distributes infringing semiconductor chip product units described in paragraph (2) of this subsection without first paying or offering to pay the reasonable royalty specified in such paragraph, or if the person refuses or fails to make such payment, the mask work owner shall be entitled to the relief provided in sections 910 and 911.

(3) If someone imports or distributes semiconductor chip products mentioned in paragraph (2) of this subsection without first paying or offering to pay the reasonable royalty outlined in that paragraph, or if the person refuses or fails to make that payment, the mask work owner is entitled to the relief provided in sections 910 and 911.

Section 914. International transitional provisions [8]

(a) Notwithstanding the conditions set forth in subparagraphs (A) and (C) of section 902(a)(1) with respect to the availability of protection under this chapter to nationals, domiciliaries, and sovereign authorities of a foreign nation, the Secretary of Commerce may, upon the petition of any person, or upon the Secretary's own motion, issue an order extending protection under this chapter to such foreign nationals, domiciliaries, and sovereign authorities if the Secretary finds-

(a) Regardless of the conditions outlined in subparagraphs (A) and (C) of section 902(a)(1) regarding the availability of protection under this chapter for nationals, residents, and sovereign authorities of a foreign country, the Secretary of Commerce may, upon request from any individual or on the Secretary's own initiative, issue an order to extend protection under this chapter to these foreign nationals, residents, and sovereign authorities if the Secretary determines—

(1) that the foreign nation is making good faith efforts and reasonable progress toward-

(1) that the foreign nation is making sincere efforts and is making reasonable progress toward-

(A) entering into a treaty described in section 902(a)(1)(A); or

(A) entering into a treaty mentioned in section 902(a)(1)(A); or

(B) enacting or implementing legislation that would be in compliance with subparagraph (A) or (B) of section 902(a)(2); and

(B) creating or putting into effect laws that would follow subparagraph (A) or (B) of section 902(a)(2); and

(2) that the nationals, domiciliaries, and sovereign authorities of the foreign nation, and persons controlled by them, are not engaged in the misappropriation, or unauthorized distribution or commercial exploitation, of mask works; and

(2) that the citizens, residents, and government authorities of the foreign nation, as well as those they control, are not involved in the misappropriation, unauthorized distribution, or commercial exploitation of mask works; and

(3) that issuing the order would promote the purposes of this chapter and international comity with respect to the protection of mask works.

(3) that giving the order would support the goals of this chapter and international cooperation regarding the protection of mask works.

(b) While an order under subsection (a) is in effect with respect to a foreign nation, no application for registration of a claim for protection in a mask work under this chapter may be denied solely because the owner of the mask work is a national, domiciliary, or sovereign authority of that foreign nation, or solely because the mask work was first commercially exploited in that foreign nation.

(b) While an order under subsection (a) is active regarding a foreign nation, no application to register a claim for protection of a mask work under this chapter can be denied just because the owner of the mask work is a citizen, resident, or government authority of that foreign nation, or just because the mask work was first used commercially in that foreign nation.

(c) Any order issued by the Secretary of Commerce under subsection (a) shall be effective for such a period as the Secretary designates in the order, except that no such order may be effective after that date on which the authority of the Secretary of Commerce terminates under subsection (e). The effective date of any such order shall also be designated in the order. In the case of an order issued upon the petition of a person, such effective date may be no earlier than the date on which the Secretary receives such petition.

(c) Any order issued by the Secretary of Commerce under subsection (a) will be effective for the period specified in the order, but no order may remain effective after the date when the Secretary of Commerce's authority ends under subsection (e). The effective date of any such order will also be specified in the order. If an order is issued in response to a petition from someone, that effective date cannot be earlier than when the Secretary receives that petition.

(d)(1) Any order issued under this section shall terminate if-

(d)(1) Any order issued under this section will end if-

(A) the Secretary of Commerce finds that any of the conditions set forth in paragraphs (1), (2), and (3) of subsection (a) no longer exist; or

(A) the Secretary of Commerce finds that any of the conditions listed in paragraphs (1), (2), and (3) of subsection (a) no longer apply; or

(B) mask works of nationals, domiciliaries, and sovereign authorities of that foreign nation or mask works first commercially exploited in that foreign nation become eligible for protection under subparagraph (A) or (C) of section 902(a)(1).

(B) mask works created by citizens, residents, and government authorities of that foreign country, or mask works that were first commercially used in that foreign country, qualify for protection under subparagraph (A) or (C) of section 902(a)(1).

(2) Upon the termination or expiration of an order issued under this section, registrations of claims of protection in mask works made pursuant to that order shall remain valid for the period specified in section 904.

(2) When an order issued under this section ends or expires, the registrations of claims for protection in mask works made under that order will stay valid for the duration specified in section 904.

(e) The authority of the Secretary of Commerce under this section shall commence on the date of the enactment of this chapter, and shall terminate on July 1, 1995.

(e) The authority of the Secretary of Commerce under this section will start on the date this chapter is enacted and will end on July 1, 1995.

(f) (1) The Secretary of Commerce shall promptly notify the Register of Copyrights and the Committees on the Judiciary of the Senate and the House of Representatives of the issuance or termination of any order under this section, together with a statement of the reasons for such action. The Secretary shall also publish such notification and statement of reasons in the Federal Register.

(f) (1) The Secretary of Commerce will quickly inform the Register of Copyrights and the Judiciary Committees of both the Senate and the House of Representatives about the issuance or cancellation of any order under this section, along with an explanation for that action. The Secretary will also publish this notification and explanation in the Federal Register.

(2) Two years after the date of the enactment of this chapter, the Secretary of Commerce, in consultation with the Register of Copyrights, shall transmit to the Committees on the Judiciary of the Senate and the House of Representatives a report on the actions taken under this section and on the current status of international recognition of mask work protection. The report shall include such recommendation for modifications of the protection accorded under this chapter to mask works owned by nationals, domiciliaries, or sovereign authorities of foreign nations as the Secretary, in consultation with the Register of Copyrights, considers would promote the purposes of this chapter and international comity with respect to mask work protection. Not later than July 1, 1994, the Secretary of Commerce, in consultation with the Register of Copyrights, shall transmit to the Committees on the Judiciary of the Senate and the House of Representatives a report updating the matters contained in the report transmitted under the preceding sentence.

(2) Two years after this chapter is enacted, the Secretary of Commerce, in consultation with the Register of Copyrights, will send a report to the Committees on the Judiciary of the Senate and the House of Representatives about the actions taken under this section and the current status of international recognition of mask work protection. The report will include any recommendations for changes to the protection offered under this chapter to mask works owned by nationals, residents, or governmental authorities of foreign countries that the Secretary, in consultation with the Register of Copyrights, believes would further the goals of this chapter and international goodwill regarding mask work protection. By July 1, 1994, the Secretary of Commerce, in consultation with the Register of Copyrights, will send an updated report to the Committees on the Judiciary of the Senate and the House of Representatives regarding the issues addressed in the previous report.

————————— Chapter 9 Endnotes

Chapter 9 References

1 In 1984, the Semiconductor Chip Protection Act amended title 17 of the *United States Code *to add a new chapter 9 entitled "Protection of Semiconductor Chip Products." Pub. L. No. 98-620, 98 Stat. 3347.

1 In 1984, the Semiconductor Chip Protection Act changed title 17 of the *United States Code* to include a new chapter 9 called "Protection of Semiconductor Chip Products." Pub. L. No. 98-620, 98 Stat. 3347.

2 In 1997, the heading for section 903 in the table of sections was amended by adding ", transfer, licensure, and recordation" at the end thereof, in lieu of "and transfer." Pub. L. No. 105-80, 111 Stat. 1529, 1535.

2 In 1997, the heading for section 903 in the table of sections was updated by adding ", transfer, licensure, and recordation" at the end, instead of "and transfer." Pub. L. No. 105-80, 111 Stat. 1529, 1535.

3 In 1987, section 902 was amended by adding the last sentence in subsection (a)(2). Pub. L. No. 100-159, 101 Stat. 899, 900.

3 In 1987, section 902 was changed by adding the last sentence in subsection (a)(2). Pub. L. No. 100-159, 101 Stat. 899, 900.

4 In 1997, section 909 was amended by correcting misspellings in subsection (b)(1). Pub. L. No. 105-80, 111 Stat. 1529, 1535.

4 In 1997, section 909 was updated to fix typos in subsection (b)(1). Pub. L. No. 105-80, 111 Stat. 1529, 1535.

5 In 1990, the Copyright Remedy Clarification Act amended section 910 by adding the last two sentences to subsection (a). Pub. L. No. 101-553, 104 Stat. 2749, 2750. In 1997, a technical correction amended section 910(a) by capitalizing the first word of the second sentence. Pub. L. No. 105-80, 111 Stat. 1529 1535.

5 In 1990, the Copyright Remedy Clarification Act changed section 910 by adding the last two sentences to subsection (a). Pub. L. No. 101-553, 104 Stat. 2749, 2750. In 1997, a technical correction updated section 910(a) by capitalizing the first word of the second sentence. Pub. L. No. 105-80, 111 Stat. 1529 1535.

6 In 1990, the Copyright Remedy Clarification Act amended section 911 by adding subsection (g). Pub. L. No. 101-553, 104 Stat. 2749, 2750.

6 In 1990, the Copyright Remedy Clarification Act changed section 911 by adding subsection (g). Pub. L. No. 101-553, 104 Stat. 2749, 2750.

7 In 1988, the Judicial Improvements and Access to Justice Act amended section 912 by deleting subsection (d) and redesignating subsection (e) as subsection (d). Pub. L. No. 100-702, 102 Stat. 4642, 4672. The Audio Home Recording Act of 1992 amended section 912 by inserting "or 10" after "8" in subsections (a) and (b). Pub. L. No. 102-563, 106 Stat. 4237, 4248.

7 In 1988, the Judicial Improvements and Access to Justice Act changed section 912 by removing subsection (d) and renaming subsection (e) to subsection (d). Pub. L. No. 100-702, 102 Stat. 4642, 4672. The Audio Home Recording Act of 1992 updated section 912 by adding "or 10" after "8" in subsections (a) and (b). Pub. L. No. 102-563, 106 Stat. 4237, 4248.

8 In 1987, section 914 was amended in subsection (e) by inserting "on July 1, 1991" in lieu of "three years after such date of enactment" and by adding the last sentence to subsection (f)(2). Pub. L. No. 100-159, 101 Stat. 899. The Semiconductor International Protection Extension Act of 1991 amended section 914 by inserting "or implementing" after "enacting" in the first sentence of subsection (a)(1)(B), by changing the date in subsection (e) to "July 1, 1995" and by changing the date in the last sentence of subsection (f)(2) to "July 1, 1994." Pub. L. No. 102-64, 105 Stat. 320.

8 In 1987, section 914 was updated in subsection (e) by replacing "three years after such date of enactment" with "on July 1, 1991" and by adding the last sentence to subsection (f)(2). Pub. L. No. 100-159, 101 Stat. 899. The Semiconductor International Protection Extension Act of 1991 revised section 914 by adding "or implementing" after "enacting" in the first sentence of subsection (a)(1)(B), changing the date in subsection (e) to "July 1, 1995," and updating the date in the last sentence of subsection (f)(2) to "July 1, 1994." Pub. L. No. 102-64, 105 Stat. 320.

On July 1, 1995, section 914 expired as required by subsection (e). It was rendered largely unnecessary upon the entry into force on January 1, 1995, of the Agreement on Trade-Related Aspects of Intellectual Property Rights (TRIPs)(Annex 1C to the World Trade Organization (WTO) Agreement). Part II, section 6 of TRIPs protects semiconductor chip products and was the basis for Presidential Proclamation No. 6780, March 23, 1995, under section 902(a)(2) extending protection to all present and future WTO members (34 countries as of February 10, 1999), as of January 1, 1996. See Part IV of the Appendix.

On July 1, 1995, section 914 expired as required by subsection (e). It became mostly unnecessary when the Agreement on Trade-Related Aspects of Intellectual Property Rights (TRIPs) came into effect on January 1, 1995 (Annex 1C to the World Trade Organization (WTO) Agreement). Part II, section 6 of TRIPs protects semiconductor chip products and formed the basis for Presidential Proclamation No. 6780 on March 23, 1995, under section 902(a)(2), extending protection to all current and future WTO members (34 countries as of February 10, 1999), effective January 1, 1996. See Part IV of the Appendix.

For a discussion of Congressional findings regarding extending
protection to semiconductor chip products of foreign entities, see Pub.
L. No. 100-159, 101 Stat. 899, and the Semiconductor International
Protection Extension Act of 1991, Pub. L. No. 102-64, 105 Stat. 320.5

For a discussion on Congress's findings about extending
protection to semiconductor chip products from foreign entities, check out Pub.
L. No. 100-159, 101 Stat. 899, and the Semiconductor International
Protection Extension Act of 1991, Pub. L. No. 102-64, 105 Stat. 320.5

————————————————————————————————————

Understood. Please provide the text you would like me to modernize.

Chapter 10 [1]

Digital Audio Recording Devices and Media

Digital Audio Recording Devices and Media

  + Subchapter A—Definitions
    + 1001. Definitions
  + Subchapter B—Copying Controls
    + 1002. Incorporation of copying controls
  + Subchapter C—Royalty Payments
    + 1003. Obligation to make royalty payments
    + 1004. Royalty payments
    + 1005. Deposit of royalty payments and deduction of expenses
    + 1006. Entitlement to royalty payments
    + 1007. Procedures for distributing royalty payments
  + Subchapter D—Prohibition on Certain Infringement Actions, Remedies,
    and Arbitration
    + 1008. Prohibition on certain infringement actions
    + 1009. Civil remedies
    + 1010. Arbitration of certain disputes

+ Subchapter A—Definitions
    + 1001. Definitions
  + Subchapter B—Copying Controls
    + 1002. Incorporation of copying controls
  + Subchapter C—Royalty Payments
    + 1003. Obligation to make royalty payments
    + 1004. Royalty payments
    + 1005. Deposit of royalty payments and deduction of expenses
    + 1006. Entitlement to royalty payments
    + 1007. Procedures for distributing royalty payments
  + Subchapter D—Prohibition on Certain Infringement Actions, Remedies,
    and Arbitration
    + 1008. Prohibition on certain infringement actions
    + 1009. Civil remedies
    + 1010. Arbitration of certain disputes

Subchapter A Definitions

Subchapter A Definitions

Section 1001. Definitions

As used in this chapter, the following terms have the following meanings:

As used in this chapter, the following terms mean:

(1) A "digital audio copied recording" is a reproduction in a digital recording format of a digital musical recording, whether that reproduction is made directly from another digital musical recording or indirectly from a transmission.

(1) A "digital audio copied recording" is a copy in a digital format of a digital music recording, whether that copy is made directly from another digital music recording or indirectly from a transmission.

(2) A "digital audio interface device" is any machine or device that is designed specifically to communicate digital audio information and related interface data to a digital audio recording device through a nonprofessional interface.

(2) A "digital audio interface device" is any machine or device that is specifically made to communicate digital audio information and related interface data to a digital audio recording device through a nonprofessional interface.

(3) A "digital audio recording device" is any machine or device of a type commonly distributed to individuals for use by individuals, whether or not included with or as part of some other machine or device, the digital recording function of which is designed or marketed for the primary purpose of, and that is capable of, making a digital audio copied recording for private use, except for-

(3) A "digital audio recording device" is any machine or device that is commonly sold to people for personal use, whether it's a standalone product or part of another machine or device, whose digital recording capability is specifically designed or advertised for the main purpose of creating a digital audio copy for personal use, except for-

(A) professional model products, and

professional model products, and

(B) dictation machines, answering machines, and other audio recording equipment that is designed and marketed primarily for the creation of sound recordings resulting from the fixation of nonmusical sounds.

(B) dictation machines, answering machines, and other audio recording equipment that is designed and marketed mainly for creating sound recordings that capture nonmusical sounds.

(4)(A) A "digital audio recording medium" is any material object in a form commonly distributed for use by individuals, that is primarily marketed or most commonly used by consumers for the purpose of making digital audio copied recordings by use of a digital audio recording device.

(4)(A) A "digital audio recording medium" is any physical item that is typically available for individual use, primarily marketed or most frequently used by consumers to create digital audio copies using a digital audio recording device.

(B) Such term does not include any material object-

(B) This term does not include any physical object-

(i) that embodies a sound recording at the time it is first distributed by the importer or manufacturer; or

(i) that captures a sound recording when it is first distributed by the importer or manufacturer; or

(ii) that is primarily marketed and most commonly used by consumers either for the purpose of making copies of motion pictures or other audiovisual works or for the purpose of making copies of nonmusical literary works, including computer programs or data bases.

(ii) that is mainly advertised and most often used by consumers either to copy movies or other audiovisual content or to copy non-musical written works, including computer programs or databases.

(5)(A) A "digital musical recording" is a material object-

(5)(A) A "digital musical recording" is a physical item-

(i) in which are fixed, in a digital recording format, only sounds, and material, statements, or instructions incidental to those fixed sounds, if any, and

(i) that contains, in a digital recording format, only sounds, along with any material, statements, or instructions related to those sounds, if any, and

(ii) from which the sounds and material can be perceived, reproduced, or otherwise communicated, either directly or with the aid of a machine or device.

(ii) from which sounds and materials can be heard, reproduced, or otherwise shared, either directly or with the help of a machine or device.

(B) A "digital musical recording" does not include a material object-

(B) A "digital musical recording" does not include a physical object-

(i) in which the fixed sounds consist entirely of spoken word recordings, or

(i) where the fixed sounds are made up entirely of spoken word recordings, or

(ii) in which one or more computer programs are fixed, except that a digital musical recording may contain statements or instructions constituting the fixed sounds and incidental material, and statements or instructions to be used directly or indirectly in order to bring about the perception, reproduction, or communication of the fixed sounds and incidental material.

(ii) in which one or more computer programs are stored, except that a digital music recording may include statements or instructions that make up the fixed sounds and additional material, as well as statements or instructions meant to directly or indirectly enable the perception, reproduction, or sharing of the fixed sounds and additional material.

(C) For purposes of this paragraph-

(C) For the purposes of this paragraph-

(i) a "spoken word recording" is a sound recording in which are fixed only a series of spoken words, except that the spoken words may be accompanied by incidental musical or other sounds, and

(i) a "spoken word recording" is a sound recording that consists solely of a series of spoken words, although these spoken words may be accompanied by occasional music or other sounds, and

(ii) the term "incidental" means related to and relatively minor by comparison.

(ii) the term "incidental" means related to and relatively minor in comparison.

(6) "Distribute" means to sell, lease, or assign a product to consumers in the United States, or to sell, lease, or assign a product in the United States for ultimate transfer to consumers in the United States.

(6) "Distribute" means to sell, lease, or assign a product to consumers in the United States, or to sell, lease, or assign a product in the United States for final transfer to consumers in the United States.

(7) An "interested copyright party" is-

(7) An "interested copyright party" is-

(A) the owner of the exclusive right under section 106(1) of this title to reproduce a sound recording of a musical work that has been embodied in a digital musical recording or analog musical recording lawfully made under this title that has been distributed;

(A) the owner of the exclusive right under section 106(1) of this title to reproduce a sound recording of a musical work that has been made in a digital or analog musical recording lawfully created under this title and that has been distributed;

(B) the legal or beneficial owner of, or the person that controls, the right to reproduce in a digital musical recording or analog musical recording a musical work that has been embodied in a digital musical recording or analog musical recording lawfully made under this title that has been distributed;

(B) the legal or beneficial owner of, or the person who controls, the right to reproduce a musical work in a digital or analog musical recording that has been lawfully made and distributed under this title;

(C) a featured recording artist who performs on a sound recording that has been distributed; or

(C) a highlighted recording artist who performs on a sound recording that has been released; or

(D) any association or other organization-

(D) any association or other organization-

(i) representing persons specified in subparagraph (A), (B), or (C), or

(i) representing individuals mentioned in subparagraph (A), (B), or (C), or

(ii) engaged in licensing rights in musical works to music users on behalf of writers and publishers.

(ii) involved in licensing rights for musical works to music users on behalf of songwriters and publishers.

(8) To "manufacture" means to produce or assemble a product in the United States. A "manufacturer" is a person who manufactures.

(8) To "manufacture" means to create or put together a product in the United States. A "manufacturer" is someone who manufactures.

(9) A "music publisher" is a person that is authorized to license the reproduction of a particular musical work in a sound recording.

(9) A "music publisher" is someone who is authorized to license the reproduction of a specific musical work in a sound recording.

(10) A "professional model product" is an audio recording device that is designed, manufactured, marketed, and intended for use by recording professionals in the ordinary course of a lawful business, in accordance with such requirements as the Secretary of Commerce shall establish by regulation.

(10) A "professional model product" is an audio recording device that is designed, made, sold, and intended for use by recording professionals in the regular course of a legal business, following the guidelines set by the Secretary of Commerce through regulation.

(11) The term "serial copying" means the duplication in a digital format of a copyrighted musical work or sound recording from a digital reproduction of a digital musical recording. The term "digital reproduction of a digital musical recording" does not include a digital musical recording as distributed, by authority of the copyright owner, for ultimate sale to consumers.

(11) The term "serial copying" refers to making a digital copy of a copyrighted song or sound recording from a digital version of that song. The phrase "digital version of a song" does not include a digital song that has been distributed, with permission from the copyright owner, for final sale to consumers.

(12) The "transfer price" of a digital audio recording device or a digital audio recording medium-

(12) The "transfer price" of a digital audio recording device or a digital audio recording medium-

(A) is, subject to subparagraph (B)-

(A) is, subject to subparagraph (B)-

(i) in the case of an imported product, the actual entered value at United States Customs (exclusive of any freight, insurance, and applicable duty), and

(i) for an imported product, the actual entered value at United States Customs (not including any freight, insurance, or applicable duty), and

(ii) in the case of a domestic product, the manufacturer's transfer price (FOB the manufacturer, and exclusive of any direct sales taxes or excise taxes incurred in connection with the sale); and

(ii) for a domestic product, the manufacturer's transfer price (FOB the manufacturer, not including any direct sales taxes or excise taxes related to the sale); and

(B) shall, in a case in which the transferor and transferee are related entities or within a single entity, not be less than a reasonable arms- length price under the principles of the regulations adopted pursuant to section 482 of the Internal Revenue Code of 1986, or any successor provision to such section.

(B) shall, in a case where the transferor and transferee are related entities or part of the same entity, not be less than a fair market price based on the regulations established under section 482 of the Internal Revenue Code of 1986, or any future provisions that replace that section.

(13) A "writer" is the composer or lyricist of a particular musical work.

(13) A "writer" is the person who creates the music or lyrics for a specific musical piece.

Subchapter B-Copying Controls

Subchapter B - Copy Controls

Section 1002. Incorporation of copying controls

(a) Prohibition on Importation, Manufacture, and Distribution. No person shall import, manufacture, or distribute any digital audio recording device or digital audio interface device that does not conform to-

(a) Prohibition on Importation, Manufacture, and Distribution. No one is allowed to import, manufacture, or distribute any digital audio recording device or digital audio interface device that does not meet-

(1) the Serial Copy Management System;

(1) the Serial Copy Management System;

(2) a system that has the same functional characteristics as the Serial Copy Management System and requires that copyright and generation status information be accurately sent, received, and acted upon between devices using the system's method of serial copying regulation and devices using the Serial Copy Management System; or

(2) a system that has the same functional characteristics as the Serial Copy Management System and requires that copyright and generation status information be accurately sent, received, and acted upon between devices using the system's method of serial copying regulation and devices using the Serial Copy Management System; or

(3) any other system certified by the Secretary of Commerce as prohibiting unauthorized serial copying.

(3) any other system approved by the Secretary of Commerce that prevents unauthorized serial copying.

(b) Development of Verification Procedure. The Secretary of Commerce shall establish a procedure to verify, upon the petition of an interested party, that a system meets the standards set forth in subsection (a)(2).

(b) Developing a Verification Procedure. The Secretary of Commerce will create a process to confirm, at the request of an interested party, that a system meets the standards outlined in subsection (a)(2).

(c) Prohibition on Circumvention of the System. No person shall import, manufacture, or distribute any device, or offer or perform any service, the primary purpose or effect of which is to avoid, bypass, remove, deactivate, or otherwise circumvent any program or circuit which implements, in whole or in part, a system described in subsection (a).

(c) Prohibition on Circumvention of the System. No one is allowed to import, make, or distribute any device, or provide any service, that mainly aims to avoid, bypass, remove, deactivate, or in any other way get around any program or circuit that implements, in whole or in part, a system described in subsection (a).

(d) Encoding of Information on Digital Musical Recordings.

(d) How Information is Recorded on Digital Music Tracks.

(1) Prohibition on encoding inaccurate information. No person shall encode a digital musical recording of a sound recording with inaccurate information relating to the category code, copyright status, or generation status of the source material for the recording.

(1) Prohibition on encoding inaccurate information. No one is allowed to encode a digital music recording with incorrect information regarding the category code, copyright status, or generation status of the source material for the recording.

(2) Encoding of copyright status not required. Nothing in this chapter requires any person engaged in the importation or manufacture of digital musical recordings to encode any such digital musical recording with respect to its copyright status.

(2) No encoding of copyright status required. Nothing in this chapter requires anyone involved in the importation or production of digital music recordings to encode any of these digital music recordings regarding their copyright status.

(e) Information Accompanying Transmission in Digital Format. Any person who transmits or otherwise communicates to the public any sound recording in digital format is not required under this chapter to transmit or otherwise communicate the information relating to the copyright status of the sound recording. Any such person who does transmit or otherwise communicate such copyright status information shall transmit or communicate such information accurately.

(e) Information Accompanying Transmission in Digital Format. Anyone who sends or shares a sound recording in digital format with the public doesn't have to provide information about the copyright status of that recording under this chapter. However, if they do share copyright status information, it must be accurate.

Subchapter C Royalty Payments

Subchapter C Royalty Payments

Section 1003. Obligation to make royalty payments

(a) Prohibition on Importation and Manufacture. No person shall import into and distribute, or manufacture and distribute, any digital audio recording device or digital audio recording medium unless such person records the notice specified by this section and subsequently deposits the statements of account and applicable royalty payments for such device or medium specified in section 1004.

(a) Prohibition on Importation and Manufacture. No one is allowed to import, distribute, or manufacture any digital audio recording device or digital audio recording medium unless they record the notice mentioned in this section and later submit the statements of account and applicable royalty payments for that device or medium as outlined in section 1004.

(b) Filing of Notice. The importer or manufacturer of any digital audio recording device or digital audio recording medium, within a product category or utilizing a technology with respect to which such manufacturer or importer has not previously filed a notice under this subsection, shall file with the Register of Copyrights a notice with respect to such device or medium, in such form and content as the Register shall prescribe by regulation.

(b) Filing of Notice. The importer or manufacturer of any digital audio recording device or digital audio recording medium, within a product category or using a technology that the manufacturer or importer has not previously submitted a notice for under this subsection, must file a notice with the Register of Copyrights regarding that device or medium, in the form and content that the Register will define through regulation.

(c) Filing of Quarterly and Annual Statements of Account.

(c) Submission of Quarterly and Annual Financial Statements.

(1) Generally. Any importer or manufacturer that distributes any digital audio recording device or digital audio recording medium that it manufactured or imported shall file with the Register of Copyrights, in such form and content as the Register shall prescribe by -regulation, such quarterly and annual statements of account with respect to such distribution as the Register shall prescribe by regulation.

(1) Generally. Any importer or manufacturer that distributes any digital audio recording device or digital audio recording medium they manufactured or imported must file with the Register of Copyrights, in the form and content that the Register specifies by regulation, quarterly and annual statements of account regarding that distribution as the Register prescribes by regulation.

(2) Certification, verification, and confidentiality. Each such statement shall be certified as accurate by an authorized officer or principal of the importer or manufacturer. The Register shall issue regulations to provide for the verification and audit of such statements and to protect the confidentiality of the information contained in such statements. Such regulations shall provide for the disclosure, in confidence, of such statements to interested copyright parties.

(2) Certification, verification, and confidentiality. Each statement must be certified as accurate by an authorized officer or principal of the importer or manufacturer. The Register will create regulations to ensure the verification and audit of these statements and to protect the confidentiality of the information they contain. These regulations will allow for the confidential disclosure of these statements to relevant copyright parties.

(3) Royalty Payments. Each such statement shall be accompanied by the royalty payments specified in section 1004.

(3) Royalty Payments. Each statement must be sent with the royalty payments mentioned in section 1004.

Section 1004. Royalty payments [2]

(a) Digital Audio Recording Devices.

Digital Audio Recorders.

(1) Amount of payment. The royalty payment due under section 1003 for each digital audio recording device imported into and distributed in the United States, or manufactured and distributed in the United States, shall be 2 percent of the transfer price. Only the first person to manufacture and distribute or import and distribute such device shall be required to pay the royalty with respect to such device.

(1) Amount of payment. The royalty payment due under section 1003 for each digital audio recording device brought into or sold in the United States, or made and sold in the United States, will be 2 percent of the selling price. Only the first person to manufacture and sell or import and sell such a device is required to pay the royalty for that device.

(2) Calculation for devices distributed with other devices. With respect to a digital audio recording device first distributed in combination with one or more devices, either as a physically integrated unit or as separate components, the royalty payment shall be calculated as follows:

(2) Calculation for devices distributed with other devices. When it comes to a digital audio recording device that is first sold together with one or more devices, whether as a single unit or as separate parts, the royalty payment will be calculated like this:

(A) If the digital audio recording device and such other devices are part of a physically integrated unit, the royalty payment shall be based on the transfer price of the unit, but shall be reduced by any royalty payment made on any digital audio recording device included within the unit that was not first distributed in combination with the unit.

(A) If the digital audio recording device and any other devices are part of a single integrated unit, the royalty payment will be based on the unit's transfer price, but will be reduced by any royalty payment made on any digital audio recording device that's included in the unit but wasn't first distributed with it.

(B) If the digital audio recording device is not part of a physically integrated unit and substantially similar devices have been distributed separately at any time during the preceding 4 calendar quarters, the royalty payment shall be based on the average transfer price of such devices during those 4 quarters.

(B) If the digital audio recording device is not part of a physically integrated unit and similar devices have been sold separately at any point during the past 4 calendar quarters, the royalty payment will be based on the average transfer price of those devices during those 4 quarters.

(C) If the digital audio recording device is not part of a physically integrated unit and substantially similar devices have not been distributed separately at any time during the preceding 4 calendar quarters, the royalty payment shall be based on a constructed price reflecting the proportional value of such device to the combination as a whole.

(C) If the digital audio recording device isn't part of a physically integrated unit and similar devices haven't been distributed separately at any time in the last 4 calendar quarters, the royalty payment will be based on a calculated price that reflects the proportional value of that device in relation to the entire combination.

(3) Limits on royalties. Notwithstanding paragraph (1) or (2), the amount of the royalty payment for each digital audio recording device shall not be less than $1 nor more than the royalty maximum. The royalty maximum shall be $8 per device, except that in the case of a physically integrated unit containing more than 1 digital audio recording device, the royalty maximum for such unit shall be $12. During the 6th year after the effective date of this chapter, and not more than once each year thereafter, any interested copyright party may petition the Librarian of Congress to increase the royalty maximum and, if more than 20 percent of the royalty payments are at the relevant royalty maximum, the Librarian of Congress shall prospectively increase such royalty maximum with the goal of having no more than 10 percent of such payments at the new royalty maximum; however the amount of any such increase as a percentage of the royalty maximum shall in no event exceed the percentage increase in the Consumer Price Index during the period under review.

(3) Limits on royalties. Regardless of paragraph (1) or (2), the royalty payment for each digital audio recording device must be at least $1 and cannot exceed the royalty maximum. The royalty maximum is set at $8 per device, except for physically combined units that have more than one digital audio recording device, where the royalty maximum for such a unit will be $12. In the 6th year after the effective date of this chapter, and no more than once each year after that, any interested copyright entity can ask the Librarian of Congress to raise the royalty maximum. If over 20 percent of the royalty payments are at the current maximum, the Librarian of Congress must increase that maximum, aiming to have no more than 10 percent of payments at the new maximum. However, any increase as a percentage of the maximum cannot exceed the percentage increase in the Consumer Price Index during the review period.

(b) Digital Audio Recording Media. The royalty payment due under section 1003 for each digital audio recording medium imported into and distributed in the United States, or manufactured and distributed in the United States, shall be 3 percent of the transfer price. Only the first person to manufacture and distribute or import and distribute such medium shall be required to pay the royalty with respect to such medium.

(b) Digital Audio Recording Media. The royalty payment due under section 1003 for each digital audio recording medium imported into and distributed in the United States, or manufactured and distributed in the United States, will be 3 percent of the transfer price. Only the first person to manufacture and distribute or import and distribute such medium will be required to pay the royalty for that medium.

Section 1005. Deposit of royalty payments and deduction of expenses [3]

The Register of Copyrights shall receive all royalty payments deposited under this chapter and, after deducting the reasonable costs incurred by the Copyright Office under this chapter, shall deposit the balance in the Treasury of the United States as offsetting receipts, in such manner as the Secretary of the Treasury directs. All funds held by the Secretary of the Treasury shall be invested in interest-bearing United States securities for later distribution with interest under section 1007. The Register may, in the Register's discretion, 4 years after the close of any calendar year, close out the royalty payments account for that calendar year, and may treat any funds remaining in such account and any subsequent deposits that would otherwise be attributable to that calendar year as attributable to the succeeding calendar year.

The Register of Copyrights will receive all royalty payments made under this chapter and, after deducting reasonable costs incurred by the Copyright Office, will deposit the remaining amount in the United States Treasury as offsetting receipts, following the instructions of the Secretary of the Treasury. All funds held by the Secretary of the Treasury will be invested in interest-bearing United States securities for future distribution with interest as stated in section 1007. The Register may, at their discretion, four years after the end of any calendar year, close out the royalty payments account for that year and can consider any remaining funds in that account and any later deposits that would normally belong to that year as belonging to the following calendar year.

Section 1006. Entitlement to royalty payments [4]

(a) Interested Copyright Parties. The royalty payments deposited pursuant to section 1005 shall, in accordance with the procedures specified in section 1007, be distributed to any interested copyright party-

(a) Interested Copyright Parties. The royalty payments deposited according to section 1005 will be distributed to any interested copyright party following the procedures outlined in section 1007.

(1) whose musical work or sound recording has been-

(1) whose music or sound recording has been-

(A) embodied in a digital musical recording or an analog musical recording lawfully made under this title that has been distributed, and

(A) embodied in a digital music recording or an analog music recording legally made under this title that has been distributed, and

(B) distributed in the form of digital musical recordings or analog musical recordings or disseminated to the public in transmissions, during the period to which such payments pertain; and

(B) distributed as digital music recordings or analog music recordings or shared with the public through broadcasts during the time that these payments apply; and

(2) who has filed a claim under section 1007.

(2) who has submitted a claim under section 1007.

(b) Allocation of Royalty Payments to Groups. The royalty payments shall be divided into 2 funds as follows:

(b) Allocation of Royalty Payments to Groups. The royalty payments will be split into 2 funds as follows:

(1) The sound recordings fund. 66 2/3 percent of the royalty payments shall be allocated to the Sound Recordings Fund. 2 5/8 percent of the royalty payments allocated to the Sound Recordings Fund shall be placed in an escrow account managed by an independent administrator jointly appointed by the interested copyright parties described in section 1001(7)(A) and the American Federation of Musicians (or any successor entity) to be distributed to nonfeatured musicians (whether or not members of the American Federation of Musicians or any successor entity) who have performed on sound recordings distributed in the United States. 1 3/8 percent of the royalty payments allocated to the Sound Recordings Fund shall be placed in an escrow account managed by an independent administrator jointly appointed by the interested copyright parties described in section 1001(7)(A) and the American Federation of Television and Radio Artists (or any successor entity) to be distributed to nonfeatured vocalists (whether or not members of the American Federation of Television and Radio Artists or any successor entity) who have performed on sound recordings distributed in the United States. 40 percent of the remaining royalty payments in the Sound Recordings Fund shall be distributed to the interested copyright parties described in section 1001(7)(C), and 60 percent of such remaining royalty payments shall be distributed to the interested copyright parties described in section 1001(7)(A).

(1) The Sound Recordings Fund. 66 2/3 percent of the royalty payments will go to the Sound Recordings Fund. 2 5/8 percent of the royalty payments allocated to the Sound Recordings Fund will be put into an escrow account managed by an independent administrator who will be jointly appointed by the relevant copyright groups mentioned in section 1001(7)(A) and the American Federation of Musicians (or any successor). This amount will be distributed to nonfeatured musicians (regardless of whether they are members of the American Federation of Musicians or any successor) who have performed on sound recordings distributed in the United States. 1 3/8 percent of the royalty payments allocated to the Sound Recordings Fund will also be placed in an escrow account managed by an independent administrator jointly appointed by the relevant copyright groups mentioned in section 1001(7)(A) and the American Federation of Television and Radio Artists (or any successor) to be distributed to nonfeatured vocalists (whether or not they are members of the American Federation of Television and Radio Artists or any successor) who have performed on sound recordings distributed in the United States. 40 percent of the remaining royalty payments in the Sound Recordings Fund will be distributed to the relevant copyright groups mentioned in section 1001(7)(C), and 60 percent of those remaining royalty payments will go to the relevant copyright groups mentioned in section 1001(7)(A).

(2) The musical works fund.

The music works fund.

(A) 33 1/3 percent of the royalty payments shall be allocated to the Musical Works Fund for distribution to interested copyright parties described in section 1001(7)(B).

(A) 33 1/3 percent of the royalty payments will be set aside for the Musical Works Fund to be distributed to the interested copyright parties mentioned in section 1001(7)(B).

(B)(i) Music publishers shall be entitled to 50 percent of the royalty payments allocated to the Musical Works Fund.

(B)(i) Music publishers will receive 50 percent of the royalty payments designated for the Musical Works Fund.

(ii) Writers shall be entitled to the other 50 percent of the royalty payments allocated to the Musical Works Fund.

(ii) Writers will receive the other 50 percent of the royalty payments designated for the Musical Works Fund.

(c) Allocation of Royalty Payments Within Groups. If all interested copyright parties within a group specified in subsection (b) do not agree on a voluntary proposal for the distribution of the royalty payments within each group, the Librarian of Congress shall convene a copyright arbitration royalty panel which shall, pursuant to the procedures specified under section 1007(c), allocate royalty payments under this section based on the extent to which, during the relevant period-

(c) Allocation of Royalty Payments Within Groups. If all interested copyright parties within a group mentioned in subsection (b) can't come to an agreement on a voluntary plan for distributing the royalty payments, the Librarian of Congress will gather a copyright arbitration royalty panel that will, according to the procedures outlined in section 1007(c), allocate royalty payments based on how much each party contributed during the relevant period.

(1) for the Sound Recordings Fund, each sound recording was distributed in the form of digital musical recordings or analog musical recordings; and

(1) for the Sound Recordings Fund, each sound recording was distributed as digital music recordings or analog music recordings; and

(2) for the Musical Works Fund, each musical work was distributed in the form of digital musical recordings or analog musical recordings or disseminated to the public in transmissions.

(2) for the Musical Works Fund, each musical work was shared through digital music recordings or analog music recordings or made available to the public via transmissions.

Section 1007. Procedures for distributing royalty payments [5]

(a) Filing of Claims and Negotiations.

Submitting Claims and Negotiations.

(1) Filing of claims. During the first 2 months of each calendar year after calendar year 1992, every interested copyright party seeking to receive royalty payments to which such party is entitled under section 1006 shall file with the Librarian of Congress a claim for payments collected during the preceding year in such form and manner as the Librarian of Congress shall prescribe by regulation.

(1) Filing of claims. During the first 2 months of each calendar year after 1992, every interested copyright party wanting to receive royalty payments they are entitled to under section 1006 must file a claim with the Librarian of Congress for payments collected during the previous year, in the form and manner that the Librarian will specify by regulation.

(2) Negotiations. Notwithstanding any provision of the antitrust laws, for purposes of this section interested copyright parties within each group specified in section 1006(b) may agree among themselves to the proportionate division of royalty payments, may lump their claims together and file them jointly or as a single claim, or may designate a common agent, including any organization described in section 1001(7) (D), to negotiate or receive payment on their behalf; except that no agreement under this subsection may modify the allocation of royalties specified in section 1006(b).

(2) Negotiations. Regardless of any antitrust laws, for this section, copyright holders within each group mentioned in section 1006(b) can agree among themselves on how to divide royalty payments. They can combine their claims and file them together or as one claim, or they can appoint a common agent, including any organization listed in section 1001(7)(D), to negotiate or collect payments for them. However, no agreement under this subsection can change the allocation of royalties outlined in section 1006(b).

(b) Distribution of Payments in the Absence of a Dispute. After the period established for the filing of claims under subsection (a), in each year after 1992, the Librarian of Congress shall determine whether there exists a controversy concerning the distribution of royalty payments under section 1006(c). If the Librarian of Congress determines that no such controversy exists, the Librarian of Congress shall, within 30 days after such determination, authorize the distribution of the royalty payments as set forth in the agreements regarding the distribution of royalty payments entered into pursuant to subsection (a), after deducting its reasonable administrative costs under this section.

(b) Distribution of Payments When There's No Dispute. After the deadline for filing claims under subsection (a), each year after 1992, the Librarian of Congress will decide if there's any disagreement about the distribution of royalty payments under section 1006(c). If the Librarian of Congress finds that there is no disagreement, they will, within 30 days of that decision, approve the distribution of royalty payments as outlined in the agreements about royalty payment distribution made according to subsection (a), after deducting reasonable administrative costs under this section.

(c) Resolution of Disputes. If the Librarian of Congress finds the existence of a controversy, the Librarian shall, pursuant to chapter 8 of this title, convene a copyright arbitration royalty panel to determine the distribution of royalty payments. During the pendency of such a proceeding, the Librarian of Congress shall withhold from distribution an amount sufficient to satisfy all claims with respect to which a controversy exists, but shall, to the extent feasible, authorize the distribution of any amounts that are not in controversy. The Librarian of Congress shall, before authorizing the distribution of such royalty payments, deduct the reasonable administrative costs incurred by the Librarian under this section.

(c) Resolution of Disputes. If the Librarian of Congress discovers a dispute, they will, following chapter 8 of this title, set up a copyright arbitration royalty panel to figure out how to distribute the royalty payments. While this process is happening, the Librarian of Congress will hold back an amount large enough to cover all claims related to the dispute but will, as much as possible, allow the distribution of any amounts that are not in dispute. Before allowing the distribution of these royalty payments, the Librarian of Congress will deduct the reasonable administrative costs incurred in this process.

Subchapter D - Prohibition on Certain Infringement Actions, Remedies, and Arbitration

Subchapter D - Ban on Certain Infringement Actions, Solutions, and Arbitration

Section 1008. Prohibition on certain infringement actions

No action may be brought under this title alleging infringement of copyright based on the manufacture, importation, or distribution of a digital audio recording device, a digital audio recording medium, an analog recording device, or an analog recording medium, or based on the noncommercial use by a consumer of such a device or medium for making digital musical recordings or analog musical recordings.

No legal action can be taken under this title for claiming copyright infringement related to the manufacturing, importing, or distributing of a digital audio recording device, a digital audio recording medium, an analog recording device, or an analog recording medium, or based on a consumer's noncommercial use of such a device or medium for creating digital or analog music recordings.

Section 1009. Civil remedies

(a) Civil Actions. Any interested copyright party injured by a violation of section 1002 or 1003 may bring a civil action in an appropriate United States district court against any person for such violation.

(a) Civil Actions. Any interested copyright party hurt by a violation of section 1002 or 1003 can file a civil lawsuit in the appropriate United States district court against anyone for that violation.

(b) Other Civil Actions. Any person injured by a violation of this chapter may bring a civil action in an appropriate United States district court for actual damages incurred as a result of such violation.

(b) Other Civil Actions. Any person harmed by a violation of this chapter may file a civil lawsuit in the appropriate United States district court for the actual damages suffered as a result of that violation.

(c) Powers of the Court. In an action brought under subsection (a), the court-

(c) Powers of the Court. In an action brought under subsection (a), the court-

(1) may grant temporary and permanent injunctions on such terms as it deems reasonable to prevent or restrain such violation;

(1) may issue temporary and permanent injunctions on terms it considers fair to prevent or stop such violations;

(2) in the case of a violation of section 1002, or in the case of an injury resulting from a failure to make royalty payments required by section 1003, shall award damages under subsection (d);

(2) if there is a violation of section 1002, or if an injury occurs due to not making the royalty payments required by section 1003, damages shall be awarded under subsection (d);

(3) in its discretion may allow the recovery of costs by or against any party other than the United States or an officer thereof; and

(3) may, at its discretion, allow any party other than the United States or its officer to recover costs; and

(4) in its discretion may award a reasonable attorney's fee to the prevailing party.

(4) may, at its discretion, award a reasonable attorney's fee to the winning party.

(d) Award of Damages.

(d) Damages Award.

(1) Damages for section 1002 or 1003 violations.

(1) Damages for violations of sections 1002 or 1003.

(A) Actual damages.

Compensatory damages.

(i) In an action brought under subsection (a), if the court finds that a violation of section 1002 or 1003 has occurred, the court shall award to the complaining party its actual damages if the complaining party elects such damages at any time before final judgment is entered.

(i) In a case filed under subsection (a), if the court finds that a violation of section 1002 or 1003 has taken place, the court will grant the complaining party their actual damages if the complaining party chooses this option at any time before the final judgment is issued.

(ii) In the case of section 1003, actual damages shall constitute the royalty payments that should have been paid under section 1004 and deposited under section 1005. In such a case, the court, in its discretion, may award an additional amount of not to exceed 50 percent of the actual damages.

(ii) In the case of section 1003, actual damages will be the royalty payments that should have been paid under section 1004 and deposited under section 1005. In this situation, the court may decide to award an extra amount not to exceed 50 percent of the actual damages.

(B) Statutory damages for section 1002 violations.

(B) Statutory damages for violations of section 1002.

(i) Device. A complaining party may recover an award of statutory damages for each violation of section 1002(a) or (c) in the sum of not more than $2,500 per device involved in such violation or per device on which a service prohibited by section 1002(c) has been performed, as the court considers just.

(i) Device. A person who complains can get an award of statutory damages for each violation of section 1002(a) or (c) up to $2,500 for each device involved in that violation or for each device on which a service banned by section 1002(c) has been performed, as the court sees fit.

(ii) Digital musical recording. A complaining party may recover an award of statutory damages for each violation of section 1002(d) in the sum of not more than $25 per digital musical recording involved in such violation, as the court considers just.

(ii) Digital music recording. A complaining party can receive an award of statutory damages for each violation of section 1002(d) up to $25 per digital music recording involved in that violation, as determined by the court.

(iii) Transmission. A complaining party may recover an award of damages for each transmission or communication that violates section 1002(e) in the sum of not more than $10,000, as the court considers just.

(iii) Transmission. A complaining party may receive damages for each transmission or communication that violates section 1002(e) in an amount not exceeding $10,000, as deemed fair by the court.

(2) Repeated violations. In any case in which the court finds that a person has violated section 1002 or 1003 within 3 years after a final judgment against that person for another such violation was entered, the court may increase the award of damages to not more than double the amounts that would otherwise be awarded under paragraph (1), as the court considers just.

(2) Repeated violations. If the court determines that someone has violated section 1002 or 1003 within 3 years after a final judgment against that person for a previous violation, the court may increase the damage award to no more than double the amounts that would normally be awarded under paragraph (1), as the court sees fit.

(3) Innocent violations of section 1002. The court in its discretion may reduce the total award of damages against a person violating section 1002 to a sum of not less than $250 in any case in which the court finds that the violator was not aware and had no reason to believe that its acts constituted a violation of section 1002.

(3) Unintentional violations of section 1002. The court may choose to reduce the total damages awarded against someone who violates section 1002 to no less than $250 if the court determines that the violator was unaware and had no reason to believe that their actions were a violation of section 1002.

(e) Payment of Damages. Any award of damages under subsection (d) shall be deposited with the Register pursuant to section 1005 for distribution to interested copyright parties as though such funds were royalty payments made pursuant to section 1003.

(e) Payment of Damages. Any award of damages under subsection (d) will be deposited with the Register according to section 1005 for distribution to relevant copyright parties as if those funds were royalty payments made under section 1003.

(f) Impounding of Articles. At any time while an action under subsection (a) is pending, the court may order the impounding, on such terms as it deems reasonable, of any digital audio recording device, digital musical recording, or device specified in section 1002(c) that is in the custody or control of the alleged violator and that the court has reasonable cause to believe does not comply with, or was involved in a violation of, section 1002.

(f) Seizing of Items. At any point while a case under subsection (a) is ongoing, the court may order the seizure, under reasonable terms, of any digital audio recording device, digital music recording, or device mentioned in section 1002(c) that is in the possession or control of the alleged violator and that the court reasonably believes does not comply with, or was involved in a violation of, section 1002.

(g) Remedial Modification and Destruction of Articles. In an action brought under subsection (a), the court may, as part of a final judgment or decree finding a violation of section 1002, order the remedial modification or the destruction of any digital audio recording device, digital musical recording, or device specified in section 1002(c) that-

(g) Remedial Modification and Destruction of Articles. In a case brought under subsection (a), the court may, as part of a final judgment or decree finding a violation of section 1002, order the corrective modification or destruction of any digital audio recording device, digital music recording, or device specified in section 1002(c) that-

(1) does not comply with, or was involved in a violation of, section 1002, and

(1) does not comply with or was involved in a violation of section 1002, and

(2) is in the custody or control of the violator or has been impounded under subsection (f).

(2) is in the possession or control of the violator or has been towed under subsection (f).

Section 1010. Arbitration of certain disputes [6]

(a) Scope of Arbitration. Before the date of first distribution in the United States of a digital audio recording device or a digital audio interface device, any party manufacturing, importing, or distributing such device, and any interested copyright party may mutually agree to binding arbitration for the purpose of determining whether such device is subject to section 1002, or the basis on which royalty payments for such device are to be made under section 1003.

(a) Scope of Arbitration. Before the first date a digital audio recording device or a digital audio interface device is distributed in the United States, any party involved in manufacturing, importing, or distributing such a device, along with any interested copyright party, can mutually agree to binding arbitration to determine whether the device falls under section 1002, or how royalty payments for the device will be handled according to section 1003.

(b) Initiation of Arbitration Proceedings. Parties agreeing to such arbitration shall file a petition with the Librarian of Congress requesting the commencement of an arbitration proceeding. The petition may include the names and qualifications of potential arbitrators. Within 2 weeks after receiving such a petition, the Librarian of Congress shall cause notice to be published in the Federal Register of the initiation of an arbitration proceeding. Such notice shall include the names and qualifications of 3 arbitrators chosen by the Librarian of Congress from a list of available arbitrators obtained from the American Arbitration Association or such similar organization as the Librarian of Congress shall select, and from potential arbitrators listed in the parties' petition. The arbitrators selected under this subsection shall constitute an Arbitration Panel.

(b) Starting Arbitration Proceedings. Parties who agree to arbitration must submit a petition to the Librarian of Congress asking to begin the arbitration process. The petition can include the names and qualifications of potential arbitrators. Within 2 weeks of receiving the petition, the Librarian of Congress will publish a notice in the Federal Register about the start of the arbitration proceedings. This notice will include the names and qualifications of 3 arbitrators chosen by the Librarian of Congress from a list of available arbitrators provided by the American Arbitration Association or a similar organization selected by the Librarian of Congress, as well as from potential arbitrators mentioned in the parties' petition. The arbitrators chosen in this section will form an Arbitration Panel.

(c) Stay of Judicial Proceedings. Any civil action brought under section 1009 against a party to arbitration under this section shall, on application of one of the parties to the arbitration, be stayed until completion of the arbitration proceeding.

(c) Stay of Judicial Proceedings. Any civil action filed under section 1009 against a party involved in arbitration under this section shall, upon request from one of the arbitration parties, be paused until the arbitration process is finished.

(d) Arbitration Proceeding. The Arbitration Panel shall conduct an arbitration proceeding with respect to the matter concerned, in accordance with such procedures as it may adopt. The Panel shall act on the basis of a fully documented written record. Any party to the arbitration may submit relevant information and proposals to the Panel. The parties to the proceeding shall bear the entire cost thereof in such manner and proportion as the Panel shall direct.

(d) Arbitration Proceeding. The Arbitration Panel will conduct an arbitration proceeding regarding the matter at hand, following the procedures it decides to implement. The Panel will operate based on a complete documented written record. Any party involved in the arbitration can submit relevant information and proposals to the Panel. The parties involved in the proceeding will cover all costs in the manner and proportion that the Panel specifies.

(e) Report to the Librarian of Congress. Not later than 60 days after publication of the notice under subsection (b) of the initiation of an arbitration proceeding, the Arbitration Panel shall report to the Librarian of Congress its determination concerning whether the device concerned is subject to section 1002, or the basis on which royalty payments for the device are to be made under section 1003. Such report shall be accompanied by the written record, and shall set forth the facts that the Panel found relevant to its determination.

(e) Report to the Librarian of Congress. No later than 60 days after the notice under subsection (b) announcing the start of an arbitration proceeding is published, the Arbitration Panel must report to the Librarian of Congress its decision on whether the device in question falls under section 1002, or the reasons for how royalty payments for the device will be structured under section 1003. This report should include the written record and outline the facts that the Panel considered important to its decision.

(f) Action by the Librarian of Congress. Within 60 days after receiving the report of the Arbitration Panel under subsection (e), the Librarian of Congress shall adopt or reject the determination of the Panel. The Librarian of Congress shall adopt the determination of the Panel unless the Librarian of Congress finds that the determination is clearly erroneous. If the Librarian of Congress rejects the determination of the Panel, the Librarian of Congress shall, before the end of that 60-day period, and after full examination of the record created in the arbitration proceeding, issue an order setting forth the Librarian's decision and the reasons therefor. The Librarian of Congress shall cause to be published in the Federal Register the determination of the Panel and the decision of the Librarian of Congress under this subsection with respect to the determination (including any order issued under the preceding sentence).

(f) Action by the Librarian of Congress. Within 60 days of receiving the Arbitration Panel's report as described in subsection (e), the Librarian of Congress will either accept or reject the Panel's decision. The Librarian will accept the Panel's decision unless it is found to be clearly wrong. If the Librarian chooses to reject the Panel's decision, they must issue an order explaining their decision and the reasons for it before the 60-day period ends, after thoroughly reviewing the record from the arbitration process. The Librarian of Congress will ensure that the Panel's decision and the Librarian's ruling regarding that decision (including any order issued as mentioned above) are published in the Federal Register.

(g) Judicial Review. Any decision of the Librarian of Congress under subsection (f) with respect to a determination of the Arbitration Panel may be appealed, by a party to the arbitration, to the United States Court of Appeals for the District of Columbia Circuit, within 30 days after the publication of the decision in the Federal Register. The pendency of an appeal under this subsection shall not stay the decision of the Librarian of Congress. The court shall have jurisdiction to modify or vacate a decision of the Librarian of Congress only if it finds, on the basis of the record before the Librarian of Congress, that the Arbitration Panel or the Librarian of Congress acted in an arbitrary manner. If the court modifies the decision of the Librarian of Congress, the court shall have jurisdiction to enter its own decision in accordance with its final judgment. The court may further vacate the decision of the Librarian of Congress and remand the case for arbitration proceedings as provided in this section.

(g) Judicial Review. Any decision made by the Librarian of Congress under subsection (f) regarding a determination by the Arbitration Panel can be appealed by any party involved in the arbitration to the United States Court of Appeals for the District of Columbia Circuit within 30 days after the decision is published in the Federal Register. The pending appeal will not delay the decision made by the Librarian of Congress. The court has the authority to change or overturn the decision of the Librarian of Congress only if it finds that the Arbitration Panel or the Librarian acted arbitrarily, based on the record presented to the Librarian. If the court changes the decision, it can issue its own ruling in line with its final judgment. Additionally, the court may also overturn the decision of the Librarian of Congress and send the case back for arbitration proceedings as outlined in this section.

—————————- Chapter 10 Endnotes

Chapter 10 References

1 The Audio Home Recording Act of 1992 added chapter 10, entitled "Digital Audio Recording Devices and Media," to title 17. Pub. L. No. 102-563, 106 Stat. 4237.

1 The Audio Home Recording Act of 1992 added chapter 10, entitled "Digital Audio Recording Devices and Media," to title 17. Pub. L. No. 102-563, 106 Stat. 4237.

2 The Copyright Royalty Tribunal Reform Act of 1993 amended section 1004(a)(3) by substituting "Librarian of Congress" in lieu of "Copyright Royalty Tribunal," where appropriate. Pub. L. No. 103-198, 107 Stat. 2304, 2312.

2 The Copyright Royalty Tribunal Reform Act of 1993 changed section 1004(a)(3) by replacing "Copyright Royalty Tribunal" with "Librarian of Congress," where applicable. Pub. L. No. 103-198, 107 Stat. 2304, 2312.

3 The Copyright Royalty Tribunal Reform Act of 1993 amended section 1005 by striking the last sentence which began "The Register shall submit to the Copyright Royalty Tribunal." Pub. L. No. 103-198, 107 Stat. 2304, 2312.

3 The Copyright Royalty Tribunal Reform Act of 1993 changed section 1005 by removing the last sentence that started with "The Register shall submit to the Copyright Royalty Tribunal." Pub. L. No. 103-198, 107 Stat. 2304, 2312.

4 The Copyright Royalty Tribunal Reform Act of 1993 amended section 1006(c) by substituting "Librarian of Congress" in lieu of "Copyright Royalty Tribunal," where appropriate. Pub. L. No. 103-198, 107 Stat. 2304, 2312. In 1997, section 1006(b)(1) was amended to insert "Federation of Television" in lieu of "Federation Television" wherever it appeared. Pub. L. No. 105-80, 111 Stat. 1529, 1535.

4 The Copyright Royalty Tribunal Reform Act of 1993 changed section 1006(c) by replacing "Copyright Royalty Tribunal" with "Librarian of Congress" where it was needed. Pub. L. No. 103-198, 107 Stat. 2304, 2312. In 1997, section 1006(b)(1) was updated to replace "Federation Television" with "Federation of Television" wherever it showed up. Pub. L. No. 105-80, 111 Stat. 1529, 1535.

5 The Copyright Royalty Tribunal Reform Act of 1993 amended section 1007 by substituting "Librarian of Congress" in lieu of "Copyright Royalty Tribunal" or "Tribunal," where appropriate, by amending the first sentence in subsection (c) and by inserting "the reasonable administrative costs incurred by the Librarian" in the last sentence of subsection (c), in lieu of "its reasonable administrative costs." Pub. L. No. 103-198, 107 Stat. 2304, 2312.

5 The Copyright Royalty Tribunal Reform Act of 1993 changed section 1007 by replacing "Copyright Royalty Tribunal" or "Tribunal" with "Librarian of Congress" where necessary, by revising the first sentence in subsection (c), and by adding "the reasonable administrative costs incurred by the Librarian" at the end of subsection (c), instead of "its reasonable administrative costs." Pub. L. No. 103-198, 107 Stat. 2304, 2312.

In 1997, section 1007 was amended, in subsection (a)(1), by inserting "calendar year 1992" in lieu of "the calendar year in which this chapter takes effect" and, in subsection (b), by inserting "1992" in lieu of "the year in which this section takes effect," and also in subsection (b), by inserting "After" in lieu of "Within 30 days after." Pub. L. No. 105-80, 111 Stat. 1529, 1534 and 1535.

In 1997, section 1007 was changed in subsection (a)(1) by replacing "the calendar year in which this chapter takes effect" with "calendar year 1992," and in subsection (b) by replacing "the year in which this section takes effect" with "1992." Additionally, in subsection (b), "After" was added instead of "Within 30 days after." Pub. L. No. 105-80, 111 Stat. 1529, 1534 and 1535.

6 The Copyright Royalty Tribunal Reform Act of 1993 amended section 1010 by substituting "Librarian of Congress" in lieu of "Copyright Royalty Tribunal" or "Tribunal," where appropriate, and by inserting "Librarian's" in lieu of "its." Pub. L. No. 103-198, 107 Stat. 2304, 2312. That Act, which established copyright arbitration royalty panels, states that "[a]ll royalty rates and all determinations with respect to the proportionate division of compulsory license fees among copyright claimants, whether made by the Copyright Royalty Tribunal, or by voluntary agreement, before the effective date set forth in subsection (a) [December 17, 1993] shall remain in effect until modified by voluntary agreement or pursuant to the amendments made by this Act." Pub. L. No. 103-198, 107 Stat. 2304, 2313.

6 The Copyright Royalty Tribunal Reform Act of 1993 changed section 1010 by replacing "Copyright Royalty Tribunal" or "Tribunal" with "Librarian of Congress" where applicable, and adding "Librarian's" instead of "its." Pub. L. No. 103-198, 107 Stat. 2304, 2312. This Act, which set up copyright arbitration royalty panels, states that "[a]ll royalty rates and all determinations regarding the division of compulsory license fees among copyright claimants, whether made by the Copyright Royalty Tribunal or by voluntary agreement, before the date effective as described in subsection (a) [December 17, 1993] will remain in effect until changed by voluntary agreement or under the amendments made by this Act." Pub. L. No. 103-198, 107 Stat. 2304, 2313.

————————————————————————————————————

Understood! Please provide the text you'd like to modernize.

Chapter 11 [1]

Sound Recordings and Music Videos

Audio and Music Videos

+ 1101. Unauthorized fixation and trafficking in sound recordings and music videos

+ 1101. Illegal recording and distribution of sound recordings and music videos

Section 1101. Unauthorized fixation and trafficking in sound recordings and music videos

(a) Unauthorized Acts. Anyone who, without the consent of the performer or performers involved-

(a) Unauthorized Acts. Anyone who, without getting the permission of the performer or performers involved-

(1) fixes the sounds or sounds and images of a live musical performance in a copy or phonorecord, or reproduces copies or phonorecords of such a performance from an unauthorized fixation,

(1) records the sounds or sounds and images of a live musical performance in a copy or phonorecord, or reproduces copies or phonorecords of that performance from an unauthorized recording,

(2) transmits or otherwise communicates to the public the sounds or sounds and images of a live musical performance, or

(2) sends or otherwise shares with the public the sounds or sounds and images of a live music performance, or

(3) distributes or offers to distribute, sells or offers to sell, rents or offers to rent, or traffics in any copy or phonorecord fixed as described in paragraph (1), regardless of whether the fixations occurred in the United States,

(3) distributes or offers to distribute, sells or offers to sell, rents or offers to rent, or deals in any copy or phonorecord fixed as described in paragraph (1), regardless of whether the recordings were made in the United States,

shall be subject to the remedies provided in sections 502 through 505, to the same extent as an infringer of copyright.

shall be subject to the remedies outlined in sections 502 through 505, just like any other copyright infringer.

(b) Definition. As used in this section, the term "traffic in" means transport, transfer, or otherwise dispose of, to another, as consideration for anything of value, or make or obtain control of with intent to transport, transfer, or dispose of.

(b) Definition. As used in this section, the term "traffic in" means to transport, transfer, or otherwise give to someone else, as payment for something valuable, or to gain control of with the intention to transport, transfer, or give away.

(c) Applicability. This section shall apply to any act or acts that occur on or after the date of the enactment of the Uruguay Round Agreements Act.

(c) Applicability. This section applies to any actions that happen on or after the date the Uruguay Round Agreements Act is enacted.

(d) State Law Not Preempted. Nothing in this section may be construed to annul or limit any rights or remedies under the common law or statutes of any State.

(d) State Law Not Preempted. Nothing in this section can be interpreted as cancelling or limiting any rights or remedies under the common law or laws of any State.

————————— Chapter 11 Endnote

Chapter 11 Footnote

1 In 1994, the Uruguay Round Agreements Act added chapter 11, entitled "Sound Recordings and Music Videos," to title 17. Pub. L. No. 103-465, 108 Stat. 4809, 4974.

1 In 1994, the Uruguay Round Agreements Act added chapter 11, titled "Sound Recordings and Music Videos," to title 17. Pub. L. No. 103-465, 108 Stat. 4809, 4974.

————————————————————————————————————

Understood! Please provide the text you want me to modernize.

Chapter 12 [1] Copyright Protection and Management Systems

+ 1201. Circumvention of copyright protection systems + 1202. Integrity of copyright management information + 1203. Civil remedies + 1204. Criminal offenses and penalties + 1205. Savings clause

+ 1201. Bypassing copyright protection systems + 1202. Protection of copyright management information + 1203. Legal remedies + 1204. Criminal offenses and penalties + 1205. Savings clause

Section 1201. Circumvention of copyright protection systems [2]

(a) Violations Regarding Circumvention of Technological Measures. (1)(A) No person shall circumvent a technological measure that effectively controls access to a work protected under this title. The prohibition contained in the preceding sentence shall take effect at the end of the 2-year period beginning on the date of the enactment of this chapter.

(a) Violations Related to Bypassing Tech Measures. (1)(A) No one is allowed to bypass a technological measure that effectively controls access to a work protected under this title. The ban mentioned in the previous sentence will take effect at the end of the 2-year period starting from the enactment date of this chapter.

(B) The prohibition contained in subparagraph (A) shall not apply to persons who are users of a copyrighted work which is in a particular class of works, if such persons are, or are likely to be in the succeeding 3-year period, adversely affected by virtue of such prohibition in their ability to make noninfringing uses of that particular class of works under this title, as determined under subparagraph (C).

(B) The ban mentioned in subparagraph (A) won't apply to people who use a copyrighted work that falls into a specific category, if those people are, or are likely to be in the next 3 years, negatively impacted by this ban regarding their ability to make legal uses of that specific category of works under this title, as determined under subparagraph (C).

(C) During the 2-year period described in subparagraph (A), and during each succeeding 3-year period, the Librarian of Congress, upon the recommendation of the Register of Copyrights, who shall consult with the Assistant Secretary for Communications and Information of the Department of Commerce and report and comment on his or her views in making such recommendation, shall make the determination in a rulemaking proceeding for purposes of subparagraph (B) of whether persons who are users of a copyrighted work are, or are likely to be in the succeeding 3-year period, adversely affected by the prohibition under subparagraph (A) in their ability to make noninfringing uses under this title of a particular class of copyrighted works. In conducting such rule-making, the Librarian shall examine-

(C) During the 2-year period mentioned in subparagraph (A), and for each subsequent 3-year period, the Librarian of Congress, following the advice of the Register of Copyrights—who will consult with the Assistant Secretary for Communications and Information of the Department of Commerce and provide feedback—will decide in a rulemaking process whether individuals who use a copyrighted work are, or are likely to be in the next 3-year period, negatively impacted by the restriction in subparagraph (A) on their ability to make non-infringing uses under this title of a specific category of copyrighted works. In carrying out this rulemaking, the Librarian will assess-

(i) the availability for use of copyrighted works;

(i) the accessibility of copyrighted works for use;

(ii) the availability for use of works for nonprofit archival, preservation, and educational purposes;

(ii) the accessibility of works for nonprofit archiving, preservation, and educational use;

(iii) the impact that the prohibition on the circumvention of technological measures applied to copyrighted works has on criticism, comment, news reporting, teaching, scholarship, or research;

(iii) the effect that the ban on bypassing technological measures put in place for copyrighted works has on criticism, commentary, news reporting, teaching, scholarship, or research;

(iv) the effect of circumvention of technological measures on the market for or value of copyrighted works; and

(iv) the impact of bypassing technological measures on the market for or value of copyrighted works; and

(v) such other factors as the Librarian considers appropriate.

(v) any other factors the Librarian thinks are relevant.

(D) The Librarian shall publish any class of copyrighted works for which the Librarian has determined, pursuant to the rulemaking conducted under subparagraph (C), that noninfringing uses by persons who are users of a copyrighted work are, or are likely to be, adversely affected, and the prohibition contained in subparagraph (A) shall not apply to such users with respect to such class of works for the ensuing 3-year period.

(D) The Librarian will publish any type of copyrighted works for which the Librarian has decided, based on the rulemaking done under subparagraph (C), that noninfringing uses by people who use a copyrighted work are, or are likely to be, negatively impacted, and the prohibition in subparagraph (A) will not apply to those users concerning that category of works for the next 3-year period.

(E) Neither the exception under subparagraph (B) from the applicability of the prohibition contained in subparagraph (A), nor any determination made in a rulemaking conducted under subparagraph (C), may be used as a defense in any action to enforce any provision of this title other than this paragraph.

(E) Neither the exception in subparagraph (B) that removes the prohibition in subparagraph (A) nor any decision made in a rulemaking under subparagraph (C) can be used as a defense in any action to enforce any provision of this title other than this paragraph.

(2) No person shall manufacture, import, offer to the public, provide, or otherwise traffic in any technology, product, service, device, component, or part thereof, that-

(2) No one is allowed to manufacture, import, offer to the public, provide, or otherwise sell any technology, product, service, device, component, or part of it, that-

(A) is primarily designed or produced for the purpose of circumventing a technological measure that effectively controls access to a work protected under this title;

(A) is mainly designed or made to get around a tech measure that effectively controls access to a work protected under this title;

(B) has only limited commercially significant purpose or use other than to circumvent a technological measure that effectively controls access to a work protected under this title; or

(B) has only a limited significant commercial purpose or use other than to bypass a technological measure that effectively controls access to a work protected under this title; or

(C) is marketed by that person or another acting in concert with that person with that person's knowledge for use in circumventing a technological measure that effectively controls access to a work protected under this title.

(C) is promoted by that person or someone working together with that person, with that person's awareness, to be used for bypassing a technological measure that effectively restricts access to a work protected under this title.

(3) As used in this subsection-

(3) As used in this subsection-

(A) to "circumvent a technological measure" means to descramble a scrambled work, to decrypt an encrypted work, or otherwise to avoid, bypass, remove, deactivate, or impair a technological measure, without the authority of the copyright owner; and

(A) to "circumvent a technological measure" means to unscramble a scrambled work, to decrypt an encrypted work, or otherwise to avoid, bypass, remove, deactivate, or weaken a technological measure, without the approval of the copyright owner; and

(B) a technological measure "effectively controls access to a work" if the measure, in the ordinary course of its operation, requires the application of information, or a process or a treatment, with the authority of the copyright owner, to gain access to the work.

(B) a technological measure "effectively controls access to a work" if the measure, in the normal course of its operation, requires the use of information, or a process or treatment, with the permission of the copyright owner, to gain access to the work.

(b) Additional Violations. (1) No person shall manufacture, import, offer to the public, provide, or otherwise traffic in any technology, product, service, device, component, or part thereof, that-

(b) Additional Violations. (1) No one is allowed to make, import, sell to the public, offer, or otherwise deal in any technology, product, service, device, component, or part of it, that-

(A) is primarily designed or produced for the purpose of circumventing protection afforded by a technological measure that effectively protects a right of a copyright owner under this title in a work or a portion thereof;

(A) is mainly created or made to get around the protection provided by a technological measure that effectively safeguards a copyright owner's rights under this title in a work or part of it;

(B) has only limited commercially significant purpose or use other than to circumvent protection afforded by a technological measure that effectively protects a right of a copyright owner under this title in a work or a portion thereof; or

(B) has only a limited commercial purpose or use other than to get around the protection provided by a technology that effectively safeguards a copyright owner's rights under this title in a work or part of it; or

(C) is marketed by that person or another acting in concert with that person with that person's knowledge for use in circumventing protection afforded by a technological measure that effectively protects a right of a copyright owner under this title in a work or a portion thereof.

(C) is promoted by that person or someone working together with that person, with their knowledge, to bypass the protection provided by a technological measure that effectively safeguards a copyright owner's rights under this title in a work or part of it.

(2) As used in this subsection-

(2) As used in this subsection-

(A) to "circumvent protection afforded by a technological measure" means avoiding, bypassing, removing, deactivating, or otherwise impairing a technological measure; and

(A) to "circumvent protection provided by a technological measure" means avoiding, bypassing, removing, deactivating, or otherwise weakening a technological measure; and

(B) a technological measure "effectively protects a right of a copyright owner under this title" if the measure, in the ordinary course of its operation, prevents, restricts, or otherwise limits the exercise of a right of a copyright owner under this title.

(B) a technological measure "effectively protects a right of a copyright owner under this title" if the measure, in its normal operation, prevents, restricts, or otherwise limits the exercise of a copyright owner's rights under this title.

(c) Other Rights, Etc., Not Affected. (1) Nothing in this section shall affect rights, remedies, limitations, or defenses to copyright infringement, including fair use, under this title.

(c) Other Rights, Etc., Not Affected. (1) Nothing in this section will affect rights, remedies, limitations, or defenses against copyright infringement, including fair use, under this title.

(2) Nothing in this section shall enlarge or diminish vicarious or contributory liability for copyright infringement in connection with any technology, product, service, device, component, or part thereof.

(2) Nothing in this section will increase or decrease vicarious or contributory liability for copyright infringement related to any technology, product, service, device, component, or part of it.

(3) Nothing in this section shall require that the design of, or design and selection of parts and components for, a consumer electronics, telecommunications, or computing product provide for a response to any particular technological measure, so long as such part or component, or the product in which such part or component is integrated, does not otherwise fall within the prohibitions of subsection (a)(2) or (b)(1).

(3) Nothing in this section requires that the design of, or the design and selection of parts and components for, a consumer electronics, telecommunications, or computing product respond to any specific technological measure, as long as that part or component, or the product it’s integrated into, doesn’t violate the prohibitions in subsection (a)(2) or (b)(1).

(4) Nothing in this section shall enlarge or diminish any rights of free speech or the press for activities using consumer electronics, telecommunications, or computing products.

(4) Nothing in this section shall expand or reduce any rights to free speech or the press related to activities using consumer electronics, telecommunications, or computing products.

(d) Exemption for Nonprofit Libraries, Archives, and Educational Institutions.

(d) Exemption for Nonprofit Libraries, Archives, and Educational Institutions.

(1) A nonprofit library, archives, or educational institution which gains access to a commercially exploited copyrighted work solely in order to make a good faith determination of whether to acquire a copy of that work for the sole purpose of engaging in conduct permitted under this title shall not be in violation of subsection (a)(1)(A). A copy of a work to which access has been gained under this paragraph-

(1) A nonprofit library, archives, or educational institution that gets access to a copyrighted work being commercially used, only to honestly decide whether to obtain a copy of that work for the specific purpose of doing something allowed under this title, will not violate subsection (a)(1)(A). A copy of a work accessed under this paragraph-

(A) may not be retained longer than necessary to make such good faith determination; and

(A) may not be kept longer than necessary to make that good faith determination; and

(B) may not be used for any other purpose.

(B) may not be used for any other purpose.

(2) The exemption made available under paragraph (1) shall only apply with respect to a work when an identical copy of that work is not reasonably available in another form.

(2) The exemption mentioned in paragraph (1) only applies to a work when an identical copy of that work is not reasonably available in another format.

(3) A nonprofit library, archives, or educational institution that willfully for the purpose of commercial advantage or financial gain violates paragraph (1)-

(3) A nonprofit library, archive, or educational institution that intentionally violates paragraph (1) for the sake of commercial benefit or profit-

(A) shall, for the first offense, be subject to the civil remedies under section 1203; and

(A) will, for the first offense, be subject to the civil remedies under section 1203; and

(B) shall, for repeated or subsequent offenses, in addition to the civil remedies under section 1203, forfeit the exemption provided under paragraph (1).

(B) will, for repeated or later offenses, in addition to the civil remedies under section 1203, lose the exemption provided in paragraph (1).

(4) This subsection may not be used as a defense to a claim under subsection (a)(2) or (b), nor may this subsection permit a nonprofit library, archives, or educational institution to manufacture, import, offer to the public, provide, or otherwise traffic in any technology, product, service, component, or part thereof, which circumvents a technological measure.

(4) This subsection cannot be used as a defense against a claim under subsection (a)(2) or (b), nor does it allow a nonprofit library, archive, or educational institution to create, import, offer to the public, provide, or otherwise deal in any technology, product, service, component, or part that bypasses a technological measure.

(5) In order for a library or archives to qualify for the exemption under this subsection, the collections of that library or archives shall be-

(5) For a library or archives to qualify for the exemption under this subsection, the collections of that library or archives must be-

(A) open to the public; or

(A) open to the public; or

(B) available not only to researchers affiliated with the library or archives or with the institution of which it is a part, but also to other persons doing research in a specialized field.

(B) available not just to researchers connected with the library or archives or with the institution it belongs to, but also to others conducting research in a specialized area.

(e) Law Enforcement, Intelligence, and Other Government Activities. This section does not prohibit any lawfully authorized investigative, protective, information security, or intelligence activity of an officer, agent, or employee of the United States, a State, or a political subdivision of a State, or a person acting pursuant to a contract with the United States, a State, or a political subdivision of a State. For purposes of this subsection, the term "information security" means activities carried out in order to identify and address the vulnerabilities of a government computer, computer system, or computer network.

(e) Law Enforcement, Intelligence, and Other Government Activities. This section does not prevent any legally authorized investigative, protective, information security, or intelligence activities conducted by an officer, agent, or employee of the United States, a State, or a political subdivision of a State, or by someone acting under a contract with the United States, a State, or a political subdivision of a State. For the purposes of this subsection, the term "information security" refers to activities aimed at identifying and addressing the vulnerabilities of a government computer, computer system, or computer network.

(f) Reverse Engineering. (1) Notwithstanding the provisions of subsection (a)(1)(A), a person who has lawfully obtained the right to use a copy of a computer program may circumvent a technological measure that effectively controls access to a particular portion of that program for the sole purpose of identifying and analyzing those elements of the program that are necessary to achieve interoperability of an independently created computer program with other programs, and that have not previously been readily available to the person engaging in the circumvention, to the extent any such acts of identification and analysis do not constitute infringement under this title.

(f) Reverse Engineering. (1) Even with the rules in subsection (a)(1)(A), someone who has legally obtained the right to use a copy of a computer program can bypass a technological measure that effectively controls access to a specific part of that program, but only for the purpose of identifying and analyzing the elements of the program needed to make an independently created computer program work with other programs. This is allowed as long as those elements haven’t been easily available to the person doing the bypassing, and as long as the actions of identification and analysis do not violate any rights under this title.

(2) Notwithstanding the provisions of subsections (a)(2) and (b), a person may develop and employ technological means to circumvent a technological measure, or to circumvent protection afforded by a technological measure, in order to enable the identification and analysis under paragraph (1), or for the purpose of enabling interoperability of an independently created computer program with other programs, if such means are necessary to achieve such interoperability, to the extent that doing so does not constitute infringement under this title.

(2) Regardless of what’s stated in subsections (a)(2) and (b), a person is allowed to create and use technical methods to bypass a technological measure, or to get around protections offered by a technological measure, as long as it’s for the purpose of identification and analysis under paragraph (1), or to enable independently created software to work with other programs, if those methods are essential for achieving that compatibility, provided that it doesn’t count as infringement under this title.

(3) The information acquired through the acts permitted under paragraph (1), and the means permitted under paragraph (2), may be made available to others if the person referred to in paragraph (1) or (2), as the case may be, provides such information or means solely for the purpose of enabling interoperability of an independently created computer program with other programs, and to the extent that doing so does not constitute infringement under this title or violate applicable law other than this section.

(3) The information obtained through the actions allowed in paragraph (1), and the methods allowed in paragraph (2), may be shared with others if the individual mentioned in paragraph (1) or (2), as appropriate, provides that information or those methods exclusively to allow an independently developed computer program to work with other programs, and only to the extent that this does not violate any rights under this title or breach any laws other than this section.

(4) For purposes of this subsection, the term "interoperability" means the ability of computer programs to exchange information, and of such programs mutually to use the information which has been exchanged.

(4) In this section, "interoperability" refers to the ability of computer programs to share information and to use the information that has been shared.

(g) Encryption Research.

Encryption Research.

(1) Definitions. For purposes of this subsection-

(1) Definitions. For the purposes of this subsection-

(A) the term "encryption research" means activities necessary to identify and analyze flaws and vulnerabilities of encryption technologies applied to copyrighted works, if these activities are conducted to advance the state of knowledge in the field of encryption technology or to assist in the development of encryption products; and

(A) the term "encryption research" refers to activities required to identify and analyze weaknesses and vulnerabilities in encryption technologies used for copyrighted works, as long as these activities are performed to enhance understanding in the field of encryption technology or to aid in the creation of encryption products; and

(B) the term "encryption technology" means the scrambling and descrambling of information using mathematical formulas or algorithms.

(B) the term "encryption technology" refers to the process of scrambling and unscrambling information using mathematical formulas or algorithms.

(2) Permissible Acts of Encryption Research. Notwithstanding the provisions of subsection (a)(1)(A), it is not a violation of that subsection for a person to circumvent a technological measure as applied to a copy, phonorecord, performance, or display of a published work in the course of an act of good faith encryption research if-

(2) Allowed Actions for Encryption Research. Regardless of the rules in subsection (a)(1)(A), a person is not breaking that rule if they bypass a technological measure related to a copy, phonorecord, performance, or display of a published work while genuinely conducting encryption research if-

(A) the person lawfully obtained the encrypted copy, phonorecord, performance, or display of the published work;

(A) the person legally acquired the encrypted copy, recording, performance, or display of the published work;

(B) such act is necessary to conduct such encryption research;

(B) that action is necessary to carry out this encryption research;

(C) the person made a good faith effort to obtain authorization before the circumvention; and

(C) the person tried seriously to get permission before bypassing it; and

(D) such act does not constitute infringement under this title or a violation of applicable law other than this section, including section 1030 of title 18 and those provisions of title 18 amended by the Computer Fraud and Abuse Act of 1986.

(D) such action does not count as infringement under this title or as a violation of any applicable law outside of this section, including section 1030 of title 18 and those parts of title 18 that were changed by the Computer Fraud and Abuse Act of 1986.

(3) Factors in Determining Exemption. In determining whether a person qualifies for the exemption under paragraph (2), the factors to be considered shall include-

(3) Factors in Determining Exemption. In figuring out if someone qualifies for the exemption under paragraph (2), the factors to take into account will include-

(A) whether the information derived from the encryption research was disseminated, and if so, whether it was disseminated in a manner reasonably calculated to advance the state of knowledge or development of encryption technology, versus whether it was disseminated in a manner that facilitates infringement under this title or a violation of applicable law other than this section, including a violation of privacy or breach of security;

(A) whether the information from the encryption research was shared, and if it was, whether it was shared in a way that reasonably aimed to enhance the understanding or progress of encryption technology, as opposed to being shared in a way that promotes infringement under this title or violates any applicable laws besides this section, including privacy violations or security breaches;

(B) whether the person is engaged in a legitimate course of study, is employed, or is appropriately trained or experienced, in the field of encryption technology; and

(B) whether the person is involved in a legitimate course of study, is employed, or has the right training or experience in the field of encryption technology; and

(C) whether the person provides the copyright owner of the work to which the technological measure is applied with notice of the findings and documentation of the research, and the time when such notice is provided.

(C) whether the person informs the copyright owner of the work that the technological measure is applied to, providing notice of the findings and documentation of the research, and the time when that notice is given.

(4) Use of Technological Means for Research Activities. Notwithstanding the provisions of subsection (a)(2), it is not a violation of that subsection for a person to-

(4) Use of Technology for Research Activities. Despite the rules in subsection (a)(2), it is not a violation of that subsection for someone to-

(A) develop and employ technological means to circumvent a technological measure for the sole purpose of that person performing the acts of good faith encryption research described in paragraph (2); and

(A) develop and use tech tools to bypass a technological measure solely for the purpose of that person conducting the good faith encryption research mentioned in paragraph (2); and

(B) provide the technological means to another person with whom he or she is working collaboratively for the purpose of conducting the acts of good faith encryption research described in paragraph (2) or for the purpose of having that other person verify his or her acts of good faith encryption research described in paragraph (2).

(B) offer the technological tools to someone they're working with collaboratively to carry out the acts of good faith encryption research mentioned in paragraph (2) or to allow that person to verify their own acts of good faith encryption research outlined in paragraph (2).

(5) Report to Congress. Not later than 1 year after the date of the enactment of this chapter, the Register of Copyrights and the Assistant Secretary for Communications and Information of the Department of Commerce shall jointly report to the Congress on the effect this subsection has had on-

(5) Report to Congress. No later than 1 year after the enactment of this chapter, the Register of Copyrights and the Assistant Secretary for Communications and Information of the Department of Commerce shall jointly report to Congress on the impact this subsection has had on-

(A) encryption research and the development of encryption technology;

(A) research on encryption and the advancement of encryption technology;

(B) the adequacy and effectiveness of technological measures designed to protect copyrighted works; and

(B) the sufficiency and efficiency of tech solutions aimed at safeguarding copyrighted materials; and

(C) protection of copyright owners against the unauthorized access to their encrypted copyrighted works.

(C) protection of copyright owners from unauthorized access to their encrypted copyrighted works.

The report shall include legislative recommendations, if any.

The report will include any legislative recommendations, if there are any.

(h) Exceptions Regarding Minors. In applying subsection (a) to a component or part, the court may consider the necessity for its intended and actual incorporation in a technology, product, service, or device, which-

(h) Exceptions Regarding Minors. In applying subsection (a) to a component or part, the court may look at how necessary it is for that component or part to be included in a technology, product, service, or device, which-

(1) does not itself violate the provisions of this title; and

(1) does not violate the rules of this title; and

(2) has the sole purpose to prevent the access of minors to material on the Internet.

(2) is designed solely to prevent minors from accessing content on the Internet.

(i) Protection of Personally Identifying Information.

(i) Protection of Personally Identifiable Information.

(1) Circumvention Permitted. Notwithstanding the provisions of subsection (a)(1)(A), it is not a violation of that subsection for a person to circumvent a technological measure that effectively controls access to a work protected under this title, if-

(1) Circumvention Permitted. Despite what’s stated in subsection (a)(1)(A), it’s not considered a violation of that subsection for someone to bypass a technological measure that effectively restricts access to a work protected under this title, if-

(A) the technological measure, or the work it protects, contains the capability of collecting or disseminating personally identifying information reflecting the online activities of a natural person who seeks to gain access to the work protected;

(A) the technological measure, or the work it protects, has the ability to gather or share personally identifiable information related to the online activities of an individual who wants to access the protected work;

(B) in the normal course of its operation, the technological measure, or the work it protects, collects or disseminates personally identifying information about the person who seeks to gain access to the work protected, without providing conspicuous notice of such collection or dissemination to such person, and without providing such person with the capability to prevent or restrict such collection or dissemination;

(B) during its regular operation, the technological measure, or the work it safeguards, gathers or shares personal identification information about the individual trying to access the protected work, without giving clear notice of this collection or sharing to that individual, and without offering that individual the ability to stop or limit this collection or sharing;

(C) the act of circumvention has the sole effect of identifying and disabling the capability described in subparagraph (A), and has no other effect on the ability of any person to gain access to any work; and

(C) the act of bypassing only serves to identify and disable the capability mentioned in subparagraph (A), and has no other impact on anyone's ability to access any work; and

(D) the act of circumvention is carried out solely for the purpose of preventing the collection or dissemination of personally identifying information about a natural person who seeks to gain access to the work protected, and is not in violation of any other law.

(D) the act of circumventing is done only to prevent the collection or sharing of personally identifiable information about an individual who wants to access the protected work, and does not violate any other laws.

(2) Inapplicability to Certain Technological Measures.

(2) Not applicable to certain technological measures.

This subsection does not apply to a technological measure, or a work it protects, that does not collect or disseminate personally identifying information and that is disclosed to a user as not having or using such capability.

This subsection doesn’t apply to a technological measure, or a work it protects, that doesn’t collect or share personally identifying information and that is communicated to a user as not having or using that capability.

(j) Security Testing.

Security Testing.

(1) Definition. For purposes of this subsection, the term "security testing" means accessing a computer, computer system, or computer network, solely for the purpose of good faith testing, investigating, or correcting, a security flaw or vulnerability, with the authorization of the owner or operator of such computer, computer system, or computer network.

(1) Definition. For this subsection, "security testing" refers to accessing a computer, computer system, or computer network only to genuinely test, investigate, or fix a security flaw or vulnerability, with the permission of the owner or operator of that computer, computer system, or computer network.

(2) Permissible Acts of Security Testing. Notwithstanding the provisions of subsection (a)(1)(A), it is not a violation of that subsection for a person to engage in an act of security testing, if such act does not constitute infringement under this title or a violation of applicable law other than this section, including section 1030 of title 18 and those provisions of title 18 amended by the Computer Fraud and Abuse Act of 1986.

(2) Acceptable Security Testing Activities. Despite what’s stated in subsection (a)(1)(A), it’s not considered a violation of that subsection for someone to perform a security test, as long as that test doesn’t infringe on this title or break any other laws aside from this section, including section 1030 of title 18 and the parts of title 18 changed by the Computer Fraud and Abuse Act of 1986.

(3) Factors in Determining Exemption. In determining whether a person qualifies for the exemption under paragraph (2), the factors to be considered shall include-

(3) Factors in Determining Exemption. In deciding if a person qualifies for the exemption under paragraph (2), the factors to consider include-

(A) whether the information derived from the security testing was used solely to promote the security of the owner or operator of such computer, computer system or computer network, or shared directly with the developer of such computer, computer system, or computer network; and

(A) whether the information obtained from the security testing was used only to enhance the security of the owner or operator of that computer, computer system, or computer network, or shared directly with the developer of that computer, computer system, or computer network; and

(B) whether the information derived from the security testing was used or maintained in a manner that does not facilitate infringement under this title or a violation of applicable law other than this section, including a violation of privacy or breach of security.

(B) whether the information obtained from the security testing was used or kept in a way that doesn’t promote infringement under this title or violate any applicable laws besides this section, including privacy violations or security breaches.

(4) Use of Technological Means for Security Testing. Notwithstanding the provisions of subsection (a)(2), it is not a violation of that subsection for a person to develop, produce, distribute or employ technological means for the sole purpose of performing the acts of security testing described in subsection (2), provided such technological means does not otherwise violate section (a)(2).

(4) Use of Technology for Security Testing. Despite the rules in subsection (a)(2), it is not considered a violation of that subsection for someone to create, produce, share, or use technology specifically for the acts of security testing mentioned in subsection (2), as long as that technology doesn't otherwise break the rules in section (a)(2).

(k) Certain Analog Devices and Certain Technological Measures.

(k) Certain Analog Devices and Certain Technological Measures.

(1) Certain Analog Devices.

Specific Analog Devices.

(A) Effective 18 months after the date of the enactment of this chapter, no person shall manufacture, import, offer to the public, provide or otherwise traffic in any-

(A) Effective 18 months after the date this chapter is enacted, no person may manufacture, import, offer to the public, provide, or otherwise traffic in any-

(i) VHS format analog video cassette recorder unless such recorder conforms to the automatic gain control copy control technology;

(i) VHS format analog video cassette recorder unless that recorder meets the automatic gain control copy control technology;

(ii) 8mm format analog video cassette camcorder unless such camcorder conforms to the automatic gain control technology;

(ii) 8mm format analog video cassette camcorder unless that camcorder uses automatic gain control technology;

(iii) Beta format analog video cassette recorder, unless such recorder conforms to the automatic gain control copy control technology, except that this requirement shall not apply until there are 1,000 Beta format analog video cassette recorders sold in the United States in any one calendar year after the date of the enactment of this chapter;

(iii) Beta format analog video cassette recorders, unless those recorders use automatic gain control copy control technology. However, this requirement won’t apply until 1,000 Beta format analog video cassette recorders are sold in the United States in any single calendar year after the enactment of this chapter;

(iv) 8mm format analog video cassette recorder that is not an analog video cassette camcorder, unless such recorder conforms to the automatic gain control copy control technology, except that this requirement shall not apply until there are 20,000 such recorders sold in the United States in any one calendar year after the date of the enactment of this chapter; or

(iv) 8mm format analog video cassette recorder that isn’t an analog video cassette camcorder, unless that recorder meets the automatic gain control copy control technology, but this requirement won’t kick in until 20,000 of those recorders are sold in the United States in any single calendar year after the date this chapter is enacted; or

(v) analog video cassette recorder that records using an NTSC format video input and that is not otherwise covered under clauses (i) through (iv), unless such device conforms to the automatic gain control copy control technology.

(v) analog video cassette recorder that records using an NTSC format video input and that is not otherwise covered under clauses (i) through (iv), unless such a device conforms to the automatic gain control copy control technology.

(B) Effective on the date of the enactment of this chapter, no person shall manufacture, import, offer to the public, provide or otherwise traffic in-

(B) Effective on the date this chapter is enacted, no one shall manufacture, import, offer to the public, provide, or otherwise deal in-

(i) any VHS format analog video cassette recorder or any 8mm format analog video cassette recorder if the design of the model of such recorder has been modified after such date of enactment so that a model of recorder that previously conformed to the automatic gain control copy control technology no longer conforms to such technology; or

(i) any VHS format analog video cassette recorder or any 8mm format analog video cassette recorder if the design of the model of such recorder has been changed after that date of enactment so that a model of recorder that used to follow the automatic gain control copy control technology no longer complies with that technology; or

(ii) any VHS format analog video cassette recorder, or any 8mm format analog video cassette recorder that is not an 8mm analog video cassette camcorder, if the design of the model of such recorder has been modified after such date of enactment so that a model of recorder that previously conformed to the four-line colorstripe copy control technology no longer conforms to such technology.

(ii) any VHS format analog video cassette recorder, or any 8mm format analog video cassette recorder that is not an 8mm analog video cassette camcorder, if the design of that model has been changed after the date of enactment so that a model that previously met the four-line colorstripe copy control technology no longer meets that technology.

Manufacturers that have not previously manufactured or sold a VHS format analog video cassette recorder, or an 8mm format analog cassette recorder, shall be required to conform to the four-line colorstripe copy control technology in the initial model of any such recorder manufactured after the date of the enactment of this chapter, and thereafter to continue conforming to the four-line colorstripe copy control technology. For purposes of this subparagraph, an analog video cassette recorder "conforms to" the four-line colorstripe copy control technology if it records a signal that, when played back by the playback function of that recorder in the normal viewing mode, exhibits, on a reference display device, a display containing distracting visible lines through portions of the viewable picture.

Manufacturers that have not previously produced or sold a VHS format analog video cassette recorder or an 8mm format analog cassette recorder must comply with the four-line colorstripe copy control technology in the first model of any such recorder made after the date this chapter is enacted, and continue to comply afterward. For this subparagraph, an analog video cassette recorder " complies with" the four-line colorstripe copy control technology if it records a signal that, when played back by the recorder's playback function in normal viewing mode, shows distracting visible lines through parts of the viewable picture on a reference display device.

(2) Certain Encoding Restrictions. No person shall apply the automatic gain control copy control technology or colorstripe copy control technology to prevent or limit consumer copying except such copying-

(2) Certain Encoding Restrictions. No one shall use the automatic gain control copy control technology or colorstripe copy control technology to stop or limit consumer copying, except for such copying—

(A) of a single transmission, or specified group of transmissions, of live events or of audiovisual works for which a member of the public has exercised choice in selecting the transmissions, including the content of the transmissions or the time of receipt of such transmissions, or both, and as to which such member is charged a separate fee for each such transmission or specified group of transmissions;

(A) of a single broadcast, or a specific group of broadcasts, of live events or audiovisual works that a member of the public has chosen by selecting the broadcasts, including the content of the broadcasts or the time they received those broadcasts, or both, and for which that member is charged a separate fee for each broadcast or specific group of broadcasts;

(B) from a copy of a transmission of a live event or an audiovisual work if such transmission is provided by a channel or service where payment is made by a member of the public for such channel or service in the form of a subscription fee that entitles the member of the public to receive all of the programming contained in such channel or service;

(B) from a copy of a transmission of a live event or an audiovisual work if that transmission is provided by a channel or service where members of the public pay a subscription fee to access all of the programming offered by that channel or service;

(C) from a physical medium containing one or more prerecorded audiovisual works; or

(C) from a physical media that holds one or more pre-recorded audiovisual works; or

(D) from a copy of a transmission described in subparagraph (A) or from a copy made from a physical medium described in subparagraph (C).

(D) from a copy of a transmission mentioned in subparagraph (A) or from a copy made from a physical medium referenced in subparagraph (C).

In the event that a transmission meets both the conditions set forth in subparagraph (A) and those set forth in subparagraph (B), the transmission shall be treated as a transmission described in subparagraph (A).

In cases where a transmission satisfies both the criteria outlined in subparagraph (A) and those outlined in subparagraph (B), the transmission shall be considered a transmission described in subparagraph (A).

(3) Inapplicability. This subsection shall not-

(3) Inapplicability. This subsection does not-

(A) require any analog video cassette camcorder to conform to the automatic gain control copy control technology with respect to any video signal received through a camera lens;

(A) require any analog video cassette camcorder to comply with the automatic gain control copy control technology regarding any video signal received through a camera lens;

(B) apply to the manufacture, importation, offer for sale, provision of, or other trafficking in, any professional analog video cassette recorder; or

(B) apply to the manufacturing, importing, offering for sale, providing, or other trafficking in any professional analog video cassette recorder; or

(C) apply to the offer for sale or provision of, or other trafficking in, any previously owned analog video cassette recorder, if such recorder was legally manufactured and sold when new and not subsequently modified in violation of paragraph (1)(B).

(C) apply to the offer for sale, provision of, or other trade in, any previously owned analog video cassette recorder, if that recorder was legally manufactured and sold when new and not later modified in violation of paragraph (1)(B).

(4) Definitions. For purposes of this subsection:

(4) Definitions. For this section:

(A) An "analog video cassette recorder" means a device that records, or a device that includes a function that records, on electromagnetic tape in an analog format the electronic impulses produced by the video and audio portions of a television program, motion picture, or other form of audiovisual work.

(A) An "analog video cassette recorder" refers to a device that records, or a device that has the capability to record, on electromagnetic tape in an analog format the electronic signals generated by the video and audio parts of a TV show, movie, or other type of audiovisual work.

(B) An "analog video cassette camcorder" means an analog video cassette recorder that contains a recording function that operates through a camera lens and through a video input that may be connected with a television or other video playback device.

(B) An "analog video cassette camcorder" refers to an analog video cassette recorder that has a recording feature that works through a camera lens and through a video input that can be linked to a television or another video playback device.

(C) An analog video cassette recorder "conforms" to the automatic gain control copy control technology if it-

(C) An analog video cassette recorder "follows" the automatic gain control copy control technology if it-

(i) detects one or more of the elements of such technology and does not record the motion picture or transmission protected by such technology; or

(i) detects one or more elements of that technology and doesn't record the movie or transmission protected by that technology; or

(ii) records a signal that, when played back, exhibits a meaningfully distorted or degraded display.

(ii) records a signal that, when played back, shows a noticeably distorted or degraded display.

(D) The term "professional analog video cassette recorder" means an analog video cassette recorder that is designed, manufactured, marketed, and intended for use by a person who regularly employs such a device for a lawful business or industrial use, including making, performing , displaying, distributing, or transmitting copies of motion pictures on a commercial scale.

(D) The term "professional analog video cassette recorder" refers to an analog video cassette recorder that is designed, made, sold, and meant for use by someone who regularly uses such a device for a legitimate business or industrial purpose, including producing, performing, showing, distributing, or sending copies of movies on a commercial scale.

(E) The terms "VHS format," "8mm format," "Beta format," "automatic gain control copy control technology," "colorstripe copy control technology," "four-line version of the colorstripe copy control technology," and "NTSC" have the meanings that are commonly understood in the consumer electronics and motion picture industries as of the date of the enactment of this chapter.

(E) The terms "VHS format," "8mm format," "Beta format," "automatic gain control copy control technology," "colorstripe copy control technology," "four-line version of the colorstripe copy control technology," and "NTSC" have the meanings that are generally accepted in the consumer electronics and film industries as of the date this chapter was enacted.

(5) Violations. Any violation of paragraph (1) of this subsection shall be treated as a violation of subsection (b)(1) of this section. Any violation of paragraph (2) of this subsection shall be deemed an "act of circumvention" for the purposes of section 1203(c)(3)(A) of this chapter.

(5) Violations. Any violation of paragraph (1) of this subsection will be considered a violation of subsection (b)(1) of this section. Any violation of paragraph (2) of this subsection will be regarded as an "act of circumvention" for the purposes of section 1203(c)(3)(A) of this chapter.

Section 1202. Integrity of copyright management information [3]

(a) False Copyright Management Information. No person shall knowingly and with the intent to induce, enable, facilitate, or conceal infringement-

(a) False Copyright Management Information. No person shall knowingly and with the intent to induce, enable, facilitate, or conceal infringement-

(1) provide copyright management information that is false, or

(1) provide false copyright management information, or

(2) distribute or import for distribution copyright management information that is false.

(2) distribute or import for distribution fake copyright management information.

(b) Removal or Alteration of Copyright Management Information. No person shall, without the authority of the copyright owner or the law-

(b) Removal or Alteration of Copyright Management Information. No one shall, without the permission of the copyright owner or the law-

(1) intentionally remove or alter any copyright management information,

(1) deliberately take out or change any copyright management information,

(2) distribute or import for distribution copyright management information knowing that the copyright management information has been removed or altered without authority of the copyright owner or the law, or

(2) distribute or import for distribution copyright management information knowing that the copyright management information has been removed or changed without the authorization of the copyright owner or the law, or

(3) distribute, import for distribution, or publicly perform works, copies of works, or phonorecords, knowing that copyright management information has been removed or altered without authority of the copyright owner or the law,

(3) distribute, import for distribution, or publicly perform works, copies of works, or phonorecords, knowing that copyright management information has been removed or changed without the permission of the copyright owner or the law,

knowing, or, with respect to civil remedies under section 1203, having reasonable grounds to know, that it will induce, enable, facilitate, or conceal an infringement of any right under this title.

knowing, or, regarding civil remedies under section 1203, having reasonable grounds to know, that it will lead to, allow, assist, or hide a violation of any right under this title.

(c) Definition. As used in this section, the term "copyright management information" means any of the following information conveyed in connection with copies or phonorecords of a work or performances or displays of a work, including in digital form, except that such term does not include any personally identifying information about a user of a work or of a copy, phonorecord, performance, or display of a work:

(c) Definition. As used in this section, the term "copyright management information" refers to any of the following information related to copies or phonorecords of a work or performances or displays of a work, including digital formats, but it does not include any personally identifiable information about a user of a work or about a copy, phonorecord, performance, or display of a work:

(1) The title and other information identifying the work, including the information set forth on a notice of copyright.

(1) The title and other details identifying the work, including the information provided on a copyright notice.

(2) The name of, and other identifying information about, the author of a work.

(2) The name and other identifying details about the author of a work.

(3) The name of, and other identifying information about, the copyright owner of the work, including the information set forth in a notice of copyright.

(3) The name and other identifying information about the copyright owner of the work, including the details provided in a copyright notice.

(4) With the exception of public performances of works by radio and television broadcast stations, the name of, and other identifying information about, a performer whose performance is fixed in a work other than an audiovisual work.

(4) Except for public performances of works by radio and television broadcast stations, the name and other identifying details of a performer whose performance is captured in a work that isn't an audiovisual work.

(5) With the exception of public performances of works by radio and television broadcast stations, in the case of an audiovisual work, the name of, and other identifying information about, a writer, performer, or director who is credited in the audiovisual work.

(5) Except for public performances of works by radio and TV broadcast stations, for an audiovisual work, the name and other identifying information about the writer, performer, or director credited in the audiovisual work.

(6) Terms and conditions for use of the work.

(6) Terms and conditions for using the work.

(7) Identifying numbers or symbols referring to such information or links to such information.

(7) Identifying numbers or symbols that refer to this information or links to this information.

(8) Such other information as the Register of Copyrights may prescribe by regulation, except that the Register of Copyrights may not require the provision of any information concerning the user of a copyrighted work.

(8) Any additional information that the Register of Copyrights may specify by regulation, except that the Register of Copyrights cannot require any information about the user of a copyrighted work.

(d) Law Enforcement, Intelligence, and Other Government Activities. This section does not prohibit any lawfully authorized investigative, protective, information security, or intelligence activity of an officer, agent, or employee of the United States, a State, or a political subdivision of a State, or a person acting pursuant to a contract with the United States, a State, or a political subdivision of a State. For purposes of this subsection, the term "information security" means activities carried out in order to identify and address the vulnerabilities of a government computer, computer system, or computer network.

(d) Law Enforcement, Intelligence, and Other Government Activities. This section does not prevent any legally authorized investigative, protective, information security, or intelligence activities conducted by an officer, agent, or employee of the United States, a State, or a political subdivision of a State, or by someone acting under a contract with the United States, a State, or a political subdivision of a State. In this subsection, "information security" refers to actions taken to identify and address the vulnerabilities of a government computer, computer system, or computer network.

(e) Limitations on Liability.

Liability Limitations.

(1) Analog Transmissions. In the case of an analog transmission, a person who is making transmissions in its capacity as a broadcast station, or as a cable system, or someone who provides programming to such station or system, shall not be liable for a violation of subsection (b) if-

(1) Analog Transmissions. In the case of an analog transmission, a person making transmissions as a broadcast station, or as a cable system, or someone providing programming to such station or system, will not be held responsible for a violation of subsection (b) if-

(A) avoiding the activity that constitutes such violation is not technically feasible or would create an undue financial hardship on such person; and

(A) avoiding the activity that violates this is not technically possible or would cause significant financial strain on that person; and

(B) such person did not intend, by engaging in such activity, to induce, enable, facilitate, or conceal infringement of a right under this title.

(B) that person did not mean to, by participating in that activity, encourage, assist, promote, or hide the infringement of a right under this title.

(2) Digital Transmissions.

Digital Communications.

(A) If a digital transmission standard for the placement of copyright management information for a category of works is set in a voluntary, consensus standard-setting process involving a representative cross- section of broadcast stations or cable systems and copyright owners of a category of works that are intended for public performance by such stations or systems, a person identified in paragraph (1) shall not be liable for a violation of subsection (b) with respect to the particular copyright management information addressed by such standard if-

(A) If a digital transmission standard for placing copyright management information for a specific category of works is established through a voluntary, consensus-based process that includes a representative mix of broadcast stations or cable systems and copyright owners of works meant for public performance by those stations or systems, a person mentioned in paragraph (1) will not be held liable for violating subsection (b) regarding the specific copyright management information covered by that standard if-

(i) the placement of such information by someone other than such person is not in accordance with such standard; and

(i) if someone other than that person places such information, it does not meet that standard; and

(ii) the activity that constitutes such violation is not intended to induce, enable, facilitate, or conceal infringement of a right under this title.

(ii) the activity that leads to this violation is not meant to encourage, allow, assist, or hide an infringement of a right under this title.

(B) Until a digital transmission standard has been set pursuant to subparagraph (A) with respect to the placement of copyright management information for a category of works, a person identified in paragraph (1) shall not be liable for a violation of subsection (b) with respect to such copyright management information, if the activity that constitutes such violation is not intended to induce, enable, facilitate, or conceal infringement of a right under this title, and if-

(B) Until a digital transmission standard is established according to subparagraph (A) regarding the placement of copyright management information for a category of works, a person referenced in paragraph (1) will not be held liable for violating subsection (b) concerning that copyright management information, as long as the activity leading to the violation is not meant to encourage, enable, facilitate, or hide infringement of a right under this title, and if-

(i) the transmission of such information by such person would result in a perceptible visual or aural degradation of the digital signal; or

(i) sharing that information would lead to a noticeable decrease in the quality of the digital signal, either visually or aurally; or

(ii) the transmission of such information by such person would conflict with-

(ii) sharing that information by that person would conflict with-

(I) an applicable government regulation relating to transmission of information in a digital signal;

(I) a relevant government regulation regarding the transmission of information in a digital signal;

(II) an applicable industry-wide standard relating to the transmission of information in a digital signal that was adopted by a voluntary consensus standards body prior to the effective date of this chapter; or

(II) a relevant industry-wide standard for transmitting information in a digital signal that was approved by a voluntary consensus standards organization before the effective date of this chapter; or

(III) an applicable industry-wide standard relating to the transmission of information in a digital signal that was adopted in a voluntary, consensus standards-setting process open to participation by a representative cross-section of broadcast stations or cable systems and copyright owners of a category of works that are intended for public performance by such stations or systems.

(III) a relevant industry-wide standard for transmitting information in a digital signal that was developed through a voluntary, consensus-based standards-setting process open to input from a representative mix of broadcast stations or cable systems and copyright owners of works intended for public performance by these stations or systems.

(3) Definitions. As used in this subsection-

(3) Definitions. As used in this subsection-

(A) the term "broadcast station" has the meaning given that term in section 3 of the Communications Act of 1934 (47 U.S.C. 153); and

(A) the term "broadcast station" means what is defined in section 3 of the Communications Act of 1934 (47 U.S.C. 153); and

(B) the term "cable system" has the meaning given that term in section 602 of the Communications Act of 1934 (47 U.S.C. 522).

(B) the term "cable system" means what is defined in section 602 of the Communications Act of 1934 (47 U.S.C. 522).

Section 1203. Civil remedies [5]

(a) Civil Actions. Any person injured by a violation of section 1201 or 1202 may bring a civil action in an appropriate United States district court for such violation.

(a) Civil Actions. Any person harmed by a violation of section 1201 or 1202 can file a civil lawsuit in a relevant United States district court for that violation.

(b) Powers of the Court. In an action brought under subsection (a), the court-

(b) Powers of the Court. In a case brought under subsection (a), the court-

(1) may grant temporary and permanent injunctions on such terms as it deems reasonable to prevent or restrain a violation, but in no event shall impose a prior restraint on free speech or the press protected under the 1st amendment to the Constitution;

(1) may issue temporary and permanent injunctions on terms it finds reasonable to stop or limit a violation, but it must never impose a prior restraint on free speech or the press protected by the 1st amendment to the Constitution;

(2) at any time while an action is pending, may order the impounding, on such terms as it deems reasonable, of any device or product that is in the custody or control of the alleged violator and that the court has reasonable cause to believe was involved in a violation;

(2) at any time while a case is ongoing, may order the seizure, under reasonable terms, of any device or product that is in the possession or control of the alleged violator and that the court has reasonable grounds to believe was involved in a violation;

(3) may award damages under subsection (c);

(3) can award damages under subsection (c);

(4) in its discretion may allow the recovery of costs by or against any party other than the United States or an officer thereof;

(4) may, at its discretion, permit the recovery of costs by or against any party other than the United States or its officers;

(5) in its discretion may award reasonable attorney's fees to the prevailing party; and

(5) in its discretion may award reasonable attorney's fees to the winning party; and

(6) may, as part of a final judgment or decree finding a violation, order the remedial modification or the destruction of any device or product involved in the violation that is in the custody or control of the violator or has been impounded under paragraph (2).

(6) may, as part of a final judgment or decree finding a violation, order the necessary changes or the destruction of any device or product involved in the violation that is with the violator or has been taken under paragraph (2).

(c) Award of Damages.

(c) Damage Compensation Award.

(1) In General. Except as otherwise provided in this title, a person committing a violation of section 1201 or 1202 is liable for either-

(1) In General. Unless stated otherwise in this title, a person who violates section 1201 or 1202 is responsible for either-

(A) the actual damages and any additional profits of the violator, as provided in paragraph (2), or

(A) the actual damages and any extra profits of the violator, as stated in paragraph (2), or

(B) statutory damages, as provided in paragraph (3).

(B) statutory damages, as outlined in paragraph (3).

(2) Actual Damages. The court shall award to the complaining party the actual damages suffered by the party as a result of the violation, and any profits of the violator that are attributable to the violation and are not taken into account in computing the actual damages, if the complaining party elects such damages at any time before final judgment is entered.

(2) Actual Damages. The court will award the complaining party the actual damages they suffered due to the violation, along with any profits that the violator made from the violation that weren’t included in calculating the actual damages, if the complaining party chooses this option anytime before the final judgment is issued.

(3) Statutory Damages. (A) At any time before final judgment is entered, a complaining party may elect to recover an award of statutory damages for each violation of section 1201 in the sum of not less than $200 or more than $2,500 per act of circumvention, device, product, component, offer, or performance of service, as the court considers just.

(3) Statutory Damages. (A) Before the final judgment is made, a complaining party can choose to receive statutory damages for each violation of section 1201, ranging from a minimum of $200 to a maximum of $2,500 for each act of circumvention, device, product, component, offer, or service performance, as determined fair by the court.

(B) At any time before final judgment is entered, a complaining party may elect to recover an award of statutory damages for each violation of section 1202 in the sum of not less than $2,500 or more than $25,000.

(B) At any point before a final judgment is issued, the party making the complaint can choose to receive an award of statutory damages for each violation of section 1202, ranging from a minimum of $2,500 to a maximum of $25,000.

(4) Repeated Violations. In any case in which the injured party sustains the burden of proving, and the court finds, that a person has violated section 1201 or 1202 within three years after a final judgment was entered against the person for another such violation, the court may increase the award of damages up to triple the amount that would otherwise be awarded, as the court considers just.

(4) Repeated Violations. In any situation where the injured party proves, and the court finds, that someone has violated section 1201 or 1202 within three years after a final judgment against that person for another similar violation, the court may increase the damage award up to three times the amount that would normally be given, as deemed fair by the court.

(5) Innocent Violations.

Innocent violations.

(A) In General. The court in its discretion may reduce or remit the total award of damages in any case in which the violator sustains the burden of proving, and the court finds, that the violator was not aware and had no reason to believe that its acts constituted a violation.

(A) In General. The court can choose to reduce or cancel the total amount of damages in any case where the violator proves, and the court agrees, that the violator was not aware and had no reason to believe that their actions were a violation.

(B) Nonprofit Library, Archives, Educational Institutions, or Public
Broadcasting Entities.

(B) Nonprofit Libraries, Archives, Educational Institutions, or Public
Broadcasting Entities.

(i) Definition. In this subparagraph, the term "public broadcasting entity" has the meaning given such term under section 118(g).

(i) Definition. In this section, the term "public broadcasting entity" means what is defined in section 118(g).

(ii) In general. In the case of a nonprofit library, archives, educational institution, or public broadcasting entity, the court shall remit damages in any case in which the library, archives, educational institution, or public broadcasting entity sustains the burden of proving, and the court finds, that the library, archives, educational institution, or public broadcasting entity was not aware and had no reason to believe that its acts constituted a violation.

(ii) In general. If it's a nonprofit library, archives, educational institution, or public broadcasting entity, the court will reduce damages in any case where the library, archives, educational institution, or public broadcasting entity proves, and the court determines, that they were not aware and had no reason to believe their actions were a violation.

Section 1204. Criminal offenses and penalties [5]

(a) In General. Any person who violates section 1201 or 1202 willfully and for purposes of commercial advantage or private financial gain-

(a) In General. Any person who willfully violates section 1201 or 1202 for commercial gain or personal profit-

(1) shall be fined not more than $500,000 or imprisoned for not more than 5 years, or both, for the first offense; and

(1) will be fined up to $500,000 or imprisoned for up to 5 years, or both, for the first offense; and

(2) shall be fined not more than $1,000,000 or imprisoned for not more than 10 years, or both, for any subsequent offense.

(2) shall be fined no more than $1,000,000 or imprisoned for no more than 10 years, or both, for any subsequent offense.

(b) Limitation for Nonprofit Library, Archives, Educational Institution, or Public Broadcasting Entity. Subsection (a) shall not apply to a nonprofit library, archives, educational institution, or public broadcasting entity (as defined under section 118(g)).

(b) Limitation for Nonprofit Library, Archives, Educational Institution, or Public Broadcasting Entity. Subsection (a) does not apply to a nonprofit library, archives, educational institution, or public broadcasting entity (as defined under section 118(g)).

(c) Statute of Limitations. No criminal proceeding shall be brought under this section unless such proceeding is commenced within five years after the cause of action arose.

(c) Statute of Limitations. No criminal case can be initiated under this section unless it starts within five years after the cause of action occurred.

Section 1205. Savings clause

Nothing in this chapter abrogates, diminishes, or weakens the provisions of, nor provides any defense or element of mitigation in a criminal prosecution or civil action under, any Federal or State law that prevents the violation of the privacy of an individual in connection with the individual's use of the Internet.

Nothing in this chapter cancels, reduces, or undermines the provisions of, nor offers any defense or mitigating factor in a criminal prosecution or civil action under, any Federal or State law that protects an individual's privacy regarding their use of the Internet.

—————————- Chapter 12 Endnotes

Chapter 12 References

1 The WIPO Copyright and Performances and Phonograms Treaties Implementation Act of 1998 added chapter 12, entitled "Copyright Protection and Management Systems," to title 17. Pub. L. No. 105-304, 112 Stat. 2860, 2863. The WIPO Copyright and Performances and Phonograms Treaties Implementation Act of 1998 is title I of the Digital Millennium Copyright Act. Pub. L. No. 105-304, 112 Stat. 2860.

1 The WIPO Copyright and Performances and Phonograms Treaties Implementation Act of 1998 added chapter 12, called "Copyright Protection and Management Systems," to title 17. Pub. L. No. 105-304, 112 Stat. 2860, 2863. The WIPO Copyright and Performances and Phonograms Treaties Implementation Act of 1998 is title I of the Digital Millennium Copyright Act. Pub. L. No. 105-304, 112 Stat. 2860.

2 The Satellite Home Viewer Improvement Act of 1999 amended section 1201(a)(1)(C) by deleting "on the record." Pub. L. No. 106-113, 113 Stat. 1501, app. I at 1501A-594.

2 The Satellite Home Viewer Improvement Act of 1999 changed section 1201(a)(1)(C) by removing "on the record." Pub. L. No. 106-113, 113 Stat. 1501, app. I at 1501A-594.

3 In 1999, section 1202 was amended by inserting "category of works" for "category or works," in subsection (e)(2)(B). Pub. L. No. 106-44, 113 Stat. 221, 222.

3 In 1999, section 1202 was updated by changing "category or works" to "category of works" in subsection (e)(2)(B). Pub. L. No. 106-44, 113 Stat. 221, 222.

4 The Satellite Home Viewer Improvement Act of 1999 amended section 1203(c)(5)(B) in its entirety. Pub. L. No. 106-113, 113 Stat. 1501, app. I at 1501A-593.

4 The Satellite Home Viewer Improvement Act of 1999 completely changed section 1203(c)(5)(B). Pub. L. No. 106-113, 113 Stat. 1501, app. I at 1501A-593.

5 The Satellite Home Viewer Improvement Act of 1999 amended section 1204(b) in its entirety. Pub. L. No. 106-113, 113 Stat. 1501, app. I at 1501A-593.

5 The Satellite Home Viewer Improvement Act of 1999 completely revised section 1204(b). Pub. L. No. 106-113, 113 Stat. 1501, app. I at 1501A-593.

————————————————————————————————————

Understood! Please provide the text you would like me to modernize.

Chapter 13 [1]

Protection of Original Designs

Protection of Original Designs

+ 1301. Designs protected + 1302. Designs not subject to protection + 1303. Revisions, adaptations, and rearrangements + 1304. Commencement of protection + 1305. Term of protection + 1306. Design notice + 1307. Effect of omission of notice + 1308. Exclusive rights + 1309. Infringement + 1310. Application for registration + 1311. Benefit of earlier filing date in foreign country + 1312. Oaths and acknowledgments + 1313. Examination of application and issue or refusal of registration + 1314. Certification of registration + 1315. Publication of announcements and indexes + 1316. Fees + 1317. Regulations + 1318. Copies of records + 1319. Correction of errors in certificates + 1320. Ownership and transfer + 1321. Remedy for infringement + 1322. Injunctions + 1323. Recovery for infringement + 1324. Power of court over registration + 1325. Liability for action on registration fraudulently obtained + 1326. Penalty for false marking + 1327. Penalty for false representation + 1328. Enforcement by Treasury and Postal Service + 1329. Relation to design patent law + 1330. Common law and other rights unaffected + 1331. Administrator; Office of the Administrator + 1332. No retroactive effect

+ 1301. Protected Designs + 1302. Designs Not Covered by Protection + 1303. Revisions, Adaptations, and Rearrangements + 1304. Start of Protection + 1305. Duration of Protection + 1306. Design Notification + 1307. Consequences of Missing Notification + 1308. Exclusive Rights + 1309. Infringement + 1310. Registration Application + 1311. Advantage of Earlier Filing Date in Foreign Country + 1312. Oaths and Acknowledgments + 1313. Application Review and Grant or Denial of Registration + 1314. Registration Certification + 1315. Publication of Announcements and Indexes + 1316. Fees + 1317. Regulations + 1318. Copies of Records + 1319. Error Corrections in Certificates + 1320. Ownership and Transfer + 1321. Remedies for Infringement + 1322. Injunctions + 1323. Recovery for Infringement + 1324. Court Authority over Registration + 1325. Liability for Actions Based on Fraudulent Registration + 1326. Penalty for False Marking + 1327. Penalty for False Representation + 1328. Enforcement by the Treasury and Postal Service + 1329. Relation to Design Patent Law + 1330. Common Law and Other Rights Remain Unaffected + 1331. Administrator; Office of the Administrator + 1332. No Retroactive Effect

Section 1301. Designs protected [3]

(a) Designs Protected.

Protected Designs.

(1) In General. The designer or other owner of an original design of a useful article which makes the article attractive or distinctive in appearance to the purchasing or using public may secure the protection provided by this chapter upon complying with and subject to this chapter.

(1) In General. The designer or any owner of the original design of a useful product that makes it appealing or unique in appearance to buyers or users can obtain the protection offered by this chapter by following the rules and conditions set in this chapter.

(2) Vessel Hulls. The design of a vessel hull, including a plug or mold, is subject to protection under this chapter, notwithstanding section 1302(4).

(2) Vessel Hulls. The design of a vessel hull, including a plug or mold, is protected under this chapter, regardless of section 1302(4).

(b) Definitions. For the purpose of this chapter, the following terms have the following meanings:

(b) Definitions. For this chapter, the following terms mean the following:

(1) A design is "original" if it is the result of the designer's creative endeavor that provides a distinguishable variation over prior work pertaining to similar articles which is more than merely trivial and has not been copied from another source.

(1) A design is considered "original" if it comes from the designer's creative efforts and offers a noticeable variation from previous work on similar items that is more than just trivial and hasn't been taken from another source.

(2) A "useful article" is a vessel hull, including a plug or mold, which in normal use has an intrinsic utilitarian function that is not merely to portray the appearance of the article or to convey information. An article which normally is part of a useful article shall be deemed to be a useful article.

(2) A "useful article" is a vessel hull, including a plug or mold, which in regular use has a practical function that goes beyond just looking nice or delivering information. An item that is typically part of a useful article will also be considered a useful article.

(3) A "vessel" is a craft-

(3) A "vessel" is a type of craft-

(A) that is designed and capable of independently steering a course on or through water through its own means of propulsion; and

(A) that is designed and capable of navigating a course on or through water using its own means of propulsion; and

(B) that is designed and capable of carrying and transporting one or more passengers.

(B) that is designed and able to carry and transport one or more passengers.

(4) A "hull" is the frame or body of a vessel, including the deck of a vessel, exclusive of masts, sails, yards, and rigging.

(4) A "hull" is the structure or body of a boat, including the deck of the boat, not including masts, sails, yards, and rigging.

(5) A "plug" means a device or model used to make a mold for the purpose of exact duplication, regardless of whether the device or model has an intrinsic utilitarian function that is not only to portray the appearance of the product or to convey information.

(5) A "plug" refers to a device or model used to create a mold for the purpose of precise duplication, regardless of whether the device or model has a practical function beyond simply representing the product's appearance or conveying information.

(6) A "mold" means a matrix or form in which a substance for material is used, regardless of whether the matrix or form has an intrinsic utilitarian function that is not only to portray the appearance of the product or to convey information.

(6) A "mold" refers to a framework or shape used to create a material substance, regardless of whether this framework or shape has a useful function beyond just showing the product's appearance or providing information.

Section 1302. Designs not subject to protection [3]

Protection under this chapter shall not be available for a design that is-

Protection under this chapter won't be available for a design that is-

(1) not original;

not original;

(2) staple or commonplace, such as a standard geometric figure, a familiar symbol, an emblem, or a motif, or another shape, pattern, or configuration which has become standard, common, prevalent, or ordinary;

(2) something that is basic or typical, like a common geometric shape, a well-known symbol, an emblem, or a motif, or another shape, pattern, or configuration that has become standard, common, widespread, or ordinary;

(3) different from a design excluded by paragraph (2) only in insignificant details or in elements which are variants commonly used in the relevant trades;

(3) different from a design excluded by paragraph (2) only in minor details or in elements that are commonly used variations in the relevant industries;

(4) dictated solely by a utilitarian function of the article that embodies it; or

(4) determined only by the practical purpose of the article that contains it; or

(5) embodied in a useful article that was made public by the designer or owner in the United States or a foreign country more than 2 years before the date of the application for registration under this chapter.

(5) embodied in a useful article that was made public by the designer or owner in the United States or another country more than 2 years before the application date for registration under this chapter.

Section 1303. Revisions, adaptations, and rearrangements

Protection for a design under this chapter shall be available notwithstanding the employment in the design of subject matter excluded from protection under section 1302 if the design is a substantial revision, adaptation, or rearrangement of such subject matter. Such protection shall be independent of any subsisting protection in subject matter employed in the design, and shall not be construed as securing any right to subject matter excluded from protection under this chapter or as extending any subsisting protection under this chapter.

Protection for a design under this chapter will still be available even if the design includes elements that aren't protected under section 1302, as long as the design is a significant revision, adaptation, or rearrangement of those elements. This protection will be separate from any existing protection for elements used in the design, and it shouldn't be interpreted as granting any rights to elements that are excluded from protection under this chapter or as extending any existing protection under this chapter.

Section 1304. Commencement of protection

The protection provided for a design under this chapter shall commence upon the earlier of the date of publication of the registration under section 1313(a) or the date the design is first made public as defined by section 1310(b).

The protection for a design under this chapter will start on the earlier of the date the registration is published under section 1313(a) or the date the design is first made public as defined in section 1310(b).

Section 1305. Term of protection

(a) In General. Subject to subsection (b), the protection provided under this chapter for a design shall continue for a term of 10 years beginning on the date of the commencement of protection under section 1304.

(a) In General. Subject to subsection (b), the protection granted under this chapter for a design will last for a period of 10 years starting from the date when protection begins under section 1304.

(b) Expiration. All terms of protection provided in this section shall run to the end of the calendar year in which they would otherwise expire.

(b) Expiration. All terms of protection mentioned in this section will continue until the end of the calendar year in which they would typically expire.

(c) Termination of Rights. Upon expiration or termination of protection in a particular design under this chapter, all rights under this chapter in the design shall terminate, regardless of the number of different articles in which the design may have been used during the term of its protection.

(c) Termination of Rights. Upon the expiration or termination of protection for a specific design under this chapter, all rights related to that design will end, no matter how many different products the design was used on during its protection period.

Section 1306. Design notice

(a) Contents of Design Notice.

(a) Design Notice Contents.

(1) Whenever any design for which protection is sought under this chapter is made public under section 1310(b), the owner of the design shall, subject to the provisions of section 1307, mark it or have it marked legibly with a design notice consisting of

(1) Whenever any design that is seeking protection under this chapter is made public according to section 1310(b), the owner of the design must, in line with the rules in section 1307, clearly mark it or have it marked with a design notice that includes

(A) the words "Protected Design", the abbreviation "Prot'd Des.", or the letter "D" with a circle, or the symbol "*D*";

(A) the words "Protected Design," the abbreviation "Prot'd Des.," the letter "D" inside a circle, or the symbol "*D*";

(B) the year of the date on which protection for the design commenced; and

(B) the year when protection for the design started; and

(C) the name of the owner, an abbreviation by which the name can be recognized, or a generally accepted alternative designation of the owner.

(C) the name of the owner, an abbreviation that identifies the name, or a commonly accepted alternative term for the owner.

Any distinctive identification of the owner may be used for purposes of subparagraph (C) if it has been recorded by the Administrator before the design marked with such identification is registered.

Any specific identification of the owner can be used for the purpose of subparagraph (C) if it has been recorded by the Administrator before the design that features such identification is registered.

(2) After registration, the registration number may be used instead of the elements specified in subparagraphs (B) and (C) of paragraph (1).

(2) After registration, you can use the registration number instead of the elements mentioned in subparagraphs (B) and (C) of paragraph (1).

(b) Location of Notice. The design notice shall be so located and applied as to give reasonable notice of design protection while the useful article embodying the design is passing through its normal channels of commerce.

(b) Location of Notice. The design notice must be placed and displayed in a way that provides reasonable notice of design protection while the useful article containing the design is moving through its usual commercial channels.

(c) Subsequent Removal of Notice. When the owner of a design has complied with the provisions of this section, protection under this chapter shall not be affected by the removal, destruction, or obliteration by others of the design notice on an article.

(c) Subsequent Removal of Notice. When the owner of a design has followed the requirements of this section, protection under this chapter will not be impacted by the removal, destruction, or obliteration of the design notice on an article by others.

Section 1307. Effect of omission of notice

(a) Actions with Notice. Except as provided in subsection (b), the omission of the notice prescribed in section 1306 shall not cause loss of the protection under this chapter or prevent recovery for infringement under this chapter against any person who, after receiving written notice of the design protection, begins an undertaking leading to infringement under this chapter.

(a) Actions with Notice. Except as stated in subsection (b), failing to give the notice required in section 1306 won’t result in losing the protection under this chapter or stop recovery for infringement under this chapter against anyone who, after getting written notice of the design protection, starts any activity that could lead to infringement under this chapter.

(b) Actions without Notice. The omission of the notice prescribed in section 1306 shall prevent any recovery under section 1323 against a person who began an undertaking leading to infringement under this chapter before receiving written notice of the design protection. No injunction shall be issued under this chapter with respect to such undertaking unless the owner of the design reimburses that person for any reasonable expenditure or contractual obligation in connection with such undertaking that was incurred before receiving written notice of the design protection, as the court in its discretion directs. The burden of providing written notice of design protection shall be on the owner of the design.

(b) Actions without Notice. Not giving the notice required in section 1306 will stop any recovery under section 1323 against someone who started an activity that led to an infringement under this chapter before they got the written notice of the design protection. No injunction will be issued under this chapter regarding such activity unless the design owner pays that person back for any reasonable expenses or contractual obligations related to that activity that were incurred before receiving the written notice of the design protection, as decided by the court. The responsibility to provide written notice of the design protection rests with the design owner.

Section 1308. Exclusive rights

The owner of a design protected under this chapter has the exclusive right to-

The owner of a design protected under this chapter has the exclusive right to-

(1) make, have made, or import, for sale or for use in trade, any useful article embodying that design; and

(1) create, have created, or import, for sale or for use in commerce, any useful item that includes that design; and

(2) sell or distribute for sale or for use in trade any useful article embodying that design.

(2) sell or distribute for sale or for use in trade any useful item featuring that design.

Section 1309. Infringement

(a) Acts of Infringement. Except as provided in subsection (b), it shall be infringement of the exclusive rights in a design protected under this chapter for any person, without the consent of the owner of the design, within the United States and during the term of such protection, to-

(a) Acts of Infringement. Except as stated in subsection (b), it is considered infringement of the exclusive rights in a design protected under this chapter for anyone, without the consent of the design owner, to, within the United States and during the term of that protection,

(1) make, have made, or import, for sale or for use in trade, any infringing article as defined in subsection (e); or

(1) create, have created, or bring in, for sale or for use in business, any infringing item as defined in subsection (e); or

(2) sell or distribute for sale or for use in trade any such infringing article.

(2) sell or distribute for sale or for use in trade any infringing item.

(b) Acts of Sellers and Distributors. A seller or distributor of an infringing article who did not make or import the article shall be deemed to have infringed on a design protected under this chapter only if that person-

(b) Acts of Sellers and Distributors. A seller or distributor of an infringing article who did not create or import the article will be considered to have infringed on a design protected under this chapter only if that person-

(1) induced or acted in collusion with a manufacturer to make, or an importer to import such article, except that merely purchasing or giving an order to purchase such article in the ordinary course of business shall not of itself constitute such inducement or collusion; or

(1) prompted or collaborated with a manufacturer to create, or an importer to bring in such an item, except that simply buying or placing an order to buy such an item in the normal course of business shall not by itself be considered as such prompting or collaboration; or

(2) refused or failed, upon the request of the owner of the design, to make a prompt and full disclosure of that person's source of such article, and that person orders or reorders such article after receiving notice by registered or certified mail of the protection subsisting in the design.

(2) refused or failed, upon the request of the design owner, to provide a quick and complete disclosure of that person's source of such article, and that person orders or reorders such article after receiving notice by registered or certified mail about the existing protection in the design.

(c) Acts without Knowledge. It shall not be infringement under this section to make, have made, import, sell, or distribute, any article embodying a design which was created without knowledge that a design was protected under this chapter and was copied from such protected design.

(c) Acts without Knowledge. It won’t be considered infringement under this section to make, have made, import, sell, or distribute any item that includes a design created without knowing that the design was protected under this chapter and was copied from that protected design.

(d) Acts in Ordinary Course of Business. A person who incorporates into that person's product of manufacture an infringing article acquired from others in the ordinary course of business, or who, without knowledge of the protected design embodied in an infringing article, makes or processes the infringing article for the account of another person in the ordinary course of business, shall not be deemed to have infringed the rights in that design under this chapter except under a condition contained in paragraph (1) or (2) of subsection (b). Accepting an order or reorder from the source of the infringing article shall be deemed ordering or reordering within the meaning of subsection (b)(2).

(d) Acts in Ordinary Course of Business. A person who includes an infringing article obtained from others into their manufactured product as part of regular business operations, or who, without knowledge of the protected design in an infringing article, produces or processes that article on behalf of someone else in the normal course of business, will not be considered to infringe the rights in that design under this chapter, except in conditions specified in paragraph (1) or (2) of subsection (b). Accepting an order or reorder from the supplier of the infringing article will be considered ordering or reordering as stated in subsection (b)(2).

(e) Infringing Article Defined. As used in this section, an "infringing article" is any article the design of which has been copied from a design protected under this chapter, without the consent of the owner of the protected design. An infringing article is not an illustration or picture of a protected design in an advertisement, book, periodical, newspaper, photograph, broadcast, motion picture, or similar medium. A design shall not be deemed to have been copied from a protected design if it is original and not substantially similar in appearance to a protected design.

(e) Infringing Article Defined. In this section, an "infringing article" refers to any item whose design has been copied from a design that's protected under this chapter, without the owner's consent. An infringing article does not include depictions or images of a protected design in advertisements, books, magazines, newspapers, photographs, broadcasts, films, or similar formats. A design will not be considered copied from a protected design if it is original and not significantly similar in appearance to a protected design.

(f) Establishing Originality. The party to any action or proceeding under this chapter who alleges rights under this chapter in a design shall have the burden of establishing the design's originality whenever the opposing party introduces an earlier work which is identical to such design, or so similar as to make prima facie showing that such design was copied from such work.

(f) Establishing Originality. The party in any action or proceeding under this chapter who claims rights related to a design must prove the design's originality whenever the opposing party presents an earlier work that is identical to that design or so similar that it clearly suggests the design was copied from that work.

(g) Reproduction for Teaching or Analysis. It is not an infringement of the exclusive rights of a design owner for a person to reproduce the design in a useful article or in any other form solely for the purpose of teaching, analyzing, or evaluating the appearance, concepts, or techniques embodied in the design, or the function of the useful article embodying the design.

(g) Reproduction for Teaching or Analysis. It does not violate the exclusive rights of a design owner for someone to reproduce the design in a useful article or in any other way just for the purpose of teaching, analyzing, or evaluating the look, ideas, or techniques represented in the design, or the function of the useful article that includes the design.

Section 1310. Application for registration

(a) Time Limit for Application for Registration. Protection under this chapter shall be lost if application for registration of the design is not made within 2 years after the date on which the design is first made public.

(a) Time Limit for Application for Registration. Protection under this chapter will be lost if the application for design registration is not submitted within 2 years after the design is first made public.

(b) When Design is Made Public. A design is made public when an existing useful article embodying the design is anywhere publicly exhibited, publicly distributed, or offered for sale or sold to the public by the owner of the design or with the owner's consent.

(b) When Design is Made Public. A design becomes public when an existing useful article featuring the design is displayed publicly, distributed publicly, or offered for sale or sold to the public by the design owner or with the owner's permission.

(c) Application by Owner of Design. Application for registration may be made by the owner of the design.

(c) Application by Design Owner. The owner of the design can apply for registration.

(d) Contents of Application. The application for registration shall be made to the Administrator and shall state-

(d) Contents of Application. The application for registration must be submitted to the Administrator and should include

(1) the name and address of the designer or designers of the design;

(1) the name and address of the designer or designers of the design;

(2) the name and address of the owner if different from the designer;

(2) the name and address of the owner if it's different from the designer;

(3) the specific name of the useful article embodying the design;

(3) the specific name of the useful item that features the design;

(4) the date, if any, that the design was first made public, if such date was earlier than the date of the application;

(4) the date, if any, when the design was first made public, if that date was before the application date;

(5) affirmation that the design has been fixed in a useful article; and

(5) confirmation that the design has been established in a helpful article; and

(6) such other information as may be required by the Administrator.

(6) any other information that the Administrator may require.

The application for registration may include a description setting forth the salient features of the design, but the absence of such a description shall not prevent registration under this chapter.

The application for registration can include a description outlining the key features of the design, but not having such a description won't stop registration under this chapter.

(e) Sworn Statement. The application for registration shall be accompanied by a statement under oath by the applicant or the applicant's duly authorized agent or representative, setting forth, to the best of the applicant's knowledge and belief-

(e) Sworn Statement. The application for registration must include a statement under oath from the applicant or the applicant's authorized agent or representative, stating, to the best of the applicant's knowledge and belief-

(1) that the design is original and was created by the designer or designers named in the application;

(1) that the design is original and was made by the designer or designers listed in the application;

(2) that the design has not previously been registered on behalf of the applicant or the applicant's predecessor in title; and

(2) that the design has not been registered before on behalf of the applicant or the applicant's predecessor in title; and

(3) that the applicant is the person entitled to protection and to registration under this chapter.

(3) that the applicant is the person eligible for protection and registration under this chapter.

If the design has been made public with the design notice prescribed in section 1306, the statement shall also describe the exact form and position of the design notice.

If the design has been made public with the design notice required in section 1306, the statement must also describe the exact form and location of the design notice.

(f) Effect of Errors. (1) Error in any statement or assertion as to the utility of the useful article named in the application under this section, the design of which is sought to be registered, shall not affect the protection secured under this chapter.

(f) Effect of Errors. (1) A mistake in any statement or claim about the usefulness of the article mentioned in the application for registration under this section will not impact the protection granted under this chapter.

(2) Errors in omitting a joint designer or in naming an alleged joint designer shall not affect the validity of the registration, or the actual ownership or the protection of the design, unless it is shown that the error occurred with deceptive intent.

(2) Mistakes in leaving out a joint designer or in naming a supposed joint designer won't impact the validity of the registration, actual ownership, or the protection of the design, unless it's proven that the mistake was made with dishonest intent.

(g) Design Made in Scope of Employment. In a case in which the design was made within the regular scope of the designer's employment and individual authorship of the design is difficult or impossible to ascribe and the application so states, the name and address of the employer for whom the design was made may be stated instead of that of the individual designer.

(g) Design Created Within Job Duties. In a situation where the design was created as part of the designer's normal job and it's hard or impossible to attribute the design to an individual, and if the application specifies this, the name and address of the employer for whom the design was created can be provided instead of the individual designer's details.

(h) Pictorial Representation of Design. The application for registration shall be accompanied by two copies of a drawing or other pictorial representation of the useful article embodying the design, having one or more views, adequate to show the design, in a form and style suitable for reproduction, which shall be deemed a part of the application.

(h) Visual Representation of Design. The application for registration must include two copies of a drawing or other visual representation of the useful article that incorporates the design, featuring one or more views that adequately display the design, in a format and style fit for reproduction, which will be considered a part of the application.

(i) Design in More Than One Useful Article. If the distinguishing elements of a design are in substantially the same form in different useful articles, the design shall be protected as to all such useful articles when protected as to one of them, but not more than one registration shall be required for the design.

(i) Design in More Than One Useful Article. If the unique features of a design are mostly the same across different useful articles, the design will be protected for all those useful articles when it’s protected for one of them, but only one registration will be needed for the design.

(j) Application for More Than One Design. More than one design may be included in the same application under such conditions as may be prescribed by the Administrator. For each design included in an application the fee prescribed for a single design shall be paid.

(j) Application for More Than One Design. You can include multiple designs in the same application under the conditions set by the Administrator. For each design included in an application, the fee for a single design must be paid.

Section 1311. Benefit of earlier filing date in foreign country

An application for registration of a design filed in the United States by any person who has, or whose legal representative or predecessor or successor in title has, previously filed an application for registration of the same design in a foreign country which extends to designs of owners who are citizens of the United States, or to applications filed under this chapter, similar protection to that provided under this chapter shall have that same effect as if filed in the United States on the date on which the application was first filed in such foreign country, if the application in the United States is filed within 6 months after the earliest date on which any such foreign application was filed.

An application to register a design in the United States can be submitted by anyone who has, or whose legal representative or predecessor or successor has, already submitted a similar application in a foreign country that offers design protections to U.S. citizens or to applications filed under this chapter. This application will be treated as if it were filed in the United States on the same date as the first foreign application, as long as it is submitted within 6 months after that earliest foreign filing date.

Section 1312. Oaths and acknowledgments

(a) In General. Oaths and acknowledgments required by this chapter-

(a) In General. Oaths and acknowledgments required by this chapter-

(1) may be made-

may be made

(A) before any person in the United States authorized by law to administer oaths; or

(A) before anyone in the United States authorized by law to administer oaths; or

(B) when made in a foreign country, before any diplomatic or consular officer of the United States authorized to administer oaths, or before any official authorized to administer oaths in the foreign country concerned, whose authority shall be proved by a certificate of a diplomatic or consular officer of the United States; and

(B) when made in a foreign country, before any U.S. diplomatic or consular officer who is authorized to administer oaths, or before any official authorized to administer oaths in that foreign country, whose authority must be verified by a certificate from a U.S. diplomatic or consular officer; and

(2) shall be valid if they comply with the laws of the State or country where made.

(2) will be valid if they follow the laws of the state or country where they were created.

(b) Written Declaration in Lieu of Oath. (1) The Administrator may by rule prescribe that any document which is to be filed under this chapter in the Office of the Administrator and which is required by any law, rule, or other regulation to be under oath, may be subscribed to by a written declaration in such form as the Administrator may prescribe, and such declaration shall be in lieu of the oath otherwise required.

(b) Written Declaration Instead of Oath. (1) The Administrator may establish rules stating that any document that needs to be filed under this chapter in the Office of the Administrator, which is required by any law, rule, or other regulation to be sworn, can instead be signed with a written declaration in a form specified by the Administrator, and this declaration will replace the oath that is otherwise required.

(2) Whenever a written declaration under paragraph (1) is used, the document containing the declaration shall state that willful false statements are punishable by fine or imprisonment, or both, pursuant to section 1001 of title 18, and may jeopardize the validity of the application or document or a registration resulting therefrom.

(2) Whenever a written declaration under paragraph (1) is used, the document containing the declaration must state that intentional false statements can lead to fines or imprisonment, or both, according to section 1001 of title 18, and may risk the validity of the application or document or any registration resulting from it.

Section 1313. Examination of application and issue or refusal of registration [4]

(a) Determination of Registrability of Design; Registration.

(a) Deciding if a Design Can Be Registered; Registration.

Upon the filing of an application for registration in proper form under section 1310, and upon payment of the fee prescribed under section 1316, the Administrator shall determine whether or not the application relates to a design which on its face appears to be subject to protection under this chapter, and, if so, the Register shall register the design. Registration under this subsection shall be announced by publication. The date of registration shall be the date of publication.

Upon submitting a properly completed application for registration under section 1310 and paying the required fee under section 1316, the Administrator will assess whether the application pertains to a design that seems to qualify for protection under this chapter. If it does, the Register will register the design. Registration as described in this subsection will be announced through publication. The registration date will be the date of publication.

(b) Refusal To Register; Reconsideration. If, in the judgment of the Administrator, the application for registration relates to a design which on its face is not subject to protection under this chapter, the Administrator shall send to the applicant a notice of refusal to register and the grounds for the refusal. Within 3 months after the date on which the notice of refusal is sent, the applicant may, by written request, seek reconsideration of the application. After consideration of such a request, the Administrator shall either register the design or send to the applicant a notice of final refusal to register.

(b) Refusal to Register; Reconsideration. If the Administrator thinks that the registration application is for a design that clearly isn’t eligible for protection under this chapter, the Administrator will send a notice of refusal to register along with the reasons for the refusal to the applicant. Within 3 months from the date the notice of refusal is sent, the applicant can request a reconsideration of the application in writing. After reviewing this request, the Administrator will either register the design or send a final notice of refusal to register to the applicant.

(c) Application To Cancel Registration. Any person who believes he or she is or will be damaged by a registration under this chapter may, upon payment of the prescribed fee, apply to the Administrator at any time to cancel the registration on the ground that the design is not subject to protection under this chapter, stating the reasons for the request. Upon receipt of an application for cancellation, the Administrator shall send to the owner of the design, as shown in the records of the Office of the Administrator, a notice of the application, and the owner shall have a period of 3 months after the date on which such notice is mailed in which to present arguments to the Administrator for support of the validity of the registration. The Administrator shall also have the authority to establish, by regulation, conditions under which the opposing parties may appear and be heard in support of their arguments. If, after the periods provided for the presentation of arguments have expired, the Administrator determines that the applicant for cancellation has established that the design is not subject to protection under this chapter, the Administrator shall order the registration stricken from the record. Cancellation under this subsection shall be announced by publication, and notice of the Administrator's final determination with respect to any application for cancellation shall be sent to the applicant and to the owner of record. Costs of the cancellation procedure under this subsection shall be borne by the nonprevailing party or parties, and the Administrator shall have the authority to assess and collect such costs.

(c) Application to Cancel Registration. Anyone who believes they are or will be harmed by a registration under this chapter may, upon paying the required fee, apply to the Administrator at any time to cancel the registration on the grounds that the design isn't eligible for protection under this chapter, providing the reasons for their request. Once the Administrator receives a cancellation application, they will send a notice to the design owner, as listed in the records of the Office of the Administrator. The owner will have 3 months from the date the notice is mailed to present arguments to the Administrator supporting the validity of the registration. The Administrator also has the authority to set regulations regarding how opposing parties may appear and be heard in support of their arguments. If, after the time for presenting arguments has passed, the Administrator finds that the cancellation applicant has proven that the design is not eligible for protection under this chapter, they will order the registration to be removed from the record. Cancellation under this subsection will be announced through publication, and the Administrator's final decision regarding any cancellation application will be sent to both the applicant and the recorded owner. The costs of the cancellation process under this subsection will be paid by the losing party or parties, and the Administrator has the authority to assess and collect these costs.

Section 1314. Certification of registration

Certificates of registration shall be issued in the name of the United States under the seal of the Office of the Administrator and shall be recorded in the official records of the Office. The certificate shall state the name of the useful article, the date of filing of the application, the date of registration, and the date the design was made public, if earlier than the date of filing of the application, and shall contain a reproduction of the drawing or other pictorial representation of the design. If a description of the salient features of the design appears in the application, the description shall also appear in the certificate. A certificate of registration shall be admitted in any court as prima facie evidence of the facts stated in the certificate.

Certificates of registration will be issued in the name of the United States under the seal of the Office of the Administrator and will be recorded in the official records of the Office. The certificate will include the name of the useful article, the date the application was filed, the date of registration, and the date the design was made public, if it's earlier than the application filing date. It will also include a reproduction of the drawing or other visual representation of the design. If a description of the key features of the design is included in the application, that description will also be included in the certificate. A certificate of registration will be accepted in any court as prima facie evidence of the facts stated in the certificate.

Section 1315. Publication of announcements and indexes

(a) Publications of the Administrator. The Administrator shall publish lists and indexes of registered designs and cancellations of designs and may also publish the drawings or other pictorial representations of registered designs for sale or other distribution.

(a) Publications of the Administrator. The Administrator will publish lists and indexes of registered designs and cancellations of designs and may also sell or distribute drawings or other visual representations of registered designs.

(b) File of Representatives of Registered Designs. The Administrator shall establish and maintain a file of the drawings or other pictorial representations of registered designs. The file shall be available for use by the public under such conditions as the Administrator may prescribe.

(b) File of Representatives of Registered Designs. The Administrator will create and keep a file of the drawings or other visual representations of registered designs. This file will be accessible to the public under conditions set by the Administrator.

Section 1316. Fees

The Administrator shall by regulation set reasonable fees for the filing of applications to register designs under this chapter and for other services relating to the administration of this chapter, taking into consideration the cost of providing these services and the benefit of a public record.

The Administrator will establish reasonable fees through regulation for filing applications to register designs under this chapter and for other services related to managing this chapter, considering the cost of providing these services and the value of a public record.

Section 1317. Regulations

The Administrator may establish regulations for the administration of this chapter.

The Administrator can set rules for managing this chapter.

Section 1318. Copies of records

Upon payment of the prescribed fee, any person may obtain a certified copy of any official record of the Office of the Administrator that relates to this chapter. That copy shall be admissible in evidence with the same effect as the original.

Upon payment of the required fee, anyone can get a certified copy of any official record from the Office of the Administrator that pertains to this chapter. That copy will be accepted as evidence with the same validity as the original.

Section 1319. Correction of errors in certificates

The Administrator may, by a certificate of correction under seal, correct any error in a registration incurred through the fault of the Office, or, upon payment of the required fee, any error of a clerical or typographical nature occurring in good faith but not through the fault of the Office. Such registration, together with the certificate, shall thereafter have the same effect as if it had been originally issued in such corrected form.

The Administrator can, through a sealed correction certificate, fix any mistakes in a registration caused by the Office's error or, upon payment of the required fee, correct any clerical or typographical mistakes made in good faith that weren’t the Office’s fault. This corrected registration, along with the certificate, will then have the same effect as if it had originally been issued in the corrected form.

Section 1320. Ownership and transfer [5]

(a) Property Right in Design. The property right in a design subject to protection under this chapter shall vest in the designer, the legal representatives of a deceased designer or of one under legal incapacity, the employer for whom the designer created the design in the case of a design made within the regular scope of the designer's employment, or a person to whom the rights of the designer or of such employer have been transferred. The person in whom the property right is vested shall be considered the owner of the design.

(a) Property Right in Design. The property right in a design that is protected under this chapter will belong to the designer, the legal representatives of a deceased designer or someone unable to legally represent themselves, the employer for whom the designer created the design if it was done within the normal duties of their job, or a person to whom the designer's rights or those of the employer have been transferred. The person who holds the property right will be considered the owner of the design.

(b) Transfer of Property Right. The property right in a registered design, or a design for which an application for registration has been or may be filed, may be assigned, granted, conveyed, or mortgaged by an instrument in writing, signed by the owner, or may be bequeathed by will.

(b) Transfer of Property Right. The property right in a registered design, or a design for which an application for registration has been or may be filed, can be assigned, granted, transferred, or mortgaged through a written document signed by the owner, or it can be passed on through a will.

(c) Oath or Acknowledgment of Transfer. An oath or acknowledgment under section 1312 shall be prima facie evidence of the execution of an assignment, grant, conveyance, or mortgage under subsection (b).

(c) Oath or Acknowledgment of Transfer. An oath or acknowledgment under section 1312 will be considered clear evidence of the execution of an assignment, grant, conveyance, or mortgage under subsection (b).

(d) Recordation of Transfer. An assignment, grant, conveyance, or mortgage under subsection (b) shall be void as against any subsequent purchaser or mortgagee for a valuable consideration, unless it is recorded in the Office of the Administrator within 3 months after its date of execution or before the date of such subsequent purchase or mortgage.

(d) Recording the Transfer. An assignment, grant, conveyance, or mortgage under subsection (b) will be invalid against any later purchaser or mortgagee for valuable consideration unless it is recorded in the Office of the Administrator within 3 months after it was executed or before the date of that subsequent purchase or mortgage.

Section 1321. Remedy for infringement

(a) In General. The owner of a design is entitled, after issuance of a certificate of registration of the design under this chapter, to institute an action for any infringement of the design.

(a) In General. The owner of a design has the right, after receiving a certificate of registration for the design under this chapter, to take legal action for any infringement of the design.

(b) Review of Refusal To Register. (1) Subject to paragraph (2), the owner of a design may seek judicial review of a final refusal of the Administrator to register the design under this chapter by bringing a civil action, and may in the same action, if the court adjudges the design subject to protection under this chapter, enforce the rights in that design under this chapter.

(b) Review of Refusal To Register. (1) Following paragraph (2), the owner of a design can request a court to review a final decision from the Administrator denying the registration of the design under this chapter by filing a civil lawsuit. In the same lawsuit, if the court determines that the design is eligible for protection under this chapter, the owner can enforce their rights for that design under this chapter.

(2) The owner of a design may seek judicial review under this section if-

(2) The owner of a design can request judicial review under this section if-

(A) the owner has previously duly filed and prosecuted to final refusal an application in proper form for registration of the design;

(A) the owner has previously filed and pursued an application in the correct format for the design registration until it was finally refused;

(B) the owner causes a copy of the complaint in the action to be delivered to the Administrator within 10 days after the commencement of the action; and

(B) the owner has a copy of the complaint in the case delivered to the Administrator within 10 days after the action starts; and

(C) the defendant has committed acts in respect to the design which would constitute infringement with respect to a design protected under this chapter.

(C) the defendant has taken actions regarding the design that would count as infringement on a design protected under this chapter.

(c) Administrator as Party to Action. The Administrator may, at the Administrator's option, become a party to the action with respect to the issue of registrability of the design claim by entering an appearance within 60 days after being served with the complaint, but the failure of the Administrator to become a party shall not deprive the court of jurisdiction to determine that issue.

(c) Administrator as Party to Action. The Administrator can choose to join the action regarding the registrability of the design claim by entering an appearance within 60 days of being served with the complaint. However, if the Administrator does not join, it will not affect the court's jurisdiction to resolve that issue.

(d) Use of Arbitration To Resolve Dispute. The parties to an infringement dispute under this chapter, within such time as may be specified by the Administrator by regulation, may determine the dispute, or any aspect of the dispute, by arbitration. Arbitration shall be governed by title 9. The parties shall give notice of any arbitration award to the Administrator, and such award shall, as between the parties to the arbitration, be dispositive of the issues to which it relates. The arbitration award shall be unenforceable until such notice is given. Nothing in this subsection shall preclude the Administrator from determining whether a design is subject to registration in a cancellation proceeding under section 1313(c).

(d) Use of Arbitration to Resolve Dispute. The parties involved in an infringement dispute under this chapter, within a timeframe specified by the Administrator through regulation, may resolve the dispute, or any part of it, through arbitration. Arbitration will be governed by title 9. The parties must notify the Administrator of any arbitration decision, and that decision will be final regarding the issues it addresses between the parties involved. The arbitration decision won't be enforceable until this notice is provided. Nothing in this subsection prevents the Administrator from determining whether a design is eligible for registration in a cancellation proceeding under section 1313(c).

Section 1322. Injunctions

(a) In General. A court having jurisdiction over actions under this chapter may grant injunctions in accordance with the principles of equity to prevent infringement of a design under this chapter, including, in its discretion, prompt relief by temporary restraining orders and preliminary injunctions.

(a) In General. A court with jurisdiction over actions under this chapter can issue injunctions based on equitable principles to stop the infringement of a design covered by this chapter, including, at its discretion, immediate relief through temporary restraining orders and preliminary injunctions.

(b) Damages for Injunctive Relief Wrongfully Obtained. A seller or distributor who suffers damage by reason of injunctive relief wrongfully obtained under this section has a cause of action against the applicant for such injunctive relief and may recover such relief as may be appropriate, including damages for lost profits, cost of materials, loss of good will, and punitive damages in instances where the injunctive relief was sought in bad faith, and, unless the court finds extenuating circumstances, reasonable attorney's fees.

(b) Damages for Wrongfully Obtained Injunctive Relief. A seller or distributor who suffers loss due to injunctive relief wrongfully granted under this section can take legal action against the person who requested that injunctive relief. They may recover appropriate relief, including damages for lost profits, materials costs, loss of goodwill, and punitive damages if the injunctive relief was sought in bad faith. Additionally, unless the court finds extenuating circumstances, they may also recover reasonable attorney's fees.

Section 1323. Recovery for infringement

(a) Damages. Upon a finding for the claimant in an action for infringement under this chapter, the court shall award the claimant damages adequate to compensate for the infringement. In addition, the court may increase the damages to such amount, not exceeding $50,000 or $1 per copy, whichever is greater, as the court determines to be just. The damages awarded shall constitute compensation and not a penalty. The court may receive expert testimony as an aid to the determination of damages.

(a) Damages. If the court finds in favor of the claimant in an infringement case under this chapter, it will award damages that are enough to compensate for the infringement. Additionally, the court may increase the damages to an amount that doesn't exceed $50,000 or $1 per copy, whichever is higher, as the court deems appropriate. The damages awarded will provide compensation and not serve as a penalty. The court may consider expert testimony to help determine the damages.

(b) Infringer's Profits. As an alternative to the remedies provided in subsection (a), the court may award the claimant the infringer's profits resulting from the sale of the copies if the court finds that the infringer's sales are reasonably related to the use of the claimant's design. In such a case, the claimant shall be required to prove only the amount of the infringer's sales and the infringer shall be required to prove its expenses against such sales.

(b) Infringer's Profits. As an alternative to the remedies listed in subsection (a), the court may award the claimant the profits made by the infringer from selling the copies if the court determines that the infringer's sales are reasonably connected to the use of the claimant's design. In this situation, the claimant only needs to prove the amount of the infringer's sales, while the infringer must prove its expenses related to those sales.

(c) Statute of Limitations. No recovery under subsection (a) or (b) shall be had for any infringement committed more than 3 years before the date on which the complaint is filed.

(c) Statute of Limitations. No recovery under subsection (a) or (b) can be obtained for any infringement that occurred more than 3 years before the date the complaint is filed.

(d) Attorney's Fees. In an action for infringement under this chapter, the court may award reasonable attorney's fees to the prevailing party.

(d) Attorney's Fees. In a lawsuit for infringement under this chapter, the court may award reasonable attorney's fees to the winning party.

(e) Disposition of Infringing and Other Articles. The court may order that all infringing articles, and any plates, molds, patterns, models, or other means specifically adapted for making the articles, be delivered up for destruction or other disposition as the court may direct.

(e) Disposition of Infringing and Other Articles. The court may order that all infringing items, along with any plates, molds, patterns, models, or other materials specifically designed for creating those items, be handed over for destruction or other handling as the court instructs.

Section 1324. Power of court over registration

In any action involving the protection of a design under this chapter, the court, when appropriate, may order registration of a design under this chapter or the cancellation of such a registration. Any such order shall be certified by the court to the Administrator, who shall make an appropriate entry upon the record.

In any case related to protecting a design under this chapter, the court, when suitable, may order the registration of a design or the cancellation of that registration. Any such order will be certified by the court to the Administrator, who will make the necessary entry in the record.

Section 1325. Liability for action on registration fraudulently obtained

Any person who brings an action for infringement knowing that registration of the design was obtained by a false or fraudulent representation materially affecting the rights under this chapter, shall be liable in the sum of $10,000, or such part of that amount as the court may determine. That amount shall be to compensate the defendant and shall be charged against the plaintiff and paid to the defendant, in addition to such costs and attorney's fees of the defendant as may be assessed by the court.

Any person who files a lawsuit for infringement while knowing that the design registration was obtained through false or fraudulent information that significantly impacts the rights under this chapter will be liable for $10,000, or a portion of that amount determined by the court. This amount will be paid to the defendant as compensation and will be the responsibility of the plaintiff, in addition to any costs and attorney's fees for the defendant that the court may award.

Section 1326. Penalty for false marking

(a) In General. Whoever, for the purpose of deceiving the public, marks upon, applies to, or uses in advertising in connection with an article made, used, distributed, or sold, a design which is not protected under this chapter, a design notice specified in section 1306, or any other words or symbols importing that the design is protected under this chapter, knowing that the design is not so protected, shall pay a civil fine of not more than $500 for each such offense.

(a) In General. Anyone who, with the intent to mislead the public, marks, applies, or uses in advertising, in connection with an article that is made, used, distributed, or sold, a design that is not protected under this chapter, a design notice specified in section 1306, or any other words or symbols suggesting that the design is protected under this chapter, knowing that the design is not actually protected, will face a civil fine of up to $500 for each offense.

(b) Suit by Private Persons. Any person may sue for the penalty established by subsection (a), in which event one-half of the penalty shall be awarded to the person suing and the remainder shall be awarded to the United States.

(b) Lawsuit by Individuals. Any individual can file a lawsuit for the penalty set by subsection (a), and in that case, half of the penalty will go to the person who filed the lawsuit, while the other half will go to the United States.

Section 1327. Penalty for false representation

Whoever knowingly makes a false representation materially affecting the rights obtainable under this chapter for the purpose of obtaining registration of a design under this chapter shall pay a penalty of not less than $500 and not more than $1,000, and any rights or privileges that individual may have in the design under this chapter shall be forfeited.

Whoever knowingly makes a false statement that significantly impacts the rights that can be obtained under this chapter to get a design registered under this chapter will have to pay a penalty of at least $500 and up to $1,000, and any rights or privileges that person might have in the design under this chapter will be forfeited.

Section 1328. Enforcement by Treasury and Postal Service

(a) Regulations. The Secretary of the Treasury and the United States Postal Service shall separately or jointly issue regulations for the enforcement of the rights set forth in section 1308 with respect to importation. Such regulations may require, as a condition for the exclusion of articles from the United States, that the person seeking exclusion take any one or more of the following actions:

(a) Regulations. The Secretary of the Treasury and the United States Postal Service will issue regulations, either separately or together, to enforce the rights outlined in section 1308 regarding importation. These regulations might require that anyone requesting the exclusion of items from the United States must take one or more of the following actions:

(1) Obtain a court order enjoining, or an order of the International Trade Commission under section 337 of the Tariff Act of 1930 excluding, importation of the articles.

(1) Get a court order to stop, or an order from the International Trade Commission under section 337 of the Tariff Act of 1930 to ban, the importation of the articles.

(2) Furnish proof that the design involved is protected under this chapter and that the importation of the articles would infringe the rights in the design under this chapter.

(2) Provide evidence that the design in question is protected under this chapter and that importing the items would violate the rights associated with the design under this chapter.

(3) Post a surety bond for any injury that may result if the detention or exclusion of the articles proves to be unjustified.

(3) Provide a surety bond for any harm that might occur if holding or removing the items turns out to be unwarranted.

(b) Seizure and Forfeiture. Articles imported in violation of the rights set forth in section 1308 are subject to seizure and forfeiture in the same manner as property imported in violation of the customs laws. Any such forfeited articles shall be destroyed as directed by the Secretary of the Treasury or the court, as the case may be, except that the articles may be returned to the country of export whenever it is shown to the satisfaction of the Secretary of the Treasury that the importer had no reasonable grounds for believing that his or her acts constituted a violation of the law.

(b) Seizure and Forfeiture. Articles imported in violation of the rights outlined in section 1308 can be seized and forfeited in the same way as property imported against customs laws. Any articles that are forfeited will be destroyed as directed by the Secretary of the Treasury or the court, depending on the situation. However, the articles may be returned to the country of export if it can be shown to the satisfaction of the Secretary of the Treasury that the importer had no reasonable basis for believing that their actions violated the law.

Section 1329. Relation to design patent law

The issuance of a design patent under title 35, United States Code, for an original design for an article of manufacture shall terminate any protection of the original design under this chapter.

The issuance of a design patent under title 35, United States Code, for a unique design for a product will end any protection of the original design under this chapter.

Section 1330. Common law and other rights unaffected

Nothing in this chapter shall annul or limit-

Nothing in this chapter will cancel or restrict-

(1) common law or other rights or remedies, if any, available to or held by any person with respect to a design which has not been registered under this chapter; or

(1) common law or other rights or remedies, if any, available to or held by any person regarding a design that hasn’t been registered under this chapter; or

(2) any right under the trademark laws or any right protected against unfair competition.

(2) any right under trademark laws or any right protected against unfair competition.

Section 1331. Administrator; Office of the Administrator

In this chapter, the "Administrator" is the Register of Copyrights, and the "Office of the Administrator" and the "Office" refer to the Copyright Office of the Library of Congress.

In this chapter, the "Administrator" refers to the Register of Copyrights, and the "Office of the Administrator" and the "Office" mean the Copyright Office of the Library of Congress.

Section 1332. No retroactive effect

Protection under this chapter shall not be available for any design that has been made public under section 1310(b) before the effective date of this chapter.

Protection under this chapter won’t be available for any design that has been made public under section 1310(b) before the effective date of this chapter.

—————————- Chapter 13 Endnotes

Chapter 13 References

1 In 1998, the Vessel Hull Design Protection Act added chapter 13, entitled "Protection of Original Designs," to title 17. Pub. L. No. 105-304, 112 Stat. 2860, 2905. The Vessel Hull Design Protection Act is title V of the Digital Millennium Copyright Act, Pub. L. No. 105-304, 112 Stat. 2860.

1 In 1998, the Vessel Hull Design Protection Act added chapter 13, called "Protection of Original Designs," to title 17. Pub. L. No. 105-304, 112 Stat. 2860, 2905. The Vessel Hull Design Protection Act is title V of the Digital Millennium Copyright Act, Pub. L. No. 105-304, 112 Stat. 2860.

2 The Satellite Home Viewer Improvement Act of 1999 amended section 1301(b)(3) in its entirety. Pub. L. No. 106-113, 113 Stat. 1501, app. I at 1501A-593.

2 The Satellite Home Viewer Improvement Act of 1999 completely updated section 1301(b)(3). Pub. L. No. 106-113, 113 Stat. 1501, app. I at 1501A-593.

3 In 1999, section 1302(5) was amended to substitute "2 years" in lieu of "1 year." Pub. L. No. 106-44, 113 Stat. 221, 222.

3 In 1999, section 1302(5) was changed to replace "1 year" with "2 years." Pub. L. No. 106-44, 113 Stat. 221, 222.

4 The Satellite Home Viewer Improvement Act of 1999 amended section 1313(c) by adding at the end thereof the last sentence, which begins "Costs of the cancellation procedure." Pub. L. No. 106-113, 113 Stat. 1501, app. I at 1501A-594.

4 The Satellite Home Viewer Improvement Act of 1999 changed section 1313(c) by adding a new last sentence that starts with "Costs of the cancellation procedure." Pub. L. No. 106-113, 113 Stat. 1501, app. I at 1501A-594.

5 In 1999, section 1320 was amended to change the spelling in the heading of subsection (c) from "acknowledgement" to "acknowledgment." Pub. L. No. 106-44, 113 Stat. 221, 222.

5 In 1999, section 1320 was updated to change the spelling in the heading of subsection (c) from "acknowledgement" to "acknowledgment." Pub. L. No. 106-44, 113 Stat. 221, 222.

————————————————————————————————————

Understood! Please provide the short piece of text for modernizing.

Appendix I. Transitional and Supplementary Provisions of the
Copyright Act of 1976 [1]

Appendix I. Transitional and Supplementary Provisions of the
Copyright Act of 1976 [1]

Sec. 102. This Act becomes effective on January 1, 1978, except as otherwise expressly provided by this Act, including provisions of the first section of this Act. The provisions of sections 118, 304(b), and chapter 8 of title 17, as amended by the first section of this Act, take effect upon enactment of this Act.

Sec. 102. This Act goes into effect on January 1, 1978, unless stated otherwise in this Act, including the provisions of the first section of this Act. The provisions of sections 118, 304(b), and chapter 8 of title 17, as updated by the first section of this Act, take effect as soon as this Act is enacted.

Sec. 103. This Act does not provide copyright protection for any work that goes into the public domain before January 1, 1978. The exclusive rights, as provided by section 106 of title 17 as amended by the first section of this Act, to reproduce a work in phonorecords and to distribute phonorecords of the work, do not extend to any nondramatic musical work copyrighted before July 1, 1909.

Sec. 103. This Act does not give copyright protection to any work that entered the public domain before January 1, 1978. The exclusive rights, as outlined in section 106 of title 17 as modified by the first section of this Act, to reproduce a work in phonorecords and to distribute phonorecords of the work, do not apply to any nondramatic musical work copyrighted before July 1, 1909.

Sec. 104. All proclamations issued by the President under section 1(e) or 9(b) of title 17 as it existed on December 31, 1977, or under previous copyright statutes of the United States, shall continue in force until terminated, suspended, or revised by the President.

Sec. 104. All proclamations issued by the President under section 1(e) or 9(b) of title 17 as it existed on December 31, 1977, or under previous copyright laws of the United States, will remain in effect until the President terminates, suspends, or revises them.

Sec. 105. (a)(1) Section 505 of title 44 is amended to read as follows:

Sec. 105. (a)(1) Section 505 of title 44 is changed to say:

"Sec. 505. Sale of duplicate plates

"Sec. 505. Sale of duplicate plates

"The Public Printer shall sell, under regulations of the Joint Committee on Printing to persons who may apply, additional or duplicate stereotype or electrotype plates from which a Government publication is printed, at a price not to exceed the cost of composition, the metal, and making to the Government, plus 10 per centum, and the full amount of the price shall be paid when the order is filed."

"The Public Printer will sell, following the rules set by the Joint Committee on Printing, additional or duplicate stereotype or electrotype plates used for printing a Government publication to anyone who applies, at a price not greater than the cost of composition, the metal, and production for the Government, plus 10 percent, and the total amount must be paid when the order is placed."

(2) The item relating to section 505 in the sectional analysis at the beginning of chapter 5 of title 44, is amended to read as follows:

(2) The item regarding section 505 in the sectional analysis at the start of chapter 5 of title 44 is updated to say:

"505. Sale of duplicate plates.".

"505. Sale of duplicate plates."

(b) Section 2113 of title 44 is amended to read as follows:

(b) Section 2113 of title 44 is amended to read as follows:

[To assist the reader, section 2113 of title 44, now designated section 2117, appears in part VII of the Appendix, *infra*, as currently amended.]

[To help the reader, section 2113 of title 44, now labeled section 2117, can be found in part VII of the Appendix, *infra*, as it is currently updated.]

(c) In section 1498(b) of title 28, the phrase "section 101(b) of title 17" is amended to read "section 504(c) of title 17".

(c) In section 1498(b) of title 28, the phrase "section 101(b) of title 17" is updated to say "section 504(c) of title 17".

(d) Section 543(a)(4) of the Internal Revenue Code of 1954, as amended, is amended by striking out "(other than by reason of section 2 or 6 thereof)".

(d) Section 543(a)(4) of the Internal Revenue Code of 1954, as amended, is changed by removing "(other than by reason of section 2 or 6 thereof)".

(e) Section 3202(a) of title 39 is amended by striking out clause (5). Section 3206 of title 39 is amended by deleting the words "subsections (b) and (c)" and inserting "subsection (b)" in subsection (a), and by deleting subsection (c). Section 3206(d) is renumbered (c).

(e) Section 3202(a) of title 39 is updated by removing clause (5). Section 3206 of title 39 is revised by taking out the words "subsections (b) and (c)" and replacing them with "subsection (b)" in subsection (a), and by removing subsection (c). Section 3206(d) is renumbered to (c).

(f) Subsection (a) of section 290(e) of title 15 is amended by deleting the phrase "section 8" and inserting in lieu thereof the phrase "section 105". [2]

(f) Subsection (a) of section 290(e) of title 15 is amended by removing the phrase "section 8" and replacing it with the phrase "section 105". [2]

(g) Section 131 of title 2 is amended by deleting the phrase "deposit to secure copyright," and inserting in lieu thereof the phrase "acquisition of material under the copyright law,".

(g) Section 131 of title 2 is amended by removing the phrase "deposit to secure copyright," and replacing it with the phrase "acquisition of material under the copyright law."

Sec. 106. In any case where, before January 1, 1978, a person has lawfully made parts of instruments serving to reproduce mechanically a copyrighted work under the compulsory license provisions of section 1(e) of title 17 as it existed on December 31, 1977, such person may continue to make and distribute such parts embodying the same mechanical reproduction without obtaining a new compulsory license under the terms of section 115 of title 17 as amended by the first section of this Act. However, such parts made on or after January 1, 1978, constitute phonorecords and are otherwise subject to the provisions of said section 115.

Sec. 106. If, before January 1, 1978, a person has legally created parts of instruments that mechanically reproduce a copyrighted work under the compulsory license rules of section 1(e) of title 17 as it was on December 31, 1977, that person can continue to make and distribute those parts that still use the same mechanical reproduction without needing a new compulsory license as outlined in section 115 of title 17, as changed by the first section of this Act. However, any parts made on or after January 1, 1978, are considered phonorecords and must follow the rules in section 115.

Sec. 107. In the case of any work in which an ad interim copyright is subsisting or is capable of being secured on December 31, 1977, under section 22 of title 17 as it existed on that date, copyright protection is hereby extended to endure for the term or terms provided by section 304 of title 17 as amended by the first section of this Act.

Sec. 107. For any work that has an interim copyright that exists or can be obtained as of December 31, 1977, under section 22 of title 17 as it was back then, copyright protection is extended to last for the duration or durations specified in section 304 of title 17 as modified by the first section of this Act.

Sec. 108. The notice provisions of sections 401 through 403 of title 17 as amended by the first section of this Act apply to all copies or phonorecords publicly distributed on or after January 1, 1978. However, in the case of a work published before January 1, 1978, compliance with the notice provisions of title 17 either as it existed on December 31, 1977, or as amended by the first section of this Act, is adequate with respect to copies publicly distributed after December 31, 1977.

Sec. 108. The notice requirements of sections 401 through 403 of title 17, as updated by the first section of this Act, apply to all copies or phonorecords that are distributed to the public on or after January 1, 1978. However, for works published before January 1, 1978, following the notice requirements of title 17 as it was on December 31, 1977, or as updated by the first section of this Act, is sufficient for copies distributed to the public after December 31, 1977.

Sec. 109. The registration of claims to copyright for which the required deposit, application, and fee were received in the Copyright Office before January 1, 1978, and the recordation of assignments of copyright or other instruments received in the Copyright Office before January 1, 1978, shall be made in accordance with title 17 as it existed on December 31, 1977.

Sec. 109. The registration of copyright claims for which the required deposit, application, and fee were submitted to the Copyright Office before January 1, 1978, and the recording of copyright assignments or other documents sent to the Copyright Office before January 1, 1978, will be handled according to title 17 as it was on December 31, 1977.

Sec. 110. The demand and penalty provisions of section 14 of title 17 as it existed on December 31, 1977, apply to any work in which copyright has been secured by publication with notice of copyright on or before that date, but any deposit and registration made after that date in response to a demand under that section shall be made in accordance with the provisions of title 17 as amended by the first section of this Act.

Sec. 110. The demand and penalty rules from section 14 of title 17 as they were on December 31, 1977, apply to any work that secured copyright through publication with a copyright notice on or before that date. However, any deposit and registration made after that date in response to a demand under that section must follow the updated provisions of title 17 as modified by the first section of this Act.

Sec. 111. Section 2318 of title 18 of the United States Code is amended to read as follows:

Sec. 111. Section 2318 of title 18 of the United States Code is amended to say:

[To assist the reader, section 2318 of title 18, as currently amended, along with related criminal provisions, appears in part VII of the Appendix, *infra*.]

[To help the reader, section 2318 of title 18, as updated, along with related criminal laws, can be found in part VII of the Appendix, *infra*.]

Sec. 112. All causes of action that arose under title 17 before January 1, 1978, shall be governed by title 17 as it existed when the cause of action arose.

Sec. 112. All legal claims that came up under title 17 before January 1, 1978, shall be governed by title 17 as it was when the claim arose.

Sec. 113. (a) The Librarian of Congress (hereinafter referred to as the "Librarian") shall establish and maintain in the Library of Congress a library to be known as the American Television and Radio Archives (hereinafter referred to as the "Archives"). The purpose of the Archives shall be to preserve a permanent record of the television and radio programs which are the heritage of the people of the United States and to provide access to such programs to historians and scholars without encouraging or causing copyright infringement.

Sec. 113. (a) The Librarian of Congress (referred to as the "Librarian") will create and manage a library in the Library of Congress called the American Television and Radio Archives (referred to as the "Archives"). The purpose of the Archives is to preserve a permanent record of the television and radio programs that make up the heritage of the people of the United States and to give historians and scholars access to these programs without promoting or causing copyright infringement.

(1) The Librarian, after consultation with interested organizations and individuals, shall determine and place in the Archives such copies and phonorecords of television and radio programs transmitted to the public in the United States and in other countries which are of present or potential public or cultural interest, historical significance, cognitive value, or otherwise worthy of preservation, including copies and phonorecords of published and unpublished transmission programs-

(1) The Librarian, after talking with interested organizations and individuals, will decide and add to the Archives copies and recordings of television and radio programs that were broadcast to the public in the United States and other countries and are of current or potential public or cultural interest, historical importance, educational value, or otherwise deserving of preservation, including copies and recordings of both published and unpublished transmission programs.

(A) acquired in accordance with sections 407 and 408 of title 17 as amended by the first section of this Act; and

(A) acquired in accordance with sections 407 and 408 of title 17 as updated by the first section of this Act; and

(B) transferred from the existing collections of the Library of
Congress; and

(B) transferred from the current collections of the Library of
Congress; and

(C) given to or exchanged with the Archives by other libraries, archives, organizations, and individuals; and

(C) provided to or exchanged with the Archives by other libraries, archives, organizations, and individuals; and

(D) purchased from the owner thereof.

(D) bought from the owner.

(2) The Librarian shall maintain and publish appropriate catalogs and indexes of the collections of the Archives, and shall make such collections available for study and research under the conditions prescribed under this section.

(2) The Librarian will keep and share updated catalogs and indexes of the Archives' collections, and will make these collections accessible for study and research according to the guidelines set in this section.

(b) Notwithstanding the provisions of section 106 of title 17 as amended by the first section of this Act, the Librarian is authorized with respect to a transmission program which consists of a regularly scheduled newscast or on-the-spot coverage of news events and, under standards and conditions that the Librarian shall prescribe by regulation-

(b) Despite the rules in section 106 of title 17 as updated by the first section of this Act, the Librarian is permitted to manage a transmission program that includes a regularly scheduled newscast or live coverage of news events, according to standards and conditions that the Librarian will set through regulations-

(1) to reproduce a fixation of such a program, in the same or another tangible form, for the purposes of preservation or security or for distribution under the conditions of clause (3) of this subsection; and

(1) to create a copy of this program, in the same or a different physical form, for the purposes of preservation, security, or for sharing as stated in clause (3) of this subsection; and

(2) to compile, without abridgment or any other editing, portions of such fixations according to subject matter, and to reproduce such compilations for the purpose of clause (1) of this subsection; and

(2) to gather, without shortening or any other edits, parts of such recordings based on their subject matter, and to reproduce these compilations for the purpose of clause (1) of this subsection; and

(3) to distribute a reproduction made under clause (1) or (2) of this subsection-

(3) to share a copy made under clause (1) or (2) of this subsection-

(A) by loan to a person engaged in research; and

(A) by loan to someone involved in research; and

(B) for deposit in a library or archives which meets the requirements of section 108(a) of title 17 as amended by the first section of this Act,

(B) for deposit in a library or archives that meets the requirements of section 108(a) of title 17 as amended by the first section of this Act,

in either case for use only in research and not for further reproduction or performance.

in either case, for use only in research and not for any further reproduction or performance.

(c) The Librarian or any employee of the Library who is acting under the authority of this section shall not be liable in any action for copyright infringement committed by any other person unless the Librarian or such employee knowingly participated in the act of infringement committed by such person. Nothing in this section shall be construed to excuse or limit liability under title 17 as amended by the first section of this Act for any act not authorized by that title or this section, or for any act performed by a person not authorized to act under that title or this section.

(c) The Librarian or any Library employee acting under this section won't be held responsible in any lawsuit for copyright infringement committed by someone else unless the Librarian or the employee knowingly took part in the infringement. This section doesn't excuse or limit liability under title 17 as amended by the first section of this Act for any act that isn't authorized by that title or this section, or for any action taken by someone not authorized to act under that title or this section.

(d) This section may be cited as the "American Television and Radio Archives Act".

(d) This section may be referred to as the "American Television and Radio Archives Act."

Sec. 114. There are hereby authorized to be appropriated such funds as may be necessary to carry out the purposes of this Act.

Sec. 114. Funds are authorized to be allocated as needed to fulfill the aims of this Act.

Sec. 115. If any provision of title 17, as amended by the first section of this Act, is declared unconstitutional, the validity of the remainder of this title is not affected.

Sec. 115. If any part of title 17, as updated by the first section of this Act, is found to be unconstitutional, the validity of the rest of this title remains unaffected.

—————————- Appendix I Endnotes

Appendix I Footnotes

1 Part I of the Appendix contains the Transitional and Supplementary Provisions of the Copyright Act of 1976, Pub. L. No. 94-533, 90 Stat. 2541, that do not amend title 17 of the *United States Code.*

1 Part I of the Appendix includes the Transitional and Supplementary Provisions of the Copyright Act of 1976, Pub. L. No. 94-533, 90 Stat. 2541, that do not change title 17 of the *United States Code.*

2 The correct reference is to "290e," not "290(e)."

2 The correct reference is "290e," not "290(e)."

————————————————————————————————————

Understood. Please provide the text you would like me to modernize.

Appendix II. Berne Convention Implementation Act of 1988 [1]

Appendix II. Berne Convention Implementation Act of 1988 [1]

Sec. 2. Declarations.

Sec. 2. Statements.

The Congress makes the following declarations:

The Congress makes the following declarations:

(1) The Convention for the Protection of Literary and Artistic Works, signed at Berne, Switzerland, on September 9, 1886, and all acts, protocols, and revisions thereto (hereafter in this Act referred to as the "Berne Convention") are not self-executing under the Constitution and laws of the United States.

(1) The Convention for the Protection of Literary and Artistic Works, signed in Berne, Switzerland, on September 9, 1886, along with all acts, protocols, and revisions related to it (hereafter in this Act referred to as the "Berne Convention") does not have automatic legal effect under the Constitution and laws of the United States.

(2) The obligations of the United States under the Berne Convention may be performed only pursuant to appropriate domestic law.

(2) The obligations of the United States under the Berne Convention can only be fulfilled according to the relevant domestic law.

(3) The amendments made by this Act, together with the law as it exists on the date of the enactment of this Act, satisfy the obligations of the United States in adhering to the Berne Convention and no further rights or interests shall be recognized or created for that purpose.

(3) The changes made by this Act, along with the law as it stands on the date this Act is enacted, meet the United States' commitments under the Berne Convention, and no additional rights or interests will be recognized or established for that purpose.

Sec. 3. Construction of the Berne Convention.

Sec. 3. Construction of the Berne Convention.

(a) Relationship With Domestic Law. The provisions of the Berne Convention-

(a) Relationship With Domestic Law. The rules of the Berne Convention-

(1) shall be given effect under title 17, as amended by this Act, and any other relevant provision of Federal or State law, including the common law; and

(1) will be enforced under title 17, as updated by this Act, and any other applicable Federal or State law, including the common law; and

(2) shall not be enforceable in any action brought pursuant to the provisions of the Berne Convention itself.

(2) will not be enforceable in any action taken under the provisions of the Berne Convention itself.

(b) Certain Rights Not Affected. The provisions of the Berne Convention, the adherence of the United States thereto, and satisfaction of United States obligations thereunder, do not expand or reduce any right of an author of a work, whether claimed under Federal, State, or the common law-

(b) Certain Rights Not Affected. The rules of the Berne Convention, the United States’ commitment to it, and the fulfillment of the United States’ responsibilities under it, do not add to or take away any rights of an author of a work, regardless of whether those rights are claimed under Federal, State, or common law.

(1) to claim authorship of the work; or

(1) to take credit for the work; or

(2) to object to any distortion, mutilation, or other modification of, or other derogatory action in relation to, the work, that would prejudice the author's honor or reputation.

(2) to object to any distortion, alteration, or other changes to, or other negative actions concerning, the work that would harm the author's honor or reputation.

Sec. 12. Works in the public domain.

Sec. 12. Works in the public domain.

Title 17, United States Code, as amended by this Act, does not provide copyright protection for any work that is in the public domain in the United States.

Title 17, United States Code, as amended by this Act, does not offer copyright protection for any work that is in the public domain in the United States.

Sec. 13. Effective date: effect on pending cases.

Sec. 13. Effective date: impact on ongoing cases.

(a) Effective Date. This Act and the amendments made by this Act take effect on the date on which the Berne Convention (as defined in section 101 of title 17, United States Code) enters into force with respect to the United States. [2]

(a) Effective Date. This Act and the changes made by this Act go into effect on the date the Berne Convention (as defined in section 101 of title 17, United States Code) is implemented for the United States. [2]

(b) Effect on Pending Cases. Any cause of action arising under title 17, United States Code, before the effective date of this Act shall be governed by the provisions of such title as in effect when the cause of action arose.

(b) Effect on Pending Cases. Any legal action arising under title 17, United States Code, before the effective date of this Act will be governed by the provisions of that title as they were in effect when the legal action began.

—————————— Appendix II Endnotes

Appendix II Footnotes

1 Part II of the Appendix consists of provisions of the Berne Convention Implementation Act of 1988, Pub. L. No. 100-568, 102 Stat. 2853, that do not amend title 17 of the *United States Code.*

1 Part II of the Appendix includes provisions from the Berne Convention Implementation Act of 1988, Pub. L. No. 100-568, 102 Stat. 2853, that do not change title 17 of the *United States Code.*

2 The Berne Convention entered into force in the United States on March 1, 1989.

2 The Berne Convention took effect in the United States on March 1, 1989.

————————————————————————————————————

Understood! Please provide the text you would like me to modernize.

Appendix III. Uruguay Round Agreements Act [1]

Appendix III. Uruguay Round Agreements Act [1]

Sec. 2. Definitions.

Sec. 2. Definitions.

For purposes of this Act:

For this Act's purposes:

(1) GATT 1947; GATT 1994.

(A) GATT 1947. The term "GATT 1947" means the General Agreement on Tariffs and Trade, dated October 30, 1947, annexed to the Final Act Adopted at the Conclusion of the Second Session of the Preparatory Committee of the United Nations Conference on Trade and Employment, as subsequently rectified, amended, or modified by the terms of legal instruments which have entered into force before the date of entry into force of the WTO Agreement.

(A) GATT 1947. The term "GATT 1947" refers to the General Agreement on Tariffs and Trade, dated October 30, 1947, attached to the Final Act adopted at the end of the Second Session of the Preparatory Committee of the United Nations Conference on Trade and Employment, as later corrected, changed, or updated by the legal instruments that took effect before the WTO Agreement came into force.

(B) GATT 1994. The term "GATT 1994" means the General Agreement on
Tariffs and Trade annexed to the WTO Agreement.

(B) GATT 1994. The term "GATT 1994" refers to the General Agreement on
Tariffs and Trade attached to the WTO Agreement.

(2) HTS. The term "HTS" means the Harmonized Tariff Schedule of the United States.

(2) HTS. The term "HTS" refers to the Harmonized Tariff Schedule of the United States.

(3)International trade commission. The term "International Trade Commission" means the United States International Trade Commission.

(3) International Trade Commission. The term "International Trade Commission" refers to the United States International Trade Commission.

(4) Multilateral trade agreement. The term "multilateral trade agreement" means an agreement described in section 101(d) of this Act (other than an agreement described in paragraph (17) or (18) of such section).

(4) Multilateral trade agreement. The term "multilateral trade agreement" refers to an agreement described in section 101(d) of this Act (excluding any agreement described in paragraph (17) or (18) of that section).

(5) Schedule XX. The term "Schedule XX" means Schedule XX - United States of America annexed to the Marrakesh Protocol to the GATT 1994.

(5) Schedule XX. The term "Schedule XX" refers to Schedule XX - United States of America attached to the Marrakesh Protocol to the GATT 1994.

(6) Trade representative. The term "Trade Representative" means the United States Trade Representative.

(6) Trade representative. The term "Trade Representative" refers to the United States Trade Representative.

(7) Uruguay round agreements. The term "Uruguay Round Agreements" means the agreements approved by the Congress under section 101(a)(1).

(7) Uruguay round agreements. The term "Uruguay Round Agreements" refers to the agreements approved by Congress under section 101(a)(1).

(8) World trade organization and WTO. The terms "World Trade Organization" and "WTO" mean the organization established pursuant to the WTO Agreement.

(8) World Trade Organization and WTO. The terms "World Trade Organization" and "WTO" refer to the organization created under the WTO Agreement.

(9) WTO agreement. The term "WTO Agreement" means the Agreement Establishing the World Trade Organization entered into on April 15, 1994.

(9) WTO agreement. The term "WTO Agreement" refers to the Agreement Establishing the World Trade Organization that was signed on April 15, 1994.

(10) WTO member and WTO member country. The terms "WTO member" and "WTO member country" mean a state, or separate customs territory (within the meaning of Article XII of the WTO Agreement), with respect to which the United States applies the WTO Agreement.

(10) WTO member and WTO member country. The phrases "WTO member" and "WTO member country" refer to a state or separate customs territory (as defined in Article XII of the WTO Agreement) to which the United States applies the WTO Agreement.

Sec. 101. Approval and entry into force of the Uruguay Round Agreements.

Sec. 101. Approval and implementation of the Uruguay Round Agreements.

(a) Approval of Agreements and Statement of Administrative Action. Pursuant to section 1103 of the Omnibus Trade and Competitiveness Act of 1988 (19 U.S.C. 2903) and section 151 of the Trade Act of 1974 (19 U.S.C. 2191), the Congress approves-

(a) Approval of Agreements and Statement of Administrative Action. According to section 1103 of the Omnibus Trade and Competitiveness Act of 1988 (19 U.S.C. 2903) and section 151 of the Trade Act of 1974 (19 U.S.C. 2191), Congress approves-

(1) the trade agreements described in subsection (d) resulting from the Uruguay Round of multilateral trade negotiations under the auspices of the General Agreement on Tariffs and Trade, entered into on April 15, 1994, and submitted to the Congress on September 27, 1994; and

(1) the trade agreements outlined in subsection (d) that came from the Uruguay Round of international trade talks led by the General Agreement on Tariffs and Trade, which were signed on April 15, 1994, and presented to Congress on September 27, 1994; and

(2) the statement of administrative action proposed to implement the agreements that was submitted to the Congress on September 27, 1994.

(2) the statement of administrative action suggested to put the agreements into effect that was submitted to Congress on September 27, 1994.

(b) Entry Into Force. At such time as the President determines that a sufficient number of foreign countries are accepting the obligations of the Uruguay Round Agreements, in accordance with article XIV of the WTO Agreement, to ensure the effective operation of, and adequate benefits for the United States under, those Agreements, the President may accept the Uruguay Round Agreements and implement article VIII of the WTO Agreement.

(b) Entry Into Force. Once the President decides that enough foreign countries are agreeing to the obligations of the Uruguay Round Agreements, as stated in article XIV of the WTO Agreement, to guarantee effective operation and sufficient benefits for the United States under those Agreements, the President may accept the Uruguay Round Agreements and put into action article VIII of the WTO Agreement.

(c) Authorization of Appropriations. There are authorized to be appropriated annually such sums as may be necessary for the payment by the United States of its share of the expenses of the WTO.

(c) Authorization of Appropriations. There are authorized to be appropriated each year the amounts needed for the United States to cover its part of the expenses of the WTO.

(d) Trade Agreements to Which This Act Applies. Subsection (a) applies to the WTO Agreement and to the following agreements annexed to that Agreement:

(d) Trade Agreements Covered by This Act. Subsection (a) applies to the WTO Agreement and the following agreements attached to that Agreement:

(1) The General Agreement on Tariffs and Trade 1994.

(1) The General Agreement on Tariffs and Trade 1994.

(2) The Agreement on Agriculture.

The Agriculture Agreement.

(3) The Agreement on the Application of Sanitary and Phytosanitary Measures.

(3) The Agreement on the Use of Sanitary and Phytosanitary Measures.

(4) The Agreement on Textiles and Clothing.

(4) The Agreement on Textiles and Clothing.

(5) The Agreement on Technical Barriers to Trade.

(5) The Agreement on Technical Barriers to Trade.

(6) The Agreement on Trade-Related Investment Measures.

(6) The Agreement on Trade-Related Investment Measures.

(7) The Agreement on Implementation of Article VI of the General Agreement on Tariffs and Trade 1994.

(7) The Agreement on Implementing Article VI of the General Agreement on Tariffs and Trade 1994.

(8) The Agreement on Implementation of Article VII of the General Agreement on Tariffs and Trade 1994.

(8) The Agreement on the Implementation of Article VII of the General Agreement on Tariffs and Trade 1994.

(9) The Agreement on Preshipment Inspection.

(9) The Agreement on Preshipment Inspection.

(10) The Agreement on Rules of Origin.

(10) The Agreement on Rules of Origin.

(11) The Agreement on Import Licensing Procedures.

(11) The Agreement on Import Licensing Procedures.

(12) The Agreement on Subsidies and Countervailing Measures.

(12) The Agreement on Subsidies and Countervailing Measures.

(13) The Agreement on Safeguards.

The Safeguards Agreement.

(14) The General Agreement on Trade in Services.

(14) The General Agreement on Trade in Services.

(15) The Agreement on Trade-Related Aspects of Intellectual Property Rights.

(15) The Agreement on Trade-Related Aspects of Intellectual Property Rights.

(16) The Understanding on Rules and Procedures Governing the Settlement of Disputes.

(16) The Understanding on Rules and Procedures Governing the Settlement of Disputes.

(17) The Agreement on Government Procurement.

(17) The Agreement on Government Procurement.

(18) The International Bovine Meat Agreement.

(18) The International Bovine Meat Agreement.

Sec. 102. Relationship of the agreements to United States law and state law.

Sec. 102. Relation of the agreements to U.S. law and state law.

(a) Relationship of Agreements to United States Law.

(a) Relationship of Agreements to U.S. Law.

(1) United states law to prevail in conflict. No provision of any of the Uruguay Round Agreements, nor the application of any such provision to any person or circumstance, that is inconsistent with any law of the United States shall have effect.

(1) United States law will take precedence in case of a conflict. No part of any of the Uruguay Round Agreements, nor the application of any such part to any person or situation, that conflicts with any law of the United States will be effective.

(2) Construction. Nothing in this Act shall be construed

(2) Construction. Nothing in this Act should be interpreted

(A) to amend or modify any law of the United States, including any law relating to-

(A) to change or alter any law of the United States, including any law related to-

(i) the protection of human, animal, or plant life or health,

(i) the protection of human, animal, or plant life or health,

(ii) the protection of the environment, or

(ii) protecting the environment, or

(iii) worker safety, or

worker safety, or

(B) to limit any authority conferred under any law of the United States, including section 301 of the Trade Act of 1974,

(B) to restrict any authority given under any U.S. law, including section 301 of the Trade Act of 1974,

unless specifically provided for in this Act.

unless specifically stated in this Act.

(b) Relationship of Agreements to State Law.-

(b) How Agreements Relate to State Law.-

(1) Federal-State Consultation.

Federal-State Collaboration.

(A) In General. Upon the enactment of this Act, the President shall, through the intergovernmental policy advisory committees on trade established under section 306(c)(2)(A) of the Trade and Tariff Act of 1984 (19 U.S.C. 2114c(2)(A)), consult with the States for the purpose of achieving conformity of State laws and practices with the Uruguay Round Agreements.

(A) In General. Upon the implementation of this Act, the President shall, through the intergovernmental policy advisory committees on trade created under section 306(c)(2)(A) of the Trade and Tariff Act of 1984 (19 U.S.C. 2114c(2)(A)), consult with the States to ensure that State laws and practices align with the Uruguay Round Agreements.

(B) Federal-State Consultation Process. The Trade Representative shall establish within the Office of the United States Trade Representative a Federal-State consultation process for addressing issues relating to the Uruguay Round Agreements that directly relate to, or will potentially have a direct effect on, the States. The Federal-State consultation process shall include procedures under which-

(B) Federal-State Consultation Process. The Trade Representative shall create a Federal-State consultation process within the Office of the United States Trade Representative to address issues concerning the Uruguay Round Agreements that are directly related to, or may directly impact, the States. This Federal-State consultation process shall include procedures under which-

(i) the States will be informed on a continuing basis of matters under the Uruguay Round Agreements that directly relate to, or will potentially have a direct impact on, the States;

(i) the States will be kept updated about issues related to the Uruguay Round Agreements that directly concern them or could have a direct effect on them;

(ii) the States will be provided an opportunity to submit, on a continuing basis, to the Trade Representative information and advice with respect to matters referred to in clause (i); and

(ii) the States will have the chance to continuously submit information and advice to the Trade Representative regarding the issues mentioned in clause (i); and

(iii) the Trade Representative will take into account the information and advice received from the States under clause (ii) when formulating United States positions regarding matters referred to in clause (i).

(iii) the Trade Representative will consider the information and advice given by the States under clause (ii) when shaping United States positions concerning the issues mentioned in clause (i).

The Federal Advisory Committee Act (5 U.S.C. App.) shall not apply to the Federal-State consultation process established by this paragraph.

The Federal Advisory Committee Act (5 U.S.C. App.) does not apply to the Federal-State consultation process set up by this paragraph.

(C) Federal-State Cooperation in WTO Dispute Settlement.

(C) Federal-State Cooperation in WTO Dispute Resolution.

(i) When a WTO member requests consultations with the United States under Article 4 of the Understanding on Rules and Procedures Governing the Settlement of Disputes referred to in section 101(d)(16) (hereafter in this subsection referred to as the "Dispute Settlement Understanding") concerning whether the law of a State is inconsistent with the obligations undertaken by the United States in any of the Uruguay Round Agreements, the Trade Representative shall notify the Governor of the State or the Governor's designee, and the chief legal officer of the jurisdiction whose law is the subject of the consultations, as soon as possible after the request is received, but in no event later than 7 days thereafter.

(i) When a WTO member asks for talks with the United States under Article 4 of the Understanding on Rules and Procedures Governing the Settlement of Disputes mentioned in section 101(d)(16) (referred to in this subsection as the "Dispute Settlement Understanding") about whether a State's law conflicts with the commitments made by the United States in any of the Uruguay Round Agreements, the Trade Representative must inform the Governor of the State or their designee, as well as the chief legal officer of the jurisdiction whose law is being discussed, as soon as possible after the request is received, but no later than 7 days after that.

(ii) Not later than 30 days after receiving such a request for consultations, the Trade Representative shall consult with representatives of the State concerned regarding the matter. If the consultations involve the laws of a large number of States, the Trade Representative may consult with an appropriate group of representatives of the States concerned, as determined by those States.

(ii) No later than 30 days after getting a request for consultations, the Trade Representative will meet with representatives of the State involved about the issue. If the consultations include the laws of many States, the Trade Representative can meet with a suitable group of representatives from the States involved, as decided by those States.

(iii) The Trade Representative shall make every effort to ensure that the State concerned is involved in the development of the position of the United States at each stage of the consultations and each subsequent stage of dispute settlement proceedings regarding the matter. In particular, the Trade Representative shall-

(iii) The Trade Representative will do everything possible to make sure that the relevant State is included in shaping the United States' position at every stage of consultations and in all future dispute settlement processes related to the issue. Specifically, the Trade Representative will-

(I) notify the State concerned not later than 7 days after a WTO member requests the establishment of a dispute settlement panel or gives notice of the WTO member's decision to appeal a report by a dispute settlement panel regarding the matter; and

(I) inform the relevant State no later than 7 days after a WTO member requests the formation of a dispute settlement panel or notifies about its decision to appeal a report made by a dispute settlement panel concerning the issue; and

(II) provide the State concerned with the opportunity to advise and assist the Trade Representative in the preparation of factual information and argumentation for any written or oral presentations by the United States in consultations or in proceedings of a panel or the Appellate Body regarding the matter.

(II) give the State involved the chance to help and support the Trade Representative in gathering factual information and arguments for any written or oral presentations made by the United States during consultations or in the proceedings of a panel or the Appellate Body concerning the issue.

(iv) If a dispute settlement panel or the Appellate Body finds that the law of a State is inconsistent with any of the Uruguay Round Agreements, the Trade Representative shall consult with the State concerned in an effort to develop a mutually agreeable response to the report of the panel or the Appellate Body and shall make every effort to ensure that the State concerned is involved in the development of the United States position regarding the response.

(iv) If a dispute resolution panel or the Appellate Body finds that a State’s law conflicts with any of the Uruguay Round Agreements, the Trade Representative will consult with the State involved to try to create a response that both parties can agree on regarding the panel's or Appellate Body's report, and will do everything possible to ensure that the State is included in shaping the United States' position on the response.

(D) Notice to States Regarding Consultations on Foreign Subcentral
Government Laws.

(D) Notice to States About Talks on Foreign Subcentral
Government Laws.

(i) Subject to clause (ii), the Trade Representative shall, at least 30 days before making a request for consultations under Article 4 of the Dispute Settlement Understanding regarding a subcentral government measure of another WTO member, notify, and solicit the views of, appropriate representatives of each State regarding the matter.

(i) As stated in clause (ii), the Trade Representative must, at least 30 days before requesting consultations under Article 4 of the Dispute Settlement Understanding concerning a subcentral government measure of another WTO member, inform and seek the opinions of relevant representatives from each State about the issue.

(ii) In exigent circumstances clause (i) shall not apply, in which case the Trade Representative shall notify the appropriate representatives of each State not later than 3 days after making the request for consultations referred to in clause (i).

(ii) In urgent situations, clause (i) won’t apply. In that case, the Trade Representative must notify the appropriate representatives of each State no later than 3 days after making the request for consultations mentioned in clause (i).

(2) Legal Challenge.

Legal Dispute.

(A) In General. No State law, or the application of such a State law, may be declared invalid as to any person or circumstance on the ground that the provision or application is inconsistent with any of the Uruguay Round Agreements, except in an action brought by the United States for the purpose of declaring such law or application invalid.

(A) In General. No state law, or how that state law is applied, can be declared invalid for any person or situation just because the provision or application conflicts with any of the Uruguay Round Agreements, except in a lawsuit filed by the United States aimed at declaring that law or application invalid.

(B) Procedures Governing Action. In any action described in subparagraph (A) that is brought by the United States against a State or any subdivision thereof

(B) Procedures Governing Action. In any lawsuit mentioned in subparagraph (A) that the United States files against a State or any of its subdivisions

(i) a report of a dispute settlement panel or the Appellate Body convened under the Dispute Settlement Understanding regarding the State law, or the law of any political subdivision thereof, shall not be considered as binding or otherwise accorded deference;

(i) a report from a dispute settlement panel or the Appellate Body convened under the Dispute Settlement Understanding concerning the State law, or the law of any political subdivision, will not be seen as binding or given any special consideration;

(ii) the United States shall have the burden of proving that the law that is the subject of the action, or the application of that law, is inconsistent with the agreement in question;

(ii) the United States must prove that the law involved in the action, or how that law is applied, doesn't align with the agreement in question;

(iii) any State whose interests may be impaired or impeded in the action shall have the unconditional right to intervene in the action as a party, and the United States shall be entitled to amend its complaint to include a claim or cross-claim concerning the law of a State that so intervenes; and

(iii) any State whose interests might be affected or obstructed in the action has the absolute right to join the action as a party, and the United States can adjust its complaint to include a claim or cross-claim related to the law of a State that joins in; and

(iv) any State law that is declared invalid shall not be deemed to have been invalid in its application during any period before the court's judgment becomes final and all timely appeals, including discretionary review, of such judgment are exhausted.

(iv) any State law that is declared invalid won’t be considered invalid in its application during any time before the court’s judgment becomes final and all timely appeals, including discretionary review, of that judgment have been completed.

(C) Reports to Congressional Committees. At least 30 days before the
United States brings an action described in subparagraph (A), the Trade
Representative shall provide a report to the Committee on Ways and Means
of the House of Representatives and the Committee on Finance of the
Senate-

(C) Reports to Congressional Committees. At least 30 days before the
United States takes action described in subparagraph (A), the Trade
Representative must submit a report to the Committee on Ways and Means
of the House of Representatives and the Committee on Finance of the
Senate-

(i) describing the proposed action;

(i) describing the suggested action;

(ii) describing efforts by the Trade Representative to resolve the matter with the State concerned by other means; and

(ii) describing the Trade Representative's attempts to address the issue with the relevant State through other means; and

(iii) if the State law was the subject of consultations under the Dispute Settlement Understanding, certifying that the Trade Representative has substantially complied with the requirements of paragraph (1)(C) in connection with the matter.

(iii) if the state law was discussed under the Dispute Settlement Understanding, confirming that the Trade Representative has mostly followed the requirements of paragraph (1)(C) related to the issue.

Following the submission of the report, and before the action is brought, the Trade Representative shall consult with the committees referred to in the preceding sentence concerning the matter.

Following the submission of the report, and before any action is taken, the Trade Representative will consult with the committees mentioned in the previous sentence about the matter.

(3) Definition of State Law. For purposes of this subsection-

(3) Definition of State Law. For the purposes of this subsection-

(A) the term "State law" includes-

(A) the term "State law" includes-

(i) any law of a political subdivision of a State; and

(i) any law from a local government of a State; and

(ii) any State law regulating or taxing the business of insurance; and

(ii) any state law that regulates or taxes the insurance business; and

(B) the terms "dispute settlement panel" and "Appellate Body" have the meanings given those terms in section 121.

(B) the terms "dispute settlement panel" and "Appellate Body" have the meanings assigned to them in section 121.

(c) Effect of Agreement With Respect to Private Remedies.

(c) Impact of Agreement on Private Remedies.

(1) Limitations. No person other than the United States-

(1) Limitations. No one other than the United States-

(A) shall have any cause of action or defense under any of the Uruguay Round Agreements or by virtue of congressional approval of such an agreement, or

(A) will have any legal grounds or defense under any of the Uruguay Round Agreements or as a result of congressional approval of such an agreement, or

(B) may challenge, in any action brought under any provision of law, any action or inaction by any department, agency, or other instrumentality of the United States, any State, or any political subdivision of a State on the ground that such action or inaction is inconsistent with such agreement.

(B) can challenge, in any legal action taken under any law, any action or failure to act by any department, agency, or other body of the United States, any State, or any local government of a State on the basis that such action or inaction goes against that agreement.

(2) Intent of congress. It is the intention of the Congress through paragraph (1) to occupy the field with respect to any cause of action or defense under or in connection with any of the Uruguay Round Agreements, including by precluding any person other than the United States from bringing any action against any State or political subdivision thereof or raising any defense to the application of State law under or in connection with any of the Uruguay Round Agreements-

(2) Intent of Congress. It is Congress's intention through paragraph (1) to take over jurisdiction regarding any claims or defenses related to the Uruguay Round Agreements, which includes preventing anyone other than the United States from filing any legal action against any state or its political subdivisions or presenting any defense against the enforcement of state law related to the Uruguay Round Agreements.

(A) on the basis of a judgment obtained by the United States in an action brought under any such agreement; or

(A) based on a judgment obtained by the United States in a case brought under any such agreement; or

(B) on any other basis.

(B) on any other grounds.

(d) Statement of Administrative Action. The statement of administrative action approved by the Congress under section 101(a) shall be regarded as an authoritative expression by the United States concerning the interpretation and application of the Uruguay Round Agreements and this Act in any judicial proceeding in which a question arises concerning such interpretation or application.

(d) Statement of Administrative Action. The statement of administrative action approved by Congress under section 101(a) will be seen as an official statement by the United States regarding the interpretation and application of the Uruguay Round Agreements and this Act in any legal proceeding where a question comes up about that interpretation or application.

Sec. 103. Implementing actions in anticipation of entry into force; regulations.

Sec. 103. Taking actions in anticipation of the effective date; regulations.

(a) Implementing Actions. After the date of the enactment of this Act-

(a) Implementing Actions. After this Act takes effect—

(1) the President may proclaim such actions, and

(1) the President can announce such actions, and

(2) other appropriate officers of the United States Government may issue such regulations,

(2) other relevant officials of the United States Government may create such regulations,

as may be necessary to ensure that any provision of this Act, or amendment made by this Act, that takes effect on the date any of the Uruguay Round Agreements enters into force with respect to the United States is appropriately implemented on such date. Such proclamation or regulation may not have an effective date earlier than the date of entry into force with respect to the United States of the agreement to which the proclamation or regulation relates.

as needed to ensure that any part of this Act, or any changes made by this Act, that goes into effect on the date that any of the Uruguay Round Agreements becomes active for the United States is properly put into action on that date. Such a proclamation or regulation cannot take effect before the date that the agreement it relates to is active for the United States.

(b) Regulations. Any interim regulation necessary or appropriate to carry out any action proposed in the statement of administrative action approved under section 101(a) to implement an agreement described in section 101(d) (7), (12), or (13) shall be issued not later than 1 year after the date on which the agreement enters into force with respect to the United States.

(b) Regulations. Any temporary regulation needed or relevant to carry out any action proposed in the approved statement of administrative action under section 101(a) to implement an agreement described in section 101(d) (7), (12), or (13) must be issued no later than 1 year after the date the agreement takes effect for the United States.

—————————— Appendix III Endnote

Appendix III Footnote

1 Part III of the Appendix consists of provisions of the Uruguay Round Agreements Act, Pub. L. No. 103-465, 108 Stat. 4809, that do not amend title 17 of the *United States Code.*

1 Part III of the Appendix includes sections of the Uruguay Round Agreements Act, Pub. L. No. 103-465, 108 Stat. 4809, that do not change title 17 of the *United States Code.*

————————————————————————————————————

Understood. Please provide the text you'd like me to modernize.

Appendix IV. GATT/Trade-Related Aspects of Intellectual
Property Rights (TRIPs) Agreement, Part II: [1]

Appendix IV. GATT/Trade-Related Aspects of Intellectual
Property Rights (TRIPs) Agreement, Part II: [1]

Section 6: Layout-Designs (Topographies) of Integrated Circuits

Article 35

Article 35

Relation to IPIC Treaty

Relation to IPIC Agreement

Members agree to provide protection to the layout-designs (topographies) of integrated circuits (hereinafter referred to as "layout-designs") in accordance with Articles 2-7 (other than paragraph 3 of Article 6), Article 12 and paragraph 3 of Article 16 of the Treaty on Intellectual Property in Respect of Integrated Circuits and, in addition, to comply with the following provisions.

Members agree to protect the layout designs (topographies) of integrated circuits (referred to as "layout designs") as outlined in Articles 2-7 (excluding paragraph 3 of Article 6), Article 12, and paragraph 3 of Article 16 of the Treaty on Intellectual Property in Respect of Integrated Circuits, and also to follow the additional provisions below.

Article 36

Article 36

Scope of the Protection [2]

Protection Scope [2]

Subject to the provisions of paragraph 1 of Article 37 below, Members shall consider unlawful the following acts if performed without the authorization of the right holder: importing, selling, or otherwise distributing for commercial purposes a protected layout-design, an integrated circuit in which a protected layout-design is incorporated, or an article incorporating such an integrated circuit only insofar as it continues to contain an unlawfully reproduced layout-design.

Subject to the rules in paragraph 1 of Article 37 below, Members shall consider the following actions illegal if done without the permission of the rights holder: importing, selling, or otherwise distributing for commercial purposes a protected layout-design, an integrated circuit that includes a protected layout-design, or a product that contains such an integrated circuit, but only as long as it still has an unlawfully reproduced layout-design.

Article 37

Article 37

Acts not Requiring the Authorization of the Right Holder

Acts Not Requiring the Authorization of the Right Holder

1. Notwithstanding Article 36 above, no Member shall consider unlawful the performance of any of the acts referred to in that Article in respect of an integrated circuit incorporating an unlawfully reproduced layout-design or any article incorporating such an integrated circuit where the person performing or ordering such acts did not know and had no reasonable ground to know, when acquiring the integrated circuit or article incorporating such an integrated circuit, that it incorporated an unlawfully reproduced layout-design. Members shall provide that, after the time that such person has received sufficient notice that the layout-design was unlawfully reproduced, he may perform any of the acts with respect to the stock on hand or ordered before such time, but shall be liable to pay to the right holder a sum equivalent to a reasonable royalty such as would be payable under a freely negotiated license in respect of such a layout-design.

1. Despite Article 36 above, no Member shall consider it unlawful to perform any of the acts mentioned in that Article concerning an integrated circuit that includes an unlawfully reproduced layout-design or any product that contains such an integrated circuit, as long as the person performing or ordering those acts did not know and had no reasonable way of knowing, at the time of acquiring the integrated circuit or the product with the integrated circuit, that it contained an unlawfully reproduced layout-design. Members must ensure that once such a person has received sufficient notice that the layout-design was unlawfully reproduced, they can perform any of the acts regarding the stock they have on hand or have ordered prior to that notice. However, they will be required to pay the rights holder a sum equivalent to a reasonable royalty that would be payable under a freely negotiated license for that layout-design.

2. The conditions set out in sub-paragraphs (a)-(k) of Article 31 above shall apply *mutatis mutandis* in the event of any non-voluntary licensing of a layout-design or of its use by or for the government without the authorization of the right holder.

2. The conditions outlined in sub-paragraphs (a)-(k) of Article 31 above will apply *mutatis mutandis* in the case of any non-voluntary licensing of a layout-design or its use by or for the government without the authorization of the rights holder.

Article 38

Article 38

Term of Protection

Protection Period

1. In Members requiring registration as a condition of protection, the term of protection of layout-designs shall not end before the expiration of a period of ten years counted from the date of filing an application for registration or from the first commercial exploitation wherever in the world it occurs.

1. For Members that require registration to receive protection, the protection period for layout designs will last at least ten years from the date an application for registration is filed or from the date of the first commercial use, no matter where it happens in the world.

2. In Members not requiring registration as a condition for protection, layout-designs shall be protected for a term of no less than ten years from the date of the first commercial exploitation wherever in the world it occurs.

2. In countries that don’t require registration for protection, layout designs will be protected for a minimum of ten years from the date of their first commercial use, no matter where that happens in the world.

3. Notwithstanding paragraphs 1 and 2 above, a Member may provide that protection shall lapse fifteen years after the creation of the layout- design.

3. However, despite paragraphs 1 and 2 above, a Member may specify that the protection will expire fifteen years after the layout-design is created.

—————————— Appendix IV Endnotes

Appendix IV: Endnotes

1 For an explanation of the relationship of this section of TRIPs to title 17 of the *United States Code*, see the second paragraph of endnote 8, chapter 9, *supra.*

1 For an explanation of how this section of TRIPs relates to title 17 of the *United States Code*, see the second paragraph of endnote 8, chapter 9, *supra.*

2 The term "right holder" in this section shall be understood as having the same meaning as the term "holder of the right" in the Treaty on Intellectual Property in Respect of Integrated Circuits, done at Washington, D.C., on May 26, 1989.

2 The term "right holder" in this section means the same as "holder of the right" in the Treaty on Intellectual Property in Respect of Integrated Circuits, signed in Washington, D.C., on May 26, 1989.

————————————————————————————————————

Understood! Please provide the text you'd like me to modernize.

Appendix V. Additional Provisions of the Digital Millennium
Copyright Act [1]

Appendix V. Extra Rules of the Digital Millennium
Copyright Act [1]

Section 1. Short Title.

This Act may be cited as the "Digital Millennium Copyright Act".

This Act can be referred to as the "Digital Millennium Copyright Act".

Title I-WIPO Treaties Implementation

Title I - WIPO Treaty Implementation

SEC. 101. SHORT TITLE.

This title may be cited as the "WIPO Copyright and Performances and
Phonograms Treaties Implementation Act of 1998".

This title can be referred to as the "WIPO Copyright and Performances and
Phonograms Treaties Implementation Act of 1998".

* * * * * * *

* * * * * * *

SEC. 104. EVALUATION OF IMPACT OF COPYRIGHT LAW AND AMENDMENTS ON ELECTRONIC COMMERCE AND TECHNOLOGICAL DEVELOPMENT.

(a) Evaluation by the Register of Copyrights and the Assistant Secretary for Communications and Information. The Register of Copyrights and the Assistant Secretary for Communications and Information of the Department of Commerce shall jointly evaluate-

(a) Evaluation by the Copyright Register and the Assistant Secretary for Communications and Information. The Copyright Register and the Assistant Secretary for Communications and Information of the Department of Commerce will work together to evaluate-

(1) the effects of the amendments made by this title and the development of electronic commerce and associated technology on the operation of sections 109 and 117 of title 17, United States Code; and

(1) the effects of the changes made by this title and the growth of online commerce and related technology on the functioning of sections 109 and 117 of title 17, United States Code; and

(2) the relationship between existing and emergent technology and the operation of sections 109 and 117 of title 17, United States Code.

(2) the relationship between current and new technologies and the operation of sections 109 and 117 of title 17, United States Code.

(b) Report to Congress. The Register of Copyrights and the Assistant Secretary for Communications and Information of the Department of Commerce shall, not later than 24 months after the date of the enactment of this Act, submit to the Congress a joint report on the evaluation conducted under subsection (a), including any legislative recommendations the Register and the Assistant Secretary may have.

(b) Report to Congress. The Register of Copyrights and the Assistant Secretary for Communications and Information of the Department of Commerce must, no later than 24 months after this Act is enacted, submit a joint report to Congress on the evaluation conducted under subsection (a), including any legislative recommendations that the Register and the Assistant Secretary might have.

SEC. 105. EFFECTIVE DATE.

(a) In General. Except as otherwise provided in this title, this title and the amendments made by this title shall take effect on the date of the enactment of this Act.

(a) In General. Except as otherwise stated in this title, this title and the changes made by this title will take effect on the date this Act is enacted.

(b) Amendments Relating to Certain International Agreements. (1) The following shall take effect upon the entry into force of the WIPO Copyright Treaty with respect to the United States:

(b) Amendments Relating to Certain International Agreements. (1) The following will take effect once the WIPO Copyright Treaty comes into force for the United States:

(A) Paragraph (5) of the definition of "international agreement" contained in section 101 of title 17, United States Code, as amended by section 102(a)(4) of this Act.

(A) Paragraph (5) of the definition of "international agreement" contained in section 101 of title 17, United States Code, as amended by section 102(a)(4) of this Act.

(B) The amendment made by section 102(a)(6) of this Act.

(B) The change made by section 102(a)(6) of this Act.

(C) Subparagraph (C) of section 104A(h)(1) of title 17, United States
Code, as amended by section 102(c)(1) of this Act.

(C) Subparagraph (C) of section 104A(h)(1) of title 17, United States
Code, as updated by section 102(c)(1) of this Act.

(D) Subparagraph (C) of section 104A(h)(3) of title 17, United States
Code, as amended by section 102(c)(2) of this Act.

(D) Subparagraph (C) of section 104A(h)(3) of title 17, United States
Code, as amended by section 102(c)(2) of this Act.

(2) The following shall take effect upon the entry into force of the WIPO Performances and Phonograms Treaty with respect to the United States:

(2) The following will come into effect when the WIPO Performances and Phonograms Treaty is implemented in the United States:

(A) Paragraph (6) of the definition of "international agreement" contained in section 101 of title 17, United States Code, as amended by section 102(a)(4) of this Act.

(A) Paragraph (6) of the definition of "international agreement" found in section 101 of title 17, United States Code, as updated by section 102(a)(4) of this Act.

(B) The amendment made by section 102(a)(7) of this Act.

(B) The update made by section 102(a)(7) of this Act.

(C) The amendment made by section 102(b)(2) of this Act.

(C) The change made by section 102(b)(2) of this Act.

(D) Subparagraph (D) of section 104A(h)(1) of title 17, United States
Code, as amended by section 102(c)(1) of this Act.

(D) Subparagraph (D) of section 104A(h)(1) of title 17, United States
Code, as updated by section 102(c)(1) of this Act.

(E) Subparagraph (D) of section 104A(h)(3) of title 17, United States
Code, as amended by section 102(c)(2) of this Act.

(E) Subparagraph (D) of section 104A(h)(3) of title 17, United States
Code, as amended by section 102(c)(2) of this Act.

(F) The amendments made by section 102(c)(3) of this Act.

(F) The changes made by section 102(c)(3) of this Act.

* * * * * * *

* * * * * * *

Title II - Online Copyright Infringement Liability Limitation

Title II - Online Copyright Infringement Liability Limitation

SEC. 201. SHORT TITLE.

This title may be cited as the "Online Copyright Infringement Liability
Limitation Act".

This title can be referred to as the "Online Copyright Infringement Liability
Limitation Act".

* * * * * * *

* * * * * * *

SEC. 203. EFFECTIVE DATE.

This title and the amendments made by this title shall take effect on the date of the enactment of this Act.

This title and the changes made by this title will take effect on the date this Act is enacted.

* * * * * * *

* * * * * * *

Title IV - Miscellaneous Provisions

Title IV - Other Provisions

SEC. 401. PROVISIONS RELATING TO THE COMMISSIONER OF PATENTS AND TRADEMARKS AND THE REGISTER OF COPYRIGHTS-

(a) Compensation. (1) Section 3(d) of title 35, United States Code, is amended by striking "prescribed by law for Assistant Secretaries of Commerce" and inserting "in effect for level III of the Executive Schedule under section 5314 of title 5, United States Code".

(a) Compensation. (1) Section 3(d) of title 35, United States Code, is amended by removing "prescribed by law for Assistant Secretaries of Commerce" and replacing it with "in effect for level III of the Executive Schedule under section 5314 of title 5, United States Code".

* * * * * * *

* * * * * * *

(3) Section 5314 of title 5, United States Code, is amended by adding at the end the following:

(3) Section 5314 of title 5, United States Code, is amended by adding at the end the following:

"Assistant Secretary of Commerce and Commissioner of Patents and
Trademarks.

"Assistant Secretary of Commerce and Commissioner of Patents and
Trademarks.

"Register of Copyrights.".

"Copyright Office."

* * * * * * *

* * * * * * *

SEC. 403. LIMITATIONS ON EXCLUSIVE RIGHTS; DISTANCE EDUCATION.

(a) Recommendations by Register of Copyrights. Not later than 6 months after the date of the enactment of this Act, the Register of Copyrights, after consultation with representatives of copyright owners, nonprofit educational institutions, and nonprofit libraries and archives, shall submit to the Congress recommendations on how to promote distance education through digital technologies, including interactive digital networks, while maintaining an appropriate balance between the rights of copyright owners and the needs of users of copyrighted works. Such recommendations shall include any legislation the Register of Copyrights considers appropriate to achieve the objective described in the preceding sentence.

(a) Recommendations by the Register of Copyrights. No later than 6 months after this Act is enacted, the Register of Copyrights, after talking with representatives of copyright owners, nonprofit educational institutions, and nonprofit libraries and archives, will submit to Congress recommendations on how to support distance education through digital technologies, including interactive digital networks, while keeping a proper balance between the rights of copyright owners and the needs of users of copyrighted works. These recommendations will include any legislation the Register of Copyrights thinks is necessary to meet the goal mentioned in the previous sentence.

(b) Factors. In formulating recommendations under subsection (a), the Register of Copyrights shall consider-

(b) Factors. In making recommendations under subsection (a), the Register of Copyrights will take into account-

(1) the need for an exemption from exclusive rights of copyright owners for distance education through digital networks;

(1) the need for an exemption from the exclusive rights of copyright owners for distance education via digital networks;

(2) the categories of works to be included under any distance education exemption;

(2) the types of works that will be included under any distance education exemption;

(3) the extent of appropriate quantitative limitations on the portions of works that may be used under any distance education exemption;

(3) the range of suitable quantitative limits on the parts of works that can be used under any distance education exemption;

(4) the parties who should be entitled to the benefits of any distance education exemption;

(4) the parties who should be entitled to the benefits of any distance education exemption;

(5) the parties who should be designated as eligible recipients of distance education materials under any distance education exemption;

(5) the parties who should be identified as eligible recipients of distance education materials under any distance education exemption;

(6) whether and what types of technological measures can or should be employed to safeguard against unauthorized access to, and use or retention of, copyrighted materials as a condition of eligibility for any distance education exemption, including, in light of developing technological capabilities, the exemption set out in section 110(2) of title 17, United States Code;

(6) whether and what types of tech measures can or should be used to protect against unauthorized access to, and use or storage of, copyrighted materials as a condition for qualifying for any distance education exemption, including, considering advancing tech capabilities, the exemption outlined in section 110(2) of title 17, United States Code;

(7) the extent to which the availability of licenses for the use of copyrighted works in distance education through interactive digital networks should be considered in assessing eligibility for any distance education exemption; and

(7) the degree to which access to licenses for using copyrighted works in distance education via interactive digital networks should be taken into account when evaluating eligibility for any distance education exemption; and

(8) such other issues relating to distance education through interactive digital networks that the Register considers appropriate.

(8) any other issues related to distance education via interactive digital networks that the Register thinks are relevant.

* * * * * * *

* * * * * * *

SEC. 405. SCOPE OF EXCLUSIVE RIGHTS IN SOUND RECORDINGS;
EPHEMERAL RECORDINGS.

(a) Scope of Exclusive Rights in Sound Recordings.

(a) Scope of Exclusive Rights in Sound Recordings.

* * * * * * *

* * * * * * *

(5) The amendment made by paragraph (2)(B)(i)(III) of this subsection shall be deemed to have been enacted as part of the Digital Performance Right in Sound Recordings Act of 1995, and the publication of notice of proceedings under section 114(f)(1) of title 17, United States Code, as in effect upon the effective date of that Act, for the determination of royalty payments shall be deemed to have been made for the period beginning on the effective date of that Act and ending on December 1, 2001.

(5) The change made by paragraph (2)(B)(i)(III) of this section is considered to have been passed as part of the Digital Performance Right in Sound Recordings Act of 1995. The notice of proceedings under section 114(f)(1) of title 17, United States Code, as it was effective on the date that Act took effect, for figuring out royalty payments will be regarded as having been issued for the period starting on the effective date of that Act and ending on December 1, 2001.

(6) The amendments made by this subsection do not annul, limit, or otherwise impair the rights that are preserved by section 114 of title 17, United States Code, including the rights preserved by subsections (c), (d)(4), and (i) of such section.

(6) The changes made by this subsection do not cancel, restrict, or otherwise undermine the rights protected by section 114 of title 17, United States Code, including the rights protected by subsections (c), (d)(4), and (i) of that section.

* * * * * * *

* * * * * * *

(c) Scope of Section 112(a) of Title 17 Not Affected.

(c) The scope of Section 112(a) of Title 17 remains unchanged.

Nothing in this section or the amendments made by this section shall affect the scope of section 112(a) of title 17, United States Code, or the entitlement of any person to an exemption thereunder.

Nothing in this section or the changes made by this section will affect the scope of section 112(a) of title 17, United States Code, or anyone's right to an exemption under it.

* * * * * * *

* * * * * * *

SEC. 406. ASSUMPTION OF CONTRACTUAL OBLIGATIONS RELATED TO-
TRANSFERS OF RIGHTS IN MOTION PICTURES.

(a) In General. Part VI of title 28, United States Code, is amended by adding at the end the following new chapter:

(a) In General. Part VI of title 28, United States Code, is updated by adding the following new chapter at the end:

"CHAPTER 180-ASSUMPTION OF CERTAIN CONTRACTUAL OBLIGATIONS

"Sec. 4001. Assumption of contractual obligations related to transfers of rights in motion pictures.

"Sec. 4001. Taking on contractual obligations linked to transfers of rights in movies."

"Sec. 4001. Assumption of contractual obligations related to transfers of rights in motion pictures

"Sec. 4001. Taking on contractual obligations related to the transfer of rights in movies"

"(a) Assumption of Obligations. (1) In the case of a transfer of copyright ownership under United States law in a motion picture (as the terms 'transfer of copyright ownership' and 'motion picture' are defined in section 101 of title 17) that is produced subject to 1 or more collective bargaining agreements negotiated under the laws of the United States, if the transfer is executed on or after the effective date of this chapter and is not limited to public performance rights, the transfer instrument shall be deemed to incorporate the assumption agreements applicable to the copyright ownership being transferred that are required by the applicable collective bargaining agreement, and the transferee shall be subject to the obligations under each such assumption agreement to make residual payments and provide related notices, accruing after the effective date of the transfer and applicable to the exploitation of the rights transferred, and any remedies under each such assumption agreement for breach of those obligations, as those obligations and remedies are set forth in the applicable collective bargaining agreement, if-

"(a) Assumption of Obligations. (1) When copyright ownership of a motion picture is transferred under U.S. law (as defined in section 101 of title 17) and the motion picture is produced under one or more collective bargaining agreements negotiated in the U.S., if the transfer takes place on or after the effective date of this chapter and isn’t just for public performance rights, the transfer document will automatically include the assumption agreements required by the relevant collective bargaining agreement. The new owner will have to fulfill the obligations stated in each assumption agreement to make residual payments and provide necessary notices that start accruing after the transfer's effective date and relate to the use of the transferred rights, as well as any remedies outlined in each assumption agreement for failing to meet those obligations, as specified in the relevant collective bargaining agreement, if—"

"(A) the transferee knows or has reason to know at the time of the transfer that such collective bargaining agreement was or will be applicable to the motion picture; or

"(A) the transferee knows or has reason to know at the time of the transfer that this collective bargaining agreement was or will be applicable to the motion picture; or

"(B) in the event of a court order confirming an arbitration award against the transferor under the collective bargaining agreement, the transferor does not have the financial ability to satisfy the award within 90 days after the order is issued.

"(B) if a court order confirms an arbitration award against the transferor under the collective bargaining agreement, and the transferor can’t afford to pay the award within 90 days after the order is issued."

"(2) For purposes of paragraph (1)(A), 'knows or has reason to know' means any of the following:

"(2) For the purposes of paragraph (1)(A), 'knows or has reason to know' means any of the following:"

"(A) Actual knowledge that the collective bargaining agreement was or will be applicable to the motion picture.

"(A) Actual knowledge that the collective bargaining agreement was or will be applicable to the motion picture."

"(B)(i) Constructive knowledge that the collective bargaining agreement was or will be applicable to the motion picture, arising from recordation of a document pertaining to copyright in the motion picture under section 205 of title 17 or from publication, at a site available to the public on-line that is operated by the relevant union, of information that identifies the motion picture as subject to a collective bargaining agreement with that union, if the site permits commercially reasonable verification of the date on which the information was available for access.

"(B)(i) Constructive knowledge that the collective bargaining agreement applied or will apply to the motion picture, stemming from the recording of a document related to copyright in the motion picture under section 205 of title 17 or from the publication, on a publicly accessible online site operated by the relevant union, of information identifying the motion picture as covered by a collective bargaining agreement with that union, as long as the site allows commercially reasonable verification of the date when the information was accessible."

"(ii) Clause (i) applies only if the transfer referred to in subsection (a)(1) occurs-

"(ii) Clause (i) only applies if the transfer mentioned in subsection (a)(1) takes place-"

"(I) after the motion picture is completed, or

(I) after the movie is completed, or

"(II) before the motion picture is completed and-

"(II) before the motion picture is completed and-"

"(aa) within 18 months before the filing of an application for copyright registration for the motion picture under section 408 of title 17, or

"(aa) within 18 months prior to submitting an application for copyright registration for the motion picture under section 408 of title 17, or"

"(bb) if no such application is filed, within 18 months before the first publication of the motion picture in the United States.

"(bb) if no such application is submitted, within 18 months prior to the first release of the motion picture in the United States."

"(C) Awareness of other facts and circumstances pertaining to a particular transfer from which it is apparent that the collective bargaining agreement was or will be applicable to the motion picture.

"(C) Awareness of other facts and circumstances related to a specific transfer that clearly shows the collective bargaining agreement was or will be relevant to the motion picture."

"(b) Scope of Exclusion of Transfers of Public Performance Rights. For purposes of this section, the exclusion under subsection (a) of transfers of copyright ownership in a motion picture that are limited to public performance rights includes transfers to a terrestrial broadcast station, cable system, or programmer to the extent that the station, system, or programmer is functioning as an exhibitor of the motion picture, either by exhibiting the motion picture on its own network, system, service, or station, or by initiating the transmission of an exhibition that is carried on another network, system, service, or station. When a terrestrial broadcast station, cable system, or programmer, or other transferee, is also functioning otherwise as a distributor or as a producer of the motion picture, the public performance exclusion does not affect any obligations imposed on the transferee to the extent that it is engaging in such functions.

(b) Scope of Exclusion of Transfers of Public Performance Rights. For this section, the exclusion under subsection (a) regarding transfers of copyright ownership in a motion picture that are limited to public performance rights includes transfers to a local broadcast station, cable system, or programmer, as long as the station, system, or programmer is acting as an exhibitor of the motion picture. This can be through showing the motion picture on its own network, system, service, or station, or by starting the transmission of a showing that is aired on another network, system, service, or station. If a local broadcast station, cable system, or programmer, or any other transferee, is also acting as a distributor or a producer of the motion picture, the public performance exclusion does not change any obligations placed on the transferee while they are performing those roles.

"(c) Exclusion for Grants of Security Interests. Subsection (a) shall not apply to-

"(c) Exclusion for Grants of Security Interests. Subsection (a) does not apply to-"

"(1) a transfer of copyright ownership consisting solely of a mortgage, hypothecation, or other security interest; or

"(1) a transfer of copyright ownership that only includes a mortgage, hypothecation, or other security interest; or

"(2) a subsequent transfer of the copyright ownership secured by the security interest described in paragraph (1) by or under the authority of the secured party, including a transfer through the exercise of the secured party's rights or remedies as a secured party, or by a subsequent transferee.

"(2) a later transfer of the copyright ownership covered by the security interest mentioned in paragraph (1) by or on behalf of the secured party, including a transfer through the exercise of the secured party's rights or remedies as a secured party, or by a later transferee."

"The exclusion under this subsection shall not affect any rights or remedies under law or contract.

"The exclusion in this section won't impact any rights or remedies under law or contract."

"(d) Deferral Pending Resolution of Bona Fide Dispute.

"(d) Deferral While Resolving Genuine Dispute."

"A transferee on which obligations are imposed under subsection (a) by virtue of paragraph (1) of that subsection may elect to defer performance of such obligations that are subject to a bona fide dispute between a union and a prior transferor until that dispute is resolved, except that such deferral shall not stay accrual of any union claims due under an applicable collective bargaining agreement.

A transferee who has obligations imposed under subsection (a) because of paragraph (1) of that subsection can choose to postpone fulfilling those obligations if there is a genuine dispute between a union and a previous transferor until the dispute is settled, but this postponement does not prevent any union claims from accumulating that are owed under a relevant collective bargaining agreement.

"(e) Scope of Obligations Determined by Private Agreement. Nothing in this section shall expand or diminish the rights, obligations, or remedies of any person under the collective bargaining agreements or assumption agreements referred to in this section.

"(e) Scope of Obligations Determined by Private Agreement. Nothing in this section will increase or decrease the rights, obligations, or remedies of any person under the collective bargaining agreements or assumption agreements mentioned in this section."

"(f) Failure to Notify. If the transferor under subsection (a) fails to notify the transferee under subsection (a) of applicable collective bargaining obligations before the execution of the transfer instrument, and subsection (a) is made applicable to the transferee solely by virtue of subsection (a)(1)(B), the transferor shall be liable to the transferee for any damages suffered by the transferee as a result of the failure to notify.

"(f) Failure to Notify. If the person transferring under subsection (a) doesn’t inform the person receiving under subsection (a) about the relevant collective bargaining obligations before the transfer agreement is executed, and subsection (a) applies to the person receiving only because of subsection (a)(1)(B), the person transferring will be responsible for any damages the person receiving incurs due to the lack of notification."

"(g) Determination of Disputes and Claims. Any dispute concerning the application of subsections (a) through (f) shall be determined by an action in United States district court, and the court in its discretion may allow the recovery of full costs by or against any party and may also award a reasonable attorney's fee to the prevailing party as part of the costs.

"(g) Determination of Disputes and Claims. Any dispute regarding the application of subsections (a) to (f) will be resolved in a United States district court. The court may, at its discretion, allow the recovery of full costs by or against any party, and it may also award a reasonable attorney's fee to the winning party as part of those costs."

"(h) Study. The Comptroller General, in consultation with the Register of Copyrights, shall conduct a study of the conditions in the motion picture industry that gave rise to this section, and the impact of this section on the motion picture industry. The Comptroller General shall report the findings of the study to the Congress within 2 years after the effective date of this chapter."

"(h) Study. The Comptroller General, in consultation with the Register of Copyrights, will conduct a study on the conditions in the motion picture industry that led to this section, as well as the impact of this section on the motion picture industry. The Comptroller General will report the findings of the study to Congress within 2 years after the effective date of this chapter."

* * * * * * *

* * * * * * *

SEC. 407. EFFECTIVE DATE.

Except as otherwise provided in this title, this title and the amendments made by this title shall take effect on the date of the enactment of this Act.

Except as otherwise stated in this title, this title and the changes made by this title will take effect on the date this Act is enacted.

* * * * * * *

* * * * * * *

Title V-Protection of Certain Original Designs

Title V - Protection of Certain Original Designs

SEC. 501. SHORT TITLE.

This Act may be referred to as the "Vessel Hull Design Protection Act".

This Act may be called the "Vessel Hull Design Protection Act."

* * * * * * *

* * * * * * *

SEC. 503. CONFORMING AMENDMENTS.

* * * * * * *

* * * * * * *

(b) Jurisdictions of District Courts Over Design Actions. (1) Section 1338(c) of title 28, United States Code, is amended by inserting ", and to exclusive rights in designs under chapter 13 of title 17," after "title 17".

(b) Jurisdictions of District Courts Over Design Actions. (1) Section 1338(c) of title 28, United States Code, is amended by adding ", and to exclusive rights in designs under chapter 13 of title 17," after "title 17".

(2)(A) The section heading for section 1338 of title 28, United States Code, is amended by inserting "designs," after "mask works,".

(2)(A) The section heading for section 1338 of title 28, United States Code, is updated by adding "designs," after "mask works,".

(B) The item relating to section 1338 in the table of sections at the beginning of chapter 85 of title 28, United States Code, is amended by inserting "designs," after "mask works,".

(B) The item related to section 1338 in the table of sections at the beginning of chapter 85 of title 28, United States Code, is amended by adding "designs," after "mask works,".

(c) Place for Bringing Design Actions. (1) Section 1400(a) of title 28, United States Code, is amended by inserting "or designs" after "mask works".

(c) Place for Bringing Design Actions. (1) Section 1400(a) of title 28, United States Code, is amended by inserting "or designs" after "mask works".

(2) The section heading for section 1400 of title 28, United States Code is amended to read as follows:

(2) The section heading for section 1400 of title 28, United States Code is updated to say the following:

"Patents and copyrights, mask works, and designs".

"Patents, copyrights, mask works, and designs."

(3) The item relating to section 1400 in the table of sections at the beginning of chapter 87 of title 28, United States Code, is amended to read as follows:

(3) The item concerning section 1400 in the table of sections at the beginning of chapter 87 of title 28, United States Code, is updated to read as follows:

"1400. Patents and copyrights, mask works, and designs.".

"1400. Patents, copyrights, mask works, and designs."

(d) Actions Against the United States. Section 1498(e) of title 28, United States Code, is amended by inserting ", and to exclusive rights in designs under chapter 13 of title 17," after "title 17".

(d) Actions Against the United States. Section 1498(e) of title 28, United States Code, is amended by adding ", and to exclusive rights in designs under chapter 13 of title 17," after "title 17".

SEC. 504. JOINT STUDY OF THE EFFECT OF THIS TITLE [2]

(a) In General. Not later than November 1, 2003, the Register of Copyrights and the Commissioner of Patents and Trademarks shall submit to the Committees on the Judiciary of the Senate and the House of Representatives a joint report evaluating the effect of the amendments made by this title.

(a) In General. Not later than November 1, 2003, the Register of Copyrights and the Commissioner of Patents and Trademarks must submit a joint report to the Judiciary Committees of the Senate and the House of Representatives evaluating the impact of the amendments made by this title.

(b) Elements for Consideration. In carrying out subsection (a), the Register of Copyrights and the Commissioner of Patents and Trademarks shall consider-

(b) Factors to Think About. In executing subsection (a), the Register of Copyrights and the Commissioner of Patents and Trademarks will take into account-

(1) the extent to which the amendments made by this title has been effective in suppressing infringement of the design of vessel hulls;

(1) how effective the amendments made by this title have been in preventing the infringement of vessel hull designs;

(2) the extent to which the registration provided for in chapter 13 of title 17, United States Code, as added by this title, has been utilized;

(2) how much the registration outlined in chapter 13 of title 17, United States Code, added by this title, has been used;

(3) the extent to which the creation of new designs of vessel hulls have been encouraged by the amendments made by this title;

(3) how much the changes made by this title have encouraged the creation of new vessel hull designs;

(4) the effect, if any, of the amendments made by this title on the price of vessels with hulls protected under such amendments; and

(4) the impact, if any, of the changes made by this title on the price of vessels that have hulls protected under these changes; and

(5) such other considerations as the Register and the Commissioner may deem relevant to accomplish the purposes of the evaluation conducted under subsection (a).

(5) any other factors that the Register and the Commissioner might find important to achieve the goals of the evaluation carried out under subsection (a).

SEC. 505. EFFECTIVE DATE. [3]

The amendments made by sections 502 and 503 shall take effect on the date of the enactment of this Act.

The changes made by sections 502 and 503 will go into effect on the date this Act is enacted.

—————————- Appendix V Endnotes

Appendix V Footnotes

1 Part V of the Appendix contains provisions from the Digital Millennium Copyright Act, Pub. L. No. 105-304, 112 Stat. 2860, that do not amend title 17 of the *United States Code.*

1 Part V of the Appendix includes sections from the Digital Millennium Copyright Act, Pub. L. No. 105-304, 112 Stat. 2860, that do not change title 17 of the *United States Code.*

2 The Satellite Home Viewer Improvement Act of 1999 amended section 504(a) in its entirety. Pub. L. No. 106-113, 113 Stat. 1501, app. I at 1501A-593.

2 The Satellite Home Viewer Improvement Act of 1999 completely changed section 504(a). Pub. L. No. 106-113, 113 Stat. 1501, app. I at 1501A-593.

3 The Intellectual Property and Communications Omnibus Reform Act of 1999 amended section 505 by deleting everything at the end of the sentence, after "Act." Pub. L. No. 106-113, 113 Stat. 1501, app. I at 1501A-593.

3 The Intellectual Property and Communications Omnibus Reform Act of 1999 changed section 505 by removing everything at the end of the sentence after "Act." Pub. L. No. 106-113, 113 Stat. 1501, app. I at 1501A-593.

————————————————————————————————————

Understood! Please provide the text you'd like me to modernize.

Appendix VI. Definition of "Berne Convention Work"

Appendix VI. Definition of "Berne Convention Work"

The WIPO Copyright and Performances and Phonograms Treaties Implementation Act of 1998 deleted the definition of "Berne Convention work" from section 101. [1] Pub. L. No. 105-304, 112 Stat. 2861. The definition of Berne Convention work, as deleted, is as follows:

The WIPO Copyright and Performances and Phonograms Treaties Implementation Act of 1998 removed the definition of "Berne Convention work" from section 101. [1] Pub. L. No. 105-304, 112 Stat. 2861. The deleted definition of Berne Convention work is as follows:

A work is a "Berne Convention work" if-

A work is a "Berne Convention work" if—

(1) in the case of an unpublished work, one or more of the authors is a national of a nation adhering to the Berne Convention, or in the case of a published work, one or more of the authors is a national of a nation adhering to the Berne Convention on the date of first publication;

(1) for an unpublished work, one or more of the authors is a citizen of a country that is a member of the Berne Convention, or for a published work, one or more of the authors is a citizen of a country that is a member of the Berne Convention on the date of first publication;

(2) the work was first published in a nation adhering to the Berne Convention, or was simultaneously first published in a nation adhering to the Berne convention and in a foreign nation that does not adhere to the Berne Convention;

(2) the work was first published in a country that follows the Berne Convention, or was simultaneously first published in a country that follows the Berne Convention and in a foreign country that does not follow the Berne Convention;

(3) in the case of an audiovisual work-

(3) in the case of an audiovisual work-

(A) if one or more of the authors is a legal entity, that author has its headquarters in a nation adhering to the Berne Convention; or

(A) if one or more of the authors is a legal entity, that author has its headquarters in a country that is part of the Berne Convention; or

(B) if one or more of the authors is an individual, that author is domiciled, or has his or her habitual residence in, a nation adhering to the Berne Convention; or

(B) if one or more of the authors is an individual, that author is living, or has their main residence in, a country that is part of the Berne Convention; or

(4) in the case of a pictorial, graphic, or sculptural work that is incorporated in a building or other structure, the building or structure is located in a nation adhering to the Berne Convention; or

(4) in the case of a pictorial, graphic, or sculptural work that is incorporated into a building or other structure, the building or structure is located in a country that is a member of the Berne Convention; or

(5) in the case of an architectural work embodied in a building, such building is erected in a country adhering to the Berne Convention.

(5) in the case of an architectural work represented in a building, that building is constructed in a country that is part of the Berne Convention.

For purposes of paragraph (1), an author who is domiciled in or has his or her habitual residence in, a nation adhering to the Berne Convention is considered to be a national of that nation. For purposes of paragraph (2), a work is considered to have been simultaneously published in two or more nations if its dates of publication are within 30 days of one another.

For the purposes of paragraph (1), an author who lives in or has their usual home in a country that is part of the Berne Convention is seen as a national of that country. For the purposes of paragraph (2), a work is regarded as having been published simultaneously in two or more countries if the publication dates are within 30 days of each other.

—————————- Appendix VI Endnote

Appendix VI Footnote

1 For a discussion of the legislative history of the definition of "Berne Convention work," see endnote 2, chapter 1, *supra.*

1 For a discussion of the legislative history of the definition of "Berne Convention work," see endnote 2, chapter 1, *supra.*

————————————————————————————————————

Understood! Please provide the text you'd like to modernize.

Appendix VII. Selected Provisions of the U.S. Code Relating to Copyright

Appendix VII. Selected Provisions of the U.S. Code Related to Copyright

Title 18 - Crimes and Criminal Procedure

Title 18 - Crimes and Criminal Procedure

Part I - Crimes
Chapter 113 - Stolen Property

* * * * * * *

* * * * * * *

Sec. 2318. Trafficking in counterfeit labels for phonorecords, copies of computer programs or computer program documentation or packaging, and copies of motion pictures or other audio visual works, and trafficking in counterfeit computer program documentation or packaging. [1]

Sec. 2318. Dealing in fake labels for recordings, copies of computer programs or their documentation and packaging, and copies of movies or other audiovisual works, as well as dealing in fake computer program documentation or packaging. [1]

(a) Whoever, in any of the circumstances described in subsection (c) of this section, knowingly traffics in a counterfeit label affixed or designed to be affixed to a phonorecord, or a copy of a computer program or documentation or packaging for a computer program, or a copy of a motion picture or other audiovisual work, and whoever, in any of the circumstances described in subsection (c) of this section, knowingly traffics in counterfeit documentation or packaging for a computer program, shall be fined under this title or imprisoned for not more than five years, or both.

(a) Anyone who, under the situations outlined in subsection (c) of this section, knowingly trades in a fake label attached to or intended to be attached to a phonorecord, or a copy of a computer program, its documentation, or packaging, or a copy of a motion picture or any other audiovisual work, and anyone who, under the conditions mentioned in subsection (c) of this section, knowingly trades in fake documentation or packaging for a computer program, will be fined under this title or face up to five years in prison, or both.

(b) As used in this section-

(b) As used in this section-

(1) the term "counterfeit label" means an identifying label or container that appears to be genuine, but is not;

(1) the term "counterfeit label" refers to an identifying label or container that looks real but isn't;

(2) the term "traffic" means to transport, transfer or otherwise dispose of, to another, as consideration for anything of value or to make or obtain control of with intent to so transport, transfer or dispose of; and

(2) the term "traffic" refers to transporting, transferring, or otherwise handing off to someone else, in exchange for something valuable, or to take control with the intention to transport, transfer, or hand off; and

(3) the terms "copy", "phonorecord", "motion picture", "computer program", and "audiovisual work" have, respectively, the meanings given those terms in section 101 (relating to definitions) of title 17.

(3) the terms "copy", "phonorecord", "motion picture", "computer program", and "audiovisual work" have the meanings assigned to them in section 101 (relating to definitions) of title 17.

(c) The circumstances referred to in subsection (a) of this section are-

(c) The situations mentioned in subsection (a) of this section are-

(1) the offense is committed within the special maritime and territorial jurisdiction of the United States; or within the special aircraft jurisdiction of the United States (as defined in section 46501 of title 49);

(1) the crime takes place within the special maritime and territorial jurisdiction of the United States; or within the special aircraft jurisdiction of the United States (as defined in section 46501 of title 49);

(2) the mail or a facility of interstate or foreign commerce is used or intended to be used in the commission of the offense;

(2) the mail or a means of interstate or foreign commerce is used or was meant to be used in carrying out the crime;

(3) the counterfeit label is affixed to or encloses, or is designed to be affixed to or enclose, a copy of a copyrighted computer program or copyrighted documentation or packaging for a computer program, a copyrighted motion picture or other audiovisual work, or a phonorecord of a copyrighted sound recording; or

(3) the fake label is attached to or surrounds, or is meant to be attached to or surround, a copy of a copyrighted computer program or copyrighted documentation or packaging for a computer program, a copyrighted movie or other audiovisual work, or a phonorecord of a copyrighted sound recording; or

(4) the counterfeited documentation or packaging for a computer program is copyrighted.

(4) the fake documentation or packaging for a computer program is copyrighted.

(d) When any person is convicted of any violation of subsection (a), the court in its judgment of conviction shall in addition to the penalty therein prescribed, order the forfeiture and destruction or other disposition of all counterfeit labels and all articles to which counterfeit labels have been affixed or which were intended to have had such labels affixed.

(d) When someone is found guilty of violating subsection (a), the court's judgment will include, in addition to the prescribed penalty, an order to confiscate and destroy or otherwise dispose of all counterfeit labels and any items that have counterfeit labels attached or were meant to have had such labels.

(e) Except to the extent they are inconsistent with the provisions of this title, all provisions of section 509, title 17, United States Code, are applicable to violations of subsection (a).

(e) Except where they conflict with the rules in this title, all parts of section 509, title 17, United States Code, apply to violations of subsection (a).

Sec. 2319. Criminal infringement of a copyright [2]

Sec. 2319. Criminal infringement of a copyright [2]

(a) Whoever violates section 506(a) (relating to criminal offenses) of title 17 shall be punished as provided in subsections (b) and (c) of this section and such penalties shall be in addition to any other provisions of title 17 or any other law.

(a) Anyone who breaks section 506(a) (related to criminal offenses) of title 17 will be punished as outlined in subsections (b) and (c) of this section, and these penalties will be in addition to any other provisions of title 17 or any other law.

(b) Any person who commits an offense under section 506 (a)(1) of title 17-

(b) Anyone who commits an offense under section 506 (a)(1) of title 17

(1) shall be imprisoned not more than 5 years, or fined in the amount set forth in this title, or both, if the offense consists of the reproduction or distribution, including by electronic means, during any 180-day period, of at least 10 copies or phonorecords, of 1 or more copyrighted works, which have a total retail value of more than $2,500;

(1) will be sentenced to a maximum of 5 years in prison, or fined the amount specified in this title, or both, if the offense involves reproducing or distributing, including electronically, at least 10 copies or phonorecords of one or more copyrighted works within any 180-day period, and those works have a total retail value exceeding $2,500;

(2) shall be imprisoned not more than 10 years, or fined in the amount set forth in this title, or both, if the offense is a second or subsequent offense under paragraph (1); and

(2) shall be imprisoned for up to 10 years, or fined an amount specified in this title, or both, if the offense is a second or subsequent offense under paragraph (1); and

(3) shall be imprisoned not more than 1 year, or fined in the amount set forth in this title, or both, in any other case.

(3) shall be imprisoned for no more than 1 year, or fined the amount stated in this title, or both, in any other case.

(c) Any person who commits an offense under section 506(a)(2) of title 17, United States Code-

(c) Anyone who commits an offense under section 506(a)(2) of title 17, United States Code-

(1) shall be imprisoned not more than 3 years, or fined in the amount set forth in this title, or both, if the offense consists of the reproduction or distribution of 10 or more copies or phonorecords of 1 or more copyrighted works, which have a total retail value of $2,500 or more;

(1) will be imprisoned for up to 3 years, fined as specified in this title, or both, if the offense involves reproducing or distributing 10 or more copies or phonorecords of one or more copyrighted works that have a total retail value of $2,500 or more;

(2) shall be imprisoned not more than 6 years, or fined in the amount set forth in this title, or both, if the offense is a second or subsequent offense under paragraph (1); and

(2) shall be imprisoned for no more than 6 years, or fined the amount specified in this title, or both, if the offense is a second or subsequent offense under paragraph (1); and

(3) shall be imprisoned not more than 1 year, or fined in the amount set forth in this title, or both, if the offense consists of the reproduction or distribution of 1 or more copies or phonorecords of 1 or more copyrighted works, which have a total retail value of more than $1,000.

(3) shall be imprisoned for no more than 1 year, or fined the amount specified in this title, or both, if the offense involves reproducing or distributing 1 or more copies or phonorecords of 1 or more copyrighted works that have a total retail value exceeding $1,000.

(d) (1) During preparation of the presentence report pursuant to Rule 32(c) of the Federal Rules of Criminal Procedure, victims of the offense shall be permitted to submit, and the probation officer shall receive, a victim impact statement that identifies the victim of the offense and the extent and scope of the injury and loss suffered by the victim, including the estimated economic impact of the offense on that victim.

(d) (1) While preparing the presentence report according to Rule 32(c) of the Federal Rules of Criminal Procedure, victims of the crime will be allowed to submit, and the probation officer will accept, a victim impact statement that identifies the victim of the crime and details the extent and nature of the injury and loss experienced by the victim, including the estimated financial impact of the crime on that victim.

(2) Persons permitted to submit victim impact statements shall include-

(2) People allowed to submit victim impact statements must include-

(A) producers and sellers of legitimate works affected by conduct involved in the offense;

(A) producers and sellers of authentic works impacted by actions related to the offense;

(B) holders of intellectual property rights in such works; and

(B) holders of intellectual property rights in these works; and

(C) the legal representatives of such producers, sellers, and holders.

(C) the legal representatives of these producers, sellers, and holders.

(e) As used in this section-

(e) As used in this section-

(1) the terms "phonorecord" and "copies" have, respectively, the meanings set forth in section 101 (relating to definitions) of title 17; and

(1) the terms "phonorecord" and "copies" have the meanings defined in section 101 (relating to definitions) of title 17; and

(2) the terms "reproduction" and "distribution" refer to the exclusive rights of a copyright owner under clauses (1) and (3) respectively of section 106 (relating to exclusive rights in copyrighted works), as limited by sections 107 through 120, of title 17.

(2) the terms "reproduction" and "distribution" refer to the exclusive rights of a copyright owner under clauses (1) and (3) respectively of section 106 (related to exclusive rights in copyrighted works), as limited by sections 107 through 120, of title 17.

Sec. 2319A. Unauthorized fixation of and trafficking in sound recordings and music videos of live musical performances [3]

Sec. 2319A. Unauthorized recording and distribution of sound recordings and music videos of live music performances [3]

(a) Offense. Whoever, without the consent of the performer or performers involved, knowingly and for purposes of commercial advantage or private financial gain-

(a) Offense. Anyone who, without the consent of the involved performer or performers, knowingly and for commercial benefit or personal financial gain-

(1) fixes the sounds or sounds and images of a live musical performance in a copy or phonorecord, or reproduces copies or phonorecords of such a performance from an unauthorized fixation;

(1) captures the sounds or audio and visuals of a live music performance in a recording, or makes copies of such a recording without permission;

(2) transmits or otherwise communicates to the public the sounds or sounds and images of a live musical performance; or

(2) sends or communicates to the public the sounds or sounds and images of a live musical performance; or

(3) distributes or offers to distribute, sells or offers to sell, rents or offers to rent, or traffics in any copy or phonorecord fixed as described in paragraph (1), regardless of whether the fixations occurred in the United States;

(3) distributes or offers to distribute, sells or offers to sell, rents or offers to rent, or deals in any copy or phonorecord fixed as described in paragraph (1), no matter if the fixations took place in the United States;

shall be imprisoned for not more than 5 years or fined in the amount set forth in this title, or both, or if the offense is a second or subsequent offense, shall be imprisoned for not more than 10 years or fined in the amount set forth in this title, or both.

shall be imprisoned for no more than 5 years or fined the amount specified in this title, or both. If the offense is a second or subsequent violation, the individual shall be imprisoned for no more than 10 years or fined the amount specified in this title, or both.

(b) Forfeiture and Destruction. When a person is convicted of a violation of subsection (a), the court shall order the forfeiture and destruction of any copies or phonorecords created in violation thereof, as well as any plates, molds, matrices, masters, tapes, and film negatives by means of which such copies or phonorecords may be made. The court may also, in its discretion, order the forfeiture and destruction of any other equipment by means of which such copies or phonorecords may be reproduced, taking into account the nature, scope, and proportionality of the use of the equipment in the offense.

(b) Forfeiture and Destruction. When someone is convicted of violating subsection (a), the court will order the forfeiture and destruction of any copies or phonorecords made in violation, as well as any plates, molds, matrices, masters, tapes, and film negatives used to create those copies or phonorecords. The court may also decide, at its discretion, to order the forfeiture and destruction of any other equipment used to reproduce those copies or phonorecords, considering the nature, scope, and proportionality of the equipment's use in the offense.

(c) Seizure and Forfeiture. If copies or phonorecords of sounds or sounds and images of a live musical performance are fixed outside of the United States without the consent of the performer or performers involved, such copies or phonorecords are subject to seizure and forfeiture in the United States in the same manner as property imported in violation of the customs laws. The Secretary of the Treasury shall, not later than 60 days after the date of the enactment of the Uruguay Round Agreements Act, issue regulations to carry out this subsection, including regulations by which any performer may, upon payment of a specified fee, be entitled to notification by the United States Customs Service of the importation of copies or phonorecords that appear to consist of unauthorized fixations of the sounds or sounds and images of a live musical performance.

(c) Seizure and Forfeiture. If copies or recordings of sounds or sounds and images from a live musical performance are created outside of the United States without the consent of the involved performer(s), those copies or recordings can be seized and forfeited in the United States, just like property imported in violation of customs laws. The Secretary of the Treasury must, within 60 days of the enactment of the Uruguay Round Agreements Act, issue regulations to implement this subsection, including rules that allow any performer to receive notification from the United States Customs Service about the importation of copies or recordings that seem to consist of unauthorized fixations of the sounds or sounds and images from a live musical performance, upon payment of a specified fee.

(d) Victim Impact Statement.

Victim Impact Statement.

(1) During preparation of the presentence report pursuant to Rule 32(c) of the Federal Rules of Criminal Procedure, victims of the offense shall be permitted to submit, and the probation officer shall receive, a victim impact statement that identifies the victim of the offense and the extent and scope of the injury and loss suffered by the victim, including the estimated economic impact of the offense on that victim.

(1) While preparing the presentence report according to Rule 32(c) of the Federal Rules of Criminal Procedure, victims of the crime will be allowed to provide, and the probation officer will receive, a victim impact statement that outlines who the victim is and the degree and range of the injury and loss experienced by the victim, including the estimated economic impact of the crime on that victim.

(2) Persons permitted to submit victim impact statements shall include-

(2) People allowed to submit victim impact statements include-

(A) producers and sellers of legitimate works affected by conduct involved in the offense;

(A) producers and sellers of legitimate works impacted by actions related to the offense;

(B) holders of intellectual property rights in such works; and

(B) holders of intellectual property rights in these works; and

(C) the legal representatives of such producers, sellers, and holders.

(C) the legal representatives of these producers, sellers, and holders.

(e) Definitions. As used in this section-

(e) Definitions. As used in this section-

(1) the terms "copy", "fixed", "musical work", "phonorecord", "reproduce", "sound recordings", and "transmit" mean those terms within the meaning of title 17; and

(1) the terms "copy," "fixed," "musical work," "phonorecord," "reproduce," "sound recordings," and "transmit" have the meanings defined in title 17; and

(2) the term "traffic in" means transport, transfer, or otherwise dispose of, to another, as consideration for anything of value, or make or obtain control of with intent to transport, transfer, or dispose of.

(2) the term "traffic in" means to transport, transfer, or otherwise hand over to someone else, in exchange for something valuable, or to make or gain control of with the intention to transport, transfer, or dispose of.

(f) Applicability. This section shall apply to any Act or Acts that occur on or after the date of the enactment of the Uruguay Round Agreements Act.

(f) Applicability. This section applies to any Act or Acts that occur on or after the date the Uruguay Round Agreements Act is enacted.

* * * * * * *

* * * * * * *

Title 28 - Judiciary and Judicial Procedure

Title 28 - Judiciary and Judicial Procedure

Part IV - Jurisdiction and Venue
Chapter 85 - District Courts; Jurisdiction

* * * * * * *

* * * * * * *

Sec. 1338. Patents, plant variety protection, copyrights, mask works, trade-marks, and unfair competition {4}

Sec. 1338. Patents, plant variety protection, copyrights, mask works, trademarks, and unfair competition {4}

(a) The district courts shall have original jurisdiction of any civil action arising under any Act of Congress relating to patents, plant variety protection, copyrights and trade-marks. Such jurisdiction shall be exclusive of the courts of the states in patent, plant variety protection and copyright cases.

(a) The district courts will have the initial authority over any civil case that comes from any Act of Congress related to patents, plant variety protection, copyrights, and trademarks. This authority will be exclusive to the states' courts in cases involving patents, plant variety protection, and copyrights.

(b) The district courts shall have original jurisdiction of any civil action asserting a claim of unfair competition when joined with a substantial and related claim under the copyright, patent, plant variety protection or trade-mark laws.

(b) The district courts will have original jurisdiction over any civil action claiming unfair competition when it is connected with a significant and related claim under copyright, patent, plant variety protection, or trademark laws.

(c) Subsections (a) and (b) apply to exclusive rights in mask works under chapter 9 of title 17 to the same extent as such subsections apply to copyrights.

(c) Subsections (a) and (b) apply to exclusive rights in mask works under chapter 9 of title 17 just as those subsections apply to copyrights.

* * * * * * * * *

* * * * * * * * *

Chapter 91 - United States Court of Federal Claims

* * * * * * * * *

* * * * * * * * *

Sec. 1498. Patent and copyright cases [5]

Sec. 1498. Patent and copyright cases [5]

* * * * * * * * *

* * * * * * * * *

(b) Hereafter, whenever the copyright in any work protected under the copyright laws of the United States shall be infringed by the United States, by a corporation owned or controlled by the United States, or by a contractor, subcontractor, or any person, firm, or corporation acting for the Government and with the authorization or consent of the Government, the exclusive action which may be brought for such infringement shall be an action by the copyright owner against the United States in the Court of Federal Claims for the recovery of his reasonable and entire compensation as damages for such infringement, including the minimum statutory damages as set forth in section 504(c) of title 17, United States Code: Provided, That a Government employee shall have a right of action against the Government under this subsection except where he was in a position to order, influence, or induce use of the copyrighted work by the Government: Provided, however, That this subsection shall not confer a right of action on any copyright owner or any assignee of such owner with respect to any copyrighted work prepared by a person while in the employment or service of the United States, where the copyrighted work was prepared as a part of the official functions of the employee, or in the preparation of which Government time, material, or facilities were used: And provided further, That before such action against the United States has been instituted the appropriate corporation owned or controlled by the United States or the head of the appropriate department or agency of the Government, as the case may be, is authorized to enter into an agreement with the copyright owner in full settlement and compromise for the damages accruing to him by reason of such infringement and to settle the claim administratively out of available appropriations.

(b) From now on, whenever the copyright in any work protected under U.S. copyright laws is violated by the United States, by a corporation owned or controlled by the United States, or by a contractor, subcontractor, or anyone acting on behalf of the Government with the Government's permission, the only legal action that can be taken for such infringement will be a lawsuit by the copyright owner against the United States in the Court of Federal Claims to recover fair and complete compensation as damages for that infringement, including the minimum statutory damages outlined in section 504(c) of title 17, United States Code: Provided, That a Government employee has the right to sue the Government under this subsection unless they had the authority to order, influence, or promote the use of the copyrighted work by the Government: Provided, however, That this subsection does not give any right to sue for any copyright owner or their assignee regarding any copyrighted work created by someone while working for the United States, where the work was part of the official duties of the employee, or involved the use of Government time, materials, or facilities: And provided further, That before such a lawsuit against the United States is filed, the relevant corporation owned or controlled by the United States or the head of the relevant department or agency of the Government is authorized to enter into an agreement with the copyright owner to fully settle and compromise the damages incurred due to such infringement and to resolve the claim administratively using available funding.

Except as otherwise provided by law, no recovery shall be had for any infringement of a copyright covered by this subsection committed more than three years prior to the filing of the complaint or counterclaim for infringement in the action, except that the period between the date of receipt of a written claim for compensation by the Department or agency of the Government or corporation owned or controlled by the United States, as the case may be, having authority to settle such claim and the date of mailing by the Government of a notice to the claimant that his claim has been denied shall not be counted as a part of the three years, unless suit is brought before the last-mentioned date.

Except as otherwise provided by law, no recovery can be made for any copyright infringement under this subsection that occurred more than three years before the complaint or counterclaim for infringement was filed in the action. However, the time between when the Department or a government agency, or a corporation owned or controlled by the United States, receives a written claim for compensation and when the government mails a notice to the claimant denying the claim will not count as part of the three years, unless a lawsuit is filed before the notice date.

(c) The provisions of this section shall not apply to any claim arising in a foreign country.

(c) The rules in this section do not apply to any claims that come up in a foreign country.

* * * * * * * * * *

* * * * * * * * * *

(e) Subsections (b) and (c) of this section apply to exclusive rights in mask works under chapter 9 of title 17 to the same extent as such subsections apply to copyrights.

(e) Subsections (b) and (c) of this section apply to exclusive rights in mask works under chapter 9 of title 17 just like these subsections apply to copyrights.

* * * * * * * * * *

* * * * * * * * * *

Title 44 - Public Printing and Documents

Title 44 - Public Printing and Documents

Chapter 21 - National Archives and Records Administration

* * * * * * * * * *

* * * * * * * * * *

Sec. 2117. Limitation on liability [6]

Sec. 2117. Limitation on liability [6]

When letters and other intellectual productions (exclusive of patented material, published works under copyright protection, and unpublished works for which copyright registration has been made) come into the custody or possession of the Archivist, the United States or its agents are not liable for infringement of copyright or analogous rights arising out of use of the materials for display, inspection, research, reproduction, or other purposes.

When letters and other intellectual works (excluding patented material, published works under copyright, and unpublished works that are copyrighted) are in the care or possession of the Archivist, the United States or its representatives are not responsible for any copyright infringement or similar rights issues that come up from using the materials for display, inspection, research, reproduction, or other purposes.

——————————- Appendix VII Endnotes

Appendix VII: Endnotes

1 In 1962, section 2318, entitled "Transportation, sale, or receipt of phonograph records bearing forged or counterfeit labels," was added to title 18 of the *United States Code.* Pub. L. No. 87-773, 76 Stat. 775. In 1974, section 2318 was amended to change the penalties. Pub. L. No. 93-573, 88 Stat. 1873. The Copyright Act of 1976 revised section 2318 with an amendment in the nature of a substitute. Pub. L. No. 94-553, 90 Stat. 2541, 2600. The Piracy and Counterfeiting Amendments Act of 1982 again revised section 2318 with an amendment in the nature of a substitute that included a new title, "Trafficking in counterfeit labels for phonorecords, and copies of motion pictures or other audiovisual works." Pub. L. No. 97-180, 96 Stat. 91. The Crime Control Act of 1990 made a technical amendment to section 2318 to delete the comma after "phonorecords" in the title. Pub. L. No. 101-647, 104 Stat. 4789, 4928. In 1994, section 2318(c)(1) was amended by inserting "section 46501 of title 49" in lieu of "section 101 of the Federal Aviation Act of 1958. Pub. L. No. 103-272, 108 Stat. 745, 1374. The Violent Crime Control and Law Enforcement Act of 1994 amended section 2318(a) by inserting "under this title" in lieu of "not more than $250,000." Pub. L. No. 103-322, 108 Stat. 1796, 2148. (As provided in 18 U.S.C. Sec. 3571, the maximum fine for an individual is $250,000, and the maximum fine for an organization is $500,000.)

1 In 1962, section 2318, titled "Transportation, sale, or receipt of phonograph records with forged or counterfeit labels," was added to title 18 of the *United States Code.* Pub. L. No. 87-773, 76 Stat. 775. In 1974, section 2318 was updated to modify the penalties. Pub. L. No. 93-573, 88 Stat. 1873. The Copyright Act of 1976 revised section 2318 with an amendment that essentially replaced it. Pub. L. No. 94-553, 90 Stat. 2541, 2600. The Piracy and Counterfeiting Amendments Act of 1982 further revised section 2318 with a similar type of amendment that added a new title, "Trafficking in counterfeit labels for phonorecords, and copies of motion pictures or other audiovisual works." Pub. L. No. 97-180, 96 Stat. 91. The Crime Control Act of 1990 made a technical amendment to section 2318 by removing the comma after "phonorecords" in the title. Pub. L. No. 101-647, 104 Stat. 4789, 4928. In 1994, section 2318(c)(1) was amended by replacing "section 101 of the Federal Aviation Act of 1958" with "section 46501 of title 49." Pub. L. No. 103-272, 108 Stat. 745, 1374. The Violent Crime Control and Law Enforcement Act of 1994 amended section 2318(a) by changing "not more than $250,000" to "under this title." Pub. L. No. 103-322, 108 Stat. 1796, 2148. (As noted in 18 U.S.C. Sec. 3571, the maximum fine for an individual is $250,000, and the maximum fine for an organization is $500,000.)

The Anticounterfeiting Consumer Protection Act of 1996 amended section 2318 by changing the title, by amending subsection (a) to insert "a computer program or documentation" through to "knowingly traffics in counterfeit documentation or packaging for a computer program" in lieu of "a motion picture or other audiovisual work" and by amending subsection (b)(3) to insert "computer program" after "motion picture." Pub. L. No. 104-153, 110 Stat. 1386. The Act also amended section 2318(c) by inserting "a copy of a copyrighted computer program or copyrighted documentation or packaging for a computer program" into paragraph (3) and by adding paragraph (4). *Id.* at 1387.

The Anticounterfeiting Consumer Protection Act of 1996 updated section 2318 by changing the title, modifying subsection (a) to add "a computer program or documentation" through to "knowingly traffics in counterfeit documentation or packaging for a computer program" instead of "a motion picture or other audiovisual work," and by revising subsection (b)(3) to include "computer program" after "motion picture." Pub. L. No. 104-153, 110 Stat. 1386. The Act also changed section 2318(c) by adding "a copy of a copyrighted computer program or copyrighted documentation or packaging for a computer program" into paragraph (3) and by adding paragraph (4). *Id.* at 1387.

2 The Piracy and Counterfeiting Amendments Act of 1982 added section 2319 to title 18 of the *United States Code.* Pub. L. No. 97-180, 96 Stat. 91, 92. In 1992, section 2319 was amended by substituting a new subsection (b), by deleting "sound recording," "motion picture" and "audiovisual work" from subsection (c)(1) and by substituting "120" for "118" in subsection (c)(2). Pub. L. No. 102-561, 106 Stat. 4233. In 1997, a technical amendment corrected the spelling of "last" in subsection (b)(1) to "least." Pub. L. No. 105-80, 111 Stat. 1529, 1536.

2 The Piracy and Counterfeiting Amendments Act of 1982 added section 2319 to title 18 of the *United States Code.* Pub. L. No. 97-180, 96 Stat. 91, 92. In 1992, section 2319 was updated by replacing the previous subsection (b), removing "sound recording," "motion picture," and "audiovisual work" from subsection (c)(1), and changing "118" to "120" in subsection (c)(2). Pub. L. No. 102-561, 106 Stat. 4233. In 1997, a technical amendment fixed the spelling of "last" in subsection (b)(1) to "least." Pub. L. No. 105-80, 111 Stat. 1529, 1536.

In 1997, the No Electronic Theft Act amended section 2319 of title 18 as follows: 1) in subsection (a) by inserting "and (c)" after "subsection (b),"; 2) in subsection (b), in the matter preceding paragraph (1), by inserting "section 506(a)(1) of title 17" in lieu of "subsection (a) of this section,"; 3) in subsection (b)(1) by inserting "including by electronic means" and by inserting "which have a total retail value" in lieu of "with a retail value," 4) by redesignating subsection (c) as subsection (e); and 5) by adding new subsections (c) and (d). Pub. L. No. 105-147, 111 Stat. 2678. The Act also directed the United States Sentencing Commission to "ensure that the applicable guideline range for a defendant convicted of a crime against intellectual property . . . is sufficiently stringent to deter such a crime" and to "ensure that the guidelines provide for consideration of the retail value and quantity of the items with respect to which the crime against intellectual property was committed."* Id.* See also endnote 5, chapter 5, *supra.*

In 1997, the No Electronic Theft Act changed section 2319 of title 18 as follows: 1) in subsection (a) by adding "and (c)" after "subsection (b),"; 2) in subsection (b), in the part before paragraph (1), by replacing "subsection (a) of this section," with "section 506(a)(1) of title 17"; 3) in subsection (b)(1) by adding "including by electronic means" and replacing "with a retail value," with "which have a total retail value"; 4) by renumbering subsection (c) as subsection (e); and 5) by adding new subsections (c) and (d). Pub. L. No. 105-147, 111 Stat. 2678. The Act also instructed the United States Sentencing Commission to "ensure that the applicable guideline range for a defendant convicted of a crime against intellectual property . . . is sufficiently stringent to deter such a crime" and to "ensure that the guidelines provide for consideration of the retail value and quantity of the items with respect to which the crime against intellectual property was committed."* Id.* See also endnote 5, chapter 5, *supra.*

3 In 1994, the Uruguay Round Agreements Act added section 2319A to title 18 of the *United States Code.* Pub. L. No. 103-465, 108 Stat. 4809, 4974. In 1997, the No Electronic Theft Act amended section 2319A by redesignating subsections (d) and (e) as subsections (e) and (f), respectively, and by adding subsection (d). Pub. L. No. 105-147, 111 Stat. 2678. See also endnote 2, *supra*, regarding the United States Sentencing Commission.

3 In 1994, the Uruguay Round Agreements Act added section 2319A to title 18 of the *United States Code.* Pub. L. No. 103-465, 108 Stat. 4809, 4974. In 1997, the No Electronic Theft Act updated section 2319A by renumbering subsections (d) and (e) to (e) and (f), respectively, and by adding a new subsection (d). Pub. L. No. 105-147, 111 Stat. 2678. See also endnote 2, *supra*, regarding the United States Sentencing Commission.

4 In 1948, section 1338, entitled "Patents, copyrights, trade-marks, and unfair competition," was added to title 28 of the *United States Code.* Pub. L. No. 773, 62 Stat. 869, 931. In 1970, the title of section 1338 and the text of subsection (b) were amended to insert "plant variety protection" after "patent." Pub. L. No. 91-577, 84 Stat. 1542, 1559. In 1988, the Judicial Improvements and Access to Justice Act amended section 1338 by adding "mask works" to the title and by adding subsection (c). Pub. L. No. 100-702, 102 Stat. 4642, 4671.

4 In 1948, section 1338, titled "Patents, copyrights, trademarks, and unfair competition," was added to title 28 of the *United States Code.* Pub. L. No. 773, 62 Stat. 869, 931. In 1970, the title of section 1338 and the text of subsection (b) were updated to include "plant variety protection" after "patent." Pub. L. No. 91-577, 84 Stat. 1542, 1559. In 1988, the Judicial Improvements and Access to Justice Act revised section 1338 by adding "mask works" to the title and by including subsection (c). Pub. L. No. 100-702, 102 Stat. 4642, 4671.

5 In 1960, section 1498 of the *United States Code* was amended to add subsections (b) and (c). Pub. L. No. 86-726, 74 Stat. 855. The Copyright Act of 1976 amended section 1498(b) to insert "section 504(c) of title 17" in lieu of "section 101(b) of title 17." Pub. L. No. 94-553, 90 Stat. 2541, 2599. The Federal Courts Improvement Act of 1982 amended section 1498(a) to insert "United States Claims Court" in lieu of "Court of Claims" and, in subsections (b) and (d), to insert "Claims Court" in lieu of "Court of Claims," wherever it appeared. Pub. L. No. 97-164, 96 Stat. 25, 40. In 1988, the Judicial Improvements and Access to Justice Act amended section 1498 by adding subsection (e). Pub. L. No. 100-702, 102 Stat. 4642, 4671. The Federal Courts Administration Act of 1992 amended section 1498 by inserting "United States Court of Federal Claims" in lieu of "United States Claims Court," wherever it appeared, and by inserting "Court of Federal Claims" in lieu of "Claims Court," wherever it appeared. Pub. L. No. 102-572, 106 Stat. 4506, 4516. In 1997, the No Electronic Theft (NET) Act amended section 1498(b) to insert "action which may be brought for such infringement shall be an action by the copyright owner" in lieu of "remedy of the owner of such copyright shall be by action." Pub. L. No. 105-147, 111 Stat. 2678, 2680.

5 In 1960, section 1498 of the *United States Code* was updated to include subsections (b) and (c). Pub. L. No. 86-726, 74 Stat. 855. The Copyright Act of 1976 changed section 1498(b) to replace "section 101(b) of title 17" with "section 504(c) of title 17." Pub. L. No. 94-553, 90 Stat. 2541, 2599. The Federal Courts Improvement Act of 1982 revised section 1498(a) to change "Court of Claims" to "United States Claims Court" and updated subsections (b) and (d) to replace "Court of Claims" with "Claims Court," wherever it appeared. Pub. L. No. 97-164, 96 Stat. 25, 40. In 1988, the Judicial Improvements and Access to Justice Act modified section 1498 by adding subsection (e). Pub. L. No. 100-702, 102 Stat. 4642, 4671. The Federal Courts Administration Act of 1992 revised section 1498 to replace "United States Claims Court" with "United States Court of Federal Claims," wherever it appeared, and to change "Claims Court" to "Court of Federal Claims," wherever it was mentioned. Pub. L. No. 102-572, 106 Stat. 4506, 4516. In 1997, the No Electronic Theft (NET) Act modified section 1498(b) to change "remedy of the owner of such copyright shall be by action" to "action which may be brought for such infringement shall be an action by the copyright owner." Pub. L. No. 105-147, 111 Stat. 2678, 2680.

6 In 1968, section 2113, entitled "Limitation on liability," was added to title 44 of the *United States Code.* Pub. L. No. 90-620, 82 Stat. 1238, 1291. The Copyright Act of 1976 amended section 2113 in its entirety. Pub. L. No. 94-553, 90 Stat. 2541, 2599. The National Archives and Records Administration Act of 1984 amended section 2113 by redesignating it as section 2117 and by inserting "Archivist" in lieu of "Administrator of General Services." Pub. L. No. 98-497, 98 Stat. 2280 and 2286.

6 In 1968, section 2113, titled "Limitation on liability," was added to title 44 of the *United States Code.* Pub. L. No. 90-620, 82 Stat. 1238, 1291. The Copyright Act of 1976 completely revised section 2113. Pub. L. No. 94-553, 90 Stat. 2541, 2599. The National Archives and Records Administration Act of 1984 revised section 2113 by renumbering it as section 2117 and by replacing "Administrator of General Services" with "Archivist." Pub. L. No. 98-497, 98 Stat. 2280 and 2286.

————————————————————————————————————

Understood! Please provide the text you'd like me to modernize.

09-Aug-2001

09-Aug-2001


Download ePUB

If you like this ebook, consider a donation!